Informatique Multifonction Monochrome 24ppm Multifonction laser mono SCX-4825FN - Mode d'emploi - Manuel de l'utilisateur - Manuels- Samsung

SAMSUNG sur fnac.com - Liste des manuels utilisateur Samsung - Revenir à l'accueil

 

 

 

24ppm Multifonction laser mono  SCX-4825FN

 

Description

Date de distribution Décroissant

Langue

Fichier Décroissant

Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2013.05.07 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 0.91 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2013.05.07 KOREAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 0.87 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 CZECH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.14 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 DANISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.11 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 GERMAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.14 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 GREEK, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.23 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide Open source 2010.04.13 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 0.07 MB
Guide Open source Téléchargement Guide Open source Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 SPANISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.14 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 FINNISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.11 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 FRENCH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.14 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 HUNGARIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.15 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 ITALIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.3 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 DUTCH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.13 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 NORWEGIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.1 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 PORTUGUESE(European), MULTI LANGUAGE 1.14 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 POLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.18 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2010.04.13 SWEDISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.98 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Guide du pilote d’impression universel 2010.04.13 SWEDISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.1 MB
Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement Guide du pilote d’impression universel Téléchargement
Déclaration de conformité 2009.10.13 ANGLAIS 0.08 MB
Déclaration de conformité Téléchargement Déclaration de conformité Téléchargement
Guide relatif au plug-in de comptabilisation des travaux de SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 3.62 MB
Guide relatif au plug-in de comptabilisation des travaux de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif au plug-in de comptabilisation des travaux de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif au plug-in de gestion du pilote de SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.1 MB
Guide relatif au plug-in de gestion du pilote de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif au plug-in de gestion du pilote de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif au plug-in de localisation des périphériques de SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.69 MB
Guide relatif au plug-in de localisation des périphériques de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif au plug-in de localisation des périphériques de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif à SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 6.68 MB
Guide relatif à SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif à SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif au plug-in de comptabilisation des travaux de SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 KOREAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 2.31 MB
Guide relatif au plug-in de comptabilisation des travaux de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif au plug-in de comptabilisation des travaux de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif au plug-in de gestion du pilote de SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 KOREAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.33 MB
Guide relatif au plug-in de gestion du pilote de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif au plug-in de gestion du pilote de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif au plug-in de localisation des périphériques de SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 KOREAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 1.65 MB
Guide relatif au plug-in de localisation des périphériques de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif au plug-in de localisation des périphériques de SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide relatif à SyncThru 5.0 2009.10.08 KOREAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.04 MB
Guide relatif à SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement Guide relatif à SyncThru 5.0 Téléchargement
Guide rapide 2009.09.11 ANGLAIS 8.26 MB
Guide rapide Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 BULGARIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.36 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 CZECH, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.22 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 DANISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.92 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 GERMAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 8 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 GREEK, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.02 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 ENGLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.72 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 SPANISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.07 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 FINNISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.89 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 FRENCH, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.04 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 HUNGARIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.08 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 ITALIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.01 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 DUTCH, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.97 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 NORWEGIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.97 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 PORTUGUESE(European), MULTI LANGUAGE 8.07 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 POLISH, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.27 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 ROMANIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 8.1 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Manuel de l'utilisateur 2009.08.17 SLOVENIAN, MULTI LANGUAGE 7.91 MB
Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement Manuel de l'utilisateur Téléchargement
Guide rapide 2008.05.23 ANGLAIS 2.68 MB
Guide rapide Téléchargement

 

Recherche par catégories :

Imprimantes       Téléphones

      GSM            Informatique

Ordinateurs            Galaxy

    Photo                  TV  

Electroménager 

Autres Manuels Utilisateurs ou documentation Samsung :

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 24-Jun-2013 15:13  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 24-Jun-2013 15:11  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 24-Jun-2013 15:10  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 24-Jun-2013 15:10  1.9M 

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 24-Jun-2013 11:31  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 24-Jun-2013 11:31  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 24-Jun-2013 11:29  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Jun-2013 11:29  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 24-Jun-2013 11:28  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 24-Jun-2013 11:28  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 24-Jun-2013 11:27  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 24-Jun-2013 11:27  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 24-Jun-2013 11:26  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Jun-2013 11:26  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 24-Jun-2013 11:25  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimante-I..> 24-Jun-2013 07:11  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Fnac.htm        24-Jun-2013 07:07  3.0M

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Jun-2013 07:20  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimante-I..> 20-Jun-2013 07:19  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-LED-SE..> 20-Jun-2013 07:18  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Jun-2013 07:18  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Video-DEL..> 20-Jun-2013 07:17  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 20-Jun-2013 06:59  2.3M 

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Jun-2013 06:59  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 20-Jun-2013 06:59  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camescopes-P..> 20-Jun-2013 06:49  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Video-3D-..> 20-Jun-2013 06:49  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-Camco..> 20-Jun-2013 06:47  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-Wirele..> 20-Jun-2013 06:47  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-3D-UN7..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Sma..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:21  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 17-Jun-2013 07:21  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 17-Jun-2013 07:20  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:20  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 17-Jun-2013 07:20  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Video-3D-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:19  2.9M 

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-3D-UN7..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Sma..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 17-Jun-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:21  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 17-Jun-2013 07:21  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 17-Jun-2013 07:20  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:20  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 17-Jun-2013 07:20  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Video-3D-..> 17-Jun-2013 07:19  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-3D-Blu..> 13-Jun-2013 07:28  3.6M

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Smart..> 13-Jun-2013 07:25  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Tel..> 13-Jun-2013 07:25  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-LCD..> 13-Jun-2013 07:24  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camescopes-P..> 13-Jun-2013 07:24  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephones-C..> 13-Jun-2013 07:23  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 13-Jun-2013 07:23  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-IT-producten..> 13-Jun-2013 07:23  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 13-Jun-2013 07:23  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-3D-Blu..> 13-Jun-2013 07:22  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Sma..> 13-Jun-2013 07:22  3.0M

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 12-Jun-2013 08:19  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-Office-LC..> 12-Jun-2013 08:18  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 12-Jun-2013 08:18  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 12-Jun-2013 08:18  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Printer-Mult..> 12-Jun-2013 08:18  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 12-Jun-2013 08:17  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 12-Jun-2013 08:17  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-Camco..> 12-Jun-2013 08:17  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Tel..> 12-Jun-2013 08:17  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Smart..> 12-Jun-2013 08:16  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 12-Jun-2013 08:16  2.8M 

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Imprim..> 11-Jun-2013 11:43  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Teleph..> 11-Jun-2013 11:43  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-GSM-Ma..> 11-Jun-2013 11:43  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Inform..> 11-Jun-2013 11:43  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Ordina..> 11-Jun-2013 11:43  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Galaxy..> 11-Jun-2013 11:42  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Electr..> 11-Jun-2013 11:42  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-Photo-..> 11-Jun-2013 11:42  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Liste-TV-Man..> 11-Jun-2013 11:42  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Liste-Produits-Manue..> 11-Jun-2013 09:51  511K  

[TXT]

 Liste-Manuels-Utilis..> 11-Jun-2013 09:51  379K 

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Multifonction-lasercouleur-CLX-3170FN-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Multifonction-lasercouleur-CLX-3170FN-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3175FW-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Multifonction-lasercouleur-CLX-3185FW-Manuels-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/19-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-S19A300N-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/20ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6220FX-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/24ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6250FX-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/27-Serie7-Moniteur-station-d-accueil-C27A750-C27A750X-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/32-UE32D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D6200TS-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/35-35ppm-Copieur-couleur-CLX-9350ND-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/40-UE40D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D6500VS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/46-LE46D550WXZF-serie-5-HD-TV-LCD-TV-LE46D550K1W-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/CLX-3185FW.htm

/SAMSUNG/GalaxyAceGT-S5830.htm

/SAMSUNG/Galaxy-S-Advance-GT-I9070P-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/GalaxySIIGT-I9100.htm

/SAMSUNG/GalaxyTab10.1GT-P7500M16.htm

/SAMSUNG/GalaxyTab8.9GT-P7310M16.htm

/SAMSUNG/GalaxyYGT-S5360.htm

/SAMSUNG/Galaxy-Y-S5360-AndroidGT-S5360-Manuels-Utilisateur-et-Guides-Rapide-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/index.html

/SAMSUNG/LE32C350LE32C350D1W.htm

/SAMSUNG/LE40C630LE40C630K1W.htm

/SAMSUNG/LE55C650-LE55C650L1W-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Liste-Manuels-Utilisateur-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Liste-Produits-Manuels-Utilisateur-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-19-UE19D4000WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LED-TV-UE19D4000NW-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-19-UE19D4010WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LED-TV-UE19D4010NW-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-Galaxy-Mini-2-GT-S6500-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-Galaxy-Y-GT-S5360-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-GT-B5510-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-GT-B7300-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-UE46ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE46ES7000S-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Manuels-Utilisateur-et-Guides-Rapide-Samsung-Galaxy-S-II-noir-Open-market-GT-I9100.htm

/SAMSUNG/Micro-chaine-MM-D330DWXZF-serie-3-MM-D330-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/MM-C330D.htm

/SAMSUNG/MM-D330D.htm

/SAMSUNG/N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/N150-NP-N150-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-GT-B5310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/RSH5UEPN.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-16-MP-Ecran-LCD-3-Compact-Performant-WB700-SAMSUNG-WB700-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-18-XTDVBEUE-SWE-0327.pdf-Suede-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-20120405165711377-2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-20-XTDVBEUE-NOR-0327.pdf-E-Manual-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-2243QW-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-22-LE22D450WXZF-serie-4-Full-HD-LCD-TV-LE22D450G1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-24-LED-HDTV-%D0%9C%D0%BE%D0%BD%D0%B8%D1%82%D0%BE%D1%80-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D0%B8-3-T24B30-T24B301EW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-24-LED-HDTV-\xd0\x9c\xd0\xbe\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd1\x82\xd0\xbe\xd1\x80-\xd1\x81\xd0\xb5\xd1\x80\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb8-3-T24B30-T24B301EW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-305U1A-A02-NP305U1A-A02HK-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-320MXN-3-SSD-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-320TSN-3D-SSD-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-32-LE32D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LCD-TV-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-32-UE32D4000WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LED-TV-UE32D4000NW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-400EXN-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-400TS-3-400TS-3-SIM-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-400TS-3D-400TS-3D-SIM-SSD-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-400UXN-3-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-400UXN-3-SSD-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-40-LE40D550WXZF-serie-5-HD-TV-LCD-TV-LE40D550K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-40-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE40ES6565U-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-40-UE40D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D5700RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-40-UE40D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D6500VS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-40-UE40D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D8000YS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-460UT-B-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6535-UE46ES6535U-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-01-XTDVBEUE-ENG-0327.pdf-E-Manual-Anglais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-19-XTDVBEUE-DAN-0327.pdf-E-Manual-Danemark-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-2012_Skype_FIN-0424.pdf-Finlande-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-2012_Skype_NOR-0424.pdf-E-Manual-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-2012_Skype_SWE-0424.pdf-Suede-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-21-XTDVBEUE-FIN-0327.pdf-E-Manual-Finlande-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6565-UE46ES6565U-Danemark-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES7005-UE46ES7005U-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-UE46D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D5700RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-46-UE46D7000WXZF-serie-7

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-51-Smart-3D-Plasma-E555-PS51E555D1K-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-51-Smart-3D-Plasma-E8005-PS51E8005GU-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-55-Smart-3D-LED-TV-ES6805-UE55ES6805U-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-700TSn-2-SSD-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-708SC-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-740SC-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-821SC-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-910MP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-940SC-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-941SC-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Affichage-Dynamique-Murs-d-images-55-Moniteur-LED-UD55A-mur-d-image-bord-fin-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Appareil-photo-numerique-Samsung-ES90-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Appareils-menagers-La-Plaque-Chauffante-Pensez-intelligemment-vivez-simplement-GN641FFXD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Appareils-mobiles-Smartphone-Galaxy-S4-I9505-Android-Impression-GT-I9505-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Appareils-mobiles-Smartphone-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-AQ09UGBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-AQ18UGFN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-AQV12KBBN-Pologne-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-AQV18UGAX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-BN68-04109G-00L05-0228.pdf-LED-TV-Serie-6-user-manual-Anglais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Camaras-Alta-definicion-Videocamara-HD-F80HMX-F80SP-Espagne-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Camera-Camcorder-Compact-ES90-14.2MP-Digital-Camera-FIND-A-PRODUCT-SAMSUNG-ES90-English-Anglais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Camera-Camcorder-Compact-ST66-SAMSUNG-ST66-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Camera-et-Camcorder-NX-NX11-Appareil-photo-compact-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Camera-et-Camcorder-NX-NX5-Appareil-photo-compact-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Camescopes-Photo-Compacts-numeriques-Samsung-SMART-Kompaktkamera-WB800F-SAMSUNG-WB800F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Cell-Phones-AT-T-SGH-I547-Samsung-Galaxy-Rugby-Pro-AT-T-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Cell-Phones-AT-T-SGH-I577-Samsung-Galaxy-Exhilarate-Android-Smartphone-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Cell-Phones-Sprint-SPH-L300-Samsung-Galaxy-Victory-4G-LTE-Sprint-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Cell-Phones-Verizon-Wireless-SCH-I405-Samsung-Stratosphere-a-Galaxy-S-phone-Black-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Cell-Phones-VIEW-ALL-SPH-M930-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-CLP-367W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Congelateur-1porteA-277-L-Blanc-RZ80FHSW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Cuisson-Four-Four-compact-Twin-30-L-FQV113T002-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-CW21Z503N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-CW21Z573N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-DA68-01829P.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-DA68-01829P.pdf-SEC-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-DA-E550-CN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/SAMSUNG-DV90-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-E1720NR-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electrom%C3%A9nager-Lave-vaisselle-DW5363PGBWQ-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-Cassette-1-voie-MH026FSEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-Cassette-4-voies-MH035FMEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH020FNEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH026FWEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH035FEEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH035FJEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH052FJEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH052FWEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH060FXEA3A-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH068FXEA4-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH18AP2X-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ09UGFN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12TSBN.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12UGBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ18FAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ18UGAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV07PSBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09KBBN.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09PSBX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09UGAX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12KBAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12NSBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12PSBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12PWAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGAX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18KBAX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18PSBX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18UGAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV24PSBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-Mistral-AQV09PSBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-Mistral-AQV09PSBN-User-Manuals-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-SH24TA6D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Combines-Refrigerateur-Combine-RB29FEJNDWW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Combines-RL34HGMG-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT41MASW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT50QMSW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59NBPN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59PMSW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT63VBPN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Four-Four-compact-Twin-30-L-FQV113T002-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Lavage-Lave-Linge-WF70F5E3U4W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-Lave-linge-EcoBubble-12kg-1400tours-WF1124XBC-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF0702NBE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF1702NHWG-YLE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF70F5E3U4W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-vaisselle-DW5363PGBSL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-Gril-23L-SILVER-GS89F-1SPGS89F-1SP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-gril-niche-380-mm-23-L-FG87SST-FG87SST-XEF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-mono-23L-SILVER-ME82V-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-CTN431SC0R-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-CTN431SC0S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-Table-induction-2-zones-7-2-KW-CTN364N006-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-Table-induction-4-foyers-7-2-KW-CTN464FB01-CTN464FB01-XEF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXC4H140EE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXDUH112EE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXTJH036EE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXWNH022EE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-Neo-Forte-EHS-Hybride-NH022NHXEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH160PHXEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH200WHXES-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH300WHXES-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NS0351DXEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NS071SDXEA-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-RVXMHF050EA-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Robot-Aspirateur-Robot-2-murs-Virtuel-Noir-SR8895-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Robot-SR8750-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Sans-sac-SC86H0-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Sans-sac-SC8850-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-electromenagers-Cuisinieres-NE595R0ABBB-Cuisiniere-electrique-de-5-9-pi-noir-NE595R0ABBB-AC-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-electromenagers-Cuisinieres-NE595R0ABSR-AC-Cuisiniere-a-convection-de-5-9-pi-acier-inoxydable-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Sechoir-seche-linge-condensation-8kg-SDC3C801-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Belgique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrig%C3%A9rateur-SBS-A-510-L-Inox%20RSH5TERS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-SBS-A-507-L-Blanc-RSA1TWP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-Side-By-Side-RS6178UGDSR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-RSA1DTMG-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Electrom-nager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-E-MANUAL-X9DVBEU4E-ENG-Manuel.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Entro-SPH-m350-SPH-M350-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Exhibit-4G-Android-Smartphone-SGH-T759-USA-Etats-Unis-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Gainable-Slim-MH026FEEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-noir-Open-market-GT-S5830-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Gio-noir-SFR-GT-S5660-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-mini-gris-Open-market-GT-S5570-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-NEXUS-SC-04D-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-noir-Bouygues-GT-I7500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Note-10-1-GT-N8000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/SamsungGalaxyNoteGT-N7000.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Note-II-GT-N7100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Note-SC-05D-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S2-GT-I9100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/SamsungGalaxySGT-I9000.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-GT-I9100-SINGAPOUR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-III-GT-I9300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-III-Pub-TV.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-LTE-SC-03D-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-II-noir-Open-market-Manuels-Samsung.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Spica-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5700-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-Plus-blanc-Orange-GT-I9001-manuel.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL-noir-Open%20market-GT-I9003-M4-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL-noir-Open-market-GT-I9003-M4-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10.1v-P7100-Android-GT-P7100-M16-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuel.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-10-1-LTE-SC-01D-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-GT-P5100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10-1-Wi-Fi-GT-P5110-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels-Mode-d-emploi.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-7.0-Plus-SC-02D-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-7-0-Wi-Fi-GT-P3110-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-GT-P1000-GT-P1000-M16-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-SC-01C-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Xcover-orange-Open-market-GT-S5690-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Galaxy-Y-DUOS-GT-S6102-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Y-Pro-Duos-GT-B5512-RUSSE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GALAXY-Y-Pro-GT-B5510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-GSM-Champ-Duos-E2652-GT-E2652W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-GSM-E1050-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-GSM-E1180-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-GSM-E2202GT-E2202-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-GSM-E2202GT-E2202-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Android-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-Gio-S5660-Android-GT-S5660-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-Note-N7000-AndroidGT-N7000-Belgique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-Pocket-S5300-Android-GT-S5300-Android-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-S4-I9505-Android-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-S-Advance-i9070-Android-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-SIII-4G-i9305-AndroidGT-I9305-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-S-II-Plus-I9105-Android-GT-I9105P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-S-Plus-i9001-Android-GT-I9001-M8-Belgique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Galaxy-Y-S5360-AndroidGT-S5360-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-GT-B5510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GSM-Smartphone-Wave-Y-S5380-Bada-GT-S5380D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-B5310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-I9250-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-I9300_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.2_120725_Screen.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-I9300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-N8000-CN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-N8000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-P5110-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-P6200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-S5360_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_111130_Screen-Manuel.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-S5360-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-S5570_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_110726_Screen.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-GT-S5830_UM_Orange_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_110825_Screen-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Home-Appliance-Side-by-Side-RSA1STMG-Arabe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Home-Appliance-Top-Loader-Top-Load-Washing-Machine-WA10W9-Singapour-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Home-Appliance-Top-Mounted-Fridge-Freezer-SR365TSS-Nouvelle-Zelande-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-I9300-GT-I9300-Afrique-du-Nord-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-et-imprimantes-multifonctions-Laser-couleur-CLP-365W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-et-imprimantes-multifonctions-Laser-monochrome-ML-2955ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-et-imprimantes-multifonctions-Multifonctions-couleurCLX-9251NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Imprimantes-laser-monochromes-multifonctions-43-ppm-A4-imprimante-laser-multifonction-noir-et-blanc-SCX-6545N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Imprimantes-laser-monochromes-multifonctions-52-ppm-A4-imprimante-laser-noir-et-blanc-ML-5510ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-laser-couleur-multifonctions-A3-35-ppm-A3-imprimante-laser-multifonction-couleur-CLX-9352NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-laser-couleur-multifonctions-A3-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-laser-monochromes-multifonctions-43-ppm-A4-imprimante-laser-multifonction-noir-et-blanc-SCX-6545NX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Multifonctions-Copieurs-A3-Multifonctions-CLX-9201NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Multifonctions-Copieurs-A4-A3-Copieur-monochrome-SCX-6555N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Multifonctions-Imprimantes-Laser-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-680ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Multifonctions-Imprimantes-Laser-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-775ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Multifonctions-Imprimantes-Laser-Monochrome-ML-6510ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Imprimantes-Multifonctions-Multifonctions-Laser-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-4705ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatica-LCD-2043SW-Portugues-Portugais-Bresil-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique%20Multifonction-Monochrome-24ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4824FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique%20Ordinateur-Portable-12-5-Serie-4-Gamme-Professionnelle-400B2B-NP400B2B-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-CE117PPT-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-320-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-32-32ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-770ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-360-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-365-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-620ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-775ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-16ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-1630-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-16ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-1660-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-18ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-1865-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-18ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-1865W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-24ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-2580N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2160-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2545-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-3710ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-3750ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-4510ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-Monochrome-SL-M2825ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-ML-1674-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2540R-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-ML-6510ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Imprimantes-Photos-SPP-2040-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Inkjet-Imprimante-jet-d-encre-CJX-1050W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD%20770TFT-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-151P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-152B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-170T-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-191T-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-226BW-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-226BW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-22-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T22A300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-23-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-S23A350H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-23-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T23A350-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-24-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T24A350-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-27-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T27A300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-460DR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-B1930N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-BX2231-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-BX2240W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-C24B550U-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-C27B750X-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-P2470HD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19B350N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19C200NW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19C450MR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-InformatiqueMoniteur-LCD-S19C450MW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S22A300H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S22B150N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S22C300H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24A650D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24A650S-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B300BL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B350H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B750V-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B970D-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27C650D-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T22B300-T22B300EW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T23A750-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T24B300-T24B300EW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T27B750EW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Moniteurs-moniteur-LCD-32-et-plus-ME40B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-lasercouleur-CLX-3185FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-3170FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-3175FN-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-3175FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-6200FX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-9201NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-9301NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-Copieur-couleur-CLX-9350ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-Multifonction-A3-A4-couleur-CLX-9352NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-Multifonction-Couleur-A4-CLX-8650ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-Multifonction-couleur-CLX-4195FW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-Multifonction-couleur-CLX-6260ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-16ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-3205-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-16ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-3205W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-19ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-20ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4521F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-33ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-5835FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Copieur-monochrome-SCX-6555N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Fax-monochrome-SF-760P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-3405W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-4833FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-Monochrome-SL-M2875FD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SL-M2875FW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Mutifonction-Monochrome-SL-M2875ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-3200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-4100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-4824FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-4828FN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-5637FR-SCX-5637FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-5737FW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8123NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8240NA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5100P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5800P-Francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5800P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-6900-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP500A2D-S02FR-2-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP700A3D-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP700A3D-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie%209-900X1A-NP900X1A-A01FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1A-3G-XE700T1A-H01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1AXE-700T1A-A02FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-12-1-Serie-5-Chromebook-XE500C21-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U3B-NP530U3B-A02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3Serie-9-900X3A-NP900X3A-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U4B-NP530U4B-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z3A-NP700Z3A-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-2-Gamme-Professionnelle-200A5B-NP200B5B-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-S04FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5ANP-300E5A-S06FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5-ANP300E5A-S08FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300V5A-NP300V5A-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-4-Gamme-Professionnelle-400B5B-NP400B5B-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-RC-RC530-NP-RC530-S03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S06FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S07FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S08FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-7-Gamer-700G7A-NP700G7A-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-RC-RC730-NP-RC730-S05FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-300V3A-NP300V3A-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-ATIV-Smart-PC-Pro-XE700T1C-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X3C-NP900X3C-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S05FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S0CFR.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S0GFR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF2FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF5FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-S04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-S08FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T05FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T06FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AH-NP300E7A-S04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AH-NP300E7A-S0DFR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AI-NP300E7A-A04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300V3AH-NP300V3A-S02FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-T01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S07FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S0BFR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-NP350V5C-S03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-S06FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP370R5E-S04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP400B5BI-NP400B5B-AG3FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP400B5B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-A05FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A01FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A06FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP550P5C-NP550P5C-T04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S03FR.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5C-NP700Z5C-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7CH-NP700Z7C-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7C-NP700Z7C-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X1B-NP900X1B-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X3C-NP900X3C-A03FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X3D-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4B-NP900X4B-A01FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-A02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-NP900X4D-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-P500NP-P500-FA01DE-Open-market-GT-C3300K-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-Q320E-NP-Q320-AS02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-Q35-NP-Q35T007-SEF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R510%20NP-R510-XA02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R530E-NP-R530-JT50FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610NP-R610-AS03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS05FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS06FR-Francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS06FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS08FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R620E-NP-R620-FS01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R620E-NP-R620-JS02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R710-NP-R710-ASS1FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R719NP-R719-XA01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R720E-NP-R720-JS03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT07FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT08FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT0BFR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730C-NP-R730-JB03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730-NP-R730-JA05FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RV510I-NP-RV510-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-Francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-France-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NQ20-NQ20RP3GH8-SEF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-QX510-NP-QX510-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-R590-Crystal-NP-R590-JS01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-R730-Red-Gloss-NP-R730-JS01FRManuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Samsung-Chromebook-XE303C12-A02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-A02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-S0AFR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5C-NP300E5C-T02FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7ANP300E7A-A02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0BFR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0CFR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-305E5A-NP305E5A-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-NP370R5E-A02FR-NP370R5E-A02FR-Logiciels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-4-NP400B2B-A03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-5-550P7C-NP550P7C-T02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-5-550P7C-NP550P7C-T03FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X3C-A05FR-NP900X3C-A05FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X3D-A04FR.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X3D-A05FR-NP900X3D-A05FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X4D-A03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV510-NP-RV510-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV515-NP-RV515-S04FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-SF310-NP-SF310-S01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500C21-XE500C21-AZ2FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-A01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-H02FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-A04FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE700T1A-XE700T1A-HF1FR-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Solutions-d-impression-Multifonctions-laser-Multifonction-couleur-CLX-3300-Version-imprimable-CLX-3300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-N150Plus-NP-N150P-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-N150Plus-NP-N150P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NC110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-N140-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-NC10-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-NC110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-IT-producten-Imprimantes-laser-monochromes-35-ppm-A4-imprimante-laser-noir-et-blanc-ML-3710D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-IT-producten-Ordinateurs-portables-Samsung-Series-9-NP900X3C-A01-NP900X3C-A01BE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Kit-Pieton-Bluetooth-HM1200-Noir-HM1200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LA46C550J1F-CN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-lcd_business_q2.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE19C350-LE19C350D1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE22C452C4H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE26B450-LE26B450C4W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE26D450G1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32A466-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32A568-LE32A568P3M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32B450C4W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32C650-LE32C650L1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32D400E1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32D460C9H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE32E420E2W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE37A466-LE37A466C2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE40A577P2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE40B551A6W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE40S71B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE46A676-LE46A676A1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE46C630-LE46C630K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-LE52A676-LE52A676A1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-Player-50-Blanc-8Go-YP-G50CW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4-0-Blanc-8Go-YP-G1CW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Livres-blancs.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Livres-blancs-Technologie-ReCP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-M_YUKON_2K_WD175ARYKSU_DC68-02631L-05-120810.pdf-SEC-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-ME40A-TP40-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-ME46A-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-ME65B-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-MH050FXEA2B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-ML-2160-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-ML-2165W-Roumanie-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Feature-Phone-GT-E1175T-Anglais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Others-HM3700-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Emirats-Arabes-Unis-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Inde-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Music-GT-S6010-Royaume-Uni-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Nexus-GT-I9250-Royaume-Uni-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Samsung-GALAXY-S-III-GALAXY-S3-GT-I9300-Singapour-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Smart-Phone-GT-I9505-Suisse-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobile-Tablet-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-Wi-Fi-GT-P5110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobilite-Smartphone-Samsung-Galaxy-S4-Impression-GT-I9505-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobilite-Telephone-a-fonction-Rugby-II-de-Samsung-SGH-a847M-SGH-A847M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Mobilite-Telephone-Intelligent-Galaxy-Q-de-Samsung-SGH-T589R-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Moniteur-grande-taille-Ecrans-grand-format-UD55A-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Monitors-2493HM-USA-Etats-Unis-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-N150-NP-N150-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NC190-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Notebook-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z5C-S01-NP700Z5C-S01DE-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NP20-NP20FK02BG-SEF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-T01FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NP300E5ZI-NP300E5Z-A09MA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NP300V5AH-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NP530U3C-A01ES-NP530U3C-A01ES-Espagnol-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NP-R530-NP-R530-JA02FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-NS140SDXEA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-7-noir-Open-market-GT-I8700-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFRGT-I8000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFR-GT-I8000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-Lite-noir-Orange-GT-B7300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7330-noir-Open-market-GT-B7330-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7610-noir-Open-market-GT-B7610-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Omnia-W-noir-Open-market-GT-I8350-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-pascal_owners_manual.pdf-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PC-OFFICE-Coree-NT-RF711NT-RF711-PS02G-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PC-Office-LCD-LED-S22C200BW-Hong-Kong-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PC-Office-Mono-Multi-function-SCX-3405FW-Hong-Kong-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PC-Office-Netbook-NP-N220-Royaume-Uni-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-ATIV-Smart-PC-XE500T1C-3G-XE500T1C-H01SG-Singapour-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-R519-Royaume-Uni-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-couleur-CLX-3305FW-Canada-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-monochromes-SCX-3200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-monochromes-SCX-3405FW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-monochromes-SCX-3405W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-monochromes-SCX-4727FD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope%20-Appareils-photo-Gamme-Compact-14-MP-Ecran-LCD-Tactile-8.9-cm-3-5-Compact-Performant-WB210-SAMSUNG-WB210-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Appareils-photo-Gamme-Compact-Samsung-ST66-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-12-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-compact-essentiel-Samsung-ES80-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-14-2MP-Ecran-3-hVGA-Smart-Camera-Samsung-WB150F-SAMSUNG-WB150F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-14-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-Ecran-avant-LCD-1-5-compact-double-ecran-Samsung-PL120-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-14-MP-Ecran-LCD-3-compact-style-Samsung-PL210-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-16-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-compact-Style-Samsung-ST77s.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-16-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-compact-Style-Samsung-ST90-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-16-MP-Ecran-LCD-3-Compact-Performant-WB700-SAMSUNG-WB700-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-16-MP-Ecran-pivotant-LCD-Tactile-3-compact-Samsung-MultiView-MV800-SAMSUNG-MV800-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Afrique-du-Nord-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Appareil-photo-numerique-SAMSUNG-WB150F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Appareil-photo-numerique-SMART-DV300F-SAMSUNG-DV300F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ES60-SAMSUNG-ES60.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-NV24HD-SAMSUNG-NV24-HD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-DV90-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL101-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL170-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL210-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL70-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-PL90-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-S850-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-SMART-Camera-DV150F-SAMSUNG-DV150F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-SMART-Camera-EX2F-SAMSUNG-EX2F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-SMART-CAMERA-ST200F-SAMSUNG-ST200F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-SMART-Camera-WB250F-SAMSUNG-WB250F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-Smart-Camera-WB850F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-ST560-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-ST65-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-ST95-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-WB100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-WB210-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-WB560-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ST45-SAMSUNG-ST45-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ST500-SAMSUNG-ST500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Definition-Standard-1-8-MP-Ecran-LCD-2.7-6.86-cm-Camescope-SD-Samsung-F50SMX-F50BP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Definition-Standard-5-MP-Ecran-LCD-2.7-6.86-cm-Camescope-SD-Samsung-F700-SMX-F700BP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-5-MP-Ecran-LCD-Tactile-rotatif-3-7-2-cm-Camescope-HD-Samsung-Q10HMX-Q10PP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-Camera-HD-HMX-Q200BP-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F800BP-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F80BP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F90WP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-QF20BP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-Samsung-SMART-Camcorder-QF30-HMX-QF30WP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Appareil-photo-numerique-NX-NX-210-Afrique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-NX10-3-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-NX10-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-NX5-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Systeme-NX-NX100-14-6-MP-Ecran-7-6cm-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Systeme-NX-NX11-14-6-MP-Ecran-7-6cm-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Player-HD-noir-Open-market-GT-I8910-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Player-One-noir-Open-market-GT-S5230-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-periph%C3%A9riques-Mini-ordinateur-portable-N102-NP-N102-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Couleur-Laser-CLP-680ND-Colour-Laser-Printer-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Couleur-Laser-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-620ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-LCD-Moniteur-LED-3D-serie-9-S27A950D-de-27-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Mono-Laser-Imprimante-laser-monochrome-ML-1865W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Mono-Laser-Imprimante-laser-monochrome-ML-2165W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Mono-Laser-Imprimante-multifunction-laser-ML-3750ND-ML-3750ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP300E5V-NP300E5V-A01MA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP300E5V-NP300E5V-A08MA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP300V5AH-NP300V5A-S03MA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP300V5AI-NP300V5A-A03MA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP300V5A-S0CZA-Superbe-encadrement-ultrafin-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP530U3BI-NP530U3B-A01ZA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP530U4C-de-la-serie-5-NP530U4C-A03ZA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-NP530U4C-S04ZA-serie-5-de-Samsung-NP530U4C-S04ZA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Ordinateur-portable-serie-9-NP900X3C-A02ZA-de-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Series-5-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-H01ZA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Series-9-NP900X3C-Notebook-NP900X3C-A03ZA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-XE700T1A-A01ZA-The-Freedom-of-true-mob.-comp.-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Presentation-du-Samsung-GALAXY-S-4-Video.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Printers-Multifunction-Mono-Laser-Printer-ML-5010ND-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PS42C450-PS42C450B1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PS50A566-PS50A566S2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PS50C450-PS50C450B1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PS50C535-PS50C535C1W-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PS51D490A1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-PS51E530-ZF-PLASMA-51-FULL-HD%20-PS51E530A3W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-RE-C21VMS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Refrigerateur-1porteA-350-L-Blanc-RR82FHSW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Refrigerateur-DP-A275-L-Blanc-RT34GBSW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Refrigerators-26-CU-FT-FRENCH-DOOR-REFRIGERATOR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-RR92HASX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-RR92HAWW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-RR92HAWW-Refrigerateur-une-porte-Monochrome-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-RV511-NP-RV511-A06MA-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-S22B350B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-S23A550H-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-551-noir-Open-marketGT-I5510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-noir-Open-market-GT-S5830-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-Pro-gris-Open-market-GT-B7510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SCH-W999-CN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SCX-3200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SCX-3400-Pakistan-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SCX-4x28-Series-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SGH-D500-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SHV-E210S-S-III-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SHV-E300L-Coree-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SHW-M220L-Coree-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-S-II-HDSHV-E120S-Coree-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-SNE-60K_UM_Embedded_KOR_100526-SEC-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Sprzet-komputerowy-i-Drukarki-Notebooki-NP-R710-AS04PL-Pologne-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Stockage-informatique-Graveur-DVD-Slim-External-8X-DVD-Writer-SE-208AB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-Basic-Kit-64-GoMZ-7PC064B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-MZ-7TD120-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-SSD-840-Pro-128Go-MZ-7PD128-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-SSD-840-Pro-256Go-MZ-7PD256-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-SSD-840-Pro-512GoMZ-7PD512-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-T%C3%A9l%C3%A9phone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-T22B300EW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-T240-JP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-T260-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Table-induction-3-foyers-7-2-KW-CTN463NC01-CTN463NC01-XEF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-GT-C3310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-Player-mini-2GT-C3310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-S5220GT-S5220-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Galaxy-Camera-Samsung-GALAXY-Camera-EK-GC100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-C3750.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1130-B.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1151-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1170-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E2220.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E2550D.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5230-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5610-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5620.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-B3310bleu-Open-market-GT-B3310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-B5722-noir-Open-marketGT-B5722-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Blue-Earth-bleu-Open-market-GT-S7550-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C3050-noir-Virgin-Mobile-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C3520-GT-C3520-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C520-Hello-Kitty-Open-marketS-GH-C520-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Chat-335-gris-Open-market-GT-S3350-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Corby-Pro-rouge-Open-market-GT-B5310-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1050-noir-Open-market-GT-E1050-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1150-rouge-Open-market-GT-E1150-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1310-NRJ-Mobile-GT-E1310B.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E2330-noir-Open-market-GT-E2330B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E250-Open-market-SGH-E250-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E2530-Open-market-GT-E2530-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-F250-Open-market-SGH-F250-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-G600-Open-market-SGH-G600-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J700-SGH-J700G-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J770-Open-market-SGH-J770-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Jetnoir-Open-market-GT-S8000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-5-noir-Open-market-GT-S5560-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-City-blanc-Orange-GT-S5260P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Light-noir-Open-market-GT-C3510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-mini-noir-Open-market-GT-C3300K-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Pixon-noir-Open-market-GT-M8800-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Star-2-noir-Open-market-GT-S5620-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Star-noir-Open-market-GT-S5600-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Style-Open-market-SGH-F480-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Ultra-rouge-open-market-GT-S8300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S3100-gris-Open-market-GT-S3100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S3500-noir-Open-market-GT-S3500-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S5150-gold-Open-market-GT-S5150-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S5233W-GT-S5233W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Solid-B2100-rouge-Open-market-GT-B2100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-C180-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E570-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E590-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E840-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-F480G.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-N620-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-R200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-S730-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-U100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-Z360-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Mobiles-Style-Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Oreillette-bluetooth-Kit-Mains-Libres-Bluetooth-HF1000-BHF1000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Oreillette-bluetooth-Kit-Pieton-Bluetooth-HM1700-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-Ace-Plus-GT-S7500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-S-Advance-GT-I9070P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-SIII-mini-GT-I8190-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GALAXY-Y-ProGT-B5510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-B5510-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I5800-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I8190-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9000-RW8-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9001-M8-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9003-RM4-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Phone-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-N7100-Afrique-du-nord-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-N7100-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5230-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5369-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5380-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5570-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5750E-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-3-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-C6625-gris-Open-market-GT-C6625-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-550-noir-Open-market-GT-I5500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-GALAXY-Camera%20EK-GC100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Express-GT-I8730-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Nexus-noir-Open-market-GT-I9250-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-blanc-SFR-GT-N7000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-GT-N7000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-noir-SFRGT-N7000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-S4GT-I9505-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-S-IIIGT-I9300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Xcover-GT-S5690-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Xcover-GT-S5690-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-I9500-GT-I9500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7330-noir-Open-market-GT-B7330-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-S6312-GT-S6312-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Wave-533-noir-Open-marketGT-S5330-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Wave-723-gris-Open-marketGT-S7230E-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Wave-noir-Open-market-GT-S8500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-SGH-I320-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Galaxy-Tab-GT-P1000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P3100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P3110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P5100-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P5100-3-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P5100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P6800-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7300-M16-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7500-M32-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7510-M16-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-GT-P5100-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-Wi-Fi-GT-P5110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-7.0-Wi-FiGT-P3110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablettes-Tablettes-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-Wi-Fi-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablettes-Tablettes-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-Wi-Fi-Version-imprimable-GT-P3110-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Telephone-coulissant-Samsung-S5200-bleu-SFRGT-S5200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Telephones-Cellulaires-telephones-intelligents-Samsung-Galaxy-Discover-Version-imprimable-SGH-S730M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV%20Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A465C1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV%20Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV%20Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A676-PS50A676T1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-LCD-Series-5-550-32inch-LE32D550-LE32D550K1W-Belgique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid%C3%A9o-Video-projecteur-SP-P310ME-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-32-UE32D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D6500VS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED%20TV-UE40D6200TS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D6300WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D6300SS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D7000LS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D6200TS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D6500VS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D8000YS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D550WXZF-serie-5-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D550C1W.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D550WXZF-serie-5-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D550C1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D8000FS-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE55D6200TS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6530WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D6530WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D7000LS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D7000LS-User-Manuals-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D8000YS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-60-UE60D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE60D8000YS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-64-PS64D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS64D8000FS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE40C750-LE40C750R2W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LED-Smart-TV-LED-3D-UA65ES8000R-serie-8-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LED-UA60D8000YR-Series-8-Smart-3D-LED-TV-UA60D8000YR-Afrique-Fr.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS43D490A1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C490-PS50C490B3W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C6970-PS50C6970YS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C7000YW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS59D6900DS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS64E8000-ZF-PLASMA-64-SMART-INTERACTION-3DPS64E8000GS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6500VQ-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6510WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32ES6100W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3D-UE32ES6300S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40C7700WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6570WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6750WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D8000YQ-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40EH6030W-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A437T2D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6100W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6300S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6560S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6710S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3DUE40ES7000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3DUE40ES8000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40F6500-TV-LED-40-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE40F6500SS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40F7000-TV-LED-40-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE40F7000SL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40F8000-TV-LED-46-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE40F8000SL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46C8700-UE46C8790XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6200TS-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6500VH-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6570WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6750WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46EH6030W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6540S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6560S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6570S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3DUE46ES6710S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46F6510-TV-LED-46-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE46F6510SS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46F8000-TV-LED-46-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE46F8000SL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6100W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6900S-ZF-Slim-LED-50-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C7700-UE55C7700WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C8700-UE55C8790XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C8700XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55D6300SS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6100W-AQV09PSBN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6530S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6540S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES7000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55F8000-TV-LED-55-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE55F8000SL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE65ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-65-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE65ES8000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE65F6400-TV-LED-65-Full-HD-Smart-TV-3D-UE65F6400AW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Ampli-Tuner-AV-HW-E551-ZF-Barre-de-son-Format-46-Convertible-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Enregistreur-DVD-DVD-SH877-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Enregistreur-DVD-DVD-SH893-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Enregistreur-DVD-SH897-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-Home-cinema-blu-ray-HT-D5550WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-3DHT-D5550-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-Home-cinema-blu-ray-HT-D6750WWXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-C6930W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-E4550-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-E5200-ZF-Home-Cinema-2.1-Blu-Ray-3D-Bluetooth-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-E8200-ZF-Barre-de-son-Blu-Ray-3D-Bluetooth-HT-E8200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-ES4200-ZFHT-ES4200-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-F6550W-ZF-Home-Cinema-5.1-Blu-Ray-3D-Smart-Hub-HT-F6550W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Home-cinema-blu-ray-HT-D5000WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-3DHT-D5000-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Home-cinema-DVD-5.1-HT-D350WXZF-serie-3HT-D350-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-C5530-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-D4200-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-C5300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-E5300-ZF-Lecteur-Blu-ray-Youtube-AllShare-BD-E5300-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-E8300-ZF-Enregistreur-Blu-Ray-320-Go-SMART-HUB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-ES6000-ZF-Lecteur-Blu-Ray-3D-SMART%20HUB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-F8500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-F8900-ZF-Lecteur-Blu-ray-3D-avec-disque-dur-Double-Tuner-Wi-Fi-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-BD-P1600A-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P2500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P4600-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-Lecteur-blu-ray-BD-D6900WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3DBD-D6900-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-DVD-DVD-D530WXZF-serie-5-DVD-D530-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Baladeur-MP3-Clip-F3-Noir-2GoYP-F3QB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi%203.6-Noir-8GoYP-GS1CB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4.0-Blanc-8GoYP-G1CW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-5.0-Blanc-8G-YP-G70CW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-P3YP-P3JCB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-R-mix-YP-R1JCP-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-S2-YP-S2QB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Samsung-Q3YP-Q3CB-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YH-820MW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GI1CW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GI1EW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GS1CW-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-Z5FQW-ELS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D430DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D470DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-MM-D470D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-MM-C330D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-MM-E330D-Micro-chaine-DVD-DivX-ARC-AUX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-MM-E430D-Micro-chaine-DVD-DivX-Double-Dock-USB-Bluetooth-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-MM-ZB7-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-MM-ZB7-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-460DR-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-46-Moniteur-LED-UE46A-mur-d-images-bord-fin-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-55-Moniteur-LED-UD55A-mur-d-image-bord-fin-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-55-Moniteur-LED-UD55A-mur-d-image-bord-fin-UD55A-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME32B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME40B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME46B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME75B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-NL22B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-SUR40-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-TC220W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-TS190W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Televiseurs-TV-2013-SMART-LED-TV-46-UE46F7000-Version-imprimable-UE46F7000SL-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-Cathodique-CW29Z504N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-Cathodique-WS32V54N-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD%20-LE22B450-LE22B450C4W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-32-LE32D550WXZF-serie-5-HD-TV-LCD-TV-LE32D550K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE19B450C4H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22A455C1D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22B650-LE22B650T6W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C350-LE22C350D1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C430C4W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22D450G1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE23R86BD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26A456C2D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26A466-LE26A466C2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26B350F1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450E1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450-LE26C450E1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C452C4H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C457C6H-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A436T1D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A437T2D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A456-LE32A456C2D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A465-LE32A465C1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A577P2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A676-LE32A676A1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32B350F1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32B651-LE32B651T3P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C350D1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450E1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450-LE32C450E1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C550-LE32C550J1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C630-LE32C630K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D403E2W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D450G1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32R86BD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32S86BD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32T51B-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A457C1D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A568-LE37A568P3M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A626-LE37A626A3M-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A676-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37B530-LE37B530P7W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37B653T5P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37C530F1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37C530-LE37C530F1W.manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A457C1D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A466-LE40A466C2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A536T1F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A556P1F-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A566P1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A568-LE40A568P3M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A626-LE40A626A3M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A676-LE40A676A1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A856-LE40A856S1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B530P7W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B620T2WXXC-LE40B620R3W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B651-LE40B651T3W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B651T3P-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C530-LE40C530F1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C630-LE40C630K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D503F7W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D550K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40R86BD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A568-LE46A568P3M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A856-LE46A856S1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46B651-LE46B651T3W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C530-LE46C530F1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C650-LE46C650L1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46D550K1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-22-UE22D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE22D5000NW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-22-UE22ES5400WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-27-UE27D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE27D5000NW-2-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE32D5000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D5700RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-40-UE40D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE40D5000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-46-UE46D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D5000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG32EA590LS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG40EA590LS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-LE40A796-LE40A796R2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE19C4000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22C4010PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5000NH-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5010NW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22ES5000-ZF-Slim-LED-22-SMART-TV-UE22ES5000W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22ES5410-ZF-Slim-LED-22-SMART-TVUE22ES5410W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22F5000-TV-LED-22-Full-HD-UE22F5000AW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26C4000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26D4003BW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000PH-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000-UE32C4000PW-2-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C5100-UE32C5100QF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C6000-UE32C6000RW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C6700-UE32C6700US-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C8700XS-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D4003BW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D5720RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH4000-ZF-LED-32-HD-TV-UE32EH4000W-Manuals-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH4000-ZF-LED-32-HD-TV-UE32EH4000W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5000-ZF-LED-32-FULL-HD-UE32EH5000W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5300W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-UE32ES5500W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32F4000-TV-LED-32-HDTV-UE32F4000AW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32F5300-TV-LED-32-Full-HD-Smart-TV-UE32F5300AW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37B6000VW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37C6000-UE37C6000RW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37D5000ZF-UE37D5000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE39EH5003W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B6000-UE40B6000VW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B7000-UE40B7000WW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C6000RH-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C6900VS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5003BW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5720RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40EH5300W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40ES5700S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B7020WW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B8000WW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C5100QW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6000-UE46C6000RW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6710-UE46C6710US-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46EH5300W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TVUE46ES5500W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46F5500-TV-LED-46-Full-HD-Smart-TV-UE46F5500AW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE55C6000-UE55C6000RW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE55C6700-UE55C6700US-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE60EH6000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-43-PS43D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-PDP-TVPS43D450A2W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A426-PS42A426C1M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A456-PS42A456P2D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42C430-PS42C430A1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42C96HD-PS-42C96HD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS43E450-ZF-PLASMA-43-HD-TV-PS43E450A1W-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS43F4500-TV-Plasma-43-HD-TV-PS43F4500AW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A456-PS50A456P2D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A466-PS50A466P2M-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B550-PS50B550T4W-manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B850-PS50B850Y1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C430-PS50C430A1W-Francais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C430-PS50C430A1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C530-PS50C530C1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50Q96HD-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS51E450-ZF-PLASMA-51-HD-TVPS51E450A1W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS58B680-PS58B680T6W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS59D530A5W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS63B680-PS63B680T6W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-DA-E650-ZF-Double-Dock-Bluetooth-3.0-USB-AUXDA-E650-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-DA-E750-ZF-Double-Dock-Pre-ampli-a-lampes-Bluetooth-3.0-USB-AUX-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-HW-F450-ZF-Barre-de-son-2.1-Bluetooth-SoundShare-HW-F450-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-Wireless-Audio-with-Dock-DA-E750-Afrique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-3D-Blu-ray-HT-E3550-English-Anglais-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-3D-TV-TV-UN50ES6350F-Coree-du-Sud-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-LED-19-D4003-Series-4-LED-TV%20-UE19D4003BW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-LED-UE40B7000WW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-PDP-2012-PS43E450A1R-43-inch-HD-Ready-Plasma-TV-Emirats-Arabes-Unis-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-TV-LED-UE32D5000-UE32D5000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-TV-LED-UE40D5000-UE40D5000PW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-AV-TV-LED-UE40D5700-UE40D5700RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TVs-LED-TV-UN55ES8000F-55-Class-54.6-Diag-LED-8000-Series-Smart-TV-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-TV-Video-3D-Televiseur-DEL-de-75-po-et-de-serie-7100-2013-UN75F7100AF-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UA32ES5500-UA32ES5500R-CN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UA40ES5500-UA40ES5500R-Chine-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UD22B-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE19D4003BW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE26EH4000-ZF-LED-26-HD-TV-UE26EH4000W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE26EH4500-ZF-LED-26-HD-TV-UE26EH4500W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE32D5700RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE32D6530WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE32EH4003W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE32ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3DUE32ES6710S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE37C5100QW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40B6050-UE40B6050VW-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40C6000-UE40C6000RW-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40C6700-UE40C6700US-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40D6510WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-UE40ES5500W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE40ES7000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE40ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE40ES8000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46C6805-UE46C6805US-Norvege-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46C8700-UE46C8790XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46C8700XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46D5720RS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46D6530WS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46ES6100W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3D-UE46ES6300S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE46ES8000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE46S870XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE50EH5300W-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE55C8700-UE55C8790XS-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE55ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-TV-3D-UE55ES6300S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE55ES6560S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE55ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES8000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-UE75ES9000S-Slim-LED-75-SMART-Interaction-3D-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-VC331LLDC6S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-VC331LLMA6S-Japon-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-VC-UBL916-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Video-tutorielle-4G-Video.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-3-noir-Open-market-GT-S8600-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-533-noir-Open-market-GT-S5330-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-578-noir-Open-market-GT-S5780-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-723-gris-Open-market-GT-S7230E-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/samsung-Wave-II-noir-Open-market-GT-S8530-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-M-noir-Open-market-GT-S7250-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-M-noir-Open-market-GT-S7250-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Wave-noir-Open-market-GT-S8500-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-WEP480-CN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-XE700T1A-HF1FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-Zephyr-AQV09YWAN-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-ZS31FASAB1S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S03FR-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/SGH-F490.htm

/SAMSUNG/T23A550T23A550.htm

/SAMSUNG/UE40D6500ZFUE40D6500VS.htm

/SAMSUNG/UE55ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES8000S-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/UE55ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES8000S-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/UE60ES6100WXZF-UE60ES6100W-Samsung-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Wave575GT-S5750E.htm

/SAMSUNG/WaveIIGT-S8530.htm

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 11-Jun-2013 07:39  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-IT-producten..> 11-Jun-2013 07:39  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 11-Jun-2013 07:39  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jun-2013 07:38  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 11-Jun-2013 07:38  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 11-Jun-2013 07:38  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 11-Jun-2013 07:37  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jun-2013 07:37  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Tel..> 11-Jun-2013 07:35  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jun-2013 07:35  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jun-2013 07:35  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 11-Jun-2013 07:35  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 11-Jun-2013 06:53  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jun-2013 06:53  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-Wirele..> 11-Jun-2013 06:53  1.5M 

Samsung-ME40A-TP40-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-UA40ES5500-UA40ES5500R-Chine-Manuels

Samsung-700TSn-2-SSD-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-ME46A-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-NC190-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-320TSN-3D-SSD-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-GT-P5110-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-E1720NR-Japon-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-GT-P5100-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels

Samsung-S22B350B-Manuels

Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Note-II-GT-N7100-Manuels

Samsung-GT-I9300-Manuels

SAMSUNG/SAMSUNG-DV90-Manuels

Samsung-GT-N8000-Manuels

Samsung-AQV12KBBN-Pologne-Manuels

Samsung-ML-2165W-Roumanie-Manuels

Samsung-Notebook-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z5C-S01-NP700Z5C-S01DE-Manuels

Samsung-Player-One-noir-Open-market-GT-S5230-Manuels

Samsung-LE32E420E2W-Manuels

Samsung-910MP-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL-noir-Open-market-GT-I9003-M4-Manuels

Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-Pro-gris-Open-market-GT-B7510-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Gio-noir-SFR-GT-S5660-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Spica-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5700-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7610-noir-Open-market-GT-B7610-Manuels

Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels

Samsung-LE32C650-LE32C650L1W-Manuels

Samsung-LE26D450G1W-Manuels

Samsung-N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels

Samsung-N150-NP-N150-Manuels

Samsung-NP20-NP20FK02BG-SEF-Manuels

Samsung-GT-S5570_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_110726_Screen.pdf-Manuels

Samsung-GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf-Manuels

Samsung-GT-I9300_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.2_120725_Screen.pdf-Manuels

Samsung-LE32D400E1W-Manuels

Samsung-Gainable-Slim-MH026FEEA-Manuels

Samsung-CW21Z573N-Manuels

Samsung-40-UE40D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-UE46C8700-UE46C8790XS-Manuels

Samsung-UE32D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-UE46ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3D-UE46ES6300S-Manuels

Samsung-2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1-Manuels

Samsung-NS140SDXEA-Manuels

Samsung-MH050FXEA2B-Manuels

Samsung-UE75ES9000S-Slim-LED-75-SMART-Interaction-3D-Manuels

Samsung-RR92HAWW-Manuels

Samsung-GT-P6200-Manuels

Samsung-Refrigerateur-1porteA-350-L-Blanc-RR82FHSW-Manuels

Samsung-UE26EH4000-ZF-LED-26-HD-TV-UE26EH4000W-Manuels

Samsung-E-MANUAL-X9DVBEU4E-ENG-Manuel

Samsung-GT-S5360_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_111130_Screen-Manuel

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuel

Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuels

Samsung-GT-S5360-Manuels

Samsung-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4-0-Blanc-8Go-YP-G1CW-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-551-noir-Open-marketGT-I5510-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Note-10-1-GT-N8000-Manuels

Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-LTE-SC-03D-JP-Manuels

Samsung-GALAXY-Note-SC-05D-JP-Manuels

Samsung-NP-R530-NP-R530-JA02FR-Manuels

Samsung-UE40C6000-UE40C6000RW-Manuels

Samsung-Congelateur-1porteA-277-L-Blanc-RZ80FHSW-Manuels

Samsung-GT-B5310-Manuels

Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-GT-B5310-Manuels

Samsung-32-LE32D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LCD-TV-Manuels

Samsung-46-UE46D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D5700RS-Manuels

Samsung-UE55ES6560S-Manuels

Samsung-UE46ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE46ES8000S-Manuels

Samsung-UE55ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-TV-3D-UE55ES6300S-Manuels

Samsung-AQV18UGAX-Manuels

Samsung-UE50EH5300W-Manuels

Samsung-LE46A676-LE46A676A1M-Manuels

Samsung-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels

Samsung-CW21Z503N-Manuels

Samsung-AQ18UGFN-Manuels

Samsung-Refrigerateur-DP-A275-L-Blanc-RT34GBSW-Manuels

Samsung-UE46ES6100W-Manuels

Samsung-RR92HASX-Manuels

Samsung-LE40S71B-Manuels

Samsung-UE32ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3DUE32ES6710S-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-noir-Open-market-GT-S5830-Manuels

Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-GT-P1000-GT-P1000-M16-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7330-noir-Open-market-GT-B7330-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-Lite-noir-Orange-GT-B7300-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-S2-GT-I9100-Manuels

Samsung-Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFRGT-I8000-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFR-GT-I8000-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-7-noir-Open-market-GT-I8700-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-noir-Bouygues-GT-I7500-Manuels

Samsung-Galaxy-mini-gris-Open-market-GT-S5570-Manuels

Samsung-XE700T1A-HF1FR-Manuels

17,3" Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S01FR - Manuels

40", UE40D6500WXZF, série 6, SMART TV, 3D, FULL HD, LED TV - UE40D6500VS - Manuels

CLX-3185FW Manuels

Galaxy Ace GT-S5830

Galaxy S II GT-I9100

Galaxy Tab 8.9 GT-P7310/M16

Galaxy Tab 10.1 GT-P7500/M16

Galaxy YGT-S5360

LE32C350 LE32C350D1W

LE40C630 LE40C630K1W

MM-C330D

MM-D330D

Micro-chaîne, MM-D330DWXZF, série 3 - MM-D330 - Manuels

N145Plus - NP-N145P - Manuels

N150 - NP-N150 - Manuels

RSH5UEPN

SGH-F490

Samsung Galaxy Ace noir - Open market - GT-S5830 - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy S II noir - Open market - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy S III - GT-I9300 - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy S noir - Open market - GT-I9000 - Manuels

Samsung Galaxy NoteGT-N7000

Samsung Galaxy SGT-I9000

Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S03FR - Manuels

T23A550 T23A550

UE40D6500ZF UE40D6500VS

UE55ES8000/ZF, Slim LED 55", SMART INTERACTION, 3D - UE55ES8000S - Manuels

Wave 575 GT-S5750E

Wave II GT-S8530

16/4ppm Imprimante laser couleur CLP-310 Manuels

16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3170FN Manuels

16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3185FW Manuels Samsung

16/4ppm Multifonction laser couleur CLX-3185 Manuels Samsung

samsung-Wave-II-noir-Open-market-GT-S8530-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-noir-Open-market-GT-S8500-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-M-noir-Open-market-GT-S7250-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-578-noir-Open-market-GT-S5780-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-533-noir-Open-market-GT-S5330-Manuels

Samsung-Wave-3-noir-Open-market-GT-S8600-Manuels

Samsung-Player-HD-noir-Open-market-GT-I8910-Manuels

Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels

Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels

Samsung-Omnia-W-noir-Open-market-GT-I8350-Manuels

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%20Photo-Camescope-Compact-Appareil-photo-numerique-Samsung-ST66-SAMSUNG-ST66-Afrique-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung%2DGT%2DP6200%2DManuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0%20%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-46-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE46EH5307-UE46EH5307K-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0%20-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-6-Full-HD-UE40C6000R-UE40C6000RW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%96%D0%9A-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%96%D0%9A-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-Full-HD-LE40C530F1-LE40C530F1W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%96%D0%9A-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-LE32B450C4W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%96%d0%9a-%d1%82%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80%d1%8b-LE40C530F1W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%96%D0%9A-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-LE40C530F1W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B0-51-c%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-Full-HD-PS51E530-PS51E530A3W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B0-43-c%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-4-HD-PS43E450PS43E450A1W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B0-42-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-4-HD-PS42C431A2-PS42C431A2W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-PS42A410C3-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-%D0%9F%D0%BB%D0%B0%D0%B7%D0%BC%D0%B0-51-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-8-3D-SMART-TV-Full-HD-PS51D8000F-PS51D8000FS-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-6-SMART-TV-3D-Full-HD-LED-UE40ES6100-UE40ES6100W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-3D-%d0%a2%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80-40-%d1%81%d0%b5%d1%80%d0%b8%d1%8f-6-SMART-TV-3D-Full-HD-LED-UE40ES6100-UE40ES6100W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-55-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-8-3D-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE55ES8007-UE55ES8007U-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-3D-%d0%a2%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80-55-%d1%81%d0%b5%d1%80%d0%b8%d1%8f-8-3D-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE55ES8007-UE55ES8007U-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-65-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-8-SMART-TV-3D-Full-HD-LED-UE65ES8007-UE65ES8007U-Russe--Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F%206-3D-SMART-TV-Full-HD-UE40D6100S-UE40D6100SW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-7-3D-SMART-TV-Full-HD-UE40D7000L-UE40D7000LS-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-3D-LED-%d1%82%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80-46-%d0%a1%d0%b5%d1%80%d0%b8%d1%8f-8-3D-SMART-TV-Full-HD-UE46D8000Y-UE46D8000YS-Russe--Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-3D-UA40C7000WR-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-UA40C7000WR-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-UA55D6600WR-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-UE40ES7500S-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-3D-UE46D7000LS-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-46-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE46EH5300-UE46EH5300W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE40ES5537-UE40ES5537K-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-Full-HD-LED-UE40EH5047-UE40EH5047K-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-40-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE40EH5307-UE40EH5307K-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-26-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-4-HD-LED-UE26EH4000-UE26EH4000W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-%D0%A2%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-32-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-Full-HD-LED-UE32EH5040-UE32EH5040W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-LED-%d1%82%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80%d1%8b-%d0%a2%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80-40-%d1%81%d0%b5%d1%80%d0%b8%d1%8f-5-SMART-TV-Full-HD-LED-UE40EH5307-UE40EH5307K-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-37-FULL-HD-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-%D1%81%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D0%B8-5-UE37EH5007K-UE37EH5007K-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-32-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-5-Full-HD-UE32C5000Q-UE32C5000QW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80-32-%D0%A1%D0%B5%D1%80%D0%B8%D1%8F-4-HD-UE32C4000P-UE32C4000PW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%d0%90%d1%83%d0%b4%d0%b8%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-%d0%92%d0%b8%d0%b4%d0%b5%d0%be%d1%82%d0%b5%d1%85%d0%bd%d0%b8%d0%ba%d0%b0-LED-%d1%82%d0%b5%d0%bb%d0%b5%d0%b2%d0%b8%d0%b7%d0%be%d1%80%d1%8b-UA40C5000QR-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-UE32D5000PW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-UE46EH5000W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%90%D1%83%D0%B4%D0%B8%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%92%D0%B8%D0%B4%D0%B5%D0%BE%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-LED-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%B2%D0%B8%D0%B7%D0%BE%D1%80%D1%8B-UE55B7000WW-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%91%D1%8B%D1%82%D0%BE%D0%B2%D0%B0%D1%8F-%D1%82%D0%B5%D1%85%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%BA%D0%B0-%D0%9D%D0%B0%D1%81%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%BD%D0%BE%D0%B5-%D0%BA%D1%80%D0%B5%D0%BF%D0%BB%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%B8%D0%B5-%D0%9D%D0%B0%D1%81%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BD%D0%BD%D0%B0%D1%8F-%D1%81%D0%BF%D0%BB%D0%B8%D1%82-%D1%81%D0%B8%D1%81%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BC%D0%B0-%D0%A1%D1%82%D0%B0%D0%BD%D0%B4%D0%B0%D1%80%D1%82-AQ07RLAQ07RLN-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%9C%D0%BE%D0%B1%D0%B8%D0%BB%D1%8C%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D1%84%D0%BE%D0%BD%D1%8B-%D0%9C%D0%BE%D0%B1%D0%B8%D0%BB%D1%8C%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D1%84%D0%BE%D0%BD%D1%8B-C3510-TVGT-C3510T-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%9C%D0%BE%D0%B1%D0%B8%D0%BB%D1%8C%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D1%84%D0%BE%D0%BD%D1%8B-%D0%A1%D0%BC%D0%B0%D1%80%D1%82%D1%84%D0%BE%D0%BD%D1%8B-GT-S5830I-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-%D0%9C%D0%BE%D0%B1%D0%B8%D0%BB%D1%8C%D0%BD%D1%8B%D0%B5-%D1%82%D0%B5%D0%BB%D0%B5%D1%84%D0%BE%D0%BD%D1%8B-%D0%A1%D0%BC%D0%B0%D1%80%D1%82%D1%84%D0%BE%D0%BD%D1%8B-Samsung-S6012-GT-S5830I-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-\xd0\x90\xd1\x83\xd0\xb4\xd0\xb8\xd0\xbe\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd1\x85\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd0\xba\xd0\xb0-\xd0\x92\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb4\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbe\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd1\x85\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd0\xba\xd0\xb0-\xd0\x96\xd0\x9a-\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbb\xd0\xb5\xd0\xb2\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb7\xd0\xbe\xd1\x80\xd1\x8b-LE32B450C4W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-\xd0\x90\xd1\x83\xd0\xb4\xd0\xb8\xd0\xbe\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd1\x85\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd0\xba\xd0\xb0-\xd0\x92\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb4\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbe\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd1\x85\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd0\xba\xd0\xb0-\xd0\x96\xd0\x9a-\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbb\xd0\xb5\xd0\xb2\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb7\xd0\xbe\xd1\x80\xd1\x8b-\xd0\x96\xd0\x9a-\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbb\xd0\xb5\xd0\xb2\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb7\xd0\xbe\xd1\x80-40-\xd0\xa1\xd0\xb5\xd1\x80\xd0\xb8\xd1\x8f-5-Full-HD-LE40C530F1-LE40C530F1W-Russe-Manuels.htm

/SAMSUNG/Samsung-\xd0\x90\xd1\x83\xd0\xb4\xd0\xb8\xd0\xbe\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd1\x85\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd0\xba\xd0\xb0-\xd0\x92\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb4\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbe\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd1\x85\xd0\xbd\xd0\xb8\xd0\xba\xd0\xb0-LED-\xd1\x82\xd0\xb5\xd0\xbb\xd0\xb5\xd0\xb2\xd0\xb8\xd0\xb7\xd0\xbe\xd1\x80\xd1\x8b-UA40C5000QR-Russe-Manuels.htm

PRODUITS SAMSUNG :
Belkin Chargeur Secteur pour Samsung Galaxy S
Belkin Coque pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noire Translucide
Belkin Etui cuir Verve Folio pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Belkin Etui Pouch pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir
Belkin Kit de Charge Secteur + Automobile pour Samsung Galaxy S
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy S3
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Anti-reflets
Belkin Lot de 3 protections d'écran Screen Guard pour Samsung Galaxy SII - Transparentes
Belkin Micro-Chargeur allume-cigares pour Samsung Galaxy S
Belkin Protection d'écran Screen Guard pour Samsung Galaxy SII - Confidentialité 360°
Câble Omenex Plug & Phone pour Samsung
Câble Omenex Plug & Phone pour Samsung
Coque semi-rigide glossy noire pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Déclencheur sans Fil Hahnel combi TF pour Canon/Pentax/Samsung
Enceintes iLuv iSM524 noir pour Samsung Galaxy Tab
Etui-Brassard Belkin DualFit pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Etui Samsung CC9S70B noir
Fnac chargeur secteur POWY pour Samsung SGH-D800
G-Mobility Pack confort pour Samsung Galaxy SII i9100
Imprimante Samsung CLX-3185FN - Ethernet
Kensington Etui pliant pour Samsung Galaxy Tab
Le Tanneur Etui cuir Pouch pour Samsung Galaxy S11 I9100 - Noir
Lunettes 3D actives Samsung SSG-4100GB
Modelabs 2 protections écran pour Samsung Galaxy ACE S5830
Modelabs Lot de 2 protections d'écran One Touch pour Samsung Galaxy Y S5360 - Transparentes
Modelabs Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung Galaxy Note - Transparentes
Muvit Adaptateur Jack 3,5 mm pour Samsung (ancienne connectique)
Muvit Coque à rabat Agenda pour Samsung Galaxy Note - Noire
Muvit Coque Doodle Coeur pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S
Muvit Coque Doodle Extraterrestres pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S
Muvit Coque Doodle Rose pour Samsung i9000 Galaxy S
Muvit Coque silicone pour Samsung Galaxy Ace
Muvit Coque silicone pour Samsung Galaxy - Noire
Muvit Etui Clapet pour Samsung I9100 - Noir
Muvit Etui Slim Clapet pour Samsung Galaxy Note
Muvit Housse Minigel pour Samsung Galaxy - Noire
Muvit Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung nexus S - 1 Miroir/1 Secret
Muvit Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Samsung S5830
Muvit Pack Accessoires pour Samsung S5830
Muvit Sticker Carbone pour Samsung I9100
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Ibiza
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love London
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love New-York
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Paris
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - I Love Tokyo
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - United Kingdom
Muvit Sticker Drapeau pour Samsung I9100 - USA
QDOS Coque Cubic pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100
QDOS Coque Steel 4 pour Samsung Galaxy S II
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste
Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD
Samsung B5722 Double SIM
Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles
Samsung Batterie ED-BP1310
Samsung batterie IA-BH130LB
Samsung batterie IA-BP420E
Samsung batterie IA-BP85ST
Samsung batterie SLB-10A
Samsung batterie SSB-690 ELS
Samsung BD-E5300
Samsung BD-E5500 3D
Samsung BD-E6100 3D
Samsung BD-E8300 3D
Samsung BD-ES5000
Samsung BD-ES6000 3D
Samsung C3050 Stratus
Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1"
Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung
Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100
Samsung CB20A12
Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir
Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB
Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir
Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung CLP-C300A
Samsung CLP-K300A
Samsung CLP-M300A
Samsung CLP-Y300A
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0
Samsung CLX-3185N Ethernet
Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung Coque pour Galaxy S3 - Blanche
Samsung Coque pour Galaxy S3 - Noire
Samsung CY-SMN1000D meuble TV
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go - 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 512 Go - 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go - 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series
Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 + Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0 + Sennheiser RS170
Samsung DP7000A3B-A01FR 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0
Samsung DP700A3B-S02FR 23" LED Tactile
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi + Etui
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi
Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi + Etui
Samsung E1150 - Silver
Samsung ES90 Noir
Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir
Samsung Etui coque pour Samsung Galaxy Y S5360 - Noir
Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir
Samsung Etui rabat pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir
Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S
Samsung EX1
Samsung Flash SEF15A
Samsung Flash SEF20A
Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Note
Samsung Galaxy Note - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy Note - Dark Blue
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir
Samsung Galaxy S3 (I9300) - Blanc Marbre
Samsung Galaxy S3 (I9300) - Bleu Galet
Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 4,2" 16 Go
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Blanc Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Blanc Wifi + HP Housse Mini Sleeve 10,2" pour Netbook et Tablette - Ocean Drive
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT 16 Go Noir Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 10,1" 16 Go - Argent
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 10,1" 16 Go - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy Tab 2 7.0" LED 8 Go
Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Android)
Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir
Samsung Graveur Externe BluRay SE-506AB
Samsung HMX-F80 Noir
Samsung HMX-Q20 Noir
Samsung HMX-QF20 Noir
Samsung HMX-W350 Noir (tout terrain) + Kit Accessoires Sport + micro SDHC 8 Go
Samsung HMX-W350 Rouge (tout terrain) + Kit Accessoires Sport + micro SDHC 8 Go
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1"
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung HT-D330
Samsung HT-D350
Samsung HT-D4500
Samsung HT-D5000 3D
Samsung HT-E4200 3D
Samsung HT-E4500 3D
Samsung HT-E5200 3D
Samsung HT-E5530 3D
Samsung HT-ES4200 3D
Samsung HT-ES6200 3D
Samsung HT-ES8200 3D
Samsung HW-E350
Samsung HW-E450
Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android)
Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1"
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220
Samsung kit HDMI
Samsung kit papier 10 x 15 cm
Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm
Samsung LE32E420
Samsung LE40D503
Samsung ML-1630/SCX4500
Samsung ML-2010D3
Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi
Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung MLT-D1052S
Samsung MLT-D1082S
Samsung MLT-D1092S
Samsung MM-D430D
Samsung MM-E320
Samsung MV800 Noir
Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir
Samsung NP300E7A-S09FR 17,3" LED
Samsung NP700Z5C 15.6" LED
Samsung NP-RC730-S07FR 17.3"LED
Samsung NX1000 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8
Samsung NX 50 - 200 mm f/4.0 - 5.6 ED OIS II i-Fonction; Dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200
Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100
Samsung Pack HMX-F800 Noir : Caméscope HD + Etui + Carte SDHC 4 Go
Samsung Pack HMX-Q200 Noir : Caméscope Full HD + Etui + Carte SDHC 4 Go
Samsung PC portable NP300E5A-S0AFR 15.6"LED
Samsung PL210 Noir
Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go
Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal
Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante
Samsung PS43E450
Samsung PS43E490 3D
Samsung PS43E490 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung PS51E450
Samsung PS51E490 3D
Samsung PS51E530
Samsung Q3 noir 4 Go
Samsung Q3 rose 4 Go
Samsung RC530-S03FR 15,6" LED
Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes
Samsung S19A100N Moniteur 18,5" - Flat Panel Display
Samsung S22B150N 21,5" LED
Samsung S22B350H 21,5" LED
Samsung S23A750D 23" LED 3D
Samsung S23B350H 23" LED
Samsung S23B550V Moniteur 23" LED
Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED
Samsung S27B350H 27" LED
Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi
Samsung SCX-4200A
Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0
Samsung SE-218BB graveur DVD externe ultra slim USB 2.0
Samsung SLB07A pour ST50
Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000
Samsung ST200F Noir - WiFi
Samsung ST200F Rouge - WiFi
Samsung ST200F Violet - WiFi
Samsung ST65 Noir
Samsung ST65 Rouge
Samsung ST66 Noir
Samsung ST77 Blanc
Samsung ST77 Noir
Samsung ST77 Rouge
Samsung ST77 Violet
Samsung ST88 Noir
Samsung station d'accueil
Samsung station d'accueil HD2
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR
Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED
Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED
Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D
Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX
Samsung T22A300 21.5" Tuner TNT HD
Samsung T22B300EW 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung T24B301 24" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung T27A550 27" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir
Samsung UE19ES4000 LED
Samsung UE22ES5000 LED
Samsung UE22ES5410 LED
Samsung UE26EH4000 LED
Samsung UE26EH4500 LED
Samsung UE32EH4000 LED
Samsung UE32EH5000 LED
Samsung UE32ES5500 LED
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE37ES5500 LED
Samsung UE40D5000 LED
Samsung UE40D6500 LED 3D
Samsung UE40EH5000 LED
Samsung UE40ES5500 LED
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE40ES6710 LED 3D
Samsung UE46EH5000 LED
Samsung UE46ES5500 LED
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE46ES8000 LED 3D
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D
Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D + Console Xbox 360 4 Go
Samsung UE60ES6100 LED 3D
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" - Aluminium + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" LED USB 3.0 - Aluminium
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B 13,3" LED USB 3.0 - Aluminium+ Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise
Samsung Ultrabook NP530U3C 13,3" HD LED - Série 5 Ultra - Marron
Samsung Ultrabook NP530U3C 13,3" HD LED - Série 5 Ultra - Rose
Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10
Samsung Wave 575
Samsung WB150F Blanc - WiFi
Samsung WB150F Noir - WiFi
Samsung WB690 Noir
Samsung WB700 Noir
Samsung WB850F Noir - WiFi - GPS
Samsung WMN250M accroche murale
Samsung XE700T1A-A02FR 11,6" 64 Go SSD
Samsung YP-F3 bleu 2 Go
Samsung YP-F3 rose 2 Go
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose
Samsung YP-U6 noir 2 Go
Samsung YP-U6 noir 4 Go
Samsung YP-U6 rose 2 Go
Samsung YP-U6 rose 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 blanc 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 bleu 4 Go
Samsung YP-Z3 rose 4 Go
Samyang 14 mm f/2.8 Aspherical IF ED UMC; Monture Samsung NX
Samyang 35 mm f/1.4 AS UMC; Monture Samsung NX
Samyang Fish-eye 8 mm f/3.5 Aspherical IF MC; Monture Samsung Type NX
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 3,6" 8 Go
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 3,6" 8 Go + Casque weSC Conga Matte noir
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 4,2" 8 Go
Tablette Samsung Galaxy S WiFi 5" 8 Go
T'nB Coque Clip On pour Samsung Galaxy SII - New York
Toner Samsung CLT-C4072S - Cyan
Toner Samsung CLT-C4092S Cyan
Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S - Noir
Toner Samsung CLT-K4092S Noir
Toner Samsung CLT-M4072S - Magenta
Toner Samsung CLT-M4092S Magenta
Toner Samsung CLT-P4092C - Pack de 4 Toners
Toner Samsung CLT-Y4072S - Jaune
Toner Samsung CLT-Y4092S Jaune
Toner Samsung MLT-D1042S - Noir
We Digital by Samsung - Silver We 1 To USB 2.0
We Digital by Samsung - Silver WE 2 To USB 2.0
Xqisit Coque iPlate Glossy pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanche
Xqisit Coque iPlate Style pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Transparente/Blanche
Xqisit Coque iPlate Style pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Transparente/Noire
Xqisit Coque Soft Grip pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanche
Xqisit Coque Soft Grip pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noire
Xqisit Etui Flipcover pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Blanc
Xqisit Etui Flipcover pour Samsung Galaxy S3 - Noir

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Imprimante-l..> 23-Jul-2012 21:34  2.8M  

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Multifonctio..> 24-Jul-2012 14:00  6.0M  

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Multifonctio..> 24-Jul-2012 13:51  5.4M  

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Multifonctio..> 23-Jul-2012 21:57  4.3M  

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Multifonctio..> 24-Jul-2012 13:55  6.0M  

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Multifonctio..> 23-Jul-2012 21:39  3.8M  

[TXT]

 16-4ppm-Multifonctio..> 23-Jul-2012 21:44  4.3M  

[TXT]

 17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-..> 23-Jul-2012 18:59  3.9M  

[TXT]

 19-Serie-3-Moniteur-..> 29-Jul-2012 10:18  4.7M  

[TXT]

 20ppm-Multifonction-..> 24-Jul-2012 14:04  6.0M  

[TXT]

 24ppm-Multifonction-..> 24-Jul-2012 14:08  6.5M  

[TXT]

 27-Serie7-Moniteur-s..> 29-Jul-2012 10:23  4.8M  

[TXT]

 32-LE32D450WXZF-seri..> 24-Jul-2012 16:22  5.7M  

[TXT]

 32-UE32D6200WXZF-ser..> 29-Jul-2012 10:12  4.6M  

[TXT]

 35-35ppm-Copieur-cou..> 24-Jul-2012 14:22  6.5M  

[TXT]

 40-UE40D6500WXZF-ser..> 23-Jul-2012 18:34  3.6M  

[TXT]

 46-LE46D550WXZF-seri..> 24-Jul-2012 16:17  6.9M  

[TXT]

 CLX-3185FW.htm          30-Aug-2012 10:57  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Galaxy-S-Advance-GT-..> 28-Jul-2012 10:42  5.5M  

[TXT]

 Galaxy-Y-S5360-Andro..> 05-Sep-2012 07:56  3.2M  

[TXT]

 GalaxyAceGT-S5830.htm   30-Apr-2012 11:05  1.4M  

[TXT]

 GalaxySIIGT-I9100.htm   30-Apr-2012 10:59  914K  

[TXT]

 GalaxyTab8.9GT-P7310..> 30-Apr-2012 17:22  2.3M  

[TXT]

 GalaxyTab10.1GT-P750..> 30-Apr-2012 17:16  2.0M  

[TXT]

 GalaxyYGT-S5360.htm     30-Apr-2012 11:32  2.0M  

[TXT]

 LE32C350LE32C350D1W.htm 30-Apr-2012 11:12  1.9M  

[TXT]

 LE40C630LE40C630K1W.htm 01-May-2012 10:44  4.8M  

[TXT]

 LE40D503F7W-Samsung-..> 24-Jul-2012 16:31  6.3M  

[TXT]

 LE55C650-LE55C650L1W..> 24-Jul-2012 16:27  6.3M  

[TXT]

 Liste-Manuels-Utilis..> 28-Nov-2012 17:46   82K  

[TXT]

 Liste-Produits-Manue..> 28-Nov-2012 06:57  213K  

[TXT]

 MM-C330D.htm            30-Apr-2012 11:18  2.0M  

[TXT]

 MM-D330D.htm            30-Apr-2012 17:46  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-Utilisateur-..> 05-Sep-2012 08:10  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 17:54  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 17:58  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 18:03  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 18:07  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 18:11  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 18:16  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 06-Sep-2012 18:21  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 05-Sep-2012 08:19  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Manuels-de-l-Utilisa..> 05-Sep-2012 08:27  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Micro-chaine-MM-D330..> 23-Jul-2012 18:43  3.9M  

[TXT]

 N145Plus-NP-N145P-Ma..> 23-Jul-2012 19:31  3.9M  

[TXT]

 N150-NP-N150-Manuels..> 23-Jul-2012 18:53  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Nexus-S-noir-Open-ma..> 24-Sep-2012 11:11  4.0M  

[TXT]

 RSH5UEPN.htm            30-Apr-2012 18:01  3.4M  

[TXT]

 SAMSUNG-DV90-Manuels..> 06-Oct-2012 18:04  2.6M  

[TXT]

 SGH-F490.htm            01-May-2012 10:22  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 12:01  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 12:02  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:47  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:44  4.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 23-Dec-2012 22:06  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:45  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 24-Dec-2012 08:07  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 23-Dec-2012 22:07  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 11:59  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 16:02  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 23-Dec-2012 22:08  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 12:11  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 12:12  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 12:00  4.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 12:10  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 12:12  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:47  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 20-Dec-2012 13:24  5.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 24-Dec-2012 08:06  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 11:59  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 23-Dec-2012 22:05  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:45  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 16:03  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 12:11  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 16:03  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 23-Dec-2012 22:06  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 12:00  4.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 12:09  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 21-Dec-2012 12:01  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:47  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 21:48  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 19-Dec-2012 16:02  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 23-Dec-2012 22:05  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 24-Dec-2012 08:07  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Аудиот..> 24-Dec-2012 08:06  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Бытова..> 19-Dec-2012 21:48  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Мобиль..> 21-Dec-2012 11:58  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Мобиль..> 21-Dec-2012 12:03  5.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Мобиль..> 21-Dec-2012 12:02  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung--Informatiqu..> 06-May-2013 11:14  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-16-MP-Ecran-..> 09-Oct-2012 17:12  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-18-XTDVBEUE-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:08  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-20-XTDVBEUE-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:37  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-22-LE22D450W..> 07-Oct-2012 10:14  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-24-LED-HDTV-..> 09-Oct-2012 17:17  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-32-LE32D450W..> 24-Sep-2012 09:34  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-32-UE32D4000..> 16-Oct-2012 11:37  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-40-LE40D550W..> 01-Oct-2012 14:59  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-40-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:36  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-40-UE40D5700..> 04-Oct-2012 07:20  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-40-UE40D6500..> 04-Oct-2012 18:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-40-UE40D8000..> 07-Oct-2012 10:19  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:36  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:19  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:24  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:28  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:37  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:36  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:34  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:35  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-UE46D5700..> 24-Sep-2012 09:40  4.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-46-UE46D7000..> 02-Oct-2012 15:40  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-51-PS51E490W..> 06-Oct-2012 17:51  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-51-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:35  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-51-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:34  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-55-Smart-3D-..> 14-Oct-2012 21:34  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-305U1A-A02-N..> 09-Oct-2012 17:26  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-320MXN-3-SSD..> 10-Oct-2012 06:44  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-320TSN-3D-SS..> 09-Oct-2012 07:48  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-400EXN-Japon..> 17-Oct-2012 10:47  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-400TS-3-400T..> 17-Oct-2012 10:46  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-400TS-3D-400..> 17-Oct-2012 10:47  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-400UXN-3-Jap..> 08-Oct-2012 18:42  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-400UXN-3-SSD..> 10-Oct-2012 06:45  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-460UT-B-Japo..> 17-Oct-2012 10:47  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-700TSn-2-SSD..> 09-Oct-2012 07:47  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-708SC-Japon-..> 17-Oct-2012 10:47  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-740SC-JP-Man..> 07-Oct-2012 10:51  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-821SC-JP-Man..> 07-Oct-2012 10:44  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-910MP-Manuel..> 06-Oct-2012 12:56  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-940SC-JP-Man..> 07-Oct-2012 10:58  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-941SC-JP-Man..> 07-Oct-2012 10:45  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-2012_Skype_E..> 01-Oct-2012 10:51  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-2243QW-Japon..> 08-Oct-2012 18:41  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-201204051657..> 07-Oct-2012 14:01  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-AQ09UGBN-Man..> 01-Oct-2012 14:54  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-AQ18UGFN-Man..> 24-Sep-2012 10:17  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-AQV12KBBN-Po..> 06-Oct-2012 18:16  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-AQV18UGAX-Ma..> 24-Sep-2012 09:53  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Affichage-Dy..> 06-Feb-2013 07:13  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Appareil-pho..> 06-May-2013 08:00  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Appareils-me..> 19-Apr-2013 18:58  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Appareils-mo..> 31-May-2013 17:12  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Appareils-mo..> 31-May-2013 17:12  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-B2440MH-Japo..> 08-Oct-2012 18:41  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-BN68-04109G-..> 07-Oct-2012 14:05  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-CLP-367W-Man..> 01-Oct-2012 15:31  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-CW21Z503N-Ma..> 24-Sep-2012 10:10  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-CW21Z573N-Ma..> 04-Oct-2012 07:15  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camaras-Alta..> 29-Nov-2012 08:22  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-Camco..> 29-Nov-2012 08:24  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-Camco..> 29-Nov-2012 10:40  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-Camco..> 10-Jun-2013 08:11  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-et-Ca..> 26-Mar-2013 06:44  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camera-et-Ca..> 26-Mar-2013 06:45  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Camescopes-P..> 06-Jun-2013 07:26  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cell-Phones-..> 06-May-2013 08:01  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cell-Phones-..> 06-May-2013 07:45  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cell-Phones-..> 06-May-2013 07:45  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cell-Phones-..> 06-May-2013 08:01  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cell-Phones-..> 06-May-2013 08:00  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cell-Phones-..> 07-Apr-2013 10:23  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Congelateur-..> 24-Sep-2012 10:54  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Cuisson-Four..> 08-Feb-2013 10:06  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-DA-E550-CN-M..> 24-Sep-2012 16:43  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-DA68-01829P...> 07-Oct-2012 10:04  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-DA68-01829P...> 07-Oct-2012 10:04  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-E-MANUAL-X9D..> 24-Sep-2012 14:08  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-E1720NR-Japo..> 09-Oct-2012 07:49  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electroména..> 01-Dec-2012 07:34  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electrom-nag..> 11-Nov-2012 14:20  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 05-Feb-2013 18:50  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 27-Dec-2012 10:57  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 18:09  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Nov-2012 07:42  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 08:19  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:27  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 01-Jan-2013 10:32  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 18:12  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 11:39  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 08:17  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:26  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 19-Dec-2012 08:26  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 18:08  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Jan-2013 08:10  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 18-Jan-2013 14:21  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 28-Nov-2012 07:19  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 08-Jan-2013 08:38  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Nov-2012 07:42  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 18:30  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 27-Dec-2012 10:57  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:28  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 18:09  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 30-Jan-2013 07:43  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 03-Dec-2012 15:43  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 05-Feb-2013 18:49  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 24-Dec-2012 14:48  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 11:57  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 04-Jan-2013 16:24  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:28  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 11:38  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 08:16  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:26  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jan-2013 08:16  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 13:14  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 27-Dec-2012 11:00  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 04-Jan-2013 16:20  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 05-Feb-2013 18:48  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 30-Jan-2013 07:45  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:25  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 27-Feb-2013 14:49  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 14:22  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 14:21  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Jan-2013 16:41  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 28-Nov-2012 14:41  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 14:18  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 09-Nov-2012 18:22  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 23-Jan-2013 06:53  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 14:20  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 06-Feb-2013 07:09  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 08-Feb-2013 10:04  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 12:21  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 17-Nov-2012 19:23  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 06-Feb-2013 07:11  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 19-Dec-2012 08:26  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 01-Dec-2012 07:34  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 20-Nov-2012 09:45  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 01-Dec-2012 07:33  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 22-Nov-2012 08:29  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 12-Feb-2013 17:51  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 30-Nov-2012 19:06  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 27-Feb-2013 14:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 19-Apr-2013 18:59  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 05-Feb-2013 18:49  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 11:40  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 13:17  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 11:41  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 27-Dec-2012 10:55  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 04-Jan-2013 16:24  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 30-Jan-2013 07:45  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Nov-2012 07:43  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 21-Jan-2013 16:29  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Jan-2013 16:42  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 03-Dec-2012 15:10  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 16-Jan-2013 07:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 09-Nov-2012 18:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 11-Nov-2012 14:22  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 29-Nov-2012 10:09  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 31-May-2013 16:01  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 26-Mar-2013 07:29  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 01-Dec-2012 07:33  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 19-Apr-2013 18:56  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 22-Nov-2012 08:31  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 22-Nov-2012 08:29  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 22-Nov-2012 08:27  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 28-Nov-2012 12:20  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jun-2013 07:26  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 03-Dec-2012 15:04  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Electromenag..> 10-Jun-2013 07:27  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Entro-SPH-m3..> 09-Oct-2012 17:12  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Exhibit-4G-A..> 03-Dec-2012 15:42  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-NEXUS..> 24-Sep-2012 15:17  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Note-..> 24-Sep-2012 14:59  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-..> 16-Oct-2012 11:36  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-..> 24-Sep-2012 14:48  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-7..> 07-Oct-2012 11:16  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-1..> 24-Sep-2012 16:29  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-G..> 24-Sep-2012 10:42  5.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-S..> 24-Sep-2012 16:32  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Y-Pro..> 16-Oct-2012 11:35  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GALAXY-Y-Pro..> 09-Oct-2012 17:13  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-GSM-Cham..> 07-Apr-2013 10:25  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-GSM-E105..> 04-Jun-2013 17:03  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-GSM-E118..> 02-Jun-2013 22:07  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-GSM-E220..> 26-Mar-2013 07:34  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-GSM-E220..> 26-Mar-2013 06:41  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-S5610-GT..> 10-Jun-2013 08:03  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 07-Apr-2013 10:23  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 26-Mar-2013 07:31  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 07-Apr-2013 10:24  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 06-May-2013 09:30  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 05-Jun-2013 06:55  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 05-Jun-2013 06:55  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 26-Mar-2013 06:42  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 07-Apr-2013 10:26  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 04-Jun-2013 16:39  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 06-May-2013 09:31  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 07-Apr-2013 10:28  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 10-Jun-2013 08:05  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GSM-Smartpho..> 05-Jun-2013 07:48  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-B5310-Man..> 24-Sep-2012 10:59  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-I9000-Man..> 02-Oct-2012 16:14  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-I9070P_UM..> 05-Oct-2012 17:16  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-I9250-Man..> 05-Oct-2012 17:34  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-I9300-Man..> 06-Oct-2012 18:01  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-I9300_UM_..> 05-Oct-2012 17:20  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-N8000-CN-..> 24-Sep-2012 16:50  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-N8000-Man..> 06-Oct-2012 18:10  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-P5110-Jap..> 09-Oct-2012 07:49  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-P6200-Man..> 01-Oct-2012 11:15  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-S5360-Man..> 24-Sep-2012 14:25  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-S5360_UM_..> 24-Sep-2012 14:16  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-S5570_UM_..> 05-Oct-2012 17:10  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-GT-S5830_UM_..> 05-Oct-2012 17:38  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Gainable-Sli..> 04-Oct-2012 07:11  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-n..> 23-Jul-2012 18:22  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Gio-n..> 06-Oct-2012 12:05  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Note-..> 24-Sep-2012 14:44  4.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Note-..> 06-Oct-2012 17:57  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-II-..> 23-Jul-2012 18:17  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-III..> 23-Jul-2012 18:29  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-III..> 28-Jul-2012 10:34  7.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-Plu..> 24-Jul-2012 11:39  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL..> 06-Oct-2012 11:51  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL..> 06-Oct-2012 11:50  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S-noi..> 23-Jul-2012 18:26  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S2-GT..> 17-Sep-2012 16:19  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT..> 20-Nov-2012 10:03  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Spica..> 06-Oct-2012 12:17  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2..> 15-Nov-2012 18:17  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2..> 06-Oct-2012 17:40  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2..> 24-Jul-2012 14:34  6.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2..> 06-Oct-2012 17:36  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-7..> 24-Jul-2012 14:35  6.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-1..> 24-Sep-2012 14:21  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-1..> 24-Sep-2012 14:22  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-1..> 09-Oct-2012 17:11  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-..> 06-Oct-2012 12:11  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Xcove..> 30-Aug-2012 10:56  4.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-Y-DUO..> 09-Oct-2012 17:13  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-mini-..> 17-Sep-2012 16:48  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Galaxy-noir-..> 17-Sep-2012 16:44  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 28-Nov-2012 17:43  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 29-Nov-2012 08:21  950K  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Home-Applian..> 29-Nov-2012 08:20  947K  

[TXT]

 Samsung-I9300-GT-I93..> 29-Nov-2012 10:21  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-IT-producten..> 26-Mar-2013 06:43  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-IT-producten..> 10-Jun-2013 07:26  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-IT-producten..> 26-Mar-2013 07:31  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 11:45  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 31-May-2013 17:12  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 06-Feb-2013 07:12  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 22:07  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 22:09  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 22:08  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 11:46  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 10-Jun-2013 07:27  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 11:44  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 04-Jun-2013 18:22  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 02-Jun-2013 11:50  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 04-Jun-2013 16:40  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 10-Jun-2013 07:26  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 04-Jun-2013 16:40  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 04-Jun-2013 16:41  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Imprimantes-..> 04-Jun-2013 16:40  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatica-..> 29-Nov-2012 08:23  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 12:47  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Dec-2012 08:10  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:44  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 12:49  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 12:49  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Nov-2012 11:05  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 07:27  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 11:45  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-May-2013 07:48  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 12:04  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-May-2013 11:13  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 02-Jun-2013 22:09  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 12:47  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 25-May-2013 11:32  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:10  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Nov-2012 08:30  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Jun-2013 07:27  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-Jun-2013 07:29  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 14:15  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 23-May-2013 07:40  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:39  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Nov-2012 19:07  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 23-May-2013 07:41  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 09:43  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 11:44  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:25  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 04-Jun-2013 18:21  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Jan-2013 14:20  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 27-May-2013 07:40  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 12:16  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Jan-2013 16:23  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Nov-2012 19:08  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 08:16  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 09:43  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 05-Feb-2013 18:51  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Jan-2013 07:47  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 05-Feb-2013 18:51  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 05-Feb-2013 18:52  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-May-2013 15:24  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Apr-2013 11:55  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Jan-2013 14:21  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 01-Jan-2013 11:17  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Jan-2013 16:25  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Jan-2013 07:48  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Nov-2012 14:23  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 27-Feb-2013 14:48  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 14:40  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Apr-2013 11:02  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-Jan-2013 11:32  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-Jan-2013 11:32  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-May-2013 18:37  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Nov-2012 19:06  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 25-May-2013 11:29  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 07-Feb-2013 15:38  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:36  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 14:38  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:14  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 09-Nov-2012 18:21  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:37  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 13-Jan-2013 18:09  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 31-May-2013 17:15  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 12:04  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 11:45  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Jan-2013 16:23  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 24-Dec-2012 08:28  6.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 08-Feb-2013 10:03  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-May-2013 15:19  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-May-2013 11:14  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Nov-2012 08:05  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Dec-2012 08:28  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 07:26  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 13-May-2013 17:34  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-May-2013 22:41  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Apr-2013 11:56  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Nov-2012 08:24  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:27  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 07-Feb-2013 15:39  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 23-May-2013 07:42  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 27-May-2013 07:58  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 27-May-2013 07:40  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 27-May-2013 22:26  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-May-2013 15:28  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-May-2013 15:17  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Jan-2013 14:20  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 05-Jun-2013 06:56  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 12:47  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 25-May-2013 11:25  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 23-May-2013 07:42  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 07:25  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 07:24  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 05-Jun-2013 06:54  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 02-Jun-2013 11:44  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 08:13  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:39  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 05-Jun-2013 19:38  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 31-May-2013 17:23  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 06:46  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:41  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-May-2013 15:21  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-Jun-2013 07:28  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 27-May-2013 22:24  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 15:03  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Jan-2013 14:21  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:05  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:26  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Nov-2012 18:16  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Nov-2012 08:31  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 23-May-2013 07:39  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 11:44  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Nov-2012 11:47  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:54  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:54  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 31-May-2013 17:19  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Nov-2012 20:17  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:15  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 09-Nov-2012 18:23  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Nov-2012 14:19  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:07  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Nov-2012 11:06  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 08:16  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 07-Feb-2013 15:36  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 02-Jun-2013 11:43  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 09:46  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 08:15  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 17:36  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:53  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 14-May-2013 07:22  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Nov-2012 11:06  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 08:03  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 08:13  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 08:03  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:09  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-May-2013 15:18  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Apr-2013 10:50  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:43  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:26  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:40  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 25-May-2013 11:33  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:07  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:44  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 12:13  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Dec-2012 08:11  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Dec-2012 08:05  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Dec-2012 08:05  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:06  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:06  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:15  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:31  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 07-Apr-2013 10:26  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:12  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 12:49  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 01-Dec-2012 07:31  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Nov-2012 11:48  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 21-Nov-2012 14:39  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:06  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:06  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:05  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:07  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 11:45  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:26  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Dec-2012 08:06  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:28  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 10-Jan-2013 18:31  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 08-Jan-2013 08:38  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 08-Jan-2013 08:37  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:45  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Nov-2012 12:22  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:08  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:46  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:38  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 08:02  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 15-Jan-2013 17:14  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 14-Jan-2013 07:15  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:56  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:43  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:49  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:52  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:48  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Nov-2012 08:24  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Jan-2013 07:49  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:15  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:47  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:06  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:53  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 15:04  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:48  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 09:04  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:45  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Apr-2013 10:51  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:31  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Apr-2013 11:56  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 08-Jan-2013 08:38  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 15-Jan-2013 17:14  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:55  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:47  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 08:24  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 12:51  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Nov-2012 08:24  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 08:08  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 08:24  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:09  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:16  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:42  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:57  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 13-May-2013 22:06  4.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 14-Jan-2013 07:14  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:09  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 08:22  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:16  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:30  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Nov-2012 11:07  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:56  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 03-Dec-2012 12:25  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:07  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 08:24  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:42  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 31-May-2013 17:19  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 09:46  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 14-Jan-2013 07:16  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 08:07  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 08:23  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:42  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:04  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 18-Nov-2012 11:05  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-May-2013 07:42  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-May-2013 06:15  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 01-Dec-2012 07:31  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 13-Jan-2013 22:33  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:39  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Nov-2012 14:18  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:49  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 14-Jan-2013 07:16  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 06:48  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:04  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 17:36  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:43  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 28-Nov-2012 12:24  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:38  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Jan-2013 07:55  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 14-Jan-2013 07:15  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 08:15  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 17-Jan-2013 07:46  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 15-Jan-2013 17:14  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 11-Jan-2013 16:39  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 09-Dec-2012 22:15  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 30-Nov-2012 18:17  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-May-2013 09:29  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 26-Mar-2013 06:41  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:40  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 23-May-2013 07:42  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:45  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 22-Jan-2013 12:06  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 16-Nov-2012 19:09  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 12-Feb-2013 17:40  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 06-Jan-2013 11:32  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 19-Nov-2012 08:05  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Informatique..> 20-Nov-2012 09:46  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Kit-Pieton-B..> 16-Oct-2012 11:34  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LA46C550J1F-..> 24-Sep-2012 17:00  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE19C350-LE1..> 16-Oct-2012 11:37  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE22C452C4H-..> 16-Oct-2012 11:38  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE26B450-LE2..> 16-Oct-2012 11:33  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE26D450G1W-..> 05-Oct-2012 16:42  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32A466-Man..> 04-Oct-2012 18:25  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32A568-LE3..> 02-Oct-2012 15:59  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32B450C4W-..> 04-Oct-2012 18:16  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32C650-LE3..> 05-Oct-2012 16:36  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32D400E1W-..> 04-Oct-2012 07:06  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32D460C9H-..> 19-Oct-2012 14:58  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE32E420E2W-..> 06-Oct-2012 12:50  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE37A466-LE3..> 19-Oct-2012 15:02  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE40A577P2M-..> 16-Oct-2012 11:38  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE40B551A6W-..> 19-Oct-2012 14:58  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE40S71B-Man..> 24-Sep-2012 10:31  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE46A676-LE4..> 24-Sep-2012 10:04  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE46C630-LE4..> 07-Oct-2012 10:34  4.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-LE52A676-LE5..> 07-Oct-2012 10:06  4.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Lecteur-Mult..> 02-Oct-2012 16:09  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Lecteur-Mult..> 24-Sep-2012 14:29  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Livres-blanc..> 05-Jun-2013 19:37  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Livres-blanc..> 05-Jun-2013 19:37  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-ME40A-TP40-J..> 09-Oct-2012 07:47  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-ME46A-Japon-..> 09-Oct-2012 07:47  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-ME65B-Japon-..> 17-Oct-2012 10:52  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-MH050FXEA2B-..> 01-Oct-2012 11:00  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-ML-2160-Impr..> 09-Nov-2012 18:26  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-ML-2165W-Rou..> 06-Oct-2012 18:21  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-M_YUKON_2K_W..> 07-Oct-2012 10:03  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 30-Nov-2012 18:15  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 31-May-2013 17:14  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 29-Nov-2012 08:22  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 03-Dec-2012 15:02  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 29-Nov-2012 08:20  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 30-Nov-2012 18:16  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Phone..> 29-Nov-2012 08:20  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Smart..> 02-Jun-2013 22:09  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobile-Table..> 06-Feb-2013 07:12  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Sma..> 04-Jun-2013 18:22  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Tel..> 07-Apr-2013 10:28  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Mobilite-Tel..> 07-Apr-2013 10:29  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Moniteur-gra..> 08-Feb-2013 10:05  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Monitors-249..> 03-Dec-2012 15:42  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-N145Plus-NP-..> 05-Oct-2012 16:58  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-N150-NP-N150..> 05-Oct-2012 17:01  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NC190-Japon-..> 09-Oct-2012 07:48  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NP-R530-NP-R..> 24-Sep-2012 10:48  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NP20-NP20FK0..> 05-Oct-2012 17:06  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NP300E5C-NP3..> 16-Oct-2012 11:37  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NP300E5ZI-NP..> 16-Oct-2012 11:36  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NP300V5AH-Ma..> 04-Jun-2013 18:23  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NP530U3C-A01..> 16-Oct-2012 11:35  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-NS140SDXEA-M..> 01-Oct-2012 10:55  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Nexus-S-noir..> 17-Sep-2012 16:24  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Notebook-Ser..> 06-Oct-2012 18:29  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-7-noir..> 17-Sep-2012 16:38  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-II-noi..> 17-Sep-2012 16:31  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-II-noi..> 17-Sep-2012 16:30  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-Lite-n..> 17-Sep-2012 16:12  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7..> 17-Sep-2012 16:09  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7..> 06-Oct-2012 12:29  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Omnia-W-noir..> 17-Sep-2012 11:47  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-OFFICE-Co..> 31-May-2013 17:13  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-Office-LC..> 29-Nov-2012 08:21  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-Office-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 08:20  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-Office-Ne..> 03-Dec-2012 15:05  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-Office-No..> 03-Dec-2012 15:03  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PC-Office-No..> 03-Dec-2012 15:06  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PDP-TV-PN51D..> 01-Oct-2012 15:21  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PS42C450-PS4..> 02-Oct-2012 16:06  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PS50A566-PS5..> 16-Oct-2012 11:38  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PS50C450-PS5..> 16-Oct-2012 11:37  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PS50C535-PS5..> 14-Oct-2012 21:34  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PS51D490A1W-..> 16-Oct-2012 11:33  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-PS51E530-ZF-..> 09-Oct-2012 17:31  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 06-May-2013 09:29  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 05-Jun-2013 06:56  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 05-Jun-2013 07:49  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 29-Nov-2012 10:21  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Peripherique..> 02-Jun-2013 22:08  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 08-Feb-2013 10:04  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 08-Feb-2013 10:04  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Dec-2012 08:26  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 16-Nov-2012 17:36  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 21-Jan-2013 16:24  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 06-May-2013 18:07  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 22-May-2013 07:33  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 27-May-2013 07:39  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 06-May-2013 11:13  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 25-May-2013 11:35  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 05-Jun-2013 07:46  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 20-May-2013 22:40  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 26-Mar-2013 07:30  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Apr-2013 18:58  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 10-Jun-2013 08:04  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung- Photo-Cames..> 06-May-2013 09:30  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 10-Jan-2013 18:08  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 06-May-2013 11:52  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 25-May-2013 11:27  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 05-Feb-2013 18:47  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 05-Feb-2013 18:48  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 21-Jan-2013 16:24  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 21-Nov-2012 12:49  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 08-Feb-2013 10:06  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 13-May-2013 17:34  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 29-Nov-2012 10:08  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 08-Feb-2013 10:06  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 31-May-2013 17:19  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 08-Jan-2013 08:38  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 08-Feb-2013 10:06  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 12-Feb-2013 17:42  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 31-May-2013 17:16  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 21-Nov-2012 12:14  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 11-Nov-2012 14:20  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 20-Nov-2012 08:18  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 06-May-2013 09:33  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 25-May-2013 11:30  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 06-Feb-2013 07:11  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 27-Feb-2013 14:50  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 22-Nov-2012 08:24  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 07-Feb-2013 15:37  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 30-Nov-2012 19:05  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 26-Mar-2013 07:29  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 22-May-2013 06:40  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 21-Nov-2012 12:49  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 26-Mar-2013 07:28  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Apr-2013 18:55  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 07-Feb-2013 15:36  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 26-Mar-2013 06:47  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 05-Feb-2013 18:52  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 13-Jan-2013 18:08  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 20-Nov-2012 08:18  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 23-May-2013 07:39  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 20-May-2013 22:39  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 31-May-2013 16:01  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Apr-2013 11:06  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Apr-2013 19:00  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Apr-2013 11:02  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 06-Feb-2013 14:49  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 01-Dec-2012 07:32  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 21-May-2013 15:20  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 19-Apr-2013 19:00  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Photo-Camesc..> 18-Nov-2012 11:04  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Player-Addic..> 17-Sep-2012 11:39  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Player-Duo-n..> 17-Sep-2012 11:35  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Player-HD-no..> 17-Sep-2012 11:31  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Player-One-n..> 06-Oct-2012 18:39  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 20-May-2013 22:40  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 05-Jun-2013 06:56  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 21-May-2013 15:19  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 06-Jun-2013 07:26  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 21-May-2013 06:47  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 21-May-2013 15:20  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 06-Jun-2013 07:28  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 04-Jun-2013 18:25  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 21-May-2013 15:20  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 14-May-2013 07:38  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 10-Jun-2013 08:04  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 14-May-2013 07:38  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 14-May-2013 08:05  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 02-Jun-2013 11:45  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 04-Jun-2013 18:23  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 19-Apr-2013 18:57  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 14-May-2013 07:23  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 14-May-2013 07:38  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 14-May-2013 07:23  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 27-Feb-2013 14:47  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 27-Feb-2013 14:47  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 19-Apr-2013 18:56  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Portables-et..> 19-Apr-2013 11:06  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Presentation..> 07-Apr-2013 10:36  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Printers-Mul..> 06-Jun-2013 07:27  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-RE-C21VMS-Ma..> 01-Oct-2012 15:24  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-RR92HASX-Man..> 24-Sep-2012 10:26  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-RR92HAWW-Man..> 01-Oct-2012 11:10  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-RR92HAWW-Ref..> 09-Nov-2012 18:25  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-RV511-NP-RV5..> 29-Nov-2012 10:07  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Refrigerateu..> 01-Oct-2012 11:18  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Refrigerateu..> 24-Sep-2012 10:20  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Refrigerator..> 03-Dec-2012 15:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-S-II-HDSHV-E..> 31-May-2013 17:15  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-S22B350B-Man..> 06-Oct-2012 17:46  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-S23A550H-Jap..> 10-Oct-2012 06:56  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-S5610-GT-S56..> 06-Oct-2012 12:37  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SCH-W999-CN-..> 24-Sep-2012 16:54  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SCX-4x28-Ser..> 02-Jun-2013 11:46  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SCX-3200-Man..> 09-Oct-2012 17:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SCX-3400-Pak..> 03-Dec-2012 15:04  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SGH-D500-Tel..> 09-Nov-2012 18:24  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SHV-E210S-S-..> 01-Oct-2012 15:39  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SHV-E300L-Co..> 31-May-2013 17:13  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SHW-M220L-Co..> 04-Jun-2013 16:41  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-SNE-60K_UM_E..> 07-Oct-2012 10:03  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Samsung-Gala..> 24-Sep-2012 14:38  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Samsung-Gala..> 24-Sep-2012 10:38  4.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Samsung-Gala..> 06-Oct-2012 11:58  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Sante-Ultras..> 28-May-2013 07:39  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Sprzet-kompu..> 29-Nov-2012 08:22  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Stockage-inf..> 30-Nov-2012 19:06  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Stockage-inf..> 01-Dec-2012 07:32  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Stockage-inf..> 16-Jan-2013 07:51  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Stockage-inf..> 23-May-2013 07:38  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Stockage-inf..> 25-May-2013 11:30  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Stockage-inf..> 23-May-2013 07:41  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Téléphone-..> 29-Nov-2012 10:05  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-T22B300EW-Ma..> 09-Oct-2012 17:38  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-T240-JP-Manu..> 07-Oct-2012 10:36  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-T260-Japon-M..> 10-Oct-2012 06:44  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-3D-Blu..> 29-Nov-2012 08:23  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-3D-TV-..> 16-Nov-2012 12:47  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-LED-19..> 03-Dec-2012 15:05  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-LED-UE..> 10-Dec-2012 08:06  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-PDP-20..> 29-Nov-2012 10:09  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-TV-LED..> 05-Jun-2013 07:47  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-TV-LED..> 05-Jun-2013 07:48  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-AV-TV-LED..> 19-Apr-2013 10:50  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-LCD..> 06-May-2013 09:30  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 26-Mar-2013 06:49  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:14  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 12:09  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:11  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 29-Nov-2012 10:05  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 08:21  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 08:01  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jan-2013 16:40  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:11  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Jan-2013 07:44  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:30  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jan-2013 16:39  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 08:03  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 29-Nov-2012 10:08  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 03-Dec-2012 15:43  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:21  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 12:53  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:58  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Jan-2013 11:43  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 08:21  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 06:48  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Apr-2013 18:58  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:39  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:12  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:17  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:22  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:25  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:18  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 14:45  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 10:23  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:15  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 08:25  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 03-Dec-2012 15:44  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 19:08  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Jan-2013 08:17  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:10  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:10  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 03-Dec-2012 15:43  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 12:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:17  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:15  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:24  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 03-Dec-2012 15:42  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 14:45  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:40  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:10  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 17:37  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 03-Dec-2012 12:29  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:50  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:24  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 21:59  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-May-2013 07:40  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:41  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 29-Nov-2012 10:03  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Feb-2013 17:44  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Jan-2013 07:50  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:20  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:20  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:18  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 14:44  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 06:57  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:19  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:21  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:10  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 17:36  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:43  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-May-2013 07:39  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:13  4.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 08:01  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 17-Nov-2012 19:24  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:24  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 10:33  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:07  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-Dec-2012 10:59  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:05  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:16  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 19:15  4.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-May-2013 22:25  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-May-2013 07:40  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 26-Nov-2012 10:28  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 31-May-2013 17:20  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 12:21  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 31-May-2013 17:18  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 17-Nov-2012 19:36  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 05-Jun-2013 07:48  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:09  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Apr-2013 18:56  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 05-Jun-2013 06:54  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 12:47  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Jan-2013 07:52  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 14-May-2013 08:08  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-May-2013 11:53  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 17-Nov-2012 19:23  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Nov-2012 08:32  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 14:39  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 17:34  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 15:02  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-May-2013 18:33  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 22:01  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 25-May-2013 11:27  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Feb-2013 17:40  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 17-Nov-2012 19:24  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:15  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Apr-2013 18:56  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 25-May-2013 11:29  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:09  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 14:42  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 12:48  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 17:34  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Nov-2012 08:16  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Jan-2013 12:05  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-May-2013 18:16  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 18-Nov-2012 11:07  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-Dec-2012 12:05  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 10:19  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 08:04  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 14:40  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 12:16  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 19:12  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:06  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:06  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 08:23  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jan-2013 16:37  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:41  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 26-Mar-2013 07:26  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Feb-2013 17:55  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 25-May-2013 11:26  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:05  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-May-2013 08:00  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-May-2013 07:58  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Nov-2012 08:28  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 18-Nov-2012 20:17  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-May-2013 06:30  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 18-Jan-2013 14:20  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Feb-2013 15:39  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 14:20  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 14:21  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 09-Nov-2012 18:24  4.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 09-Nov-2012 18:28  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 09-Nov-2012 18:22  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 08:22  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 17-Nov-2012 12:05  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 12:52  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 26-Mar-2013 06:47  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 12:29  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:32  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:29  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 11:37  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Jan-2013 07:46  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:24  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:21  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Nov-2012 09:44  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 10:32  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 07:19  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 08:03  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 11:36  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:22  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 23-Jan-2013 06:52  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-Dec-2012 11:00  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 08:03  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:22  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Jan-2013 07:46  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 08:04  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 09:40  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:23  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:21  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:15  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 08:01  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:09  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:17  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:14  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:20  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:17  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Nov-2012 08:19  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 29-Nov-2012 10:07  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:58  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:18  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:42  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-May-2013 11:53  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:07  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:08  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 09-Dec-2012 22:16  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Nov-2012 08:16  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jan-2013 16:43  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 13:16  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 03-Mar-2013 12:16  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 18-Jan-2013 14:23  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 18:29  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:49  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 11:41  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 13:16  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:30  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:19  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:41  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 07:18  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Nov-2012 08:28  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 08:22  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 18:56  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 17-Nov-2012 19:22  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 07:18  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 08:04  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 08:04  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 13:17  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:17  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 10:37  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Nov-2012 08:30  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-Dec-2012 10:59  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Nov-2012 09:44  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 26-Nov-2012 10:28  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-Nov-2012 08:25  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 08:24  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 18:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 13:14  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 05-Feb-2013 18:51  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:41  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:27  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 21:59  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:25  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:13  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jan-2013 09:41  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:19  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:11  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 12:50  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Jan-2013 07:48  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:09  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 25-May-2013 11:28  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:20  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 12:46  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:28  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:30  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 05-Feb-2013 18:50  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:33  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 10:18  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Jan-2013 07:47  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:15  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 21:58  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:09  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 11:48  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:20  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:44  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:08  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 08:25  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:19  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Feb-2013 17:47  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 11:38  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 17:33  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:10  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Jan-2013 07:49  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Jan-2013 07:44  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Nov-2012 12:51  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-Jan-2013 11:31  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-Dec-2012 12:03  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 10:20  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:49  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 08:21  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 25-May-2013 11:26  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:43  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 13:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 08:27  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:43  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:24  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:18  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 11:19  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Nov-2012 11:50  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:14  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 11:40  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-Jan-2013 11:31  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 12:48  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 09-Dec-2012 22:15  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 15-Nov-2012 08:24  5.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:44  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:11  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 08:25  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Nov-2012 08:26  5.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 08:24  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 18-Jan-2013 14:20  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 12-Nov-2012 07:19  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 08:26  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 14:48  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:45  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-Apr-2013 11:56  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 22-May-2013 06:31  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 27-Dec-2012 12:05  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 11:37  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:09  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 04-Jan-2013 16:22  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:08  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 22:00  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Jan-2013 16:40  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 28-May-2013 07:43  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 12:15  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 24-Dec-2012 08:26  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 16-Jan-2013 07:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Nov-2012 07:43  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 08:23  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 30-Nov-2012 19:08  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 14:19  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 19-Dec-2012 08:24  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 06-May-2013 11:14  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 21-Jan-2013 16:21  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 07-Jan-2013 19:10  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 01-Jan-2013 10:34  4.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 13-May-2013 21:56  4.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 08-Feb-2013 10:04  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-Nov-2012 08:17  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 31-May-2013 17:18  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 14-May-2013 08:06  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Audio-Vid..> 20-May-2013 22:40  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV-Video-3D-..> 04-Jun-2013 18:22  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV Audio-Vid..> 23-Jan-2013 06:53  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV Audio-Vid..> 11-Nov-2012 13:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TV Audio-Vid..> 10-Jan-2013 08:19  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TVs-LED-TV-U..> 13-May-2013 21:57  4.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-TVs-LED-TV-U..> 13-May-2013 21:57  4.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Table-induct..> 09-Nov-2012 18:25  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Nov-2012 08:28  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 28-Nov-2012 08:23  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Nov-2012 13:24  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 13-May-2013 17:33  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 08:10  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 08:08  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Nov-2012 08:04  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 20-Nov-2012 09:57  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 08:09  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 08:10  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 12-Feb-2013 17:44  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 21-Nov-2012 12:14  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 10-Jan-2013 18:37  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 21-Nov-2012 12:16  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 31-May-2013 17:18  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 31-May-2013 17:17  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 09-Dec-2012 22:14  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 28-Nov-2012 12:21  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 25-May-2013 11:31  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 25-May-2013 11:31  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 10-Jan-2013 18:31  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 31-May-2013 17:16  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 09-Dec-2012 22:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 28-Nov-2012 12:21  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 09-Dec-2012 22:14  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 28-Nov-2012 08:25  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 10-Jun-2013 08:04  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Nov-2012 19:13  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 13-May-2013 22:01  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 31-May-2013 17:17  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 28-Nov-2012 08:23  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 25-May-2013 11:26  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Nov-2012 08:28  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Nov-2012 06:48  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Nov-2012 08:27  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Nov-2012 19:13  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-May-2013 06:47  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 10:05  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 08:09  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Apr-2013 13:30  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 10:10  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Nov-2012 11:47  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 20-Nov-2012 08:17  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 20-Nov-2012 09:45  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 21-Nov-2012 14:57  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Jan-2013 11:43  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 12-Feb-2013 17:42  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 10:08  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 13-May-2013 22:00  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 12-Feb-2013 17:41  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 16:41  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Feb-2013 14:49  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 10:06  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Jan-2013 12:05  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 12-Feb-2013 17:43  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 30-Nov-2012 19:08  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 16:42  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 03-Dec-2012 15:02  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 05-Jun-2013 06:53  4.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Apr-2013 11:55  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 18-Nov-2012 20:17  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 25-May-2013 11:26  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 21-Nov-2012 12:49  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Nov-2012 19:13  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-Jun-2013 07:27  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 08-Feb-2013 10:03  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 10:55  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 01-Jan-2013 11:13  5.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-May-2013 09:30  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Feb-2013 15:38  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Nov-2012 19:10  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Jan-2013 19:05  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Nov-2012 12:50  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 18:15  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 08-Jan-2013 09:25  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Apr-2013 10:27  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Jan-2013 07:52  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Nov-2012 11:47  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 28-Nov-2012 12:08  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Jan-2013 19:07  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 16-Jan-2013 07:51  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-May-2013 18:17  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 09-Nov-2012 18:21  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Nov-2012 12:22  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 25-May-2013 11:33  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Jan-2013 16:39  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 08:23  6.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 05-Jun-2013 07:49  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 14-Jan-2013 07:38  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 12:06  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Feb-2013 14:48  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Jan-2013 11:44  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 26-Mar-2013 06:49  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 26-Mar-2013 07:32  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 10:22  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-Feb-2013 07:12  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Feb-2013 15:37  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 18:17  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Apr-2013 18:59  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 10-Jun-2013 08:03  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 08:26  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Nov-2012 08:26  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-Feb-2013 07:12  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 30-Nov-2012 18:16  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 25-May-2013 11:28  4.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 12:08  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 12:09  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 10:20  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 10:22  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Apr-2013 10:30  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 12:09  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 23-May-2013 07:40  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 18:16  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 07-Apr-2013 10:31  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 17-Nov-2012 19:22  5.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 14-May-2013 08:06  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 13-May-2013 21:59  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 29-Nov-2012 10:22  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Nov-2012 11:48  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 19-Apr-2013 18:57  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 08-Jan-2013 08:39  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-May-2013 18:06  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 12-Feb-2013 17:44  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 12:07  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 26-Mar-2013 06:45  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-May-2013 18:17  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-May-2013 18:34  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 09-Dec-2012 22:15  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 11-Nov-2012 14:23  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 10:21  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 10:30  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Jan-2013 11:44  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 27-Dec-2012 12:08  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 22-Apr-2013 11:54  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 05-Feb-2013 18:57  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 15-Nov-2012 10:20  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 08-Feb-2013 10:06  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 06-May-2013 09:28  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephone-Mo..> 04-Jan-2013 16:23  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Telephones-C..> 08-Feb-2013 10:05  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UA32ES5500-U..> 01-Oct-2012 10:49  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UA40ES5500-U..> 09-Oct-2012 07:57  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UD22B-Japon-..> 08-Oct-2012 18:42  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE19D4003BW-..> 01-Oct-2012 15:09  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE26EH4000-Z..> 24-Sep-2012 14:02  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE26EH4500-Z..> 04-Oct-2012 18:04  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE32D5700RS-..> 01-Oct-2012 10:43  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE32D6530WS-..> 16-Oct-2012 11:34  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE32EH4003W-..> 19-Oct-2012 14:57  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE32ES6710-Z..> 24-Sep-2012 10:34  4.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE37C5100QW-..> 02-Oct-2012 15:55  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40B6050-UE..> 14-Oct-2012 21:33  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40C6000-UE..> 24-Sep-2012 10:50  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40C6700-UE..> 28-Sep-2012 11:53  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40D6510WS-..> 09-Nov-2012 18:26  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40ES5500-Z..> 16-Oct-2012 11:54  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40ES7000-Z..> 07-Oct-2012 10:26  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE40ES8000-Z..> 02-Oct-2012 16:21  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46C6805-UE..> 14-Oct-2012 21:33  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46C7700-UE..> 24-Sep-2012 10:08  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46C8700-UE..> 04-Oct-2012 07:31  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46C8700XS-..> 01-Oct-2012 15:02  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46D5720RS-..> 04-Oct-2012 18:21  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46D6300SS-..> 02-Oct-2012 15:29  753K  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46D6530WS-..> 04-Oct-2012 18:02  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46ES6100W-..> 24-Sep-2012 10:23  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46ES6300-Z..> 01-Oct-2012 10:49  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46ES8000-Z..> 24-Sep-2012 09:46  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE46S870XS-M..> 01-Oct-2012 15:05  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE50EH5300W-..> 24-Sep-2012 09:57  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE55C8700-UE..> 07-Oct-2012 10:10  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE55ES6300-Z..> 24-Sep-2012 09:50  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE55ES6560S-..> 24-Sep-2012 09:43  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE55ES8000-Z..> 02-Oct-2012 15:35  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-UE75ES9000S-..> 01-Oct-2012 11:05  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-VC-UBL916-Ma..> 01-Oct-2012 15:35  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-VC331LLDC6S-..> 01-Oct-2012 15:17  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-VC331LLMA6S-..> 10-Oct-2012 06:43  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Video-tutori..> 07-Apr-2013 10:32  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-WEP480-CN-Ma..> 24-Sep-2012 17:03  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-3-noir-..> 17-Sep-2012 11:27  4.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-533-noi..> 17-Sep-2012 11:23  4.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-575-bla..> 24-Jul-2012 11:44  4.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-578-noi..> 17-Sep-2012 11:19  4.2M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-723-gri..> 24-Jul-2012 14:45  7.0M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-M-noir-..> 17-Sep-2012 11:14  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-M-noir-..> 28-Jul-2012 10:51  5.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Wave-noir-Op..> 17-Sep-2012 11:09  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-XE700T1A-HF1..> 17-Sep-2012 16:57  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-ZS31FASAB1S-..> 01-Oct-2012 15:14  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-Zephyr-AQV09..> 19-Oct-2012 14:59  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 19-Apr-2013 19:11  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 19-Apr-2013 18:55  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-electromenag..> 29-Nov-2012 08:21  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-lcd_business..> 10-Oct-2012 06:45  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Samsung-pascal_owner..> 10-Oct-2012 06:45  1.6M  

[TXT]

 SamsungGalaxyNoteGT-..> 30-Apr-2012 11:47  1.9M  

[TXT]

 SamsungGalaxySGT-I90..> 30-Apr-2012 11:26  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Serie-3-300E7A-NP300..> 23-Jul-2012 18:56  3.9M  

[TXT]

 T23A550T23A550.htm      23-Jul-2012 19:31  2.8M  

[TXT]

 UE40D6500ZFUE40D6500..> 30-Apr-2012 17:32  2.5M  

[TXT]

 UE55ES8000-ZF-Slim-L..> 23-Jul-2012 18:46  3.8M  

[TXT]

 UE55ES8000-ZF-Slim-L..> 24-Jul-2012 16:35  6.6M  

[TXT]

 UE60ES6100WXZF-UE60E..> 24-Jul-2012 16:43  7.3M  

[TXT]

 UE65C8700-UE65C8700X..> 24-Jul-2012 16:40  7.3M  

[TXT]

 Video-Samsung-Galaxy..> 28-Jul-2012 10:29  7.3M  

[TXT]

 Wave575GT-S5750E.htm    01-May-2012 10:05  3.2M  

[TXT]

 WaveIIGT-S8530.htm      01-May-2012 10:11  3.6M  

[TXT]

 samsung-Wave-II-noir..> 17-Sep-2012 11:06  3.3M

Samsung - Aspirateur robot Navibot SR8845

Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86G0 gris foncé/fuchsia

Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac SC4780 noir

Samsung - Four micro-ondes MW73B - blanc

SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 36 L - Micro ondes 36 L - CP1395ES

SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 42 L - Micro ondes 42 L - CQ1570U

Samsung - Micro-ondes combiné CE117PT-B

SAMSUNG - Micro-ondes Grill simultané GS89F-1SP

Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED

Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste

Samsung Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86H0 gris clair/bleu

Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD

Samsung B5722 Double SIM

Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles

Samsung Batterie ED-BP1310

Samsung batterie IA-BH130LB

Samsung batterie IA-BP420E

Samsung batterie IA-BP85ST

Samsung batterie SLB-10A

Samsung batterie SSB-690 ELS

Samsung BD-E5300

Samsung BD-E5500 3D

Samsung BD-E8300 3D

Samsung C3050 Stratus

Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1"

Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung

Samsung Caméra additionnelle de vidéosurveillance SEB-1015RWP EX

Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100

Samsung CB20A12

Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir

Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB

Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir

Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB

Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLP-325 WiFi

Samsung CLP-325 WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0

Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet

Samsung CLP-C300A

Samsung CLP-K300A

Samsung CLP-M300A

Samsung CLP-Y300A

Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir

Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi

Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0

Samsung CLX-3185N Ethernet

Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet

Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet

Samsung Coque silicone Croisillons pour nexus S

Samsung CY-SMN1000D meuble TV

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128D 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series

Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series

Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX

Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0

Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel

Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose

Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi

Samsung DV300F Noir - WiFi

Samsung E1150 - Silver

Samsung E2550

Samsung EcoBlue SC61E0 bleu azur

Samsung ES30 Noir

Samsung ES30 Noir + Carte SD 2 Go

Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir

Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir

Samsung Etui flap en cuir pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - Noir

Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S

Samsung Flash SEF15A

Samsung Flash SEF20A

Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Androïd)

Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android)

Samsung Galaxy Note

Samsung Galaxy Note - Blanc

Samsung Galaxy Note - Rose

Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc

Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir

Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet

Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi

Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir 16 Go 3G

Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi

Samsung Galaxy Xcover s5690 (sous Androïd) - Smartphone Samsung Solide certifié IP67

Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Androïd)

Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Androïd)

Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir

Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1"

Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9"

Samsung HT-D330

Samsung HT-D350

Samsung HT-D423

Samsung HT-D4500

Samsung HT-D5000 3D

Samsung HT-E4200 3D

Samsung HT-E4500 3D

Samsung HT-E5200 3D

Samsung HT-ES6200 3D WiFi

Samsung HW-E450

Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android)

Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1"

Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX

Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220

Samsung Kit Etui + Clavier Bluetooth pour Galaxy Tab 10,1" - Brun foncé

Samsung kit HDMI

Samsung kit HDMI

Samsung kit papier 10 x 15 cm

Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm

Samsung LE40D550

Samsung Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Galaxy S2 - Transparente/Miroir

Samsung Lot de 2 Protections d'écran pour i9000 Galaxy S

Samsung Lunettes 3D SSG-3050GB

SAMSUNG ME106V-SX

Samsung ME82V Micro-onde monofonction

SAMSUNG ME82V-SX

SAMSUNG Micro ondes MW87Y

SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE117APT B

SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE137NEMX

SAMSUNG Micro-ondes FW113T002

Samsung ML-1630/SCX4500

Samsung ML-2010D3

Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome

Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi

Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome

Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi

Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet

Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome

Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi

Samsung MLT-D1052S

Samsung MLT-D1082S

Samsung MLT-D1092S

Samsung MM-D430D

Samsung MV800 Noir

Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir

Samsung NP300E7A-S03FR 17,3" LED

Samsung NP700Z5A-S02FR 15,6" LED

Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides

Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS + Flash SEF-8A NG8

Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8

Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200

Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100

Samsung Pack étui cuir + chargeur + protection d'écran pour Galaxy S

Samsung PL170 Noir

Samsung PL210 Noir

Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go

Samsung PL90 Noir et Rouge

Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal

Samsung Player Mini C3300 - Noir

Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante

Samsung PS43D450

Samsung PS43E450

Samsung PS43E490 3D

Samsung PS51E450

Samsung PS51E490 3D

Samsung PS59D530

Samsung Q3 rose 4 Go

Samsung RC530-S03FR 15,6" LED

Samsung RC730-S06FR 17,3" LED

Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes

Samsung S22A300B 21,5" TFT

Samsung S22B350H 21,5" LED

Samsung S23A750D 23" LED 3D

Samsung S23B350H 23" LED

Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED

Samsung S27B350H 27" LED

Samsung SC4340 noir ébène

Samsung SC4790 - Aspirateur sans sac - traineau - rouge

Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions

Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions

Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet

Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi

Samsung SCX-4200A

Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet

Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi

Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet

Samsung SE-084D graveur DVD externe slim USB 2.0

Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0

Samsung SLB07A pour ST50

Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000

Samsung ST65 Noir

Samsung ST65 Rouge

Samsung station d'accueil

Samsung station d'accueil HD2

Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 10,1"

Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9"

Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR

Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED

Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED

Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D

Samsung SyncMaster S24A350H 24" LED

Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD

Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX

Samsung T22A350 21,5" LED Tuner TNT

Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir

Samsung UE19D4010 LED

Samsung UE19ES4000 LED

Samsung UE22ES5000 LED

Samsung UE22ES5410 LED

Samsung UE26EH4000 LED

Samsung UE26EH4500 LED

Samsung UE32D5000 LED

Samsung UE32EH4000 LED

Samsung UE32EH5000 LED

Samsung UE32ES5500 LED

Samsung UE32ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc

Samsung UE40D5000 LED

Samsung UE40D5710 LED

Samsung UE40D6500 LED 3D

Samsung UE40EH5000 LED

Samsung UE40ES5500 LED

Samsung UE40ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung UE40ES6710 LED 3D

Samsung UE46EH5000 LED

Samsung UE46ES5500 LED

Samsung UE46ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc

Samsung UE55ES6300 LED 3D

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise

Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0 + Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0 + CaseLogic Sacoche double pour ordinateurs 14" & tablettes 10,1" - Grise

Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0 + Samsonite Sac pour ordinateur portable 14,1" S Noir

Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10

Samsung WB150F Blanc - WiFi

Samsung WB150F Noir - WiFi

Samsung WB700 Noir

Samsung WB750 Noir

Samsung WIS09ABGN LinkStick WLAN-Adapter

Samsung WMN250M accroche murale

Samsung YP-F3 bleu 2 Go

Samsung YP-F3 noir 2 Go

Samsung YP-F3 rose 2 Go

Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go

Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose

Samsung YP-U6 noir 2 Go

Samsung YP-U6 noir 4 Go

Samsung YP-U6 rose 2 Go

Samsung YP-U6 rose 4 Go

Samsung YP-Z3 blanc 4 Go

Samsung YP-Z3 bleu 4 Go

Samsung YP-Z3 rose 4 Go

Samsung Universal Print Driver Uživatelská příručka představte si ty možnostiCopyright_ 2 Copyright © 2009 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Všechna práva vyhrazena. Tato příručka správce je poskytována pouze pro informativní účely. Veškeré v ní obsažené informace se mohou změnit bez předchozího upozornění. Společnost Samsung Electronics nenese odpovědnost za žádné škody, přímé či nepřímé, vyplývající z použití této uživatelské příručky, nebo s ní související. • Samsung Universal Print Driver je ochranná známka společnosti Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. • Samsung a logo Samsung jsou ochranné známky společnosti Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. • Microsoft, Windows, Internet Explorer a Windows Vista jsou registrované ochranné známky nebo ochranné známky společnosti Microsoft Corporation a USA a dalších zemích. • Veškeré ostatní názvy značek, produktů a společností uvedené v tomto dokumentu mohou být ochranné známky příslušných vlastníků. REV. 1.01Obsah_ 3 Obsah COPYRIGHT/2 OBSAH/3 ÚVOD Samsung Universal Print Driver versus ovladače pro konkrétní modely . . . . . 4 Požadavky na systém . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 INSTALACE A ODINSTALOVÁNÍ SAMSUNG UNIVERSAL PRINT DRIVER Instalace Samsung Universal Print Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Odinstalování Samsung Universal Print Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 POUŽÍVÁNÍ SAMSUNG UNIVERSAL PRINT DRIVER Přístup k Samsung Universal Print Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Přehled rozvržení . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Změna nastavení Samsung Universal Print Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Nastavení místního okna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Nastavení možnosti hledání tiskárny . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Vyhledávání tiskových zařízení . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Hledat nyní . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Hledat podle adresy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Vytvoření složky oblíbených tiskáren . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Nápověda . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Tisk s Samsung Universal Print Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Základní funkce tisku . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Změna vybrané tiskárny . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 LICENSE INFORMATION JPEG License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 zlib/png License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 OpenSSL License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Boost Software License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 BSD License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Infozip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Intel Mobile Platform SDK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 PNG:The Definitive Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Open BSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Common Public License Version 1.0 (CPL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 REJSTŘÍK/19Úvod_ 4 1.Úvod Samsung Universal Print Driver je ovladač, který lze používat s různými modely tiskáren. To umožňuje uživateli okamžitý přístup nejen k tiskovým zařízením Samsung, ale také k řadě zařízení na bázi PDL jiných výrobců bez nutnosti stahovat samostatné ovladače. • PDL znamená PCL i PS. • Společnost Samsung nezaručuje kvalitu tiskových zařízení jiných výrobců a modelů Samsung, které nejsou podporovány (klepnutím na zobrazíte seznam podporovaných zařízení Samsung). Pro nepodporované modely Samsung je ovladač automaticky nastaven na použitelné výchozí PDL. Samsung Universal Print Driver versus ovladače pro konkrétní modely V následující tabulce jsou uvedeny rozdíly mezi Samsung Universal Print Driver a ovladači pro konkrétní produkty: Požadavky na systém Minimální požadavky na systém pro Samsung Universal Print Driver jsou následující: SAMSUNG UNIVERSAL PRINT DRIVER OVLADAČE PRO KONKRÉTNÍ MODELY Uživatelské rozhraní Konzistentní uživatelské rozhraní. Nekonzistentní uživatelské rozhraní. Instalace • Stažení a instalace pomocí instalačního souboru dodaného s Samsung Universal Print Driver. • Instalace spuštěním instalačního souboru. • Ruční vyhledání, stažení a instalace ovladače pro každé zařízení. • Instalace prostřednictvím automaticky spouštěného disku CD nebo Průvodce pro přidáním tiskárny. Vyhledání zařízení Snadné vyhledávání a přístup k dostupným zařízením ze všech tiskových zařízení Samsung. Ruční vyhledávání zařízení. Dostupnost K dispozici na webovém serveru Samsung. K dispozici na disku CD dodaném se zařízením nebo ovladač pro konkrétní produkt. OPERAČNÍ SYSTÉM POŽADAVKY (DOPORUČENO) PROCESOR RAM VOLNÉ MÍSTO NA PEVNÉM DISKU Windows Vista Pentium IV 3 GHz 512 MB (1 GB) 15 GB Windows XP Pentium III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (256 MB) 1,5 GB nebo větší Windows 2000 Pentium II 400 MHz (Pentium III 933 MHz) 64 MB (128 MB) 600 MB Windows 7 32bitový nebo 64bitový procesor Pentium IV 1 GHz nebo vyšší 1 GB (2 GB) 16 GB • Podpora grafického rozhraní DirectX 9 s pamětí 128 MB (k aktivaci motivu Aero) • Mechanika DVD-R/W Windows Server 2003 Pentium III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (512 MB) 1,25 GB až 2 GB Windows Server 2008 Pentium IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz) 512 MB (2 GB) 10 GB Windows Server 2008 (R2) Procesory Pentium IV 1 GHz (x86) nebo 1,4 GHz (x64) (2 GHz nebo rychlejší) 512 MB (2 GB) 10 GBInstalace a odinstalování Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 5 2.Instalace a odinstalování Samsung Universal Print Driver Tato kapitola obsahuje podrobné pokyny pro instalaci a odinstalování Samsung Universal Print Driver. Následující okna jsou pro ovladač PCL v operačním systému Windows XP. Pro ovladač PS se operační systém Windows může lišit, ale postup je stejný. Instalace Samsung Universal Print Driver Před instalací ovladače zkontrolujte doporučené minimální požadavky pro váš systém (viz „Požadavky na systém“ na straně 4). 1. Spusťte webový prohlížeč a přejděte na www.samsung.com. 2. Vyhledejte instalační soubor Samsung Universal Print Driver. 3. Spusťte instalační soubor. Otevře se Průvodce instalací Samsung Universal Print Driver. 4. Klepněte na Další. V případě potřeby vyberte z rozevíracího seznamu příslušný jazyk. Po zobrazení instalačního okna počkejte na dokončení instalace. 5. Po zobrazení okna Instalace dokončena klepněte na Dokončit. Chcete-li se zaregistrovat jako uživatel zařízení Samsung, abyste mohli získat informace od společnosti Samsung, zaškrtněte příslušné políčko a klepněte na tlačítko Dokončit. Pokud je ovladač nainstalován správně, můžete najít Samsung Universal Print Driver ve složce Tiskárny a faxy.Instalace a odinstalování Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 6 Odinstalování Samsung Universal Print Driver Chcete-li odinstalovat Samsung Universal Print Driver, postupujte podle následujících kroků: 1. V nabídce Start systému Windows vyberte > Všechny programy > Samsung Universal Print Driver > Údržba. Otevře se Průvodce instalací Samsung Universal Print Driver. 2. Vyberte možnost Odebrat a klepněte na Další. 3. Vyberte součásti, které chcete odebrat a klepněte na Další. 4. Po zobrazení okna s výzvou k potvrzení klepněte na Ano. 5. Po dokončení odinstalování klepněte na Dokončit. Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 7 3.Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver Hlavním účelem Samsung Universal Print Driver je nainstalovat jeden ovladač (Samsung Universal Print Driver) a používat jej s různými tiskovými zařízeními. Samsung Universal Print Driver má ovšem další funkce, jako například vyhledávání tiskových zařízení, vytvoření složky s oblíbenými položkami a zjišťování stavu zařízení. Přístup k Samsung Universal Print Driver 1. V nabídce Start systému Windows vyberte Tiskárny a faxy. 2. Klepněte pravým tlačítkem myši na Samsung Universal Print Driver. 3. Klepněte na Předvolby tisku nebo Vlastnosti. Otevře se okno Samsung Universal Print Driver. Není-li k dispozici žádná naposledy použitá tiskárna, zobrazí se místní okno s žádostí o vyhledání tiskáren. Klepnutím na OK budou vyhledány připojené tiskárny. Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 8 Přehled rozvržení 1 Panel Rozvržení Obsahuje možnosti zobrazení. • : Slouží k výběru rozvržení okna Samsung Universal Print Driver. Zvolíte-li Rozvržení2 a nainstalovali jste program Samsung Smart Panel, zobrazí se stavové okno (číslo 4). • : Aktualizuje všechny informace o tiskárně v seznamu. • : Slouží k výběru typu zobrazení seznamu tiskáren. Zobrazení detailů ukazuje informace o tiskárně, například Adresa, Umístění, Stav a Systémový název. Zobrazení obrazu rovněž ukazuje informace o tiskárně, ovšem s větším obrázkem tiskárny. Tato možnost je podporována pouze v operačním systému Windows XP (a novějším). • : Zobrazuje seznam tiskáren ve skupinách. Chcete-li uspořádat tiskárny do skupin, stiskněte toto tlačítko. Tato možnost je podporována pouze v operačním systému Windows XP (a novějším). • : Slouží k vyhledání tiskárny v seznamu podle klíčového slova, například názvu modelu. • : Otevře okno s nápovědou. • : Ukazuje informace o Samsung Universal Print Driver.Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 9 Změna nastavení Samsung Universal Print Driver Nastavení místního okna Můžete nastavit, aby se při tisku zobrazovalo okno Samsung Universal Print Driver. Existují čtyři možnosti zobrazení tohoto okna: 1. Klepněte na tlačítko Nastavení v levém dolním rohu. 2 Hlavní nabídky • Poslední - Naposledy používané tiskárny: Ukazuje seznam naposledy používaných tiskáren. Tiskárna použitá jako zcela poslední se nachází na začátku seznamu. - Naposledy vyhledávané tiskárny: Ukazuje seznam naposledy nalezených tiskáren. Tiskárna nalezená jako zcela poslední se nachází na začátku seznamu. • Hledat - Hledat nyní: Vyhledá tiskárny, které jsou připojeny prostřednictvím rozhraní USB nebo sítě. - Hledat podle adresy: Vyhledá tiskárnu podle adresy IP tiskárny. • Moje tiskárna - Vytvořit složku Oblíbené: Vytvoří složku pro oblíbené tiskárny. • Nastavení: Zobrazí možnosti pro místní okna a vyhledávání. 3 Seznam tiskáren Zobrazí seznam tiskáren. Po stisknutí tlačítka na panelu rozvržení můžete tiskárny uspořádat do skupin. Klepněte pravým tlačítkem do oblasti seznamu tiskáren. Vyberte možnost uspořádání do skupin. • Online/neznámý: Vytvoří skupinu v závislosti na aktuálních stavech zařízení. • Datum: Vytvoří skupinu v závislosti na posledním datu použití tiskárny, například dnes, včera, tento týden, tento měsíc atd. • Barevně/černobíle: Vytvoří skupinu v závislosti na typu zařízení: barevná nebo černobílá tiskárna. • Oboustranně/jednostranně: Vytvoří skupinu v závislosti na tom, zda zařízení podporuje funkci oboustranného tisku nebo ne. 4 Stavové okno Ukazuje stav vybrané tiskárny v seznamu. Aby se toto okno zobrazilo, je třeba vybrat Rozvržení2 a nainstalovat program Samsung Smart Panel. • Aktualizovat nyní: Zaktualizuje informace o vybrané tiskárně. • Koupit spotřební materiál: Otevře webový server pro nákup spotřebního materiálu. • Průvodce řešením problémů: Otevře kapitolu věnovanou řešení problémů v uživatelské příručce. Aby se průvodce řešením problémů zobrazil, je třeba nainstalovat program Smart Panel modelu, který používáte. • Nastavení tiskárny: Otevře službu SyncThru Web Service, která nabízí možnosti pro konfigurování a správu vaší tiskárny. Tuto možnost lze používat pouze se síťovými tiskárnami. Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 10 2. Viz možnosti Vyvolat níže: • Pouze když není dostupná poslední použitá tiskárna: Okno Samsung Universal Print Driver se zobrazí pouze, pokud tiskárna, která byla naposledy použitá, není k dispozici. • Když se objeví ovladač UI: Okno Samsung Universal Print Driver se zobrazí, když otevřete okno Předvolby tisku (Vlastnosti). • Při každém tisku: Okno Samsung Universal Print Driver se zobrazí při každém tisku. • Pouze při prvním tisku: Okno Samsung Universal Print Driver se zobrazí pouze poprvé, když je Samsung Universal Print Driver vybrán jako tiskárna v některé aplikaci. 3. Klepněte na OK. Nastavení možnosti hledání tiskárny Chcete-li nastavit možnosti hledání pro Samsung Universal Print Driver, postupujte podle následujících kroků: 1. Klepněte na tlačítko Nastavení v levém dolním rohu. Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 11 2. Viz Možnosti hledání níže: • Hledání tiskáren Samsung: Vyhledá pouze připojené tiskárny Samsung. Klepnutím na zobrazíte seznam podporovaných zařízení Samsung. • Hledání všech tiskáren: Vyhledá všechny připojené tiskárny. 3. Klepněte na OK. Vyhledávání tiskových zařízení Hledat nyní Neznáte-li adresu TCP/IP tiskového zařízení, které chcete použít, můžete pro vyhledání zařízení použít možnost Hledat nyní. Postupujte podle následujících kroků: 1. V nabídce Start systému Windows vyberte Tiskárny a faxy. 2. Klepněte pravým tlačítkem myši na Samsung Universal Print Driver. 3. Klepněte na Předvolby tisku nebo Vlastnosti. Otevře se okno Samsung Universal Print Driver. 4. Klepněte na Hledat nyní. Samsung Universal Print Driver vyhledá připojená tisková zařízení. Výsledek hledání se může lišit v závislosti na vybrané možnosti hledání (viz „Nastavení možnosti hledání tiskárny“ na straně 10.) Hledat podle adresy Znáte-li adresu TCP/IP tiskového zařízení, které chcete použít, můžete zařízení vyhledat zadáním adresy TCP/IP. Zařízení můžete také hledat v rozmezí IP adres zadáním počáteční a koncové IP adresy. Postupujte podle následujících kroků: 1. V nabídce Start systému Windows vyberte Tiskárny a faxy. 2. Klepněte pravým tlačítkem myši na Samsung Universal Print Driver. 3. Klepněte na Předvolby tisku nebo Vlastnosti. Otevře se okno Samsung Universal Print Driver. 4. Klepněte na Hledat podle adresy. Zobrazí se okno. 5. Zadejte příslušnou IP adresu, podle které chcete hledat, nebo zadejte počáteční a koncovou adresu pro hledání v rozmezí IP adres. 6. Klepněte na Hledat.Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 12 Vytvoření složky oblíbených tiskáren Pro usnadnění můžete vytvořit složku s nejčastěji používanými tiskárnami. Například jestliže cestujete mezi domovem a zaměstnáním, můžete si vytvořit dvě rozdílné složky s tiskárnami; Doma a Práce a spravovat tiskárny podle potřeby. Při vytváření složky oblíbených tiskáren postupujte podle následujících kroků: 1. Klepněte na Vytvořit složku oblíbených. Zobrazí se okno Přidat novou složku oblíbených. 2. Zadejte název složky a nastavte atributy. • Nepoužívat chytré složky: Přidá obecnou složku. Chcete-li přidat tiskárny do některé složky v části Moje tiskárna, můžete přetáhnout tiskárnu ze seznamu do složky nebo klepněte pravým tlačítkem myši na tiskárnu v seznamu a vyberte Přesunout nebo Kopírovat. • Používat chytré složky: Přidá speciální složku, která bude dynamicky zobrazovat tiskárny podporující následující funkce: - Barevný tisku - Pouze černobílý tisk - Oboustranný tisk - Online: Zahrne zařízení v online stavu. Složka využívající inteligentní filtr vyhledává zařízení automaticky, takže uživatelé nemohou ručně přidávat/ odstraňovat tiskárny do/ze složky. 3. Klepněte na OK. Do části Moje tiskárna bude přidána nová složka. Používání Samsung Universal Print Driver_ 13 Nápověda Klepněte na tlačítko Nápověda ( ) v pravém horním rohu okna Samsung Universal Print Driver. Zobrazí se okno nápovědy. V této nápovědě najdete odpovědi na vaše otázky o používání Samsung Universal Print Driver. Tisk s Samsung Universal Print Driver Základní funkce tisku Chcete-li vytisknout dokument pomocí Samsung Universal Print Driver, postupujte podle následujících kroků: Následující kroky ukazují tisk z programu Poznámkový blok. Názvy nabídky se mohou lišit v závislosti na používané aplikaci. 1. Otevřete soubor, který chcete vytisknout, v některé aplikaci. 2. Na panelu nabídek vyberte Soubor > Tisk. 3. V seznamu tiskáren vyberte Samsung Universal Print Driver. 4. Klepněte na OK. Bude zahájen tisk. Nebo se v závislosti na vybrané možnosti místního okna (viz „Nastavení místního okna“ na straně 9) může před tiskem zobrazit okno Samsung Universal Print Driver. Zvolte tiskárnu, kterou chcete použít a tiskněte. Změna vybrané tiskárny 1. V nabídce Start systému Windows vyberte Tiskárny a faxy. 2. Klepněte pravým tlačítkem myši na Samsung Universal Print Driver. 3. Klepněte na Předvolby tisku nebo Vlastnosti. Otevře se okno Předvolby tisku (Vlastnosti). 4. Vyberte jinou tiskárnu se seznamu tiskáren nebo vyhledáním (viz „Vyhledávání tiskových zařízení“ na straně 11). 5. Klepněte na OK. Veškerý následující tisk bude směrován na novou tiskárnu.License Information_ 14 4.License Information JPEG License This software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group. zlib/png License This product uses software program which is distributed under the zlib/png license. OpenSSL License This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/). Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 1. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following dis-claimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. 2. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: 3. "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http:// www.openssl.org/)" 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior written permission. For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org. 5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written permission of the OpenSSL Project. 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). Boost Software License This product uses software program which is distributed under the BSL license. Boost Software License 1.0 (BSL1.0) Tue, 2008-02-05 16:36 ? nelson Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person or organization obtaining a copy of the software and accompanying documentation covered by this license (the "Software") to use, reproduce, display, distribute, execute, and transmit the Software, and to prepare derivative works of the Software, and to permit third-parties to whom the Software is furnished to do so, all subject to the following: The copyright notices in the Software and this entire statement, including the above license grant, this restriction and the following disclaimer, must be included in all copies of the Software, in whole or in part, and all derivative works of the Software, unless such copies or derivative works are solely in the form of machine-executable object code generated by a source language processor. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHERDEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.License Information_ 15 BSD License This product uses software programs which are distributed under the BSD license. BSD license SW : PNG:The Definitive Guide, Intel Mobile Platform SDK, Info-zip. Infozip This is version 2007-Mar-4 of the Info-ZIP license. The definitive version of this document should be available at ftp:// ftp.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/license.html indefinitely and a copy at http://www.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/license.html. Copyright (c) 1990-2007 Info-ZIP. All rights reserved. For the purposes of this copyright and license, "Info-ZIP" is defined as the following set of individuals: Mark Adler, John Bush, Karl Davis, Harald Denker, Jean-Michel Dubois, Jean-loup Gailly, Hunter Goatley, Ed Gordon, Ian Gorman, Chris Herborth, Dirk Haase, Greg Hartwig, Robert Heath, Jonathan Hudson, Paul Kienitz, David Kirschbaum, Johnny Lee, Onno van der Linden, Igor Mandrichenko, Steve P. Miller, Sergio Monesi, Keith Owens, George Petrov, Greg Roelofs, Kai Uwe Rommel, Steve Salisbury, Dave Smith, Steven M. Schweda, Christian Spieler, Cosmin Truta, Antoine Verheijen, Paul von Behren, Rich Wales, Mike White. This software is provided "as is," without warranty of any kind, express or implied. In no event shall Info-ZIP or its contributors be held liable for any direct, indirect, incidental, special or consequential damages arising out of the use of or inability to use this software. Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the above disclaimer and the following restrictions: • Redistributions of source code (in whole or in part) must retain the above copyright notice, definition, disclaimer, and this list of conditions. • Redistributions in binary form (compiled executables and libraries) must reproduce the above copyright notice, definition, disclaimer, and this list of conditions in documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. The sole exception to this condition is redistribution of a standard UnZipSFX binary (including SFXWiz) as part of a self-extracting archive; that is permitted without inclusion of this license, as long as the normal SFX banner has not been removed from the binary or disabled. • Altered versions--including, but not limited to, ports to new operating systems, existing ports with new graphical interfaces, versions with modified or added functionality, and dynamic, shared, or static library versions not from Info-ZIP--must be plainly marked as such and must not be misrepresented as being the original source or, if binaries, compiled from the original source. Such altered versions also must not be misrepresented as being Info-ZIP releases--including, but not limited to, labeling of the altered versions with the names "Info-ZIP" (or any variation thereof, including, but not limited to, different capitalizations), "Pocket UnZip," "WiZ" or "MacZip" without the explicit permission of Info-ZIP. Such altered versions are further prohibited from misrepresentative use of the Zip-Bugs or Info-ZIP e-mail addresses or the Info-ZIP URL(s), such as to imply Info-ZIP will provide support for the altered versions. • Info-ZIP retains the right to use the names "Info-ZIP," "Zip," "UnZip," "UnZipSFX," "WiZ," "Pocket UnZip," "Pocket Zip," and "MacZip" for its own source and binary releases. Intel Mobile Platform SDK Copyright (c) <2008>, Intel Corp. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: • Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. • Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. • Neither the name of Intel Corporation nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. PNG:The Definitive Guide Copyright (c) 1998-2001 Greg Roelofs. All rights reserved. This software is provided "as is," without warranty of any kind, express or implied. In no event shall the author or contributors be held liable for any damages arising in any way from the use of this software. Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the following restrictions: • Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, disclaimer, and this list of conditions. • Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, disclaimer, and this list of conditions in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. • All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: This product includes software developed by Greg Roelofs and contributors for the book, "PNG: The Definitive Guide," published by O'Reilly and Associates.License Information_ 16 Open BSD Copyright (c) 2004 by Internet Systems Consortium, Inc. ("ISC") Copyright (c) 1996,1999 by Internet Software Consortium. Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND ISC DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL ISC BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. Common Public License Version 1.0 (CPL) This product uses software program which is distributed under the CPL license. The following CPL software source codes that have been used in this product can be provided after asking to oss.request@samsung.com. CPL software : WTL(Windows Templete Library) THE ACCOMPANYING PROGRAM IS PROVIDED UNDER THE TERMS OF THIS COMMON PUBLIC LICENSE ("AGREEMENT"). ANY USE, REPRODUCTION OR DISTRIBUTION OF THE PROGRAM CONSTITUTES RECIPIENT'S ACCEPTANCE OF THIS AGREEMENT. 1. DEFINITIONS "Contribution" means: a. in the case of the initial Contributor, the initial code and documentation distributed under this Agreement, and b. in the case of each subsequent Contributor: • changes to the Program, and • additions to the Program; where such changes and/or additions to the Program originate from and are distributed by that particular Contributor. A Contribution 'originates' from a Contributor if it was added to the Program by such Contributor itself or anyone acting on such Contributor's behalf. Contributions do not include additions to the Program which: (i) are separate modules of software distributed in conjunction with the Program under their own license agreement, and (ii) are not derivative works of the Program. "Contributor" means any person or entity that distributes the Program. "Licensed Patents " mean patent claims licensable by a Contributor which are necessarily infringed by the use or sale of its Contribution alone or when combined with the Program. "Program" means the Contributions distributed in accordance with this Agreement. "Recipient" means anyone who receives the Program under this Agreement, including all Contributors. 2. GRANT OF RIGHTS a. Subject to the terms of this Agreement, each Contributor hereby grants Recipient a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free copyright license to reproduce, prepare derivative works of, publicly display, publicly perform, distribute and sublicense the Contribution of such Contributor, if any, and such derivative works, in source code and object code form. b. Subject to the terms of this Agreement, each Contributor hereby grants Recipient a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license under Licensed Patents to make, use, sell, offer to sell, import and otherwise transfer the Contribution of such Contributor, if any, in source code and object code form. This patent license shall apply to the combination of the Contribution and the Program if, at the time the Contribution is added by the Contributor, such addition of the Contribution causes such combination to be covered by the Licensed Patents. The patent license shall not apply to any other combinations which include the Contribution. No hardware per se is licensed hereunder. c. Recipient understands that although each Contributor grants the licenses to its Contributions set forth herein, no assurances are provided by any Contributor that the Program does not infringe the patent or other intellectual property rights of any other entity. Each Contributor disclaims any liability to Recipient for claims brought by any other entity based on infringement of intellectual property rights or otherwise. As a condition to exercising the rights and licenses granted hereunder, each Recipient hereby assumes sole responsibility to secure any other intellectual property rights needed, if any. For example, if a third party patent license is required to allow Recipient to distribute the Program, it is Recipient's responsibility to acquire that license before distributing the Program. d. Each Contributor represents that to its knowledge it has sufficient copyright rights in its Contribution, if any, to grant the copyright license set forth in this Agreement. 3. REQUIREMENTS A Contributor may choose to distribute the Program in object code form under its own license agreement, provided that: a. it complies with the terms and conditions of this Agreement; and b. its license agreement: • effectively disclaims on behalf of all Contributors all warranties and conditions, express and implied, including warranties or conditions of title and non-infringement, and implied warranties or conditions of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose; • effectively excludes on behalf of all Contributors all liability for damages, including direct, indirect, special, incidental and consequential damages, such as lost profits;License Information_ 17 • states that any provisions which differ from this Agreement are offered by that Contributor alone and not by any other party; and • states that source code for the Program is available from such Contributor, and informs licensees how to obtain it in a reasonable manner on or through a medium customarily used for software exchange. When the Program is made available in source code form: a. it must be made available under this Agreement; and b. ia copy of this Agreement must be included with each copy of the Program. Contributors may not remove or alter any copyright notices contained within the Program. Each Contributor must identify itself as the originator of its Contribution, if any, in a manner that reasonably allows subsequent Recipients to identify the originator of the Contribution. 4. COMMERCIAL DISTRIBUTION Commercial distributors of software may accept certain responsibilities with respect to end users, business partners and the like. While this license is intended to facilitate the commercial use of the Program, the Contributor who includes the Program in a commercial product offering should do so in a manner which does not create potential liability for other Contributors. Therefore, if a Contributor includes the Program in a commercial product offering, such Contributor ("Commercial Contributor") hereby agrees to defend and indemnify every other Contributor ("Indemnified Contributor") against any losses, damages and costs (collectively "Losses") arising from claims, lawsuits and other legal actions brought by a third party against the Indemnified Contributor to the extent caused by the acts or omissions of such Commercial Contributor in connection with its distribution of the Program in a commercial product offering. The obligations in this section do not apply to any claims or Losses relating to any actual or alleged intellectual property infringement. In order to qualify, an Indemnified Contributor must: a) promptly notify the Commercial Contributor in writing of such claim, and b) allow the Commercial Contributor to control, and cooperate with the Commercial Contributor in, the defense and any related settlement negotiations. The Indemnified Contributor may participate in any such claim at its own expense. For example, a Contributor might include the Program in a commercial product offering, Product X. That Contributor is then a Commercial Contributor. If that Commercial Contributor then makes performance claims, or offers warranties related to Product X, those performance claims and warranties are such Commercial Contributor's responsibility alone. Under this section, the Commercial Contributor would have to defend claims against the other Contributors related to those performance claims and warranties, and if a court requires any other Contributor to pay any damages as a result, the Commercial Contributor must pay those damages. 5. NO WARRANTY EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY SET FORTH IN THIS AGREEMENT, THE PROGRAM IS PROVIDED ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Each Recipient is solely responsible for determining the appropriateness of using and distributing the Program and assumes all risks associated with its exercise of rights under this Agreement, including but not limited to the risks and costs of program errors, compliance with applicable laws, damage to or loss of data, programs or equipment, and unavailability or interruption of operations. 6. DISCLAIMER OF LIABILITY EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY SET FORTH IN THIS AGREEMENT, NEITHER RECIPIENT NOR ANY CONTRIBUTORS SHALL HAVE ANY LIABILITY FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION LOST PROFITS), HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OR DISTRIBUTION OF THE PROGRAM OR THE EXERCISE OF ANY RIGHTS GRANTED HEREUNDER, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. 7. GENERAL If any provision of this Agreement is invalid or unenforceable under applicable law, it shall not affect the validity or enforceability of the remainder of the terms of this Agreement, and without further action by the parties hereto, such provision shall be reformed to the minimum extent necessary to make such provision valid and enforceable. If Recipient institutes patent litigation against a Contributor with respect to a patent applicable to software (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit), then any patent licenses granted by that Contributor to such Recipient under this Agreement shall terminate as of the date such litigation is filed. In addition, if Recipient institutes patent litigation against any entity (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that the Program itself (excluding combinations of the Program with other software or hardware) infringes such Recipient's patent(s), then such Recipient's rights granted under Section 2(b) shall terminate as of the date such litigation is filed. All Recipient's rights under this Agreement shall terminate if it fails to comply with any of the material terms or conditions of this Agreement and does not cure such failure in a reasonable period of time after becoming aware of such noncompliance. If all Recipient's rights under this Agreement terminate, Recipient agrees to cease use and distribution of the Program as soon as reasonably practicable. However, Recipient's obligations under this Agreement and any licenses granted by Recipient relating to the Program shall continue and survive. Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute copies of this Agreement, but in order to avoid inconsistency the Agreement is copyrighted and may only be modified in the following manner. The Agreement Steward reserves the right to publish new versions (including revisions) of this Agreement from time to time. No one other than the Agreement Steward has the right to modify this Agreement. IBM is the initial Agreement Steward. IBM may assign the responsibility to serve as the Agreement Steward to a suitable separate entity. Each new version of the Agreement will be given a distinguishing version number. The Program (including Contributions) may always be distributed subject to the version of the Agreement under which it was received. In addition, after a new version of the Agreement is published, Contributor may elect to distribute the Program (including its Contributions) under the new version. Except as expressly stated in Sections 2(a) and 2(b) above, Recipient receives no rights or licenses to the intellectual property of any Contributor under this Agreement, whether expressly, License Information_ 18 by implication, estoppel or otherwise. All rights in the Program not expressly granted under this Agreement are reserved. This Agreement is governed by the laws of the State of New York and the intellectual property laws of the United States of America. No party to this Agreement will bring a legal action under this Agreement more than one year after the cause of action arose. Each party waives its rights to a jury trial in any resulting litigation.Rejstřík_ 19 Rejstřík C copyright 2 H hledat TCPIP 11 tlačítko hledat nyní 11 tlačítko hledat podle adresy 11 I instalace 5 N nastavení 9 místní okno 9 možnost hledání 10 O odinstalace 6 open source information 14 P používání 7 požadavky na systém 4 přístup 7 R rozdíl 4 rozvržení 8 S Search by address 11 Search Now 11 složka 12 T tisk 13 Ú úvod 4 Pour plus d’informations sur votre produit, veuillez vous référer au mode d’emploi complet de votre appareil sur le site www.samsung.com. GT-I9100 Guide de prise en main rapide2 Nous vous remercions de la confiance que vous nous accordez en achetant cet appareil mobile Samsung. Cet appareil vous permettra de communiquer et d’accéder à des divertissements de haute qualité, basés sur les critères de qualité et la technologie de Samsung. • Le contenu de ce mode d’emploi peut différer en fonction du produit ou de la version logicielle fournie par votre opérateur et peut faire l’objet de modifications sans préavis. • Les options et les accessoires fournis avec cet appareil peuvent varier selon votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur. • Vous pouvez acquérir d’autres accessoires auprès de votre revendeur Samsung. • Les accessoires fournis sont spécialement conçus pour votre appareil. • Il est possible que certains accessoires, autres que ceux fournis, ne soient pas compatibles avec votre appareil. Icônes Avant de démarrer, familiarisez-vous avec les icônes utilisées dans ce mode d’emploi : Avertissement—situations susceptibles de vous blesser ou de blesser d'autres personnes Attention —situations susceptibles d'endommager votre appareil ou d'autres appareils3 Remarque—remarques, conseils d'utilisation ou informations complémentaires [ ] Crochets—touches de l'appareil Droits d’auteur Copyright © 2011 Samsung Electronics Ce mode d’emploi est protégé par les lois internationales relatives aux droits d’auteur. Il est interdit de reproduire, distribuer, traduire ou transmettre sous quelque forme et par quelque moyen que ce soit, électronique ou mécanique, notamment par photocopie, enregistrement ou stockage dans un système de stockage et de recherche documentaire, tout ou partie de ce document sans le consentement préalable écrit de Samsung Electronics. Marques déposées • SAMSUNG et le logo SAMSUNG sont des marques déposées de Samsung Electronics. • Les logos Android, Google Search ™, Google Maps ™, Google Mail ™, YouTube ™, Android Market ™ et Google Talk ™ sont des marques déposées de Google, Inc. • Bluetooth® est une marque déposée de Bluetooth SIG, Inc. dans le monde entier.4 • Oracle et Java sont des marques déposées de Oracle et/ ou de ses filiales. Les autres marques sont déposées et demeurent la propriété de leurs détenteurs respectifs. • Wi-Fi ®, le logo Wi-Fi CERTIFIED et le logo Wi-Fi sont des marques déposées de Wi-Fi Alliance. Votre appareil utilise une fréquence non harmonisée. Il est conçu pour fonctionner dans tous les pays européens. Au sein de l’Union Européenne, le réseau Wi-Fi peut fonctionner sans restriction en intérieur, mais pas en extérieur en France. • Toutes les autres marques et droits d’auteur appartiennent à leurs propriétaires respectifs.5 Assemblage Installer la carte SIM ou USIM et la batterie 1. Si le téléphone est allumé, maintenez la touche Marche/ Arrêt enfoncée, puis appuyez sur Éteindre → OK pour l’éteindre. 2. Retirez le cache de la batterie. Veillez à ne pas abîmer vos ongles en retirant le cache de la batterie. 3. Insérez la carte SIM ou USIM, puce orientée vers le bas.6 4. Insérez la batterie. 5. Remettez le cache de la batterie en place. Mettre la batterie en charge Vous devez charger la batterie avant d’utiliser l’appareil pour la première fois. Utilisez uniquement des chargeurs et des câbles homologués par Samsung. L'utilisation de chargeurs ou de câbles non homologués peut provoquer l'explosion de la batterie ou endommager votre appareil. Si la batterie est complètement déchargée, il est impossible d’allumer l'appareil, même si le chargeur est branché. Laissez une batterie épuisée se recharger pendant quelques minutes avant d’essayer d’allumer l'appareil.7 1. Branchez la fiche micro-USB du chargeur sur le connecteur à fonctions multiples de l'appareil. Un branchement incorrect du chargeur peut sérieusement endommager l'appareil. Les dommages résultant d'une mauvaise utilisation ne sont pas couverts par la garantie. 2. Branchez l’autre extrêmité du chargeur sur une prise de courant. Lorsque l’appareil est en cours de chargement, il est possible que l’écran tactile ne fonctionne pas en raison de l’instabilité de l’alimentation électrique. Dans ce cas, débranchez le chargeur de l’appareil. 3. Lorsque la batterie est entièrement chargée, débranchez le chargeur de l’appareil, puis de la prise de courant. Ne retirez jamais la batterie avant d'avoir débranché le chargeur. Ceci pourrait endommager l'appareil. Pour économiser l’énergie, débranchez le chargeur lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas. Le chargeur n’étant pas muni d’un bouton marche/arrêt, vous devez le débrancher de la prise de courant pour couper l’alimentation. Lorsqu’il est utilisé, le chargeur doit rester à proximité de la prise.8 Démarrage Allumer/éteindre l’appareil Pour allumer le téléphone, maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée. Si vous allumez votre appareil pour la première fois, suivez les instructions qui s’affichent à l’écran pour procéder à la configuration. Pour éteindre le téléphone, maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée, puis appuyez sur Éteindre → OK. • Respectez toutes les consignes et directives formulées par le personnel compétent dans les lieux où l'utilisation d'appareils mobiles est interdite, notamment dans les avions et les hôpitaux. • Pour utiliser uniquement les services hors-réseau de votre appareil, c’est-à-dire les fonctions autres que GSM et Bluetooth, activez le mode Hors-ligne.9 Présentation de l’appareil 1. Actif uniquement lorsque vous utilisez la fonction haut-parleur ou lorsque vous enregistrez des vidéos. Capteur de proximité Capteur de luminosité Objectif photo avant Touche de volume Touche Accueil Écouteur Écran tactile Touche Retour Microphone Connecteur à fonctions multiples Prise audio 3,5 mm Touche Marche/ Arrêt/ Verrouillage Antenne interne Objectif photo arrière Cache de la batterie Haut-parleur Flash Microphone1 Touche Menu10 Touches Touche Fonction Marche/Arrêt/ Verrouillage Allumer l'appareil (maintenir enfoncée). Accéder aux menus rapides (maintenir enfoncée) et verrouiller l'écran tactile. Menu Afficher à l'écran la liste des options disponibles. Ouvrir la liste des options disponibles dans l’écran actuel, ouvrir la barre de recherche rapide (maintenir enfoncée). Accueil Revenir à l'écran d'accueil. Ouvrir la liste des applications récentes (maintenir enfoncée). Retour Revenir à l'écran précédent. Volume Régler le volume de l'appareil. Écran tactile L’écran tactile de votre appareil vous permet de sélectionner des éléments et des fonctions en toute facilité. Vous pouvez exercer une simple pression, une pression prolongée, ou faire glisser votre doigt sur l’écran.11 Écran d’accueil Lorsque l’appareil est en mode veille, l’écran d’accueil apparaît. A partir de l’écran d’accueil, vous pouvez voir apparaître des icônes d’information et accéder aux widgets ou aux applications. L’écran d’accueil comprend plusieurs volets. Faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite pour atteindre l’un des volets de l’écran d’accueil. Vous pouvez également appuyer sur un point en bas de l’écran pour accéder directement à l’écran d’accueil correspondant. Icônes d’information Les icônes d’information indiquent la force du signal, l’état de l’appareil et d’autres informations dans la partie supérieure de l’écran. Widgets Les widgets sont de petites applications qui permettent d’accéder à des fonctions et des informations pratiques sur votre écran d’accueil. Ajoutez un widget à l’écran d’accueil ou supprimez-le en le faisant glisser dans la corbeille. Volet des raccourcis Depuis l’écran d’accueil ou lorsque vous utilisez une application, appuyez sur la zone des icônes d’information et faites glisser votre doigt vers le bas pour ouvrir le volet des raccourcis. Vous pouvez ainsi accéder aux informations de réseau et à la liste des notifications (messages reçus, appels manqués, événements etc.). Pour masquer la liste, refermez le volet des raccourcis en faisant glisser votre doigt de bas en haut.12 Accéder aux applications 1. Depuis l’écran d’accueil, appuyez sur Applications pour accéder au mode Menu. 2. Faites défiler l’écran vers la gauche ou la droite pour atteindre un écran de menu. Vous pouvez également appuyer sur un point en bas de l’écran pour accéder directement à l’écran de menu correspondant. 3. Sélectionnez une application. 4. Appuyez sur [ ] pour revenir à l’écran précédent. Appuyez sur la touche Accueil pour revenir à l’écran d’accueil. Accéder aux applications récentes Maintenez la touche Accueil enfoncée pour afficher les applications que vous avez récemment utilisées. Lancer plusieurs applications simultanément Votre appareil est multitâche et permet l’exécution simultanée de plusieurs applications. Pour lancer plusieurs applications simultanément, appuyez sur la touche Accueil en cours d’utilisation d’une application pour revenir au menu principal et sélectionnez une application à lancer en parallèle.13 Saisir du texte Vous pouvez saisir du texte en utilisant les caractères du clavier virtuel ou en utilisant l’écriture manuscrite. Vous pouvez également exploiter la fonction copier-coller pour utiliser le même texte dans d’autres applications. Clavier Swype Avec le clavier Swype, vous pouvez saisir du texte en faisant glisser votre doigt sur les caractères. Appuyez sur le premier caractère d’un mot, faites glisser votre doigt vers les autres caractères du mot en maintenant votre doigt appuyé sur l’écran et relâchez votre doigt après le dernier caractère. Clavier Samsung Le clavier Samsung permet d’utiliser des types de clavier différents (notamment les claviers AZERTY et 3x4), ainsi qu’un mode de saisie manuscrite. Lorsque vous saisissez du texte avec un clavier AZERTY ou 3x4, utilisez la fonction de saisie de texte intuitive. Cette fonction permet d'anticiper le mot que vous allez saisir et affiche des suggestions. Lorsque vous saisissez du texte, faites pivoter l'appareil vers la gauche pour afficher le clavier AZERTY en mode paysage. Appeler un correspondant ou répondre à un appel Vous pouvez passer un appel en saisissant un numéro de téléphone dans l’écran de numérotation ou en le sélectionnant dans la liste de contacts. Vous pouvez également consulter le journal d’appels pour recomposer les numéros récents.14 Passer un appel Ouvrez l’écran de numérotation, saisissez un numéro de téléphone et appuyez sur . Pour passer un appel visio, appuyez sur . Répondre à un appel Lorsque vous recevez un appel, faites glisser vers la droite. Envoyer et recevoir un message Vous pouvez créer et envoyer des messages texte (SMS), multimédia (MMS) ou des e-mails, et afficher ou gérer les messages envoyés ou reçus. L'envoi ou la réception de messages en dehors des zones couvertes par votre opérateur peut occasionner des frais supplémentaires. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. SMS et MMS Vous pouvez créer et envoyer un message texte simple ou un message multimédia qui peut contenir du texte, des images, des vidéos et des fichiers son. E-mail Vous pouvez utiliser l’application de messagerie électronique sur votre appareil pour envoyer des e-mails. Avant d’envoyer ou de recevoir des e-mails, vous devez créer un compte.15 Se connecter à Internet Vous pouvez utiliser une connexion sans fil via la fonction Wi-Fi ou les connexions de données. Ouvrez l’application Web et consultez des pages Web. Vous pouvez enregistrer vos pages préférées dans les favoris ou utiliser différentes options. L'accès au Web et le téléchargement de contenu multimédia peuvent entraîner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l'offre que vous avez souscrite auprès de votre opérateur. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur.16 Consignes de sécurité Afin d'éviter de blesser votre entourage ou vous-même, ou bien d'endommager votre téléphone, veuillez lire toutes les informations suivantes avant d'utiliser votre téléphone. Avertissement : Évitez les chocs électriques, le feu et les explosions N'utilisez pas de prises et de cordons d'alimentation endommagé(e)s ou de prises électriques mal fixées Ne touchez pas le cordon d'alimentation lorsque vos mains sont mouillées et ne tirez pas sur le chargeur pour le débrancher Ne tordez pas ou n'endommagez pas le cordon d'alimentation N'utilisez et ne touchez pas votre téléphone avec les mains mouillées lorsque celui-ci est en cours de chargement Ne provoquez pas de court-circuit avec le chargeur ou la batterie Ne laissez pas tomber le chargeur ou la batterie et ne les exposez pas aux chocs Ne rechargez pas la batterie en utilisant un chargeur non homologué par Samsung N'utilisez pas votre téléphone pendant un orage Le téléphone peut mal fonctionner et les risques de choc électrique peuvent augmenter. Ne manipulez pas la batterie Lithium Ion (Li-Ion) lorsque celle-ci coule ou est endommagée Contactez le centre de traitement agréé le plus proche de chez vous afin de vous séparer de vos batteries Li-Ion en toute sécurité. Manipulez et jetez les batteries et les chargeurs avec précaution • N'utilisez que les batteries et les chargeurs homologués par Samsung et spécialement conçus pour votre téléphone. L'utilisation de batteries et de chargeurs incompatibles peut provoquer des blessures graves ou endommager votre téléphone. • Ne jetez jamais une batterie ou un téléphone au feu. Respectez la réglementation en vigueur dans votre pays concernant l'élimination des batteries et des téléphone usagé(e)s.17 • Ne posez jamais une batterie ou un téléphone à l'intérieur ou au-dessus d'appareils chauffants, tels que des fours à micro-ondes, des cuisinières ou des radiateurs. En cas de surchauffe, la batterie peut exploser. • N'écrasez ou ne perforez jamais la batterie. Évitez d'exposer la batterie à une pression externe élevée qui risquerait d'entraîner un court-circuit interne et une surchauffe. Protégez le téléphone, la batterie et le chargeur contre toute détérioration • Évitez d'exposer votre téléphone et la batterie à des températures très basses ou très élevées. • Des températures extrêmes peuvent déformer le téléphone et réduire la capacité de chargement, ainsi que sa durée de vie et celle de la batterie. • Évitez tout contact de la batterie avec des objets métalliques, car cela risquerait de provoquer un court-circuit entre les bornes + et – de la batterie et de l'endommager de manière temporaire ou permanente. • N'utilisez jamais une batterie ou un chargeur endommagé(e). Attention : Respectez tous les avertissements de sécurité et les réglementations en vigueur lorsque vous utilisez votre téléphone dans un endroit où son utilisation est réglementée Éteignez votre téléphone lorsque son utilisation est interdite Respectez toutes les réglementations interdisant l'utilisation des téléphones mobiles dans certaines zones spécifiques. N'utilisez pas votre téléphone à proximité d'autres appareils électroniques La plupart des appareils électroniques utilisent des signaux de radiofréquence radiofréquence. Il est possible que votre téléphone cause des interférences avec d'autres appareils électroniques. N'utilisez pas votre téléphone à proximité d'un stimulateur cardiaque • Maintenez une distance minimale de 15 cm entre votre téléphone et le stimulateur cardiaque pour éviter toute interférence. • Il est fortement conseillé, lors d'un appel, de positionner le téléphone sur le côté opposé à l'implant. • Si vous pensez que votre téléphone vient perturber le fonctionnement d'un stimulateur cardiaque ou d'un appareil médical, éteignez-le immédiatement et contactez le fabricant du stimulateur ou de l'appareil médical.18 N'utilisez pas votre téléphone dans un hôpital ou à proximité d'équipements médicaux en raison des interférences qu'il pourrait produire Si vous utilisez vous-même des équipements médicaux, contactez votre fabriquant afin d'éviter toute interférence de radiofréquence. Si vous utilisez un appareil auditif, contactez votre fabriquant afin d'obtenir plus d'informations sur les interférences Il est possible que certains appareils auditifs subissent des interférences causées par la radiofréquence de votre téléphone. Afin de vous assurer d'une utilisation de votre appareil auditif en toute sécurité, contactez votre fabriquant. Éteignez le téléphone dans les lieux présentant des risques d'explosion • Éteignez le téléphone dans les lieux présentant des risques d'explosion. • Respectez toujours les consignes, les instructions et la signalétique d'utilisation dans un environnement explosif. • N'utilisez pas votre téléphone dans une station-service, dans les zones potentiellement explosives ou à proximité de produits combustibles ou chimiques. • Ne transportez et ne stockez jamais de liquides inflammables, de gaz ou de matériaux explosifs dans le même habitacle que le téléphone, ses composants ou ses accessoires. Éteignez votre téléphone lorsque vous voyagez en avion Les téléphones portables peuvent engendrer des interférences avec les équipements aéronautiques. Conformez-vous aux réglementations en vigueur et éteignez votre téléphone. Il est possible que les appareils électroniques se trouvant à bord d'un véhicule motorisé subissent des dysfonctionnements provoqués par la radiofréquence de votre propre téléphone Respectez toutes les consignes de sécurité et réglementations relatives à l'utilisation de votre téléphone lorsque vous vous trouvez au volant d'un véhicule Votre responsabilité principale est avant tout de conduire votre véhicule sans prendre de risques. N'utilisez jamais votre téléphone au volant, si cela est interdit par la loi. Pour votre sécurité et celle des autres, faites preuve de bon sens et gardez à l'esprit les conseils suivants : • Utilisez un kit mains-libres. • Apprenez à connaître les fonctions pratiques de votre téléphone, comme par exemple la numérotation rapide et la fonction de rappel automatique. Ces fonctions vous permettent de gagner du temps et de rester concentré lorsque vous passez ou recevez des appels sur votre téléphone.19 • Gardez votre téléphone à portée de main. Soyez en mesure d'atteindre votre téléphone mobile sans quitter la route des yeux. Si vous recevez un appel entrant à un moment inopportun, laissez votre messagerie vocale répondre à votre place. • Informez votre interlocuteur que vous êtes au volant. Interrompez tout appel en cas d'embouteillages ou de conditions météorologiques dangereuses. La pluie, la neige, le verglas et une circulation dense sont des facteurs dangereux. • Ne prenez pas de notes ou ne recherchez pas de numéros de téléphone. Noter une liste de tâches à effectuer ou parcourir votre répertoire détourne votre attention de votre responsabilité principale qui consiste à conduire sans prendre de risques. • Composez des numéros de manière raisonnable et évaluez l'état de la circulation. Passez vos appels lorsque vous êtes immobile ou avant de vous insérer dans la circulation. Essayez de passer vos appels de préférence lorsque votre véhicule est stationné. Si vous devez absolument passer un appel, composez les chiffres un à un, regardez la route et dans vos rétroviseurs, puis reprenez la numérotation. • Ne poursuivez pas de conversations stressantes ou émotionnelles qui pourraient vous distraire. Informez vos interlocuteurs que vous êtes au volant et interrompez toute conversation susceptible d'altérer votre attention sur la route. • Utilisez votre téléphone pour demander de l'aide. En cas d'incendie, d'accident de la route ou d'urgence médicale, composez le numéro d'urgence local. • Utilisez votre téléphone pour aider d'autres personnes en situation d'urgence. Si vous êtes témoin d'un accident, d'une agression ou de toute autre situation d'urgence mettant des vies en jeu, contactez les services d'urgence locaux. • Appelez un service d'assistance dépannage ou un service spécial d'assistance, si cela s'avère nécessaire. Si vous croisez un véhicule endommagé ne présentant pas de danger immédiat, si vous constatez un feu rouge cassé, un accident de la route sans gravité où personne ne semble blessé ou encore un véhicule que vous savez volé, appelez un service d'assistance dépannage ou un service spécial d'assistance autre que les services d'urgence. Pour entretenir et bien utiliser votre téléphone Conservez votre téléphone au sec • L'humidité et tous types de liquides peuvent endommager les pièces ou les circuits électroniques de votre téléphone. • En cas de contact avec un liquide, retirez la batterie sans allumer votre téléphone. Séchez votre téléphone avec un chiffon et confiez-le à un service de réparation. • Les liquides modifient la couleur de l'étiquette indiquant que l'intérieur du téléphone a été endommagé. L'eau peut endommager votre téléphone et entraîner l'annulation de la garantie du fabricant.20 N'utilisez pas ou ne rangez pas votre téléphone dans des endroits poussiéreux ou sales La poussière peut causer des dysfonctionnements de votre téléphone. Ne posez pas votre téléphone sur des surfaces inclinées Si votre téléphone tombe, il peut être endommagé. Ne conservez pas votre téléphone dans des endroits chauds ou froids. Utilisez votre téléphone à des températures comprises entre -20° C et 50° C • Votre téléphone peut exploser si vous le laissez dans un véhicule fermé, la température intérieure pouvant monter jusqu'à 80° C. • N'exposez pas votre téléphone à la lumière directe du soleil de manière prolongée (comme par exemple sur le tableau de bord d'une voiture). • Conservez la batterie à des températures allant de 0° C à 40° C. Ne conservez pas votre téléphone à proximité d'objets métalliques, comme par exemple des pièces, des clés ou des colliers • Votre téléphone pourrait être déformé ou subir des dysfonctionnements. • Les bornes de la batterie peuvent causer des incendies si elles sont mises en contact avec des objets métalliques. Ne conservez pas votre téléphone à proximité de champs magnétiques • Lorsqu'il est exposé à des champs magnétiques, votre téléphone peut subir des dysfonctionnements ou la batterie peut se décharger. • Les cartes à piste, comme par exemple les cartes de crédit, les cartes de téléphone et les cartes d'embarquement peuvent être endommagées par des champs magnétiques. • N'utilisez pas de housses ou d'accessoires équipés de fermetures aimantées et évitez toute exposition prolongée de votre téléphone à des champs magnétiques. Ne conservez pas votre téléphone à proximité ou à l'intérieur de radiateurs, de fours à micro-ondes, d'équipements de cuisine chauffants ou de conteneurs à haute pression • La batterie peut couler. • Votre téléphone peut surchauffer et causer un incendie. Ne laissez pas tomber votre téléphone et ne l'exposez pas aux chocs • L'écran de votre téléphone pourrait être endommagé. • Votre téléphone peut être endommagé ou certaines pièces peuvent subir des dysfonctionnements si vous le tordez ou le déformez.21 N'utilisez pas le flash de l'appareil photo trop près des yeux de personnes ou d'animaux Utiliser un flash à proximité des yeux peut causer des lésions oculaires ou une perte temporaire de la vue. Préservez la durée de vie de la batterie et du chargeur • Ne laissez pas la batterie en charge pendant plus d'une semaine, car une surcharge risque de réduire sa durée de vie. • Lorsqu'elle n'est pas utilisée pendant une période prolongée, une batterie pleine se décharge progressivement et doit être rechargée avant utilisation. • Lorsque le chargeur n'est pas utilisé, ne le laissez pas branché à une prise de courant. • Utilisez la batterie pour votre téléphone uniquement. N'utilisez que des batteries, chargeurs, accessoires et fournitures homologué(e)s par Samsung • Utiliser des batteries ou des chargeurs génériques peut réduire la durée de vie de votre téléphone ou provoquer des dysfonctionnements. • Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable de la sécurité de l'utilisateur si celui-ci utilise des accessoires ou des éléments non homologués par Samsung. Ne mordez et ne portez pas à votre bouche le téléphone ou la batterie • Mordre ou porter le téléphone ou la batterie à votre bouche pourrait endommager votre téléphone ou provoquer une explosion. • Assurez-vous que les enfants manipulent le téléphone de façon appropriée s'ils doivent l'utiliser. Pour parler dans le téléphone : • Tenez le téléphone droit, comme vous le feriez avec un téléphone traditionnel. • Parlez directement dans le microphone. • Évitez tout contact avec l'antenne interne de votre téléphone. Toucher l'antenne peut réduire la qualité d'écoute ou provoquer une émission de radiofréquence plus élevée que nécessaire. • Lorsque vous utilisez votre téléphone, tenez-le de manière détendue, appuyez légèrement sur les touches, utilisez les fonctions spéciales de saisie (telles que les modèles et la saisie intuitive) pour réduire le nombre de touches à manipuler et faites des pauses régulières. Restez prudent lorsque vous utilisez votre téléphone en marchant ou en bougeant Restez toujours conscient de votre environnement afin d'éviter de vous blesser ou de blesser d'autres personnes.22 Ne placez pas votre téléphone dans vos poches arrières ou à votre ceinture Vous pouvez être blessé ou endommager votre téléphone si vous tombez. Ne démontez pas, ne modifiez pas ou ne réparez pas vous-même votre téléphone • Toute modification ou tout changement effectué(e) sur votre téléphone peut entraîner l'annulation de la garantie du fabricant. Pour tout besoin de service, confiez votre téléphone à un service après-vente Samsung. • Ne démontez pas ou ne perforez pas la batterie, car ceci peut causer une explosion ou un incendie. Ne peignez jamais votre téléphone et n'y apposez jamais d'autocollants La peinture et les autocollants risquent de bloquer les pièces mobiles du téléphone et perturber son fonctionnement. Si vous êtes allergique à la peinture ou aux pièces métalliques du téléphone, vous pouvez souffrir de démangeaisons, d'eczéma ou de boursouflures de la peau. Si ces symptômes apparaissent, cessez immédiatement d'utiliser le téléphone et consultez un médecin. Lors du nettoyage de votre téléphone : • Essuyez votre téléphone ou le chargeur avec un chiffon ou une gomme. • Nettoyez les bornes de la batterie avec un morceau de coton ou un chiffon. • N'utilisez pas de produits chimiques ou de détergents. N'utilisez pas le téléphone si son écran est fissuré ou cassé Le verre ou l’acrylique brisé risque de vous blesser à la main ou au visage. Confiez votre téléphone à un service après-vente Samsung afin de le faire réparer. Utilisez votre téléphone uniquement pour vous servir des fonctions auxquelles il est destiné Évitez de déranger votre entourage lorsque vous utilisez votre téléphone dans un lieu public Ne laissez pas les enfants utiliser votre téléphone Votre téléphone n'est pas un jouet. Ne laissez pas les enfants jouer avec le téléphone, car ils pourraient se blesser ou blesser d'autre personnes, endommager le téléphone ou passer des appels susceptibles d'augmenter vos frais de communication. Installez le téléphone et ses accessoires avec précaution • Veillez à la bonne fixation de votre téléphone mobile et de ses accessoires dans votre véhicule. • Évitez de placer votre téléphone ou ses accessoires à proximité de la zone d'ouverture des airbags. Si l'équipement mobile n'est pas installé correctement, le déclenchement de l'airbag risque de provoquer des blessures graves.23 Toute réparation doit être réalisée par un technicien agréé Le recours aux services d'un technicien non agréé risque d'entraîner des dégâts sur le téléphone et d'annuler la garantie du fabricant. Manipulez les cartes SIM et les cartes mémoire avec soin • Ne retirez pas une carte lorsque le téléphone y enregistre ou y lit des informations, car vous risqueriez de perdre des données et/ou d'endommager la carte ou le téléphone lui-même. • Protégez les cartes contre les chocs violents, les décharges électrostatiques et les interférences émises par d'autres appareils. • Ne touchez pas les contacts dorés de la carte avec vos doigts ou avec des objets métalliques. Si la carte est sale, nettoyez-la avec un chiffon doux. Assurez l'accès aux services d'urgence Dans certaines zones ou dans certaines circonstances, il peut être impossible de joindre les numéros d'urgence avec votre téléphone. Avant de vous rendre dans des régions isolées ou non couvertes, prévoyez un autre moyen pour contacter les services d'urgence. Veillez à sauvegarder les données importantes Samsung ne sera en aucun cas tenu responsable en cas de perte de données. Ne transmettez pas d'éléments protégés par des droits d'auteur Ne transmettez pas d'éléments protégés par des droits d’auteur que vous avez enregistrés sans la permission des détenteurs de ces droits. Dans le cas contraire, vous seriez en infraction avec la législation sur les droits d’auteur. Le fabricant n’est en aucun cas responsable de l'utilisation frauduleuse des éléments protégés par les droits d’auteur.24 Informations sur la certification DAS Votre téléphone a été conçu pour ne pas dépasser les limites d'exposition aux radiofréquences (RF) émises recommandées par le Conseil de l'Union européenne. Ces normes empêchent la vente d'appareils mobiles qui dépassent le niveau d'exposition maximal (également connu sous le nom de DAS ou Débit d'absorption spécifique) de 2 W/kg. Lors des tests, la valeur DAS maximum enregistrée pour ce modèle était de 0,338 W/kg. En condition normale d'utilisation, la valeur DAS réelle sera généralement beaucoup plus faible, car le téléphone n'émet que l'énergie RF nécessaire à la transmission du signal vers la station de base la plus proche. Le téléphone minimise ainsi votre exposition globale à l'énergie RF en émettant automatiquement à des niveaux plus faibles dès que cela est possible. Par ailleurs, il est également recommandé d'utiliser autant que possible le kit piéton. Cependant, on veillera dans ce cas à éloigner le téléphone du ventre des femmes enceintes et du bas ventre des enfants et des adolescents. Les informations scientifiques actuelles n’indiquent en rien que l’utilisation des téléphones portables exige de prendre de quelconques précautions. Cependant, si certains s’inquiètent des risques potentiels liés à une durée d’utilisation excessive du téléphone, nous leur conseillons d’utiliser le kit piéton afin de tenir le téléphone portable éloigné de la tête et du corps. La Déclaration de conformité figurant au dos de ce mode d'emploi prouve que votre téléphone est conforme à la directive européenne relative aux équipements terminaux de télécommunications et aux équipements radio. Pour plus d'informations sur le DAS et les normes européennes correspondantes, veuillez consulter le site Web de Samsung mobile. Les bons gestes de mise au rebut de ce produit (Déchets d'équipements électriques et électroniques) (Applicable dans les pays de l'Union Européenne et dans d'autres pays européens pratiquant le tri sélectif) Ce symbole sur le produit, ses accessoires ou sa documentation indique que ni le produit, ni ses accessoires électroniques usagés (chargeur, casque audio, câble USB, etc.) ne peuvent être jetés avec les autres déchets ménagers. La mise au rebut incontrôlée des déchets présentant des risques environnementaux et de santé publique, veuillez séparer vos produits et accessoires usagés des autres déchets. Vous favoriserez ainsi le recyclage de la matière qui les compose dans le cadre d'un développement durable. Les particuliers sont invités à contacter le magasin leur ayant vendu le produit ou à se renseigner auprès des autorités locales pour connaître les procédures et les points de collecte de ces produits en vue de leur recyclage. Les entreprises et professionnels sont invités à contacter leurs fournisseurs et à consulter les conditions de leur contrat de vente. Ce produit et ses accessoires ne peuvent être jetés avec les autres déchets professionnels et commerciaux.25 Élimination de la batterie de ce produit (Applicable aux pays de l'Union européenne et aux autres pays européens dans lesquels des systèmes de collecte sélective sont mis en place) Le symbole sur la batterie, le manuel ou l'emballage indique que la batterie de ce produit ne doit pas être éliminée en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. L'indication éventuelle des symboles chimiques Hg, Cd ou Pb signifie que la batterie contient des quantités de mercure, de cadmium ou de plomb supérieures aux niveaux de référence stipulés dans la directive CE 2006/66. Si la batterie n'est pas correctement éliminée, ces substances peuvent porter préjudice à la santé humaine ou à l'environnement. Afin de protéger les ressources naturelles et d'encourager la réutilisation du matériel, veillez à séparer la batterie des autres types de déchets et à la recycler via votre système local de collecte gratuite des piles et batteries. Limitation de responsabilité Les contenus et les services accessibles par l’intermédiaire de ce téléphone appartiennent dans leur intégralité à des tiers et sont protégés par les lois sur les droits d’auteur, les brevets, les marques et/ou d’autres lois sur la propriété intellectuelle. Ces contenus et services sont fournis uniquement pour votre usage personnel et non pour une utilisation commerciale. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser ces contenus ou services d’une manière qui n’a pas été autorisée par le propriétaire des contenus ou le fournisseur des services. Sans que cela ne limite ce qui précède, sauf autorisation expresse du propriétaire de contenus ou du fournisseur de services concerné, il vous est interdit de modifier, de copier, de republier, de transférer, de diffuser, de transmettre, de traduire, de vendre, d’exploiter ou de distribuer, d’une quelconque manière et sur quelque support que ce soit, des contenus ou des services affichés par l’intermédiaire de ce téléphone, ou d’en créer des dérivés. LES CONTENUS ET SERVICES DE TIERS SONT FOURNIS " EN L'ÉTAT ". DANS TOUTE LA MESURE PERMISE PAR LA LOI LOCALE, SAMSUNG NE GARANTIT PAS LES CONTENUS OU LES SERVICES AINSI FOURNIS, EXPRESSÉMENT OU IMPLICITEMENT, À QUELQUE FIN QUE CE SOIT. SAMSUNG EXCLUT EXPRESSÉMENT TOUTE GARANTIE IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS, SANS QUE CELA SOIT LIMITATIF, LES GARANTIES DE QUALITÉ MARCHANDE ET D'ADÉQUATION À UN USAGE PARTICULIER. SAMSUNG NE GARANTIT PAS L'EXACTITUDE, LA VALIDITÉ, L'ACTUALITÉ, LA LÉGALITÉ OU L'EXHAUSTIVITÉ DES CONTENUS OU DES SERVICES FOURNIS PAR L'INTERMÉDIAIRE DE CET APPAREIL, ET SAMSUNG NE SERA RESPONSABLE EN AUCUN CAS, Y COMPRIS EN CAS DE NÉGLIGENCE, QUE CE SOIT AU TITRE DE LA RESPONSABILITÉ CONTRACTUELLE OU DÉLICTUELLE, DES DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCESSOIRES, SPÉCIAUX OU CONSÉCUTIFS, DES HONORAIRES D'AVOCAT, DES FRAIS OU DE TOUT AUTRE DOMMAGE DÉCOULANT DE L'UTILISATION DE TOUT CONTENU OU SERVICE PAR VOUS-MÊME OU PAR UN TIERS (OU DE TOUTE INFORMATION FIGURANT DANS LEDIT CONTENU OU SERVICE), MÊME SI SAMSUNG A ÉTÉ INFORMÉ DE L'ÉVENTUALITÉ DE TELS DOMMAGES. DANS LA MESURE OÙ CERTAINS PAYS N'AUTORISENT PAS L'EXCLUSION DES GARANTIES IMPLICITES OU LA LIMITATION DES DROITS LÉGAUX DU CONSOMMATEUR, IL 26 EST POSSIBLE QUE CES EXCLUSIONS ET LIMITATIONS NE VOUS SOIENT PAS APPLICABLES. Les services tiers peuvent être suspendus ou interrompus à tout moment, et Samsung ne garantit pas qu'un contenu ou un service restera disponible pendant une certaine période. Les contenus et les services sont transmis par des tiers au moyen de réseaux et d'équipements de transmission qui échappent au contrôle de Samsung. Sans que cela ne limite le caractère général du présent avis, Samsung décline expressément toute responsabilité en cas d'interruption ou de suspension de tout contenu ou service fourni par l'intermédiaire de cet appareil. Samsung n'est pas responsable du service client lié aux contenus et aux services. Toute question ou demande de service portant sur les contenus ou les services doit être adressée directement aux fournisseurs de contenus et de services concernés.Déclaration de conformité (R&TTE) Nous, Samsung Electronics déclarons sous notre seule responsabilité que le produit Téléphone mobile : GT-I9100 en relation avec cette déclaration est en conformité avec les normes suivantes et/ou d’autres documents normatifs. Sécurité EN 60950-1 : 2006 +A11:2009 DAS EN 50360 : 2001 / AC 2006 EN 62209-1 : 2006 CEM EN 301 489-01 V1.8.1 (04-2008) EN 301 489-07 V1.3.1 (11-2005) EN 301 489-17 V2.1.1 (05-2009) EN 301 489-24 V1.4.1 (09-2007) Radio EN 301 511 V9.0.2 (03-2003) EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (10-2006) EN 301 908-1 V4.2.1 (03-2010) EN 301 908-2 V4.2.1 (03-2010) EN 300 440-1 V1.5.1 (03-2009) EN 300 440-2 V1.3.1 (03-2009) EN 301 893 V1.5.1 (12-2008) Ce produit a été testé et s’est avéré conforme aux normes relatives à l’émission de fréquences radio. En outre, nous déclarons que cet appareil satisfait à toutes les conditions essentielles de la directive 1999/5/CE. La procédure de déclaration de conformité, définie dans l’article 10, puis reprise à l’alinéa [IV] de la directive 1999/5/EC a été conduite sous contrôle de l’organisme suivant : BABT, Forsyth House, Churchfield Road, Walton-on-Thames, Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK* Numéro d’identification : 0168 Documentation technique détenue par : Samsung Electronics QA Lab. disponible sur simple demande. (Représentant pour l’union européenne) Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab. Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way, Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK* 2011.05.23 Joong-Hoon Choi / Lab Manager (lieu et date de parution) (nom et signature du responsable dûment habilité) * Il ne s’agit pas de l’adresse du service après-vente de Samsung. Pour obtenir l’adresse ou le numéro de téléphone du service après-vente de Samsung,reportez-vous au certificat de garantie ou contactez le revendeur auprès duquel vous avez acheté ce produit.Printed in Korea GH68-34545D www.samsung.com French. 10/2011. Rev. 1.1 Pour installer Samsung Kies 1. Téléchargez la dernière version de Kies sur le site web de Samsung (www.samsung.com) et installez le logiciel sur votre PC. 2. Utilisez un câble de connexion PC pour connecter votre appareil. Samsung Kies démarre automatiquement. Référez-vous à l’aide Kies pour plus d’informations. Le contenu de ce mode d’emploi peut ne pas correspondre fidèlement à votre téléphone en fonction de votre version logicielle ou de votre opérateur. Protégez votre acuité auditive • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé peut endommager votre audition. • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé lorsque vous êtes au volant peut détourner votre attention et provoquer un accident. • Diminuez toujours le volume avant de connecter des écouteurs à une source audio et réglez le volume minimum nécessaire vous permettant d'entendre votre conversation ou la musique. Getting Started 1 www.samsungcomputer.com Using Using the Slate PC the Slate PCBefore Reading This Guide Getting Started 2 Before Reading This Guide • This guide describes the general functions provided with Samsung Slate PC. Some functions and devices may not be provided or the version may differ depending on the product. Please note that the descriptions in this guide may not matchyour computer’s environment exactly. • The images onthe cover andthemaincontent ofthisguide are images ofrepresentative Samsung Slate PCmodels and maydifferfromyour actualproduct. Copyright ©2011 SamsungElectronicsCo., Ltd. Thisguide istheproperty of SamsungElectronicsCo., Ltd. andisprotectedby copyright. No informationcontainedhereinmaybedistributedor copied inany formwhatsoeverwithoutthepriorwrittenconsent of SamsungElectronicsCo., Ltd. Informationinthisguide issubjectto changedue to functional enhancements oftheproduct andotherreasonswithoutprior notice.Getting Started 2 Overview Turning the Slate PC On and Off Using the Touch Logon LCD (Touch Screen) BrightnessControl Using the Home Button Using the Easy Settings Using the Basic Gestures Using the Applied Gestures Screen Calibration Entering Letters Using the Touch Screen Using the Touch Launcher Using the Touch Supporter Using the digitizer pen Using the Auto Screen RotationFunction Adjusting the Volume Wireless Network Using the camera Using the Bluetooth keyboard Using the Slate PC Dock Getting Started Using the Touch Feature Using the Slate PC CONTENTSGetting Started 4 Overview Turning the Slate PC On and Off Using the Touch Logon LCD (Touch Screen) Brightness Control Using the Home Button Using the Easy Settings Getting StartedOverview Getting Started 5 Camera Power Button Rotation Lock SIM Card Slot (Optional) Slate PC Dock Port Home button Touch Screen speaker Micro SD Card Slot Microphone Ear-set / headset Jack USB Port Volume Control Button Micro HDMI Port DC Jack Illumination Sensor Battery Emergency Hole Camera Front View Bottom View Rear View Left View Top View Right ViewTurning the Slate PC On and Off Getting Started 6 Turning the computer on 1 Connect the AC adapter. 2 Press the Power button to turn the computer on. 3 Power button LED is lit while the computer is turned on. LED Setting up the Windows When you use the computer for the first time, you have to Set up the Windows. Turn the computer on and follow the Setting up the procedures according to the instructions on the Windows screen. 1 Turn the computer on. 2 Confirm your country and region, the time and currency, the keyboard type and click Next. 3 Follow the activation procedures according to the instructions on the screen.Getting Started 7 4 Once theWindowsset-upis complete, youcanuse the computer. Entering Sleep mode Whenthe computeristurnedon,pressthe computer’spower buttononcebriefly. Towake the computerup,briefl ypressthePowerbuttonofthe computer again. Turning the computer off Click Start >Shut down mode to shutdownthe computer. 1 2 Turning the Slate PC On and OffGetting Started 8 Configuring the Touch Logon program To use the Touch Logon function, you have to setup the Touch Logon function in the Windows Logon screen. 1 Click Start > All Programs > Samsung > Touch Logon > Touch Logon Options. 2 Select Use Touch Logon. 3 Choose the Touch Logon background screen. Select a background screen by touching it and touch Next. z x If you haven’t set a Windows password, the Touch Logon settings are finished at this stage. If you have set a Windows password, proceed to the next step. Using the Touch Logon program, you can easily log on using your fingers. Using the Touch LogonUsing the Touch Logon Getting Started 9 4 Choose a Touch Logon theme. If you touch a theme, you can view a video that shows you how to use the theme to logon. Select a theme and touch Next. z x 5 Touch OK and enter the previously configured Windows password. 6 Set a Touch Logon password. Set a Touch Logon password according to the method of the corresponding theme and touch Next. E.g. when the Color Ball theme is selected. x z 7 Confirm the Touch Logon password you entered in the previous step. Touch the password that you have entered again by touching each letter of the password in sequence. When entering the password is complete, touch Next. 8 The Touch Logon settings have been completed. Now you can use the Touch Logon function from when you next logon.Getting Started 10 Using the Touch Logon function To logon by touch in the Windows logon screen 1 Press the Power button to turn the computer on. 2 When the Windows logon screen appears, touch your account to log on. 3 When the following screen appears, touch the at the bottom of the screen and drag it to the top while your finger maintains contact. 4 Touch each letter of the configured Touch Logon password in sequence. E.g. when the Color Ball theme is set If there is no configured Windows account password, it is immediately Unlocked without requiring the password. Using the Touch LogonGetting Started 11 Changing the Touch Logon Settings /Removing Touch Logon 1 Click Start > All Programs > Samsung > Touch Logon > Touch Logon Options. 2 You can change the Touch Logon settings or remove the Touch Logon function according to the instructions on the screen. If you change the Windows password in the Control Panel > User Accounts, the Touch Logon function is deactivated. Change Touch Logon Remove Touch Using the Touch LogonGetting Started 12 LCD (Touch Screen) Brightness Control 1 Launchthe Easy Settings. 2 Click Display > Screen Brightness and set the brightness level. z x ● Maintaining the changed LCD brightness even after turning the computer on again Tomaintainthe LCDbrightnesssetbyusingthe brightness control keys orthroughthe PowerOptions, followtheproceduresbelow. ► For Windows 7 1. ClickControl Panel > Hardware and Sound > Power Options. 2. ClickChange the settingsofthe currently configuredmode. 3. Adjustthedisplaybrightness adjustmentmenubar andclick theSave the changesbutton. When the computer runs on battery power, the touch screen is dark. The screenbrightnessissettodarkwhenthe computeris runningonbatterypowertoextendthebattery use time. In the Easy Settings,setthe level ofthe screenbrightness. The LCDbrightnessis automatically controlledusingthe illuminationsensor. Youcanmanually controlthe LCDbrightness asfollows.Using the Home Button Getting Started 13 Using the Home button, you can conveniently execute the Touch Launcher or switch to the Windows Desktop screen. Touching Once Launches the Touch Launcher. Touching and holding shows the Windows Desktop screen. Touching Twice performs the role of the Win + Tab key combination.Using the Easy Settings Getting Started 14 1 Click Start > All Programs > Samsung > Easy Settings. 2 To configure a function, select the corresponding item. The functions of the Easy Settings Touch calibration The Touch Logon setting and the screen text font size setting. General Fast Start setting, silent mode and user account. Power You can configure the Power Plan (highperformance, power-saving, Samsung optimal mode), the power-saving settings and the display settings. Wireless Network You can configure whether to use the Airplane mode and Wi-Fi options. Display You can configure external display devices, and the screen brightness/color. Desktop Background / Screen Saver You can configure the Desktop background and the screen saver. Sound Alive You can configure the sound mode (Music, Movie, Speech, Silver Mode etc.). The functions of the Easy Settings Advanced Settings screen for each functions Easy Settings is the integrated Samsung software control programUsing the Touch Feature 15 Using the Basic Gestures Using the Applied Gestures Screen Calibration Entering Letters Using the Touch Screen Using the Touch Launcher Using the Touch Supporter Using the digitizer pen Using the Touch FeatureUsing the Basic Gestures Using the Touch Feature 16 Learning basic touch screen operations Touch Operation Function Single-tap (click) To select an item, tap over the item with your finger. This is the same as leftclicking once with a mouse. Double-tap (double-click) To run an item, quickly tap the item twice with your finger. This is the same as double-clicking once. Moving (drag) To drag an item, place your finger over the item and drag it to the new location. This is the same as dragging using a mouse. Press and take off (mouse right-click) If you press and hold the screen for approximately 3 seconds, the pop-up menu appears. This is the same as right-clicking with the mouse. Tapping two fingers in succession (mouse right-click) Tap with one finger and then tap with another finger while holding down the first finger. A pop-up menu appears. This is equivalent to right-clicking a mouse. Moving finger (scroll) Move your finger up and down, left or right to move on the screen accordingly. This is the scroll function of the mouse. This operation may perform a different function depending on the application program.Using the Applied Gestures Using the Touch Feature 17 Touch Operation Function Drag two fingers apart / together (zoom-in/zoom-out) Drag apart or together two fingers to zoom-in or -out of a picture or image. Flick one finger fast (page move) Flick one finger quickly to the left or right in order to move to the previous or next page. Quickly draw with two fingers (this runs the Touch Launcher) By quickly drawing a line from top to bottom with two fingers, the Touch Launcher program is launched. Tapping three fingers (Launching the Touch Supporter) Tapping three fingers simultaneously launches the touch supporter program. Tapping five fingers (Launching the keyboard program) Tapping fi ve fingers simultaneously launches the keyboard program. Learning about touch operations Select Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Pen and Touch > Flicks tab and select Practice using flicks to learn about the various touch operations.Screen Calibration Using the Touch Feature 18 Screen Calibration The calibration process for the touch screen may differ depending on the operating system and may not be available in some operating systems. The following descriptions assume the Windows 7 operating system. 1 Click Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Tablet PC Settings > Display > Calibrate. 2 Select the screen type to calibrate. If the Calibration screen appears, touch the point represented by the “+” mark and then remove your finger. The “+” mark appears sequentially from the top left to the bottom right of the screen. 3 When the Do you want to save the calibration data? window appears, click Yes. The touch screen input points are calibrated. When you use the touch screen for the fi rst time or the pointer on the screen does not precisely match the points you touch, calibrate the touch screen using the Tablet PC Settings menu.Entering Letters Using the Touch Screen Using the Touch Feature 19 Launching the Tablet PC Input Panel If you touch the touch screen with your finger, the Tablet PC Input Panel tab appears with the cursor at the bottom left on the Desktop. If you touch the Tablet PC Input Panel tab, the Tablet PC Input Panel appears. Are you unable to find the Tablet PC Input Panel tab ? click start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Tablet PC Settings > Other tab and select [Go to Input Panel Settings], select the “Use the Input Panel tab” in the Options window and then click OK. Let’s learn how to enter letters in Notepad. 1 Launching Notepad. 2 If you touch the Notepad screen with your finger, the appears on the Notepad with the cursor. 3 If you touch the with your finger, the Tablet PC Input Panel appears. Tools Close Writing Pad Mode Touch keyboard You can enter letters using either the Tablet PC input panel.Using the Touch Feature 20 Entering Letters Using the Touch Screen Entering Letters Using the Touch Screen Using the touch keyboard, you can enter letters by touching the corresponding keys on the keyboard that is displayed on the screen as you do with a normal keyboard. 1 In the Tablet PC input panel, touch the touch keyboard icon . 2 Enter letters by touching the corresponding keys on the screen. Entering letters with the writing pad (hand-writing input mode) In the touch screen, you can enter letters by directly writing letters with your finger on the writing pad input panel. 1 In the Tablet PC input panel, touch the writing pad icon . 2 Write a letter in the input area of the writing pad in the touch screen and wait for a moment. Then the letter is converted to the most likely letter. 3 If you touch the Insert button, the converted letter is entered. Modifying a letter Over-write a new letter over an incorrectly recognized letter or touch the above the letter and select a letter.Using the Touch Launcher Using the Touch Feature 21 Touch Launcher Functions On the touch screen, drag two fingers from top to bottom quickly. Alternatively,Click Start > All Programs > Samsung > Play Touch and select Touch Launcher to launch it. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 To exit the Touch Launcher, touch . No. Function Description 1 Power Option Shows the remaining battery charge and the currently confi gured battery mode. 2 WiFi Shows the Wi-Fi connection status. If the computer is connected to Wi-Fi, the connected AP name is displayed. 3 ToDo (Things to do) Creates/Displays the ToDo list You can create a list of things to do. 4 Clock / Weather Shows the time and weather information for the confi gured region. 5 Edit Mode You can move the program icons, add groups, add/remove programs as well as change the Desktop background. 6 Page Indicator Shows the position of the current page. To navigate the pages, click the Page Indicator or drag the screen to the left or the right. 7 Program area Shows the program list. To launch a program, click the program icon. Touching the Launcher program enables you to easily play music and video files and operate downloaded applications by touching the screen with your finger on models with a touch screen.Using the Touch Launcher Using the Touch Feature 22 Launching a Program To launch a program added to the Touch Launcher, quickly touch a program icon twice. Navigating Pages To navigate pages in the Touch Launcher (1), touch the page icon or (2) flick one finger to the left or right. (1) (2)Using the Touch Feature 23 Editing Program Icons In Edit mode, you can add or remove a program, add a group, move a program icon and change the background image. To edit program icons 1 Touch the Edit mode icon. 2 If the program icon changes to Edit mode , move the icon to the new location. 3 To exit Edit mode, touch the Edit mode icon again. Using the Touch LauncherUsing the Touch Supporter Using the Touch Feature 24 Using the Touch Supporter If you touch the screen with three fingers simultaneously the touch support program is launched. Ctrl+C Ctrl Ctrl+X Del Magnifier Settings Show/Hide Hotkeys Ctrl+V Ctrl+Z Numeric Keypad To exit the Touch Supporter, click or touch the screen with three fingers again. What does the Ctrl key do (multiple selection mode)? The icon performs the same function as the Ctrl key on the keyboard. If you touch the Ctrl button, the button indicator is turned on. While the Ctrl (multiple selection mode) icon is selected and you touch various files with your finger sequentially, all the touched files are selected. Using the Numeric Keypad The Numeric Keypad is to use numeric and direction keys only. 1 Touch the Numeric Keypad . The Numeric Keypad appears on the screen. 2 If you touch the buttons on the Numeric Keypad, the corresponding number or symbol is entered on the screen. Switches the mode between the numeric and the direction key input modes To select direction key input mode, touch . To select numeric key input mode, touch . This program helps you to use functions that cannot be easily used with touch operations more easily.Using the Touch Feature 25 If a digitizer pen is supplied with the product, you can operate the computer with the pen instead of your fi ngers. You can use the digitizer pen as you would use your fi ngers. Using the digitizer pen Digitizer pen structure and functions Pen eraser Pen button Pen tip Pen tip Ring Pen tip This performs the function of your finger tip when you touch the screen. Pen button If you press the pen button when the digitizer pen tip is on the screen, circles appear around the pointer on the screen. Touch the screen with the digitizer pen while holding down the pen button. This performs the right-click function. Pen eraser Erases letters with the top end of the digitizer Pen. This performs the function of an eraser.Using the digitizer pen Using the Touch Feature 26 Replacing the pen tip If the pen tip is damaged, you can replace the pen tip as follows: 1 Hold the pen tip by inserting it into the hole of the ring and remove the tip by pulling it out. 2 Insert the new pen tip into the digitizer pen. Take care so that the pen tip does not spring out when taking it out.Using the Slate PC 27 Using the Auto Screen Rotation Function Adjusting the Volume Wireless Network Using the camera Using the Bluetooth keyboard Using the Slate PC Dock Using theSlate PCUsing the Auto Screen Rotation Function Using the Slate PC 28 To disable the Auto Screen Rotation function Press the Orientation Lock button. If the Orientation Lock function is activated, the screen orientation does not change regardless of the rotation of the computer. To release the Orientation Lock function so that the screen orientation is automatically changed, press the Orientation Lock button again. If the Auto Screen Rotation function is activated, the screen orientation automatically changes as the computer is rotated.Adjusting the Volume Using the Slate PC 29 Method 1 Adjusting the volume with the buttons You can control the volume by pressing the volume control button on the left side of the computer. Method 2 Adjusting the Volume using the Volume Adjustment Program Click the Volume icon on the taskbar and slide the volume control bar to adjust the volume. Mute + _ You can control the volume using the volume control buttons or the volume control program.Wireless Network Using the Slate PC 30 Connecting to a Wireless LAN through Easy Settings 1 Click Start > All Programs > Samsung > Easy Settings. 2 Confi gure the Wireless Network and set the Wi-Fi device toON. Touch an AP in the AP list. If the computer is properly connected to the wireless network, the wireless LAN icon appears in the system tray. z x c If there is a nearby AP (Access Point), you can easily connect to a wireless LAN using the Easy Settings. If this option is set to ON, the Wi-Fi function will run. AP ListUsing the camera Using the Slate PC 31 Using the Camera program Click the Touch Launcher and launch the Camera. Select the front or rear camera Minimize Exit Select camera mode ( camera , video ) Select the resolution. View the captured picture or video. Take a picture or make a recording Open the folder to save the file with Explorer. z x c 1 Touch the Select Front/Rear Camera to select either the front or the rear camera that you will use. 2 To take a picture, select camera mode. To record a video, select video mode. 3 Touch the Take a Picture /Record to take a picture or record a video. 4 You can view the picture or recorded video through the Preview function or the Open the saved folder with Explorer . This product has 2 cameras(Optional). One is at the front and the other is at the back. Using the touch camera program, you can conveniently take a picture or record a video using touch operations.Using the Bluetooth keyboard Using the Slate PC 32 You can connect and use an external type keyboard. Now let’s look at how to connect the Bluetooth wireless keyboard (optional) provided by Samsung Electronics. What isBluetooth? Bluetooth is wireless communications technology that allows access to nearby devices such as another computer, a cell phone, printer, keyboard, mouse, etc. without a cable connection. Using the Bluetooth Wireless Keyboard 1 Remove the battery compartment cover at the back of the computer. 2 Install the battery and close the cover. Power ButtonUsing the Slate PC 33 3 If you press and hold the keyboard power button for 3 seconds after starting the computer, the Bluetooth LED willblink in blue. 4 Click > Bluetooth Devices > Add a Device. 5 Select the keyboard to be connected and click Next. 6 Enter the number displayed on the screen and press Enter. This will connect the keyboard. When the keyboard is connected, the blue Bluetooth LED of the keyboard is turned off. Now you can use the keyboard. Using the Bluetooth keyboardUsing the Slate PC Dock Using the Slate PC 34 Installing/Removing the Dock Before installing a computer to the docking station, make sure to disconnect all the cables connected to the computer. Installing and separating the Slate PC Dock after turning the computer off is recommended. Installing the Slate PC onto the Dock 1 Insert your fi nger into the groove on the side of the Slate PC Dock to open the top cover of the Slate PC Dock. 2 Align the computer connector of the Slate PC Dock and the Slate PC Dock port at the bottom of the computer and connect them. Computer Connector By connecting the computer to the Slate PC Dock, you can use various types of ports.Using the Slate PC Dock Using the Slate PC 35 Ports Provided by the Dock The back of the Dock 1 2 3 4 5 1 DC Jack A jack to connect the AC adapter that supplies power to the computer. 2 Wired LAN Port Connect the Ethernet cable to this port. 3 Digital Video/ Audio Port (HDMI) You can connect an HDMI cable to this port. Using this port, you can enjoy digital video and audio on the TV. 4 USB Port You can connect USB devices to the USB port such as a keyboard/mouse, digital camera, etc. 5 Headphone Jack A jack used to connect the headphones. Connecting headphones to the Dock Using the Headphone jack 1 Right-click over the Volume Control icon in the notification area at the bottom right of the Desktop and select Playback Devices. (Alternatively, click the Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Sound > Playback tab.) 2 Select the Speakers(USB audio), click Set Default and click OK. Using the computer’s built-in speaker when the computer is installing on the Dock When the Dock is connected, the audio is output to the headphone jack of the Dock. To use the computer’s built-in speaker when the Dock is connected, configure it as follows. 1 Right-click over the Volume Control icon in the notifi cation area at the bottom right of the Desktop and select Playback Devices. (Alternatively, click the Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Sound > Playback tab.) 2 Select the Speakers (Realtek High Defi nition Audio), click Set Default and click OK. Rev 1.00 A pleine puissance, l'écoute prolongée du baladeur peut endommager l'audition de l'utilisateur. En fonction du logiciel de l'appareil ou de votre opérateur, certaines descriptions de ce mode d'emploi peuvent ne pas correspondre à votre appareil. World Wide Web http://www.samsungmobile.com Printed in Korea Code No.:GH68-21920A French. 01/2009. Rev. 1.0Samsung C6625 Guide de prise en main rapide2 Utilisation de ce mode d'emploi Ce guide de prise en main rapide a été spécialement conçu pour vous guider à travers les fonctions et caractéristiques de votre appareil. Icônes Familiarisez-vous d'abord avec les icônes utilisées dans ce mode d'emploi : Avertissement—situations susceptibles de vous blesser ou de blesser d'autres personnes Attention—situations susceptibles d'endommager votre appareil ou d'autres appareils Remarque—remarques, conseils d'utilisation ou informations complémentaires X Référence—pages contenant plus d'informations. Exemple : X p. 12 (reportez-vous à la page 12)3 Copyright Les droits sur toutes les technologies et produits inclus dans cet appareil sont la propriété de leurs détenteurs respectifs. → Suivi de—pour modifier l'ordre des options ou des menus, vous devez exécuter une action. Exemple : Appuyez sur → Tous les progr. → Appareil photo (signifie que vous devez d'abord appuyer sur Démarrer, puis sur Tous les progr. et enfin sur Appareil photo) [ ] Crochets—touches du téléphone. Exemple : [ ] (représente la touche marche/arrêt) < > Crochets—touches du téléphone auxquelles sont associées des fonctions différentes selon l'écran. Exemple : (représente la touche écran Sélectionner) • Java™ est une marque de Sun Microsystems, Inc. • Bluetooth ® est une marque déposée de Bluetooth SIG, Inc. dans le monde entier—Bluetooth QD ID: B013854. • Windows Media Player ® est une marque déposée de Microsoft Corporation.4 • Cet appareil contient un logiciel sous licence MS, une société affiliée de Microsoft Corporation. Microsoft et les logiciels portant le nom de Microsoft sont des marques déposées de Microsoft Corporation. Avant d'utiliser cet appareil, veuillez lire les CONDITIONS DE LICENCE MICROSOFT POUR LE LOGICIEL WINDOWS MOBILE 6.1, à la fin de ce mode d'emploi, pour prendre connaissance de différentes informations relatives aux droits et restrictions.5 Informations relatives à la sécurité et à l'utilisation Conformez-vous toujours aux mises en garde suivantes afin de prévenir toute situation dangereuse ou illégale et de garantir des performances optimales. Ne laissez pas le téléphone à la portée des enfants en bas âge et des animaux domestiques Conservez le téléphone, ses pièces détachées et ses accessoires hors de portée des enfants en bas âge et des animaux. L'ingestion de petites pièces peut provoquer un étouffement ou des blessures graves. Installez le téléphone et ses accessoires avec précaution Veillez à la bonne fixation de votre téléphone portable et de ses accessoires dans votre véhicule. Évitez de poser votre téléphone ou l'un de ses accessoires à proximité de la zone d'ouverture des airbags. Si l'équipement téléphonique n'est pas installé correctement, le déclenchement de l'airbag pourrait provoquer des blessures graves. Mises en garde6 Utilisez les batteries et les chargeurs avec bon sens et éliminez les selon la réglementation en vigueur • Utilisez uniquement des batteries homologuées par Samsung et des chargeurs spécifiquement conçus pour votre téléphone. L'utilisation de batteries et de chargeurs non compatibles peut provoquer des blessures graves ou endommager votre téléphone. • Ne jetez jamais une batterie ou un appareil au feu. Respectez la réglementation en vigueur concernant le recyclage des batteries et des appareils usagés. • Ne posez jamais les batteries ou le appareil dans ou sur un appareil chauffant, tel qu'un four à micro-ondes, une cuisinière ou un radiateur. En cas de surchauffe, les batteries risquent d'exploser. • Veillez à ne pas écraser ou perforer la batterie. Évitez d'exposer la batterie à une pression externe élevée qui risquerait d'entraîner un court-circuit interne et une surchauffe. Évitez les interférences avec les stimulateurs cardiaques Conformément aux directives des fabricants et du Wireless Technology Research, programme américain de recherche sur les technologies de téléphonie mobile, maintenez une distance minimale de 15 cm (6 pouces) entre votre téléphone et le stimulateur cardiaque pour éviter toute interférence. Si vous pensez que votre téléphone vient perturber le fonctionnement d'un stimulateur cardiaque ou d'un appareil médical, éteignez le immédiatement et contactez le fabricant du stimulateur ou de l'appareil médical.7 Éteignez le téléphone dans les zones potentiellement explosives N'utilisez pas votre téléphone dans une station service ou à proximité de produits combustibles ou chimiques. Éteignez le téléphone dans les lieux où son utilisation est interdite. Votre téléphone peut provoquer une explosion ou un incendie dans ou près des lieux de stockage ou de transfert de produits chimiques ou combustibles ou dans les zones de dynamitage. Ne transportez et ne stockez jamais de liquides inflammables, de gaz ou de matériaux explosifs dans le même habitacle que le téléphone, ses composants ou ses accessoires. Réduisez les risques de lésions engendrées par des gestes répétitifs Lorsque vous envoyez des SMS ou jouez à des jeux sur votre appareil, tenez-le de manière détendue, appuyez légèrement sur les touches, utilisez les fonctions spéciales (modèles et saisie intuitive) pour réduire le nombre de touches à manipuler et faites régulièrement des pauses. N'utilisez pas votre téléphone en conduisant Évitez d'utiliser votre téléphone en conduisant et respectez la réglementation concernant l'utilisation des téléphones portables en voiture. Utilisez un kit mains libres pour conduire en toute sécurité. Consignes de sécurité8 Observez toutes les mises en garde et les consignes de sécurité Respectez la réglementation interdisant l'utilisation des téléphones portables dans certains lieux. Utilisez uniquement des accessoires homologués par Samsung L'utilisation d'accessoires non compatibles peut endommager le téléphone ou provoquer des blessures. Éteignez votre téléphone à proximité de tout appareil médical Votre téléphone peut provoquer des interférences avec les équipements médicaux utilisés dans les hôpitaux et les centres de soins. Observez la réglementation en vigueur ainsi que les consignes et mises en garde affichées par le personnel médical. Éteignez le téléphone ou désactivez les fonctions radio lorsque vous voyagez en avion Les téléphones portables peuvent engendrer des interférences avec les équipements aéronautiques. Conformez-vous aux réglementations en vigueur et éteignez votre téléphone ou passez en mode hors-ligne qui vous permettra de désactiver les fonctions radio (GSM + Bluetooth) de votre téléphone. Protégez les batteries et les chargeurs • Évitez d'exposer les batteries à des températures extrêmes (inférieures à 0° C/32° F ou supérieures à 45° C/ 113° F). Les températures très faibles ou très élevées peuvent affecter la capacité de charge et la durée de vie des batteries.9 • Évitez tout contact entre les batteries et des objets métalliques, cela risquerait de provoquer un court-circuit entre les bornes + et - et d'endommager les batteries de manière temporaire ou permanente. • N'utilisez jamais de batterie ou de chargeur endommagé. Manipulez votre téléphone avec soin • Évitez tout contact avec des liquides—ils risquent de provoquer des dégâts sérieux. N'utilisez pas le téléphone avec les mains mouillées. L'eau peut endommager votre téléphone et entraîner l'annulation de la garantie du fabricant. • Ne stockez pas votre téléphone dans un endroit poussiéreux ou sale. Ses composants mobiles risquent de se détériorer. • Votre téléphone est un appareil électronique complexe. Protégez-le de tout choc afin d'éviter de graves dégâts. • Peindre le téléphone risque de bloquer ses pièces mobiles et de perturber son fonctionnement. • N'utilisez ni le flash ni l'éclairage du téléphone trop près des yeux des enfants et des animaux. • Les champs magnétiques peuvent endommager votre téléphone et les cartes mémoire. N'utilisez pas d'étui ni d'accessoires dotés de fermetures aimantées et évitez toute exposition prolongée de votre téléphone à des champs magnétiques.10 Évitez les interférences avec d'autres appareils électroniques Les signaux de radiofréquence émis par votre téléphone peuvent perturber le fonctionnement des systèmes électroniques mal installés ou insuffisamment protégés, notamment les stimulateurs cardiaques, les prothèses auditives, les équipements médicaux, électroniques domestiques et automobiles. Contactez les fabricants de ces appareils électroniques pour résoudre les éventuels problèmes d'interférences. Utilisez votre téléphone normalement Évitez tout contact avec l'antenne interne de votre téléphone. Toute réparation doit être réalisée par un technicien agréé Un technicien non agréé pourrait endommager votre téléphone ce qui entraînerait, de ce fait, l'annulation de la garantie. Préservez la durée de vie des batteries et du chargeur • Ne laissez pas la batterie en charge pendant plus d'une semaine, car une surcharge risque de raccourcir sa durée de vie. Consignes d'utilisation importantes11 • Lorsqu'elle n'est pas utilisée pendant une période prolongée, une batterie pleine se décharge progressivement. • Lorsque le chargeur n'est pas utilisé, ne le laissez pas branché à une prise de courant. • Utilisez la batterie pour votre téléphone uniquement. Manipulez les cartes SIM et les cartes mémoire avec précaution • Ne retirez pas une carte lorsque le téléphone est en cours d'enregistrement ou de lecture, car vous risqueriez de perdre des données et/ou d'endommager la carte ou le téléphone. • Protégez les cartes contre les chocs violents, les décharges électrostatiques et les nuisances électriques émanant d'autres appareils. • Une trop grande fréquence des opérations d'effacement et d'écriture réduit la durée de vie de la carte mémoire. • Ne touchez pas la puce avec vos doigts ou avec des objets métalliques. Si la carte est sale, nettoyez-la avec un chiffon doux. Garantir l'accès aux services d'urgence Dans certains lieux et dans certaines circonstances, il peut être impossible de joindre les numéros d'urgence avec votre téléphone. Avant de vous rendre dans des régions non couvertes ou isolées, prévoyez un autre moyen pour contacter les services d'urgence. Informations sur la certification DAS Votre téléphone a été conçu pour ne pas dépasser les limites d'exposition aux radiofréquences (RF) recommandées par le Conseil de l'Union européenne. 12 Ces normes empêchent la vente d'appareils mobiles qui dépassent le niveau d'exposition maximal (également connu sous le nom de DAS ou Débit d'absorption spécifique) de 2.0 watts par kilogramme de tissu humain. Au cours des essais, la valeur DAS maximale enregistrée pour ce modèle était de 0.661 watt par kilogramme. Au cours d'une utilisation normale, la valeur DAS réelle sera généralement beaucoup plus faible, car le téléphone n'émet que l'énergie RF nécessaire à la transmission du signal vers la station de base la plus proche. Le téléphone minimise ainsi votre exposition globale à l'énergie RF en émettant automatiquement à des niveaux plus faibles dès que cela est possible. Cependant, par mesure de précaution, quelques dispositions simples peuvent contribuer à diminuer le niveau d'exposition aux radiofréquences. Ainsi, afin de réduire au maximum la puissance d'émission de votre téléphone, veillez à l'utiliser dans des conditions de réception optimales, l'indicateur de puissance du signal affiché à l'écran comportant alors un nombre suffisant de barres. En général, plus vous êtes proche d'un relais, moins la puissance utilisée par le téléphone est élevée. Par ailleurs, il est également recommandé d'utiliser autant que possible le kit piéton. Cependant, on veillera dans ce cas à éloigner le téléphone du ventre des femmes enceintes et du bas ventre des enfants et des adolescents. La Déclaration de conformité figurant au dos de ce mode d'emploi atteste de la conformité de votre téléphone avec la directive européenne R&TTE sur les équipements terminaux de télécommunications et les équipements radio. Pour plus d'informations sur le DAS et les normes européennes correspondantes, consultez le site Web de Samsung mobile.13 Recyclage (Déchets d'équipements électriques et électroniques) (Applicable dans le cadre de l'Union européenne et des autres pays européens utilisant des systèmes de collecte sélective) Ce symbole sur le produit ou sur sa documentation indique qu'il ne doit pas être éliminé en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. En raison des risques que l'élimination non contrôlée des déchets représente pour l'environnement et la santé de l'homme, veuillez séparer ce produit des autres types de déchets et le recycler de façon responsable. Vous favoriserez ainsi la réutilisation durable des ressources matérielles. Les particuliers sont invités à contacter leur distributeur ou à se renseigner auprès de leur mairie pour savoir où et comment ils peuvent se débarrasser de ce produit afin qu'il soit recyclé dans le respect de l'environnement. Les entreprises sont invitées à contacter leur fournisseur et à se référer aux conditions de leur contrat de vente. Ce produit ne doit pas être éliminé avec les autres déchets commerciaux. 14 Elimination des batteries de ce produit (Applicable aux pays de l'Union européenne et aux autres pays européens dans lesquels des systèmes de collecte sélective sont mis en place) Le symbole sur la batterie, le manuel ou l'emballage indique que les batteries de ce produit ne doivent pas être éliminées en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. L'indication éventuelle des symboles chimiques Hg, Cd ou Pb signifie que la batterie contient des quantités de mercure, de cadmium ou de plomb supérieures aux niveaux de référence stipulés dans la directive CE 2006/66. Si les batteries ne sont pas correctement éliminées, ces substances peuvent porter préjudice à la santé humaine ou à l'environnement. Afin de protéger les ressources naturelles et d'encourager la réutilisation du matériel, veillez à séparer les batteries des autres types de déchets et à les recycler via votre système local de collecte gratuite des batteries.15 Guide de prise en main rapide Contenu du coffret Sortez le téléphone de son coffret et vérifiez que tous les éléments suivants sont présents : • Smartphone • Kit piéton • Batterie • Guide de prise en main rapide • Chargeur • Câble de connexion PC • CD-ROM1 • Les éléments fournis avec votre téléphone peuvent varier en fonction des logiciels et accessoires disponibles dans votre région ou proposés par votre opérateur. Vous pouvez acquérir d'autres accessoires auprès de votre revendeur Samsung. • Utilisez exclusivement des logiciels autorisés par Samsung. L'utilisation de logiciels illégaux ou piratés peut entraîner des dommages ou des dysfonctionnements qui ne sont pas couverts par la garantie du fabricant. 1. Le CD-ROM contient le logiciel Microsoft ActiveSync, des modules complémentaires et d'autres applications.16 Présentation du téléphone Présentation des touches et fonctions de la face avant de votre téléphone : Présentation des touches et fonctions de la face arrière de votre téléphone : Écouteur Écran Touche terminer/ verrouiller Touche écran droite Touche Retour/ Supprimer Touches de navigation (Haut/ Bas/Gauche/Droite) Touche de confirmation Microphone Touche marche/ arrêt Objectif photo avant Touche de volume Emplacement pour carte mémoire Touche d'appel Touche Accueil/ Gestionnaire des tâches Clavier AZERTY Touche écran gauche Objectif photo arrière Cache de la batterie Connecteur à fonctions multiples Miroir Antenne intégrée17 Touches Touche Fonction Allumer ou éteindre l'appareil (maintenir la touche enfoncée) ; ouvrir le menu rapide Exécuter les actions indiquées au bas de l'écran Parcourir les listes ou les menus et déplacer le curseur vers le haut, le bas, la gauche ou la droite Confirmer votre sélection ou exécuter l'application sélectionnée Ouvrir l'écran de numérotation ; appeler un correspondant ou répondre à un appel Mettre fin à un appel ; revenir à l'écran d'accueil ; verrouiller l'appareil (maintenir la touche enfoncée) Basculer vers l'écran d'accueil à partir d'un programme ; ouvrir le Gestionnaire des tâches (maintenir la touche enfoncée) Revenir au menu ou à l'écran précédent ; supprimer des caractères ~ Saisir des chiffres, des caractères et des symboles Supprimer des caractères Touche Fonction18 Dans un champ de texte, permet de saisir des caractères de la moitié supérieure des touches Confirmer la sélection ; permet d'effectuer un retour à la ligne en mode de saisie de texte Changer la casse en mode de saisie de texte Lancer le navigateur WAP Ouvrir l'écran des symboles en mode saisie de texte (maintenir la touche enfoncée) ; ouvrir la liste des modes de saisie de texte en mode saisie de texte Touche Fonction Utiliser l'alphabet Unicode spécial pour les langues autres que l'anglais Activer ou désactiver le mode Vibreur à partir de l'écran d'accueil (maintenir la touche enfoncée) ; insérer un espace en mode de saisie de texte Ouvrir la messagerie Activer l'appareil photo (maintenir la touche enfoncée) ; ouvrir le Gestionnaire de contenu Régler le volume du téléphone ; couper la sonnerie d'un appel entrant Touche Fonction19 Icônes Signification des icônes qui apparaissent à l'écran. Icône Signification Puissance du signal Appel vocal en cours Appel de données en cours Appel en attente Réseau GPRS disponible Réseau GPRS connecté Réseau EDGE disponible Réseau EDGE connecté Itinérance en GPRS Réseau UMTS disponible Niveau de charge de la batterie Sonnerie réglée sur vibreur Ligne téléphonique 1 ou 2 (service réseau) Itinérance (hors de la zone de service normale) Bluetooth activé Casque Bluetooth connecté Erreur de synchronisation Nouveau SMS ou MMS Nouveau message instantané Nouveau message vocal Appel manqué Transfert d'appels actif Icône Signification20 Installation et préparation de votre téléphone Cette section décrit comment préparer votre téléphone mobile en vue de sa première utilisation. Installer la carte SIM et la batterie Lorsque vous vous abonnez à un service de téléphonie mobile, une carte SIM (Subscriber Identity Module) vous est remise. Elle permet de vous identifier et contient tous les détails de votre abonnement (code PIN, services disponibles en option, etc.). Pour bénéficier des services UMTS ou HSDPA, vous devez disposer d'une carte USIM (Universal Subscriber Identity Module). Pour installer la carte SIM ou USIM et la batterie : 1. Retirez le cache de la batterie. Si l'appareil est allumé, maintenez la touche [ ] enfoncée pour l'éteindre.21 2. Insérez la carte SIM ou USIM. 3. Installez la batterie. 4. Remettez le cache de la batterie en place. • Installez la carte SIM ou USIM en orientant la puce vers le bas. • Retirez la batterie avant d'insérer ou de retirer la carte SIM ou USIM.22 Mettre la batterie en charge Vous devez charger la batterie avant d'utiliser le téléphone pour la première fois. 1. Ouvrez le cache du connecteur à fonctions multiples, sur le côté de l'appareil. 2. Branchez la fiche du chargeur sur le connecteur à fonctions multiples. 3. Branchez le chargeur sur une prise secteur. 4. Lorsque la batterie est entièrement chargée (l'icône ne bouge plus), débranchez le chargeur de la prise secteur. 5. Débranchez le chargeur de l'appareil. 6. Refermez le cache du connecteur à fonctions multiples. Triangle orienté vers le haut Informations sur l'indicateur de faible charge Lorsque le niveau de charge de la batterie est faible, le téléphone émet une tonalité et affiche un message d'avertissement. L'icône de batterie est alors vide et clignote. Lorsque le niveau de charge de la batterie est vraiment insuffisant, le téléphone s'éteint automatiquement. Rechargez la batterie pour remettre le téléphone en marche.23 Insérer une carte mémoire (en option) Pour stocker des fichiers multimédia supplémentaires, vous pouvez utiliser une carte mémoire. Le téléphone est compatible avec les cartes microSDTM d'une capacité allant jusqu'à 8 Go (en fonction de la marque et du modèle de carte mémoire). 1. Ouvrez le compartiment à carte mémoire, sur le côté de l'appareil. 2. Introduisez une carte mémoire, étiquette orientée vers le haut. 3. Enfoncez la carte mémoire dans son emplacement jusqu'à ce qu'elle se verrouille. Pour retirer la carte mémoire, enfoncez-la légèrement jusqu'à ce qu'elle se déverrouille, puis retirez-la du téléphone. Mise en marche/arrêt du téléphone Pour allumer le téléphone : 1. Maintenez la touche [ ] enfoncée pour allumer l'appareil. 2. Suivez les instructions qui s'affichent à l'écran pour définir votre région, votre ville, l'heure et la date. L'appareil se connecte automatiquement au réseau de téléphonie mobile. Pour éteindre le téléphone, répétez l'étape 1 ci-dessus.24 Verrouiller ou déverrouiller les touches Vous pouvez verrouiller les touches pour empêcher toute utilisation accidentelle du téléphone. Sur l'écran d'accueil, maintenez la touche [ ] enfoncée. Pour déverrouiller le clavier, appuyez sur → [ ]. Désactiver les fonctions sans fil Vous pouvez désactiver les fonctions sans fil de l'appareil lorsque leur utilisation est interdite, par exemple dans les avions et les hôpitaux, pour continuer à utiliser les fonctions de votre appareil qui ne nécessitent pas de connexion radio (GSM + Bluetooth). Pour désactiver les fonctions sans fil : 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur [ ] → Gestionnaire sans fil. 2. Sélectionnez Téléphone et appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. Le symbole s'affiche sur l'écran d'accueil. 3. Appuyez sur . Pour activer les fonctions sans fil, répétez les étapes 2 à 3 ci-dessus. Le symbole s'affiche sur l'écran d'accueil. Utilisation des applications Ouvrir des applications ou des dossiers 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur . 2. Sélectionnez une application et appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. Reportez-vous au mode d'emploi pour en savoir plus sur les fonctions d'affichage et de gestion de documents de l'appareil.25 Changer d'application Votre appareil est multitâche et permet l'exécution simultanée de plusieurs applications. Pour passer d'une application active à une autre : 1. Appuyez sur [ ] → . 2. Sélectionnez une application et appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. Fermer une application Pour quitter l'application en cours, appuyez sur [ ]. Pour fermer une application ouverte en arrièreplan : 1. Maintenez la touche [ ] enfoncée pour ouvrir le Gestionnaire des tâches. 2. Sélectionnez une application et appuyez sur . Fonctions d'appel de base Découvrez comment appeler un numéro et répondre à un appel et comment utiliser les fonctions d'appel de base. Passer un appel 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, saisissez un numéro de téléphone avec son indicatif. 2. Appuyez sur [ ] pour composer ce numéro. Pour passer un appel visio, appuyez sur

→ Appel visio pour composer le numéro. 3. Pour mettre fin à l'appel, appuyez sur [ ]. Répondre à un appel 1. Lorsque le téléphone reçoit un appel, appuyez sur [ ]. 2. Pour mettre fin à l'appel, appuyez sur [ ].26 Réglage du volume Pour régler le volume en cours d'appel, utilisez la touche de volume haut ou bas. Afficher les appels manqués et rappeler les numéros correspondants Votre téléphone affiche à l'écran les appels que vous avez manqués. Pour composer le numéro d'un appel manqué : 1. Appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. 2. Sélectionnez l'appel manqué de votre choix. 3. Appuyez sur [ ] pour composer son numéro. Appeler un numéro récemment composé 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur [ ] pour ouvrir la liste des numéros récents. 2. Sélectionnez le numéro souhaité et appuyez sur [ ] pour le composer. Composer un numéro international 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, maintenez la touche [0] enfoncée pour insérer le caractère +. 2. Saisissez le numéro de téléphone complet (indicatif du pays, indicatif régional et numéro de téléphone), puis appuyez sur la touche [ ] pour le composer.27 Appeler un correspondant à partir du Répertoire Vous pouvez appeler directement des numéros à partir du Répertoire à l'aide des contacts enregistrés. X p. 28 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Répertoire. 2. Sélectionnez le numéro souhaité et appuyez sur [ ] pour le composer. Envoi et consultation des SMS Découvrez comment envoyer ou consulter des SMS. Envoyer un SMS 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Messagerie → SMS/MMS. 2. Appuyez sur → Nouveau. 3. Entrez un numéro de téléphone ou appuyez sur la touche de confirmation pour sélectionner un contact. 4. Naviguez vers le bas et rédigez le texte du message. 5. Pour envoyer le message, appuyez sur . Saisir un texte Votre appareil est muni d'un clavier AZERTY pour une saisie de texte facile et rapide. Saisissez votre texte comme vous le feriez avec un clavier d'ordinateur. Lors de la saisie, vous pouvez utiliser les touches suivantes : • : supprimer des caractères • : commencer une nouvelle ligne • Fn : utiliser les caractères de la partie supérieure de la touche28 • shift : changer la casse • sym : ouvrir la liste des symboles (maintenir la touche enfoncée) • âë : utiliser l'alphabet Unicode spécial pour les langues autres que l'anglais • espace : insérer un espace Lire un SMS 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Messagerie → SMS/MMS. 2. Sélectionnez un SMS. Ajout et recherche de contacts Fonctions de base du Répertoire. Ajouter un nouveau contact 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, entrez un numéro de téléphone et appuyez sur . 2. Appuyez sur la touche de confirmation → un type de contact. 3. Complétez les coordonnées du contact. 4. Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur ou sur pour enregistrer le contact. Rechercher un contact 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Répertoire. 2. Saisissez la première lettre du nom recherché. 3. Sélectionnez le nom du contact dans la liste de recherche. Une fois le contact localisé, vous pouvez : • l'appeler en appuyant sur [ ] • modifier ses coordonnées en appuyant sur → Modifier29 Fonctions de base de l'appareil photo Cette section décrit les fonctions de base pour photographier, filmer et visionner les clichés et vidéos. Prendre des photos 1. Maintenez la touche [ ] enfoncée pour activer l'appareil photo. 2. Orientez l'objectif vers le sujet et procédez à la mise au point (voir "Utiliser le clavier en mode Appareil photo"). 3. Pour prendre une photo, appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. 4. Appuyez sur pour enregistrer la photo. Utiliser le clavier en mode Appareil photo Touche Fonction Navigation (Gauche/Droite) Régler la luminosité Navigation (Haut) Changer le mode objectif Navigation (Bas) Régler le retardateur avant la prise du cliché 1 Basculer en mode Caméscope 2 Changer le mode de prise de vue 3 Modifier la taille de l'image 4 Modifier la balance des blancs 5 Changer d'effet30 Visualiser des photos 1. Dans l'objectif de l'appareil photo, appuyez sur . 2. Sélectionnez une photo et appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. Filmer des vidéos 1. Maintenez la touche [ ] enfoncée pour activer l'appareil photo. 2. Appuyez sur [1] pour passer en mode Caméscope. 3. Orientez l'objectif vers le sujet et procédez à la mise au point (voir "Utiliser le clavier en mode Caméscope"). 4. Appuyez sur la touche de confirmation pour commencer à enregistrer. 5. Appuyez sur < > pour arrêter l'enregistrement. 6. Appuyez sur pour enregistrer la vidéo. Utiliser le clavier en mode Caméscope 6 Activer ou désactiver le mode Nuit 7 Modifier les paramètres Volume Zoom avant ou arrière Touche Fonction Touche Fonction Navigation (Gauche/Droite) Régler la luminosité Navigation (Haut) Changer le mode objectif Navigation (Bas) Régler le retardateur avant l'enregistrement de la vidéo31 Visionner des vidéos 1. Dans le viseur du caméscope, appuyez sur . 2. Sélectionnez une vidéo et appuyez sur la touche de confirmation. Lecteur audio Votre téléphone vous permet d'écouter de la musique à l'aide du lecteur audio. Ajouter des fichiers audio dans l'appareil Commencez par ajouter des fichiers sur votre appareil ou sur une carte mémoire : • Téléchargez sur le WAP. • Téléchargez depuis un ordinateur à l'aide du logiciel Samsung PC Studio (en option). • Recevez des fichiers via Bluetooth. • Copiez des fichiers sur une carte mémoire. • Synchronisez le téléphone avec Windows Media Player 11. Pour en savoir plus, reportez-vous au mode d'emploi. 1 Basculer en mode Appareil photo 2 Modifier le mode d'enregistrement 3 Modifier la taille du cadre 4 Modifier la balance des blancs 5 Changer d'effet 7 Modifier les paramètres Volume Zoom avant ou arrière Touche Fonction32 Lire un fichier audio 1. Ajoutez des fichiers audio dans l'appareil. 2. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Windows Media. 3. Appuyez sur → Mettre à jour bibliothèque. 4. Une fois les bibliothèques actualisées, appuyez sur . 5. Sélectionnez Ma musique. 6. Sélectionnez une catégorie → un fichier audio. 7. Les touches suivantes permettent de contrôler la lecture : 8. Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur → Arrêter. Touche Fonction Confirmer Mettre en pause ou reprendre après une pause Volume/ Navigation (Haut/Bas) Régler le volume Navigation (Gauche) Redémarrer la lecture. Revenir au fichier précédent (maintenir enfoncée pendant 3 secondes). Reculer dans le fichier (maintenir la touche enfoncée) Navigation (Droite) Passer au fichier suivant. Avancer dans le fichier (maintenir la touche enfoncée) 0 Basculer en mode plein écran (fichier vidéo uniquement) espace Activer et désactiver le son Touche Fonction33 Créer une liste de lecture 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Windows Media. 2. Appuyez sur → Bibliothèque → Ma musique. 3. Sélectionnez une catégorie → un fichier audio. 4. Appuyez sur → Mettre en file d'attente. 5. Pour ajouter d'autres fichiers, répétez les étapes 2 et 3. 6. Appuyez sur → Lecteur. 7. Pour enregistrer la liste de lecture, appuyez sur → Enregistrer la sélection. 8. Saisissez le nom de la liste de lecture et appuyez sur . Personnalisation de l'appareil Tirez le meilleur de votre appareil en l'adaptant selon vos préférences. Modifier la sonnerie Vous pouvez modifier la sonnerie en la sélectionnant à partir d'un profil. Activer un profil 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Paramètres → Profils. 2. Sélectionnez un profil et appuyez sur . Pour changer rapidement de profil, appuyez sur [ ] et choisissez un autre profil.34 Personnaliser un profil 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Paramètres → Profils. 2. Sélectionnez un profil, puis appuyez sur → Modifier. 3. Modifiez les paramètres selon vos préférences. 4. Lorsque vous avez terminé de personnaliser le profil, appuyez sur . Choisir un thème pour l'arrière-plan ou un fond d'écran. 1. Dans l'écran d'accueil, appuyez sur → Paramètres → Affichage → Écran d'accueil. 2. Faites défiler vers la gauche ou la droite pour changer le thème dans l'option Affich. écran d'accueil. 3. Sélectionnez Image d'arrière-plan. 4. Faites défiler vers la gauche ou la droite pour sélectionner une image d'arrière-plan. 5. Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur .Déclaration de conformité (R&TTE) Nous, Samsung Electronics déclarons sous notre seule responsabilité que le produit Téléphone mobile GSM : C6625 en relation avec cette déclaration est en conformité avec les normes suivantes et/ou d'autres documents normatifs. Sécurité EN 60950-1 : 2001+A11:2004 EMC EN 301 489-01 V1.6.1 (09-2005) EN 301 489-07 V1.3.1 (11-2005) EN 301 489-17 V1.2.1 (08-2002) EN 301 489-24 V1.3.1 (11-2005) SAR EN 50360 : 2001 EN 62209-1 : 2006 Radio EN 301 511 V9.0.2 (03-2003) EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (10-2006) EN 301 908-1 V2.2.1 (03-2003) EN 301 908-1 V3.2.1 (05-2007) EN 301 908-2 V3.2.1 (05-2007) Ce téléphone a été testé et s'est avéré conforme aux normes relatives à l'émission de fréquences radio. En outre, nous déclarons que cet appareil répond à la directive 1999/5/EC. La procédure de déclaration de conformité, définie dans l'article 10, puis reprise à l'alinéa [IV] de la directive 1999/5/EC a été conduite sous contrôle de l'organisme suivant : BABT, Balfour House, Churchfield Road, Walton-on-Thames, Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK* Numéro d'identification : 0168 Documentation technique détenue par : Samsung Electronics QA Lab. disponible sur simple demande. (Représentant pour l'union européenne) Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab. Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way, Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK* 2009.01.14 Yong-Sang Park / Directeur Général (lieu et date de parution) (nom et signature du responsable dûment habilité) * Cette adresse n'est pas celle du Centre de service de Samsung. Pour obtenir celle-ci, consultez la carte de la garantie ou contactez le revendeur de votre téléphone. imagine as possibilidades Obrigado por adquirir um produto da Samsung. Registe o seu produto e participe das nossas promoções no site: www.samsung.com/register Frigorifico manual do utilizador Português Aparelho Não Encastrável2_ características características do seu novo frigorífico PRINCIPAIS CARACTERÍSTICAS DO SEU NOVO FRIGORÍFICO O seu Frigorífico Samsung está equipado com várias opções inovadoras de armazenamento e eficiência energética. • Sistema de Refrigeração Twin O Frigorífico e o Congelador têm evaporadores separados. Devido a este sistema de refrigeração independente, o Congelador e o Frigorífico refrigeram com mais eficiência. Adicionalmente, este sistema de fluxo de ar separado evita que o odor dos alimentos de um compartimento se espalhe para os outros compartimentos. • Espaço Maior e Mais Amplo A área vasta da prateleira fornece espaço suficiente para itens grandes. A gaveta larga do congelador também oferece espaço suficiente para 2~3 perus. • Fecho Automático Seguro A opção de Fecho Automático Seguro fechará automaticamente uma porta que esteja ligeiramente aberta. • Ecrã Digital e Controlo da Temperatura • Alarme da Porta Um sinal sonoro alerta-o se alguma porta estiver entreaberta. Para futura referência, escreva o número do modelo e o número de série. Encontrará o seu número de modelo e o número de série do lado esquerdo do frigorífico. N.º do modelo N.º de série Notificação CE Este produto foi fabricado de acordo com as Directivas de Baixa Voltagem (2006/95/EC), a Directiva de Compatibilidade electromagnética (2004/108/EC) e a Directiva de Eco-Design (2009/125/EC) implementadas pelo Regulamento (EC) Nr 643/2009 da União Europeia.informações de segurança _3 informações de segurança INFORMAÇÕES DE SEGURANÇA SÍMBOLO DE AVISO/CUIDADOS DE UTILIZAÇÃO AVISO Indica que existe perigo de morte ou graves lesões. CUIDADO Indica que existe risco de lesões ou danos materiais. OUTROS SÍMBOLOS UTILIZADOS Representa algo que NÃO deve fazer. Representa algo que NÃO deve desmontar. Representa algo em que NÃO deve tocar. Representa algo que deve cumprir. Indica que deve desligar a ficha de alimentação da tomada. Representa que deve existir uma ligação à terra para evitar choques eléctricos. Recomendamos que este símbolo seja alvo de acção por parte de um técnico de assistência técnica. • Antes de utilizar o aparelho, leia atentamente este manual e guarde-o para referência futura. AVISO • Uma vez que as instruções de funcionamento que se seguem abrangem vários modelos, as características do seu frigorífico podem ser ligeiramente diferentes das características descritas neste manual. AVISO Os sinais de aviso apresentados destinam-se a evitar ferimentos pessoais e a terceiros. Siga-os explicitamente. Após ler esta secção, guarde o manual num local seguro para referência futura. • Este frigorífico deve ser instalado e posicionado de modo correcto e em conformidade com o manual antes de ser usado. • Use este aparelho apenas para o efeito a que se destina, conforme descrito neste Manual de instruções. • Recomendamos vivamente que qualquer operação de assistência técnica seja realizada por um técnico qualificado. • O R600a ou R134a podem ser utilizados como agentes refrigerantes. Consulte a etiqueta do compressor na parte traseira do aparelho e a etiqueta de características no interior do frigorífico para ver qual o agente refrigerante utilizado para o frigorífico. • Caso seja utilizado o agente refrigerante R600a, há que ter em mente que se trata de um gás natural com elevada compatibilidade ambiental, mas que é, no entanto, também inflamável. Quando transportar e instalar o aparelho, deve tomar cuidado para assegurar que nenhuma das peças do circuito de refrigeração é danificada. • A fuga de agente refrigerante dos tubos pode provocar um incêndio ou lesões nos olhos. Se for detectada uma fuga, evite todas as fontes de chamas ou fontes potenciais de ignição e areje a divisão onde o aparelho se encontra durante vários minutos.informações de segurança 4_ informações de segurança SINAIS DE AVISO MUITO IMPORTANTES • De modo a evitar a criação de uma mistura de gás e ar inflamável no caso de ocorrer uma fuga no circuito de refrigeração, a dimensão da divisão na qual se pode colocar o aparelho deve depender da quantidade de agente refrigerante utilizado. AVISO • Nunca ligue um aparelho que apresente sinais de estar danificado. No caso de dúvida, consulte o seu agente autorizado. • A divisão deve ter 1 m3 de tamanho por cada 8g de agente refrigerante R600a no interior do aparelho. • A quantidade de agente refrigerante no seu frigorífico específico é indicada na placa de identificação no interior do aparelho. • Elimine o material da embalagem deste produto de um modo amigo do ambiente. • Retire a ficha de alimentação eléctrica da tomada antes de substituir a luz interior no frigorífico. - Caso contrário, existe um risco de choques eléctricos. • Não coloque este frigorífico exposto à luz directa do sol ou ao calor de fogões, aquecedores ou outros aparelhos que gerem calor. • Deixe um espaço suficiente para instalar o frigorífico numa superfície plana. - Se o seu frigorífico não estiver nivelado, o sistema de refrigeração interno pode não funcionar correctamente. • Não ligue vários aparelhos na mesma tomada. O frigorífico deve estar sempre ligado na sua própria tomada eléctrica individual cuja tensão deve corresponder à informação indicada na placa de tensão. - Isto permite um melhor desempenho e evita também a sobrecarga dos circuitos eléctricos domésticos, o que poderia provocar um incêndio a partir de fios eléctricos sobreaquecidos. • Nunca desligue a ficha do seu frigorífico puxando pelo cabo de alimentação. Segure sempre firmemente na ficha e puxe-a directamente para fora da tomada. - Cabos danificados podem provocar curto-circuitos, incêndios e/ou choques eléctricos. • Certifique-se de que a ficha de alimentação não é entalada nem danificada pela parte traseira do frigorífico. • Não dobre o cabo de alimentação excessivamente nem coloque objectos pesados em cima deste. - Tal situação pode constituir um perigo de incêndio. • Se o cabo de alimentação for danificado ou se descarnar, leve-o para ser reparado ou substituído imediatamente junto do fabricante ou do seu agente autorizado de assistência técnica. • Não utilize um cabo com fissuras ou danos provocados por abrasão ao longo do seu comprimento ou de qualquer uma das extremidades. • Se o cabo de alimentação estiver danificado, substitua-o imediatamente junto do fabricante ou do seu agente autorizado de assistência técnica. • Quando deslocar o frigorífico, tenha cuidado para não danificar nem passar com ele por cima do cabo de alimentação. • Não introduza a ficha de alimentação eléctrica com as mãos molhadas. • Desligue o frigorífico da tomada eléctrica antes de o limpar ou de efectuar reparações. • Não use um pano húmido ou molhado quando estiver a limpar a ficha. • Retire todas e quaisquer matérias estranhas ou poeiras dos pinos da ficha de alimentação eléctrica. - Caso contrário, existe perigo de incêndio. • Se desligar o frigorífico da tomada de alimentação eléctrica, deve aguardar pelo menos dez minutos antes de voltar a ligar. • Se a tomada de parede estiver solta, não introduza a ficha de alimentação eléctrica. - Existe um risco de incêndio ou de choque eléctrico. • O aparelho deve ser colocado de modo a que a ficha eléctrica fique acessível depois da instalação • Não instale o frigorífico num local húmido ou num local onde possa entrar em contacto com água. AVISO - Um isolamento incorrecto das peças eléctricas pode provocar um choque eléctrico ou um incêndio.informações de segurança _5 informações de segurança SINAIS DE CUIDADO • O frigorífico deve ser ligado à terra. - Tem de ligar o frigorífico à terra para evitar qualquer fuga de corrente ou choques eléctricos causados por fuga de corrente do frigorífico. • Não tente desmontar ou reparar o frigorífico por si próprio. - Se o fizer, corre o risco de provocar um incêndio, avarias e/ou ferimentos pessoais. • Se sentir o odor de produtos farmacêuticos ou fumo proveniente do frigorífico, desligue imediatamente a ficha de alimentação da tomada e contacte o seu centro de assistência técnica da Samsung Electronics. • Mantenha o orifício de ventilação na estrutura do aparelho ou na estrutura de montagem livre de qualquer obstrução. • Não utilize dispositivos mecânicos ou qualquer outro meio para acelerar o processo de descongelamento, para além dos recomendados pelo fabricante. • Não danifique o circuito de refrigeração. • Não utilize nem coloque aparelhos eléctricos no interior do frigorífico/congelador, a menos que sejam de um tipo recomendado pelo fabricante. • Antes de substituir a luz interior, desligue o aparelho da tomada eléctrica. • Se tiver dificuldade ao tentar substituir a lâmpada, contacte o centro de assistência da Samsung. • Este aparelho não é indicado para ser utilizado por pessoas (incluindo crianças) com capacidades físicas, sensoriais ou mentais reduzidas, ou falta de experiência e conhecimento, excepto com supervisão e instruções relativas à utilização do aparelho por uma pessoa responsável pela sua segurança. • As crianças devem ser vigiadas para assegurar que não brincam com o aparelho. • Não deixe as crianças pendurarem-se na porta. Caso contrário, poderão ocorrer ferimentos graves. • Não toque nas paredes interiores do congelador ou nos produtos guardados no congelador com as mãos molhadas. - Isto pode causar queimaduras provocadas pelo gelo. • Se não for utilizar o frigorifico durante um longo período de tempo, desligue a ficha de alimentação eléctrica da tomada. - A deterioração do isolamento do cabo de alimentação pode provocar um incêndio. • Não coloque artigos em cima do aparelho. - Quando abrir ou fechar a porta, os artigos podem cair e provocar ferimentos pessoais e/ou danos materiais. • Nunca utilize tubos de gás, linhas telefónicas ou outros potenciais elementos pára-raios como ligação de terra. - A utilização incorrecta da ficha de ligação de terra pode resultar em choque eléctrico. • As garrafas devem ser armazenadas bem juntas de modo a que não caiam. • Não coloque bebidas carbonatadas ou com gás no compartimento do congelador. • Não encha o frigorífico com alimentos em excesso. - Quando abrir a porta, um artigo pode cair e provocar ferimentos pessoais ou danos materiais. • Não coloque garrafas ou outro tipo de recipientes de vidro no congelador. - Quando o conteúdo destes recipientes congelar, o vidro pode rachar e provocar ferimentos pessoais. • Não pulverize gás inflamável junto ao frigorífico. - Existe um risco de explosão ou incêndio. • Não pulverize água directamente no interior ou no exterior do frigorífico. - Existe um risco de incêndio ou de choque eléctrico. • Este produto destina-se a ser utilizado apenas para armazenar alimentos num ambiente doméstico. • Os períodos de armazenamento recomendados pelo fabricante e os prazos de validade de produtos congelados devem ser cumpridos. Consulte as instruções aplicáveis. CUIDADOinformações de segurança 6_ informações de segurança • Não guarde substâncias voláteis ou inflamáveis no frigorífico. - O armazenamento de benzina, diluente, álcool, éter, gás LP ou qualquer outra substância deste tipo pode provocar uma explosão. • Não volte a congelar alimentos congelados que tenham descongelado por completo. • Não guarde produtos farmacêuticos, materiais científicos ou quaisquer outros produtos sensíveis em termos de temperatura no frigorífico. - Os produtos que necessitam de um controlo de temperatura rígido não devem ser guardados no frigorífico. • Não coloque qualquer recipiente cheio de água em cima do frigorífico. - Se a água se entornar, existe um risco de incêndio ou choque eléctrico. SINAIS DE CUIDADO PARA A LIMPEZA • Não introduza as mãos na área inferior do aparelho. - Quaisquer arestas aguçadas existentes poderão provocar ferimentos pessoais. • Não use um pano húmido ou molhado quando estiver a limpar a ficha, a remover quaisquer materiais estranhos ou poeiras dos pinos da ficha de alimentação eléctrica. - Caso contrário, existe um perigo de incêndio. SINAIS DE AVISO PARA ELIMINAÇÃO DO APARELHO • Quando eliminar este ou outros frigoríficos, retire as portas/vedantes das portas e o fecho da porta de modo a que crianças pequenas e animais não possam ficar presos no interior. • Deixe as prateleiras no lugar de modo a que as crianças não possam subir facilmente para o interior. • O R600a ou R134a são utilizados como agentes refrigerantes. Consulte a etiqueta do compressor na parte traseira do aparelho e a etiqueta de características no interior do frigorífico para ver qual o agente refrigerante utilizado para o seu frigorífico. Se este produto tiver um gás inflamável (agente refrigerante R600a), contacte a respectiva autoridade local para obter informação sobre a eliminação segura deste produto. • O ciclopentano é utilizado como gás de sopro de isolamento. Os gases existentes no material de isolamento requerem procedimentos de eliminação especiais. Contacte as suas respectivas autoridades locais para obter informação relativamente à eliminação ambientalmente segura deste produto. Assegure-se de que nenhum dos tubos na parte traseira dos aparelhos está danificado antes de eliminar o produto. Os tubos deverão ser partidos num espaço aberto. Em caso de ocorrência de uma falha eléctrica, contacte o departamento local da Companhia Eléctrica e pergunte quanto tempo esta vai durar. A maior parte das falhas eléctricas que sejam corrigidas no espaço de uma ou duas horas não afectarão as temperaturas do seu frigorífico. Contudo, deve minimizar o número de vezes que abre a porta enquanto a alimentação está desligada. Na eventualidade da falha eléctrica durar mais de 24 horas, retire todos os alimentos congelados. Nos casos de portas e tampas com fechaduras e chaves, deve manter as chaves das portas e tampas fora do alcance das crianças e longe do aparelho de refrigeração, para evitar que as crianças possam ficar fechadas no seu interior. CUIDADOinformações de segurança informações de segurança _7 SUGESTÕES ADICIONAIS PARA USO ADEQUADO • Deixe o aparelho repousar durante 2 horas após a instalação. • Para obter o melhor desempenho do produto, - Não coloque alimentos demasiado perto dos orifícios de ventilação na parte traseira do aparelho uma vez que pode obstruir a livre circulação de ar no compartimento do frigorífico. - Embrulhe os alimentos de forma adequada ou coloque-os em recipientes estanques antes de os colocar no congelador do frigorífico. - Não coloque qualquer alimento introduzido recentemente para congelamento perto de alimentos já congelados. • Não é necessário desligar o frigorífico da fonte de alimentação eléctrica se for ausentar-se por menos de três semanas. Deve, no entanto, remover todos os alimentos no caso de se ausentar por três ou mais semanas. Desligue e limpe, lave e seque o frigorífico. • O aparelho pode não funcionar de forma consistente (possibilidade de descongelamento do conteúdo ou aumento da temperatura no compartimento de alimentos congelados) quando presente durante um longo período de tempo abaixo da extremidade fria do intervalo de temperaturas para as quais o aparelho foi concebido. • Não armazene alimentos que se estraguem facilmente a baixas temperaturas, como bananas ou melões. • Coloque a cuvete de gelo na posição original apresentada pelo fabricante por forma a obter um congelamento ideal de gelo. • O seu aparelho é isento de criação de gelo, o que significa que não é necessário descongelar o seu aparelho manualmente, uma vez que esta acção será realizada automaticamente. • O aumento de temperatura durante o descongelamento pode estar em conformidade com o requisito ISO. No entanto, se pretende evitar um aumento indevido da temperatura dos alimentos durante o descongelamento do aparelho, embrulhe os alimentos congelados em várias camadas de papel, como por exemplo papel de jornal. • Qualquer aumento de temperatura dos alimentos congelados durante o descongelamento pode reduzir o seu tempo de armazenamento. • Contém gases de efeito de estufa fluorinados abrangidos pelo Protocolo de Quioto. • Espuma contendo gases de efeito de estufa fluorinados. Sugestões de poupança de electricidade • Instale o aparelho numa divisão fresca, seca e com uma ventilação adequada. Certifique-se de que o aparelho não está exposto à luz directa do sol e nunca o coloque perto de uma fonte de calor directa (por exemplo, um aquecedor). • Nunca bloqueie quaisquer orifícios de ventilação ou grelhas existentes no aparelho. • Deixe a comida quente arrefecer antes de a colocar no aparelho. • Coloque comida congelada no frigorífico para descongelar. Pode assim utilizar as baixas temperatura dos produtos para arrefecer a comida no frigorífico. • Não deixe a porta do aparelho aberta durante muito tempo quando estiver a colocar comida no interior ou a retirar comida. Quando menor o tempo durante o qual a porta estiver aberta, menor o gelo que se irá formar no congelador. • Limpe regularmente a parte posterior do frigorífico. O pó aumenta o consumo de energia. • Não defina a temperatura para um nível mais frio do que o necessário. • Certifique-se de que a saída de ar do frigorífico é suficiente na base e na parte posterior do mesmo. Não tape as aberturas de ventilação de ar. • Quando instalar, liberte espaço à direita, esquerda, atrás e em cima do frigorífico Isto vai ajudar a reduzir o consumo de energia e também as contas de electricidade.8_ índice índice CONFIGURAR O SEU FRIGORÍFICO 09 09 Preparar a instalação do frigorífico 10 Instalação da linha de água 13 Configurar o frigorífico para uso 13 Remover as portas do frigorífico 17 Nivelar o frigorífico UTILIZAR O SEU FRIGORÍFICO SAMSUNG 18 18 Partes e funções 19 Utilizar o painel de controlo 20 Controlar a temperatura 22 Fazer Gelo 23 Guardar alimentos no frigorífico 23 Guardar alimentos na gaveta do congelador 24 Remover e recolocar os acessórios do frigorífico 25 Remover os acessórios do congelador 26 Utilizar o dispensador de água 27 Limpar o frigorífico 28 Substituir a luz interior (opção) RESOLUÇÃO DE PROBLEMAS 29 29 Resolução de problemasconfigurar _9_ configurar o seu frigorífico 01 CONFIGURAR Parabéns pela sua compra deste Frigorífico Samsung. Esperamos que desfrute das funcionalidades de ponta e da eficiência que este novo aparelho oferece. O mais importante! Certifique-se de que pode mover facilmente o seu Frigorífico até à localização final, medindo as portas (tanto a largura como a altura), os limiares, os tectos, as escadas, etc. • Deixe algum espaço livre dos lados direito, esquerdo, traseiro e superior ao instalar. Este espaço livre irá permitir-lhe economizar no consumo de electricidade e manter as suas facturas de energia eléctrica mais baixas. • Se instalar o Frigorífico num local com menos de 10ºC, pode não funcionar da forma ideal. Quando deslocar o frigorífico Para evitar danos no chão, certifique-se de que as bases de nivelamento frontais estão na posição vertical (acima do chão). Consulte a secção ‘Nivelar o frigorífico’ do manual (na página 17) Chave de parafusos (-) Alavanca de Comando PAVIMENTO Para a instalação correcta, este frigorífico tem de estar colocado numa superfície nivelada de material rígido, com a mesma altura do resto do pavimento. Esta superfície deve ser forte o suficiente para suportar um frigorífico totalmente carregado ou aproximadamente 106 kg. Para proteger o acabamento do pavimento, corte um pedaço grande de cartão e coloque por baixo do frigorífico onde está a trabalhar. Ao mover o frigorífico, certifique-se de que o puxa totalmente para fora e volte a posicioná-lo, empurrando-o para dentro. CUIDADO PREPARAR A INSTALAÇÃO DO FRIGORÍFICO Seleccionar a melhor localização para o Frigorífico • Um local com fácil acesso ao fornecimento de água. • Um local sem exposição directa à luz do sol. • Um local com piso nivelado (ou quase nivelado). • Um local com espaço suficiente para que as portas do Frigorifico abram facilmente. • Permite espaço suficiente para a direita, esquerda, a parte de trás e o topo da unidade para circulação de ar. Se o Frigorífico não tiver espaço suficiente, o sistema de refrigeração interna pode não funcionar correctamente. • Certifique-se de que o aparelho pode ser movimentado livremente para manutenção & reparação. 150mm 100mm 100mm 1368.5mm 817mm 1249.0mm 1504.0mm10_ configurar configurar o seu frigorífico INSTALAÇÃO DO TUBO DE ÁGUA (MODELO COM MÁQUINA DE GELO AUTOMÁTICA) Antes de instalar a linha de água • A instalação da linha de água não é garantida pelo fabricante do frigorífico. Antes de instalar a linha de água, leia os passos completos de instalação e siga cuidadosamente estas instruções para minimizar o risco de danos dispendiosos causados pela água. • A existência de tubos rompidos (tubagem com fissuras) na canalização da casa pode causar danos em partes do frigorífico e causar fugas de água ou inundações. Contacte um canalizador qualificado para corrigir o problema, antes de instalar o cano de fornecimento de água para o frigorífico. • Para evitar queimaduras ou danos no produto, não suspenda o tubo de água por cima do tubo de água quente. • Não instale o cano de água em áreas onde as temperaturas desçam abaixo do ponto de congelação. • Ao utilizar qualquer dispositivo eléctrico (como um berbequim eléctrico) durante a instalação, certifique-se de que o dispositivo está isolado ou ligado de forma a evitar choques eléctricos. • Todas as instalações devem estar de acordo com os requisitos locais para as canalizações. • O kit de tubagem de água e o filtro de água não estão cobertos pela Garantia da Samsung. O fabricante (ou vendedor, instalador) dos mesmos é responsável por quaisquer defeitos e todas as perdas causadas pelo filtro de água e pelo kit de tubagem da água. • O filtro deve ser substituído de acordo com as instruções do fabricante (ou do vendedor). • Para encomendar filtros de água adicionais, por favor contacte o fabricante (ou vendedor) do filtro. Ligar à tubagem de fornecimento de água • Desliguealinhaprincipaldefornecimentodeáguaedesactive a máquina de fazer gelo. • Localize a linha de água potável fria mais próxima. • Siga as instruções do kit de instalação do filtro de água. • Depois de ligar o cano de fornecimento de água à entrada do Suporte do Cartucho e de instalar o Cartucho do Filtro (insira o cano de plástico completamente). • Ligue o fornecimento de água e deite 4 ou mais galões para um balde, para limpar o filtro de água. • O filtro de água tem de estar instalado fora do frigorífico. Não é fornecido com o seu novo frigorífico. O kit do cartucho do filtro (8) e do suporte (9) pode ser adquirido junto do retalhista a quem adquiriu este frigorífico. • Não use um tubo de cobre. • Corte o tubo, certificando-se de que as extremidades ficam planas e limpas. Utilizar o filtro de água (não fornecido) Incorrecto Correcto 90 graus 1. Cano da Água Fria 2. Braçadeira do Tubo 3. Tubo de plástico 4. Porca de Compressão 5. Manga de Compressão 6. Porca de Empanque 7. Válvula de Passagem 8. Cartucho do Filtro 9. Suporte do Cartucho Verifique os acessórios indicados a seguir. Fixador da tubagem da água e parafusos Conector de tubo Tubo de águaconfigurar _11 01 CONFIGURAR Ligue o tubo de água ao frigorífico • Ligue o tubo de plástico na parte de trás do seu frigorífico à saída do suporte do cartucho (insira completamente o tubo de plástico na saída do suporte do cartucho). • Insira o clipe de plástico na entrada e na saída do suporte do cartucho. • Abra a água e verifique se existe alguma fuga. • Pode adquirir o cartucho do filtro no retalhista onde adquiriu este frigorífico. Certifique-se de que compra o cartucho de filtro SAMSUNG (Cartucho de substituição Nº: DA29-00015A) para garantir o melhor desempenho. • O tubo de água deve ser ligado apenas a uma saída de água potável • É fornecido um kit com união de compressão e porca com o aparelho, o qual se encontra na gaveta do frigorífico. • Ao voltar a encostar o Frigorífico, certifique-se de que não o passa por cima do cabo eléctrico ou do tubo de água (Tubo de fornecimento para a máquina de gelo) Suporte do Cartucho clipe Cartucho do Filtro Tubo de plástico (fornecidas) Para utilizar sem o filtro de água 1. Tubagem da Água Fria 2. Braçadeira do Tubo 3. Tubo de plástico 4. Porca de Compressão 5. Manga de Compressão 6. Porca de Empanque 7. Válvula de Passagem Ligar a linha de fornecimento de água • Desligue a linha principal de fornecimento de água e desactive a máquina de fazer gelo. • Localize a linha de água potável fria mais próxima. 1. Em primeiro lugar, feche a linha principal de fornecimento de agua. 2. Localize a linha de água potável fresca mais próxima. 3. Siga as instruções de instalação do tubo de água do kit de instalação. A linha de água deve ser ligada ao tubo de água fria. Se for ligada ao tubo de água quente, este poderá provocar uma avaria do purificador. CUIDADO Fechar o tubo de água principal Fechar o tubo de água principal SEM FOLGA 4. Depois de ligar o fornecimento de água ao filtro de água, volte a ligar o fornecimento de água principal e deite cerca de 3L para limpar e embeber o filtro de água.configurar o seu frigorífico 12_ configurar Ligar a linha de água ao frigorífico 1. Remova a tampa da linha de água na unidade e introduza a porca de compressão na linha de água na unidade depois de a desmontar da linha de agua fornecida. 2. Ligue ambos os tubos de água da unidade e o tubo de água ao kit. 3. Aperte a porca de compressão no acoplamento de compressão. Não devem existir folgas entre (A, B e C) 4. Abra a água e verifique se existe alguma fuga. Desaperte a Remover a tampa Linha de agua da unidade Sem folga Linha de agua da unidade Ligue a linha de água apenas a uma fonte de água potável. Se necessitar de reparar ou desmontar a linha de água, corte 6,5 mm do tubo de plástico para se certificar de que usa uma ligação de boa qualidade sem fugas. • A garantia Samsung não cobre a INSTALAÇÃO DA LINHA DE ÁGUA. • Tal será feito ao encargo do cliente, excepto o preço a retalho, que inclui o custo de instalação. • Se necessário, contacte um canalizador ou instalador autorizado para proceder a instalação. • Casoseverifiquemfugasdeáguadevidoaumainstalaçãoincorrecta, contacte o instalador. Antes de proceder à utilização, devem verificar-se estes locais relativamente a presença de fugas. CUIDADOconfigurar _13 01 CONFIGURAR Agora que tem o seu novo Frigorífico instalado no lugar, está pronto a configurar e a desfrutar das funcionalidades e funções do aparelho. Ao concluir os passos seguintes, o seu Frigorífico deverá ficar totalmente operacional. 1. Coloque o Frigorífico num local adequado com uma distância suficiente entre a parede e o Frigorífico. Consulte as instruções de instalação contidas neste manual. (P8. Seleccionar a melhor localização para o Frigorífico) 2. Quando o Frigorífico estiver ligado, certifique-se de que a luz interior aparece quando abrir as portas. 3. Regule o controlo da temperatura para a temperatura mais fria e aguarde uma hora. O Congelador ficará ligeiramente gelado e o motor funcionará lentamente. 4. Depois de ligar o Frigorífico, demorará algumas horas a atingir a temperatura adequada. Pode guardar alimentos e bebidas no Frigorífico, quando a temperatura estiver suficientemente fria. Chave de Parafusos Phillips (+) Chave de Parafusos de Cabeça Plana (-) Chave de Caixa (10mm) (para parafusos) Chave Hexagonal (3/16 pol.) (para dobradiças médias) Chave hexagonal (5/32 pol.) (para eixo de dobradiça média) Ferramentas Necessárias (Não fornecidas) REMOVER AS PORTAS DO FRIGORÍFICO Algumas instalações requerem a remoção das portas para transportar o Frigorífico para a sua localização final. Não retire a porta se não for necessário. Antes de retirar a porta, certifique-se de que lê os seguintes itens. • Cuidado para não deixar cair a porta, e arranhá-la ou danificá-la enquanto a remove. • Cuidado para não se lesionar enquanto retira a porta. • Depois de voltar a apertar a porta: É possível ocorrer condensação se existir fuga de ar. É possível que a porta esteja desnivelada. É possível que a conta da electricidade aumente. Desligue a corrente do Frigorífico antes de remover a porta. AVISO CONFIGURAR O FRIGORÍFICO PARA USOconfigurar o seu frigorífico 14_ configurar Como inverter a porta (RL62S/RL62U/RL62Z/RL62T) Desligue o frigorífico da tomada ou desligue a corrente. O número em cada imagem indica a localização relevante do frigorífico. Consulte a Imagem de Referência para cada localização. Retire 1 parafuso e desmonte a cobertura da dobradiça superior do lado direito. Desmonte os 2 conectores. Desmonte o fio de terra, retirando 1 parafuso, e desmonte a dobradiça superior direita, retirando os 3 parafusos. Proceda com precaução para evitar danificar os fios. Cuidado para não se inclinar sobre o frigorífico ao desapertar o parafuso. Retire a porta do frigorífico, levantando-a para cima. Cuidado para não deixar cair ou arranhar a porta do frigorífico. (A cobertura da dobradiça média pode sair com a porta do frigorífico.) Desmontar a cobertura da dobradiça média. (A cobertura da dobradiça média pode sair com a porta do frigorífico, ao remover a porta.) Imagem de Referência 1 2 3 6 5 4 7 8 9 10 14 13 12 11 1 1 1 2 1 3 2 Peças para reverter a porta. Pode encontrar essas peças no compartimento da porta, no interior do frigorífico.01 CONFIGURAR configurar _15 3 Cobertura Tampa Cobertura Retire 2 pernos de cada dobradiça, e retire as dobradiças da parte inferior direita e esquerda. Separe o eixo da dobradiça inferior, utilizando uma chave de 5/32 e desmontando a perna da dobradiça inferior, rodando-a no sentido dos ponteiros do relógio, e depois monte a dobradiça inferior, rodando-a. Separe a cobertura do lado da perna frontal esquerda da Tampa e insira-a do lado da perna frontal direita da Tampa. Volte a apertar a antiga dobradiça direita do lado esquerdo, e a antiga dobradiça esquerda do lado direito, utilizando 2 pernos. Separe o batente, retirando 1 parafuso do lado inferior direito do congelador, e monte o batente do lado esquerdo, revertendo-o. Volte a colocar a tampa da cobertura da dobradiça inferior. Retire 1 parafuso (use uma chave de parafusos) e 2 pernos (use uma chave allen de 3/16), e retire a dobradiça a meio do lado direito. Retire a porta do congelador, levantando a para cima. (A cobertura da dobradiça inferior pode sair com a porta do congelador.) Cuidado para não deixar cair ou arranhar a porta do congelador. Separe a cobertura da perna frontal, retirando 2 parafusos. 3 4 11 4 3 4 4 3 10 2 4 Coberturaconfigurar o seu frigorífico 16_ configurar Monte os 2 conectores. (Se não ficar ligado, aparece uma mensagem de erro no visor) ① 8 13 14 6 6 6 6 7 1 Cubra a cobertura da dobradiça média. Retire 1 cobertura e 3 parafusos do lado esquerdo do frigorífico, onde irá apertar a dobradiça média esquerda. (Consultar a figura da esquerda.) E volte a colocar na posição da antiga dobradiça média do lado direito, como na figura da direita. Para retirar os 2 parafusos de plástico, agarre-os com pinças (alicate, pinça, tenaz), enquanto os roda com a chave de parafusos (+). 5 2 2 5 1 2 3 Volte a colocar a porta do congelador na dobradiça do lado inferior esquerdo. Volte a colocar a dobradiça do lado médio esquerdo. Pode encontrá-la na caixa de ferramentas de instalação fornecida com o seu novo frigorífico Samsung. Volte a apertar, utilizando 1 parafuso e 2 porcas. (Deve utilizar a chave de parafusos (+) para os parafusos, e a chave para as porcas.) Monte a dobradiça superior esquerda do lado esquerdo, utilizando 3 parafusos, e volte a apertar o fio de terra, utilizando 1 parafuso. Pode encontrar a dobradiça na caixa de ferramentas de instalação fornecida com o seu novo frigorífico Samsung. (Cuidado para não se inclinar sobre a porta do frigorífico e para não danificar o fio.) Retire o batente (①), removendo os 3 parafusos do lado direito. (Consulte a figura.) E volte a colocá-lo do lado direito. Retire os 3 parafusos do lado esquerdo. (Consulte a figura.) A seguir, substitua o batente (①) separado do lado direito. Volte a apertar, utilizando os 3 parafusos removidos do lado esquerdo, no lado esquerdo. Depois de retirar a cobertura do lado superior esquerdo da porta do frigorífico, volte a apertar a porta do frigorífico do lado direito. Separe a cobertura do lado superior esquerdo do frigorífico, removendo 1 parafuso, e volte a apertar do lado superior direito. (Cuidado para não danificar o revestimento do fio.) Volte a colocar a cobertura da dobradiça superior esquerda, utilizando 1 parafuso. Pode encontrá-la na caixa de ferramentas de instalação, fornecida com o seu novo frigorífico Samsung. Verifique o alinhamento da porta, a abertura e o funcionamento da lâmpada interior, ao abrir as portas do frigorífico e do congelador.NIVELAR O FRIGORÍFICO Depois de voltar a colocar as portas no Frigorífico, certifique-se de que o Frigorífico está nivelado, para efectuar os ajustes finais. Se o Frigorífico não estiver nivelado, as portas não fecharão de modo perfeitamente uniforme. Além disso, pode causar fugas no frigorífico, fazendo aumentar a conta da electricidade. Por exemplo, se o lado esquerdo estiver mais abaixo do que o direito, insira uma chave de parafusos de pontas planas num entalhe da alavanca de controlo esquerda, e rode no sentido dos ponteiros do relógio ou no sentido contrário para nivelar a porta. Rode no sentido dos ponteiros do relógio para levantar o frigorífico, e no sentido contrário para o baixar. Se o lado esquerdo estiver acima, use a alavanca direita. Quando o lado esquerdo está mais baixo. Quando o lado esquerdo está mais alto. Chave de parafusos (-) Chave de parafusos (-) Alavanca de Comando Alavanca de Comando Ambas as alavancas de controlo devem tocar no chão para evitar possíveis lesões pessoais ou AVISO danos materiais devido à inclinação. 01 CONFIGURAR configurar _17utilizar o seu frigorífico Samsung Use esta página para se familiarizar com as peças e funcionalidades do Frigorífico. PEÇAS E FUNCIONALIDADES Luz do Frigorífico Prateleira Multiusos da Porta Frigorífico Prateleiras do Frigorífico Tabuleiro Móvel (Localização ajustável) Gavetas para Fruta e Legumes Máquina de Gelo Gaveta de Puxar Para Fora Prateleira para Garrafas Prateleira para Garrafas Luz do Congelador Prateleira Multiusos da Porta 18_ utilizar Reservatório de Água (Opção)02 UTILIZAR utilizar _19 ( 1 ) Botão Power Freeze Prima este botão para congelar rapidamente os alimentos. (O Power Freeze dura 2 horas e meia.) ( 2 ) Botão Freezer (congelador) Botão de regulação da temperatura do congelador. Prima este botão para definir a temperatura do Congelador entre -14ºC e -25ºC. (Ao ligar inicialmente, a predefinição é -19ºC.) ( 3 ) Botão Desactivar Gelo (Opção) Quando o Botão Desactivar Gelo é premido, não é produzido gelo. Use esta função apenas quando for necessário. ( 3 ) Botão Desactivar Alarme (Opção) Quando o Botão Desactivar Alarme for premido, o alarme não soa, caso a porta esteja aberta. Use este botão apenas quando for necessário. ( 4 ) Botão Power Cool Prima este botão para arrefecer rapidamente os alimentos no frigorífico. (O Power Cool desliga-se quando são atingidos -4ºC ou após 2 horas e meia.) ( 5 ) Botão Fridge (frigorífico) Botão de regulação da temperatura do frigorífico. Prima este botão para definir a temperatura do Frigorífico em intervalos de 1ºC entre 7ºC e 1ºC. (Ao ligar inicialmente, a predefinição é de 3ºC.) ( 6 ) Premir o Botão de Bloqueio durante 3 seg Ao premir este botão durante 3 seg., a função de visualização fica bloqueada ou desbloqueada. (Bloquear ou desbloquear tecla) UTILIZAR O PAINEL DE CONTROLO Painel de selecção / controlo da Temperatura e Funções 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 1. Para modelo com máquina de gelo automática 2. Para modelo com máquina de gelo normalutilizar o seu frigorífico Samsung CONTROLAR A TEMPERATURA Configurar a temperatura do congelador - A temperatura do Congelador mudará, dependendo do número de aberturas de porta, da quantidade de alimentos, da temperatura ambiente, etc. - A temperatura de cada prateleira do congelador pode ser diferente. - O visor da temperatura pisca quando a temperatura do congelador aumentar, devido à abertura frequente da porta, à introdução de alimentos quentes, etc. (Para de piscar quando o frigorífico atingir a temperatura normal. Se, por algum motivo, não parar depois de um longo período de tempo, contacte um centro de assistência da Samsung.) Ao seleccionar a temperatura, a temperatura definida é visualizada inicialmente durante 5 segundos, a seguir, é indicada a temperatura actual. (Pode existir uma ligeira diferença entre a temperatura definida e a temperatura actual visualizada, mas será automaticamente corrigida para a temperatura definida.) 20_ utilizar Se desejar controlar a temperatura do congelador, proceda como indicado acima. Prima o botão Freezer (Consulte a imagem) - A temperatura pode ser definida em intervalos de 1ºC, entre -25ºC e -14ºC. - Sempre que o Botão Freezer for premido, a definição da temperatura muda da forma seguinte; (-19ºC → -20ºC → -21ºC → -22ºC → -23ºC → -24ºC → -25ºC → -14ºC → -15ºC → -16ºC → -17ºC → -18ºC → -19ºC) Configurar a temperatura do frigorífico Se desejar controlar a temperatura do frigorífico, proceda como indicado acima. Prima o botão Fridge (Consulte a imagem) - A temperatura pode ser definida em intervalos de 1ºC, entre 1ºC e 7ºC. - Sempre que o Botão Fridge for premido, a definição da temperatura muda da forma seguinte; (3ºC → 2ºC → 1ºC → 7ºC → 6ºC → 5ºC → 4ºC → 3ºC)Ao seleccionar a temperatura do frigorífico, a temperatura definida é visualizada inicialmente durante 5 segundos; a seguir, é indicada a temperatura actual. (Pode existir uma ligeira diferença entre a temperatura definida e a temperatura actual visualizada, mas será automaticamente corrigida para a temperatura definida.) - A temperatura do Frigorífico mudará, dependendo do número de aberturas de porta, da quantidade de alimentos, da temperatura ambiente, etc. - A temperatura de cada prateleira ou caixa do frigorífico pode ser diferente. - O visor da temperatura pisca quando a temperatura do frigorífico aumentar, devido à abertura frequente da porta, à introdução de alimentos quentes, etc. (Para de piscar quando o frigorífico atingir a temperatura normal. Se, por algum motivo, não parar depois de um longo período de tempo, contacte um centro de assistência da Samsung.) A função Power Cool opera durante 2 horas e meia, independentemente da temperatura ambiente. utilizar _21 02 UTILIZAR Como fazer gelo mais rápido (Controlar a Potência de Congelamento) Acelera o tempo necessário para congelar produtos no congelador. Pode ser útil se necessitar de congelar rapidamente itens que vertem com facilidade ou se a temperatura do congelador aumentar dramaticamente (Por exemplo, se a porta for deixada aberta). Esta função tem de ser activada antes de colocar alimentos grandes no compartimento do congelador, pelo menos 24 horas antes. Se desejar acelerar a refrigeração no Frigorífico (Power Cool) Prima o botão Power Cool. (Consulte a figura.) - A luz Power Cool acende-se no visor (ver a marca da seta) e esta função começa a funcionar, independentemente da temperatura definida do frigorífico. Prima novamente o Botão Power Cool para cancelar esta função. - A luz desliga-se e o frigorífico volta a funcionar com a temperatura definida. Modo de Refrigeração Desactivada (código “OF & OF” no visor) Esta função destina-se a frigoríficos de loja com visor. Não se destina a um uso particular. No Modo deRefrigeraçãoDesactivada, o frigorífico funciona, mas não produz arfresco.Para cancelar este modo, pressione os botões “Power Freeze” e “Freezer” simultaneamente durante 3 segundos ate ouvir um som tipo “Dingdong”. CUIDADO Modo de Refrigeração Desactivadautilizar o seu frigorífico Samsung 22_ utilizar A máquina de gelo produzirá 8 cubos por ciclo - aproximadamente 100~130 cubos num período de 24 horas, dependendo da temperatura do compartimento do congelador, da temperatura ambiente, do número de aberturas de porta e de outras condições de utilização. Deite fora os primeiros cubos de gelo para deixar limpar o cano de água. Certifique-se de que nada interfere com o varrimento do braço do alimentador. Quando o cesto enche até ao nível do braço do alimentador, a máquina de gelo pára de produzir gelo. Depois de a máquina de gelo ser novamente ligada, existe algum atraso antes da mesma retomar a operação. É normal se alguns cubos saírem juntos. Se o gelo não for utilizado com frequência, os cubos de gelo antigos tornamse enevoados, com um sabor bafiento e encolhem. Se não pretender fazer gelo, prima o botão Ice Off. Modelo com Máquina de Gelo Automática Retire o gelo, utilizando a pá Modelo com Tabuleiro de Gelo 1. Puxe para fora o tabuleiro de gelo. 2. Deixe água por cima do tabuleiro de gelo. 3. Coloque o tabuleiro de gelo no cesto de gelo. Feche a porta do congelador. Botão de Teste 1 2 3 FAZER GELO Modelo Twist Icemaker 1. Puxe para fora os recipientes para cubos de gelo. 2. Encha-os de água até à marca (seta) do nível de água. 3. Volte a colocar os recipientes para cubos de gelo na sua posição original e feche a porta do congelador. 4. Quando a água estiver congelada, rode para despejar os cubos de gelo para o respectivo compartimento. 1 2 3 4GUARDAR ALIMENTOS NO FRIGORÍFICO O Frigorífico Samsung foi concebido para lhe fornecer o máximo espaço, sem poupar nas funções e funcionalidades. Existem alguns compartimentos personalizados que criámos para manter os seus alimentos frescos por mais tempo. Para evitar que os odores se propaguem pelo compartimento de gelo, os alimentos armazenados devem ser bem embrulhados, de forma a entrar ar o menos possível. Tabuleiro Móvel Pode ser utilizado para guardar pequenos alimentos lácteos, como manteiga ou margarina, iogurte ou cubos de queijo fundido. manteiga/queijo Prateleira para Garrafas Concebidos para suportar elementos grandes e volumosos, tais como garrafas de leite ou outras garrafas e recipientes grandes. Prateleiras do Frigorífico Concebidas para resistirem ao choque, as prateleiras podem ser utilizadas para todos os tipos de alimentos e bebidas. As marcas circulares na superfície do vidro são um fenómeno normal e normalmente podem ser limpas com um pano húmido. Gavetas para Fruta e Legumes Utilizada para preservar a frescura dos seus vegetais e frutos armazenados. Esta gaveta foi especificamente concebida para controlar o nível de humidade dentro do compartimento. Mantenha os legumes e a fruta separados, se possível Não coloque alimentos grandes por baixo da lâmpada do Frigorífico. Está localizado um sensor de ar perto da lâmpada; se o sensor ficar bloqueado, o seu Frigorífico pode arrefecer demasiado. Coloque os Legumes e a Fruta nas Gavetas de Legumes e Fruta, para evitar que congelem. Se os alimentos no interior do Frigorífico congelarem, aumente a temperatura. GUARDAR ALIMENTOS NA GAVETA DO CONGELADOR Gaveta de Puxar Para Fora Ideias para guardar carne e alimentos secos. Os alimentos armazenados devem ser colocados num recipiente ou embrulhados, utilizando película de plástico ou outros materiais adequados. Cesto da Gaveta do Congelador Pode ser utilizado para guardar carne e alimentos secos. Os alimentos armazenados devem ser colocados num recipiente ou embrulhados, utilizando película de plástico ou outros materiais adequados. As garrafas devem ser guardadas juntas, para não tombarem e caírem quando a porta do Frigorífico abrir. Se estiver a planear afastar-se durante muito tempo, esvazie o Frigorífico e desligue-o. Limpe a humidade em excesso do interior do aparelho e deixe as portas abertas. Isto ajuda a evitar o desenvolvimento de odores e bolor. utilizar _23 02 UTILIZARutilizar o seu frigorífico Samsung REMOVER E ALTERAR A DISPOSIÇÃO DOS ACESSÓRIOS DO FRIGORÍFICO Método de remoção de pó – Retire a protecção e lave com água. Não ajuste um cesto cheio de alimentos. 1. Compartimentos das portas Para remover: levante simplesmente o cesto e puxe-o para fora. Para voltar a colocar: deslize-o para a localização pretendida e empurre para baixo até parar. Podem ocorrer danos se os cestos da porta não ficarem firmemente inseridos. Não deixe crianças a brincarem com os cestos. Os cantos afiados dos cestos podem causar lesões. CUIDADO 2. Prateleiras do frigorífico Para remover: ao puxar a prateleira para fora, se esta não deslizar facilmente, levante-a ligeiramente e puxe-a para fora outra vez. Para voltar a colocar: ao empurrar a prateleira, se esta não deslizar facilmente, levante-a ligeiramente e puxe-a para dentro outra vez. As prateleiras de vidro são pesadas. CUIDADO Use um cuidado especial ao removê-las. As gavetas precisam de ser retiradas antes da prateleira de vidro de cima poder ser levantada. 3. Gavetas para Fruta e Legumes Para remover: puxe a gaveta para fora até ao máximo. Incline para cima a parte da frente da gaveta e puxe para fora. Para voltar a colocar: insira a gaveta nas calhas e volte a empurrar para o lugar. 1 2 24_ utilizarREMOVER OS ACESSÓRIOS DO CONGELADOR 1. Gaveta de Puxar Para Fora Para remover: puxe a gaveta para fora até ao máximo.Incline para cima a parte de trás da gaveta e levante-a para fora. (Consulte as figuras 1 e 2) Abra completamente a porta do congelador e retire a gaveta. Para voltar a colocar: coloque a gaveta sobre as calhas, inclinando-a para cima. Baixe a gaveta até ficar horizontal e deslize-a para dentro. (Consulte a figura 3) 2. Cesto da Gaveta do Congelador Para remover: puxe a gaveta completamente para fora. Incline para cima a parte de trás do cesto e levante-o para o retirar. Para voltar a colocar: coloque o cesto sobre as calhas. Ao voltar a colocar, coloque o suporte da gaveta no orifício da calha. utilizar _25 02 UTILIZAR 3 1 2 2 1 Para obter a melhor eficiência energética deste produto, deixe todas as prateleiras, gavetas e cestos na sua posição original, conforme está apresentado na página (18). Se o dispensador de água não estiver a ser utilizado, recomenda-se o seguinte 1. Aperte bem o dispositivo de fornecimento de água ao orifício de fixação. • A porta não fecha automaticamente se o dispositivo de fornecimento de água estiver puxado para fora durante muito tempo, devido a uma fuga de ar frio. 2. Coloque uma garrafa de água sobresselente para o reservatório de água. • Podem ser utilizadas duas garrafas de 1,5 litro. 3. Defina o dispositivo de bloqueio para “LOCK” • Ao premir o botão “PUSH” com o dispositivo de fornecimento de água apenas fixado no orifício de fixação, e o dispositivo de bloqueio definido para “OPEN”, o dispositivo de fornecimento de água pode ser removido do orifício de fixação e ocorrem fugas. utilizar o seu frigorífico Samsung Ao permitir o acesso a crianças, defina o dispositivo de bloqueio para “LOCK”. Encher o reservatório de água 1. Abra o reservatório de água, removendo a tampa redonda e enchendo com água potável. (Não use água quente.) • Encha o reservatório até ao nível completo (logo abaixo de 4,2 litros). 2. Volte a colocar a tampa redonda, carregando para baixo até clicar no lugar. 3. Coloque um copo no suporte para copos e carregue na alavanca “PRESS”. 1 2 3 Descrição Alavanca de pressão Dispositivo de bloqueio Tampa do reservatório de água Reservatório de água Dispositivo de fornecimento de água 26_ utilizar Pode obter facilmente água fresca através do dispensador de água, sem abrir a porta do frigorífico. Além disso, pode poupar electricidade, reduzindo o número de vezes em que a porta é aberta, em mais de 30%. UTILIZAR O DISPENSADOR DE ÁGUA (OPÇÃO)02 UTILIZAR utilizar _27 Limpar o interior Limpe as paredes interiores e os acessórios com um detergente suave e seque com um pano macio. Pode remover as gavetas e prateleiras para uma limpeza mais completa. Certifique-se de que seca as gavetas e as prateleiras antes de voltar a colocá-las no lugar. Cuidar do seu Frigorífico Samsung prolonga a duração do seu aparelho, e conserva-o sem odores e germes. Painel de visualização Limpar o exterior Limpe o painel de visualização com um pano húmido, limpo e macio. Não pulverize água directamente sobre a superfície do Frigorífico. As superfícies das portas, pegas e armários deverão ser limpas com um detergente suave e secas a seguir com um pano macio. Para que o seu aparelho tenha sempre uma boa aparência, devera polir o exterior uma ou duas vezes por ano. Não use gasolina, diluente, detergente para automóveis ou cloro para a limpeza. Estes podem danificar a superfície do aparelho e causar incêndios. CUIDADO Limpar os vedantes de borracha das portas Se os vedantes de borracha das portas estiverem sujos, as portas podem não fechar correctamente e o Frigorífico pode não funcionar com eficiência. Mantenha os vedantes das portas livres de areia e sujidade, limpando-os com um detergente suave e um pano húmido. Seque com um pano macio limpo. Limpar atrás do Frigorífico Para manter os cabos e as partes expostas livres de pó e de acumulação de sujidade, aspire atrás do aparelho uma ou duas vezes por ano. Não remova a cobertura posterior. Pode causar um choque eléctrico. CUIDADO LIMPAR O FRIGORÍFICOSUBSTITUIR A LUZ INTERIOR (OPÇÃO) Substituir a Luz Interior do Frigorífico 1. Desligue o cabo eléctrico da tomada. 2. Puxe a protecção para baixo, empurrando para trás para remover. 3. A lâmpada pode estar quente, por isso tenha cuidado ao tocar na lâmpada. 4. Rode a lâmpada no sentido contrário aos ponteiros do relógio. 5. Volte a montar pelo sentido inverso da desmontagem. escudo Antes de mudar alguma das luzes interiores, desligue o Frigorífico da fonte de alimentação. Se não tiver a certeza sobre como mudar as luzes depois de ler estas instruções, contacte o centro de assistência Samsung para obter ajuda. CUIDADO Substituir a Luz Interior da Gaveta do Congelador 1. Desligue o cabo eléctrico da tomada. 2. Puxe a gaveta para fora até ao máximo. 3. Puxe a protecção para baixo, empurrando para trás para remover. 4. A lâmpada pode estar quente. Cuidado ao tocar na lâmpada. 5. Rode a lâmpada no sentido contrário aos ponteiros do relógio. 6. Volte a montar pelo sentido inverso da desmontagem. Não introduza os dedos no interior da cobertura. CUIDADO A lâmpada pode estar quente. utilizar o seu frigorífico Samsung 28_ utilizar Para a lâmpada do LED, contacte o técnico de assistência técnica para a substituir.resolução de problemas _29 03 RESOLUÇÃO DE PROBLEMAS PROBLEMA SOLUÇÃO O Frigorífico não funciona ou não refrigera o suficiente. • Verifique se a ficha de alimentação eléctrica esta ligada correctamente. • O controlo de temperatura no painel digital esta definido para a temperatura correcta? Experimente colocar o frigorífico numa temperatura mais baixa. • O Frigorífico está exposto à luz solar directa ou está localizado perto de uma fonte de calor? • A parte de trás do Frigorífico está tão próxima da parede que o ar não possa circular? (Consulte a página 10 para a melhor localização.) Os alimentos no interior do Frigorífico estão congelados. • O controlo da temperatura no visor está definido para a temperatura correcta? Experimente definir o frigorífico para uma temperatura mais quente. • A temperatura do quarto está demasiado baixa? • Guardou os alimentos demasiado perto da abertura de ventilação na parte de trás do Frigorífico? Afaste os alimentos da abertura de ventilação. Escuta ruídos ou sons invulgares. • Verifique se o Frigorífico está nivelado e estável. • A parte de trás do Frigorífico está tão próxima da parede que o ar não possa circular? • Caiu alguma coisa atrás ou por baixo do Frigorífico? • Um som de “tique” é escutado no interior do Frigorífico. Este som é normal e ocorre porque vários acessórios estão a contrair-se e a expandir-se, consoante a temperatura no interior do Frigorífico. Os cantos frontais e a secção articulada horizontal do aparelho ficam quentes, e ocorre a condensação. • É normal algum calor, porque estão instalados anticondensadores na secção articulada horizontal do Frigorífico para evitar a condensação. • A porta do Frigorífico está entreaberta? Pode ocorrer condensação se deixar a porta aberta durante um longo período de tempo. A Máquina de Gelo não produz gelo. (Opção) • Aguardou 12 horas após a instalação da linha de fornecimento de água antes de fabricar gelo? • O cano de água está ligado e a válvula de passagem está aberta? • Parou manualmente a função de fabrico de gelo? • A temperatura do Congelador está demasiado quente? Tente reduzir a temperatura do Congelador. Escuta água a borbulhar no Frigorífico. • Isto é normal. O borbulhar é a circulação do líquido refrigerante a circular pelo Frigorífico. O Frigorífico apresenta um mau odor. • Verifique se existem alimentos derramados. • Os alimentos com odores fortes (por exemplo, peixe) devem estar bem cobertos. • Limpe periodicamente o seu Congelador e deite fora qualquer alimento derramado ou suspeito. Há formação de gelo nas paredes do Congelador. • A abertura de ventilação está bloqueada? Retire quaisquer objectos que estejam a causar obstrução de modo a que o ar possa circular livremente. • Deixe espaço suficiente entre os alimentos armazenados para uma circulação de ar eficiente. • A gaveta do Congelador está correctamente fechada? resolução de problemasmemomemoNum esforço para promover a reciclagem, este manual do utilizador é impresso em papel reciclado. Portugal Eliminação Correcta Deste Produto (Resíduos de Equipamentos Eléctricos e Electrónicos) Esta marca apresentada no produto, nos acessórios ou na literatura – indica que o produto e os seus acessórios electrónicos (por exemplo, o carregador, o auricular, o cabo USB) não deverão ser eliminados juntamente com os resíduos domésticos no final do seu período de vida útil. Para impedir danos ao ambiente ou à saúde humana causados pela eliminação incontrolada de resíduos, deverá separar estes equipamentos de outros tipos de resíduos e reciclá-los de forma responsável, para promover uma reutilização sustentável dos recursos materiais. Os utilizadores domésticos deverão contactar o estabelecimento onde adquiriram este produto ou as entidades oficiais locais para obterem informações sobre onde e de que forma podem entregar estes equipamentos para permitir efectuar uma reciclagem segura em termos ambientais. Os utilizadores profissionais deverão contactar o seu fornecedor e consultar os termos e condições do contrato de compra. Este produto e os seus acessórios electrónicos não deverão ser misturados com outros resíduos comerciais para eliminação. Limites da temperatura ambiente Este frigorífico combinado foi concebido para funcionar em temperaturas ambiente especificadas pela classe indicada na placa de classificação. NOTA: As temperaturas internas podem ser afectadas por factores como, por exemplo, a localização do frigorífico combinado, a temperatura ambiente e a frequência de vezes com que abre a porta. Ajuste a temperatura conforme seja necessário para realizar a compensação devido a estes factores. Classe Símbolo Intervalo de temperatura ambiente (°C) Temperatura alargada SN +10 a +32 Temperado N +16 a +32 Subtropical ST +16 a +38 Tropical T +16 a +43 Contacte SAMSUNG GLOBAL Se tem algumas dúvidas ou comentários sobre os produtos Samsung, contacte por favor a nossa linha de apoio a clientes Samsung. SAMSUNG ELECTRÓNICA PORTUGUESA, Lagoas Park, Edifício 5B, Piso 0, 2740-298 Porto Salvo, Portugal 808 20 - SAMSUNG(7267864) www.samsung.com/pt ENG This user manual includes detailed usage instructions for your camera. Please read this manual thoroughly. USER MANUAL1 Copyright information • Camera specifications or contents of this manual may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of camera functions. • You are not allowed to reuse or distribute any part of this manual without prior permission. • We recommend using your camera within the country where you purchase it. • Use this camera responsibly and adhere to all laws and regulations concerning its use. PlanetFirst represents Samsung Electronics' commitment to sustainable development and social responsibility through eco-driven business and management activities. • Microsoft Windows and the Windows logo are registered trademarks of the Microsoft Corporation. • Mac and Apple App Store are registered trademarks of the Apple Corporation. • Google Play Store is a registered trademark of Google, Inc. • Adobe, the Adobe logo, Photoshop and Lightroom are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries. • microSD™, microSDHC™, and microSDXC™ are registered trademarks of the SD Association. • HDMI, the HDMI logo, and the term “High Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. • Wi-Fi®, the Wi-Fi CERTIFIED logo, and the Wi-Fi logo are registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance. • Trademarks and trade names used in this manual are the property of their respective owners.2 Health and safety information Prevent damage to subjects’ eyesight. Do not use the flash in close proximity (closer than 1 m/3 ft) to people or animals. If you use the flash too close to your subject’s eyes, this can cause temporary or permanent eyesight damage. Keep your camera away from small children and pets. Keep your camera and all accessories out of the reach of small children and animals. Small parts may cause choking or serious injury if swallowed. Moving parts and accessories may present physical dangers as well. Do not expose the camera to direct sunlight or high temperatures for an extended period of time. Prolonged exposure to sunlight or extreme temperatures can cause permanent damage to your camera’s internal components. Avoid covering the camera or charger with blankets or clothes. The camera may overheat, which may distort the camera or cause a fire. Do not handle the power supply cord or go near the charger during a thunderstorm. This may result in electric shock. Always comply with the following precautions and usage tips to avoid dangerous situations and ensure peak performance of your camera. Warning—situations that could cause injury to yourself or others Do not disassemble or attempt to repair your camera. This may result in electric shock or damage to the camera. Do not use your camera near flammable or explosive gases and liquids. This may cause a fire or explosion. Do not insert flammable materials into the camera or store these materials near the camera. This may cause a fire or electric shock. Do not handle your camera with wet hands. This may result in electric shock.3 Health and safety information If liquid or foreign objects enter your camera, immediately disconnect all power sources, such as the battery or charger, and then contact a Samsung service center. Comply with any regulations that restrict the use of a camera in a certain area. • Avoid interference with other electronic devices. • Turn off the camera when in an aircraft. Your camera can cause interference with aircraft equipment. Follow all airline regulations and turn off your camera when directed by airline personnel. • Turn off the camera near medical equipment. Your camera can interfere with medical equipment in hospitals or health care facilities. Follow all regulations, posted warnings, and directions from medical personnel. Avoid interference with pacemakers. Maintain the distance between this camera and all pacemakers to avoid potential interference, as recommended by the manufacturer and research groups. If you have any reason to suspect that your camera is interfering with a pacemaker or other medical device, turn off the camera immediately and contact the manufacturer of the pacemaker or medical device for guidance. Caution—situations that could cause damage to your camera or other equipment Remove the batteries from your camera when storing it for an extended period of time. Installed batteries may leak or corrode over time and cause serious damage to your camera. Use only authentic, manufacturer-recommended, Lithium-ion replacement batteries. Do not damage or heat the battery. Inauthentic, damaged, or heated batteries may cause a fire or personal injury. Use only Samsung-approved batteries, chargers, cables and accessories. • Using unauthorized batteries, chargers, cables or accessories can cause batteries to explode, damage your camera, or cause injury. • Samsung is not responsible for damage or injuries caused by unapproved batteries, chargers, cables or accessories. Use the battery only for its intended purpose. Misusing the battery may cause a fire or electric shock.4 Health and safety information Do not touch the flash while it fires. The flash is very hot when fired and may burn your skin. When you use the AC charger, turn off the camera before you disconnect the power to the AC charger. Failing to do so may result in fire or electric shock. Disconnect the charger from the wall socket when not in use. Failing to do so may result in fire or electric shock. Do not use a damaged power supply cord, plug, or loose outlet when you charge batteries. This may cause a fire or electric shock. Do not allow the AC charger to come in contact with the +/- terminals on the battery. This may cause a fire or electric shock. Do not drop or subject the camera to strong impacts. Doing so may damage the screen or external or internal components. Exercise caution when you connect cables and install batteries and memory cards. If you force the connectors, improperly connect cables, or improperly install batteries and memory cards, you can damage ports, connectors, and accessories. Keep cards with magnetic strips away from the camera case. Information stored on the card may be damaged or erased. Never use a damaged battery, or memory card. This may result in electric shock or camera malfunction or cause a fire. Do not place the camera in or near magnetic fields. Doing so may cause the camera to malfunction. Do not use the camera if the screen is damaged. If the glass or acrylic parts are broken, visit a Samsung service center to have the camera repaired.5 Health and safety information Check that the camera is operating properly before use. The manufacturer takes no responsibility for any loss of files or damage that may result from camera malfunction or improper use. You must plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. Do not expose the lens to direct sunlight. This may discolor the image sensor or cause it to malfunction. If the camera overheats, remove the battery and allow it to cool down. • Prolonged usage of the camera may overheat the battery and raise the internal temperature of the camera. If the camera stops operating, remove the battery and allow it to cool down. • High internal temperatures may result in noise in your photos. This is normal and does not affect your camera’s overall performance. Avoid interference with other electronic devices. Your camera emits radio frequency (RF) signals that may interfere with unshielded or improperly shielded electronic equipment, such as pacemakers, hearing aids, medical devices, and other electronic devices in homes or vehicles. Consult the manufacturers of your electronic devices to solve any interference problems you experience. To prevent unwanted interference, use only Samsung-approved devices or accessories. Use your camera in the normal position. Avoid contact with your camera’s internal antenna. Data transference and your responsibilities • Data transferred via WLAN could be leaked, so avoid transferring sensitive data in public areas or on open networks. • The camera manufacturer is not liable for any data transfers that infringe on copyrights, trademarks, intellectual property laws, or public decency ordinances.6 Indications used in this manual Mode indications Mode Indication Smart Auto t Program P Aperture Priority A Shutter Priority S Manual M Lens Priority i Smart s Wi-Fi B Icons used in this manual Icon Function Additional information Safety warnings and precautions [ ] Camera buttons. For example, [Shutter] represents the shutter button. ( ) Page number of related information → The order of options or menus you must select to perform a step; for example: Select 1→Quality (represents select 1, and then Quality). * Annotation7 Contents Chapter 1 My Camera Getting started ............................................................................................ 29 Unpacking.................................................................................................................... 29 Camera layout .............................................................................................. 30 Using the DIRECT LINK button ................................................................................ 32 Inserting the battery and memory card ................................................. 33 Removing the battery and memory card ........................................................... 33 Using the memory card adapter ............................................................................. 33 Charging the battery and turning on your camera .............................. 34 Charging the battery................................................................................................ 34 Turning on your camera ......................................................................................... 34 Performing the initial setup ...................................................................... 35 Selecting functions (options) ................................................................... 36 Selecting with buttons ............................................................................................ 36 Selecting by touch .................................................................................................... 36 Using m .............................................................................................................. 37 E.g. Selecting the photo size in P mode ............................................................. 37 Using the Smart panel ............................................................................................. 38 E.g. Adjust the exposure value in P mode ......................................................... 38 Tips Concepts in Photography Shooting postures....................................................................................... 13 Holding the camera ..................................................................................................... 13 Standing photography ............................................................................................... 13 Crouching photography ............................................................................................ 14 Using the display .......................................................................................................... 14 Low-angle shot .............................................................................................................. 15 High-angle shot ............................................................................................................. 15 Aperture ........................................................................................................ 16 Aperture value and the depth of field .................................................................. 17 Shutter speed ............................................................................................... 18 ISO sensitivity .............................................................................................. 19 How the aperture setting, shutter speed, and ISO sensitivity control exposure ......................................................................................... 20 Correlation between focal length, angle, and perspective ................ 21 Depth of field ............................................................................................... 22 What controls out-of-focus effects? ....................................................................... 22 Optical preview ............................................................................................................. 24 Composition ................................................................................................. 24 Rule of Thirds .................................................................................................................. 24 Photos with two subjects .......................................................................................... 25 Flash ............................................................................................................... 26 Flash guide number ..................................................................................................... 26 Bounce Photography .................................................................................................. 278 Contents Display icons ................................................................................................ 40 In Shooting mode ..................................................................................................... 40 Capturing photos ........................................................................................................ 40 Recording videos ......................................................................................................... 41 About the level gauge ............................................................................................... 41 In Playback mode ...................................................................................................... 42 Viewing photos ............................................................................................................ 42 Playing videos ............................................................................................................... 42 Changing the information displayed ................................................................. 43 Lenses ............................................................................................................ 44 Lens layout ................................................................................................................... 44 Locking or unlocking the lens ................................................................................. 45 Lens markings ............................................................................................................ 47 Accessories ................................................................................................... 48 External flash layout ................................................................................................. 48 Connecting the external flash ................................................................................. 49 GPS module layout (optional) .............................................................................. 51 Attaching the GPS module .................................................................................... 51 Shooting modes .......................................................................................... 53 t Smart Auto mode ..................................................................................... 53 P Program mode ....................................................................................................... 55 Program Shift ................................................................................................................ 56 Minimum shutter speed ............................................................................................ 56 A Aperture Priority mode ..................................................................................... 57 S Shutter Priority mode.......................................................................................... 58 M Manual mode ....................................................................................................... 59 Framing mode .............................................................................................................. 59 Using the Bulb function ............................................................................................ 60 i Lens Priority mode ............................................................................................. 60 Using E ............................................................................................................. 60 Using i-Function in P/A/S/M modes ................................................................ 61 Using Z .............................................................................................................. 63 s Smart mode ........................................................................................................ 64 Using the Best Face mode ........................................................................................ 65 Capturing panoramic photos .................................................................................. 66 Recording a video ..................................................................................................... 68 3D mode ....................................................................................................................... 69 Available functions by shooting mode ............................................................. 719 Contents Chapter 2 Shooting Functions Size and Resolution .................................................................................... 73 Photo size ..................................................................................................................... 73 Quality ........................................................................................................................... 74 ISO sensitivity .............................................................................................. 75 White Balance .............................................................................................. 76 Customizing preset White Balance options ....................................................... 77 Picture Wizard (photo styles) .................................................................... 79 AF mode ........................................................................................................ 80 Single AF ....................................................................................................................... 81 Continuous AF ............................................................................................................ 81 Manual focus ............................................................................................................... 82 AF area ........................................................................................................... 83 Selection AF ................................................................................................................ 83 Multi AF ......................................................................................................................... 84 Face detection AF ...................................................................................................... 84 Self-Portrait AF ........................................................................................................... 85 Touch AF ........................................................................................................ 86 Touch AF ....................................................................................................................... 86 AF Point ......................................................................................................................... 86 Tracking AF .................................................................................................................. 86 One touch shot .......................................................................................................... 87 Focus assist ................................................................................................... 88 MF Assist ....................................................................................................................... 88 Focus Peaking ............................................................................................................. 88 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) ............................................................. 89 Drive (shooting method) ........................................................................... 90 Single ............................................................................................................................. 90 Continuous .................................................................................................................. 90 Burst ............................................................................................................................... 91 Timer .............................................................................................................................. 91 Auto Exposure Bracketing (AE Bracket) ............................................................. 92 White Balance Bracketing (WB Bracket) ............................................................ 92 Picture Wizard Bracketing (P Wiz Bracket) ........................................................ 93 Bracketing setting ..................................................................................................... 93 Flash ............................................................................................................... 94 Reducing the red-eye effect .................................................................................. 95 Adjusting the flash intensity ................................................................................. 95 Metering ........................................................................................................ 97 Multi ............................................................................................................................... 97 Spot ................................................................................................................................ 98 Center-weighted ....................................................................................................... 98 Measuring the exposure value of the focus area ........................................... 99 Dynamic Range ......................................................................................... 100 Smart Filter ................................................................................................. 101 Exposure compensation .......................................................................... 102 Exposure lock ............................................................................................. 103 Video functions ......................................................................................... 104 Movie size.................................................................................................................. 104 Movie quality ........................................................................................................... 104 Multi Motion ............................................................................................................ 105 Fader ........................................................................................................................... 105 Voice ............................................................................................................................ 106 Wind cut .................................................................................................................... 106 Mic Level .................................................................................................................... 10610 Contents Chapter 3 Playback/Editing Searching and managing files ................................................................ 108 Viewing photos ....................................................................................................... 108 Viewing image thumbnails ................................................................................. 108 Viewing files by category .................................................................................... 109 Viewing files as a folder ........................................................................................ 109 Protecting files ........................................................................................................ 110 Lock/Unlock all files .................................................................................................. 110 Deleting files ............................................................................................................ 111 Deleting a single file ................................................................................................. 111 Deleting multiple files .............................................................................................. 111 Deleting all files .......................................................................................................... 112 Viewing photos .......................................................................................... 113 Enlarging a photo .................................................................................................. 113 Viewing a slide show ............................................................................................. 113 Auto rotating ........................................................................................................... 114 Creating a print order (DPOF) ............................................................................ 114 Playing videos ............................................................................................ 115 Trimming a video during playback .................................................................. 115 Capturing an image during playback ............................................................. 116 Editing photos ........................................................................................... 117 Cropping a photo ................................................................................................... 117 Rotating a photo .................................................................................................... 118 Resizing photos....................................................................................................... 118 Adjusting your photos .......................................................................................... 119 Retouching faces .................................................................................................... 120 Reducing red-eye ................................................................................................... 120 Applying Smart Filter effects .............................................................................. 121 Chapter 4 Wireless network Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings ............... 123 Connecting to a WLAN ......................................................................................... 123 Setting network options ......................................................................................... 124 Manually setting the IP address ........................................................................... 124 Using the login browser....................................................................................... 125 Network connection tips ..................................................................................... 126 Entering text ............................................................................................................ 127 Saving files to a smart phone automatically ....................................... 128 Sending photos or videos to a smart phone ....................................... 129 Using a smart phone as a remote shutter release .............................. 131 Using Auto Backup to send photos or videos ..................................... 133 Installing the program for Auto Backup on your PC.................................. 133 Sending photos or videos to a PC .................................................................... 133 Sending photos or videos via email ...................................................... 135 Changing email settings ...................................................................................... 135 Storing your information ........................................................................................ 135 Setting an email password ..................................................................................... 136 Changing the email password .............................................................................. 137 Sending photos or videos via email ................................................................ 137 Using photo or video sharing websites ................................................ 139 Accessing a website .............................................................................................. 139 Uploading photos or videos............................................................................... 140 Using AllShare Play to send files ............................................................ 141 Uploading photos to online storage ............................................................... 141 Viewing photos or videos on devices that support AllShare Play ........ 142 Sending photos using Wi-Fi Direct ........................................................ 14411 Contents Chapter 6 Connecting to external devices Viewing files on an HDTV or 3D TV ........................................................ 158 Viewing files on an HDTV .................................................................................... 158 Viewing files on a 3D TV ....................................................................................... 159 Transferring files to your computer ....................................................... 160 Transferring files to your Windows OS computer ....................................... 160 Connecting the camera as a removable disk ................................................... 160 Disconnecting the camera (for Windows XP) .................................................. 161 Transferring files to your Mac OS ...................................................................... 161 Using programs on a PC........................................................................... 163 Installing programs from the provided CD ................................................... 163 Available programs when using i-Launcher .................................................... 163 Using i-Launcher .................................................................................................... 163 Requirements for Windows OS ............................................................................. 163 Requirements for Mac OS ....................................................................................... 164 Opening i-Launcher .................................................................................................. 164 Using Multimedia Viewer ........................................................................................ 165 Downloading the firmware .................................................................................... 166 Downloading the PC Auto Backup program ................................................... 166 Installing Adobe Photoshop Lightroom ........................................................ 167 Using Adobe Photoshop Lightroom ............................................................... 167 Chapter 5 Camera settings menu User settings ............................................................................................... 146 ISO Customizing ..................................................................................................... 146 ISO Step ......................................................................................................................... 146 Auto ISO Range .......................................................................................................... 146 Noise Reduction ..................................................................................................... 146 Bracket Set ................................................................................................................ 147 DMF (Direct Manual Focus) ................................................................................ 147 Color space ............................................................................................................... 148 Distortion Correct .................................................................................................. 149 Touch Operation ..................................................................................................... 149 iFn Customizing ...................................................................................................... 149 User Display .............................................................................................................. 149 Key Mapping ............................................................................................................ 150 Grid Line .................................................................................................................... 151 AF Lamp ..................................................................................................................... 151 Setting ......................................................................................................... 15212 Contents Before contacting a service center ........................................................ 181 Camera specifications .............................................................................. 184 Glossary ....................................................................................................... 189 Optional accessories ................................................................................. 195 Index ............................................................................................................ 197 FCC notice ................................................................................................... 200 Chapter 7 Appendix Error messages .......................................................................................... 169 Maintaining the camera........................................................................... 170 Cleaning the camera ............................................................................................. 170 Camera lens and display ......................................................................................... 170 Image sensor ............................................................................................................... 170 Camera body ............................................................................................................... 170 Using or storing the camera ............................................................................... 171 Inappropriate places to use or store the camera ........................................... 171 Using on beaches or shores ................................................................................... 171 Storing for extended period of time ................................................................... 171 Using the camera with caution in humid environments ............................ 172 Other cautions ............................................................................................................ 172 About memory card .............................................................................................. 173 Supported memory card ........................................................................................ 173 Memory card capacity ............................................................................................. 174 Cautions when using memory cards .................................................................. 176 About the battery .................................................................................................. 177 Battery specifications ............................................................................................... 177 Battery life .................................................................................................................... 178 Low battery message ............................................................................................... 178 Notes about using the battery .............................................................................. 178 Cautions about using the battery ........................................................................ 179 Notes about charging the battery ....................................................................... 179 Notes about charging with a computer connected...................................... 180 Handle and dispose of batteries and chargers with care ............................ 18013 Concepts in Photography Standing photography Compose your shot; stand up straight with your feet shoulder-length apart, and keep your elbows pointed down. Shooting postures A correct posture for stabilizing the camera is necessary for taking a good photo. Even if you hold a camera correctly, the wrong posture can cause the camera to shake. Stand up straight and remain still to maintain a steady base for your camera. When shooting with a slow shutter speed, hold your breath to minimize body movement. Holding the camera Hold the camera with your right hand and place you right index finger on the shutter button. Place your left hand under the lens for support.14 Concepts in Photography Crouching photography Compose your shot, crouch with one knee touching the ground, and keep a straight posture. Using the display To take photos at high or low angles, tilt the display up or down. You can tilt the display up to 90° upwards ( ) or 45° downwards ( ). • Keep the display closed ( ) when the camera is not in use. • Tilt the display only within the angle allowed. Failing to do so may damage your camera.15 Concepts in Photography Low-angle shot A low-angle shot is a shot from a camera positioned below your eyeline, looking up the subject. High-angle shot A high-angle shot is a shot from a camera positioned above your eyeline, looking down on the subject.16 Concepts in Photography Aperture The aperture, a hole that controls the amount of light that enters the camera, is one of the three factors that determine the exposure. The aperture housing contains thin, metal plates that open and close to let light through the aperture and into the camera. The size of the aperture is closely related to the brightness of a photo: the larger the aperture, the brighter the photo; the smaller the aperture, the darker the photo. Aperture sizes Minimum aperture Medium aperture Maximum aperture Darker photo (aperture opened slightly) Brighter photo (aperture opened wide) The size of the aperture is represented by a value known as an “F-number.” The f-number represents the focal length divided by the diameter of the lens. For example, if a lens with a 50 mm focal length has an f-number of F2, the diameter of the aperture is 25 mm. (50 mm/25 mm=F2) The smaller the f-number, the greater the size of the aperture. The opening in the aperture is described as the Exposure Value (EV). Increasing the Exposure Value (+1 EV) means the amount of light doubles. Decreasing the Exposure Value (-1 EV) means the amount of light halves. You can also use the exposure compensation feature to fine-tune the amount of light by subdividing exposure values into 1/2, 1/3 EV, and so on. +1 EV F1.4 F2 F2.8 F4 F5.6 F8 -1 EV Exposure Value Steps17 Concepts in Photography Aperture value and the depth of field You can blur or sharpen the background of a photo by controlling the aperture. It is closely related to the depth of field (DOF), which can be expressed as small or large. A photo with a large DOF A photo with a small DOF The aperture housing contains several blades. These blades move together and control the amount of light passing through the center of the aperture. The number of blades also affects the shape of light when shooting night scenes. If an aperture has an even number of blades, light divides into an equal number of sections. If the number of blades is odd, the number of sections is double the number of blades. For example, an aperture with 8 blades divides light into 8 sections and an aperture with 7 blades into 14 sections. 7 blades 8 blades18 Concepts in Photography Shutter speed Shutter speed refers to the amount of time it takes to open and close the shutter, and it is an important factor in the brightness of a photo, as it controls the amount of light which passes through the aperture before it reaches the image sensor. Usually, the shutter speed is manually adjustable. The measurement of the shutter speed is known as the “Exposure Value” (EV), which is marked in intervals of 1 s, 1/2 s, 1/4 s, 1/8 s, 1/15 s, 1/1000 s, 1/2000 s, and so on. Exposure +1 EV -1 EV 1s 1/2 s 1/4 s 1/8 s 1/15 s 1/30 s Shutter Speed Therefore, the faster the shutter speed, the less light will be let in. Likewise, the slower the shutter speed, the more light will be let in. As the photos below illustrate, a slow shutter speed allows more time to let light in, so the photo becomes brighter. On the other hand, a fast shutter speed allows less time to let light in and the photo becomes darker and more easily freezes subjects in motion. 0.8 s 0.004 s19 Concepts in Photography ISO sensitivity The exposure of an image is determined by the sensitivity of the camera. This sensitivity is based on international film standards, known as ISO standards. On digital cameras, this sensitivity rating is used to represent the sensitivity of the digital mechanism that captures the image. ISO sensitivity doubles as the number doubles. For example, an ISO 200 setting is capable of capturing images at twice the speed of an ISO 100 setting. However, higher ISO settings can result in “noise”—small specks, spots, and other phenomena in a photo that give the shot a noisy or dirty appearance. As a general rule, it is best to use a low ISO setting to prevent noise in your photos, unless you are shooting in darkened environments or at night. Changes in the quality and brightness according to ISO sensitivity Because a low ISO sensitivity means the camera will be less sensitive to light, you need more light to have an optimal exposure. When using a low ISO sensitivity, open the aperture more or reduce the shutter speed to allow more light to enter the camera. For example, on a sunny day when light is abundant, a low ISO sensitivity does not require a slow shutter speed. However, in a dark place or at night, a low ISO sensitivity will result in a blurry photo. Therefore, it is recommended to increase the ISO sensitivity by a moderate amount. A photo captured with a tripod and high ISO sensitivity A blurred photo with a low ISO sensitivity20 Concepts in Photography How the aperture setting, shutter speed, and ISO sensitivity control exposure The aperture setting, shutter speed, and ISO sensitivity are closely interconnected in photography. The aperture setting controls the opening that regulates the light that enters the camera, while the shutter speed determines the length of time that light is allowed to enter. ISO sensitivity determines the speed at which the film reacts to light. Together, these three aspects are described as the triangle of exposure. A change in shutter speed, aperture value, or ISO sensitivity can be offset by adjustments to the others to maintain the amount of light. The results, however, change according to the settings. For example, shutter speed is useful in expressing movement, aperture can control the depth of field, and ISO sensitivity can control the graininess of a photo. Settings Results Aperture value Wide aperture = more light Narrow aperture = less light Wide = small depth of field Narrow = large depth of field Settings Results Shutter speed Fast speed = less light Slow speed = more light Fast = still Slow = blurry ISO sensitivity High sensitivity = more sensitive to light Low sensitivity = less sensitive to light High = more grainy Low = less grainy21 Concepts in Photography Correlation between focal length, angle, and perspective Focal length, which is measured in millimeters, is the distance between the middle of the lens to its focal point. It affects the angle and perspective of captured images. A short focal length translates into a wide angle, which allows you to capture a wide shot. A long focal length translates into a narrow angle, which allows you to capture telephoto shots. Short focal length wide shot wide angle wide-angle lens Long focal length telephoto shot narrow angle telephoto lens Look at these photos below and compare the changes. 18 mm angle 55 mm angle 200 mm angle Normally, a lens with a wide angle is suitable for shooting landscapes and a lens with a narrow angle is recommended for shooting sports events or portraits.22 Concepts in Photography Depth of field Portraits or still-life photos mostly acclaimed by people are the ones on which the background is out of focus so the subject looks pronounced. Depending on the focused areas, a photo can be blurred or sharpened. This is called ‘a low DOF’ or ‘a high DOF’. The depth of field is the focused area around the subject. Therefore, a small DOF signifies that the focused area is narrow and a large DOF means the focused area is wide. A photo with a small DOF, which stresses the subject and makes the rest of it blurred, can be obtained by using a telescope lens or selecting a low aperture value. Conversely, a photo with a large DOF which shows all the elements on the photo sharply focused can be achieved by using a wide angle lens or selecting a high aperture value. Small Depth of Field Large Depth of Field What controls out-of-focus effects? DOF depends on aperture value The wider the aperture is (namely the lower the aperture value), the lower the DOF becomes. Under the condition where the other values including shutter speed and ISO sensitivity are equal, a low aperture value leads to a photo with a low DOF. 55 mm F5.7 55 mm F2223 Concepts in Photography DOF depends on focal length The longer the focal length is, the lower the DOF gets. A telescope lens with a longer focal length than a telescope lens with a short focal length is better to capture a photo of a low DOF. A photo captured with a 18 mm telescope lens A photo captured with a 100 mm telescope lens DOF depends on the distance between the subject and the camera The shorter the distance between the subject and the camera is, the lower the DOF gets. Therefore, taking a photo close to a subject can result in a photo of low DOF. A photo captured with a 100 mm telescope lens A photo captured close to the subject 24 Concepts in Photography Optical preview You can press the Custom button to view the optical preview before capturing a photo. The camera adjusts the aperture to the predefined settings and shows the results on the screen. Set the Custom button to Optical preview. (p. 150) Composition It is fun to capture a photo of the beauty of world with a camera. No matter how the world is beautiful, however, a poor composition cannot capture the beauty of it. When it comes to composition, it is very important to prioritize subjects. Composition in photography means arranging objects in a photo. Usually, abiding by the rule of thirds leads to a good composition. Rule of Thirds To use the rule of thirds, divide the image into a 3x3 pattern of equal rectangles. To compose photos that best emphasize the subject, make sure the subject is located at one of the corners of the center rectangle.25 Concepts in Photography Using the rule of thirds will create photos with stable and compelling compositions. Below are a few examples. Photos with two subjects If your subject is in one corner of the photo, it creates an unbalanced composition. You can stabilize the photo by capturing a second subject in the opposite corner to balance the weight of the photo. Subject 1 Subject 2 Subject 1 Subject 2 Unstable Stable When taking landscape photos, centering the horizon will create an unbalanced effect. Give more weight to the photo by moving the horizon up or down. Subject 1 Subject 2 Subject 1 Subject 2 Unstable Stable26 Concepts in Photography Flash guide number The model number of a flash refers to the flash’s power, and the maximum amount of light created is represented by a value known as a “guide number.” The bigger the guide number, the more light is emitted from the flash. The guide number is achieved by multiplying the distance from the flash to the subject and the aperture value when the ISO sensitivity is set to 100. Guide number = Flash to Subject Distance X Aperture value Aperture value = Guide number / Flash to Subject Distance Flash to Subject Distance = Guide number / Aperture value Therefore, if you know the guide number of a flash, you can estimate an optimum flash to subject distance when setting the flash manually. For example, if a flash has a guide number of GN 20 and is 4 meters away from the subject, the optimal aperture value is F5.0. Flash Light is one of the most important components in photography. It’s not easy, however, to have an enough amount of light anytime and anywhere. Making use of a flash allows you to optimize light settings and create a variety of effects. Flash, also known as strobe or speed light, helps to create adequate exposure in low-light conditions. It is also useful in light-abundant situations. For example, flash can be used in compensating the exposure of a subject’s shadow or capturing clearly both the subject and the background in backlit conditions. Before correction After correction27 Concepts in Photography Bounce Photography Bounce photography refers to the method of bouncing light off of the ceiling or walls so that the light spreads evenly over the subject. Normally, photos captured with flash may appear unnatural and cast shadows. Subjects in photos captured with bounce photography cast no shadows and look smooth due to evenly spread light.Chapter 1 My Camera Learn about your camera’s layout, display icons, lens, optional accessories, and basic functions.My Camera 29 Getting started Unpacking Check your product box for the following items. Camera (including the body cap and hot-shoe cover) AC adapter/USB cable Rechargeable battery External flash Software CD-ROM (User manual included) Adobe Photoshop Lightroom DVD-ROM Quick Start Guide Strap • The illustrations may differ from your actual items. • You can purchase optional accessories at a retailer or a Samsung service center. Samsung is not responsible for any problems caused by using unauthorized accessories. For information about accessories, refer to page 195.My Camera 30 Camera layout No. Name 1 Mode dial • t: Smart Auto mode (p. 53) • P: Program mode (p. 55) • A: Aperture Priority mode (p. 57) • S: Shutter Priority mode (p. 58) • M: Manual mode (p. 59) • i: Lens Priority mode (p. 60) • s: Smart mode (p. 64) • B: Wi-Fi (p. 122) 2 Jog dial • In the Menu screen: Move to a desired menu item. • In the Smart panel: Adjust a selected option. • In Shooting mode: Adjust shutter speed or aperture value in some shooting modes or change the size of a focus area. • In Playback mode: View thumbnails, enlarge or reduce a photo, or open or close a folder of continuous or burst shots in Playback mode. 3 DIRECT LINK button: Start a preset Wi-Fi function. (p. 32) No. Name 4 Microphone 5 Hot-shoe cover 6 Hot-shoe 7 Eyelet for camera strap 8 Image sensor 9 Internal antenna/NFC tag * Avoid contact with the internal antenna while using the wireless network. 10 Speaker 11 Lens release button 12 Lens mount 13 Lens mount index 14 AF-assist light/Timer lamp 15 Power switch 16 Shutter button 1 2 3 4 5 7 9 10 11 12 13 14 6 4 8 7 16 15My Camera > Camera layout 31 No. Name 1 Video recording button Start recording a video. 2 EV adjust button (p. 102) Press and hold the button, and then scroll the jog dial to adjust the exposure value. In M mode, the aperture value will be adjusted. 3 Fn button Access the Smart panel and fine-tune some settings. 4 o button • In the Menu screen: Save the selected options. • In Shooting mode: Allow you to select a focus area manually in some shooting modes. 5 Navigation button • In Shooting mode -D: View camera settings and change options. - I: Select an ISO value. - C: Select a drive option. - F: Select an AF mode. • In other situations Move up, down, left, right, respectively. No. Name 6 Delete/Custom button • In Shooting mode: Perform the assigned function. (p. 150) • In Playback mode: Delete files. 7 Playback button Enter Playback mode. 8 Status lamp Indicate the status of the camera. • Blinking: When saving a photo, shooting a video, sending data to a computer, connecting to WLAN, or sending a photo. • Steady: When there is no data transfer, when data transfer to a computer is complete, or charging the battery. 9 MENU button Access options or menus. 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 8 9My Camera > Camera layout 32 No. Name 1 USB and shutter release port Connect the camera to a computer or shutter release. Use a shutter release cable with a tripod to minimize camera movement. 2 HDMI port 3 Battery chamber/Memory card cover Insert a memory card and battery. 4 Display • To take photos at high or low angles, tilt the display up or down. (p. 14) • Touch the screen to select a menu or an option. (p. 36) 5 Tripod mount Using the DIRECT LINK button You can turn on the Wi-Fi feature conveniently by pressing [DIRECT LINK]. Press [DIRECT LINK] again to return to the previous mode. Setting the DIRECT LINK button You can select a Wi-Fi function to launch when you press [DIRECT LINK]. (p. 150) To set a DIRECT LINK option, In Shooting mode, press [m] →5→Key Mapping→ DIRECT LINK → an option. 4 5 1 2 3My Camera 33 Inserting the battery and memory card Learn how to insert the battery and an optional memory card into the camera. Memory card Insert a memory card with the goldcolored contacts facing down. Rechargeable battery Insert the battery with the Samsung logo facing up. Removing the battery and memory card Rechargeable battery Battery lock Slide the lock up to release the battery. Memory card Push the card gently until it disengages from the camera, and then pull it out of the slot. Using the memory card adapter To use micro memory cards with this product, a PC, or a memory card reader, insert the card into an adapter. While the status lamp of the camera is blinking, do not remove the memory card or battery. Doing so may damage the data stored on the memory card or your camera.My Camera 34 Charging the battery and turning on your camera Charging the battery Before you use the camera for the first time, you must charge the battery. Plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera, and then plug the other end of the USB cable into the AC adapter. Status lamp • Red light on: Charging • Red light off: Fully charged • Red light blinking: Error • Use only the AC adapter and USB cable supplied with your camera. If you use another AC adapter, the camera battery may not charge or work properly. • You can charge the battery with the USB cable only when the camera is turned off. Turning on your camera Set the Power switch to ON. • To turn your camera off, set the Power switch to OFF. • The initial setup screen appears when you turn on the camera for the first time. (p. 35)My Camera 35 Performing the initial setup When you turn on your camera for the first time, the initial setup screen appears. The language is preset for the country or region where the camera is sold. You can change the language as desired. You can also select an item by touching it on the screen. 1 Press [I] to select Time Zone, and then press [F] or [o]. 2 Press [D/I] to select a time zone, and then press [o]. Back Set Time Zone [GMT +00:00] London [GMT -01:00] Cape Verde [GMT -02:00] Mid-Atlantic [GMT -03:00] Buenos Aires, Sao Paulo [GMT -03:30] Newfoundland 3 Press [I] to select Date & Time, and then press [F] or [o]. Back Set Date & Time Year Month Day Hr Min DST • The screen may differ depending on the language selected. 4 Press [C/F] to select an item (Year/Month/Day/Hr/Min/ DST). 5 Press [D/I] to set the option, and then press [o]. 6 Press [I] to select Date Type, and then press [F] or [o]. 7 Press [D/I] to select a date type, and then press [o]. 8 Press [I] to select Time Type, and then press [F] or [o]. 9 Press [D/I] to select a time type, and then press [o]. 10 Press [m] to finish the initial setup.My Camera 36 Selecting functions (options) Selecting with buttons Scroll the jog dial or press [D/I/C/F] to move, and then press [o] to select an option. Selecting by touch Do not use sharp objects, such as pens or pencils, to touch the screen. You can damage the screen. Touching: Touch an icon to select a menu or an option. AllShare Play MobileLink Remote Viewfinder Auto Backup Email SNS & Cloud Dragging: Touch and hold an area on the screen, and then drag your finger. AutoShare Photo Size Quality ISO White Balance Back SelectMy Camera > Selecting functions (options) 37 Flicking: Gently flick your finger across the screen. • The touch screen may not recognize your inputs if you touch multiple items at the same time. • When you touch or drag the screen, discolorations may occur. This is not a malfunction, but a characteristic of the touch screen. Touch or drag lightly to minimize the discolorations. • The touch screen may not work properly if you use the camera in extremely humid environments. • The touch screen may not work properly if you apply screen protection film or other accessories to the screen. • Depending on the viewing angle, the screen may appear dim. Adjust the brightness or viewing angle to improve the resolution. Using Press [m m] or touch on the screen, and then change shooting options or settings. E.g. Selecting the photo size in P mode 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Press [m] or touch . 3 Press [C] → [D/I] to move to 1, and then press [o]. • You can also touch 1 on the screen. 4 Scroll the jog dial or press [D/I] to move to Photo Size, and then press [o]. • You can also drag the option list, and then touch an option. Back Select AutoShare Photo Size Quality ISO White BalanceMy Camera > Selecting functions (options) 38 5 Scroll the jog dial or press [D/I] to move to an option, and then press [o]. • You can also drag the option list, and then touch an option. • Press [m] or touch Back to go back to the previous menu. Back Set AutoShare Photo Size Quality ISO White Balance 5472x3648 (3:2) 3888x2592 (3:2) 2976x1984 (3:2) 1728x1152 (3:2) 5472x3080 (16:9) 6 Press [m] or touch Back to switch to Shooting mode. Using the Smart panel Press [f] or touch on the screen to access some functions such as Exposure, ISO, and White Balance. E.g. Adjust the exposure value in P mode 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Press [f] or touch .My Camera > Selecting functions (options) 39 3 Press [D/I/C/F] to move to EV, and then press [o]. • You can directly select an option by scrolling the jog dial without having to press [o]. • You can also select an option by touching it. EV : 0.0 Adjust You can adjust some options by dragging them. Back 4 Scroll the jog dial or press [C/F] to adjust the exposure value, and then press [o]. • You can also drag the dial on the screen, and then select Set to adjust the option. EV : 0.0 Back SetMy Camera 40 Display icons Capturing photos 1 2 3 London 1. Shooting information Icon Description Shooting mode Current date Current time GPS activated* London Location information* Memory card not inserted** Auto exposure lock (p. 103) Available number of photos • : Fully charged • : Partially charged • (Red): Empty (recharge the battery) Icon Description Auto focus frame Spot metering area Camera shake Manual focus scale Level gauge (p. 41) Histogram (p. 150) Focus Shutter speed Aperture value Exposure adjustment value ISO sensitivity (p. 75) * These icons appear when you attach an optional GPS module. ** Photos that were captured without inserting a memory card cannot be transferred to a memory card or a computer. 2. Shooting options Icon Description Photo size Drive mode Flash (p. 94) Flash intensity adjustment Metering (p. 97) Icon Description AF mode (p. 80) Focus area Face detection White Balance (p. 76) White Balance micro adjustment Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) (p. 89) ZZ on ratio RAW file Dynamic Range (p. 100) 3. Shooting options (Touch) Icon Description Change Smart mode*** AutoShare Touch AF options Shooting options Smart panel *** This icon appears only when you select Smart mode. The icons displayed will change according to the mode you select or the options you set. In Shooting modeMy Camera > Display icons 41 2. Shooting options Icon Description Video size AF mode (p. 80) Metering (p. 97) White Balance (p. 76) Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) (p. 89) White Balance micro adjustment Fader (p. 105) Multi Motion (p. 105) Voice recording off (p. 106) The icons displayed will change according to the mode you select or the options you set. About the level gauge The level gauge helps you align the camera with the horizontal and vertical lines on the display. If the level gauge is not level, calibrate the level gauge using the Horizontal Calibration function. (p. 152) Vertical Horizontal ▲ Level ▲ Unlevel You cannot use the level gauge when you shoot in portrait orientation. Recording videos 1 2 1. Shooting information Icon Description Shooting mode Current recording time/Available recording time • : Fully charged • : Partially charged • (Red): Empty (recharge the battery) Shutter speed Aperture value Exposure value ISO sensitivity (p. 75)My Camera > Display icons 42 In Playback mode Viewing photos London Information Mode F No Shutter ISO Metering Flash Focal Length White Balance EV Photo Size Date Icon Description Continuously captured file Current file/The total number of files Folder number - File number File with location information London Location information RAW file Protected file Print information added to file (p. 114) 3D file m Playback/Editing menu (Touch) Editing photos (Touch) Trimming a video (Touch) Viewing image thumbnails (Touch) 1 2 3 London No. Description 1 Captured photo 2 RGB histogram (p. 150) 3 Shooting mode, Metering, Flash, White Balance, Aperture value, Shutter speed, ISO, Focal length, Exposure value, Photo size, Date, Location information Playing videos Stop Capture Icon Description Playback speed Multi Motion Current playback time Video length / View previous file/Scan backward. (Each time you touch the scan backward icon, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) / Pause or resume playback. / View next file/Scan forward. (Each time you touch the scan forward icon, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) Adjust the volume or mute the sound.My Camera > Display icons 43 Changing the information displayed Press [D] repeatedly to change the display type. Mode Display type Shooting • Basic shooting information (Shooting mode, Shutter speed, Aperture value, Exposure value, ISO sensitivity, etc.) • Basic shooting information + Shooting option buttons (MENU, Fn, AutoShare, Touch AF) + Level gauge • Basic shooting information + Shooting option buttons + Current shooting options information (Photo size, Drive mode, Flash, Metering, AF mode, etc.) • Basic shooting information + Shooting option buttons + Current shooting options information + Histogram + Date and time Playback • Basic information • Display all information about the current file. • Display all information about the current file including RGB histogram.My Camera 44 Lenses You can purchase optional lenses made exclusively for your NX series camera. Learn about the functions of each lens and select one that suits your needs and preferences. Lens layout SAMSUNG 18-55 mm F3.5-5.6 OIS III lens (example) 1 2 3 5 4 6 7 8 No. Description 1 Lens mount index 2 Zoom ring 3 Focus ring (p. 88) 4 Lens hood mount index 5 Lens 6 i-Function button (p. 60) 7 AF/MF switch (p. 80) 8 Lens contacts When not using the lens, attach the lens cap and lens mount cover to protect the lens from dust and scratches.My Camera > Lenses 45 SAMSUNG 20-50 mm F3.5-5.6 ED II lens (example) 7 1 2 3 5 6 4 No. Description 1 Lens mount index 2 Zoom lock switch 3 Lens 4 Focus ring (p. 88) 5 i-Function button (p. 60) 6 Zoom ring 7 Lens contacts Locking or unlocking the lens To lock the lens, pull and hold the zoom lock switch away from the camera body and rotate the zoom ring as shown in the illustration.My Camera > Lenses 46 To unlock the lens, rotate the zoom ring as shown in the illustation until you hear the click. You cannot capture a photo when the lens is locked. SAMSUNG 16 mm F2.4 lens (example) 5 2 1 4 3 No. Description 1 i-Function button (p. 60) 2 Lens mount index 3 Focus ring (p. 88) 4 Lens 5 Lens contactsMy Camera > Lenses 47 Lens markings Find out what the numbers on the lens signify. SAMSUNG 18-200 mm F3.5-6.3 ED OIS lens (example) 1 2 345 No. Description 1 Aperture value A range of supported aperture values. For example, 1:3.5–6.3 means the maximum aperture value range from 3.5 to 6.3. 2 Focal length The distance from the middle of the lens to its focal point (in millimeters). This figure is expressed in a range: minimum focal length to maximum focal length of the lens. Longer focal lengths result in narrower angles of view and the subject is magnified. Shorter focal lengths result in wider angles of view. 3 ED ED stands for Extra-low Dispersion. Extra-low dispersion glass is effective in minimizing chromatic aberration (a distortion that occurs when a lens fails to focus all colors to the same convergence point). 4 OIS (p. 89) Optical Image Stabilization. Lenses with this feature can detect camera shake and effectively cancel out the movement inside the camera. 5 Ø The lens diameter. When you attach a filter to the lens, make sure that the diameters of the lens and the filter are the same.My Camera 48 Accessories You can use accessories including external flash and GPS module that can help you capture better and more convenient photos. For more information about optional accessories, refer to the manual for each accessory. • The illustrations may differ from the actual items. • You can purchase Samsung-approved accessories at a retailer or a Samsung service center. Samsung is not responsible for damage caused by using another manufacturer's accessories. External flash layout SEF8A (example) 1 2 3 No. Description 1 Bulb 2 Hot-shoe fastening dial 3 Hot-shoe connectionMy Camera > Accessories 49 Connecting the external flash 1 Remove the hot-shoe cover from the camera. 2 Mount the flash by sliding it into the hot-shoe. 3 Lock the flash into place by turning the hot-shoe fastening dial clockwise. 4 Lift up the flash for use.My Camera > Accessories 50 • You can capture a photo with a flash that is not fully charged, but it is recommended to use a fully charged flash. • Refer to the optional accessories page for available external flashes. (p. 195) • The available options may differ depending on the shooting mode. • There is an interval between two bursts of the flash. Do not move until the flash fires a second time. • SEF8A may not be compatible with other NX series cameras. • For more details about optional flashes, refer to the user manual for the flash. Use only Samsung-approved flashes. Using incompatible flashes may damage your camera. SEF220A (example) (optional) 2 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 No. Description 1 Display icons 2 READY lamp/Test button 3 MODE button 4 Flash release button 5 POWER button 6 Battery cover 7 Bulb 8 TELE/WIDE mode switch 9 Hot-shoe connectionMy Camera > Accessories 51 GPS module layout (optional) 1 2 3 4 5 No. Description 1 Status lamp 2 POWER button 3 Hot-shoe fastening dial 4 Hot-shoe connection 5 Battery cover Attaching the GPS module 1 Remove the hot-shoe cover from the camera. 2 Mount the GPS module by sliding it into the hot-shoe.My Camera > Accessories 52 3 Lock the GPS module into place by turning the hot-shoe fastening dial towards LOCK. 4 Press the power button of the GPS module.My Camera 53 Shooting modes Two simple shooting modes—Smart Auto and Smart mode—help you capture photos with numerous automatic settings. Additional modes allow for greater customization of settings. Icon Description t Smart Auto mode (p. 53) P Program mode (p. 55) A Aperture Priority mode (p. 57) S Shutter Priority mode (p. 58) M Manual mode (p. 59) i Lens Priority mode (p. 60) s Smart mode (p. 64) B Wi-Fi features (p. 122) t Smart Auto mode In Smart Auto mode, the camera recognizes surrounding conditions and automatically adjusts factors that contribute to exposure, including shutter speed, aperture value, metering, White Balance, and exposure compensation. As the camera controls most of the functions, some shooting functions are limited. This mode is useful for capturing quick snapshots with the least amount of adjustment.My Camera > Shooting modes 54 1 Rotate the mode dial to t. 2 Align your subject in the frame. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. • The camera selects a scene. An appropriate scene icon appears at the screen. Recognizable scenes Icon Description Landscapes Scenes with bright white backgrounds Landscapes at night Icon Description Portraits at night Landscapes with backlighting Portraits with backlighting Portraits Close-up photos of objects Close-up photos of text Sunsets Indoors, dark Partially lit Close-up with spot lighting Portraits with spot lighting Blue skies Forested areas typically consist of green-colored subjects Close-up photos of colorful subjects Camera is stabilized on a tripod and the subject is not moving for a certain period of time. (when shooting in the dark) Actively moving subjects Fireworks (when using a tripod) 4 Press [Shutter] to capture the photo.My Camera > Shooting modes 55 • The camera may detect different scenes, even the same subjects, depending on external factors such as camera shake, lighting, and distance to the subject. • If the camera does not recognize an appropriate scene mode, it uses the default settings for the Smart Auto mode. • Even if it detects a face, the camera may not select a portrait mode depending on the subject's position or lighting. • Even if you use a tripod, the camera may not detect the tripod mode ( ) if the subject is moving. • The camera consumes more battery power, because it changes settings often to select appropriate scenes. P Program mode The camera automatically adjusts shutter speed and aperture value so that an optimal exposure value can be achieved. This mode is useful when you want to capture shots of constant exposure while being able to adjust other settings. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Set the desired options. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo.My Camera > Shooting modes 56 Program Shift Program Shift function lets you adjust the shutter speed and aperture value while the camera maintains the same exposure. When you scroll the jog dial to the left, the shutter speed decreases and the aperture value increases. When you scroll the jog dial to the right, the shutter speed increases and the aperture value decreases. Minimum shutter speed Set the shutter speed not to be slower than the selected speed. However, if an optimal exposure value cannot be achieved because the ISO sensitivity reached the maximum ISO value that is set by Auto ISO Range, shutter speed may be slower than the selected minimum shutter speed. To set the minimum shutter speed, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Minimum Shutter Speed→ an option. • This feature is available only when the ISO sensitivity is set to Auto. • This feature is available only in Program or Aperture priority mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 57 A Aperture Priority mode In Aperture Priority mode, the camera automatically calculates shutter speed according to the aperture value you choose. You can adjust the depth of field (DOF) by changing the aperture value. This mode is useful for taking portraits, flowers, or landscape shots. Large Depth of Field Small Depth of Field 1 Rotate the mode dial to A. 2 Scroll the jog dial to adjust the aperture value. • You can also adjust the aperture value by pressing [f], moving to the aperture value, and then scrolling the jog dial or dragging the screen. 3 Set the desired options. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • In low-light settings, you may need to increase the ISO sensitivity to prevent blurred photos. • To set the minimum shutter speed, in Shooting mode, press [m] →1 →Minimum Shutter Speed→ an option.My Camera > Shooting modes 58 S Shutter Priority mode In Shutter Priority mode, the camera automatically adjusts the aperture value according to the shutter speed you choose. This mode is useful for capturing photos of fast-moving subjects or for creating tracer effects in a photo. For example, set the shutter speed to over 1/500 s to freeze the subject. To make the subject appear blurred set the shutter speed to below 1/30 s. Slow shutter speed Fast shutter speed 1 Rotate the mode dial to S. 2 Scroll the jog dial to adjust the shutter speed. • You can also adjust the shutter speed by pressing [f], moving to the shutter speed, and then scrolling the jog dial or dragging the screen. 3 Set the desired options. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. In order to compensate for the reduced amount of light allowed by fast shutter speeds, open the aperture and let in more light. If your photos are still too dark, increase the ISO value.My Camera > Shooting modes 59 M Manual mode Manual mode lets you adjust the shutter speed and aperture value manually. In this mode, you can fully control the exposure of your photos. This mode is useful in controlled shooting environments, such as a studio, or when it is necessary to fine-tune camera settings. The Manual mode is also recommended for shooting night scenes or fireworks. 1 Rotate the mode dial to M. 2 Scroll the jog dial to adjust the shutter speed. 3 Press and hold [W], and then rotate the mode dial to adjust the aperture value. • You can also adjust the shutter speed or the aperture value by pressing [f], moving to the shutter speed or the aperture value, and then scrolling the jog dial or dragging the screen. 4 Set the desired options. 5 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. Framing mode When you adjust the aperture value or shutter speed, the exposure changes according to the settings, so the display may darken. With this function on, the brightness of the display is constant regardless of the settings, so you can better frame your shot. To use Framing Mode, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Framing Mode → an option.My Camera > Shooting modes 60 Using the Bulb function Use the Bulb function to shoot night scenes or the night sky. While you are pressing [Shutter], the shutter is left open so you can create moving light effects. To use a bulb, Completely scroll the jog dial to the left to Bulb→ Press and hold [Shutter] for the desired time. • If you set a high ISO value or open the shutter for a long time, image noise may increase. • Drive options, flash, and One touch shot cannot be used with the Bulb function. • The Bulb function is available only in Manual mode. • Use a tripod and shutter release to prevent your camera from shaking. • The longer you open the shutter, the longer it takes to save a photo. Do not turn the camera off while the camera saves a photo. • If you use this function for a long time, use a fully charged battery. i Lens Priority mode You can adjust the depth of field to blur or sharpen the background. Using E 1 Rotate the mode dial to i. 2 Press [i-Function] on the lens to select E. • You can also press [i-Function], and then press [C/F] or drag the screen to select E.My Camera > Shooting modes 61 3 Adjust the focus ring to select a value. • You can also scroll the jog dial to adjust the value. • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the value. Defocus E Sharpen 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • As you sharpen photos, the aperture value Increases and the shutter speed reduces. In dark places, photos may be blurry. • This function is not available when you set 3D Auto Mode in 3D mode. Using i-Function in P/A/S/M modes When you use the i-Function button on an i-Function lens, you can manually select and adjust shutter speed, aperture value, exposure value, ISO sensitivity, and White Balance on the lens. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P, A, S, or M. 2 Press [i-Function] on the lens to select a setting. • You can also press [i-Function], and then press [C/F] or drag the screen to select a setting.My Camera > Shooting modes 62 3 Adjust the focus ring to select an option. • You can also scroll the jog dial or drag the screen to select an option. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. Available options Shooting mode PASM 3D Aperture -O-OShutter Speed - - OO - EV OOO - O ISO OOOO - White Balance OOOOO Z OOOO - • To select items to appear when you press [i-Function] on the lens in Shooting mode, press [m] →5→iFn Customizing→ an item. • This function is not available when you set 3D Auto Mode in 3D mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 63 Using ZThe Z allows you to zoom in on a subject with less degradation of photo quality than the Digital zoom. However, the photo resolution may change compared to when you zoom in by rotating the zoom ring. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P, A, S, M, or i. 2 Press [i-Function] on the lens to select Z. • You can also press [i-Function], and then press [C/F] or drag the screen to select Z. 3 Adjust the focus ring to select a zoom ratio. • You can also scroll the jog dial or drag the screen to select an option. • Photo resolution varies according to the zoom ratio if you use the Z. 3:2 16:9 1:1 x1.2 4560X3040 (13.9M) 4560X2568 (11.7M) 3040X3040 (9.2M) x1.4 3888X2592 (10.1M) 3888X2184 (8.5M) 2592X2592 (6.7M) x1.7 3264X2176 (7.1M) 3264X1840 (6.0M) 2176X2176 (4.7M) x2 2736X1824 (5.0M) 2736X1536 (4.2M) 1824X1824 (3.3M) These figures are based on the maximum resolution at each image ratio. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • Z is not available when you capture burst shots. • Z is not available when you capture photos in the RAW file format. • Z is deactivated when you record videos by pressing the video recording button. • This function is not available when you set 3D Auto Mode in 3D mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 64 s Smart mode In Smart mode, you can capture photos with options that are preset for a specific scene. 1 Rotate the mode dial to s. 2 Select a scene. • To select a shooting mode when the mode dial is set to s, press [f] or touch , and then select a desired mode. Smart : Beauty Face Set Option Description Beauty Face Capture a portrait with options to hide facial imperfections. Best Face Capture multiple photos and replace faces to create the best possible image. Landscape Capture still-life scenes and landscapes. Option Description Macro Capture small or close-up subjects. Action Freeze Capture subjects moving at high speed. Rich Tones Capture a photo with vibrant colors. Panorama Capture a wide panoramic scene in a single photo. Waterfall Capture scenes with waterfalls. Silhouette Capture subjects as dark shapes against a light background. Sunset Capture scenes at sunset, with natural-looking reds and yellows. Night Capture multiple photos in low light conditions without a flash. The camera combines them to create a single image that is brighter and has less blurring. Fireworks Capture scenes with fireworks. Light Trace Capture scenes with the light trailing in low-light conditions. Creative Shot Capture photos with effects applied automatically. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture.My Camera > Shooting modes 65 Using the Best Face mode In Best Face mode, you can capture multiple photos and replace faces to create the best possible image. Use this mode to select the best image for each individual when capturing group photos. 1 Rotate the mode dial to s, and then select Best Face. 2 Align your subject in the frame, and then half-press [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • The camera captures 5 photos consecutively. • The first photo is set as the background image. • The camera automatically detects faces after shooting. 4 Touch a face to replace. 5 Touch the best image from the 5 faces that were captured. • Repeat steps 4 and 5 to replace the rest faces of the photo. • The icon will appear on the image that the camera recommends. 6 Touch to save the photo. • Use a tripod to prevent your camera from shaking. • The resolution is set to 5.9M or smaller.My Camera > Shooting modes 66 Capturing panoramic photos Capture a 2D or 3D panoramic photo. Captured 3D panoramic photos can be viewed only on a 3D TV or 3D monitor. 1 Rotate the mode dial to s, and then select Panorama. 2 Press [m] →1→Panorama→Live Panorama or 3D. 3 Press [m] to return to Shooting mode. 4 Press and hold [Shutter] to start shooting. 5 With [Shutter] pressed, slowly move the camera in the direction you selected. • In 3D Panorama mode, you can capture a scene only in horizontal directions. • An arrow toward the direction of motion is displayed, and the entire shooting image is displayed in the preview box. • When the scenes are aligned, the camera captures the next photo automatically. 6 When you are finished, release [Shutter]. • The camera will automatically save the shots into one photo. • If you release [Shutter] while shooting, the panoramic shooting stops and photos that have been captured are saved.My Camera > Shooting modes 67 • The resolution varies depending on the panoramic photo you captured. • In Panorama mode, some shooting options are not available. • The camera may stop shooting due to the shooting composition or the subject's movement. • In Panorama mode, your camera may not capture the entire last scene if you stop moving the camera to improve the photo quality. To capture the entire scene, move your camera slightly beyond the point where you want the scene to end. • In 3D Panorama mode, your camera may not capture the very beginning or end of a scene due to the nature of the 3D effect. To capture the entire scene, move slightly beyond the beginning and end points you want to capture. • Photos captured with the 3D function are saved in JPEG (2D) and MPO (3D) formats. On your camera's display, you can view only JPEG files. • To view 3D files, connect your camera to a 3D TV or 3D monitor with an optional HDMI cable. While viewing, wear proper 3D glasses. • Capturing photos in 3D Panorama mode may result in a less pronounced 3D effect than those captured with a 3D lens. To increase the 3D effect, attach the optional 3D lens and use 3D mode. (p. 69) • For best results when capturing panoramic photos, avoid the following: - moving the camera too quickly or too slowly - moving the camera too little to capture the next image - moving the camera at irregular speeds - shaking the camera - shooting in dark places - capturing moving subjects nearby - shooting conditions where the brightness or color of light is changing • Photos taken are automatically saved, and shooting is stopped under the following conditions: - if you change the shooting direction while shooting - if you move the camera too rapidly - if you don't move the cameraMy Camera > Shooting modes 68 Recording a video In Shooting mode, you can record Full HD videos (1920X1080) by pressing (Video recording). The camera lets you record a video up to 29 minutes and 59 seconds in length at 60, 30, 24, or 15 fps, and saves the files in MP4 (H.264) format. 60 fps is available only with 1920X1080 and 1280X720 and 24 fps is available only with 1920X810. 15 fps is available only with some Smart Filter options. The sound is recorded via the camera's microphone. You can set the exposure by adjusting the aperture value and shutter speed for the mode you selected. When you use a lens that does not have an AF/MF switch while recording a video, press [F] to deactivate or activate the AF function. When you use the lens that has an AF/MF switch, the AF function works according to the switch’s setting. Select Fader to fade in or out a scene. You can also select Voice, Wind Cut, or other options to set recording options. (p. 106) 1 Rotate the mode dial to t, P, A, S, M, i, or s. • This feature may not work in some modes. 2 Set the desired options. 3 Press (Video recording) to start recording. 4 Press (Video recording) again to stop. • H.264 (MPEG-4 part10/AVC) is the latest video coding format established in 2003 collaboratively by ISO-IEC and ITU-T. Since this format uses a high compression rate, more data can be saved in less memory space. • If you have the image stabilizer option on when shooting a movie, the camera may record the image stabilizer sound. • The zoom sound or other lens sounds may be recorded if you adjust the lens while recording a video. • When using an optional video lens, the autofocus noise is not recorded. • If you remove the camera lens while recording a movie, the recording will be interrupted. Do not change the lens while recording. • If you attach an external microphone while recording a movie, sound will not be recorded through the external microphone. (The previous settings are maintained.) If you remove the external microphone while recording a movie, sound will not be recorded. Turn off the camera before attaching or removing the external microphone. My Camera > Shooting modes 69 • If you change the shooting angle of the camera suddenly while shooting a movie, the camera may not be able to record images accurately. Use a tripod to minimize camera shake. • The camera supports only the Multi AF function when recording a video. You cannot use any other focus area setting functions, such as Face Detection AF. • When the size of a movie file exceeds 4 GB, the camera automatically stops recording even if the maximum recording time (29 minutes and 59 seconds) has not been reached. • If you use a slow writing memory card, the recording of your movie can be interrupted because the card cannot process data at the rate the video is being shot. If this occurs, replace the card with a faster memory card or reduce the video size (for example, from 1280X720 to 640X480). • When formatting a memory card, always format using the camera. If you format on another camera or a PC, you can lose files on the card or cause a change in the capacity of the card. • When you press the video recording button, Z turns off. • While recording a video in the same ISO sensitivity, the screen may be darker than taking a photo. Adjust the ISO sensitivity. • When you record a video in P, A, or S mode, ISO is automatically set to Auto. 3D mode You can capture 3D photos or videos with an optional 3D lens. SAMSUNG 45 mm F1.8 [T6] 2D/3D lens (example) Set the 2D/3D switch on the lens to 3D, and then capture a photo or video 1.5-5 m away from the subject.My Camera > Shooting modes 70 • 3D mode is always on, regardless of the mode dial of the camera, except B. • To use auto 3D options that enable the camera to set shooting options automatically depending on shooting conditions in 3D mode, press [m] →1→3D Auto Mode→On. • To change the 3D recording option, press [m] →6→ 3D REC Mode→ a desired option. * Default Icon Description Side by Side*: Displays two images next to each other. Frame Packing: Displays the images for the left and right eye alternately in frames. • Available shooting options differ compared to other shooting modes. • You can select either 4.1M (2688X1512) or 2.1M (1920X1080) photo size. • The video resolution is set to 1920X1080. • Videos recorded in 3D may be dark or playback may be jittery. • Shooting in low temperatures may result in color distortion in images and may consume more battery power. • You may not be able to shoot properly in conditions below 8.5 LV/900 lux. For best results, capture photos in places with sufficient light. • When you photograph objects that contain polarizing material, such as a display, sunglasses, or a polarizing filter, or use the polarizing material with your lens, the images may appear dark or the 3D effect may not be applied properly. • Use a tripod to prevent your camera from shaking. • If you rotate or tilt the camera vertically while shooting, the 3D effect may not be applied properly. Capture images with the camera in the normal position. • If you shoot in fluorescent lighting or capture images displayed by projectors or TVs, the images may appear black due to the flicker effect. • In 3D mode, the Enlarge x8 option of MF Assist may not be available. • The camera's display shows 3D videos only in 2D. • Photos captured with the 3D function are saved in JPEG (2D) and MPO (3D) formats. On your camera's display, you can view only JPEG files. • To view 3D files, connect your camera to a 3D TV or 3D monitor with an optional HDMI cable. While viewing, wear proper 3D glasses. • You cannot use the flash in 3D mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 71 Available functions by shooting mode For details about shooting functions, see Chapter 2. Press a shortcut for each function. Function Available in Shortcut Photo Size (p. 73) P/A/S/M/i/s*/t/3D* - Quality (p. 74) P/A/S/M/i/s* - ISO (p. 75) P/A/S/M f/I White Balance (p. 76) P/A/S/M f Picture Wizard (p. 79) P/A/S/M f Smart Filter (p. 101) P/A/S/M f AF Mode (p. 80) P/A/S/M/i*/s*/3D* f AF Area (p. 83) P/A/S/M/i*/s* f/F Touch AF (p. 86) P/A/S/M/i/s*/t/3D* - MF Assist (p. 88) P/A/S/M/i/s/t/3D* - Focus Peaking (p. 88) P/A/S/M/i/s/t - Link AE to AF Point (p. 99) P/A/S/M - Function Available in Shortcut Framing Mode (p. 59) P/A/S/M - OIS (Anti-Shake) (p. 89) P/A/S/M/i/s*/t* - Drive (Continuous/ Burst/Timer/ Bracketing) (p. 90) P/A/S/M/i*/s*/t*/3D* f/C Metering (p. 97) P/A/S/M f Dynamic Range (p. 100) P/A/S/M - Flash (p. 94) P*/A*/S*/M*/i*/s*/t* f Exposure compensation (p. 102) P/A/S f/W Exposure lock (p. 103) P/A/S - * Some functions are limited in these modes.Chapter 2 Shooting Functions Learn about the functions you can set in Shooting mode. You can enjoy more customized photos and videos by using the shooting functions.Shooting Functions 73 Shooting Functions Photo size As you increase the resolution, your photo or video will include more pixels, so it can be printed on larger paper or displayed on a larger screen. When you use a high resolution, the file size will also increase. Select a low resolution for photos that will be displayed in a digital picture frame or uploaded to the web. To set the size, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Photo Size→ an option. Icon Size Recommended for 5472x3648 (3:2) Printing on A1 paper. 3888x2592 (3:2) Printing on A2 paper. 2976x1984 (3:2) Printing on A3 paper. 1728x1152 (3:2) Printing on A5 paper. 5472x3080 (16:9) Printing on A1 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 3712x2088 (16:9) Printing on A3 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 2944x1656 (16:9) Printing on A4 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 1920x1080 (16:9) Printing on A5 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 3648x3648 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A1 paper. 2640x2640 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A3 paper. 2000x2000 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A4 paper. 1024x1024 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A5 paper. Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Size and Resolution74 Shooting Functions > Size and Resolution Quality The camera saves photos in either the JPEG or RAW format. Photos captured by a camera are often transformed to the JPEG format and stored in the memory according to the settings of the camera at the time of shooting. RAW files are not transformed to the JPEG format and are stored in the memory without any changes. RAW files have the file extension “SRW”. To adjust and calibrate exposures, White Balances, tones, contrasts, and colors of the RAW files, or to convert them into JPEG or TIFF format, use the Adobe Photoshop Lightroom program found on the supplied DVD-ROM. Ensure you have enough space on the memory card to save photos in the RAW format. To set the quality, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Quality→ an option. Icon Format Description JPEG Super Fine: • Compressed for the best quality. • Recommended for printing in large size. JPEG Fine: • Compressed for better quality. • Recommended for printing in normal size. Icon Format Description JPEG Normal: • Compressed for normal quality. • Recommended for printing in small size or uploading to the web. RAW RAW: • Save a photo without data loss. • Recommended for editing after shooting. RAW+JPEG RAW + S.Fine: Save a photo in both the JPEG (S.Fine quality) and RAW format. RAW+JPEG RAW + Fine: Save a photo in both the JPEG (Fine quality) and RAW format. RAW+JPEG RAW + Normal: Save a photo in both the JPEG (Normal quality) and RAW format. Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Shooting Functions 75 Shooting Functions The ISO sensitivity value represents the sensitivity of camera to light. The larger the ISO value, the more sensitive the camera is to light. Consequently, by selecting a higher ISO sensitivity value, you can capture photos in dim or dark places at faster shutter speeds. However, this may increase electronic noise and result in a grainy photo. To set ISO sensitivity, In Shooting mode, press [I] → an option. Examples ISO 100 ISO 400 ISO 800 ISO 3200 • You can also set the option by pressing [m] →1→ISO→ an option in Shooting mode. • Increase the ISO value in places where flash use is prohibited. You can capture a clear photo by setting a high ISO value without having to secure more light. • Use the Noise Reduction function in order to reduce the visual noise that can appear on photos of a high ISO value. (p. 146) • Available options may differ depending on the shooting conditions. ISO sensitivityShooting Functions 76 Shooting Functions White Balance represents the light source that influences on the color of a photo. The color of a photo depends on the type and quality of the light source. If you want the color of your photo to be realistic, select an appropriate lighting condition to calibrate the White Balance, such as Auto WB, Daylight, Cloudy, Tungsten, or adjust color temperature manually. You can also adjust color for the preset light sources so that the colors of the photo match the actual scene under mixed lighting conditions. To set the White Balance, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→White Balance→ an option. Icon Description Auto WB: Use automatic settings depending on the lighting conditions. Daylight: Select when taking outdoor photos on a sunny day. This option results in photos closest to the natural colors of the scene. Cloudy: Select when taking outdoor photos on a cloudy day or in shadows. Photos captured on cloudy days tend to be more bluish than on sunny days. This option offsets that effect. Icon Description Fluorescent White: Select when shooting under a daylight fluorescent lamp. Especially for white fluorescent light with a color temperature of about 4,200K. Fluorescent NW: Select when shooting under a daylight fluorescent lamp. Especially for white fluorescent light of very white hues with a temperature of about 5,000K. Fluorescent Daylight: Select when shooting under a daylight fluorescent lamp. Especially for white fluorescent light of slightly bluish hue with a temperature of about 6,500K. Tungsten: Select when taking indoor photos under incandescent bulbs or halogen lamps. Incandescent tungsten bulbs tend to have a reddish hue. This option offsets that effect. Flash WB: Select when using a flash. Custom Set: Use your pre-defined settings. You can manually set the White Balance by pressing [D], and then shooting a white sheet of paper. Fill the spot metering circle with the paper and set the White Balance. White Balance77 Shooting Functions > White Balance Icon Description Color Temperature: Manually adjust the color temperature of the light source. Color temperature is a measurement in degrees Kelvin that indicates the specific type of light source. As the color temperature increases, the color distribution becomes cooler. Alternatively, as the color temperature decreases, the color distribution becomes warmer. Press [D], and then adjust the color temperature. Clear sky Fluorescent H Fluorescent L Cloudy Halogen lamp Daylight Tungsten Candle light Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Customizing preset White Balance options You can also customize preset White Balance options. To customize preset options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→White Balance → an option → [D] → scroll the jog dial, or press [D/I/C/F]. White Balance : Daylight Back Set Reset You can also touch an area on the screen.78 Shooting Functions > White Balance Examples Auto WB Daylight Fluorescent Daylight TungstenShooting Functions 79 Shooting Functions Picture Wizard lets you apply different photo styles to your photo to create various looks and emotional moods. You can also create and save your own photo styles by adjusting color, saturation, sharpness, and contrast for each style. There is no rule for which style is suitable in which conditions. Experiment with different styles and find your own settings. To set a photo style, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Picture Wizard → an option. Examples Standard Vivid Portrait Landscape Forest Retro Cool Calm Classic • You can also adjust the value of the preset style settings. Select a Picture Wizard option, press [D], and then adjust color, saturation, sharpness, or contrast. • To customize your own picture wizard, select , , or , and then adjust the color, saturation, sharpness, and contrast. • Picture Wizard options cannot be set with Smart Filter options at the same time. Picture Wizard (photo styles)Shooting Functions 80 Shooting Functions AF mode Learn how to adjust the camera’s focus according to the subjects. You can select a focusing mode appropriate to the subject among Single Auto Focus, Continuous Auto Focus, and Manual Focus. The AF function is activated when you press [Shutter] halfway. In the MF mode, you have to rotate the focus ring on the lens to focus manually. In most cases, you can have a focus by selecting Single AF. Fast moving subjects or subjects of a color similar to the background are difficult to focus. Select an appropriate focusing mode for such instances. If your lens has an AF/MF switch, you must set the switch according to the selected mode. Set the switch to AF when you select Single AF or Continuous AF. Set the switch to MF when you select Manual Focus. When your lens has no AF/MF switch, press [F] to select a desired AF mode. To set the auto focus mode, In Shooting mode, press [F] → an option. • You can also set the option by pressing [m] →1→AF Mode→ an option in Shooting mode. • The available options may differ depending on the lens in use.81 Shooting Functions > AF mode Single AF Single AF is appropriate for shooting a still subject. When you press [Shutter] halfway, the focus fixes in the focus area. The area turns green when the focus is achieved. Continuous AF While you are pressing [Shutter] halfway, the camera continues to automatic focusing. Once the focus area is fixed on the subject, the subject is always in focus even when moving. This mode is recommended for shooting a person on a bicycle, a running dog, or a car racing scene.82 Shooting Functions > AF mode Manual focus You can manually focus on a subject by rotating the focus ring on the lens. The MF Assist function lets you easily achieve a focus. While you are rotating the focus ring, the focus area is magnified. When you use the Focus Peaking function, the color you selected appears on the focused subject. This mode is recommended for shooting an object similar in color to the background, a night scene, or fireworks. If you use this function, you cannot set Touch AF, AF Area, and Link AE to AF Point options.Shooting Functions 83 Shooting Functions The AF area function changes the positions of the focus area. Generally, cameras focus on the nearest subject. When there are a lot of subjects, however, unwanted subjects can be in focus. In order to prevent unwanted subjects from being in focus, change the focus area so that a desired subject is in focus. You can get a clearer and sharper photo by selecting an appropriate focus area. To set the auto focus area, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→AF Area→ an option. • Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. • When the AF/MF switch is set to MF, you cannot change the AF area from the shooting menu. • When you use the Face Detection AF option, the camera focuses on the area with the white frame automatically. • Depending on the Picture Wizard options, Face Detection may not be effective. • When you set manual focus, Face Detection may not be available. • Face Detection may not be effective when: - the subject is far from the camera - it is too bright or too dark - the subject is not facing the camera - the subject is wearing sunglasses or a mask - the subject’s facial expression changes drastically - the subject is backlit or the lighting conditions are unstable Selection AF You can set the focus on an area you want. Apply an out-of-focus effect to make the subject more distinguishable. The focus on the photo below was repositioned and resized so that it fits the subject’s face. To resize or move the focus area, in Shooting mode, press [o]. Use the navigation button to move the focus area. Scroll the jog dial to resize the focus area. AF area84 Shooting Functions > AF area Multi AF The camera displays a green rectangle in places where focus is set correctly. The photo is divided into two or more areas, and the camera obtains focus points of each area. It is recommended for scenery photos. When you press [Shutter] halfway, the camera displays the focus areas as shown in the photo below. Face detection AF The camera focuses on human faces preferentially. Faces of up to 10 people can be detected. This setting is recommended for shooting a group of people. When you press [Shutter] halfway, the camera focuses on faces as shown in the photo below. In cases of shooting a group of people, the camera displays the focus on the nearest person’s face in white and the rest of the people’s faces in gray.85 Shooting Functions > AF area Self-Portrait AF It can be difficult to check whether your face is in focus when you are taking a self-portrait. When this function is on, the beep from the camera gets faster when your face is located at the center of the composition.Shooting Functions 86 Shooting Functions Tracking AF Tracking AF allows you to track and automatically focus on your subject, even when the subject is moving or when you change the shooting composition. White frame: Your camera is tracking the subject. Green frame: Your subject is in focus when you half-press [Shutter]. Red frame: Your camera failed to focus. Select or focus on a focal area that you touch on the screen. Additionally, focus on the subject and capture a photo by touching on the screen. To set Touch AF, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→ Touch AF→ an option. Available options may differ depending on the shooting conditions. Touch AF Touch AF allows you to select and focus on the focus area that you touch on the screen. AF Point The focal area will correspond to the area you touch on the screen and the focus will not be achieved. Touch AF87 Shooting Functions > Touch AF One touch shot You can capture a photo with the touch of your finger. As you touch on a subject, the camera focuses on the subject automatically and captures a photo. • If you do not select a focus area, the Auto Focus function does not work. • Tracking a subject may fail when: - the subject is too small - the subject moves excessively - the subject is backlit or you are shooting in a dark place - colors or patterns on the subject and the background are the same - the subject includes horizontal patterns, such as blinds - the camera shakes excessively • When tracking fails, the feature will be reset. • If the camera fails to track the subject, the focus area will be reset. • If the camera fails to focus, the focus frame will change to red and the focus will be reset.Shooting Functions 88 Shooting Functions In the manual focus mode, you have to rotate the focus ring on the lens to focus. When you use the MF Assist function or the Focus Peaking function, you can achieve a clearer focus. This function is only available on a lens that supports manual focus. MF Assist In the manual focus mode, you can enlarge the scene and easily adjust the focus while rotating the focus ring. To set the manual focus assist, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→MF Assist→ an option. * Default Option Description Off Do not use the MF Assist function. Enlarge x5* The focus area is magnified by 5 times when you rotate the focus ring. * Default Option Description Enlarge x8 The focus area is magnified by 8 times when you rotate the focus ring. Focus Peaking In the manul focus mode, the color you selected appears on the focused subject to help you focus while rotating the focus ring. To set Focus Peaking options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Focus Peaking→ an option. * Default Option Description Level Set a sensitivity for detecting the focused subject. (Off, High, Normal*, Low) Color Set a color to appear on the focused subject. (White*, Red, Green) Focus assistShooting Functions 89 Shooting Functions Use the Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) function to minimize camera shake. OIS may not be available with some lenses. Camera shake tends to occur in dark places or when shooting indoors. In such cases, the camera uses slower shutter speeds in order to increase the amount of light taken in, which can result in a blurry photo. You can prevent this situation by using the OIS function. If your lens has an OIS switch, you have set the switch to ON to use the OIS function. To set OIS options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→OIS (Anti-Shake) → an option. * Default Icon Description Off: The OIS function is off. (This option may not be available with some lenses.) Mode 1*: The OIS function is applied only when you press [Shutter] in full or half. Mode 2: The OIS function is on. Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) Without OIS correction With OIS correction • OIS may not function properly when: - you move your camera to follow a moving subject - there is too much camera shake - the shutter speed is slow (for example, when you select Night in s mode) - the battery is low - you capture a close-up shot • If you use the OIS function with a tripod, your images may be blurred by the vibration of the OIS sensor. Deactivate the OIS function when you use a tripod. • If the camera is hit or dropped, the display will be blurry. If this occurs, turn off the camera, and then turn it on again. • Use the OIS function only when needed because the function consumes more battery power. • To set an OIS option on the menu, set the OIS switch on your lens to ON. • This option may not be available with some lenses. • Off may not be available with some lenses.Shooting Functions 90 Shooting Functions You can set the shooting method such as Continuous, Burst, Timer and so on. Select Single to capture one photo at a time. Select Continuous or Burst to shoot fast moving subjects. Select AE Bracket, WB Bracket, or P Wiz Bracket to adjust exposure, White Balance, or apply Picture Wizard effects. You can also select Timer to capture a photo of yourself. To set the shooting method, In Shooting mode, press [C] → an option. • You can also set the option by pressing [m] →1→Drive→ an option in Shooting mode. • Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Single Capture one photo whenever you press [Shutter]. Recommended for general conditions. Continuous Continuously capture photos while you are pressing [Shutter]. You can capture up to 5 photos (Continuous Normal) or 8.6 photos (Continuous High) per second. If you select Continuous High, the noise reduction function is not available. Drive (shooting method)91 Shooting Functions > Drive (shooting method) Burst Consecutively capture up to 10 shots per second (3 seconds), 15 shots per second (2 seconds), or 30 shots per second (1 second) when you press [Shutter] once. It is recommended for shooting the rapid motion of fast moving subjects such as racing cars. • To set the number of shots, in Shooting mode, press [C] → Burst, and then press [D]. • The photo size is set to 5M. • It may take longer to save a photo. • You cannot use the flash with this option. • Shutter speed must be faster than 1/30 second. • Photos captured with this option may be slightly enlarged when saving. • You cannot set an ISO option higher than ISO 3200. • This option cannot be used with the RAW file format and is not available when the photo quality is set to RAW. Timer Capture a photo with a delay of 2 to 30 seconds. The delay is adjustable in increments of 1 second. To set the delay, in Shooting mode, press [C] →Timer, and then press [D].92 Shooting Functions > Drive (shooting method) Auto Exposure Bracketing (AE Bracket) When you press [Shutter], the camera captures 3 consecutive photos: the original, one a step darker, and one a step lighter. Use a tripod to prevent blurry photos as the camera captures three photos continuously. You can adjust the settings in Bracket Set menu. Exposure -2 Original Exposure +2 White Balance Bracketing (WB Bracket) When you press [Shutter], the camera captures 3 consecutive photos: the original and two more with different White Balance settings. The original photo is captured when you press [Shutter]. The other two are automatically adjusted according to the White Balance you have set. You can adjust the settings in Bracket Set menu. WB-2 Original WB+2 This option cannot be used with the RAW file format and is not available when the photo quality is set to RAW.93 Shooting Functions > Drive (shooting method) Picture Wizard Bracketing (P Wiz Bracket) When you press [Shutter], the camera captures three consecutive photos, each with a different Picture Wizard setting. The camera captures a photo and applies the three Picture Wizard options you have set to the image captured. You can select three different settings in Bracket Set menu. Vivid Standard Retro This option cannot be used with the RAW file format and is not available when the photo quality is set to RAW. Bracketing setting You can set up the options for AE Bracket, WB Bracket, and P Wiz Bracket. (p. 147) To set a bracketing option, In Shooting mode, press [m] →5→Bracket Set→ an option.Shooting Functions 94 Shooting Functions In order to capture a realistic photo of a subject, the amount of light should be constant. When the light source varies, you can use a flash and supply a constant amount of light. Select appropriate settings according to a light source and a subject. To set flash options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Flash→ an option. Icon Description Off: Do not use the flash. Smart Flash: The camera automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash according to the amount of light in the surrounding environment. Auto: The flash automatically fires in dark places. Auto Red-eye: The flash automatically fires and reduces red-eyes. Fill in: The flash fires whenever you capture a photo. (Brightness is automatically adjusted.) Fill-in Red: The flash fires whenever you capture a photo and reduces red-eyes. Icon Description 1st Curtain: The flash fires immediately after the shutter opens. The camera captures a photo of a subject earlier in an action sequence clearly. Ball moving direction 2nd Curtain: The flash fires just before the shutter closes. The camera captures a photo of a subject later in an action sequence clearly. Ball moving direction • The available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. • There is an interval between two bursts of the flash. Do not move until the flash fires a second time. • If you select Off, the flash does not fire even when an external flash is attached. Use only Samsung-approved flashes. Using incompatible flashes may damage your camera. Flash95 Shooting Functions > Flash Reducing the red-eye effect If the flash fires when you capture a photo of a person in the dark, a red glow may appear in the eyes. To reduce the red-eye effect, select Auto Red-eye or Fill-in Red. Without red-eye reduction With red-eye reduction If the subject is too far from the camera or moves when the first flash fires, redeyes may not be reduced. Adjusting the flash intensity When the flash is on, adjust the flash intensity +/-2 levels. To set the flash intensity, In Shooting mode, press [f] →Flash→ an option → [D] → scroll the jog dial or press [C/F] to adjust the flash intensity. Back Set Flash : 0.096 Shooting Functions > Flash • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the intensity. • Adjusting the flash intensity may not be effective when: - the subject is too close to the camera - you set a high ISO sensitivity - the exposure value is too big or too small • In some shooting modes, you cannot use this function. • If you attach an intensity-adjustable external flash to the camera, the intensity settings of the flash will be applied. • If the subject is too close when you use the flash, some light may be blocked, resulting in a dark photo. Ensure that the subject is within the recommended range, which varies by lens. • When a lens hood is attached, the light from the flash can be blocked by the hood. Remove the hood to use the flash.Shooting Functions 97 Shooting Functions The metering mode refers to the way in which a camera measures the quantity of light. The camera measures the amount of light in a scene, and in many of its modes, uses the measurement to adjust various settings. For example, if a subject looks darker than its actual color, the camera captures an overexposed photo of it. If a subject looks lighter than its actual color, the camera captures an underexposed photo of it. The brightness and overall mood of the photo can also be affected by how the camera measures the amount of light. Select an appropriate setting for a shooting condition. To set a metering option, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Metering→ an option. Multi The Multi mode calculates the amount of light in multiple areas. When light is sufficient or insufficient, the camera adjusts the exposure by averaging the overall brightness of the scene. This mode is suitable for general photos. Metering98 Shooting Functions > Metering Spot The Spot mode calculates the amount of light in the center. When you capture a photo in conditions where there is a strong backlight behind a subject, the camera adjusts the exposure so as to shoot a subject correctly. For example, when you select the Multi mode in a strong backlight condition, the camera calculates that the overall amount of light is abundant, which results in a darker photo. The Spot mode can prevent this situation as it calculates the amount of light in a designated area. The subject is in bright color while the background is dark. The Spot mode is recommended for a situation like this where a huge difference in the exposure exists between a subject and a background. Center-weighted The Center-weighted mode calculates a broader area than the Spot mode does. It sums up the amount of light in the center portion of the shot (60–80 %) and that of the rest of the shot (20–40 %). It is recommended for situations where there is a slight difference in brightness between a subject and a background or an area of the subject is large compared to the overall composition of the photo.99 Shooting Functions > Metering Measuring the exposure value of the focus area When this function is turned on, the camera automatically sets an optimal exposure by calculating the brightness of the focus area. This function is only available when you select Spot metering or Multi metering, and Selection AF. To set this function, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Link AE to AF Point→ an option.Shooting Functions 100 Shooting Functions This function automatically corrects the loss of bright detail that can occur due to shading differences in the photo. To set Smart Range options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→ Dynamic Range→ an option. Without Dynamic Range effect With Dynamic Range effect Icon Description Off: Do not use Dynamic Range. Smart Range+: Correct the loss of bright detail. You cannot set ISO 100. HDR: Capture 2 photos with different exposures, and then combine them to create a single image automatically. • You cannot set an ISO option higher than ISO 3200. • Dynamic Range options cannot be set at the same time as Picture Wizard options. Dynamic RangeShooting Functions 101 Shooting Functions Smart Filter lets you apply special effects to your photos. You can select various filter options to create special effects that are difficult to be achieved with normal lenses. To set Smart Filter options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Smart Filter→ an option. Option Description Off No effect Vignetting Apply the retro-looking colors, high contrast, and strong vignette effect of Lomo cameras. Miniature Apply a tilt-shift effect to make the subject appear in miniature. Colored Pencil Apply a colored pencil painting effect. Watercolor Apply a watercolor painting effect. Wash drawing Apply a washed-out effect. Oil Sketch Apply an oil sketching effect. Ink Sketch Apply an ink sketching effect. Acryl Apply an acryl painting effect. Option Description Negative Apply a negative film effect. Red Desaturate all colors but red. Green Desaturate all colors but green. Blue Desaturate all colors but blue. Yellow Desaturate all colors but yellow. Smart filter options cannot be set with Picture Wizard options at the same time. Smart FilterShooting Functions 102 Shooting Functions The camera automatically sets the exposure by measuring the levels of light from the photo’s composition and the position of a subject. If the exposure set by the camera is higher or lower than you expected, you can adjust the exposure value manually. The exposure value is adjustable in ±3 increments. The camera displays the exposure warning in red for each step beyond ±3 range. To adjust the exposure value, while holding down [W], scroll the jog dial. You can also adjust the exposure value by pressing [f], and then selecting EV. You can check the exposure value by the position of the exposure level indicator. Exposure level indicator Increased exposure (brighter) Decreased exposure (darker) Exposure warning Standard exposure index -2 Original +2 Exposure compensationShooting Functions 103 Shooting Functions When you cannot achieve an appropriate exposure because of a strong color contrast, lock the exposure, and then capture a photo. To lock the exposure value, adjust the photo’s exposure, and then press the custom button. After locking the exposure, aim the lens where you desire, and then press [Shutter]. • Set a function of the custom button to AEL to lock the current exposure value. (p. 150) • This feature is not available in Manual mode. Exposure lockShooting Functions 104 Shooting Functions The functions available for video are explained below. Movie size Set the movie size. To set movie size options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Movie Size→ an option. Icon Size Recommended for 1920X1080 (60 fps) (16:9) View on a Full HDTV. (Playable only on full HDTVs capable of playback at 60 fps.) 1920X1080 (30 fps) (16:9) View on a Full HDTV. 1920X1080 (15 fps) (16:9) View on a Full HDTV. (Available only with some Smart Filter options.) 1920X810 (24 fps) (Approx. 2.35:1) View on an HDTV. 1280X720 (60 fps) (16:9) View on an HDTV. 1280X720 (30 fps) (16:9) View on an HDTV. 640X480 (30 fps) (4:3) View on a TV. 320X240 (30 fps) (4:3) Post on a website using the wireless network (30 seconds maximum). Movie quality Set the Movie quality. To set movie quality options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Movie Quality→ an option. Icon Extension Description MP4 (H.264) Normal: Record videos in normal quality. MP4 (H.264) HQ: Record videos in high quality. Video functions105 Shooting Functions > Video functions Multi Motion Set the playing speed of a video. To set playing speed options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→ Multi Motion→ an option. Icon Description x0.25: Record a video and play it at 1/4 normal speed. (Available only with 640x480 or 320x240) x0.5: Record a video and play it at 1/2 normal speed. (Available only with 1280x720 (30 fps), 640x480, or 320x240) x1: Record a video and play it at normal speed. x5: Record a video and play it at 5X normal speed. x10: Record a video and play it at 10X normal speed. x20: Record a video and play it at 20X normal speed. • If you select an option other than x1, sound will not be recorded. • The available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Fader You can fade in or fade out a scene using the fader function on the camera without having to do it on a PC. Set the fade in option to gradually fade in at the start of the scene. Set the fade out option to gradually fade out the scene. Use the function appropriately and add dramatic effects on your videos. To set fader options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→ Fader→ an option. Icon Description Off: Fader function not used. In: Scene gradually fades in. Out: Scene gradually fades out. In-out: The fader function is applied at the start and end of the scene. When you use the fader function, it may take longer to save a file.106 Shooting Functions > Video functions Mic Level Set the mic level for the shooting conditions. To set the mic level, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Mic Level→ an option. Voice Sometimes, a muted video is more appealing than the one with sound. Turn the voice off to record a muted video. To set voice options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Voice→ an option. Wind cut When you record videos in noisy environments, unintended sounds can be recorded in videos. In particular, severe wind noise recorded in videos distracts you from enjoying your videos. Use the Wind Cut function to remove some surrounding noise in addition to wind noise. To reduce wind sound, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Wind Cut→ an option.Chapter 3 Playback/Editing Learn about how to play back and edit photos and videos. Refer to chapter 6 for editing files on a PC.108 Playback/Editing Learn how to view photo and video thumbnails and how to protect or delete files. If you perform no operations for a while, information and icons on the screen disappear. When you operate the camera again, they will reappear. Viewing photos 1 Press [y]. • The most recent file you captured will be displayed. 2 Press [C/F] to scroll through files. • You can also drag the image left or right to move to another file. You may not be able to edit or play back files that were captured with other cameras, due to unsupported sizes or codecs. Use a computer or another device to edit or play back these files. Viewing image thumbnails In order to search for photos and videos you want, convert to the thumbnail view. The thumbnail view displays multiple images at a time so that you can easily look through items you wish to find. You can also classify and display files by category, such as date or file type. Scroll the jog dial to the left to select the thumbnail view mode. (Scroll the jog dial to the right to return to the previous mode.) Searching and managing files109 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Viewing files by category 1 In the thumbnail view, press [m] →z→Filter→ a category. • You can also touch FILTER to select a category. * Default Option Description All* View files normally. Date View files by the date they were saved. Type View files by the file type. Location View files by the place they were saved. (Only the photos captured with an optional GPS module have the location information.) 2 Select a list to open it. 3 Select a file to view it. 4 Touch to return to the previous view. Viewing files as a folder Continuous and burst shots appear as a folder. Selecting a folder will play back all photos automatically. Deleting a folder will delete all photos in the folder. 1 In Playback mode, press [C/F] or drag the image left or right to move to a desired folder. • The camera will automatically play back photos in the folder. 2 Scroll the jog dial to the right to open the folder. • You can also touch the folder on the screen to open the folder. 3 Press [C/F] or drag the image left or right to move to another file. 4 Scroll the jog dial to the left to return to Playback mode.110 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Protecting files Protect your files from accidental deletion. 1 In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Protect→Select. 2 Press [C/F] to select a file, and then press [o]. 3 Press [f]. You cannot delete or rotate a protected file. Lock/Unlock all files Lock or unlock all files. 1 In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Protect→All. 2 Select an option. Option Description Lock Lock all files. Unlock Unlock all files. Cancel Return to the previous menu.111 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Deleting files Delete files in Playback mode and secure more space on your memory card. Protected files are not deleted. Deleting a single file You can select a single file and delete it. 1 In Playback mode, select a file, and then press [n]. 2 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes. Deleting multiple files You can select multiple files and delete them. 1 In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Delete→Select. • Alternatively, in thumbnails view, press [n], and then select files to delete. 2 Select files you want to delete by pressing [C/F], and then press [o]. • Press [o] again to cancel your selection. 3 Press [n]. 4 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes.112 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Deleting all files You can delete all files on the memory card at once. 1 In Playback mode, press [m]. 2 Select z→Delete→All. 3 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes.113 Playback/Editing Enlarging a photo You can enlarge photos when viewing them in Playback mode. You can also use the Trim function to extract the portion of the image displayed on the screen and save it as a new file. Magnified area Magnification (the maximum magnification may differ by resolution) Full Image Crop Scroll the jog dial to the right to enlarge a photo. (Scroll the jog dial to the left to reduce a photo.) To Do this Move magnified area Press [D/I/C/F]. Crop the enlarged image Press [f]. (saved as a new file) Return to the original image Press [o]. You can also pinch your fingers together or spread them apart on the screen to reduce or enlarge a photo. You can also double-tap an area to enlarge it quickly. Viewing a slide show You can view photos in a slide show, apply various effects to the slide show, and play background music. 1 In Playback mode, press [m]. 2 Select z→Slide Show Options. 3 Select a slide show effect option. • Skip to step 4 to start a slide show with no effects. * Default Option Description Play Mode Set whether or not to repeat the slide show. (One Play*, Repeat) Interval Set the interval between photos. (1 sec*, 3 sec, 5 sec, 10 sec) Music Set background audio. Effect • Set a scene change effect between photos. • Select Off to cancel effects. Viewing photos114 Playback/Editing > Viewing photos 4 Press [m]. 5 Select Start Slide Show. 6 View the slide show. • Press [o] to pause. • Press [o] again to resume. • Press [m] to stop the slide show and return to Playback mode. • Press [D/I] to adjust the volume level. Auto rotating With Auto Rotate on, the camera automatically rotates photos you have captured vertically so they fit the screen horizontally. To set auto rotate options, In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Auto Rotate→ an option. Creating a print order (DPOF) DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) lets you set the number of copies to be printed. The camera saves the DPOF information in the MISC folder of your memory card. If you have set DPOF information for your images, you can take the memory card to a digital printing shop for printing. You cannot set the print order of RAW format files. Photos with dimensions that are wider than the paper may be cut off on the left and right edges. Ensure that your photo dimensions are compatible with the paper you select. 1 In Playback mode, select a photo, and then press [m]. 2 Select z→DPOF. 3 Press [D/I] to set the number of copies. • To select another photo, press [C/F]. 4 Press [o] to save.115 Playback/Editing In Playback mode, you can play a video, capture an image from a video, or crop a video to save as another file. Stop Capture Video viewing controls Icon/Button Description / /[C] View previous file/Scan backward. (Each time you touch the icon or press the button while playing the video, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) / /[o] Pause or resume playback. / /[F] View next file/Scan forward. (Each time you touch the icon or press the button while playing the video, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) /[D/I] Adjust the volume or mute the sound. Trimming a video during playback 1 In Playback mode, scroll to a video, and then touch . 2 Press [o] or touch to start playing the video. 3 Press [o] or touch at the point where you want the trimming to begin. 4 Press [f] or touch Start Point. 5 Press [o] or touch to resume playing the video. 6 Press [o] or touch at the point where you want the trimming to end. Playing videos116 Playback/Editing > Playing videos 7 Press [f] or touch End Point. 8 Press [f] or touch Trim to trim a video. • You can adjust the scene to be cropped by dragging the handles that appear on the progress bar. 9 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes. • You cannot trim a video recorded in 3D mode. • The original video should be at least 10 seconds long. • The camera will save the edited video as a new file and leave the original video intact. Capturing an image during playback 1 While viewing a video, press [o] or touch at the point where you want to capture an image. 2 Press [f] or touch Capture. • You cannot capture an image from a video recorded in 3D mode. • The resolution of the captured image will be the same as the original video. • The captured image is saved as a new file.117 Playback/Editing Perform photo editing tasks, such as resizing, rotating, or reducing red-eye effects. Edited photos are saved as new files under different file names. Photos captured in some modes cannot be edited with the Image Edit function. To edit images, In Playback mode, scroll to a photo, and then touch → an option. • You can also edit images in Playback mode by selecting a photo, and then pressing [f] or [m] →Edit Image. • Some images may not be edited with the Image Edit function. In this case, use a supplied image editing software. • The camera will save edited photos as new files. • When you edit photos, the camera will automatically convert them to a lower resolution. Photos that you rotate or resize manually are not automatically converted to a lower resolution. • You cannot edit photos while viewing files as a folder. Open the folder and select a photo to edit each photo. Cropping a photo 1 Touch → . 2 Drag the corners of the box to adjust the size of the area. 3 Drag the box to move the location of the area. 4 Touch OK. 5 Touch to save. Editing photos118 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Rotating a photo 1 Touch → . 2 Touch an option. Rotate : Right 90° 3 Touch OK. 4 Touch to save. • You can also rotate a photo in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting z→Rotate→ a desired option. • The camera will overwrite the original file. Resizing photos Change the size of a photo and save it as a new file. 1 Touch → . 2 Touch an option. Resize : 10.1M 3:2 3 Touch OK. 4 Touch to save. Available resize options differ depending on the original size of the photo.119 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Adjusting your photos You can correct captured photos by adjusting the brightness, contrast, or saturation. 1 Touch . 2 Touch an adjusting option. Icon Description Original (Reset to the original image) Auto adjustment Brightness Contrast Saturation RGB adjustment Color Temperature Exposure Hue 3 Press [C/F] to adjust the option. • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the option. • If you selected , skip to step 4. 4 Touch OK. 5 Touch to save.120 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Retouching faces 1 Touch → . 2 Press [C/F] to adjust the option. • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the option. • As the number increases, the skin tone becomes brighter and smoother. 3 Touch OK. • To cancel correction, touch . 4 Touch to save. Reducing red-eye 1 Touch → . 2 Touch OK. • To cancel correction, touch . 3 Touch to save.121 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Applying Smart Filter effects Apply special effects to your photos. 1 Touch , and then touch an option. Smart Filter : Vignetting Option Description Original No effect Vignetting Apply the retro-looking colors, high contrast, and strong vignette effect of Lomo cameras. Miniature Apply a tilt-shift effect to make the subject appear in miniature. Colored Pencil Apply a colored pencil painting effect. Watercolor Apply a watercolor painting effect. Wash drawing Apply a washed-out effect. Option Description Oil Sketch Apply an oil sketching effect. Ink Sketch Apply an ink sketching effect. Acryl Apply an acryl painting effect. Negative Apply a negative film effect. Red Desaturate all colors but red. Green Desaturate all colors but green. Blue Desaturate all colors but blue. Yellow Desaturate all colors but yellow. 2 Touch OK. 3 Touch to save.Chapter 4 Wireless network Learn how to connect to wireless local area networks (WLANs) and use functions.123 Wireless network Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Learn to connect via an access point (AP) when you are in a range of a WLAN. You can also configure network settings. Connecting to a WLAN 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select , , ,or . 3 Press [m], and then select Wi-Fi Setting. • In some modes, follow the on-screen instructions until the Wi-Fi Setting screen appears. • The camera automatically searches for available AP devices. 4 Select an AP. Back Refresh Samsung1 Samsung2 Samsung3 Samsung4 • Select Refresh to refresh connectable APs. • Select Add wireless network to add an AP manually. Your AP name must be in English to add the AP manually. Icon/Option Description Ad hoc AP Secured AP WPS AP Signal strength Press [F] or touch to open network setting options. • When you select a secured AP, a pop-up window appears. Enter the required passwords to connect to the WLAN. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • When a login page appears, refer to "Using the login browser". (p. 125) • When you select an unsecured AP, the camera will connect to the WLAN. • If you select a WPS profile supported AP, select →WPS PIN connection, and then enter a PIN on the AP device. You can also connect to a WPS profile supported AP by selecting →WPS button connection on the camera, and then pushing the WPS button on the AP device. • The same AP may be listed twice, with different frequencies, because your camera supports the dual band function.124 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Setting network options 1 In the Wi-Fi Setting screen, move to an AP, and then press [F] or touch . 2 Select each option, and then enter the required information. Option Description Network Password Enter the network password. IP Setting Set the IP address automatically or manually. Manually setting the IP address 1 In the Wi-Fi Setting screen, move to an AP, and then press [F] or touch . 2 Select IP Setting→Manual. 3 Select each option, and then enter the required information. Option Description IP Enter the static IP address. Subnet Mask Enter the subnet mask. Gateway Enter the gateway. DNS Server Enter the DNS address.125 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Using the login browser You can enter your login information via the login browser when connecting to some APs, sharing sites, or cloud servers. Icon Description Close the login browser. Move to the previous page. Move to the next page. Stop loading the page. Reload the page. • You may not be able to select some items depending on the page you connected to. This does not indicate a malfunction. • The login browser may not close automatically after you log into some pages. If this occurs, close the login browser by touching , and then proceed with the desired operation. • It may take longer to load the login page due to the page size or network speed. If this occurs, wait until the login information input window appears.126 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Network connection tips • You must insert a memory card to use the Wi-Fi features. • The quality of the network connection will be determined by the AP. • The further the distance between your camera and the AP, the longer it will take to connect to the network. • If a nearby device is using the same radio frequency signal as your camera, it may interrupt your connection. • If your AP name is not in English, the camera may not be able to locate the device or the name may appear incorrectly. • For network settings or a password, contact your network administrator or network service provider. • If a WLAN requires authentication from the service provider, you may not be able to connect to it. To connect the WLAN, contact your network service provider. • Depending on the encryption type, the number of digits in the password may differ. • A WLAN connection may not be possible in all surroundings. • The camera may display a WLAN enabled printer on the AP List. You cannot connect to a network via a printer. • You cannot connect your camera to a network and a TV simultaneously. • Connecting to a network may incur additional charges. Costs will vary based on the conditions of your contract. • If you cannot connect to a WLAN, try another AP from the available AP list. • A login page may appear when you select free WLANs provided by some network service providers. Enter your ID and password to connect to the WLAN. For information about registering or the service, contact the network service providers. • Be cautious when you enter personal information for an AP connection. Do not enter any payment or credit card information on your camera. The manufacturer is not liable for any problem caused by entering such information. • Available network connections may differ by country. • The WLAN feature of your camera must comply with radio transmission laws in your region. To ensure compliance, use the WLAN feature only in the country where you purchased the camera. • The process for adjusting network settings may differ, depending on network conditions. • Do not access a network that you are not authorized to use. • Before you connect to a network, ensure your battery is fully charged. • You cannot upload or send files captured in some modes. • Files that you transfer to another device may not be supported by the device. In this case, use a computer to play back the files.127 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Entering text Learn how to enter text. The icons in the table let you move the cursor, change the case, etc. Touch a key to enter it. Icon Description Move the cursor. Stop entering text and return to the previous page. Change case. Switch between Symbol/Number mode and the normal mode. Change the input language. Enter a space. Save the displayed text. Delete the last letter. • You can use only the English alphabets in some modes, regardless of the display language. • You can enter up to 64 characters. • The screen may differ depending on the input mode. • Touch and hold a key to enter the character at the upper right corner of the key.128 Wireless network Saving files to a smart phone automatically The camera connects to a smart phone that supports the AutoShare feature via a WLAN. When you capture a photo with your camera, the photo is saved to the smart phone automatically. • The AutoShare feature is supported by Galaxy series smart phones or Galaxy Tab models with the Android 2.3 OS or higher or iOS devices with the iOS 6.0 or higher. Before using this feature, check the device’s firmware and update it if needed. • You should install Samsung SMART CAMERA App on your phone or device before using this feature. You can download the application from Samsung Apps, the Google Play Store, or the Apple App Store. Samsung SMART CAMERA App is compatible with Samsung camera models manufactured in 2013 or later. • To install and launch Samsung SMART CAMERA App on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the NFC feature and place the smart phone near an NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. This feature is supported by smart phones running Android OS 2.3 or higher. This feature is not available for iOS devices. • You must insert a memory card to use this feature. • If you set this function, the setting is maintained even when you change the Shooting mode. • This feature may not be supported in some modes or may not be available with some shooting options. 1 On the camera, in Shooting mode, press [m]. 2 On the camera, select 1→AutoShare→On. • If the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. 3 On the smart phone, turn on Samsung SMART CAMERA App. • For iOS devices, turn on the Wi-Fi feature before turning on the application. • To start the application automatically on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the function and place the smart phone near the NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. Verify that the smart phone is connected to your camera, and then skip to step 6. 4 Select the camera from the list and connect the smart phone to the camera. • The smart phone can connect to only one camera at a time. 5 On the camera, allow the smart phone to connect to your camera. • If the smart phone has been connected to your camera before, it is connected automatically. • An icon that shows the connection status ( ) will appear on the camera’s screen. 6 On the camera, capture a photo. • The captured photo is saved to the camera, and then transferred to the smart phone. • If you recorded a video, it is saved only to the camera.129 Wireless network The camera connects to a smart phone that supports the MobileLink feature via a WLAN. You can easily send photos or videos to your smart phone. • The MobileLink feature is supported by Galaxy series smart phones or Galaxy Tab models with the Android 2.3 OS or higher or iOS devices with the iOS 6.0 or higher. Before using this feature, check the device’s firmware and update it if needed. • You should install Samsung SMART CAMERA App on your phone or device before using this feature. You can download the application from Samsung Apps, the Google Play Store, or the Apple App Store. Samsung SMART CAMERA App is compatible with Samsung camera models manufactured in 2013 or later. • To install and launch Samsung SMART CAMERA App on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the NFC feature and place the smart phone near an NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. This feature is supported by smart phones running Android OS 2.3 or higher. This feature is not available for iOS devices. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • If you select files from the smart phone, you can view up to 1,000 recent files and send up to 150 files at a time. If you select files from the camera, you can view files that were selected from the camera. The maximum number of files that can be sent varies depending on the storage space of the smart phone. • When you send Full HD videos using MobileLink feature, you may not be able to play back files on some devices. • When using this feature on an iOS device, the device may lose its Wi-Fi connection. • You cannot send RAW files. 1 On the camera, rotate the mode dial to B. 2 On the camera, select . • If the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. 3 On the camera, select a sending option. • If you select Select Files from Smartphone, you can use your smart phone to view and share files stored on the camera. • If you select Select Files from Camera, you can select files to send from the camera. 4 On the smart phone, turn on Samsung SMART CAMERA App. • For iOS devices, turn on the Wi-Fi feature before turning on the application. • To start the application automatically on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the function and place the smart phone near the NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. Verify that the smart phone is connected to your camera, and then skip to step 7. Sending photos or videos to a smart phone130 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos to a smart phone 5 Select the camera from the list and connect the smart phone to the camera. • The smart phone can connect to only one camera at a time. 6 On the camera, allow the smart phone to connect to your camera. • If the smart phone has been connected to your camera before, it is connected automatically. 7 On the smart phone or camera, select files to transfer from the camera. 8 On the smart phone, touch the copy button or on the camera, select Send. • The camera will send the files.131 Wireless network The camera connects to a smart phone that supports the Remote Viewfinder feature via a WLAN. Use the smart phone as a remote shutter release with the Remote Viewfinder feature. The captured photo will display on the smart phone. • The Remote Viewfinder feature is supported by Galaxy series smart phones or Galaxy Tab models with the Android 2.3 OS or higher or iOS devices with the iOS 6.0 or higher. Before using this feature, check the device’s firmware and update it if needed. • You should install Samsung SMART CAMERA App on your phone or device before using this feature. You can download the application from Samsung Apps, the Google Play Store, or the Apple App Store. Samsung SMART CAMERA App is compatible with Samsung camera models manufactured in 2013 or later. • To install and launch Samsung SMART CAMERA App on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the NFC feature and place the smart phone near an NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. This feature is supported by smart phones running Android OS 2.3 or higher. This feature is not available for iOS devices. • This function is not available in 3D mode. 1 On the camera, rotate the mode dial to B. 2 On the camera, select . • If the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. 3 On the smart phone, turn on Samsung SMART CAMERA App. • For iOS devices, turn on the Wi-Fi feature before turning on the application. • To start the application automatically on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the function and place the smart phone near the NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. Verify that the smart phone is connected to your camera, and then skip to step 6. 4 Select the camera from the list and connect the smart phone to the camera. • The smart phone can connect to only one camera at a time. Using a smart phone as a remote shutter release132 Wireless network > Using a smart phone as a remote shutter release 5 On the camera, allow the smart phone to connect to your camera. • If the smart phone has been connected to your camera before, it is connected automatically. 6 On the smart phone, set the following shooting options. Icon Description Flash option Timer option Photo size Saving location • While using this feature, some buttons are not available on your camera. • The zoom button and the shutter button on your smart phone will not function when using this feature. • Remote Viewfinder mode supports the and photo sizes only. 7 On the smart phone, touch and hold to focus. • The focus is automatically set to Multi AF. 8 Release to capture the photo. • Photos saved to the smart phone will be resized to 1616X1080 when shooting in and to 1920X1080 when shooting in resolution. • When you use this feature, the ideal distance between the camera and the smart phone may vary, depending on your surroundings. • The smart phone must be within 7 m of the camera to use this feature. • It will take some time to capture the photo after you release on the smart phone. • The Remote Viewfinder function will deactivate when: - there is an incoming call on the smart phone - either the camera or the smart phone turns off - the memory is full - device loses its connection to the WLAN - the Wi-Fi connection is poor or unstable - you perform no operations for approximately 5 minutes while connected133 Wireless network Using Auto Backup to send photos or videos You can send photos or videos that you captured with the camera to a PC wirelessly. Installing the program for Auto Backup on your PC 1 Install i-Launcher on the PC. (p. 163) 2 Connect the camera to the PC with the USB cable. 3 When the Auto Backup program icon appears, click it. • The Auto Backup program is installed on the PC and the information about the PC will be stored to the camera. Follow the on-screen instructions to complete the installation. • You can also save the information about the PC to the camera by connecting the PC and the camera via Wi-Fi. 4 Remove the USB cable. Before installing the program, ensure that the PC is connected to a network. If no internet connection is available, you must install the program from the provided CD. Sending photos or videos to a PC 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • If the the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. • You must configure the backup PC information to use the Auto Backup feature. For more details, refer to "Installing the program for Auto Backup on your PC". (p. 133) If the Auto Backup program is installed on your PC, save the PC information via USB cable or Wi-Fi connection. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123)134 Wireless network > Using Auto Backup to send photos or videos 3 Select a backup PC. • If you have performed a backup before, move to step 4. 4 Select OK. • To cancel sending, select Cancel. • You cannot select individual files to backup. This function backs up only new files on the camera. • The backup's progress will be shown on the PC monitor. • When the transfer is completed, the camera will turn off automatically in approximately 30 seconds. Select Cancel to return to the previous screen and prevent the camera from turning off automatically. • To turn off your PC automatically after the transfer is complete, select Shut down PC after backup. • To change the backup PC, select . • When you connect the camera to the WLAN, select the AP that is connected to the PC. • The camera will search for available access points even if you are connecting to the same access point again. • If you turn off the camera or remove the battery while sending files, the file transfer will be interrupted. • While you are using this feature, the shutter control is disabled on your camera. • You can connect only one camera to the PC at a time for sending files. • The backup may be canceled due to network conditions. • Photos or videos can be sent to a PC one time only. Files cannot be sent again even if you reconnect your camera to another PC. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You must turn off Windows Firewall and any other firewalls before using this feature. • You can send up to 1,000 recent files. • On the PC software, the server name must be entered in the Latin alphabet and can contain no more than 48 characters. • When multiple file types are created at once, only the image files (JPG) will be sent to the PC with this feature.135 Wireless network 5 Select the Name box, enter your name, and then touch . Sender Setting Name Save Email Reset 6 Select the Email box, enter your email address, and then touch . 7 Select Save to save your changes. • To delete your information, select Reset. You can change settings in the email menu and send photos or videos stored on the camera via email. Changing email settings In the email menu, you can change settings for storing your information. You can also set or change the email password. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) Storing your information 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Press [m]. 4 Select Sender Setting. Sending photos or videos via email136 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos via email Setting an email password 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Press [m]. 4 Select Setting Password→On. • To deactivate the password, select Off. 5 When the pop-up appears, select OK. 6 Enter a 4-digit password. 7 Enter the password again. 8 When the pop-up appears, select OK. If you lost your password, you can reset it by selecting RESET on the password setting screen. When you reset the information, the previously saved user’s setting information, email address, and recently sent email list will be deleted.137 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos via email Changing the email password 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Press [m]. 4 Select Change Password. 5 Enter your current 4-digit password. 6 Enter a new 4-digit password. 7 Enter the new password again. 8 When the pop-up appears, select OK. Sending photos or videos via email You can send photos or videos stored on the camera via email. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Select the Sender box, enter your email address, and then touch . • If you have previously saved your information, it will be inserted automatically. (p. 135) • To use an address from the list of previous senders, select → an address.138 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos via email 4 Select the Receiver box, enter an email address, and then touch . • To use an address from the list of previous recipients, select → an address. • Select to add additional recipients. You can input up to 30 recipients. • Select to delete an address from the list. 5 Select Next. 6 Select files to send. • You can select up to 20 files. The total size must be 7 MB or less. 7 Select Next. 8 Select the comment box, enter your comments, and then touch . 9 Select Send. • The camera will send the email. • Even if a photo appears to have transferred successfully, errors with the recipient’s email account may cause the photo to be rejected or recognized as spam. • You may not be able to send an email if no network connection is available or if your email account settings are incorrect. • You cannot send an email if the file size exceeds the limit. The maximum photo resolution you can send is 2M and the longest video you can upload is a video recorded using . If the selected photo resolution is higher than 2M, it will be automatically resized to a lower resolution. • If you cannot send an email because of firewall or user authentication settings, contact your network administrator or network service provider. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You can also send an email in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting Share(Wi-Fi)→Email.139 Wireless network Upload your photos or videos to file sharing websites. Available websites will be displayed on your camera. To upload files to some websites, you must visit the website and register before connecting your camera. Accessing a website 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . 3 Select a website. • If the pop-up message that prompts you to create an account appears, select OK. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 4 Enter your ID and password to log in. • For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • If you connected to SkyDrive, refer to "Using the login browser". (p. 125) • To select an ID from the list, select → an ID. • If you have previously logged in to the website, you may be logged in automatically. You must have an existing account on the file sharing website to use this feature. Using photo or video sharing websites140 Wireless network > Using photo or video sharing websites Uploading photos or videos 1 Access the website with your camera. 2 Select files to upload. • You can select up to 20 files. The total size must be 10 MB or less. (On some websites, the total size or number of files may vary.) 3 Select Upload. • On some websites, you can enter your comments by selecting the comment box. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • You can set an upload folder for Facebook by pressing [m], and then selecting Upload Folder (Facebook) on the website's list screen. • You cannot upload files if the file size exceeds the limit. The maximum photo resolution you can upload is 2M, and the longest video you can upload is a video recorded using . If the selected photo resolution is higher than 2M, it will be automatically resized to a lower resolution. (On some websites, the maximum photo resolution may vary.) • The method of uploading photos or videos may differ depending on the selected website. • If you cannot access a website because of firewall or user authentication settings, contact your network administrator or network service provider. • Uploaded photos or videos may be automatically titled with the date they were captured. • The speed of your internet connection may affect how quickly photos upload or web pages open. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You can also upload photos or videos to file sharing websites in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting Share(Wi-Fi)→ a desired website. • You cannot upload videos to some websites. • When you upload photos to SkyDrive, they will be resized to 2M while maintaining their aspect ratios.141 Wireless network Using AllShare Play to send files You can upload files from your camera to AllShare Play online storage or view files on an AllShare Play device connected to the same AP. Uploading photos to online storage 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select → Web storage. • If the guide message appears, select OK. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) • To change the size for uploaded photos, press [m], and then select Upload Image Size. • If you have registered more than one web storage, you can select from the list by pressing [m], and then selecting Change Web storage. 3 Enter your ID and password, and then select Login→OK. • For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • To select an ID from the list, select → an ID. • If you have previously logged in to the website, you may be logged in automatically. To use this feature, you must create an AllShare Play account and an account with an affiliated online storage service using your PC. After finishing creating accounts, add your online storage account to AllShare Play. 4 Select files you want to upload, and then select Upload. • If you have registered more than one web storage, select a web storage first. • You cannot upload video files to AllShare Play online storage. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You can upload up to 20 files. • You can also upload photos in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting Share(Wi-Fi)→AllShare Play.142 Wireless network > Using AllShare Play to send files Viewing photos or videos on devices that support AllShare Play 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select → Nearby devices. • If the guide message appears, select Yes. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) • You can set to allow only selected devices or all devices to connect by pressing [m], and then selecting DLNA Access Control on the screen. • A sharing file list is created. Wait until other devices can find your camera. 3 Connect the AllShare Play device to a network, and then turn on the AllShare Play feature. • Refer to your device's user manual for more information. 4 On the camera, allow the AllShare Play device to connect to your camera. 5 On the AllShare Play device, select a camera to connect. 6 On the AllShare Play device, browse the shared photos or videos. • For information about searching for the camera and browsing the photos or videos on the AllShare Play device, refer to the device's user manual. • Videos may not play smoothly depending on the type of AllShare Play device or the network condition. For smooth playback, use a 5 Ghz dual-band AP device. AP S A camera is connected to a TV that supports AllShare Play via WLAN.143 Wireless network > Using AllShare Play to send files • You can share up to 1,000 recent files. • On an AllShare Play device, you can view only photos or videos captured with your camera. • The range of the wireless connection between your camera and an AllShare Play device may vary depending on the specifications of the AP. • If the camera is connected to 2 AllShare Play devices, playback may be slower. • Photos or videos will be shared in their original sizes. • You can use this feature only with devices that support AllShare Play. • Shared photos or videos will not be stored on the AllShare Play device, but they can be stored in the camera to meet the device's specifications. • Transferring photos or videos to the AllShare Play device may take some time depending on the network connection, the number of files to be shared, or the sizes of the files. • If you power off the camera abnormally while viewing photos or videos on an AllShare Play device (for example, by removing the battery), the device considers the camera to still be connected. • The order of photos or videos on the camera may be different than on the AllShare Play device. • Depending on the number of photos or videos you want to share, it may take some time to load your photos or videos and complete the initial set-up process. • While viewing photos or videos on the AllShare Play device, continuously using the device's remote or performing additional operations on the device may prevent this feature from working properly. • If you reorder or sort files on the camera while viewing them on an AllShare Play device, you must repeat the initial set-up process to update the list of files on the device. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • We recommend you use a network cable to connect your AllShare Play device to your AP. This will minimize any video ‘Stuttering’ you may experience when streaming content. • To view files on an AllShare Play device using the Nearby devices feature, enable multicast mode on your AP. • 1920X1080 (60 fps) videos can be played only on full HDTVs capable of playback at 60 fps. • You can view 3D files only on 3D-compatible TVs or monitors.144 Wireless network Sending photos using Wi-Fi Direct When the camera connects via a WLAN to a device that supports the Wi-Fi Direct function, you can send photos to the device. This feature may not be supported on some devices. 1 On the device, turn on the Wi-Fi Direct option. 2 On the camera, in Playback mode, scroll to a photo. 3 Press [m], and then select Share(Wi-Fi)→Wi-Fi Direct. • When in the single image view, you can send only one photo at a time. • When in thumbnails view, you can select multiple photos. Select Upload when you are finished selecting photos. 4 Select the device from the camera’s list of Wi-Fi Direct devices. • Ensure that the device's Wi-Fi Direct option is turned on. • You can also select your camera from the device's list of Wi-Fi Direct devices. 5 On the device, allow the camera to connect to the device. • The photo will be sent to the device. • You can send up to 20 files at a time. • When there are no photos in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • If you cannot connect to a Wi-Fi Direct device, update the device with the latest firmware. This feature may not be supported on some devices.Chapter 5 Camera settings menu Learn about the user settings and general settings menu. You can adjust the settings to better suit your needs and preferences.146 Camera settings menu You can set the user environment with these settings. To set user options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →5→ an option. Available items and the order of them may differ depending on shooting conditions. ISO Customizing ISO Step You can set the size for the ISO sensitivity by either 1/3 or 1 step. Auto ISO Range You can set the maximum ISO value under which each EV step is chosen when you set the ISO to Auto. * Default Option Value 1/3 Step ISO 125, ISO 160, ISO 200, ISO 250, ISO 320, ISO 400, ISO 500, ISO 640, ISO 800, ISO 1000, ISO 1250, ISO 1600, ISO 2000, ISO 2500, ISO 3200* 1 Step ISO 200, ISO 400, ISO 800, ISO 1600, ISO 3200* Noise Reduction Use the Noise Reduction to reduce the visual noise in photos. * Default Option Description High ISO NR This function reduces noise that may occur when you set a high ISO sensitivity. (Off, High, Normal*, Low) Long Term NR This function reduces noise when you set the camera for a long exposure. (Off, On*) User settings147 Camera settings menu > User settings Bracket Set You can set up the options for AE Bracket, WB Bracket, and P Wiz Bracket. Option Description AE Bracket Set Set the exposure interval. (-/+0.3 EV*, -/+0.7 EV, -/+1 EV, -/+1.3 EV, -/+1.7 EV, -/+2 EV, -/+2.3 EV, -/+2.7 EV, -/+3 EV) WB Bracket Set Adjust the White Balance interval range of the 3 bracketed photos. (AB-/+3*, AB-/+2, AB-/+1, MG-/+3, MG-/+2, MG-/+1) For example, AB-/+3 adjusts the Amber value plus or minus three steps. MG-/+3 adjusts the Magenta value the same amount. P Wiz Bracket Set Select 3 Picture Wizard settings the camera uses to capture the 3 bracketed photos. DMF (Direct Manual Focus) You can adjust the focus manually by rotating the focus ring after achieving the focus by half-pressing [Shutter]. This feature may not be available with some lenses.148 Camera settings menu > User settings Color space The color space option allows you to select methods for representing colors. Digital imaging devices such as digital cameras, monitors, and printers have their own methods for representing colors, which are called color spaces. Option Description sRGB sRGB (Standard RGB) is an international specification to define the color space created by IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission). It is widely used for creating colors on PC monitors and is also the standard color space for Exif. sRGB is recommended for regular images and images you intend to publish on the Internet. Adobe RGB Adobe RGB is used for commercial printing and has a larger color range than sRGB. Its wider range of colors helps you to easily edit photos on a computer. Note that individual programs are generally compatible with a limited number of color spaces. Adobe RGB sRGB When the color space is set to Adobe RGB, photos will be saved as “_SAMXXXX.JPG”.149 Camera settings menu > User settings Distortion Correct You can correct lens distortion that might occur from lenses. This feature may not be available with some lenses. Touch Operation Set to enable touch operation in Shooting mode. Option Description On Use touch operations in Shooting mode. Off Do not use touch operations in Shooting mode. (You can use touch operations in other situations.) iFn Customizing You can select options that can be adjusted when you press [i-Function] on an i-Function lens. Option Description Aperture Set to adjust the aperture value. Shutter Speed Set to adjust the shutter speed. EV Set to adjust the exposure value. ISO Set to adjust ISO sensitivity. White Balance Set to adjust the White Balance. Z Set to adjust the zoom ratio. User Display You can add or remove shooting information from the display. 1 2 3 London No. Description 1 Date & Time Set to display the date and time. 2 Icons Set to display icons on the right in Shooting mode.150 Camera settings menu > User settings No. Description 3 Histogram Set the histogram on the display on or off. About histogram A histogram is a graph that shows the brightness distribution of a photo. A histogram inclined to the left indicates a dark photo. A histogram inclined to the right indicates a bright photo. The height of the graph is related to color information. The graph gets higher if a specific color is more common. Insufficient exposure Balanced exposure Excessive exposure Key Mapping You can change the function assigned to the Custom button or DIRECT LINK button. * Default Button Function Custom Set a function of the Custom button. • Optical Preview*: Execute the Depth of Field Preview function for the current aperture value. (p. 24) • One Touch WB (White Balance): Execute the Custom White Balance function. • One Touch RAW +: Save a file in the RAW+JPEG format. To save a file in JPEG format, press the button again. • Reset: Reset some settings. • AEL: Execute the auto exposure lock function. • AEL Hold: Keep executing the auto exposure lock function after shooting. DIRECT LINK Set a function of the DIRECT LINK button. (AutoShare*, MobileLink, Remote Viewfinder, Auto Backup, Email, SNS & Cloud, AllShare Play)151 Camera settings menu > User settings Grid Line Select a guide to help you compose a scene. (Off*, 3 X 3, 2 X 2, Cross, Diagonal) AF Lamp When shooting in dark places, turn the AF lamp on in order to have a better auto focus. The Auto Focus functions more accurately in dark places when the AF lamp is on.152 Camera settings menu Learn to configure your camera's settings. To set Setting options, In Shooting or Playback mode, press [m] →q→ an option. * Default Item Description Sound • System Volume: Set the sound volume or turn all sound off entirely. (Off, Low, Medium*, High) Even if the system volume is turned off, the camera emits the sound while playing a video or a slide show. • AF Sound: Set the sound the camera emits when you half-press the shutter button on or off. (Off, On*) • Button Sound: Set the sound the camera emits when you press the buttons or touch the screen on or off. (Off, On*) Quick View Set the Quick View time length – the amount of time the camera displays a photo immediately after you capture it. (Off, 1 sec*, 3 sec, 5 sec, Hold) * Default Item Description Display Adjust Adjust the display brightness, auto brightness setting, display color, or level gauge. • Display Brightness: You can adjust the display brightness manually. • Auto Brightness: Turn auto brightness on or off. (Off, On*) • Display Color: You can adjust the display color manually. • Horizontal Calibration: Calibrate the level gauge. If the level gauge is not level, position the camera on the level surface, and then follow the on-screen instructions. • You cannot access the Horizontal Calibration option in Playback mode. • You cannot calibrate the level gauge in portrait orientation. Auto Display Off Set the display off time. The display turns off if you do not use the camera for the time you set. (Off, 30 sec*, 1 min, 3 min, 5 min, 10 min) Setting153 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description Power Save Set power shut off time. The camera shuts off if you do not use it for the time you set. (30 sec, 1 min*, 3 min, 5 min, 10 min, 30 min) • The camera retains the power-off time setting even if you replace the battery. • Power Save may not work if the camera is connected to a computer or a TV or playing a slide show or a movie. Help Guide Display • Mode Help Guide: Set to display help text about the selected mode when changing shooting modes. (Off, On*) • Function Help Guide: Set to display help text about menus and functions. (Off, On*) Press [n] to hide the help text. Language Set a language the camera shows on the display. Date & Time Set date, time, date format, time zone and whether to imprint the date on photos. (Time Zone, Date & Time, Date Type, Time Type, Imprint) • The date appears on the lower right side of the photo. • When you print a photo, some printers may not print the date appropriately. * Default Item Description Video Out Set the video signal output appropriate for your country when connecting the camera to an external video device such as a monitor or HDTV. • NTSC: USA, Canada, Japan, Korea, Taiwan, Mexico, etc • PAL (Supports only PAL B, D, G, H, or I): Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, England, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, Norway, etc Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC) When you connect the camera to an HDTV that supports Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC), you can control the play function of the camera with the TV remote control. • Off: You cannot control the play function of camera with the TV remote control. • On*: You can control the play function of camera with the TV remote control. HDMI Output When you connect the camera to an HDTV with an HDMI cable, you can change the resolution of the image. • NTSC: Auto*, 1080p, 720p, 480p, 576p (activates only when PAL is selected) If the connected HDTV does not support the resolution you select, the camera sets the resolution one level lower.154 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description 3D HDMI Output Select an option for playing files on a 3D TV. • Side by Side*: Displays two images next to each other. • Frame Packing: Displays the images for the left and right eye alternately in frames. File Name Set the method of creating file names. • Standard*: SAM_XXXX.JPG (sRGB)/ _SAMXXXX.JPG (Adobe RGB) • Date: - sRGB files - MMDDXXXX.JPG. For example, for a photo captured on Jan. 01, the file name would be 0101XXXX.jpg. - Adobe RGB files - _MDDXXXX.JPG for the months Jan through Sept. For the months Oct through Dec, the month number is replaced by the letters A (Oct.), B (Nov.) and C (Dec.). For example, for a photo captured on Feb. 03, the file name would be _203XXXX.jpg. For a photo captured on Oct. 05, the file name would be _A05XXXX.jpg. * Default Item Description File Number Set the method of numbering files and folders. • Reset: After using the reset function, the next file name is started at 0001. • Series*: New file numbers continue the existing number sequence, even if you have installed a new memory card, formatted the card, or deleted all photos. • The first folder name is 100PHOTO, if you have selected the sRGB color space and Standard file naming, the first file name is SAM_0001. • File name numbers are increased by 1 from SAM_0001 to SAM_9999. • Folder numbers are increased by 1 from 100PHOTO to 999PHOTO. • The maximum number of files that can be saved in one folder is 9,999. • File numbers are assigned according to DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) specifications. • If you change a file name (for example, on a computer), the camera will not be able to play the file. Folder Type Set the type of folder. • Standard*: XXXPHOTO • Date: XXX_MMDD155 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description Format Format the memory card. Formatting deletes all existing files including protected files. (Yes, No) Errors can occur if you use a memory card formatted by another brand of camera, a memory card reader, or a computer. Please format memory cards in the camera before using them to capture photos. Device Information View the firmware version of the body and the lens, Mac address, and network certification number, or update the firmware. • Firmware Update: Update the firmware of the camera body or lens. (Body Firmware, Lens Firmware) • You can download firmware upgrades from www.samsung.com. • You cannot run a firmware upgrade without a fully charged battery. Recharge the battery fully before running a firmware upgrade. • If you update the firmware, user settings and values will be reset. (Date, time, language, and video out will not change.) • Do not turn the camera off while the update is in progress. * Default Item Description Dual-band Mobile AP Set a frequency for using the camera as an AP for the AutoShare, MobileLink, or Remote Viewfinder feature. (5 GHz, 2.4 GHz*) If you use the camera in a country other than the one where it was purchased, the 5 GHz Wi-Fi feature may not function properly, due to differences in radio frequencies. In this case, use the 2.4 GHz Wi-Fi feature instead. GPS • Geotagging: Set to capture photos with location information using the Global Positioning System (GPS). Location information is added to the Exif data associated with the photo. (Off, On*) • GPS Valid Time Settings: Set the time to use the last location information when the camera fails to receive GPS signals. If the camera fails to receive GPS signals after the specified time, the location information will not be recorded onto the photos. (15 sec*, 30 sec, 1 min, 3 min, 10 min, 30 min) • Location Display: Set to display the location information on the screen in Shooting mode. The location information will appear in Korean only when you are in Korea and the display language is set to Korean. When another language is set, the location information will appear in English. (Off, On*) • GPS Reset: Set to search for GPS satellites closest to your current position. (Yes, No) To use the GPS function, you must purchase an optional GPS device.156 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description Sensor Cleaning • Sensor Cleaning: Remove dust from the sensor. • Start-Up Action: When on, the camera performs sensor cleaning each time you turn it on. (Off*, On) As this product uses interchangeable lenses, the sensor can get dust on it when you change lenses. This can lead to dust particles appearing in the photos you capture. It is recommended not to change lenses when you are in a particularly dusty area. Also, make sure to attach the lens cap to the lens when not using it. Reset Reset the setup menu and shooting options to the factory defaults. (Date, time, language, and video output settings do not change.) (Yes, No) Open Source Licenses View open source licenses.Chapter 6 Connecting to external devices Make full use of the camera by connecting it to external devices such as a computer, HDTV or 3D TV.158 Connecting to external devices Play back photos or videos by connecting your camera to an HDTV (3D TV) using an optional HDMI cable. Viewing files on an HDTV 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [m] →q→ HDMI Output→ an option. (p. 153) 2 Turn off your camera and HDTV. 3 Connect your camera to your HDTV with the optional HDMI cable. 4 Turn on your HDTV, and then select the HDMI video source. 5 Turn on the camera. • The camera automatically enters into Playback mode when you connect it to an HDTV. 6 View photos or play videos using the camera buttons. • When using the HDMI cable, you can connect the camera to an HDTV using the Anynet+(CEC) method. • The Anynet+(CEC) functions allow you to control connected devices using the TV remote control. • If the HDTV supports Anynet+(CEC), the TV turns on automatically when used in conjunction with the camera. This feature may not be available on some HDTVs. • When connected to an HDTV by an HDMI cable, the camera cannot capture a photo or video. • When connected to an HDTV, some of the camera’s playback functions may not be available. • The length of time after which the camera and an HDTV are connected may vary depending on the memory card that you are using. As the main feature of a memory card is to increase the transfer speed, it is not necessarily true to say that a memory card with a faster transfer speed is also fast in using the HDMI function. • 1920X1080 (60 fps) videos can be played only on full HDTVs capable of playback at 60 fps. Viewing files on an HDTV or 3D TV159 Connecting to external devices > Viewing files on an HDTV or 3D TV Viewing files on a 3D TV You can view photos or videos captured in 3D mode or with the 3D Panorama option in Smart mode on a 3D TV. 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [m] →q→ HDMI Output→ an option. (p. 153) 2 Select 3D HDMI Output→ an option. (p. 154) 3 Turn off your camera and 3D TV. 4 Connect your camera to your 3D TV with the optional HDMI cable. 5 Turn on your 3D TV, and then select the HDMI video source. 6 Turn on your camera. • The camera automatically enters into Playback mode when you connect it to a 3D TV. 7 Move to a 3D file, and then press [I] to switch to 3D mode. • Press [I] again to switch to 2D Mode. 8 Turn on your TV's 3D function. • Refer to your TV's user manual for more details. 9 View 3D photos or play 3D videos using the camera buttons. • You cannot view an MPO file in 3D effect on TVs that do not support the file format. • Use proper 3D glasses when you view an MPO file or a 3D video file on a 3D TV. • Capturing photos in 3D Panorama mode may result in a less pronounced 3D effect than those captured in 3D mode with a 3D lens. Do not view the 3D photos or videos captured by your camera on a 3D TV or 3D monitor for an extended period of time. It may cause unpleasant symptoms, such as eyestrain, fatigue, nausea, and more.160 Connecting to external devices Transfer files on a memory card to your computer by connecting the camera to the PC. Transferring files to your Windows OS computer Connecting the camera as a removable disk You can connect the camera to your computer as a removable disk. 1 Turn off the camera. 2 Connect the camera to your computer with the USB cable. • You must plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. • If you try to plug the USB cable into the HDMI port, the camera may not work properly. 3 Turn on the camera. • The computer recognizes the camera automatically. 4 On your computer, select My Computer→Removable Disk →DCIM→100PHOTO or 101_0101. 5 Select the files you want, and then drag or save them to your computer. If the Folder Type is set to Date, the folder name appears as “XXX_MMDD”. For example, if you capture a photo on January 1, the folder name will be "101_0101". Transferring files to your computer161 Connecting to external devices > Transferring files to your computer Disconnecting the camera (for Windows XP) With Windows Vista, Windows 7, and Windows 8, the methods for disconnecting the camera are similar. 1 Ensure that no data is being transferred between the camera and the computer. • If the status lamp on your camera is blinking, it means the data transfer is in progress. Please wait until the status lamp stops blinking. 2 Click on the tool bar at the bottom right of your computer screen. 3 Click the pop-up message. 4 Click the message box indicating safely removed. 5 Remove the USB cable. Transferring files to your Mac OS Mac OS 10.5 or later is supported. 1 Turn off the camera. 2 Connect your camera to a Macintosh computer with the USB cable. • You must plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. • If you try to plug the USB cable into the HDMI port, the camera may not work properly.162 Connecting to external devices > Transferring files to your computer 3 Turn on the camera. • The computer recognizes the camera automatically and displays a removable disk icon. 4 Open the removable disk. 5 Transfer photos or videos to the Mac OS computer.163 Connecting to external devices You can view and edit files using the provided programs. You can also send the files to a PC wirelessly. Installing programs from the provided CD 1 Insert the installation CD into your PC. 2 Select a language. 3 Select a program to install. 4 Follow the on-screen instructions. 5 Click Exit to complete the installation. Available programs when using i-Launcher Item Description Multimedia Viewer You can view files with Multimedia Viewer. Firmware Upgrade You can download the firmware of your camera. PC Auto Backup You can send photos or videos that you captured with the camera to a PC wirelessly. Using i-Launcher i-Launcher allows you to play back files with Multimedia Viewer and provides a link to download the PC Auto Backup program. Requirements for Windows OS Item Requirements CPU Intel® i5 3.3 GHz or higher/ AMD Phenom™ II x4 3.2 GHz or higher RAM Minimum 512 MB RAM (1 GB or more recommended) OS* Windows XP SP2, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows 8 Hard disk capacity 250 MB or more (1 GB and above recommended) Others • CD-ROM drive • 1024X768 pixels, 16-bit color display compatible monitor (1280X1024 pixels, 32-bit color display recommended) • USB 2.0 port • nVIDIA Geforce 7600GT or higher/ ATI X1600 series or higher • Microsoft DirectX 9.0c or higher * A 32-bit version of i-Launcher will be installed—even on 64-bit editions of Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, and Windows 8. Using programs on a PC164 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC • The requirements are recommendation only. i-Launcher may not work properly even when the computer meets the requirements, depending on the condition of your computer. • If your computer does not meet the requirements, videos may not play correctly. The manufacturer is not responsible for any damage that results from using unqualified computers such as a computer you assembled yourself. Requirements for Mac OS Item Requirements OS Mac OS 10.5 or higher (except PowerPC) RAM Minimum 256 MB RAM (512 MB or more recommended) Hard disk capacity Minimum 110 MB Others USB 2.0 port, CD-ROM drive Opening i-Launcher On your computer, select Start→All Programs→Samsung→ i-Launcher→Samsung i-Launcher. Or, click Applications→Samsung →i-Launcher on your Mac OS computer.165 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC Using Multimedia Viewer Multimedia Viewer allows you to play back files. From the Samsung i-Launcher screen, click Multimedia Viewer. • Multimedia Viewer supports the following formats: - Videos: MP4 (Video: H.264, Audio: AAC), WMV (WMV 7/8/9), AVI (MJPEG) - Photos: JPG, GIF, BMP, PNG, TIFF, MPO • Files that have been recorded with other manufacturers’ devices may not play back smoothly. Viewing photos 1 2 3 1011 456789 No. Description 1 File name 2 Enlarged area 3 Histogram 4 Open the selected file. 5 Histogram button 6 Rotate to the left/Rotate to the right. 7 Move to the previous file/Move to the next file. 8 Fit the photo to the screen. 9 View the photo in the original size. 10 Zoom in/Zoom out 11 Switches between 2D and 3D mode.166 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC Viewing videos 1 2 8 4567 3 No. Description 1 File name 2 Adjust the volume. 3 Open the selected file. 4 Move to the next file. 5 Stop No. Description 6 Pause 7 Move to the previous file. 8 Progress bar Downloading the firmware From the Samsung i-Launcher screen, click Firmware Upgrade. Downloading the PC Auto Backup program From the Samsung i-Launcher screen, click PC Auto Backup. For information about installing the PC Auto Backup program, refer to page 133.167 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC Installing Adobe Photoshop Lightroom 1 Insert Adobe Photoshop Lightroom DVD-ROM into your PC. 2 Select a language. 3 Follow the on-screen instructions. Using Adobe Photoshop Lightroom Photos captured by a camera are often transformed to JPEG formats and stored in the memory according to the settings of the camera at the time of shooting. RAW files are not transformed to JPEG formats and are stored in the memory without any changes. With Adobe Photoshop Lightroom, you can calibrate exposures, White Balances, tones, contrasts, and colors of photos. You can also edit JPEG or TIFF files as well as RAW files. For more information, refer to the program guide.Chapter 7 Appendix Get information about error messages, camera maintenance, trouble shooting tips, specifications, and optional accessories. 169 Appendix When the following error messages appear, try these remedies. Error messages Suggested remedies Lens is locked The lens is locked. Rotate the lens counter-clockwise until you hear a click. (p. 45) Card Error • Turn off your camera, and then turn it on again. • Remove your memory card and insert it again. • Format your memory card. Low Battery Insert a charged battery or recharge the battery. No Image File Capture photos or insert a memory card that contains photos. File Error Delete the damaged file or contact a service center. Memory Full Delete unnecessary files or insert a new memory card. Card Locked You can lock SD, SDHC, SDXC, or UHS-1 card to prevent files from being deleted. Unlock the card when shooting. (p. 173) Error messages Suggested remedies Folder and file number are max values. Replace the card File names do not match the DCF standard. Transfer the files on the memory card to your computer and format the card. (p. 155) Error 00 Turn off your camera and remount the lens. If the message still appears, contact a service center. Error 01/02 Turn off your camera, remove the battery, and insert again. If the message still appears, contact a service center. Error messages170 Appendix Cleaning the camera Camera lens and display Use a brush to remove dust and wipe the lens gently with a soft cloth. If any dust remains, apply lens cleaning liquid to a piece of cleaning paper and wipe gently. Image sensor Depending on different shooting conditions, dust may appear in photos because the image sensor is exposed to the external environment. This problem is normal, and the exposure to dust occurs in everyday use of the camera. You can remove dust from the sensor by operating the sensor cleaning function. (p. 156) If dust remains after cleaning the sensor, contact a service center. Do not insert the blower into the mounting opening of the lens. Camera body Wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. Never use benzene, thinners, or alcohol to clean the device. These solutions can damage the camera or cause it to malfunction. Maintaining the camera171 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Using on beaches or shores • Protect your camera from sand and dirt when you use it on beaches or in other similar areas. • Your camera is not waterproof. Do not handle the battery, adapter, or memory card with wet hands. Operating the camera with wet hands may cause damage to your camera. Storing for extended period of time • When you store the camera for an extended period, place it in a sealed container with an absorbent material, such as silica gel. • Over time, unused batteries will discharge and must be recharged before use. • The present date and time can be initialized when the camera is turned on after the camera and battery have been separated for a prolonged period. Using or storing the camera Inappropriate places to use or store the camera • Avoid exposing the camera to very cold or very hot temperatures. • Avoid using your camera in areas with extremely high humidity, or where the humidity changes drastically. • Avoid exposing the camera to direct sunlight and storing it in hot, poorly-ventilated areas, such as in a car during summer time. • Protect your camera and the display from impact, rough handling, and excessive vibration to avoid serious damage. • Avoid using or storing your camera in dusty, dirty, humid, or poorlyventilated areas to prevent damage to moving parts and internal components. • Do not use your camera near fuels, combustibles, or flammable chemicals. Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or explosive materials in the same compartment as the camera or its accessories. • Do not store the camera where there are mothballs.172 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Using the camera with caution in humid environments When you transfer the camera from a cold environment to a warm one, condensation can form on the lens or internal components of the camera. In this situation, turn off the camera and wait for at least 1 hour. If condensation forms on the memory card, remove the memory card from the camera and wait until all moisture has evaporated before reinserting it. Other cautions • Do not swing your camera by the strap. This may cause injury to yourself or others or damage to your camera. • Do not paint your camera, as paint can clog moving parts and prevent proper operation. • Turn off the camera when not using it. • Your camera consists of delicate parts. Avoid impacts to the camera. • Protect the display from external force by keeping it in the case when not in use. Protect the camera from scratches by keeping it away from sand, sharp implements, or loose change. • Do not use the camera if the screen is cracked or broken. Broken glass or acrylic could cause injury to your hands and face. Take the camera to a Samsung service center to have it repaired. • Never place cameras, batteries, chargers, or accessories near, on, or in heating devices, such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. These devices may be deformed and can overheat and cause a fire or explosion. • Do not expose the lens to direct sunlight, as this may discolor the image sensor or cause it to malfunction. • Protect your lens from fingerprints and scratches. Clean your lens with a soft, clean, debris-free lens cloth. • The camera may turn off if impacted from the outside. This is to protect the memory card. Turn on the camera to use it again. • While you use the camera, it may heat up. This is normal and should not affect your camera’s lifespan or performance. • When you use the camera in low temperatures, it may take some time to turn on, the color of the display may be changed temporarily, or afterimages may appear. These conditions are not malfunctions and they will correct themselves when the camera is returned to milder temperatures. • Paint or metal on the outside of the camera may cause allergies, itchy skin, eczema, or swelling for people with sensitive skin. If you experience any of these symptoms, stop using the camera immediately and consult a doctor. • Do not insert foreign objects into any of your camera’s compartments, slots, or access points. Damage due to improper use may not be covered by your warranty. • Do not allow unqualified personnel to service the camera or attempt to service the camera yourself. Any damage that results from unqualified service is not covered by your warranty.173 Appendix > Maintaining the camera About memory card Supported memory card This product supports SD (Secure Digital), SDHC (Secure Digital High Capacity), SDXC (Secure Digital eXtended Capacity), UHS-1 (Ultra High Speed-1), microSD, microSDHC, microSDXC, or microUHS-1 memory cards. Terminal Write-protect switch Label (front) You can prevent files from being deleted by using the write-protect switch on an SD, SDHC, SDXC, or UHS-1 card. Slide the switch down to lock or slide it up to unlock. Unlock the card when capturing photos and videos. Memory card adapter Memory card To use micro memory cards with this product, a PC, or a memory card reader, insert the card into an adapter.174 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Memory card capacity The memory capacity may differ depending on shooting scenes or shooting conditions. These capacities are based on a 2 GB SD card. Size Quality Super Fine Fine Normal RAW RAW + S.Fine RAW + Fine RAW + Normal Photo 20.0M (5472X3648) 151 179 218 69 47 49 52 10.1M (3888X2592) 276 321 384 - 62 64 66 5.9M (2976X1984) 423 484 565 - 71 72 74 2.0M (1728X1152) 845 923 1,016 - 82 83 84 Burst 479 545 631 - - - - 16.9M (5472X3080) 177 208 252 - 51 53 56 7.8M (3712X2088) 343 396 467 - 66 68 70 4.9M (2944X1656) 487 553 640 - 74 75 76 2.1M (1920X1080) 827 905 999 - 82 83 84 13.3M (3648X3648) 218 255 307 - 56 58 61 7.0M (2640X2640) 373 429 504 - 68 70 72 4.0M (2000X2000) 559 630 721 - 76 77 78 1.1M (1024X1024) 1,111 1,180 1,258 - 86 86 87175 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Size Quality HQ Normal Video 1920X1080 (60 fps) Approx. 10' 10" Approx. 12' 43" 1920X1080 (30 fps) Approx. 17' 41" Approx. 22' 09" * 1920X1080 (15 fps) Approx. 23' 38" Approx. 29' 24" 1920X810 (24 fps) Approx. 21' 35" Approx. 27' 02" 1280X720 (60 fps) Approx. 16' 51" Approx. 21' 06" 1280X720 (30 fps) Approx. 29' 11" Approx. 36' 35" 640X480 (30 fps) Approx. 120' 47" Approx. 153' 30" For Sharing (30 fps) Approx. 218' 48" Approx. 278' 24" * is available only with some Smart Filter options. • The figures above are measured without using the zoom function. • Available recording time may vary if you use the zoom. • Several videos were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. • The maximum recording time is 29 minutes and 59 seconds per file. • The maximum playback time of For Sharing videos is 30 seconds per file.176 Appendix > Maintaining the camera • Prevent memory cards from making contact with liquids, dirt, or foreign substances. If dirty, wipe the memory card clean with a soft cloth before you insert the memory card in your camera. • Do not allow liquids, dirt, or foreign substances to come in contact with memory cards or the memory card slot. Doing so may cause memory cards or the camera to malfunction. • When you carry a memory card, use a case to protect the card from electrostatic discharges. • Transfer important data to other media, such as a hard disk, CD, or DVD. • When you use the camera for an extended period, the memory card may become warm. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. • Use a memory card that meets the standard requirements. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. Cautions when using memory cards • Avoid memory cards to very cold or very hot temperatures (below 0 °C/32 °F or above 40 °C/104 °F). Extreme temperatures can cause memory cards to malfunction. • Insert a memory card in the correct direction. Inserting a memory card in the wrong direction may damage your camera and memory card. • Do not use memory cards that have been formatted by other cameras or by a computer. Reformat the memory card with your camera. • Turn off the camera when you insert or remove the memory card. • Do not remove the memory card or turn off your camera while the lamp is blinking, as this may damage your data. • When the lifespan of a memory card has expired, you cannot store any more photos on the card. Use a new memory card. • Do not bend, drop, or subject memory cards to heavy impact or pressure. • Avoid using or storing memory cards near strong magnetic fields. • Avoid using or keeping memory cards in areas with high temperature, high humidity, or corrosive substances.177 Appendix > Maintaining the camera • Do not rest the device on flammable surfaces, such as bedding, carpets, or electric blankets for a prolonged period. • When the device is switched on, do not leave it in any confined space for a prolonged period. • Do not allow battery terminals to come in contact with metallic objects, such as necklaces, coins, keys, or watches. • Use only authentic, manufacturer-recommended, Lithium-ion replacement batteries. • Do not disassemble the battery or puncture the battery with any sharp object. • Avoid exposing the battery to high pressure or crushing forces. • Avoid exposing the battery to major impacts, such as dropping it from high places. • Do not expose the battery to temperatures of 60 °C (140 °F) or above. • Do not allow the battery to come in contact with moisture or liquids. • Battery shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as sunshine, fire or the like. Disposal guidelines • Dispose of the battery with care. • Do not dispose of the battery in a fire. • Disposal regulations may differ by country or region. Dispose of the battery in accordance with all local and federal regulations. Guidelines for charging the battery Charge the battery only by the method described in this user manual. The battery can ignite or explode if not charged properly. About the battery Use only Samsung-approved batteries. Battery specifications Item Description Model BP1130 Type Lithium-ion battery Cell capacity 1,130 mAh Voltage 7.6 V Charging time* (When the battery is completely discharged) Approx. 215 min * Charging the battery by connecting it to a computer may take longer. Personal injury or death can occur if the battery is handled carelessly or improperly. For your safety, follow these instructions for proper battery handling: • The battery can ignite or explode if not handled properly. If you notice any deformities, cracks, or other abnormalities in the battery, immediately discontinue use of the battery and contact your manufacturer. • Use only authentic, manufacturer-recommend battery chargers and charge the battery only by the method described in this user manual. • Do not place the battery near heating devices or expose to excessively warm environments, such as the inside of an enclosed car in the summertime. • Do not place the battery in a microwave oven. • Avoid storing or using the battery in hot, humid places, such as spas or shower enclosures.178 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Battery life Shooting mode Average time / Number of photos Photos Approx. 165 min/Approx. 330 photos Videos Approx. 110 min (Record videos at 1920X1080 resolution and 60 fps.) • The figures above are based on the CIPA test standards. Your results may differ depending on your actual usage. • Available shooting time differs depending on background, shooting interval, and use conditions. • Several videos were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. Low battery message When the battery has fully discharged, the battery icon will turn red and the "Low Battery" message will appear. Notes about using the battery • Avoid exposing batteries to very cold or very hot temperatures (below 0 °C/32 °F or above 40 °C/104 °F). Extreme temperatures can reduce the charging capacity of your batteries. • When you use the camera for an extended period, the area around the battery chamber may become warm. This does not affect the normal use of the camera. • Do not pull the power supply cord to disconnect the plug from the power outlet, as this may cause a fire or electric shock. • In temperatures below 0 °C/32 °F, battery capacity and battery life may decrease. • Battery capacity may decrease in low temperatures, but will return to normal in milder temperatures. • Remove the batteries from your camera when storing it for an extended period. Installed batteries may leak or corrode over time and cause serious damage to your camera. Storing the camera for extended periods with the battery installed causes the battery to discharge. You may not be able to recharge a fully discharged battery. • When you do not use the camera for an extended period (3 months or more), check the battery and recharge it regularly. If you let the battery discharge continually, its capacity and life may decrease, which can lead to a malfunction, fire, or explosion.179 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Cautions about using the battery Protect batteries, chargers, and memory cards from damage. Prevent batteries from making contact with metal objects, as this can create a connection between the + and – terminals of your battery and lead to temporary or permanent battery damage and may cause a fire or electric shock. Notes about charging the battery • If the status lamp is off, make sure that the battery is inserted correctly. • If the camera is on while charging, the battery may not fully charge. Turn off the camera before charging the battery. • Do not use your camera when you are charging the battery. This may cause a fire or electric shock. • Do not pull the power supply cord to disconnect the plug from the power outlet, as this may cause a fire or electric shock. • Let the battery charge for at least 10 minutes before turning on the camera. • If you connect the camera to an external power source when the battery is depleted, using high energy-consuming functions will cause the camera to turn off. To use the camera normally, recharge the battery. • If you reconnect the power cable when the battery is fully charged, the status lamp turns on for approximately 30 minutes. • Using the flash or recording videos depletes the battery quickly. Charge the battery until the red status lamp turns off. • If the status lamp blinks in red, reconnect the cable, or remove the battery and insert it again. • If you charge the battery when the cable is overheated or the temperature is too high, the status lamp may blink in red. Charging will start when the battery cools down. • Overcharging batteries may shorten battery life. After charging is finished, disconnect the cable from your camera. • Do not bend or place heavy objects on the AC cable. Doing so may damage the cable.180 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Notes about charging with a computer connected • Use only the provided USB cable. • The battery may not charge when: - you use a USB hub - other USB devices are connected to your computer - you connect the cable to the port on the front side of your computer - the USB port of your computer does not support the power output standard (5 V, 500 mA) Handle and dispose of batteries and chargers with care • Never dispose of batteries in a fire. Follow all local regulations when you dispose of used batteries. • Never place batteries or cameras on or in heating devices, such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. Batteries may explode when they are overheated.181 Appendix Before contacting a service center If you are having trouble with your device, try these troubleshooting solutions before contacting a service professional. When you leave your camera at a service center, be sure to also leave the other components that may have contributed to the malfunction, such as the memory card and battery. Situation Suggested remedies Cannot turn on the camera • Ensure that the battery is inserted. • Ensure that the battery is inserted correctly. • Charge the battery. The power turns off suddenly • Charge the battery. • Your camera may be in Power save mode or the display turns off automatically. (p. 153) • The camera may be turned off automatically to prevent the memory card from being damaged due to excessive heat. Turn on your camera again. The camera is losing battery power quickly • The battery may lose power more quickly in low temperatures (below 0 °C/32 °F). Keep the battery warm by putting it into your pocket. • Using the flash or recording videos depletes the battery quickly. Recharge if needed. • Batteries are consumable parts that must be replaced over time. Get a new battery if the battery life is diminishing quickly. Situation Suggested remedies Cannot capture photos • There is no space on the memory card. Delete unnecessary files or insert a new card. • Format the memory card. • The memory card is defective. Get a new memory card. • The memory card is locked. Unlock the card. (p. 173) • Ensure that the camera is switched on. • Charge the battery. • Ensure that the battery is inserted correctly. The camera freezes Remove the battery and insert it again. The camera heats up While using the camera, it may heat up. This is normal and should not affect your camera’s lifespan or performance. The flash fires unexpectedly The flash may fire due to static electricity. The camera is not malfunctioning. The flash does not work • The flash option may be set to Off. (p. 94) • You cannot use the flash in some modes. The date and time are incorrect Set the date and time under the q menu. (p. 153) The display or buttons do not work Remove the battery and insert it again.182 Appendix > Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies The memory card has an error • Turn off your camera, and then turn it on again. • Remove your memory card, and then insert it again. • Format your memory card. See "Cautions when using memory cards" for more details. (p. 176) Your computer does not recognize an SDXC or UHS-1 memory card SDXC memory cards use the exFAT file system. To use SDXC memory cards or UHS-1 memory cards that are formatted with the exFAT file system on a Windows XP computer, download and update the exFAT file system driver from the Microsoft website. Your TV or computer cannot display photos and videos that are stored on an SDXC or UHS-1 memory card SDXC memory cards use the exFAT file system. To use SDXC memory cards or UHS-1 memory cards that are formatted with the exFAT file system, ensure that the external device is compatible with the exFAT file system before connecting the camera to the device. Cannot display files If you change the name of a file, your camera may not play the file (the name of the file should meet the DCF standard). If you encounter this situation, display files on your computer. The photo is blurry • Ensure that the focus option you set is suitable for the kind of shot you are capturing. • Use a tripod to prevent your camera from shaking. • Ensure that the lens is clean. If not, clean the lens. (p. 170) Situation Suggested remedies The colors in the photo do not match the actual scene An incorrect White Balance can create unrealistic color. Select the proper White Balance option to suit the light source. (p. 76) The photo is too bright or too dark. Your photo is overexposed or underexposed. • Adjust the aperture value or the shutter speed. • Adjust the ISO sensitivity. (p. 75) • Turn off or on the flash. (p. 94) • Adjust the exposure value. (p. 102) Photos are distorted This camera can have minute distortion when using a wide-angle lens that enables shooting with a wide angle of view. This is normal, and does not cause malfunction. Playback screen does not appear on the connected external device • Ensure that HDMI cable is properly connected to the external monitor. • Ensure that the memory card is properly recorded. Your computer does not recognize your camera • Ensure that the USB cable is connected correctly. • Ensure that your camera is switched on. • Ensure that you are using a supported operating system. Your computer disconnects the camera while transferring files The file transfer may be interrupted by static electricity. Disconnect the USB cable and connect it again. 183 Appendix > Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies Your computer cannot play videos Videos may not play on some video player programs. To play video files captured with your camera, use the Multimedia Viewer program that you can install with the i-Launcher program on your computer. i-Launcher is not functioning properly • End i-Launcher and restart the program. • Depending on your computer's specifications and environment, the program may not launch automatically. In this case, click Start→All Programs→Samsung→ i-Launcher→Samsung i-Launcher on your Windows computer. (For Windows 8, open Start screen, and then select All apps→ Samsung i-Launcher.) Or, click Applications →Samsung→i-Launcher on your Mac OS computer. Cannot set the DPOF for RAW files You cannot set the DPOF for RAW files. Auto Focus does not work • Subject is not in focus. When the subject is outside the AF area, shoot by moving the subject inside the AF area and half-pressing [Shutter]. • Subject is too close. Step back from the subject and shoot. • The focus mode is set to MF. Switch the mode to AF. Situation Suggested remedies AEL feature does not work AEL feature does not work in t, M, i, and s modes. Select another mode to use this feature. Lens does not work • Ensure that the lens is properly mounted. • Remove the lens from the camera and re-mount it. External flash or GPS does not work Ensure that the external device is properly mounted and turned on. The date & time settings screen appears when you power on the camera • Set the date and time again. • This screen appears when the camera’s internal power source is completely discharged. Insert a fully charged battery and wait at least 72 hours in power off status for the internal power source to be recharged.184 Appendix Camera specifications Image Sensor Type CMOS Sensor size 23.5 X 15.7 mm Effective pixels Approx. 20.3 mega-pixels Total pixels Approx. 21.6 mega-pixels Color filter RGB primary color filter Lens Mount Type Samsung NX Mount Available lens Samsung lenses Image Stabilization Type Lens shift (depends on lens) Mode Off/Mode 1/Mode 2 Distortion Correct Off/On (depends on lens) i-Function E, Z (X1.2, 1.4, 1.7, 2.0) Dust Reduction Type Super sonic drive Display Type AMOLED with Touch Panel (C-type Touch Control Enabled) Size 3.31" (Approx. 84.0 mm) Resolution WVGA (800X480) 768 k dots (PenTile) Field of view Approx. 100 % Angle Tiltable (Up 90°, Down 45°) User display Grid Line, Icons, Histogram, Distance Scale, Level gauge Focusing Type Phase Detection & Contrast AF Focusing point • Total AF point: 105 points (Phase Detection AF), 247 points (Contrast AF) • Selection: 1 point (Free selection) • Multi: Normal 21 (3 X 7) points (Cross point 1), Close up 35 points • Face detection: Max. 10 faces Mode Single AF, Continuous AF, Manual Focus, Touch AF & Shutter AF Assist Lamp Green LED185 Appendix > Camera specifications Shutter Type Electronically controlled vertical-run focal plane shutter Speed • Auto: 1/6,000–30 sec. • Manual: 1/6,000–30 sec. (1/3 EV Step) • Bulb (time limit: 4 min) Exposure Metering system TTL 221 (17 X 13) Block segment Metering: Multi, Center-weighted, Spot Metering range: EV 0–18 (ISO100 · 30 mm, F2) Compensation ±3 EV (1/3 EV Step) AE lock CUSTOM key ISO equivalent • 1 Step: Auto, ISO 100, ISO 200, ISO 400, ISO 800, ISO 1600, ISO 3200, ISO 6400, ISO 12800, ISO 25600 • 1/3 Step: Auto, ISO 100, ISO 125, ISO 160, ISO 200, ISO 250, ISO 320, ISO 400, ISO 500, ISO 640, ISO 800, ISO 1000, ISO 1250, ISO 1600, ISO 2000, ISO 2500, ISO 3200, ISO 4000, ISO 5000, ISO 6400, ISO 8000, ISO 10000, ISO 12800, ISO 16000, ISO 20000, ISO 25600 Drive Mode Mode Single, Continuous, Burst (5M only), Timer, Bracket (Auto Exposure, White Balance, Picture Wizard) Continuous shooting • JPEG: High (8.6 fps), Normal (5 fps) • RAW: High (8.6 fps), Normal (5 fps) Burst shooting • 10, 15, or 30 frames per second • Up to 30 shots per shutter-press Bracket shooting Auto exposure bracketing (±3 EV), White Balance bracketing, Picture Wizard bracketing Self-timer 2–30 sec. (1 second interval) Shutter release SR2NX02 (via Micro USB port) (optional) Flash Type External Flash (Bundle with SEF8A) Mode Smart Flash, Auto, Auto Red-eye, Fill in, Fill-in Red, 1st Curtain, 2nd Curtain, Off Guide number 8 (based on ISO 100) (SEF8A) Angle of view 28 mm (35 mm film equivalent) Sync speed Less than 1/180 sec.186 Appendix > Camera specifications Flash EV -2–+2 EV (0.5 EV Step) External flash Optional Samsung external flashes: SEF42A, SEF220A Sync terminal Hot-shoe White Balance Mode Auto WB, Daylight, Cloudy, Fluorescent White, Fluorescent NW, Fluorescent Daylight, Tungsten, Flash WB, Custom Set, Color Temperature (Manual) Micro adjustment Amber/Blue/Green/Magenta 7 steps respectively Dynamic Range Off/Smart Range+/HDR Picture Wizard Mode Standard, Vivid, Portrait, Landscape, Forest, Retro, Cool, Calm, Classic, Custom1, Custom2, Custom3 Parameter Color, Saturation, Sharpness, Contrast Shooting Mode Smart Auto, Program, Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, Manual, Lens Priority, Smart Smart mode Beauty Face, Best Face, Landscape, Macro, Action Freeze, Rich Tones, Panorama, Waterfall, Silhouette, Sunset, Night, Fireworks, Light Trace, Creative Shot Smart Filter Vignetting, Miniature, Colored Pencil, Watercolor, Wash drawing, Oil Sketch, Ink Sketch, Acryl, Negative, Red, Green, Blue, Yellow Size • JPEG (3:2): 20.0M (5472X3648), 10.1M (3888X2592), 5.9M (2976X1984), 5.0M (2736X1824) (Burst mode only), 2.0M (1728X1152) • JPEG (16:9): 16.9M (5472X3080), 7.8M (3712X2088), 4.9M (2944X1656), 2.1M (1920X1080) • JPEG (1:1): 13.3M (3648X3648), 7.0M (2640X2640), 4.0M (2000X2000), 1.1M (1024X1024) • RAW: 20.0M (5472X3648) * 3D mode with 3D lens is available only with JPEG (16:9) 4.1M (2688X1512) or 2.1M (1920X1080). Quality Super Fine, Fine, Normal RAW standard SRW (ver.2.0.0) Color space sRGB, Adobe RGB187 Appendix > Camera specifications Video Type MP4 (H.264) Format Movie: H.264, Sound: AAC Movie AE mode Program, Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, Manual Movie clip Audio on/off (Shooting time: Max. 29' 59'') Smart Filter Vignetting, Miniature, Colored Pencil, Watercolor, Wash drawing, Oil Sketch, Ink Sketch, Acryl, Negative, Red, Green, Blue, Yellow Size 1920X1080, 1920X810, 1280X720, 640X480, 320X240 (For Sharing) Frame rate 60 fps, 30 fps, 24 fps (available only with 1920X810), 15 fps (available only with some Smart Filter options) Multi Motion x0.25 (640X480, 320X240 only), x0.5 (1280X720 (30 fps), 640X480, 320X240 only), x1, x5, x10, x20 Quality HQ, Normal Sound Stereo Edit Still image capture, Time trimming Playback Type Single image, Thumbnails (15/28), Slide show, Movie Edit Smart Filter, Red-eye Fix, Backlight, Resize, Rotate, Face Retouch, Brightness, Contrast Smart filter Vignetting, Miniature, Colored Pencil, Watercolor, Wash drawing, Oil Sketch, Ink Sketch, Acryl, Negative, Red, Green, Blue, Yellow Smart filter size • JPEG (3:2): 5.9M (2976X1984), 5.0M (2736X1824), 2.0M (1728X1152) • JPEG (16:9): 6.2M (3328X1872), 4.9M (2944X1656), 2.1M (1920X1080) • JPEG (1:1): 6.0M (2448X2448), 4.0M (2000X2000), 1.1M (1024X1024) Storage Media External memory (optional)*: SD card (2 GB guaranteed), SDHC card (up to 32 GB guaranteed), SDXC card (up to 64 GB guaranteed), UHS-1 card * Class 6 and above recommended File format RAW (SRW (ver.2.0.0)), JPEG (EXIF 2.21), MPO (3D), DCF, DPOF 1.1 GPS Type Geo-tagging with an optional GPS Module (WGS 84) Feature Location name (English and Korean only)188 Appendix > Camera specifications Wireless network Type IEEE 802.11b/g/n support Dual Band Function MobileLink, Remote Viewfinder, Auto Backup, Email, SNS & Cloud, AllShare Play, AutoShare, Wi-Fi Direct NFC Yes Interface Digital output USB 2.0 (micro USB jack) Video output • NTSC, PAL (selectable) • HDMI External release Yes (micro USB) External microphone Yes DC power input DC 5.0V, 1A via micro USB Power Source Type Rechargeable battery: BP1130 (1,130 mAh) * The power source may differ depending on your region. Dimensions (W X H X D) 122 X 63.7 X 40.7 mm (without protrusions) Weight 284 g (without battery and memory card) Operating Temperature 0–40 °C Operating Humidity 5–85 % Software i-Launcher, Adobe Photoshop Lightroom * Specifications may change without notice to improve performance. * Other brands and products names are trademarks of respective owners.189 Appendix Glossary AP (Access Point) An access point is a device that allows wireless devices to connect to a wired network. Ad-Hoc network An ad-hoc network is a temporary connection for sharing files or an internet connection and between computers and devices. AdobeRGB Adobe RGB is used for commercial printing and has a larger color range than sRGB. Its wider range of colors helps you to easily edit photos on a computer. AEB (Auto Exposure Bracket) This feature automatically captures several images at different exposures to help you capture a properly-exposed image. AEL/AFL (Auto Exposure Lock/Auto Focus Lock) These features help you lock the exposure or focus on which you want to focus or calculate the exposure. AF (Auto Focus) A system that automatically focuses the camera lens on the subject. Your camera uses the contrast to focus automatically. AMOLED (Active-matrix organic light-emitting diode) / LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) AMOLED is a visual display that is very thin and light, as it does not need backlighting. LCD is a visual display commonly used in consumer electronics. This display needs a separate backlight, such as CCFL or LED, to reproduce colors. Aperture The aperture controls the amount of light that reaches the camera’s sensor.190 Appendix > Glossary Composition Composition in photography means arranging objects in a photo. Usually, abiding by the rule of thirds leads to a good composition. DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) A specification to define a file format and file system for digital cameras created by the Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association (JEITA). Depth of field The distance between the nearest and farthest points that can be acceptably focused in a photograph. Depth of field varies with lens aperture, focal length, and distance from the camera to the subject. Selecting a smaller aperture, for example, will increase the depth of field and blur the background of a composition. DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) A format for writing printing information, such as selected images and number of prints, on a memory card. DPOF-compatible printers, sometimes available at photo shops, can read the information from the card for convenient printing. Camera shake (Blur) If the camera is moved while the shutter is open, the entire image may appear blurred. This occurs more often when the shutter speed is slow. Prevent camera shake by raising the sensitivity, using the flash, or using a faster shutter speed. Alternatively, use a tripod or the OIS function to stabilize the camera. Cloud Computing Cloud computing is a technology that allows you to store data on remote servers and to use them from a device with internet access. Color space The range of colors that the camera can see. Color temperature Color Temperature is a measurement in degrees Kelvin (K) that indicates the hue of a specific type of light source. As the color temperature increases, the color of the light source has a more bluish quality. As the color temperature decreases, the color of the light source has a more reddish quality. At 5,500 degrees Kelvin, the color of the light source is similar to the sun at midday.191 Appendix > Glossary Flash A speed light that helps to create adequate exposure in low-light conditions. Focal length The distance from the middle of the lens to its focal point(in millimeters). Longer focal lengths result in narrower angles of view and the subject is magnified. Shorter focal lengths result in wider angles of view. Histogram A graphical representation of the brightness of an image. The horizontal axis represents the brightness and the vertical axis represents the number of pixels. High points at the left (too dark) and right (too bright) on the histogram indicate a photo that is improperly exposed. H.264/MPEG-4 A high-compression video format established by international standard organizations ISO-IEC and ITU-T. This codec is capable of providing good video quality at low bit rates developed by the Joint Video Team (JVT). EV (Exposure Value) All the combinations of the camera’s shutter speed and lens aperture that result in the same exposure. EV Compensation This feature allows you to quickly adjust the exposure value measured by the camera, in limited increments, to improve the exposure of your photos. Exif (Exchangeable Image File Format) A specification to define an image file format for digital cameras created by the Japan Electronic Industries Development Association (JEIDA). Exposure The amount of light allowed to reach the camera’s sensor. Exposure is controlled by a combination of the shutter speed, the aperture value, and ISO sensitivity.192 Appendix > Glossary Metering The metering refers to the way in which the camera measures the quantity of light to set the exposure. MF (Manual Focus) A system that manually focuses the camera lens on the subject. You can use the focus ring to focus on a subject. MJPEG (Motion JPEG) A video format which is compressed as a JPEG image. MPO (Multi Picture Object) An image file format that contains multiple images in a file. An MPO file provides a 3D effect on MPO-compatible displays, such as 3D TVs or 3D monitors. Image sensor The physical part of a digital camera that contains a photosite for each pixel in the image. Each photosite records the brightness of the light that strikes it during an exposure. Common sensor types are CCD (Chargecoupled Device) and CMOS (Complementary Metal Oxide Semiconductor). IP (Internet protocol) address An IP address is a unique number that is assigned to every device that is connected to the internet. ISO sensitivity The sensitivity of the camera to light, based on the equivalent film speed used in a film camera. At higher ISO sensitivity settings, the camera uses a higher shutter speed, which can reduce blur caused by camera shake and low light. However, images with high sensitivity are more susceptible to noise. JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group) A lossy method of compression for digital images. JPEG images are compressed to reduce their overall file size with minimal deterioration of the image resolution. 193 Appendix > Glossary PAL (Phase Alternate Line) A video color encoding standard used in numerous countries throughout Africa, Asia, Europe, and the Middle East. Quality An expression of the rate of compression used in a digital image. Higher quality images have a lower rate of compression, which usually results in a larger file size. RAW (CCD raw data) The original, unprocessed data, collected directly from the camera’s image sensor. White Balance, contrast, saturation, sharpness, and other data can be manipulated with editing software before the image is compressed into a standard file format. Resolution The number of pixels present in a digital image. High resolution images contain more pixels and typically show more detail than low resolution images. Noise Misinterpreted pixels in a digital image that may appear as misplaced or random, bright pixels. Noise usually occurs when photos are shot with a high sensitivity or when a sensitivity is automatically set in a dark place. NFC (Near Field Communication) NFC is a set of standards for radio communication at very close proximity. You can use NFC-enabled devices to activate features or exchange data with other devices. NTSC (National Television System Committee) A video color encoding standard used most commonly in Japan, North America, the Philippines, South America, South Korea, and Taiwan. Optical zoom This is a general zoom which can enlarge images with a lens and does not deteriorate quality of images.194 Appendix > Glossary Shutter speed Shutter speed refers to the amount of time it takes to open and close the shutter, and it is an important factor in the brightness of a photo, as it controls the amount of light which passes through the aperture before it reaches the image sensor. A fast shutter speed allows less time to let light in and the photo becomes darker and more easily freezes subjects in motion. sRGB (Standard RGB) International standard of color space established by the IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission). This is defined from color space for PC monitors and is also used as the standard color space for Exif. Vignetting A reduction of an image’s brightness or saturation at the periphery (outer edges) compared to the center of the image. Vignetting can draw interest to subjects positioned in the center of an image. White Balance (Color balance) An adjustment of the intensities of colors (typically the primary colors red, green, and blue), in an image. The goal of adjusting the White Balance, or color balance, is to correctly render the colors in an image. Wi-Fi Wi-Fi is a technology that allows electronic devices to exchange data wirelessly over a network. WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) WPS is a technology that secures wireless home networks.195 Appendix Optional accessories Lens SAMSUNG 18-55 mm F3.5-5.6 OIS III SAMSUNG 20-50 mm F3.5-5.6 ED II SAMSUNG 16 mm F2.4 SAMSUNG 20 mm F2.8 SAMSUNG 30 mm F2 SAMSUNG 50-200 mm F4-5.6 ED OIS III SAMSUNG 60 mm F2.8 Macro ED OIS SSA SAMSUNG 18-200 mm F3.5-6.3 ED OIS Lens SAMSUNG 85 mm F1.4 ED SSA SAMSUNG 12-24 mm F4-5.6 ED SAMSUNG 45 mm F1.8 SAMSUNG 45 mm F1.8 [T6] 2D/3D External flash SEF42A SEF220A GPS GPS10196 Appendix > Optional accessories Shutter release (micro USB type) Microphone SR2NX02 EM10 Rechargeable battery Battery charger BP1130 BC3NX01 Camera bag Camera case Memory card Filter USB cable HDMI cable Strap • These illustrations may differ from your actual items. Refer to the user manuals of these optional accessories for details. • Use only Samsung-approved accessories. Samsung is not responsible for damage caused by using another manufacturer’s accessories.197 Appendix A Adobe Photoshop Lightroom 167 AllShare Play 141 Aperture 16, 20 Auto Backup 133 Auto focus 80 B Battery Caution 177 Charging 34 Insert 33 Best Face mode 65 Bracketing 92 C Camera Connecting as removable disk 160 Connecting to PC 160 Disconnecting (Windows) 161 Layout 30 Camera specifications 184 Charging 34 Color space 148 D Date & Time 153 Depth of Field (DOF) 17, 22 Digital Print Order Format (DPOF) 114 DIRECT LINK 32 Display brightness 152 Display type 43 Drive 90 E Enlarging 113 Exposure Value (EV) 16, 102 F Fader 105 Files Deleting 111 Photo type 74 Protecting 110 Video type 104 Flash Bounce photography 27 Flash options 94 Guide number 26 Intensity 95 F-number 16 Focal length 21 Focus assist 88 Focus Peaking 88 I Icons Playback mode 42 Shooting mode 40 i-Function 61 i-Launcher 163 Image adjustment Adjusting photos 119 Red-eye 120 Retouching faces 120 ISO sensitivity 75 i-Zoom 63 L Lenses Layout 44 Locking 45 Markings 47 Unlocking 46 M Maintenance 170 Memory card Caution 173 Insert 33 Metering 97 MobileLink 129 Index198 Appendix > Index O One touch shot 87 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) 89 Optional accessories Attach the GPS module 51 Connect the flash 49 Flash layout 48 GPS module layout 51 P Panorama mode 66 Photos Editing 117 Enlarging 113 Shooting options 73 Viewing on 3D TV 159 Viewing on camera 108 Viewing on HDTV 158 Picture Wizard 79 Posture 13 Power save mode 153 R Red-eye effect Playback mode 120 Shooting mode 95 Remote Viewfinder 131 Resolution Playback mode 118 Shooting mode (Movie) 104 Shooting mode (Photo) 73 Retouching faces 120 Rotating 118 Rule of thirds 24 S Service center 181 Settings 152 Shooting modes Aperture Priority 57 Lens Priority 60 Manual 59 Program 55 Recording 68 Shutter Priority 58 Smart 64 Smart Auto 53 Shutter speed 18, 20 Slide show 113 Smart filter Playback mode 121 Shooting mode 101 Smart panel 38 T Thumbnails 108 Timer 91 Touch AF 86 Touch screen 36 Tracking AF 86 Transferring files Mac 161 Windows 160 TV 158 U Unpacking 29 V Video Out 153 Videos Capturing 116 Options 104 Recording 68 Viewing 115 W White balance 76 Wireless network 123 3 3D mode 69199 Correct Disposal of This Product (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment) (Applicable in countries with separate collection systems) This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these items from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources. Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take these items for environmentally safe recycling. Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its electronic accessories should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal. Correct disposal of batteries in this product (Applicable in countries with separate collection systems) This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that the batteries in this product should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium or lead above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to human health or the environment. To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them through your local, free battery return system. CAN ICES-3 (B)/NMB-3(B) Dispose unwanted electronics through an approved recycler. To find the nearest recycling location, go to our website: www.samsung.com/recyclingdirect Or call, (877) 278 - 0799 Appendix200 Appendix FCC notice Caution: Any changes or modifications in construction of this device which are not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. NOTE: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorientate or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the distance between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. Declaration of Conformity Trade Name : Samsung Electronics America, Inc. Model No. : Samsung NX300 Responsible Party : Samsung Electronics America, Inc. Address : 85 Challenger Road, Ridgefield Park, NJ 07660 Telephone No. : 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. RF exposure statements: This device is for handheld operation only. The antenna(s) used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a separation distance of at least 20 cm from all persons and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. FCC ID:A3LNX300201 TA-2012/1802 APPROVED Model : NX300 Year of Manufacture : 2013 CAUTION RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Caution: Any changes or modifications to the equipment not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void user’s authority to operate the equipment. IC: 649E-NX300 This equipment may be operated in all EU countries. In France, this equipment may only be used indoors. Complies with IDA Standards DA100790 No.: ESD-1306913C TRC/SS/2013/17Please refer to the warranty that came with your product or visit our website www.samsung.com for after-sales service or inquiries. ENG This user manual includes detailed usage instructions for your camera. Please read this manual thoroughly. USER MANUAL1 Copyright information • Camera specifications or contents of this manual may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of camera functions. • You are not allowed to reuse or distribute any part of this manual without prior permission. • We recommend using your camera within the country where you purchase it. • Use this camera responsibly and adhere to all laws and regulations concerning its use. PlanetFirst represents Samsung Electronics' commitment to sustainable development and social responsibility through eco-driven business and management activities. • Microsoft Windows and the Windows logo are registered trademarks of the Microsoft Corporation. • Mac and Apple App Store are registered trademarks of the Apple Corporation. • Google Play Store is a registered trademark of Google, Inc. • Adobe, the Adobe logo, Photoshop and Lightroom are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries. • microSD™, microSDHC™, and microSDXC™ are registered trademarks of the SD Association. • HDMI, the HDMI logo, and the term “High Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. • Wi-Fi®, the Wi-Fi CERTIFIED logo, and the Wi-Fi logo are registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance. • Trademarks and trade names used in this manual are the property of their respective owners.2 Health and safety information Prevent damage to subjects’ eyesight. Do not use the flash in close proximity (closer than 1 m/3 ft) to people or animals. If you use the flash too close to your subject’s eyes, this can cause temporary or permanent eyesight damage. Keep your camera away from small children and pets. Keep your camera and all accessories out of the reach of small children and animals. Small parts may cause choking or serious injury if swallowed. Moving parts and accessories may present physical dangers as well. Do not expose the camera to direct sunlight or high temperatures for an extended period of time. Prolonged exposure to sunlight or extreme temperatures can cause permanent damage to your camera’s internal components. Avoid covering the camera or charger with blankets or clothes. The camera may overheat, which may distort the camera or cause a fire. Do not handle the power supply cord or go near the charger during a thunderstorm. This may result in electric shock. Always comply with the following precautions and usage tips to avoid dangerous situations and ensure peak performance of your camera. Warning—situations that could cause injury to yourself or others Do not disassemble or attempt to repair your camera. This may result in electric shock or damage to the camera. Do not use your camera near flammable or explosive gases and liquids. This may cause a fire or explosion. Do not insert flammable materials into the camera or store these materials near the camera. This may cause a fire or electric shock. Do not handle your camera with wet hands. This may result in electric shock.3 Health and safety information If liquid or foreign objects enter your camera, immediately disconnect all power sources, such as the battery or charger, and then contact a Samsung service center. Comply with any regulations that restrict the use of a camera in a certain area. • Avoid interference with other electronic devices. • Turn off the camera when in an aircraft. Your camera can cause interference with aircraft equipment. Follow all airline regulations and turn off your camera when directed by airline personnel. • Turn off the camera near medical equipment. Your camera can interfere with medical equipment in hospitals or health care facilities. Follow all regulations, posted warnings, and directions from medical personnel. Avoid interference with pacemakers. Maintain the distance between this camera and all pacemakers to avoid potential interference, as recommended by the manufacturer and research groups. If you have any reason to suspect that your camera is interfering with a pacemaker or other medical device, turn off the camera immediately and contact the manufacturer of the pacemaker or medical device for guidance. Caution—situations that could cause damage to your camera or other equipment Remove the batteries from your camera when storing it for an extended period of time. Installed batteries may leak or corrode over time and cause serious damage to your camera. Use only authentic, manufacturer-recommended, Lithium-ion replacement batteries. Do not damage or heat the battery. Inauthentic, damaged, or heated batteries may cause a fire or personal injury. Use only Samsung-approved batteries, chargers, cables and accessories. • Using unauthorized batteries, chargers, cables or accessories can cause batteries to explode, damage your camera, or cause injury. • Samsung is not responsible for damage or injuries caused by unapproved batteries, chargers, cables or accessories. Use the battery only for its intended purpose. Misusing the battery may cause a fire or electric shock.4 Health and safety information Do not touch the flash while it fires. The flash is very hot when fired and may burn your skin. When you use the AC charger, turn off the camera before you disconnect the power to the AC charger. Failing to do so may result in fire or electric shock. Disconnect the charger from the wall socket when not in use. Failing to do so may result in fire or electric shock. Do not use a damaged power supply cord, plug, or loose outlet when you charge batteries. This may cause a fire or electric shock. Do not allow the AC charger to come in contact with the +/- terminals on the battery. This may cause a fire or electric shock. Do not drop or subject the camera to strong impacts. Doing so may damage the screen or external or internal components. Exercise caution when you connect cables and install batteries and memory cards. If you force the connectors, improperly connect cables, or improperly install batteries and memory cards, you can damage ports, connectors, and accessories. Keep cards with magnetic strips away from the camera case. Information stored on the card may be damaged or erased. Never use a damaged battery, or memory card. This may result in electric shock or camera malfunction or cause a fire. Do not place the camera in or near magnetic fields. Doing so may cause the camera to malfunction. Do not use the camera if the screen is damaged. If the glass or acrylic parts are broken, visit a Samsung service center to have the camera repaired.5 Health and safety information Check that the camera is operating properly before use. The manufacturer takes no responsibility for any loss of files or damage that may result from camera malfunction or improper use. You must plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. Do not expose the lens to direct sunlight. This may discolor the image sensor or cause it to malfunction. If the camera overheats, remove the battery and allow it to cool down. • Prolonged usage of the camera may overheat the battery and raise the internal temperature of the camera. If the camera stops operating, remove the battery and allow it to cool down. • High internal temperatures may result in noise in your photos. This is normal and does not affect your camera’s overall performance. Avoid interference with other electronic devices. Your camera emits radio frequency (RF) signals that may interfere with unshielded or improperly shielded electronic equipment, such as pacemakers, hearing aids, medical devices, and other electronic devices in homes or vehicles. Consult the manufacturers of your electronic devices to solve any interference problems you experience. To prevent unwanted interference, use only Samsung-approved devices or accessories. Use your camera in the normal position. Avoid contact with your camera’s internal antenna. Data transference and your responsibilities • Data transferred via WLAN could be leaked, so avoid transferring sensitive data in public areas or on open networks. • The camera manufacturer is not liable for any data transfers that infringe on copyrights, trademarks, intellectual property laws, or public decency ordinances.6 Indications used in this manual Mode indications Mode Indication Smart Auto t Program P Aperture Priority A Shutter Priority S Manual M Lens Priority i Smart s Wi-Fi B Icons used in this manual Icon Function Additional information Safety warnings and precautions [ ] Camera buttons. For example, [Shutter] represents the shutter button. ( ) Page number of related information → The order of options or menus you must select to perform a step; for example: Select 1→Quality (represents select 1, and then Quality). * Annotation7 Contents Chapter 1 My Camera Getting started ............................................................................................ 29 Unpacking.................................................................................................................... 29 Camera layout .............................................................................................. 30 Using the DIRECT LINK button ................................................................................ 32 Inserting the battery and memory card ................................................. 33 Removing the battery and memory card ........................................................... 33 Using the memory card adapter ............................................................................. 33 Charging the battery and turning on your camera .............................. 34 Charging the battery................................................................................................ 34 Turning on your camera ......................................................................................... 34 Performing the initial setup ...................................................................... 35 Selecting functions (options) ................................................................... 36 Selecting with buttons ............................................................................................ 36 Selecting by touch .................................................................................................... 36 Using m .............................................................................................................. 37 E.g. Selecting the photo size in P mode ............................................................. 37 Using the Smart panel ............................................................................................. 38 E.g. Adjust the exposure value in P mode ......................................................... 38 Tips Concepts in Photography Shooting postures....................................................................................... 13 Holding the camera ..................................................................................................... 13 Standing photography ............................................................................................... 13 Crouching photography ............................................................................................ 14 Using the display .......................................................................................................... 14 Low-angle shot .............................................................................................................. 15 High-angle shot ............................................................................................................. 15 Aperture ........................................................................................................ 16 Aperture value and the depth of field .................................................................. 17 Shutter speed ............................................................................................... 18 ISO sensitivity .............................................................................................. 19 How the aperture setting, shutter speed, and ISO sensitivity control exposure ......................................................................................... 20 Correlation between focal length, angle, and perspective ................ 21 Depth of field ............................................................................................... 22 What controls out-of-focus effects? ....................................................................... 22 Optical preview ............................................................................................................. 24 Composition ................................................................................................. 24 Rule of Thirds .................................................................................................................. 24 Photos with two subjects .......................................................................................... 25 Flash ............................................................................................................... 26 Flash guide number ..................................................................................................... 26 Bounce Photography .................................................................................................. 278 Contents Display icons ................................................................................................ 40 In Shooting mode ..................................................................................................... 40 Capturing photos ........................................................................................................ 40 Recording videos ......................................................................................................... 41 About the level gauge ............................................................................................... 41 In Playback mode ...................................................................................................... 42 Viewing photos ............................................................................................................ 42 Playing videos ............................................................................................................... 42 Changing the information displayed ................................................................. 43 Lenses ............................................................................................................ 44 Lens layout ................................................................................................................... 44 Locking or unlocking the lens ................................................................................. 45 Lens markings ............................................................................................................ 47 Accessories ................................................................................................... 48 External flash layout ................................................................................................. 48 Connecting the external flash ................................................................................. 49 GPS module layout (optional) .............................................................................. 51 Attaching the GPS module .................................................................................... 51 Shooting modes .......................................................................................... 53 t Smart Auto mode ..................................................................................... 53 P Program mode ....................................................................................................... 55 Program Shift ................................................................................................................ 56 Minimum shutter speed ............................................................................................ 56 A Aperture Priority mode ..................................................................................... 57 S Shutter Priority mode.......................................................................................... 58 M Manual mode ....................................................................................................... 59 Framing mode .............................................................................................................. 59 Using the Bulb function ............................................................................................ 60 i Lens Priority mode ............................................................................................. 60 Using E ............................................................................................................. 60 Using i-Function in P/A/S/M modes ................................................................ 61 Using Z .............................................................................................................. 63 s Smart mode ........................................................................................................ 64 Using the Best Face mode ........................................................................................ 65 Capturing panoramic photos .................................................................................. 66 Recording a video ..................................................................................................... 68 3D mode ....................................................................................................................... 69 Available functions by shooting mode ............................................................. 719 Contents Chapter 2 Shooting Functions Size and Resolution .................................................................................... 73 Photo size ..................................................................................................................... 73 Quality ........................................................................................................................... 74 ISO sensitivity .............................................................................................. 75 White Balance .............................................................................................. 76 Customizing preset White Balance options ....................................................... 77 Picture Wizard (photo styles) .................................................................... 79 AF mode ........................................................................................................ 80 Single AF ....................................................................................................................... 81 Continuous AF ............................................................................................................ 81 Manual focus ............................................................................................................... 82 AF area ........................................................................................................... 83 Selection AF ................................................................................................................ 83 Multi AF ......................................................................................................................... 84 Face detection AF ...................................................................................................... 84 Self-Portrait AF ........................................................................................................... 85 Touch AF ........................................................................................................ 86 Touch AF ....................................................................................................................... 86 AF Point ......................................................................................................................... 86 Tracking AF .................................................................................................................. 86 One touch shot .......................................................................................................... 87 Focus assist ................................................................................................... 88 MF Assist ....................................................................................................................... 88 Focus Peaking ............................................................................................................. 88 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) ............................................................. 89 Drive (shooting method) ........................................................................... 90 Single ............................................................................................................................. 90 Continuous .................................................................................................................. 90 Burst ............................................................................................................................... 91 Timer .............................................................................................................................. 91 Auto Exposure Bracketing (AE Bracket) ............................................................. 92 White Balance Bracketing (WB Bracket) ............................................................ 92 Picture Wizard Bracketing (P Wiz Bracket) ........................................................ 93 Bracketing setting ..................................................................................................... 93 Flash ............................................................................................................... 94 Reducing the red-eye effect .................................................................................. 95 Adjusting the flash intensity ................................................................................. 95 Metering ........................................................................................................ 97 Multi ............................................................................................................................... 97 Spot ................................................................................................................................ 98 Center-weighted ....................................................................................................... 98 Measuring the exposure value of the focus area ........................................... 99 Dynamic Range ......................................................................................... 100 Smart Filter ................................................................................................. 101 Exposure compensation .......................................................................... 102 Exposure lock ............................................................................................. 103 Video functions ......................................................................................... 104 Movie size.................................................................................................................. 104 Movie quality ........................................................................................................... 104 Multi Motion ............................................................................................................ 105 Fader ........................................................................................................................... 105 Voice ............................................................................................................................ 106 Wind cut .................................................................................................................... 106 Mic Level .................................................................................................................... 10610 Contents Chapter 3 Playback/Editing Searching and managing files ................................................................ 108 Viewing photos ....................................................................................................... 108 Viewing image thumbnails ................................................................................. 108 Viewing files by category .................................................................................... 109 Viewing files as a folder ........................................................................................ 109 Protecting files ........................................................................................................ 110 Lock/Unlock all files .................................................................................................. 110 Deleting files ............................................................................................................ 111 Deleting a single file ................................................................................................. 111 Deleting multiple files .............................................................................................. 111 Deleting all files .......................................................................................................... 112 Viewing photos .......................................................................................... 113 Enlarging a photo .................................................................................................. 113 Viewing a slide show ............................................................................................. 113 Auto rotating ........................................................................................................... 114 Creating a print order (DPOF) ............................................................................ 114 Playing videos ............................................................................................ 115 Trimming a video during playback .................................................................. 115 Capturing an image during playback ............................................................. 116 Editing photos ........................................................................................... 117 Cropping a photo ................................................................................................... 117 Rotating a photo .................................................................................................... 118 Resizing photos....................................................................................................... 118 Adjusting your photos .......................................................................................... 119 Retouching faces .................................................................................................... 120 Reducing red-eye ................................................................................................... 120 Applying Smart Filter effects .............................................................................. 121 Chapter 4 Wireless network Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings ............... 123 Connecting to a WLAN ......................................................................................... 123 Setting network options ......................................................................................... 124 Manually setting the IP address ........................................................................... 124 Using the login browser....................................................................................... 125 Network connection tips ..................................................................................... 126 Entering text ............................................................................................................ 127 Saving files to a smart phone automatically ....................................... 128 Sending photos or videos to a smart phone ....................................... 129 Using a smart phone as a remote shutter release .............................. 131 Using Auto Backup to send photos or videos ..................................... 133 Installing the program for Auto Backup on your PC.................................. 133 Sending photos or videos to a PC .................................................................... 133 Sending photos or videos via email ...................................................... 135 Changing email settings ...................................................................................... 135 Storing your information ........................................................................................ 135 Setting an email password ..................................................................................... 136 Changing the email password .............................................................................. 137 Sending photos or videos via email ................................................................ 137 Using photo or video sharing websites ................................................ 139 Accessing a website .............................................................................................. 139 Uploading photos or videos............................................................................... 140 Using AllShare Play to send files ............................................................ 141 Uploading photos to online storage ............................................................... 141 Viewing photos or videos on devices that support AllShare Play ........ 142 Sending photos using Wi-Fi Direct ........................................................ 14411 Contents Chapter 6 Connecting to external devices Viewing files on an HDTV or 3D TV ........................................................ 158 Viewing files on an HDTV .................................................................................... 158 Viewing files on a 3D TV ....................................................................................... 159 Transferring files to your computer ....................................................... 160 Transferring files to your Windows OS computer ....................................... 160 Connecting the camera as a removable disk ................................................... 160 Disconnecting the camera (for Windows XP) .................................................. 161 Transferring files to your Mac OS ...................................................................... 161 Using programs on a PC........................................................................... 163 Installing programs from the provided CD ................................................... 163 Available programs when using i-Launcher .................................................... 163 Using i-Launcher .................................................................................................... 163 Requirements for Windows OS ............................................................................. 163 Requirements for Mac OS ....................................................................................... 164 Opening i-Launcher .................................................................................................. 164 Using Multimedia Viewer ........................................................................................ 165 Downloading the firmware .................................................................................... 166 Downloading the PC Auto Backup program ................................................... 166 Installing Adobe Photoshop Lightroom ........................................................ 167 Using Adobe Photoshop Lightroom ............................................................... 167 Chapter 5 Camera settings menu User settings ............................................................................................... 146 ISO Customizing ..................................................................................................... 146 ISO Step ......................................................................................................................... 146 Auto ISO Range .......................................................................................................... 146 Noise Reduction ..................................................................................................... 146 Bracket Set ................................................................................................................ 147 DMF (Direct Manual Focus) ................................................................................ 147 Color space ............................................................................................................... 148 Distortion Correct .................................................................................................. 149 Touch Operation ..................................................................................................... 149 iFn Customizing ...................................................................................................... 149 User Display .............................................................................................................. 149 Key Mapping ............................................................................................................ 150 Grid Line .................................................................................................................... 151 AF Lamp ..................................................................................................................... 151 Setting ......................................................................................................... 15212 Contents Before contacting a service center ........................................................ 181 Camera specifications .............................................................................. 184 Glossary ....................................................................................................... 189 Optional accessories ................................................................................. 195 Index ............................................................................................................ 197 FCC notice ................................................................................................... 200 Chapter 7 Appendix Error messages .......................................................................................... 169 Maintaining the camera........................................................................... 170 Cleaning the camera ............................................................................................. 170 Camera lens and display ......................................................................................... 170 Image sensor ............................................................................................................... 170 Camera body ............................................................................................................... 170 Using or storing the camera ............................................................................... 171 Inappropriate places to use or store the camera ........................................... 171 Using on beaches or shores ................................................................................... 171 Storing for extended period of time ................................................................... 171 Using the camera with caution in humid environments ............................ 172 Other cautions ............................................................................................................ 172 About memory card .............................................................................................. 173 Supported memory card ........................................................................................ 173 Memory card capacity ............................................................................................. 174 Cautions when using memory cards .................................................................. 176 About the battery .................................................................................................. 177 Battery specifications ............................................................................................... 177 Battery life .................................................................................................................... 178 Low battery message ............................................................................................... 178 Notes about using the battery .............................................................................. 178 Cautions about using the battery ........................................................................ 179 Notes about charging the battery ....................................................................... 179 Notes about charging with a computer connected...................................... 180 Handle and dispose of batteries and chargers with care ............................ 18013 Concepts in Photography Standing photography Compose your shot; stand up straight with your feet shoulder-length apart, and keep your elbows pointed down. Shooting postures A correct posture for stabilizing the camera is necessary for taking a good photo. Even if you hold a camera correctly, the wrong posture can cause the camera to shake. Stand up straight and remain still to maintain a steady base for your camera. When shooting with a slow shutter speed, hold your breath to minimize body movement. Holding the camera Hold the camera with your right hand and place you right index finger on the shutter button. Place your left hand under the lens for support.14 Concepts in Photography Crouching photography Compose your shot, crouch with one knee touching the ground, and keep a straight posture. Using the display To take photos at high or low angles, tilt the display up or down. You can tilt the display up to 90° upwards ( ) or 45° downwards ( ). • Keep the display closed ( ) when the camera is not in use. • Tilt the display only within the angle allowed. Failing to do so may damage your camera.15 Concepts in Photography Low-angle shot A low-angle shot is a shot from a camera positioned below your eyeline, looking up the subject. High-angle shot A high-angle shot is a shot from a camera positioned above your eyeline, looking down on the subject.16 Concepts in Photography Aperture The aperture, a hole that controls the amount of light that enters the camera, is one of the three factors that determine the exposure. The aperture housing contains thin, metal plates that open and close to let light through the aperture and into the camera. The size of the aperture is closely related to the brightness of a photo: the larger the aperture, the brighter the photo; the smaller the aperture, the darker the photo. Aperture sizes Minimum aperture Medium aperture Maximum aperture Darker photo (aperture opened slightly) Brighter photo (aperture opened wide) The size of the aperture is represented by a value known as an “F-number.” The f-number represents the focal length divided by the diameter of the lens. For example, if a lens with a 50 mm focal length has an f-number of F2, the diameter of the aperture is 25 mm. (50 mm/25 mm=F2) The smaller the f-number, the greater the size of the aperture. The opening in the aperture is described as the Exposure Value (EV). Increasing the Exposure Value (+1 EV) means the amount of light doubles. Decreasing the Exposure Value (-1 EV) means the amount of light halves. You can also use the exposure compensation feature to fine-tune the amount of light by subdividing exposure values into 1/2, 1/3 EV, and so on. +1 EV F1.4 F2 F2.8 F4 F5.6 F8 -1 EV Exposure Value Steps17 Concepts in Photography Aperture value and the depth of field You can blur or sharpen the background of a photo by controlling the aperture. It is closely related to the depth of field (DOF), which can be expressed as small or large. A photo with a large DOF A photo with a small DOF The aperture housing contains several blades. These blades move together and control the amount of light passing through the center of the aperture. The number of blades also affects the shape of light when shooting night scenes. If an aperture has an even number of blades, light divides into an equal number of sections. If the number of blades is odd, the number of sections is double the number of blades. For example, an aperture with 8 blades divides light into 8 sections and an aperture with 7 blades into 14 sections. 7 blades 8 blades18 Concepts in Photography Shutter speed Shutter speed refers to the amount of time it takes to open and close the shutter, and it is an important factor in the brightness of a photo, as it controls the amount of light which passes through the aperture before it reaches the image sensor. Usually, the shutter speed is manually adjustable. The measurement of the shutter speed is known as the “Exposure Value” (EV), which is marked in intervals of 1 s, 1/2 s, 1/4 s, 1/8 s, 1/15 s, 1/1000 s, 1/2000 s, and so on. Exposure +1 EV -1 EV 1s 1/2 s 1/4 s 1/8 s 1/15 s 1/30 s Shutter Speed Therefore, the faster the shutter speed, the less light will be let in. Likewise, the slower the shutter speed, the more light will be let in. As the photos below illustrate, a slow shutter speed allows more time to let light in, so the photo becomes brighter. On the other hand, a fast shutter speed allows less time to let light in and the photo becomes darker and more easily freezes subjects in motion. 0.8 s 0.004 s19 Concepts in Photography ISO sensitivity The exposure of an image is determined by the sensitivity of the camera. This sensitivity is based on international film standards, known as ISO standards. On digital cameras, this sensitivity rating is used to represent the sensitivity of the digital mechanism that captures the image. ISO sensitivity doubles as the number doubles. For example, an ISO 200 setting is capable of capturing images at twice the speed of an ISO 100 setting. However, higher ISO settings can result in “noise”—small specks, spots, and other phenomena in a photo that give the shot a noisy or dirty appearance. As a general rule, it is best to use a low ISO setting to prevent noise in your photos, unless you are shooting in darkened environments or at night. Changes in the quality and brightness according to ISO sensitivity Because a low ISO sensitivity means the camera will be less sensitive to light, you need more light to have an optimal exposure. When using a low ISO sensitivity, open the aperture more or reduce the shutter speed to allow more light to enter the camera. For example, on a sunny day when light is abundant, a low ISO sensitivity does not require a slow shutter speed. However, in a dark place or at night, a low ISO sensitivity will result in a blurry photo. Therefore, it is recommended to increase the ISO sensitivity by a moderate amount. A photo captured with a tripod and high ISO sensitivity A blurred photo with a low ISO sensitivity20 Concepts in Photography How the aperture setting, shutter speed, and ISO sensitivity control exposure The aperture setting, shutter speed, and ISO sensitivity are closely interconnected in photography. The aperture setting controls the opening that regulates the light that enters the camera, while the shutter speed determines the length of time that light is allowed to enter. ISO sensitivity determines the speed at which the film reacts to light. Together, these three aspects are described as the triangle of exposure. A change in shutter speed, aperture value, or ISO sensitivity can be offset by adjustments to the others to maintain the amount of light. The results, however, change according to the settings. For example, shutter speed is useful in expressing movement, aperture can control the depth of field, and ISO sensitivity can control the graininess of a photo. Settings Results Aperture value Wide aperture = more light Narrow aperture = less light Wide = small depth of field Narrow = large depth of field Settings Results Shutter speed Fast speed = less light Slow speed = more light Fast = still Slow = blurry ISO sensitivity High sensitivity = more sensitive to light Low sensitivity = less sensitive to light High = more grainy Low = less grainy21 Concepts in Photography Correlation between focal length, angle, and perspective Focal length, which is measured in millimeters, is the distance between the middle of the lens to its focal point. It affects the angle and perspective of captured images. A short focal length translates into a wide angle, which allows you to capture a wide shot. A long focal length translates into a narrow angle, which allows you to capture telephoto shots. Short focal length wide shot wide angle wide-angle lens Long focal length telephoto shot narrow angle telephoto lens Look at these photos below and compare the changes. 18 mm angle 55 mm angle 200 mm angle Normally, a lens with a wide angle is suitable for shooting landscapes and a lens with a narrow angle is recommended for shooting sports events or portraits.22 Concepts in Photography Depth of field Portraits or still-life photos mostly acclaimed by people are the ones on which the background is out of focus so the subject looks pronounced. Depending on the focused areas, a photo can be blurred or sharpened. This is called ‘a low DOF’ or ‘a high DOF’. The depth of field is the focused area around the subject. Therefore, a small DOF signifies that the focused area is narrow and a large DOF means the focused area is wide. A photo with a small DOF, which stresses the subject and makes the rest of it blurred, can be obtained by using a telescope lens or selecting a low aperture value. Conversely, a photo with a large DOF which shows all the elements on the photo sharply focused can be achieved by using a wide angle lens or selecting a high aperture value. Small Depth of Field Large Depth of Field What controls out-of-focus effects? DOF depends on aperture value The wider the aperture is (namely the lower the aperture value), the lower the DOF becomes. Under the condition where the other values including shutter speed and ISO sensitivity are equal, a low aperture value leads to a photo with a low DOF. 55 mm F5.7 55 mm F2223 Concepts in Photography DOF depends on focal length The longer the focal length is, the lower the DOF gets. A telescope lens with a longer focal length than a telescope lens with a short focal length is better to capture a photo of a low DOF. A photo captured with a 18 mm telescope lens A photo captured with a 100 mm telescope lens DOF depends on the distance between the subject and the camera The shorter the distance between the subject and the camera is, the lower the DOF gets. Therefore, taking a photo close to a subject can result in a photo of low DOF. A photo captured with a 100 mm telescope lens A photo captured close to the subject 24 Concepts in Photography Optical preview You can press the Custom button to view the optical preview before capturing a photo. The camera adjusts the aperture to the predefined settings and shows the results on the screen. Set the Custom button to Optical preview. (p. 150) Composition It is fun to capture a photo of the beauty of world with a camera. No matter how the world is beautiful, however, a poor composition cannot capture the beauty of it. When it comes to composition, it is very important to prioritize subjects. Composition in photography means arranging objects in a photo. Usually, abiding by the rule of thirds leads to a good composition. Rule of Thirds To use the rule of thirds, divide the image into a 3x3 pattern of equal rectangles. To compose photos that best emphasize the subject, make sure the subject is located at one of the corners of the center rectangle.25 Concepts in Photography Using the rule of thirds will create photos with stable and compelling compositions. Below are a few examples. Photos with two subjects If your subject is in one corner of the photo, it creates an unbalanced composition. You can stabilize the photo by capturing a second subject in the opposite corner to balance the weight of the photo. Subject 1 Subject 2 Subject 1 Subject 2 Unstable Stable When taking landscape photos, centering the horizon will create an unbalanced effect. Give more weight to the photo by moving the horizon up or down. Subject 1 Subject 2 Subject 1 Subject 2 Unstable Stable26 Concepts in Photography Flash guide number The model number of a flash refers to the flash’s power, and the maximum amount of light created is represented by a value known as a “guide number.” The bigger the guide number, the more light is emitted from the flash. The guide number is achieved by multiplying the distance from the flash to the subject and the aperture value when the ISO sensitivity is set to 100. Guide number = Flash to Subject Distance X Aperture value Aperture value = Guide number / Flash to Subject Distance Flash to Subject Distance = Guide number / Aperture value Therefore, if you know the guide number of a flash, you can estimate an optimum flash to subject distance when setting the flash manually. For example, if a flash has a guide number of GN 20 and is 4 meters away from the subject, the optimal aperture value is F5.0. Flash Light is one of the most important components in photography. It’s not easy, however, to have an enough amount of light anytime and anywhere. Making use of a flash allows you to optimize light settings and create a variety of effects. Flash, also known as strobe or speed light, helps to create adequate exposure in low-light conditions. It is also useful in light-abundant situations. For example, flash can be used in compensating the exposure of a subject’s shadow or capturing clearly both the subject and the background in backlit conditions. Before correction After correction27 Concepts in Photography Bounce Photography Bounce photography refers to the method of bouncing light off of the ceiling or walls so that the light spreads evenly over the subject. Normally, photos captured with flash may appear unnatural and cast shadows. Subjects in photos captured with bounce photography cast no shadows and look smooth due to evenly spread light.Chapter 1 My Camera Learn about your camera’s layout, display icons, lens, optional accessories, and basic functions.My Camera 29 Getting started Unpacking Check your product box for the following items. Camera (including the body cap and hot-shoe cover) AC adapter/USB cable Rechargeable battery External flash Software CD-ROM (User manual included) Adobe Photoshop Lightroom DVD-ROM Quick Start Guide Strap • The illustrations may differ from your actual items. • You can purchase optional accessories at a retailer or a Samsung service center. Samsung is not responsible for any problems caused by using unauthorized accessories. For information about accessories, refer to page 195.My Camera 30 Camera layout No. Name 1 Mode dial • t: Smart Auto mode (p. 53) • P: Program mode (p. 55) • A: Aperture Priority mode (p. 57) • S: Shutter Priority mode (p. 58) • M: Manual mode (p. 59) • i: Lens Priority mode (p. 60) • s: Smart mode (p. 64) • B: Wi-Fi (p. 122) 2 Jog dial • In the Menu screen: Move to a desired menu item. • In the Smart panel: Adjust a selected option. • In Shooting mode: Adjust shutter speed or aperture value in some shooting modes or change the size of a focus area. • In Playback mode: View thumbnails, enlarge or reduce a photo, or open or close a folder of continuous or burst shots in Playback mode. 3 DIRECT LINK button: Start a preset Wi-Fi function. (p. 32) No. Name 4 Microphone 5 Hot-shoe cover 6 Hot-shoe 7 Eyelet for camera strap 8 Image sensor 9 Internal antenna/NFC tag * Avoid contact with the internal antenna while using the wireless network. 10 Speaker 11 Lens release button 12 Lens mount 13 Lens mount index 14 AF-assist light/Timer lamp 15 Power switch 16 Shutter button 1 2 3 4 5 7 9 10 11 12 13 14 6 4 8 7 16 15My Camera > Camera layout 31 No. Name 1 Video recording button Start recording a video. 2 EV adjust button (p. 102) Press and hold the button, and then scroll the jog dial to adjust the exposure value. In M mode, the aperture value will be adjusted. 3 Fn button Access the Smart panel and fine-tune some settings. 4 o button • In the Menu screen: Save the selected options. • In Shooting mode: Allow you to select a focus area manually in some shooting modes. 5 Navigation button • In Shooting mode -D: View camera settings and change options. - I: Select an ISO value. - C: Select a drive option. - F: Select an AF mode. • In other situations Move up, down, left, right, respectively. No. Name 6 Delete/Custom button • In Shooting mode: Perform the assigned function. (p. 150) • In Playback mode: Delete files. 7 Playback button Enter Playback mode. 8 Status lamp Indicate the status of the camera. • Blinking: When saving a photo, shooting a video, sending data to a computer, connecting to WLAN, or sending a photo. • Steady: When there is no data transfer, when data transfer to a computer is complete, or charging the battery. 9 MENU button Access options or menus. 5 6 1 2 3 4 7 8 9My Camera > Camera layout 32 No. Name 1 USB and shutter release port Connect the camera to a computer or shutter release. Use a shutter release cable with a tripod to minimize camera movement. 2 HDMI port 3 Battery chamber/Memory card cover Insert a memory card and battery. 4 Display • To take photos at high or low angles, tilt the display up or down. (p. 14) • Touch the screen to select a menu or an option. (p. 36) 5 Tripod mount Using the DIRECT LINK button You can turn on the Wi-Fi feature conveniently by pressing [DIRECT LINK]. Press [DIRECT LINK] again to return to the previous mode. Setting the DIRECT LINK button You can select a Wi-Fi function to launch when you press [DIRECT LINK]. (p. 150) To set a DIRECT LINK option, In Shooting mode, press [m] →5→Key Mapping→ DIRECT LINK → an option. 4 5 1 2 3My Camera 33 Inserting the battery and memory card Learn how to insert the battery and an optional memory card into the camera. Memory card Insert a memory card with the goldcolored contacts facing down. Rechargeable battery Insert the battery with the Samsung logo facing up. Removing the battery and memory card Rechargeable battery Battery lock Slide the lock up to release the battery. Memory card Push the card gently until it disengages from the camera, and then pull it out of the slot. Using the memory card adapter To use micro memory cards with this product, a PC, or a memory card reader, insert the card into an adapter. While the status lamp of the camera is blinking, do not remove the memory card or battery. Doing so may damage the data stored on the memory card or your camera.My Camera 34 Charging the battery and turning on your camera Charging the battery Before you use the camera for the first time, you must charge the battery. Plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera, and then plug the other end of the USB cable into the AC adapter. Status lamp • Red light on: Charging • Red light off: Fully charged • Red light blinking: Error • Use only the AC adapter and USB cable supplied with your camera. If you use another AC adapter, the camera battery may not charge or work properly. • You can charge the battery with the USB cable only when the camera is turned off. Turning on your camera Set the Power switch to ON. • To turn your camera off, set the Power switch to OFF. • The initial setup screen appears when you turn on the camera for the first time. (p. 35)My Camera 35 Performing the initial setup When you turn on your camera for the first time, the initial setup screen appears. The language is preset for the country or region where the camera is sold. You can change the language as desired. You can also select an item by touching it on the screen. 1 Press [I] to select Time Zone, and then press [F] or [o]. 2 Press [D/I] to select a time zone, and then press [o]. Back Set Time Zone [GMT +00:00] London [GMT -01:00] Cape Verde [GMT -02:00] Mid-Atlantic [GMT -03:00] Buenos Aires, Sao Paulo [GMT -03:30] Newfoundland 3 Press [I] to select Date & Time, and then press [F] or [o]. Back Set Date & Time Year Month Day Hr Min DST • The screen may differ depending on the language selected. 4 Press [C/F] to select an item (Year/Month/Day/Hr/Min/ DST). 5 Press [D/I] to set the option, and then press [o]. 6 Press [I] to select Date Type, and then press [F] or [o]. 7 Press [D/I] to select a date type, and then press [o]. 8 Press [I] to select Time Type, and then press [F] or [o]. 9 Press [D/I] to select a time type, and then press [o]. 10 Press [m] to finish the initial setup.My Camera 36 Selecting functions (options) Selecting with buttons Scroll the jog dial or press [D/I/C/F] to move, and then press [o] to select an option. Selecting by touch Do not use sharp objects, such as pens or pencils, to touch the screen. You can damage the screen. Touching: Touch an icon to select a menu or an option. AllShare Play MobileLink Remote Viewfinder Auto Backup Email SNS & Cloud Dragging: Touch and hold an area on the screen, and then drag your finger. AutoShare Photo Size Quality ISO White Balance Back SelectMy Camera > Selecting functions (options) 37 Flicking: Gently flick your finger across the screen. • The touch screen may not recognize your inputs if you touch multiple items at the same time. • When you touch or drag the screen, discolorations may occur. This is not a malfunction, but a characteristic of the touch screen. Touch or drag lightly to minimize the discolorations. • The touch screen may not work properly if you use the camera in extremely humid environments. • The touch screen may not work properly if you apply screen protection film or other accessories to the screen. • Depending on the viewing angle, the screen may appear dim. Adjust the brightness or viewing angle to improve the resolution. Using Press [m m] or touch on the screen, and then change shooting options or settings. E.g. Selecting the photo size in P mode 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Press [m] or touch . 3 Press [C] → [D/I] to move to 1, and then press [o]. • You can also touch 1 on the screen. 4 Scroll the jog dial or press [D/I] to move to Photo Size, and then press [o]. • You can also drag the option list, and then touch an option. Back Select AutoShare Photo Size Quality ISO White BalanceMy Camera > Selecting functions (options) 38 5 Scroll the jog dial or press [D/I] to move to an option, and then press [o]. • You can also drag the option list, and then touch an option. • Press [m] or touch Back to go back to the previous menu. Back Set AutoShare Photo Size Quality ISO White Balance 5472x3648 (3:2) 3888x2592 (3:2) 2976x1984 (3:2) 1728x1152 (3:2) 5472x3080 (16:9) 6 Press [m] or touch Back to switch to Shooting mode. Using the Smart panel Press [f] or touch on the screen to access some functions such as Exposure, ISO, and White Balance. E.g. Adjust the exposure value in P mode 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Press [f] or touch .My Camera > Selecting functions (options) 39 3 Press [D/I/C/F] to move to EV, and then press [o]. • You can directly select an option by scrolling the jog dial without having to press [o]. • You can also select an option by touching it. EV : 0.0 Adjust You can adjust some options by dragging them. Back 4 Scroll the jog dial or press [C/F] to adjust the exposure value, and then press [o]. • You can also drag the dial on the screen, and then select Set to adjust the option. EV : 0.0 Back SetMy Camera 40 Display icons Capturing photos 1 2 3 London 1. Shooting information Icon Description Shooting mode Current date Current time GPS activated* London Location information* Memory card not inserted** Auto exposure lock (p. 103) Available number of photos • : Fully charged • : Partially charged • (Red): Empty (recharge the battery) Icon Description Auto focus frame Spot metering area Camera shake Manual focus scale Level gauge (p. 41) Histogram (p. 150) Focus Shutter speed Aperture value Exposure adjustment value ISO sensitivity (p. 75) * These icons appear when you attach an optional GPS module. ** Photos that were captured without inserting a memory card cannot be transferred to a memory card or a computer. 2. Shooting options Icon Description Photo size Drive mode Flash (p. 94) Flash intensity adjustment Metering (p. 97) Icon Description AF mode (p. 80) Focus area Face detection White Balance (p. 76) White Balance micro adjustment Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) (p. 89) ZZ on ratio RAW file Dynamic Range (p. 100) 3. Shooting options (Touch) Icon Description Change Smart mode*** AutoShare Touch AF options Shooting options Smart panel *** This icon appears only when you select Smart mode. The icons displayed will change according to the mode you select or the options you set. In Shooting modeMy Camera > Display icons 41 2. Shooting options Icon Description Video size AF mode (p. 80) Metering (p. 97) White Balance (p. 76) Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) (p. 89) White Balance micro adjustment Fader (p. 105) Multi Motion (p. 105) Voice recording off (p. 106) The icons displayed will change according to the mode you select or the options you set. About the level gauge The level gauge helps you align the camera with the horizontal and vertical lines on the display. If the level gauge is not level, calibrate the level gauge using the Horizontal Calibration function. (p. 152) Vertical Horizontal ▲ Level ▲ Unlevel You cannot use the level gauge when you shoot in portrait orientation. Recording videos 1 2 1. Shooting information Icon Description Shooting mode Current recording time/Available recording time • : Fully charged • : Partially charged • (Red): Empty (recharge the battery) Shutter speed Aperture value Exposure value ISO sensitivity (p. 75)My Camera > Display icons 42 In Playback mode Viewing photos London Information Mode F No Shutter ISO Metering Flash Focal Length White Balance EV Photo Size Date Icon Description Continuously captured file Current file/The total number of files Folder number - File number File with location information London Location information RAW file Protected file Print information added to file (p. 114) 3D file m Playback/Editing menu (Touch) Editing photos (Touch) Trimming a video (Touch) Viewing image thumbnails (Touch) 1 2 3 London No. Description 1 Captured photo 2 RGB histogram (p. 150) 3 Shooting mode, Metering, Flash, White Balance, Aperture value, Shutter speed, ISO, Focal length, Exposure value, Photo size, Date, Location information Playing videos Stop Capture Icon Description Playback speed Multi Motion Current playback time Video length / View previous file/Scan backward. (Each time you touch the scan backward icon, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) / Pause or resume playback. / View next file/Scan forward. (Each time you touch the scan forward icon, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) Adjust the volume or mute the sound.My Camera > Display icons 43 Changing the information displayed Press [D] repeatedly to change the display type. Mode Display type Shooting • Basic shooting information (Shooting mode, Shutter speed, Aperture value, Exposure value, ISO sensitivity, etc.) • Basic shooting information + Shooting option buttons (MENU, Fn, AutoShare, Touch AF) + Level gauge • Basic shooting information + Shooting option buttons + Current shooting options information (Photo size, Drive mode, Flash, Metering, AF mode, etc.) • Basic shooting information + Shooting option buttons + Current shooting options information + Histogram + Date and time Playback • Basic information • Display all information about the current file. • Display all information about the current file including RGB histogram.My Camera 44 Lenses You can purchase optional lenses made exclusively for your NX series camera. Learn about the functions of each lens and select one that suits your needs and preferences. Lens layout SAMSUNG 18-55 mm F3.5-5.6 OIS III lens (example) 1 2 3 5 4 6 7 8 No. Description 1 Lens mount index 2 Zoom ring 3 Focus ring (p. 88) 4 Lens hood mount index 5 Lens 6 i-Function button (p. 60) 7 AF/MF switch (p. 80) 8 Lens contacts When not using the lens, attach the lens cap and lens mount cover to protect the lens from dust and scratches.My Camera > Lenses 45 SAMSUNG 20-50 mm F3.5-5.6 ED II lens (example) 7 1 2 3 5 6 4 No. Description 1 Lens mount index 2 Zoom lock switch 3 Lens 4 Focus ring (p. 88) 5 i-Function button (p. 60) 6 Zoom ring 7 Lens contacts Locking or unlocking the lens To lock the lens, pull and hold the zoom lock switch away from the camera body and rotate the zoom ring as shown in the illustration.My Camera > Lenses 46 To unlock the lens, rotate the zoom ring as shown in the illustation until you hear the click. You cannot capture a photo when the lens is locked. SAMSUNG 16 mm F2.4 lens (example) 5 2 1 4 3 No. Description 1 i-Function button (p. 60) 2 Lens mount index 3 Focus ring (p. 88) 4 Lens 5 Lens contactsMy Camera > Lenses 47 Lens markings Find out what the numbers on the lens signify. SAMSUNG 18-200 mm F3.5-6.3 ED OIS lens (example) 1 2 345 No. Description 1 Aperture value A range of supported aperture values. For example, 1:3.5–6.3 means the maximum aperture value range from 3.5 to 6.3. 2 Focal length The distance from the middle of the lens to its focal point (in millimeters). This figure is expressed in a range: minimum focal length to maximum focal length of the lens. Longer focal lengths result in narrower angles of view and the subject is magnified. Shorter focal lengths result in wider angles of view. 3 ED ED stands for Extra-low Dispersion. Extra-low dispersion glass is effective in minimizing chromatic aberration (a distortion that occurs when a lens fails to focus all colors to the same convergence point). 4 OIS (p. 89) Optical Image Stabilization. Lenses with this feature can detect camera shake and effectively cancel out the movement inside the camera. 5 Ø The lens diameter. When you attach a filter to the lens, make sure that the diameters of the lens and the filter are the same.My Camera 48 Accessories You can use accessories including external flash and GPS module that can help you capture better and more convenient photos. For more information about optional accessories, refer to the manual for each accessory. • The illustrations may differ from the actual items. • You can purchase Samsung-approved accessories at a retailer or a Samsung service center. Samsung is not responsible for damage caused by using another manufacturer's accessories. External flash layout SEF8A (example) 1 2 3 No. Description 1 Bulb 2 Hot-shoe fastening dial 3 Hot-shoe connectionMy Camera > Accessories 49 Connecting the external flash 1 Remove the hot-shoe cover from the camera. 2 Mount the flash by sliding it into the hot-shoe. 3 Lock the flash into place by turning the hot-shoe fastening dial clockwise. 4 Lift up the flash for use.My Camera > Accessories 50 • You can capture a photo with a flash that is not fully charged, but it is recommended to use a fully charged flash. • Refer to the optional accessories page for available external flashes. (p. 195) • The available options may differ depending on the shooting mode. • There is an interval between two bursts of the flash. Do not move until the flash fires a second time. • SEF8A may not be compatible with other NX series cameras. • For more details about optional flashes, refer to the user manual for the flash. Use only Samsung-approved flashes. Using incompatible flashes may damage your camera. SEF220A (example) (optional) 2 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 No. Description 1 Display icons 2 READY lamp/Test button 3 MODE button 4 Flash release button 5 POWER button 6 Battery cover 7 Bulb 8 TELE/WIDE mode switch 9 Hot-shoe connectionMy Camera > Accessories 51 GPS module layout (optional) 1 2 3 4 5 No. Description 1 Status lamp 2 POWER button 3 Hot-shoe fastening dial 4 Hot-shoe connection 5 Battery cover Attaching the GPS module 1 Remove the hot-shoe cover from the camera. 2 Mount the GPS module by sliding it into the hot-shoe.My Camera > Accessories 52 3 Lock the GPS module into place by turning the hot-shoe fastening dial towards LOCK. 4 Press the power button of the GPS module.My Camera 53 Shooting modes Two simple shooting modes—Smart Auto and Smart mode—help you capture photos with numerous automatic settings. Additional modes allow for greater customization of settings. Icon Description t Smart Auto mode (p. 53) P Program mode (p. 55) A Aperture Priority mode (p. 57) S Shutter Priority mode (p. 58) M Manual mode (p. 59) i Lens Priority mode (p. 60) s Smart mode (p. 64) B Wi-Fi features (p. 122) t Smart Auto mode In Smart Auto mode, the camera recognizes surrounding conditions and automatically adjusts factors that contribute to exposure, including shutter speed, aperture value, metering, White Balance, and exposure compensation. As the camera controls most of the functions, some shooting functions are limited. This mode is useful for capturing quick snapshots with the least amount of adjustment.My Camera > Shooting modes 54 1 Rotate the mode dial to t. 2 Align your subject in the frame. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. • The camera selects a scene. An appropriate scene icon appears at the screen. Recognizable scenes Icon Description Landscapes Scenes with bright white backgrounds Landscapes at night Icon Description Portraits at night Landscapes with backlighting Portraits with backlighting Portraits Close-up photos of objects Close-up photos of text Sunsets Indoors, dark Partially lit Close-up with spot lighting Portraits with spot lighting Blue skies Forested areas typically consist of green-colored subjects Close-up photos of colorful subjects Camera is stabilized on a tripod and the subject is not moving for a certain period of time. (when shooting in the dark) Actively moving subjects Fireworks (when using a tripod) 4 Press [Shutter] to capture the photo.My Camera > Shooting modes 55 • The camera may detect different scenes, even the same subjects, depending on external factors such as camera shake, lighting, and distance to the subject. • If the camera does not recognize an appropriate scene mode, it uses the default settings for the Smart Auto mode. • Even if it detects a face, the camera may not select a portrait mode depending on the subject's position or lighting. • Even if you use a tripod, the camera may not detect the tripod mode ( ) if the subject is moving. • The camera consumes more battery power, because it changes settings often to select appropriate scenes. P Program mode The camera automatically adjusts shutter speed and aperture value so that an optimal exposure value can be achieved. This mode is useful when you want to capture shots of constant exposure while being able to adjust other settings. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Set the desired options. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo.My Camera > Shooting modes 56 Program Shift Program Shift function lets you adjust the shutter speed and aperture value while the camera maintains the same exposure. When you scroll the jog dial to the left, the shutter speed decreases and the aperture value increases. When you scroll the jog dial to the right, the shutter speed increases and the aperture value decreases. Minimum shutter speed Set the shutter speed not to be slower than the selected speed. However, if an optimal exposure value cannot be achieved because the ISO sensitivity reached the maximum ISO value that is set by Auto ISO Range, shutter speed may be slower than the selected minimum shutter speed. To set the minimum shutter speed, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Minimum Shutter Speed→ an option. • This feature is available only when the ISO sensitivity is set to Auto. • This feature is available only in Program or Aperture priority mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 57 A Aperture Priority mode In Aperture Priority mode, the camera automatically calculates shutter speed according to the aperture value you choose. You can adjust the depth of field (DOF) by changing the aperture value. This mode is useful for taking portraits, flowers, or landscape shots. Large Depth of Field Small Depth of Field 1 Rotate the mode dial to A. 2 Scroll the jog dial to adjust the aperture value. • You can also adjust the aperture value by pressing [f], moving to the aperture value, and then scrolling the jog dial or dragging the screen. 3 Set the desired options. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • In low-light settings, you may need to increase the ISO sensitivity to prevent blurred photos. • To set the minimum shutter speed, in Shooting mode, press [m] →1 →Minimum Shutter Speed→ an option.My Camera > Shooting modes 58 S Shutter Priority mode In Shutter Priority mode, the camera automatically adjusts the aperture value according to the shutter speed you choose. This mode is useful for capturing photos of fast-moving subjects or for creating tracer effects in a photo. For example, set the shutter speed to over 1/500 s to freeze the subject. To make the subject appear blurred set the shutter speed to below 1/30 s. Slow shutter speed Fast shutter speed 1 Rotate the mode dial to S. 2 Scroll the jog dial to adjust the shutter speed. • You can also adjust the shutter speed by pressing [f], moving to the shutter speed, and then scrolling the jog dial or dragging the screen. 3 Set the desired options. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. In order to compensate for the reduced amount of light allowed by fast shutter speeds, open the aperture and let in more light. If your photos are still too dark, increase the ISO value.My Camera > Shooting modes 59 M Manual mode Manual mode lets you adjust the shutter speed and aperture value manually. In this mode, you can fully control the exposure of your photos. This mode is useful in controlled shooting environments, such as a studio, or when it is necessary to fine-tune camera settings. The Manual mode is also recommended for shooting night scenes or fireworks. 1 Rotate the mode dial to M. 2 Scroll the jog dial to adjust the shutter speed. 3 Press and hold [W], and then rotate the mode dial to adjust the aperture value. • You can also adjust the shutter speed or the aperture value by pressing [f], moving to the shutter speed or the aperture value, and then scrolling the jog dial or dragging the screen. 4 Set the desired options. 5 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. Framing mode When you adjust the aperture value or shutter speed, the exposure changes according to the settings, so the display may darken. With this function on, the brightness of the display is constant regardless of the settings, so you can better frame your shot. To use Framing Mode, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Framing Mode → an option.My Camera > Shooting modes 60 Using the Bulb function Use the Bulb function to shoot night scenes or the night sky. While you are pressing [Shutter], the shutter is left open so you can create moving light effects. To use a bulb, Completely scroll the jog dial to the left to Bulb→ Press and hold [Shutter] for the desired time. • If you set a high ISO value or open the shutter for a long time, image noise may increase. • Drive options, flash, and One touch shot cannot be used with the Bulb function. • The Bulb function is available only in Manual mode. • Use a tripod and shutter release to prevent your camera from shaking. • The longer you open the shutter, the longer it takes to save a photo. Do not turn the camera off while the camera saves a photo. • If you use this function for a long time, use a fully charged battery. i Lens Priority mode You can adjust the depth of field to blur or sharpen the background. Using E 1 Rotate the mode dial to i. 2 Press [i-Function] on the lens to select E. • You can also press [i-Function], and then press [C/F] or drag the screen to select E.My Camera > Shooting modes 61 3 Adjust the focus ring to select a value. • You can also scroll the jog dial to adjust the value. • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the value. Defocus E Sharpen 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • As you sharpen photos, the aperture value Increases and the shutter speed reduces. In dark places, photos may be blurry. • This function is not available when you set 3D Auto Mode in 3D mode. Using i-Function in P/A/S/M modes When you use the i-Function button on an i-Function lens, you can manually select and adjust shutter speed, aperture value, exposure value, ISO sensitivity, and White Balance on the lens. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P, A, S, or M. 2 Press [i-Function] on the lens to select a setting. • You can also press [i-Function], and then press [C/F] or drag the screen to select a setting.My Camera > Shooting modes 62 3 Adjust the focus ring to select an option. • You can also scroll the jog dial or drag the screen to select an option. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. Available options Shooting mode PASM 3D Aperture -O-OShutter Speed - - OO - EV OOO - O ISO OOOO - White Balance OOOOO Z OOOO - • To select items to appear when you press [i-Function] on the lens in Shooting mode, press [m] →5→iFn Customizing→ an item. • This function is not available when you set 3D Auto Mode in 3D mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 63 Using ZThe Z allows you to zoom in on a subject with less degradation of photo quality than the Digital zoom. However, the photo resolution may change compared to when you zoom in by rotating the zoom ring. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P, A, S, M, or i. 2 Press [i-Function] on the lens to select Z. • You can also press [i-Function], and then press [C/F] or drag the screen to select Z. 3 Adjust the focus ring to select a zoom ratio. • You can also scroll the jog dial or drag the screen to select an option. • Photo resolution varies according to the zoom ratio if you use the Z. 3:2 16:9 1:1 x1.2 4560X3040 (13.9M) 4560X2568 (11.7M) 3040X3040 (9.2M) x1.4 3888X2592 (10.1M) 3888X2184 (8.5M) 2592X2592 (6.7M) x1.7 3264X2176 (7.1M) 3264X1840 (6.0M) 2176X2176 (4.7M) x2 2736X1824 (5.0M) 2736X1536 (4.2M) 1824X1824 (3.3M) These figures are based on the maximum resolution at each image ratio. 4 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • Z is not available when you capture burst shots. • Z is not available when you capture photos in the RAW file format. • Z is deactivated when you record videos by pressing the video recording button. • This function is not available when you set 3D Auto Mode in 3D mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 64 s Smart mode In Smart mode, you can capture photos with options that are preset for a specific scene. 1 Rotate the mode dial to s. 2 Select a scene. • To select a shooting mode when the mode dial is set to s, press [f] or touch , and then select a desired mode. Smart : Beauty Face Set Option Description Beauty Face Capture a portrait with options to hide facial imperfections. Best Face Capture multiple photos and replace faces to create the best possible image. Landscape Capture still-life scenes and landscapes. Option Description Macro Capture small or close-up subjects. Action Freeze Capture subjects moving at high speed. Rich Tones Capture a photo with vibrant colors. Panorama Capture a wide panoramic scene in a single photo. Waterfall Capture scenes with waterfalls. Silhouette Capture subjects as dark shapes against a light background. Sunset Capture scenes at sunset, with natural-looking reds and yellows. Night Capture multiple photos in low light conditions without a flash. The camera combines them to create a single image that is brighter and has less blurring. Fireworks Capture scenes with fireworks. Light Trace Capture scenes with the light trailing in low-light conditions. Creative Shot Capture photos with effects applied automatically. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus, and then press [Shutter] to capture.My Camera > Shooting modes 65 Using the Best Face mode In Best Face mode, you can capture multiple photos and replace faces to create the best possible image. Use this mode to select the best image for each individual when capturing group photos. 1 Rotate the mode dial to s, and then select Best Face. 2 Align your subject in the frame, and then half-press [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to capture the photo. • The camera captures 5 photos consecutively. • The first photo is set as the background image. • The camera automatically detects faces after shooting. 4 Touch a face to replace. 5 Touch the best image from the 5 faces that were captured. • Repeat steps 4 and 5 to replace the rest faces of the photo. • The icon will appear on the image that the camera recommends. 6 Touch to save the photo. • Use a tripod to prevent your camera from shaking. • The resolution is set to 5.9M or smaller.My Camera > Shooting modes 66 Capturing panoramic photos Capture a 2D or 3D panoramic photo. Captured 3D panoramic photos can be viewed only on a 3D TV or 3D monitor. 1 Rotate the mode dial to s, and then select Panorama. 2 Press [m] →1→Panorama→Live Panorama or 3D. 3 Press [m] to return to Shooting mode. 4 Press and hold [Shutter] to start shooting. 5 With [Shutter] pressed, slowly move the camera in the direction you selected. • In 3D Panorama mode, you can capture a scene only in horizontal directions. • An arrow toward the direction of motion is displayed, and the entire shooting image is displayed in the preview box. • When the scenes are aligned, the camera captures the next photo automatically. 6 When you are finished, release [Shutter]. • The camera will automatically save the shots into one photo. • If you release [Shutter] while shooting, the panoramic shooting stops and photos that have been captured are saved.My Camera > Shooting modes 67 • The resolution varies depending on the panoramic photo you captured. • In Panorama mode, some shooting options are not available. • The camera may stop shooting due to the shooting composition or the subject's movement. • In Panorama mode, your camera may not capture the entire last scene if you stop moving the camera to improve the photo quality. To capture the entire scene, move your camera slightly beyond the point where you want the scene to end. • In 3D Panorama mode, your camera may not capture the very beginning or end of a scene due to the nature of the 3D effect. To capture the entire scene, move slightly beyond the beginning and end points you want to capture. • Photos captured with the 3D function are saved in JPEG (2D) and MPO (3D) formats. On your camera's display, you can view only JPEG files. • To view 3D files, connect your camera to a 3D TV or 3D monitor with an optional HDMI cable. While viewing, wear proper 3D glasses. • Capturing photos in 3D Panorama mode may result in a less pronounced 3D effect than those captured with a 3D lens. To increase the 3D effect, attach the optional 3D lens and use 3D mode. (p. 69) • For best results when capturing panoramic photos, avoid the following: - moving the camera too quickly or too slowly - moving the camera too little to capture the next image - moving the camera at irregular speeds - shaking the camera - shooting in dark places - capturing moving subjects nearby - shooting conditions where the brightness or color of light is changing • Photos taken are automatically saved, and shooting is stopped under the following conditions: - if you change the shooting direction while shooting - if you move the camera too rapidly - if you don't move the cameraMy Camera > Shooting modes 68 Recording a video In Shooting mode, you can record Full HD videos (1920X1080) by pressing (Video recording). The camera lets you record a video up to 29 minutes and 59 seconds in length at 60, 30, 24, or 15 fps, and saves the files in MP4 (H.264) format. 60 fps is available only with 1920X1080 and 1280X720 and 24 fps is available only with 1920X810. 15 fps is available only with some Smart Filter options. The sound is recorded via the camera's microphone. You can set the exposure by adjusting the aperture value and shutter speed for the mode you selected. When you use a lens that does not have an AF/MF switch while recording a video, press [F] to deactivate or activate the AF function. When you use the lens that has an AF/MF switch, the AF function works according to the switch’s setting. Select Fader to fade in or out a scene. You can also select Voice, Wind Cut, or other options to set recording options. (p. 106) 1 Rotate the mode dial to t, P, A, S, M, i, or s. • This feature may not work in some modes. 2 Set the desired options. 3 Press (Video recording) to start recording. 4 Press (Video recording) again to stop. • H.264 (MPEG-4 part10/AVC) is the latest video coding format established in 2003 collaboratively by ISO-IEC and ITU-T. Since this format uses a high compression rate, more data can be saved in less memory space. • If you have the image stabilizer option on when shooting a movie, the camera may record the image stabilizer sound. • The zoom sound or other lens sounds may be recorded if you adjust the lens while recording a video. • When using an optional video lens, the autofocus noise is not recorded. • If you remove the camera lens while recording a movie, the recording will be interrupted. Do not change the lens while recording. • If you attach an external microphone while recording a movie, sound will not be recorded through the external microphone. (The previous settings are maintained.) If you remove the external microphone while recording a movie, sound will not be recorded. Turn off the camera before attaching or removing the external microphone. My Camera > Shooting modes 69 • If you change the shooting angle of the camera suddenly while shooting a movie, the camera may not be able to record images accurately. Use a tripod to minimize camera shake. • The camera supports only the Multi AF function when recording a video. You cannot use any other focus area setting functions, such as Face Detection AF. • When the size of a movie file exceeds 4 GB, the camera automatically stops recording even if the maximum recording time (29 minutes and 59 seconds) has not been reached. • If you use a slow writing memory card, the recording of your movie can be interrupted because the card cannot process data at the rate the video is being shot. If this occurs, replace the card with a faster memory card or reduce the video size (for example, from 1280X720 to 640X480). • When formatting a memory card, always format using the camera. If you format on another camera or a PC, you can lose files on the card or cause a change in the capacity of the card. • When you press the video recording button, Z turns off. • While recording a video in the same ISO sensitivity, the screen may be darker than taking a photo. Adjust the ISO sensitivity. • When you record a video in P, A, or S mode, ISO is automatically set to Auto. 3D mode You can capture 3D photos or videos with an optional 3D lens. SAMSUNG 45 mm F1.8 [T6] 2D/3D lens (example) Set the 2D/3D switch on the lens to 3D, and then capture a photo or video 1.5-5 m away from the subject.My Camera > Shooting modes 70 • 3D mode is always on, regardless of the mode dial of the camera, except B. • To use auto 3D options that enable the camera to set shooting options automatically depending on shooting conditions in 3D mode, press [m] →1→3D Auto Mode→On. • To change the 3D recording option, press [m] →6→ 3D REC Mode→ a desired option. * Default Icon Description Side by Side*: Displays two images next to each other. Frame Packing: Displays the images for the left and right eye alternately in frames. • Available shooting options differ compared to other shooting modes. • You can select either 4.1M (2688X1512) or 2.1M (1920X1080) photo size. • The video resolution is set to 1920X1080. • Videos recorded in 3D may be dark or playback may be jittery. • Shooting in low temperatures may result in color distortion in images and may consume more battery power. • You may not be able to shoot properly in conditions below 8.5 LV/900 lux. For best results, capture photos in places with sufficient light. • When you photograph objects that contain polarizing material, such as a display, sunglasses, or a polarizing filter, or use the polarizing material with your lens, the images may appear dark or the 3D effect may not be applied properly. • Use a tripod to prevent your camera from shaking. • If you rotate or tilt the camera vertically while shooting, the 3D effect may not be applied properly. Capture images with the camera in the normal position. • If you shoot in fluorescent lighting or capture images displayed by projectors or TVs, the images may appear black due to the flicker effect. • In 3D mode, the Enlarge x8 option of MF Assist may not be available. • The camera's display shows 3D videos only in 2D. • Photos captured with the 3D function are saved in JPEG (2D) and MPO (3D) formats. On your camera's display, you can view only JPEG files. • To view 3D files, connect your camera to a 3D TV or 3D monitor with an optional HDMI cable. While viewing, wear proper 3D glasses. • You cannot use the flash in 3D mode.My Camera > Shooting modes 71 Available functions by shooting mode For details about shooting functions, see Chapter 2. Press a shortcut for each function. Function Available in Shortcut Photo Size (p. 73) P/A/S/M/i/s*/t/3D* - Quality (p. 74) P/A/S/M/i/s* - ISO (p. 75) P/A/S/M f/I White Balance (p. 76) P/A/S/M f Picture Wizard (p. 79) P/A/S/M f Smart Filter (p. 101) P/A/S/M f AF Mode (p. 80) P/A/S/M/i*/s*/3D* f AF Area (p. 83) P/A/S/M/i*/s* f/F Touch AF (p. 86) P/A/S/M/i/s*/t/3D* - MF Assist (p. 88) P/A/S/M/i/s/t/3D* - Focus Peaking (p. 88) P/A/S/M/i/s/t - Link AE to AF Point (p. 99) P/A/S/M - Function Available in Shortcut Framing Mode (p. 59) P/A/S/M - OIS (Anti-Shake) (p. 89) P/A/S/M/i/s*/t* - Drive (Continuous/ Burst/Timer/ Bracketing) (p. 90) P/A/S/M/i*/s*/t*/3D* f/C Metering (p. 97) P/A/S/M f Dynamic Range (p. 100) P/A/S/M - Flash (p. 94) P*/A*/S*/M*/i*/s*/t* f Exposure compensation (p. 102) P/A/S f/W Exposure lock (p. 103) P/A/S - * Some functions are limited in these modes.Chapter 2 Shooting Functions Learn about the functions you can set in Shooting mode. You can enjoy more customized photos and videos by using the shooting functions.Shooting Functions 73 Shooting Functions Photo size As you increase the resolution, your photo or video will include more pixels, so it can be printed on larger paper or displayed on a larger screen. When you use a high resolution, the file size will also increase. Select a low resolution for photos that will be displayed in a digital picture frame or uploaded to the web. To set the size, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Photo Size→ an option. Icon Size Recommended for 5472x3648 (3:2) Printing on A1 paper. 3888x2592 (3:2) Printing on A2 paper. 2976x1984 (3:2) Printing on A3 paper. 1728x1152 (3:2) Printing on A5 paper. 5472x3080 (16:9) Printing on A1 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 3712x2088 (16:9) Printing on A3 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 2944x1656 (16:9) Printing on A4 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 1920x1080 (16:9) Printing on A5 paper or viewing on an HDTV. 3648x3648 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A1 paper. 2640x2640 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A3 paper. 2000x2000 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A4 paper. 1024x1024 (1:1) Printing a square photo on A5 paper. Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Size and Resolution74 Shooting Functions > Size and Resolution Quality The camera saves photos in either the JPEG or RAW format. Photos captured by a camera are often transformed to the JPEG format and stored in the memory according to the settings of the camera at the time of shooting. RAW files are not transformed to the JPEG format and are stored in the memory without any changes. RAW files have the file extension “SRW”. To adjust and calibrate exposures, White Balances, tones, contrasts, and colors of the RAW files, or to convert them into JPEG or TIFF format, use the Adobe Photoshop Lightroom program found on the supplied DVD-ROM. Ensure you have enough space on the memory card to save photos in the RAW format. To set the quality, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Quality→ an option. Icon Format Description JPEG Super Fine: • Compressed for the best quality. • Recommended for printing in large size. JPEG Fine: • Compressed for better quality. • Recommended for printing in normal size. Icon Format Description JPEG Normal: • Compressed for normal quality. • Recommended for printing in small size or uploading to the web. RAW RAW: • Save a photo without data loss. • Recommended for editing after shooting. RAW+JPEG RAW + S.Fine: Save a photo in both the JPEG (S.Fine quality) and RAW format. RAW+JPEG RAW + Fine: Save a photo in both the JPEG (Fine quality) and RAW format. RAW+JPEG RAW + Normal: Save a photo in both the JPEG (Normal quality) and RAW format. Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Shooting Functions 75 Shooting Functions The ISO sensitivity value represents the sensitivity of camera to light. The larger the ISO value, the more sensitive the camera is to light. Consequently, by selecting a higher ISO sensitivity value, you can capture photos in dim or dark places at faster shutter speeds. However, this may increase electronic noise and result in a grainy photo. To set ISO sensitivity, In Shooting mode, press [I] → an option. Examples ISO 100 ISO 400 ISO 800 ISO 3200 • You can also set the option by pressing [m] →1→ISO→ an option in Shooting mode. • Increase the ISO value in places where flash use is prohibited. You can capture a clear photo by setting a high ISO value without having to secure more light. • Use the Noise Reduction function in order to reduce the visual noise that can appear on photos of a high ISO value. (p. 146) • Available options may differ depending on the shooting conditions. ISO sensitivityShooting Functions 76 Shooting Functions White Balance represents the light source that influences on the color of a photo. The color of a photo depends on the type and quality of the light source. If you want the color of your photo to be realistic, select an appropriate lighting condition to calibrate the White Balance, such as Auto WB, Daylight, Cloudy, Tungsten, or adjust color temperature manually. You can also adjust color for the preset light sources so that the colors of the photo match the actual scene under mixed lighting conditions. To set the White Balance, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→White Balance→ an option. Icon Description Auto WB: Use automatic settings depending on the lighting conditions. Daylight: Select when taking outdoor photos on a sunny day. This option results in photos closest to the natural colors of the scene. Cloudy: Select when taking outdoor photos on a cloudy day or in shadows. Photos captured on cloudy days tend to be more bluish than on sunny days. This option offsets that effect. Icon Description Fluorescent White: Select when shooting under a daylight fluorescent lamp. Especially for white fluorescent light with a color temperature of about 4,200K. Fluorescent NW: Select when shooting under a daylight fluorescent lamp. Especially for white fluorescent light of very white hues with a temperature of about 5,000K. Fluorescent Daylight: Select when shooting under a daylight fluorescent lamp. Especially for white fluorescent light of slightly bluish hue with a temperature of about 6,500K. Tungsten: Select when taking indoor photos under incandescent bulbs or halogen lamps. Incandescent tungsten bulbs tend to have a reddish hue. This option offsets that effect. Flash WB: Select when using a flash. Custom Set: Use your pre-defined settings. You can manually set the White Balance by pressing [D], and then shooting a white sheet of paper. Fill the spot metering circle with the paper and set the White Balance. White Balance77 Shooting Functions > White Balance Icon Description Color Temperature: Manually adjust the color temperature of the light source. Color temperature is a measurement in degrees Kelvin that indicates the specific type of light source. As the color temperature increases, the color distribution becomes cooler. Alternatively, as the color temperature decreases, the color distribution becomes warmer. Press [D], and then adjust the color temperature. Clear sky Fluorescent H Fluorescent L Cloudy Halogen lamp Daylight Tungsten Candle light Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Customizing preset White Balance options You can also customize preset White Balance options. To customize preset options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→White Balance → an option → [D] → scroll the jog dial, or press [D/I/C/F]. White Balance : Daylight Back Set Reset You can also touch an area on the screen.78 Shooting Functions > White Balance Examples Auto WB Daylight Fluorescent Daylight TungstenShooting Functions 79 Shooting Functions Picture Wizard lets you apply different photo styles to your photo to create various looks and emotional moods. You can also create and save your own photo styles by adjusting color, saturation, sharpness, and contrast for each style. There is no rule for which style is suitable in which conditions. Experiment with different styles and find your own settings. To set a photo style, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Picture Wizard → an option. Examples Standard Vivid Portrait Landscape Forest Retro Cool Calm Classic • You can also adjust the value of the preset style settings. Select a Picture Wizard option, press [D], and then adjust color, saturation, sharpness, or contrast. • To customize your own picture wizard, select , , or , and then adjust the color, saturation, sharpness, and contrast. • Picture Wizard options cannot be set with Smart Filter options at the same time. Picture Wizard (photo styles)Shooting Functions 80 Shooting Functions AF mode Learn how to adjust the camera’s focus according to the subjects. You can select a focusing mode appropriate to the subject among Single Auto Focus, Continuous Auto Focus, and Manual Focus. The AF function is activated when you press [Shutter] halfway. In the MF mode, you have to rotate the focus ring on the lens to focus manually. In most cases, you can have a focus by selecting Single AF. Fast moving subjects or subjects of a color similar to the background are difficult to focus. Select an appropriate focusing mode for such instances. If your lens has an AF/MF switch, you must set the switch according to the selected mode. Set the switch to AF when you select Single AF or Continuous AF. Set the switch to MF when you select Manual Focus. When your lens has no AF/MF switch, press [F] to select a desired AF mode. To set the auto focus mode, In Shooting mode, press [F] → an option. • You can also set the option by pressing [m] →1→AF Mode→ an option in Shooting mode. • The available options may differ depending on the lens in use.81 Shooting Functions > AF mode Single AF Single AF is appropriate for shooting a still subject. When you press [Shutter] halfway, the focus fixes in the focus area. The area turns green when the focus is achieved. Continuous AF While you are pressing [Shutter] halfway, the camera continues to automatic focusing. Once the focus area is fixed on the subject, the subject is always in focus even when moving. This mode is recommended for shooting a person on a bicycle, a running dog, or a car racing scene.82 Shooting Functions > AF mode Manual focus You can manually focus on a subject by rotating the focus ring on the lens. The MF Assist function lets you easily achieve a focus. While you are rotating the focus ring, the focus area is magnified. When you use the Focus Peaking function, the color you selected appears on the focused subject. This mode is recommended for shooting an object similar in color to the background, a night scene, or fireworks. If you use this function, you cannot set Touch AF, AF Area, and Link AE to AF Point options.Shooting Functions 83 Shooting Functions The AF area function changes the positions of the focus area. Generally, cameras focus on the nearest subject. When there are a lot of subjects, however, unwanted subjects can be in focus. In order to prevent unwanted subjects from being in focus, change the focus area so that a desired subject is in focus. You can get a clearer and sharper photo by selecting an appropriate focus area. To set the auto focus area, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→AF Area→ an option. • Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. • When the AF/MF switch is set to MF, you cannot change the AF area from the shooting menu. • When you use the Face Detection AF option, the camera focuses on the area with the white frame automatically. • Depending on the Picture Wizard options, Face Detection may not be effective. • When you set manual focus, Face Detection may not be available. • Face Detection may not be effective when: - the subject is far from the camera - it is too bright or too dark - the subject is not facing the camera - the subject is wearing sunglasses or a mask - the subject’s facial expression changes drastically - the subject is backlit or the lighting conditions are unstable Selection AF You can set the focus on an area you want. Apply an out-of-focus effect to make the subject more distinguishable. The focus on the photo below was repositioned and resized so that it fits the subject’s face. To resize or move the focus area, in Shooting mode, press [o]. Use the navigation button to move the focus area. Scroll the jog dial to resize the focus area. AF area84 Shooting Functions > AF area Multi AF The camera displays a green rectangle in places where focus is set correctly. The photo is divided into two or more areas, and the camera obtains focus points of each area. It is recommended for scenery photos. When you press [Shutter] halfway, the camera displays the focus areas as shown in the photo below. Face detection AF The camera focuses on human faces preferentially. Faces of up to 10 people can be detected. This setting is recommended for shooting a group of people. When you press [Shutter] halfway, the camera focuses on faces as shown in the photo below. In cases of shooting a group of people, the camera displays the focus on the nearest person’s face in white and the rest of the people’s faces in gray.85 Shooting Functions > AF area Self-Portrait AF It can be difficult to check whether your face is in focus when you are taking a self-portrait. When this function is on, the beep from the camera gets faster when your face is located at the center of the composition.Shooting Functions 86 Shooting Functions Tracking AF Tracking AF allows you to track and automatically focus on your subject, even when the subject is moving or when you change the shooting composition. White frame: Your camera is tracking the subject. Green frame: Your subject is in focus when you half-press [Shutter]. Red frame: Your camera failed to focus. Select or focus on a focal area that you touch on the screen. Additionally, focus on the subject and capture a photo by touching on the screen. To set Touch AF, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→ Touch AF→ an option. Available options may differ depending on the shooting conditions. Touch AF Touch AF allows you to select and focus on the focus area that you touch on the screen. AF Point The focal area will correspond to the area you touch on the screen and the focus will not be achieved. Touch AF87 Shooting Functions > Touch AF One touch shot You can capture a photo with the touch of your finger. As you touch on a subject, the camera focuses on the subject automatically and captures a photo. • If you do not select a focus area, the Auto Focus function does not work. • Tracking a subject may fail when: - the subject is too small - the subject moves excessively - the subject is backlit or you are shooting in a dark place - colors or patterns on the subject and the background are the same - the subject includes horizontal patterns, such as blinds - the camera shakes excessively • When tracking fails, the feature will be reset. • If the camera fails to track the subject, the focus area will be reset. • If the camera fails to focus, the focus frame will change to red and the focus will be reset.Shooting Functions 88 Shooting Functions In the manual focus mode, you have to rotate the focus ring on the lens to focus. When you use the MF Assist function or the Focus Peaking function, you can achieve a clearer focus. This function is only available on a lens that supports manual focus. MF Assist In the manual focus mode, you can enlarge the scene and easily adjust the focus while rotating the focus ring. To set the manual focus assist, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→MF Assist→ an option. * Default Option Description Off Do not use the MF Assist function. Enlarge x5* The focus area is magnified by 5 times when you rotate the focus ring. * Default Option Description Enlarge x8 The focus area is magnified by 8 times when you rotate the focus ring. Focus Peaking In the manul focus mode, the color you selected appears on the focused subject to help you focus while rotating the focus ring. To set Focus Peaking options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Focus Peaking→ an option. * Default Option Description Level Set a sensitivity for detecting the focused subject. (Off, High, Normal*, Low) Color Set a color to appear on the focused subject. (White*, Red, Green) Focus assistShooting Functions 89 Shooting Functions Use the Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) function to minimize camera shake. OIS may not be available with some lenses. Camera shake tends to occur in dark places or when shooting indoors. In such cases, the camera uses slower shutter speeds in order to increase the amount of light taken in, which can result in a blurry photo. You can prevent this situation by using the OIS function. If your lens has an OIS switch, you have set the switch to ON to use the OIS function. To set OIS options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→OIS (Anti-Shake) → an option. * Default Icon Description Off: The OIS function is off. (This option may not be available with some lenses.) Mode 1*: The OIS function is applied only when you press [Shutter] in full or half. Mode 2: The OIS function is on. Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) Without OIS correction With OIS correction • OIS may not function properly when: - you move your camera to follow a moving subject - there is too much camera shake - the shutter speed is slow (for example, when you select Night in s mode) - the battery is low - you capture a close-up shot • If you use the OIS function with a tripod, your images may be blurred by the vibration of the OIS sensor. Deactivate the OIS function when you use a tripod. • If the camera is hit or dropped, the display will be blurry. If this occurs, turn off the camera, and then turn it on again. • Use the OIS function only when needed because the function consumes more battery power. • To set an OIS option on the menu, set the OIS switch on your lens to ON. • This option may not be available with some lenses. • Off may not be available with some lenses.Shooting Functions 90 Shooting Functions You can set the shooting method such as Continuous, Burst, Timer and so on. Select Single to capture one photo at a time. Select Continuous or Burst to shoot fast moving subjects. Select AE Bracket, WB Bracket, or P Wiz Bracket to adjust exposure, White Balance, or apply Picture Wizard effects. You can also select Timer to capture a photo of yourself. To set the shooting method, In Shooting mode, press [C] → an option. • You can also set the option by pressing [m] →1→Drive→ an option in Shooting mode. • Available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Single Capture one photo whenever you press [Shutter]. Recommended for general conditions. Continuous Continuously capture photos while you are pressing [Shutter]. You can capture up to 5 photos (Continuous Normal) or 8.6 photos (Continuous High) per second. If you select Continuous High, the noise reduction function is not available. Drive (shooting method)91 Shooting Functions > Drive (shooting method) Burst Consecutively capture up to 10 shots per second (3 seconds), 15 shots per second (2 seconds), or 30 shots per second (1 second) when you press [Shutter] once. It is recommended for shooting the rapid motion of fast moving subjects such as racing cars. • To set the number of shots, in Shooting mode, press [C] → Burst, and then press [D]. • The photo size is set to 5M. • It may take longer to save a photo. • You cannot use the flash with this option. • Shutter speed must be faster than 1/30 second. • Photos captured with this option may be slightly enlarged when saving. • You cannot set an ISO option higher than ISO 3200. • This option cannot be used with the RAW file format and is not available when the photo quality is set to RAW. Timer Capture a photo with a delay of 2 to 30 seconds. The delay is adjustable in increments of 1 second. To set the delay, in Shooting mode, press [C] →Timer, and then press [D].92 Shooting Functions > Drive (shooting method) Auto Exposure Bracketing (AE Bracket) When you press [Shutter], the camera captures 3 consecutive photos: the original, one a step darker, and one a step lighter. Use a tripod to prevent blurry photos as the camera captures three photos continuously. You can adjust the settings in Bracket Set menu. Exposure -2 Original Exposure +2 White Balance Bracketing (WB Bracket) When you press [Shutter], the camera captures 3 consecutive photos: the original and two more with different White Balance settings. The original photo is captured when you press [Shutter]. The other two are automatically adjusted according to the White Balance you have set. You can adjust the settings in Bracket Set menu. WB-2 Original WB+2 This option cannot be used with the RAW file format and is not available when the photo quality is set to RAW.93 Shooting Functions > Drive (shooting method) Picture Wizard Bracketing (P Wiz Bracket) When you press [Shutter], the camera captures three consecutive photos, each with a different Picture Wizard setting. The camera captures a photo and applies the three Picture Wizard options you have set to the image captured. You can select three different settings in Bracket Set menu. Vivid Standard Retro This option cannot be used with the RAW file format and is not available when the photo quality is set to RAW. Bracketing setting You can set up the options for AE Bracket, WB Bracket, and P Wiz Bracket. (p. 147) To set a bracketing option, In Shooting mode, press [m] →5→Bracket Set→ an option.Shooting Functions 94 Shooting Functions In order to capture a realistic photo of a subject, the amount of light should be constant. When the light source varies, you can use a flash and supply a constant amount of light. Select appropriate settings according to a light source and a subject. To set flash options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Flash→ an option. Icon Description Off: Do not use the flash. Smart Flash: The camera automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash according to the amount of light in the surrounding environment. Auto: The flash automatically fires in dark places. Auto Red-eye: The flash automatically fires and reduces red-eyes. Fill in: The flash fires whenever you capture a photo. (Brightness is automatically adjusted.) Fill-in Red: The flash fires whenever you capture a photo and reduces red-eyes. Icon Description 1st Curtain: The flash fires immediately after the shutter opens. The camera captures a photo of a subject earlier in an action sequence clearly. Ball moving direction 2nd Curtain: The flash fires just before the shutter closes. The camera captures a photo of a subject later in an action sequence clearly. Ball moving direction • The available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. • There is an interval between two bursts of the flash. Do not move until the flash fires a second time. • If you select Off, the flash does not fire even when an external flash is attached. Use only Samsung-approved flashes. Using incompatible flashes may damage your camera. Flash95 Shooting Functions > Flash Reducing the red-eye effect If the flash fires when you capture a photo of a person in the dark, a red glow may appear in the eyes. To reduce the red-eye effect, select Auto Red-eye or Fill-in Red. Without red-eye reduction With red-eye reduction If the subject is too far from the camera or moves when the first flash fires, redeyes may not be reduced. Adjusting the flash intensity When the flash is on, adjust the flash intensity +/-2 levels. To set the flash intensity, In Shooting mode, press [f] →Flash→ an option → [D] → scroll the jog dial or press [C/F] to adjust the flash intensity. Back Set Flash : 0.096 Shooting Functions > Flash • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the intensity. • Adjusting the flash intensity may not be effective when: - the subject is too close to the camera - you set a high ISO sensitivity - the exposure value is too big or too small • In some shooting modes, you cannot use this function. • If you attach an intensity-adjustable external flash to the camera, the intensity settings of the flash will be applied. • If the subject is too close when you use the flash, some light may be blocked, resulting in a dark photo. Ensure that the subject is within the recommended range, which varies by lens. • When a lens hood is attached, the light from the flash can be blocked by the hood. Remove the hood to use the flash.Shooting Functions 97 Shooting Functions The metering mode refers to the way in which a camera measures the quantity of light. The camera measures the amount of light in a scene, and in many of its modes, uses the measurement to adjust various settings. For example, if a subject looks darker than its actual color, the camera captures an overexposed photo of it. If a subject looks lighter than its actual color, the camera captures an underexposed photo of it. The brightness and overall mood of the photo can also be affected by how the camera measures the amount of light. Select an appropriate setting for a shooting condition. To set a metering option, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Metering→ an option. Multi The Multi mode calculates the amount of light in multiple areas. When light is sufficient or insufficient, the camera adjusts the exposure by averaging the overall brightness of the scene. This mode is suitable for general photos. Metering98 Shooting Functions > Metering Spot The Spot mode calculates the amount of light in the center. When you capture a photo in conditions where there is a strong backlight behind a subject, the camera adjusts the exposure so as to shoot a subject correctly. For example, when you select the Multi mode in a strong backlight condition, the camera calculates that the overall amount of light is abundant, which results in a darker photo. The Spot mode can prevent this situation as it calculates the amount of light in a designated area. The subject is in bright color while the background is dark. The Spot mode is recommended for a situation like this where a huge difference in the exposure exists between a subject and a background. Center-weighted The Center-weighted mode calculates a broader area than the Spot mode does. It sums up the amount of light in the center portion of the shot (60–80 %) and that of the rest of the shot (20–40 %). It is recommended for situations where there is a slight difference in brightness between a subject and a background or an area of the subject is large compared to the overall composition of the photo.99 Shooting Functions > Metering Measuring the exposure value of the focus area When this function is turned on, the camera automatically sets an optimal exposure by calculating the brightness of the focus area. This function is only available when you select Spot metering or Multi metering, and Selection AF. To set this function, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Link AE to AF Point→ an option.Shooting Functions 100 Shooting Functions This function automatically corrects the loss of bright detail that can occur due to shading differences in the photo. To set Smart Range options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→ Dynamic Range→ an option. Without Dynamic Range effect With Dynamic Range effect Icon Description Off: Do not use Dynamic Range. Smart Range+: Correct the loss of bright detail. You cannot set ISO 100. HDR: Capture 2 photos with different exposures, and then combine them to create a single image automatically. • You cannot set an ISO option higher than ISO 3200. • Dynamic Range options cannot be set at the same time as Picture Wizard options. Dynamic RangeShooting Functions 101 Shooting Functions Smart Filter lets you apply special effects to your photos. You can select various filter options to create special effects that are difficult to be achieved with normal lenses. To set Smart Filter options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →1→Smart Filter→ an option. Option Description Off No effect Vignetting Apply the retro-looking colors, high contrast, and strong vignette effect of Lomo cameras. Miniature Apply a tilt-shift effect to make the subject appear in miniature. Colored Pencil Apply a colored pencil painting effect. Watercolor Apply a watercolor painting effect. Wash drawing Apply a washed-out effect. Oil Sketch Apply an oil sketching effect. Ink Sketch Apply an ink sketching effect. Acryl Apply an acryl painting effect. Option Description Negative Apply a negative film effect. Red Desaturate all colors but red. Green Desaturate all colors but green. Blue Desaturate all colors but blue. Yellow Desaturate all colors but yellow. Smart filter options cannot be set with Picture Wizard options at the same time. Smart FilterShooting Functions 102 Shooting Functions The camera automatically sets the exposure by measuring the levels of light from the photo’s composition and the position of a subject. If the exposure set by the camera is higher or lower than you expected, you can adjust the exposure value manually. The exposure value is adjustable in ±3 increments. The camera displays the exposure warning in red for each step beyond ±3 range. To adjust the exposure value, while holding down [W], scroll the jog dial. You can also adjust the exposure value by pressing [f], and then selecting EV. You can check the exposure value by the position of the exposure level indicator. Exposure level indicator Increased exposure (brighter) Decreased exposure (darker) Exposure warning Standard exposure index -2 Original +2 Exposure compensationShooting Functions 103 Shooting Functions When you cannot achieve an appropriate exposure because of a strong color contrast, lock the exposure, and then capture a photo. To lock the exposure value, adjust the photo’s exposure, and then press the custom button. After locking the exposure, aim the lens where you desire, and then press [Shutter]. • Set a function of the custom button to AEL to lock the current exposure value. (p. 150) • This feature is not available in Manual mode. Exposure lockShooting Functions 104 Shooting Functions The functions available for video are explained below. Movie size Set the movie size. To set movie size options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Movie Size→ an option. Icon Size Recommended for 1920X1080 (60 fps) (16:9) View on a Full HDTV. (Playable only on full HDTVs capable of playback at 60 fps.) 1920X1080 (30 fps) (16:9) View on a Full HDTV. 1920X1080 (15 fps) (16:9) View on a Full HDTV. (Available only with some Smart Filter options.) 1920X810 (24 fps) (Approx. 2.35:1) View on an HDTV. 1280X720 (60 fps) (16:9) View on an HDTV. 1280X720 (30 fps) (16:9) View on an HDTV. 640X480 (30 fps) (4:3) View on a TV. 320X240 (30 fps) (4:3) Post on a website using the wireless network (30 seconds maximum). Movie quality Set the Movie quality. To set movie quality options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Movie Quality→ an option. Icon Extension Description MP4 (H.264) Normal: Record videos in normal quality. MP4 (H.264) HQ: Record videos in high quality. Video functions105 Shooting Functions > Video functions Multi Motion Set the playing speed of a video. To set playing speed options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→ Multi Motion→ an option. Icon Description x0.25: Record a video and play it at 1/4 normal speed. (Available only with 640x480 or 320x240) x0.5: Record a video and play it at 1/2 normal speed. (Available only with 1280x720 (30 fps), 640x480, or 320x240) x1: Record a video and play it at normal speed. x5: Record a video and play it at 5X normal speed. x10: Record a video and play it at 10X normal speed. x20: Record a video and play it at 20X normal speed. • If you select an option other than x1, sound will not be recorded. • The available options may differ depending on shooting conditions. Fader You can fade in or fade out a scene using the fader function on the camera without having to do it on a PC. Set the fade in option to gradually fade in at the start of the scene. Set the fade out option to gradually fade out the scene. Use the function appropriately and add dramatic effects on your videos. To set fader options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→ Fader→ an option. Icon Description Off: Fader function not used. In: Scene gradually fades in. Out: Scene gradually fades out. In-out: The fader function is applied at the start and end of the scene. When you use the fader function, it may take longer to save a file.106 Shooting Functions > Video functions Mic Level Set the mic level for the shooting conditions. To set the mic level, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Mic Level→ an option. Voice Sometimes, a muted video is more appealing than the one with sound. Turn the voice off to record a muted video. To set voice options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Voice→ an option. Wind cut When you record videos in noisy environments, unintended sounds can be recorded in videos. In particular, severe wind noise recorded in videos distracts you from enjoying your videos. Use the Wind Cut function to remove some surrounding noise in addition to wind noise. To reduce wind sound, In Shooting mode, press [m] →6→Wind Cut→ an option.Chapter 3 Playback/Editing Learn about how to play back and edit photos and videos. Refer to chapter 6 for editing files on a PC.108 Playback/Editing Learn how to view photo and video thumbnails and how to protect or delete files. If you perform no operations for a while, information and icons on the screen disappear. When you operate the camera again, they will reappear. Viewing photos 1 Press [y]. • The most recent file you captured will be displayed. 2 Press [C/F] to scroll through files. • You can also drag the image left or right to move to another file. You may not be able to edit or play back files that were captured with other cameras, due to unsupported sizes or codecs. Use a computer or another device to edit or play back these files. Viewing image thumbnails In order to search for photos and videos you want, convert to the thumbnail view. The thumbnail view displays multiple images at a time so that you can easily look through items you wish to find. You can also classify and display files by category, such as date or file type. Scroll the jog dial to the left to select the thumbnail view mode. (Scroll the jog dial to the right to return to the previous mode.) Searching and managing files109 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Viewing files by category 1 In the thumbnail view, press [m] →z→Filter→ a category. • You can also touch FILTER to select a category. * Default Option Description All* View files normally. Date View files by the date they were saved. Type View files by the file type. Location View files by the place they were saved. (Only the photos captured with an optional GPS module have the location information.) 2 Select a list to open it. 3 Select a file to view it. 4 Touch to return to the previous view. Viewing files as a folder Continuous and burst shots appear as a folder. Selecting a folder will play back all photos automatically. Deleting a folder will delete all photos in the folder. 1 In Playback mode, press [C/F] or drag the image left or right to move to a desired folder. • The camera will automatically play back photos in the folder. 2 Scroll the jog dial to the right to open the folder. • You can also touch the folder on the screen to open the folder. 3 Press [C/F] or drag the image left or right to move to another file. 4 Scroll the jog dial to the left to return to Playback mode.110 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Protecting files Protect your files from accidental deletion. 1 In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Protect→Select. 2 Press [C/F] to select a file, and then press [o]. 3 Press [f]. You cannot delete or rotate a protected file. Lock/Unlock all files Lock or unlock all files. 1 In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Protect→All. 2 Select an option. Option Description Lock Lock all files. Unlock Unlock all files. Cancel Return to the previous menu.111 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Deleting files Delete files in Playback mode and secure more space on your memory card. Protected files are not deleted. Deleting a single file You can select a single file and delete it. 1 In Playback mode, select a file, and then press [n]. 2 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes. Deleting multiple files You can select multiple files and delete them. 1 In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Delete→Select. • Alternatively, in thumbnails view, press [n], and then select files to delete. 2 Select files you want to delete by pressing [C/F], and then press [o]. • Press [o] again to cancel your selection. 3 Press [n]. 4 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes.112 Playback/Editing > Searching and managing files Deleting all files You can delete all files on the memory card at once. 1 In Playback mode, press [m]. 2 Select z→Delete→All. 3 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes.113 Playback/Editing Enlarging a photo You can enlarge photos when viewing them in Playback mode. You can also use the Trim function to extract the portion of the image displayed on the screen and save it as a new file. Magnified area Magnification (the maximum magnification may differ by resolution) Full Image Crop Scroll the jog dial to the right to enlarge a photo. (Scroll the jog dial to the left to reduce a photo.) To Do this Move magnified area Press [D/I/C/F]. Crop the enlarged image Press [f]. (saved as a new file) Return to the original image Press [o]. You can also pinch your fingers together or spread them apart on the screen to reduce or enlarge a photo. You can also double-tap an area to enlarge it quickly. Viewing a slide show You can view photos in a slide show, apply various effects to the slide show, and play background music. 1 In Playback mode, press [m]. 2 Select z→Slide Show Options. 3 Select a slide show effect option. • Skip to step 4 to start a slide show with no effects. * Default Option Description Play Mode Set whether or not to repeat the slide show. (One Play*, Repeat) Interval Set the interval between photos. (1 sec*, 3 sec, 5 sec, 10 sec) Music Set background audio. Effect • Set a scene change effect between photos. • Select Off to cancel effects. Viewing photos114 Playback/Editing > Viewing photos 4 Press [m]. 5 Select Start Slide Show. 6 View the slide show. • Press [o] to pause. • Press [o] again to resume. • Press [m] to stop the slide show and return to Playback mode. • Press [D/I] to adjust the volume level. Auto rotating With Auto Rotate on, the camera automatically rotates photos you have captured vertically so they fit the screen horizontally. To set auto rotate options, In Playback mode, press [m] →z→Auto Rotate→ an option. Creating a print order (DPOF) DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) lets you set the number of copies to be printed. The camera saves the DPOF information in the MISC folder of your memory card. If you have set DPOF information for your images, you can take the memory card to a digital printing shop for printing. You cannot set the print order of RAW format files. Photos with dimensions that are wider than the paper may be cut off on the left and right edges. Ensure that your photo dimensions are compatible with the paper you select. 1 In Playback mode, select a photo, and then press [m]. 2 Select z→DPOF. 3 Press [D/I] to set the number of copies. • To select another photo, press [C/F]. 4 Press [o] to save.115 Playback/Editing In Playback mode, you can play a video, capture an image from a video, or crop a video to save as another file. Stop Capture Video viewing controls Icon/Button Description / /[C] View previous file/Scan backward. (Each time you touch the icon or press the button while playing the video, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) / /[o] Pause or resume playback. / /[F] View next file/Scan forward. (Each time you touch the icon or press the button while playing the video, you change the scan speed in this order: 2X, 4X, 8X.) /[D/I] Adjust the volume or mute the sound. Trimming a video during playback 1 In Playback mode, scroll to a video, and then touch . 2 Press [o] or touch to start playing the video. 3 Press [o] or touch at the point where you want the trimming to begin. 4 Press [f] or touch Start Point. 5 Press [o] or touch to resume playing the video. 6 Press [o] or touch at the point where you want the trimming to end. Playing videos116 Playback/Editing > Playing videos 7 Press [f] or touch End Point. 8 Press [f] or touch Trim to trim a video. • You can adjust the scene to be cropped by dragging the handles that appear on the progress bar. 9 When the pop-up message appears, select Yes. • You cannot trim a video recorded in 3D mode. • The original video should be at least 10 seconds long. • The camera will save the edited video as a new file and leave the original video intact. Capturing an image during playback 1 While viewing a video, press [o] or touch at the point where you want to capture an image. 2 Press [f] or touch Capture. • You cannot capture an image from a video recorded in 3D mode. • The resolution of the captured image will be the same as the original video. • The captured image is saved as a new file.117 Playback/Editing Perform photo editing tasks, such as resizing, rotating, or reducing red-eye effects. Edited photos are saved as new files under different file names. Photos captured in some modes cannot be edited with the Image Edit function. To edit images, In Playback mode, scroll to a photo, and then touch → an option. • You can also edit images in Playback mode by selecting a photo, and then pressing [f] or [m] →Edit Image. • Some images may not be edited with the Image Edit function. In this case, use a supplied image editing software. • The camera will save edited photos as new files. • When you edit photos, the camera will automatically convert them to a lower resolution. Photos that you rotate or resize manually are not automatically converted to a lower resolution. • You cannot edit photos while viewing files as a folder. Open the folder and select a photo to edit each photo. Cropping a photo 1 Touch → . 2 Drag the corners of the box to adjust the size of the area. 3 Drag the box to move the location of the area. 4 Touch OK. 5 Touch to save. Editing photos118 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Rotating a photo 1 Touch → . 2 Touch an option. Rotate : Right 90° 3 Touch OK. 4 Touch to save. • You can also rotate a photo in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting z→Rotate→ a desired option. • The camera will overwrite the original file. Resizing photos Change the size of a photo and save it as a new file. 1 Touch → . 2 Touch an option. Resize : 10.1M 3:2 3 Touch OK. 4 Touch to save. Available resize options differ depending on the original size of the photo.119 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Adjusting your photos You can correct captured photos by adjusting the brightness, contrast, or saturation. 1 Touch . 2 Touch an adjusting option. Icon Description Original (Reset to the original image) Auto adjustment Brightness Contrast Saturation RGB adjustment Color Temperature Exposure Hue 3 Press [C/F] to adjust the option. • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the option. • If you selected , skip to step 4. 4 Touch OK. 5 Touch to save.120 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Retouching faces 1 Touch → . 2 Press [C/F] to adjust the option. • You can also drag the slider or touch +/- to adjust the option. • As the number increases, the skin tone becomes brighter and smoother. 3 Touch OK. • To cancel correction, touch . 4 Touch to save. Reducing red-eye 1 Touch → . 2 Touch OK. • To cancel correction, touch . 3 Touch to save.121 Playback/Editing > Editing photos Applying Smart Filter effects Apply special effects to your photos. 1 Touch , and then touch an option. Smart Filter : Vignetting Option Description Original No effect Vignetting Apply the retro-looking colors, high contrast, and strong vignette effect of Lomo cameras. Miniature Apply a tilt-shift effect to make the subject appear in miniature. Colored Pencil Apply a colored pencil painting effect. Watercolor Apply a watercolor painting effect. Wash drawing Apply a washed-out effect. Option Description Oil Sketch Apply an oil sketching effect. Ink Sketch Apply an ink sketching effect. Acryl Apply an acryl painting effect. Negative Apply a negative film effect. Red Desaturate all colors but red. Green Desaturate all colors but green. Blue Desaturate all colors but blue. Yellow Desaturate all colors but yellow. 2 Touch OK. 3 Touch to save.Chapter 4 Wireless network Learn how to connect to wireless local area networks (WLANs) and use functions.123 Wireless network Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Learn to connect via an access point (AP) when you are in a range of a WLAN. You can also configure network settings. Connecting to a WLAN 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select , , ,or . 3 Press [m], and then select Wi-Fi Setting. • In some modes, follow the on-screen instructions until the Wi-Fi Setting screen appears. • The camera automatically searches for available AP devices. 4 Select an AP. Back Refresh Samsung1 Samsung2 Samsung3 Samsung4 • Select Refresh to refresh connectable APs. • Select Add wireless network to add an AP manually. Your AP name must be in English to add the AP manually. Icon/Option Description Ad hoc AP Secured AP WPS AP Signal strength Press [F] or touch to open network setting options. • When you select a secured AP, a pop-up window appears. Enter the required passwords to connect to the WLAN. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • When a login page appears, refer to "Using the login browser". (p. 125) • When you select an unsecured AP, the camera will connect to the WLAN. • If you select a WPS profile supported AP, select →WPS PIN connection, and then enter a PIN on the AP device. You can also connect to a WPS profile supported AP by selecting →WPS button connection on the camera, and then pushing the WPS button on the AP device. • The same AP may be listed twice, with different frequencies, because your camera supports the dual band function.124 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Setting network options 1 In the Wi-Fi Setting screen, move to an AP, and then press [F] or touch . 2 Select each option, and then enter the required information. Option Description Network Password Enter the network password. IP Setting Set the IP address automatically or manually. Manually setting the IP address 1 In the Wi-Fi Setting screen, move to an AP, and then press [F] or touch . 2 Select IP Setting→Manual. 3 Select each option, and then enter the required information. Option Description IP Enter the static IP address. Subnet Mask Enter the subnet mask. Gateway Enter the gateway. DNS Server Enter the DNS address.125 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Using the login browser You can enter your login information via the login browser when connecting to some APs, sharing sites, or cloud servers. Icon Description Close the login browser. Move to the previous page. Move to the next page. Stop loading the page. Reload the page. • You may not be able to select some items depending on the page you connected to. This does not indicate a malfunction. • The login browser may not close automatically after you log into some pages. If this occurs, close the login browser by touching , and then proceed with the desired operation. • It may take longer to load the login page due to the page size or network speed. If this occurs, wait until the login information input window appears.126 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Network connection tips • You must insert a memory card to use the Wi-Fi features. • The quality of the network connection will be determined by the AP. • The further the distance between your camera and the AP, the longer it will take to connect to the network. • If a nearby device is using the same radio frequency signal as your camera, it may interrupt your connection. • If your AP name is not in English, the camera may not be able to locate the device or the name may appear incorrectly. • For network settings or a password, contact your network administrator or network service provider. • If a WLAN requires authentication from the service provider, you may not be able to connect to it. To connect the WLAN, contact your network service provider. • Depending on the encryption type, the number of digits in the password may differ. • A WLAN connection may not be possible in all surroundings. • The camera may display a WLAN enabled printer on the AP List. You cannot connect to a network via a printer. • You cannot connect your camera to a network and a TV simultaneously. • Connecting to a network may incur additional charges. Costs will vary based on the conditions of your contract. • If you cannot connect to a WLAN, try another AP from the available AP list. • A login page may appear when you select free WLANs provided by some network service providers. Enter your ID and password to connect to the WLAN. For information about registering or the service, contact the network service providers. • Be cautious when you enter personal information for an AP connection. Do not enter any payment or credit card information on your camera. The manufacturer is not liable for any problem caused by entering such information. • Available network connections may differ by country. • The WLAN feature of your camera must comply with radio transmission laws in your region. To ensure compliance, use the WLAN feature only in the country where you purchased the camera. • The process for adjusting network settings may differ, depending on network conditions. • Do not access a network that you are not authorized to use. • Before you connect to a network, ensure your battery is fully charged. • You cannot upload or send files captured in some modes. • Files that you transfer to another device may not be supported by the device. In this case, use a computer to play back the files.127 Wireless network > Connecting to a WLAN and configuring network settings Entering text Learn how to enter text. The icons in the table let you move the cursor, change the case, etc. Touch a key to enter it. Icon Description Move the cursor. Stop entering text and return to the previous page. Change case. Switch between Symbol/Number mode and the normal mode. Change the input language. Enter a space. Save the displayed text. Delete the last letter. • You can use only the English alphabets in some modes, regardless of the display language. • You can enter up to 64 characters. • The screen may differ depending on the input mode. • Touch and hold a key to enter the character at the upper right corner of the key.128 Wireless network Saving files to a smart phone automatically The camera connects to a smart phone that supports the AutoShare feature via a WLAN. When you capture a photo with your camera, the photo is saved to the smart phone automatically. • The AutoShare feature is supported by Galaxy series smart phones or Galaxy Tab models with the Android 2.3 OS or higher or iOS devices with the iOS 6.0 or higher. Before using this feature, check the device’s firmware and update it if needed. • You should install Samsung SMART CAMERA App on your phone or device before using this feature. You can download the application from Samsung Apps, the Google Play Store, or the Apple App Store. Samsung SMART CAMERA App is compatible with Samsung camera models manufactured in 2013 or later. • To install and launch Samsung SMART CAMERA App on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the NFC feature and place the smart phone near an NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. This feature is supported by smart phones running Android OS 2.3 or higher. This feature is not available for iOS devices. • You must insert a memory card to use this feature. • If you set this function, the setting is maintained even when you change the Shooting mode. • This feature may not be supported in some modes or may not be available with some shooting options. 1 On the camera, in Shooting mode, press [m]. 2 On the camera, select 1→AutoShare→On. • If the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. 3 On the smart phone, turn on Samsung SMART CAMERA App. • For iOS devices, turn on the Wi-Fi feature before turning on the application. • To start the application automatically on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the function and place the smart phone near the NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. Verify that the smart phone is connected to your camera, and then skip to step 6. 4 Select the camera from the list and connect the smart phone to the camera. • The smart phone can connect to only one camera at a time. 5 On the camera, allow the smart phone to connect to your camera. • If the smart phone has been connected to your camera before, it is connected automatically. • An icon that shows the connection status ( ) will appear on the camera’s screen. 6 On the camera, capture a photo. • The captured photo is saved to the camera, and then transferred to the smart phone. • If you recorded a video, it is saved only to the camera.129 Wireless network The camera connects to a smart phone that supports the MobileLink feature via a WLAN. You can easily send photos or videos to your smart phone. • The MobileLink feature is supported by Galaxy series smart phones or Galaxy Tab models with the Android 2.3 OS or higher or iOS devices with the iOS 6.0 or higher. Before using this feature, check the device’s firmware and update it if needed. • You should install Samsung SMART CAMERA App on your phone or device before using this feature. You can download the application from Samsung Apps, the Google Play Store, or the Apple App Store. Samsung SMART CAMERA App is compatible with Samsung camera models manufactured in 2013 or later. • To install and launch Samsung SMART CAMERA App on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the NFC feature and place the smart phone near an NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. This feature is supported by smart phones running Android OS 2.3 or higher. This feature is not available for iOS devices. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • If you select files from the smart phone, you can view up to 1,000 recent files and send up to 150 files at a time. If you select files from the camera, you can view files that were selected from the camera. The maximum number of files that can be sent varies depending on the storage space of the smart phone. • When you send Full HD videos using MobileLink feature, you may not be able to play back files on some devices. • When using this feature on an iOS device, the device may lose its Wi-Fi connection. • You cannot send RAW files. 1 On the camera, rotate the mode dial to B. 2 On the camera, select . • If the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. 3 On the camera, select a sending option. • If you select Select Files from Smartphone, you can use your smart phone to view and share files stored on the camera. • If you select Select Files from Camera, you can select files to send from the camera. 4 On the smart phone, turn on Samsung SMART CAMERA App. • For iOS devices, turn on the Wi-Fi feature before turning on the application. • To start the application automatically on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the function and place the smart phone near the NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. Verify that the smart phone is connected to your camera, and then skip to step 7. Sending photos or videos to a smart phone130 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos to a smart phone 5 Select the camera from the list and connect the smart phone to the camera. • The smart phone can connect to only one camera at a time. 6 On the camera, allow the smart phone to connect to your camera. • If the smart phone has been connected to your camera before, it is connected automatically. 7 On the smart phone or camera, select files to transfer from the camera. 8 On the smart phone, touch the copy button or on the camera, select Send. • The camera will send the files.131 Wireless network The camera connects to a smart phone that supports the Remote Viewfinder feature via a WLAN. Use the smart phone as a remote shutter release with the Remote Viewfinder feature. The captured photo will display on the smart phone. • The Remote Viewfinder feature is supported by Galaxy series smart phones or Galaxy Tab models with the Android 2.3 OS or higher or iOS devices with the iOS 6.0 or higher. Before using this feature, check the device’s firmware and update it if needed. • You should install Samsung SMART CAMERA App on your phone or device before using this feature. You can download the application from Samsung Apps, the Google Play Store, or the Apple App Store. Samsung SMART CAMERA App is compatible with Samsung camera models manufactured in 2013 or later. • To install and launch Samsung SMART CAMERA App on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the NFC feature and place the smart phone near an NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. This feature is supported by smart phones running Android OS 2.3 or higher. This feature is not available for iOS devices. • This function is not available in 3D mode. 1 On the camera, rotate the mode dial to B. 2 On the camera, select . • If the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. 3 On the smart phone, turn on Samsung SMART CAMERA App. • For iOS devices, turn on the Wi-Fi feature before turning on the application. • To start the application automatically on an NFC-enabled smart phone, turn on the function and place the smart phone near the NFC tag (p. 30) on the camera. Verify that the smart phone is connected to your camera, and then skip to step 6. 4 Select the camera from the list and connect the smart phone to the camera. • The smart phone can connect to only one camera at a time. Using a smart phone as a remote shutter release132 Wireless network > Using a smart phone as a remote shutter release 5 On the camera, allow the smart phone to connect to your camera. • If the smart phone has been connected to your camera before, it is connected automatically. 6 On the smart phone, set the following shooting options. Icon Description Flash option Timer option Photo size Saving location • While using this feature, some buttons are not available on your camera. • The zoom button and the shutter button on your smart phone will not function when using this feature. • Remote Viewfinder mode supports the and photo sizes only. 7 On the smart phone, touch and hold to focus. • The focus is automatically set to Multi AF. 8 Release to capture the photo. • Photos saved to the smart phone will be resized to 1616X1080 when shooting in and to 1920X1080 when shooting in resolution. • When you use this feature, the ideal distance between the camera and the smart phone may vary, depending on your surroundings. • The smart phone must be within 7 m of the camera to use this feature. • It will take some time to capture the photo after you release on the smart phone. • The Remote Viewfinder function will deactivate when: - there is an incoming call on the smart phone - either the camera or the smart phone turns off - the memory is full - device loses its connection to the WLAN - the Wi-Fi connection is poor or unstable - you perform no operations for approximately 5 minutes while connected133 Wireless network Using Auto Backup to send photos or videos You can send photos or videos that you captured with the camera to a PC wirelessly. Installing the program for Auto Backup on your PC 1 Install i-Launcher on the PC. (p. 163) 2 Connect the camera to the PC with the USB cable. 3 When the Auto Backup program icon appears, click it. • The Auto Backup program is installed on the PC and the information about the PC will be stored to the camera. Follow the on-screen instructions to complete the installation. • You can also save the information about the PC to the camera by connecting the PC and the camera via Wi-Fi. 4 Remove the USB cable. Before installing the program, ensure that the PC is connected to a network. If no internet connection is available, you must install the program from the provided CD. Sending photos or videos to a PC 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • If the the pop-up message that prompts you to download the application appears, select Next. • You must configure the backup PC information to use the Auto Backup feature. For more details, refer to "Installing the program for Auto Backup on your PC". (p. 133) If the Auto Backup program is installed on your PC, save the PC information via USB cable or Wi-Fi connection. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123)134 Wireless network > Using Auto Backup to send photos or videos 3 Select a backup PC. • If you have performed a backup before, move to step 4. 4 Select OK. • To cancel sending, select Cancel. • You cannot select individual files to backup. This function backs up only new files on the camera. • The backup's progress will be shown on the PC monitor. • When the transfer is completed, the camera will turn off automatically in approximately 30 seconds. Select Cancel to return to the previous screen and prevent the camera from turning off automatically. • To turn off your PC automatically after the transfer is complete, select Shut down PC after backup. • To change the backup PC, select . • When you connect the camera to the WLAN, select the AP that is connected to the PC. • The camera will search for available access points even if you are connecting to the same access point again. • If you turn off the camera or remove the battery while sending files, the file transfer will be interrupted. • While you are using this feature, the shutter control is disabled on your camera. • You can connect only one camera to the PC at a time for sending files. • The backup may be canceled due to network conditions. • Photos or videos can be sent to a PC one time only. Files cannot be sent again even if you reconnect your camera to another PC. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You must turn off Windows Firewall and any other firewalls before using this feature. • You can send up to 1,000 recent files. • On the PC software, the server name must be entered in the Latin alphabet and can contain no more than 48 characters. • When multiple file types are created at once, only the image files (JPG) will be sent to the PC with this feature.135 Wireless network 5 Select the Name box, enter your name, and then touch . Sender Setting Name Save Email Reset 6 Select the Email box, enter your email address, and then touch . 7 Select Save to save your changes. • To delete your information, select Reset. You can change settings in the email menu and send photos or videos stored on the camera via email. Changing email settings In the email menu, you can change settings for storing your information. You can also set or change the email password. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) Storing your information 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Press [m]. 4 Select Sender Setting. Sending photos or videos via email136 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos via email Setting an email password 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Press [m]. 4 Select Setting Password→On. • To deactivate the password, select Off. 5 When the pop-up appears, select OK. 6 Enter a 4-digit password. 7 Enter the password again. 8 When the pop-up appears, select OK. If you lost your password, you can reset it by selecting RESET on the password setting screen. When you reset the information, the previously saved user’s setting information, email address, and recently sent email list will be deleted.137 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos via email Changing the email password 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Press [m]. 4 Select Change Password. 5 Enter your current 4-digit password. 6 Enter a new 4-digit password. 7 Enter the new password again. 8 When the pop-up appears, select OK. Sending photos or videos via email You can send photos or videos stored on the camera via email. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 3 Select the Sender box, enter your email address, and then touch . • If you have previously saved your information, it will be inserted automatically. (p. 135) • To use an address from the list of previous senders, select → an address.138 Wireless network > Sending photos or videos via email 4 Select the Receiver box, enter an email address, and then touch . • To use an address from the list of previous recipients, select → an address. • Select to add additional recipients. You can input up to 30 recipients. • Select to delete an address from the list. 5 Select Next. 6 Select files to send. • You can select up to 20 files. The total size must be 7 MB or less. 7 Select Next. 8 Select the comment box, enter your comments, and then touch . 9 Select Send. • The camera will send the email. • Even if a photo appears to have transferred successfully, errors with the recipient’s email account may cause the photo to be rejected or recognized as spam. • You may not be able to send an email if no network connection is available or if your email account settings are incorrect. • You cannot send an email if the file size exceeds the limit. The maximum photo resolution you can send is 2M and the longest video you can upload is a video recorded using . If the selected photo resolution is higher than 2M, it will be automatically resized to a lower resolution. • If you cannot send an email because of firewall or user authentication settings, contact your network administrator or network service provider. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You can also send an email in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting Share(Wi-Fi)→Email.139 Wireless network Upload your photos or videos to file sharing websites. Available websites will be displayed on your camera. To upload files to some websites, you must visit the website and register before connecting your camera. Accessing a website 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select . 3 Select a website. • If the pop-up message that prompts you to create an account appears, select OK. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) 4 Enter your ID and password to log in. • For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • If you connected to SkyDrive, refer to "Using the login browser". (p. 125) • To select an ID from the list, select → an ID. • If you have previously logged in to the website, you may be logged in automatically. You must have an existing account on the file sharing website to use this feature. Using photo or video sharing websites140 Wireless network > Using photo or video sharing websites Uploading photos or videos 1 Access the website with your camera. 2 Select files to upload. • You can select up to 20 files. The total size must be 10 MB or less. (On some websites, the total size or number of files may vary.) 3 Select Upload. • On some websites, you can enter your comments by selecting the comment box. For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • You can set an upload folder for Facebook by pressing [m], and then selecting Upload Folder (Facebook) on the website's list screen. • You cannot upload files if the file size exceeds the limit. The maximum photo resolution you can upload is 2M, and the longest video you can upload is a video recorded using . If the selected photo resolution is higher than 2M, it will be automatically resized to a lower resolution. (On some websites, the maximum photo resolution may vary.) • The method of uploading photos or videos may differ depending on the selected website. • If you cannot access a website because of firewall or user authentication settings, contact your network administrator or network service provider. • Uploaded photos or videos may be automatically titled with the date they were captured. • The speed of your internet connection may affect how quickly photos upload or web pages open. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You can also upload photos or videos to file sharing websites in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting Share(Wi-Fi)→ a desired website. • You cannot upload videos to some websites. • When you upload photos to SkyDrive, they will be resized to 2M while maintaining their aspect ratios.141 Wireless network Using AllShare Play to send files You can upload files from your camera to AllShare Play online storage or view files on an AllShare Play device connected to the same AP. Uploading photos to online storage 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select → Web storage. • If the guide message appears, select OK. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) • To change the size for uploaded photos, press [m], and then select Upload Image Size. • If you have registered more than one web storage, you can select from the list by pressing [m], and then selecting Change Web storage. 3 Enter your ID and password, and then select Login→OK. • For information about entering text, refer to "Entering text". (p. 127) • To select an ID from the list, select → an ID. • If you have previously logged in to the website, you may be logged in automatically. To use this feature, you must create an AllShare Play account and an account with an affiliated online storage service using your PC. After finishing creating accounts, add your online storage account to AllShare Play. 4 Select files you want to upload, and then select Upload. • If you have registered more than one web storage, select a web storage first. • You cannot upload video files to AllShare Play online storage. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • You can upload up to 20 files. • You can also upload photos in Playback mode by pressing [m], and then selecting Share(Wi-Fi)→AllShare Play.142 Wireless network > Using AllShare Play to send files Viewing photos or videos on devices that support AllShare Play 1 Rotate the mode dial to B. 2 Select → Nearby devices. • If the guide message appears, select Yes. • The camera will automatically attempt to connect to a WLAN via the most recently connected AP device. • If the camera has not previously been connected to a WLAN, it will search for available AP devices. (p. 123) • You can set to allow only selected devices or all devices to connect by pressing [m], and then selecting DLNA Access Control on the screen. • A sharing file list is created. Wait until other devices can find your camera. 3 Connect the AllShare Play device to a network, and then turn on the AllShare Play feature. • Refer to your device's user manual for more information. 4 On the camera, allow the AllShare Play device to connect to your camera. 5 On the AllShare Play device, select a camera to connect. 6 On the AllShare Play device, browse the shared photos or videos. • For information about searching for the camera and browsing the photos or videos on the AllShare Play device, refer to the device's user manual. • Videos may not play smoothly depending on the type of AllShare Play device or the network condition. For smooth playback, use a 5 Ghz dual-band AP device. AP S A camera is connected to a TV that supports AllShare Play via WLAN.143 Wireless network > Using AllShare Play to send files • You can share up to 1,000 recent files. • On an AllShare Play device, you can view only photos or videos captured with your camera. • The range of the wireless connection between your camera and an AllShare Play device may vary depending on the specifications of the AP. • If the camera is connected to 2 AllShare Play devices, playback may be slower. • Photos or videos will be shared in their original sizes. • You can use this feature only with devices that support AllShare Play. • Shared photos or videos will not be stored on the AllShare Play device, but they can be stored in the camera to meet the device's specifications. • Transferring photos or videos to the AllShare Play device may take some time depending on the network connection, the number of files to be shared, or the sizes of the files. • If you power off the camera abnormally while viewing photos or videos on an AllShare Play device (for example, by removing the battery), the device considers the camera to still be connected. • The order of photos or videos on the camera may be different than on the AllShare Play device. • Depending on the number of photos or videos you want to share, it may take some time to load your photos or videos and complete the initial set-up process. • While viewing photos or videos on the AllShare Play device, continuously using the device's remote or performing additional operations on the device may prevent this feature from working properly. • If you reorder or sort files on the camera while viewing them on an AllShare Play device, you must repeat the initial set-up process to update the list of files on the device. • When there are no files in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • We recommend you use a network cable to connect your AllShare Play device to your AP. This will minimize any video ‘Stuttering’ you may experience when streaming content. • To view files on an AllShare Play device using the Nearby devices feature, enable multicast mode on your AP. • 1920X1080 (60 fps) videos can be played only on full HDTVs capable of playback at 60 fps. • You can view 3D files only on 3D-compatible TVs or monitors.144 Wireless network Sending photos using Wi-Fi Direct When the camera connects via a WLAN to a device that supports the Wi-Fi Direct function, you can send photos to the device. This feature may not be supported on some devices. 1 On the device, turn on the Wi-Fi Direct option. 2 On the camera, in Playback mode, scroll to a photo. 3 Press [m], and then select Share(Wi-Fi)→Wi-Fi Direct. • When in the single image view, you can send only one photo at a time. • When in thumbnails view, you can select multiple photos. Select Upload when you are finished selecting photos. 4 Select the device from the camera’s list of Wi-Fi Direct devices. • Ensure that the device's Wi-Fi Direct option is turned on. • You can also select your camera from the device's list of Wi-Fi Direct devices. 5 On the device, allow the camera to connect to the device. • The photo will be sent to the device. • You can send up to 20 files at a time. • When there are no photos in the camera memory, you cannot use this feature. • If you cannot connect to a Wi-Fi Direct device, update the device with the latest firmware. This feature may not be supported on some devices.Chapter 5 Camera settings menu Learn about the user settings and general settings menu. You can adjust the settings to better suit your needs and preferences.146 Camera settings menu You can set the user environment with these settings. To set user options, In Shooting mode, press [m] →5→ an option. Available items and the order of them may differ depending on shooting conditions. ISO Customizing ISO Step You can set the size for the ISO sensitivity by either 1/3 or 1 step. Auto ISO Range You can set the maximum ISO value under which each EV step is chosen when you set the ISO to Auto. * Default Option Value 1/3 Step ISO 125, ISO 160, ISO 200, ISO 250, ISO 320, ISO 400, ISO 500, ISO 640, ISO 800, ISO 1000, ISO 1250, ISO 1600, ISO 2000, ISO 2500, ISO 3200* 1 Step ISO 200, ISO 400, ISO 800, ISO 1600, ISO 3200* Noise Reduction Use the Noise Reduction to reduce the visual noise in photos. * Default Option Description High ISO NR This function reduces noise that may occur when you set a high ISO sensitivity. (Off, High, Normal*, Low) Long Term NR This function reduces noise when you set the camera for a long exposure. (Off, On*) User settings147 Camera settings menu > User settings Bracket Set You can set up the options for AE Bracket, WB Bracket, and P Wiz Bracket. Option Description AE Bracket Set Set the exposure interval. (-/+0.3 EV*, -/+0.7 EV, -/+1 EV, -/+1.3 EV, -/+1.7 EV, -/+2 EV, -/+2.3 EV, -/+2.7 EV, -/+3 EV) WB Bracket Set Adjust the White Balance interval range of the 3 bracketed photos. (AB-/+3*, AB-/+2, AB-/+1, MG-/+3, MG-/+2, MG-/+1) For example, AB-/+3 adjusts the Amber value plus or minus three steps. MG-/+3 adjusts the Magenta value the same amount. P Wiz Bracket Set Select 3 Picture Wizard settings the camera uses to capture the 3 bracketed photos. DMF (Direct Manual Focus) You can adjust the focus manually by rotating the focus ring after achieving the focus by half-pressing [Shutter]. This feature may not be available with some lenses.148 Camera settings menu > User settings Color space The color space option allows you to select methods for representing colors. Digital imaging devices such as digital cameras, monitors, and printers have their own methods for representing colors, which are called color spaces. Option Description sRGB sRGB (Standard RGB) is an international specification to define the color space created by IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission). It is widely used for creating colors on PC monitors and is also the standard color space for Exif. sRGB is recommended for regular images and images you intend to publish on the Internet. Adobe RGB Adobe RGB is used for commercial printing and has a larger color range than sRGB. Its wider range of colors helps you to easily edit photos on a computer. Note that individual programs are generally compatible with a limited number of color spaces. Adobe RGB sRGB When the color space is set to Adobe RGB, photos will be saved as “_SAMXXXX.JPG”.149 Camera settings menu > User settings Distortion Correct You can correct lens distortion that might occur from lenses. This feature may not be available with some lenses. Touch Operation Set to enable touch operation in Shooting mode. Option Description On Use touch operations in Shooting mode. Off Do not use touch operations in Shooting mode. (You can use touch operations in other situations.) iFn Customizing You can select options that can be adjusted when you press [i-Function] on an i-Function lens. Option Description Aperture Set to adjust the aperture value. Shutter Speed Set to adjust the shutter speed. EV Set to adjust the exposure value. ISO Set to adjust ISO sensitivity. White Balance Set to adjust the White Balance. Z Set to adjust the zoom ratio. User Display You can add or remove shooting information from the display. 1 2 3 London No. Description 1 Date & Time Set to display the date and time. 2 Icons Set to display icons on the right in Shooting mode.150 Camera settings menu > User settings No. Description 3 Histogram Set the histogram on the display on or off. About histogram A histogram is a graph that shows the brightness distribution of a photo. A histogram inclined to the left indicates a dark photo. A histogram inclined to the right indicates a bright photo. The height of the graph is related to color information. The graph gets higher if a specific color is more common. Insufficient exposure Balanced exposure Excessive exposure Key Mapping You can change the function assigned to the Custom button or DIRECT LINK button. * Default Button Function Custom Set a function of the Custom button. • Optical Preview*: Execute the Depth of Field Preview function for the current aperture value. (p. 24) • One Touch WB (White Balance): Execute the Custom White Balance function. • One Touch RAW +: Save a file in the RAW+JPEG format. To save a file in JPEG format, press the button again. • Reset: Reset some settings. • AEL: Execute the auto exposure lock function. • AEL Hold: Keep executing the auto exposure lock function after shooting. DIRECT LINK Set a function of the DIRECT LINK button. (AutoShare*, MobileLink, Remote Viewfinder, Auto Backup, Email, SNS & Cloud, AllShare Play)151 Camera settings menu > User settings Grid Line Select a guide to help you compose a scene. (Off*, 3 X 3, 2 X 2, Cross, Diagonal) AF Lamp When shooting in dark places, turn the AF lamp on in order to have a better auto focus. The Auto Focus functions more accurately in dark places when the AF lamp is on.152 Camera settings menu Learn to configure your camera's settings. To set Setting options, In Shooting or Playback mode, press [m] →q→ an option. * Default Item Description Sound • System Volume: Set the sound volume or turn all sound off entirely. (Off, Low, Medium*, High) Even if the system volume is turned off, the camera emits the sound while playing a video or a slide show. • AF Sound: Set the sound the camera emits when you half-press the shutter button on or off. (Off, On*) • Button Sound: Set the sound the camera emits when you press the buttons or touch the screen on or off. (Off, On*) Quick View Set the Quick View time length – the amount of time the camera displays a photo immediately after you capture it. (Off, 1 sec*, 3 sec, 5 sec, Hold) * Default Item Description Display Adjust Adjust the display brightness, auto brightness setting, display color, or level gauge. • Display Brightness: You can adjust the display brightness manually. • Auto Brightness: Turn auto brightness on or off. (Off, On*) • Display Color: You can adjust the display color manually. • Horizontal Calibration: Calibrate the level gauge. If the level gauge is not level, position the camera on the level surface, and then follow the on-screen instructions. • You cannot access the Horizontal Calibration option in Playback mode. • You cannot calibrate the level gauge in portrait orientation. Auto Display Off Set the display off time. The display turns off if you do not use the camera for the time you set. (Off, 30 sec*, 1 min, 3 min, 5 min, 10 min) Setting153 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description Power Save Set power shut off time. The camera shuts off if you do not use it for the time you set. (30 sec, 1 min*, 3 min, 5 min, 10 min, 30 min) • The camera retains the power-off time setting even if you replace the battery. • Power Save may not work if the camera is connected to a computer or a TV or playing a slide show or a movie. Help Guide Display • Mode Help Guide: Set to display help text about the selected mode when changing shooting modes. (Off, On*) • Function Help Guide: Set to display help text about menus and functions. (Off, On*) Press [n] to hide the help text. Language Set a language the camera shows on the display. Date & Time Set date, time, date format, time zone and whether to imprint the date on photos. (Time Zone, Date & Time, Date Type, Time Type, Imprint) • The date appears on the lower right side of the photo. • When you print a photo, some printers may not print the date appropriately. * Default Item Description Video Out Set the video signal output appropriate for your country when connecting the camera to an external video device such as a monitor or HDTV. • NTSC: USA, Canada, Japan, Korea, Taiwan, Mexico, etc • PAL (Supports only PAL B, D, G, H, or I): Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, England, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, Norway, etc Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC) When you connect the camera to an HDTV that supports Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC), you can control the play function of the camera with the TV remote control. • Off: You cannot control the play function of camera with the TV remote control. • On*: You can control the play function of camera with the TV remote control. HDMI Output When you connect the camera to an HDTV with an HDMI cable, you can change the resolution of the image. • NTSC: Auto*, 1080p, 720p, 480p, 576p (activates only when PAL is selected) If the connected HDTV does not support the resolution you select, the camera sets the resolution one level lower.154 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description 3D HDMI Output Select an option for playing files on a 3D TV. • Side by Side*: Displays two images next to each other. • Frame Packing: Displays the images for the left and right eye alternately in frames. File Name Set the method of creating file names. • Standard*: SAM_XXXX.JPG (sRGB)/ _SAMXXXX.JPG (Adobe RGB) • Date: - sRGB files - MMDDXXXX.JPG. For example, for a photo captured on Jan. 01, the file name would be 0101XXXX.jpg. - Adobe RGB files - _MDDXXXX.JPG for the months Jan through Sept. For the months Oct through Dec, the month number is replaced by the letters A (Oct.), B (Nov.) and C (Dec.). For example, for a photo captured on Feb. 03, the file name would be _203XXXX.jpg. For a photo captured on Oct. 05, the file name would be _A05XXXX.jpg. * Default Item Description File Number Set the method of numbering files and folders. • Reset: After using the reset function, the next file name is started at 0001. • Series*: New file numbers continue the existing number sequence, even if you have installed a new memory card, formatted the card, or deleted all photos. • The first folder name is 100PHOTO, if you have selected the sRGB color space and Standard file naming, the first file name is SAM_0001. • File name numbers are increased by 1 from SAM_0001 to SAM_9999. • Folder numbers are increased by 1 from 100PHOTO to 999PHOTO. • The maximum number of files that can be saved in one folder is 9,999. • File numbers are assigned according to DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) specifications. • If you change a file name (for example, on a computer), the camera will not be able to play the file. Folder Type Set the type of folder. • Standard*: XXXPHOTO • Date: XXX_MMDD155 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description Format Format the memory card. Formatting deletes all existing files including protected files. (Yes, No) Errors can occur if you use a memory card formatted by another brand of camera, a memory card reader, or a computer. Please format memory cards in the camera before using them to capture photos. Device Information View the firmware version of the body and the lens, Mac address, and network certification number, or update the firmware. • Firmware Update: Update the firmware of the camera body or lens. (Body Firmware, Lens Firmware) • You can download firmware upgrades from www.samsung.com. • You cannot run a firmware upgrade without a fully charged battery. Recharge the battery fully before running a firmware upgrade. • If you update the firmware, user settings and values will be reset. (Date, time, language, and video out will not change.) • Do not turn the camera off while the update is in progress. * Default Item Description Dual-band Mobile AP Set a frequency for using the camera as an AP for the AutoShare, MobileLink, or Remote Viewfinder feature. (5 GHz, 2.4 GHz*) If you use the camera in a country other than the one where it was purchased, the 5 GHz Wi-Fi feature may not function properly, due to differences in radio frequencies. In this case, use the 2.4 GHz Wi-Fi feature instead. GPS • Geotagging: Set to capture photos with location information using the Global Positioning System (GPS). Location information is added to the Exif data associated with the photo. (Off, On*) • GPS Valid Time Settings: Set the time to use the last location information when the camera fails to receive GPS signals. If the camera fails to receive GPS signals after the specified time, the location information will not be recorded onto the photos. (15 sec*, 30 sec, 1 min, 3 min, 10 min, 30 min) • Location Display: Set to display the location information on the screen in Shooting mode. The location information will appear in Korean only when you are in Korea and the display language is set to Korean. When another language is set, the location information will appear in English. (Off, On*) • GPS Reset: Set to search for GPS satellites closest to your current position. (Yes, No) To use the GPS function, you must purchase an optional GPS device.156 Camera settings menu > Setting * Default Item Description Sensor Cleaning • Sensor Cleaning: Remove dust from the sensor. • Start-Up Action: When on, the camera performs sensor cleaning each time you turn it on. (Off*, On) As this product uses interchangeable lenses, the sensor can get dust on it when you change lenses. This can lead to dust particles appearing in the photos you capture. It is recommended not to change lenses when you are in a particularly dusty area. Also, make sure to attach the lens cap to the lens when not using it. Reset Reset the setup menu and shooting options to the factory defaults. (Date, time, language, and video output settings do not change.) (Yes, No) Open Source Licenses View open source licenses.Chapter 6 Connecting to external devices Make full use of the camera by connecting it to external devices such as a computer, HDTV or 3D TV.158 Connecting to external devices Play back photos or videos by connecting your camera to an HDTV (3D TV) using an optional HDMI cable. Viewing files on an HDTV 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [m] →q→ HDMI Output→ an option. (p. 153) 2 Turn off your camera and HDTV. 3 Connect your camera to your HDTV with the optional HDMI cable. 4 Turn on your HDTV, and then select the HDMI video source. 5 Turn on the camera. • The camera automatically enters into Playback mode when you connect it to an HDTV. 6 View photos or play videos using the camera buttons. • When using the HDMI cable, you can connect the camera to an HDTV using the Anynet+(CEC) method. • The Anynet+(CEC) functions allow you to control connected devices using the TV remote control. • If the HDTV supports Anynet+(CEC), the TV turns on automatically when used in conjunction with the camera. This feature may not be available on some HDTVs. • When connected to an HDTV by an HDMI cable, the camera cannot capture a photo or video. • When connected to an HDTV, some of the camera’s playback functions may not be available. • The length of time after which the camera and an HDTV are connected may vary depending on the memory card that you are using. As the main feature of a memory card is to increase the transfer speed, it is not necessarily true to say that a memory card with a faster transfer speed is also fast in using the HDMI function. • 1920X1080 (60 fps) videos can be played only on full HDTVs capable of playback at 60 fps. Viewing files on an HDTV or 3D TV159 Connecting to external devices > Viewing files on an HDTV or 3D TV Viewing files on a 3D TV You can view photos or videos captured in 3D mode or with the 3D Panorama option in Smart mode on a 3D TV. 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [m] →q→ HDMI Output→ an option. (p. 153) 2 Select 3D HDMI Output→ an option. (p. 154) 3 Turn off your camera and 3D TV. 4 Connect your camera to your 3D TV with the optional HDMI cable. 5 Turn on your 3D TV, and then select the HDMI video source. 6 Turn on your camera. • The camera automatically enters into Playback mode when you connect it to a 3D TV. 7 Move to a 3D file, and then press [I] to switch to 3D mode. • Press [I] again to switch to 2D Mode. 8 Turn on your TV's 3D function. • Refer to your TV's user manual for more details. 9 View 3D photos or play 3D videos using the camera buttons. • You cannot view an MPO file in 3D effect on TVs that do not support the file format. • Use proper 3D glasses when you view an MPO file or a 3D video file on a 3D TV. • Capturing photos in 3D Panorama mode may result in a less pronounced 3D effect than those captured in 3D mode with a 3D lens. Do not view the 3D photos or videos captured by your camera on a 3D TV or 3D monitor for an extended period of time. It may cause unpleasant symptoms, such as eyestrain, fatigue, nausea, and more.160 Connecting to external devices Transfer files on a memory card to your computer by connecting the camera to the PC. Transferring files to your Windows OS computer Connecting the camera as a removable disk You can connect the camera to your computer as a removable disk. 1 Turn off the camera. 2 Connect the camera to your computer with the USB cable. • You must plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. • If you try to plug the USB cable into the HDMI port, the camera may not work properly. 3 Turn on the camera. • The computer recognizes the camera automatically. 4 On your computer, select My Computer→Removable Disk →DCIM→100PHOTO or 101_0101. 5 Select the files you want, and then drag or save them to your computer. If the Folder Type is set to Date, the folder name appears as “XXX_MMDD”. For example, if you capture a photo on January 1, the folder name will be "101_0101". Transferring files to your computer161 Connecting to external devices > Transferring files to your computer Disconnecting the camera (for Windows XP) With Windows Vista, Windows 7, and Windows 8, the methods for disconnecting the camera are similar. 1 Ensure that no data is being transferred between the camera and the computer. • If the status lamp on your camera is blinking, it means the data transfer is in progress. Please wait until the status lamp stops blinking. 2 Click on the tool bar at the bottom right of your computer screen. 3 Click the pop-up message. 4 Click the message box indicating safely removed. 5 Remove the USB cable. Transferring files to your Mac OS Mac OS 10.5 or later is supported. 1 Turn off the camera. 2 Connect your camera to a Macintosh computer with the USB cable. • You must plug the small end of the USB cable into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. • If you try to plug the USB cable into the HDMI port, the camera may not work properly.162 Connecting to external devices > Transferring files to your computer 3 Turn on the camera. • The computer recognizes the camera automatically and displays a removable disk icon. 4 Open the removable disk. 5 Transfer photos or videos to the Mac OS computer.163 Connecting to external devices You can view and edit files using the provided programs. You can also send the files to a PC wirelessly. Installing programs from the provided CD 1 Insert the installation CD into your PC. 2 Select a language. 3 Select a program to install. 4 Follow the on-screen instructions. 5 Click Exit to complete the installation. Available programs when using i-Launcher Item Description Multimedia Viewer You can view files with Multimedia Viewer. Firmware Upgrade You can download the firmware of your camera. PC Auto Backup You can send photos or videos that you captured with the camera to a PC wirelessly. Using i-Launcher i-Launcher allows you to play back files with Multimedia Viewer and provides a link to download the PC Auto Backup program. Requirements for Windows OS Item Requirements CPU Intel® i5 3.3 GHz or higher/ AMD Phenom™ II x4 3.2 GHz or higher RAM Minimum 512 MB RAM (1 GB or more recommended) OS* Windows XP SP2, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows 8 Hard disk capacity 250 MB or more (1 GB and above recommended) Others • CD-ROM drive • 1024X768 pixels, 16-bit color display compatible monitor (1280X1024 pixels, 32-bit color display recommended) • USB 2.0 port • nVIDIA Geforce 7600GT or higher/ ATI X1600 series or higher • Microsoft DirectX 9.0c or higher * A 32-bit version of i-Launcher will be installed—even on 64-bit editions of Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, and Windows 8. Using programs on a PC164 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC • The requirements are recommendation only. i-Launcher may not work properly even when the computer meets the requirements, depending on the condition of your computer. • If your computer does not meet the requirements, videos may not play correctly. The manufacturer is not responsible for any damage that results from using unqualified computers such as a computer you assembled yourself. Requirements for Mac OS Item Requirements OS Mac OS 10.5 or higher (except PowerPC) RAM Minimum 256 MB RAM (512 MB or more recommended) Hard disk capacity Minimum 110 MB Others USB 2.0 port, CD-ROM drive Opening i-Launcher On your computer, select Start→All Programs→Samsung→ i-Launcher→Samsung i-Launcher. Or, click Applications→Samsung →i-Launcher on your Mac OS computer.165 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC Using Multimedia Viewer Multimedia Viewer allows you to play back files. From the Samsung i-Launcher screen, click Multimedia Viewer. • Multimedia Viewer supports the following formats: - Videos: MP4 (Video: H.264, Audio: AAC), WMV (WMV 7/8/9), AVI (MJPEG) - Photos: JPG, GIF, BMP, PNG, TIFF, MPO • Files that have been recorded with other manufacturers’ devices may not play back smoothly. Viewing photos 1 2 3 1011 456789 No. Description 1 File name 2 Enlarged area 3 Histogram 4 Open the selected file. 5 Histogram button 6 Rotate to the left/Rotate to the right. 7 Move to the previous file/Move to the next file. 8 Fit the photo to the screen. 9 View the photo in the original size. 10 Zoom in/Zoom out 11 Switches between 2D and 3D mode.166 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC Viewing videos 1 2 8 4567 3 No. Description 1 File name 2 Adjust the volume. 3 Open the selected file. 4 Move to the next file. 5 Stop No. Description 6 Pause 7 Move to the previous file. 8 Progress bar Downloading the firmware From the Samsung i-Launcher screen, click Firmware Upgrade. Downloading the PC Auto Backup program From the Samsung i-Launcher screen, click PC Auto Backup. For information about installing the PC Auto Backup program, refer to page 133.167 Connecting to external devices > Using programs on a PC Installing Adobe Photoshop Lightroom 1 Insert Adobe Photoshop Lightroom DVD-ROM into your PC. 2 Select a language. 3 Follow the on-screen instructions. Using Adobe Photoshop Lightroom Photos captured by a camera are often transformed to JPEG formats and stored in the memory according to the settings of the camera at the time of shooting. RAW files are not transformed to JPEG formats and are stored in the memory without any changes. With Adobe Photoshop Lightroom, you can calibrate exposures, White Balances, tones, contrasts, and colors of photos. You can also edit JPEG or TIFF files as well as RAW files. For more information, refer to the program guide.Chapter 7 Appendix Get information about error messages, camera maintenance, trouble shooting tips, specifications, and optional accessories. 169 Appendix When the following error messages appear, try these remedies. Error messages Suggested remedies Lens is locked The lens is locked. Rotate the lens counter-clockwise until you hear a click. (p. 45) Card Error • Turn off your camera, and then turn it on again. • Remove your memory card and insert it again. • Format your memory card. Low Battery Insert a charged battery or recharge the battery. No Image File Capture photos or insert a memory card that contains photos. File Error Delete the damaged file or contact a service center. Memory Full Delete unnecessary files or insert a new memory card. Card Locked You can lock SD, SDHC, SDXC, or UHS-1 card to prevent files from being deleted. Unlock the card when shooting. (p. 173) Error messages Suggested remedies Folder and file number are max values. Replace the card File names do not match the DCF standard. Transfer the files on the memory card to your computer and format the card. (p. 155) Error 00 Turn off your camera and remount the lens. If the message still appears, contact a service center. Error 01/02 Turn off your camera, remove the battery, and insert again. If the message still appears, contact a service center. Error messages170 Appendix Cleaning the camera Camera lens and display Use a brush to remove dust and wipe the lens gently with a soft cloth. If any dust remains, apply lens cleaning liquid to a piece of cleaning paper and wipe gently. Image sensor Depending on different shooting conditions, dust may appear in photos because the image sensor is exposed to the external environment. This problem is normal, and the exposure to dust occurs in everyday use of the camera. You can remove dust from the sensor by operating the sensor cleaning function. (p. 156) If dust remains after cleaning the sensor, contact a service center. Do not insert the blower into the mounting opening of the lens. Camera body Wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. Never use benzene, thinners, or alcohol to clean the device. These solutions can damage the camera or cause it to malfunction. Maintaining the camera171 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Using on beaches or shores • Protect your camera from sand and dirt when you use it on beaches or in other similar areas. • Your camera is not waterproof. Do not handle the battery, adapter, or memory card with wet hands. Operating the camera with wet hands may cause damage to your camera. Storing for extended period of time • When you store the camera for an extended period, place it in a sealed container with an absorbent material, such as silica gel. • Over time, unused batteries will discharge and must be recharged before use. • The present date and time can be initialized when the camera is turned on after the camera and battery have been separated for a prolonged period. Using or storing the camera Inappropriate places to use or store the camera • Avoid exposing the camera to very cold or very hot temperatures. • Avoid using your camera in areas with extremely high humidity, or where the humidity changes drastically. • Avoid exposing the camera to direct sunlight and storing it in hot, poorly-ventilated areas, such as in a car during summer time. • Protect your camera and the display from impact, rough handling, and excessive vibration to avoid serious damage. • Avoid using or storing your camera in dusty, dirty, humid, or poorlyventilated areas to prevent damage to moving parts and internal components. • Do not use your camera near fuels, combustibles, or flammable chemicals. Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or explosive materials in the same compartment as the camera or its accessories. • Do not store the camera where there are mothballs.172 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Using the camera with caution in humid environments When you transfer the camera from a cold environment to a warm one, condensation can form on the lens or internal components of the camera. In this situation, turn off the camera and wait for at least 1 hour. If condensation forms on the memory card, remove the memory card from the camera and wait until all moisture has evaporated before reinserting it. Other cautions • Do not swing your camera by the strap. This may cause injury to yourself or others or damage to your camera. • Do not paint your camera, as paint can clog moving parts and prevent proper operation. • Turn off the camera when not using it. • Your camera consists of delicate parts. Avoid impacts to the camera. • Protect the display from external force by keeping it in the case when not in use. Protect the camera from scratches by keeping it away from sand, sharp implements, or loose change. • Do not use the camera if the screen is cracked or broken. Broken glass or acrylic could cause injury to your hands and face. Take the camera to a Samsung service center to have it repaired. • Never place cameras, batteries, chargers, or accessories near, on, or in heating devices, such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. These devices may be deformed and can overheat and cause a fire or explosion. • Do not expose the lens to direct sunlight, as this may discolor the image sensor or cause it to malfunction. • Protect your lens from fingerprints and scratches. Clean your lens with a soft, clean, debris-free lens cloth. • The camera may turn off if impacted from the outside. This is to protect the memory card. Turn on the camera to use it again. • While you use the camera, it may heat up. This is normal and should not affect your camera’s lifespan or performance. • When you use the camera in low temperatures, it may take some time to turn on, the color of the display may be changed temporarily, or afterimages may appear. These conditions are not malfunctions and they will correct themselves when the camera is returned to milder temperatures. • Paint or metal on the outside of the camera may cause allergies, itchy skin, eczema, or swelling for people with sensitive skin. If you experience any of these symptoms, stop using the camera immediately and consult a doctor. • Do not insert foreign objects into any of your camera’s compartments, slots, or access points. Damage due to improper use may not be covered by your warranty. • Do not allow unqualified personnel to service the camera or attempt to service the camera yourself. Any damage that results from unqualified service is not covered by your warranty.173 Appendix > Maintaining the camera About memory card Supported memory card This product supports SD (Secure Digital), SDHC (Secure Digital High Capacity), SDXC (Secure Digital eXtended Capacity), UHS-1 (Ultra High Speed-1), microSD, microSDHC, microSDXC, or microUHS-1 memory cards. Terminal Write-protect switch Label (front) You can prevent files from being deleted by using the write-protect switch on an SD, SDHC, SDXC, or UHS-1 card. Slide the switch down to lock or slide it up to unlock. Unlock the card when capturing photos and videos. Memory card adapter Memory card To use micro memory cards with this product, a PC, or a memory card reader, insert the card into an adapter.174 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Memory card capacity The memory capacity may differ depending on shooting scenes or shooting conditions. These capacities are based on a 2 GB SD card. Size Quality Super Fine Fine Normal RAW RAW + S.Fine RAW + Fine RAW + Normal Photo 20.0M (5472X3648) 151 179 218 69 47 49 52 10.1M (3888X2592) 276 321 384 - 62 64 66 5.9M (2976X1984) 423 484 565 - 71 72 74 2.0M (1728X1152) 845 923 1,016 - 82 83 84 Burst 479 545 631 - - - - 16.9M (5472X3080) 177 208 252 - 51 53 56 7.8M (3712X2088) 343 396 467 - 66 68 70 4.9M (2944X1656) 487 553 640 - 74 75 76 2.1M (1920X1080) 827 905 999 - 82 83 84 13.3M (3648X3648) 218 255 307 - 56 58 61 7.0M (2640X2640) 373 429 504 - 68 70 72 4.0M (2000X2000) 559 630 721 - 76 77 78 1.1M (1024X1024) 1,111 1,180 1,258 - 86 86 87175 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Size Quality HQ Normal Video 1920X1080 (60 fps) Approx. 10' 10" Approx. 12' 43" 1920X1080 (30 fps) Approx. 17' 41" Approx. 22' 09" * 1920X1080 (15 fps) Approx. 23' 38" Approx. 29' 24" 1920X810 (24 fps) Approx. 21' 35" Approx. 27' 02" 1280X720 (60 fps) Approx. 16' 51" Approx. 21' 06" 1280X720 (30 fps) Approx. 29' 11" Approx. 36' 35" 640X480 (30 fps) Approx. 120' 47" Approx. 153' 30" For Sharing (30 fps) Approx. 218' 48" Approx. 278' 24" * is available only with some Smart Filter options. • The figures above are measured without using the zoom function. • Available recording time may vary if you use the zoom. • Several videos were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. • The maximum recording time is 29 minutes and 59 seconds per file. • The maximum playback time of For Sharing videos is 30 seconds per file.176 Appendix > Maintaining the camera • Prevent memory cards from making contact with liquids, dirt, or foreign substances. If dirty, wipe the memory card clean with a soft cloth before you insert the memory card in your camera. • Do not allow liquids, dirt, or foreign substances to come in contact with memory cards or the memory card slot. Doing so may cause memory cards or the camera to malfunction. • When you carry a memory card, use a case to protect the card from electrostatic discharges. • Transfer important data to other media, such as a hard disk, CD, or DVD. • When you use the camera for an extended period, the memory card may become warm. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. • Use a memory card that meets the standard requirements. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. Cautions when using memory cards • Avoid memory cards to very cold or very hot temperatures (below 0 °C/32 °F or above 40 °C/104 °F). Extreme temperatures can cause memory cards to malfunction. • Insert a memory card in the correct direction. Inserting a memory card in the wrong direction may damage your camera and memory card. • Do not use memory cards that have been formatted by other cameras or by a computer. Reformat the memory card with your camera. • Turn off the camera when you insert or remove the memory card. • Do not remove the memory card or turn off your camera while the lamp is blinking, as this may damage your data. • When the lifespan of a memory card has expired, you cannot store any more photos on the card. Use a new memory card. • Do not bend, drop, or subject memory cards to heavy impact or pressure. • Avoid using or storing memory cards near strong magnetic fields. • Avoid using or keeping memory cards in areas with high temperature, high humidity, or corrosive substances.177 Appendix > Maintaining the camera • Do not rest the device on flammable surfaces, such as bedding, carpets, or electric blankets for a prolonged period. • When the device is switched on, do not leave it in any confined space for a prolonged period. • Do not allow battery terminals to come in contact with metallic objects, such as necklaces, coins, keys, or watches. • Use only authentic, manufacturer-recommended, Lithium-ion replacement batteries. • Do not disassemble the battery or puncture the battery with any sharp object. • Avoid exposing the battery to high pressure or crushing forces. • Avoid exposing the battery to major impacts, such as dropping it from high places. • Do not expose the battery to temperatures of 60 °C (140 °F) or above. • Do not allow the battery to come in contact with moisture or liquids. • Battery shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as sunshine, fire or the like. Disposal guidelines • Dispose of the battery with care. • Do not dispose of the battery in a fire. • Disposal regulations may differ by country or region. Dispose of the battery in accordance with all local and federal regulations. Guidelines for charging the battery Charge the battery only by the method described in this user manual. The battery can ignite or explode if not charged properly. About the battery Use only Samsung-approved batteries. Battery specifications Item Description Model BP1130 Type Lithium-ion battery Cell capacity 1,130 mAh Voltage 7.6 V Charging time* (When the battery is completely discharged) Approx. 215 min * Charging the battery by connecting it to a computer may take longer. Personal injury or death can occur if the battery is handled carelessly or improperly. For your safety, follow these instructions for proper battery handling: • The battery can ignite or explode if not handled properly. If you notice any deformities, cracks, or other abnormalities in the battery, immediately discontinue use of the battery and contact your manufacturer. • Use only authentic, manufacturer-recommend battery chargers and charge the battery only by the method described in this user manual. • Do not place the battery near heating devices or expose to excessively warm environments, such as the inside of an enclosed car in the summertime. • Do not place the battery in a microwave oven. • Avoid storing or using the battery in hot, humid places, such as spas or shower enclosures.178 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Battery life Shooting mode Average time / Number of photos Photos Approx. 165 min/Approx. 330 photos Videos Approx. 110 min (Record videos at 1920X1080 resolution and 60 fps.) • The figures above are based on the CIPA test standards. Your results may differ depending on your actual usage. • Available shooting time differs depending on background, shooting interval, and use conditions. • Several videos were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. Low battery message When the battery has fully discharged, the battery icon will turn red and the "Low Battery" message will appear. Notes about using the battery • Avoid exposing batteries to very cold or very hot temperatures (below 0 °C/32 °F or above 40 °C/104 °F). Extreme temperatures can reduce the charging capacity of your batteries. • When you use the camera for an extended period, the area around the battery chamber may become warm. This does not affect the normal use of the camera. • Do not pull the power supply cord to disconnect the plug from the power outlet, as this may cause a fire or electric shock. • In temperatures below 0 °C/32 °F, battery capacity and battery life may decrease. • Battery capacity may decrease in low temperatures, but will return to normal in milder temperatures. • Remove the batteries from your camera when storing it for an extended period. Installed batteries may leak or corrode over time and cause serious damage to your camera. Storing the camera for extended periods with the battery installed causes the battery to discharge. You may not be able to recharge a fully discharged battery. • When you do not use the camera for an extended period (3 months or more), check the battery and recharge it regularly. If you let the battery discharge continually, its capacity and life may decrease, which can lead to a malfunction, fire, or explosion.179 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Cautions about using the battery Protect batteries, chargers, and memory cards from damage. Prevent batteries from making contact with metal objects, as this can create a connection between the + and – terminals of your battery and lead to temporary or permanent battery damage and may cause a fire or electric shock. Notes about charging the battery • If the status lamp is off, make sure that the battery is inserted correctly. • If the camera is on while charging, the battery may not fully charge. Turn off the camera before charging the battery. • Do not use your camera when you are charging the battery. This may cause a fire or electric shock. • Do not pull the power supply cord to disconnect the plug from the power outlet, as this may cause a fire or electric shock. • Let the battery charge for at least 10 minutes before turning on the camera. • If you connect the camera to an external power source when the battery is depleted, using high energy-consuming functions will cause the camera to turn off. To use the camera normally, recharge the battery. • If you reconnect the power cable when the battery is fully charged, the status lamp turns on for approximately 30 minutes. • Using the flash or recording videos depletes the battery quickly. Charge the battery until the red status lamp turns off. • If the status lamp blinks in red, reconnect the cable, or remove the battery and insert it again. • If you charge the battery when the cable is overheated or the temperature is too high, the status lamp may blink in red. Charging will start when the battery cools down. • Overcharging batteries may shorten battery life. After charging is finished, disconnect the cable from your camera. • Do not bend or place heavy objects on the AC cable. Doing so may damage the cable.180 Appendix > Maintaining the camera Notes about charging with a computer connected • Use only the provided USB cable. • The battery may not charge when: - you use a USB hub - other USB devices are connected to your computer - you connect the cable to the port on the front side of your computer - the USB port of your computer does not support the power output standard (5 V, 500 mA) Handle and dispose of batteries and chargers with care • Never dispose of batteries in a fire. Follow all local regulations when you dispose of used batteries. • Never place batteries or cameras on or in heating devices, such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. Batteries may explode when they are overheated.181 Appendix Before contacting a service center If you are having trouble with your device, try these troubleshooting solutions before contacting a service professional. When you leave your camera at a service center, be sure to also leave the other components that may have contributed to the malfunction, such as the memory card and battery. Situation Suggested remedies Cannot turn on the camera • Ensure that the battery is inserted. • Ensure that the battery is inserted correctly. • Charge the battery. The power turns off suddenly • Charge the battery. • Your camera may be in Power save mode or the display turns off automatically. (p. 153) • The camera may be turned off automatically to prevent the memory card from being damaged due to excessive heat. Turn on your camera again. The camera is losing battery power quickly • The battery may lose power more quickly in low temperatures (below 0 °C/32 °F). Keep the battery warm by putting it into your pocket. • Using the flash or recording videos depletes the battery quickly. Recharge if needed. • Batteries are consumable parts that must be replaced over time. Get a new battery if the battery life is diminishing quickly. Situation Suggested remedies Cannot capture photos • There is no space on the memory card. Delete unnecessary files or insert a new card. • Format the memory card. • The memory card is defective. Get a new memory card. • The memory card is locked. Unlock the card. (p. 173) • Ensure that the camera is switched on. • Charge the battery. • Ensure that the battery is inserted correctly. The camera freezes Remove the battery and insert it again. The camera heats up While using the camera, it may heat up. This is normal and should not affect your camera’s lifespan or performance. The flash fires unexpectedly The flash may fire due to static electricity. The camera is not malfunctioning. The flash does not work • The flash option may be set to Off. (p. 94) • You cannot use the flash in some modes. The date and time are incorrect Set the date and time under the q menu. (p. 153) The display or buttons do not work Remove the battery and insert it again.182 Appendix > Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies The memory card has an error • Turn off your camera, and then turn it on again. • Remove your memory card, and then insert it again. • Format your memory card. See "Cautions when using memory cards" for more details. (p. 176) Your computer does not recognize an SDXC or UHS-1 memory card SDXC memory cards use the exFAT file system. To use SDXC memory cards or UHS-1 memory cards that are formatted with the exFAT file system on a Windows XP computer, download and update the exFAT file system driver from the Microsoft website. Your TV or computer cannot display photos and videos that are stored on an SDXC or UHS-1 memory card SDXC memory cards use the exFAT file system. To use SDXC memory cards or UHS-1 memory cards that are formatted with the exFAT file system, ensure that the external device is compatible with the exFAT file system before connecting the camera to the device. Cannot display files If you change the name of a file, your camera may not play the file (the name of the file should meet the DCF standard). If you encounter this situation, display files on your computer. The photo is blurry • Ensure that the focus option you set is suitable for the kind of shot you are capturing. • Use a tripod to prevent your camera from shaking. • Ensure that the lens is clean. If not, clean the lens. (p. 170) Situation Suggested remedies The colors in the photo do not match the actual scene An incorrect White Balance can create unrealistic color. Select the proper White Balance option to suit the light source. (p. 76) The photo is too bright or too dark. Your photo is overexposed or underexposed. • Adjust the aperture value or the shutter speed. • Adjust the ISO sensitivity. (p. 75) • Turn off or on the flash. (p. 94) • Adjust the exposure value. (p. 102) Photos are distorted This camera can have minute distortion when using a wide-angle lens that enables shooting with a wide angle of view. This is normal, and does not cause malfunction. Playback screen does not appear on the connected external device • Ensure that HDMI cable is properly connected to the external monitor. • Ensure that the memory card is properly recorded. Your computer does not recognize your camera • Ensure that the USB cable is connected correctly. • Ensure that your camera is switched on. • Ensure that you are using a supported operating system. Your computer disconnects the camera while transferring files The file transfer may be interrupted by static electricity. Disconnect the USB cable and connect it again. 183 Appendix > Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies Your computer cannot play videos Videos may not play on some video player programs. To play video files captured with your camera, use the Multimedia Viewer program that you can install with the i-Launcher program on your computer. i-Launcher is not functioning properly • End i-Launcher and restart the program. • Depending on your computer's specifications and environment, the program may not launch automatically. In this case, click Start→All Programs→Samsung→ i-Launcher→Samsung i-Launcher on your Windows computer. (For Windows 8, open Start screen, and then select All apps→ Samsung i-Launcher.) Or, click Applications →Samsung→i-Launcher on your Mac OS computer. Cannot set the DPOF for RAW files You cannot set the DPOF for RAW files. Auto Focus does not work • Subject is not in focus. When the subject is outside the AF area, shoot by moving the subject inside the AF area and half-pressing [Shutter]. • Subject is too close. Step back from the subject and shoot. • The focus mode is set to MF. Switch the mode to AF. Situation Suggested remedies AEL feature does not work AEL feature does not work in t, M, i, and s modes. Select another mode to use this feature. Lens does not work • Ensure that the lens is properly mounted. • Remove the lens from the camera and re-mount it. External flash or GPS does not work Ensure that the external device is properly mounted and turned on. The date & time settings screen appears when you power on the camera • Set the date and time again. • This screen appears when the camera’s internal power source is completely discharged. Insert a fully charged battery and wait at least 72 hours in power off status for the internal power source to be recharged.184 Appendix Camera specifications Image Sensor Type CMOS Sensor size 23.5 X 15.7 mm Effective pixels Approx. 20.3 mega-pixels Total pixels Approx. 21.6 mega-pixels Color filter RGB primary color filter Lens Mount Type Samsung NX Mount Available lens Samsung lenses Image Stabilization Type Lens shift (depends on lens) Mode Off/Mode 1/Mode 2 Distortion Correct Off/On (depends on lens) i-Function E, Z (X1.2, 1.4, 1.7, 2.0) Dust Reduction Type Super sonic drive Display Type AMOLED with Touch Panel (C-type Touch Control Enabled) Size 3.31" (Approx. 84.0 mm) Resolution WVGA (800X480) 768 k dots (PenTile) Field of view Approx. 100 % Angle Tiltable (Up 90°, Down 45°) User display Grid Line, Icons, Histogram, Distance Scale, Level gauge Focusing Type Phase Detection & Contrast AF Focusing point • Total AF point: 105 points (Phase Detection AF), 247 points (Contrast AF) • Selection: 1 point (Free selection) • Multi: Normal 21 (3 X 7) points (Cross point 1), Close up 35 points • Face detection: Max. 10 faces Mode Single AF, Continuous AF, Manual Focus, Touch AF & Shutter AF Assist Lamp Green LED185 Appendix > Camera specifications Shutter Type Electronically controlled vertical-run focal plane shutter Speed • Auto: 1/6,000–30 sec. • Manual: 1/6,000–30 sec. (1/3 EV Step) • Bulb (time limit: 4 min) Exposure Metering system TTL 221 (17 X 13) Block segment Metering: Multi, Center-weighted, Spot Metering range: EV 0–18 (ISO100 · 30 mm, F2) Compensation ±3 EV (1/3 EV Step) AE lock CUSTOM key ISO equivalent • 1 Step: Auto, ISO 100, ISO 200, ISO 400, ISO 800, ISO 1600, ISO 3200, ISO 6400, ISO 12800, ISO 25600 • 1/3 Step: Auto, ISO 100, ISO 125, ISO 160, ISO 200, ISO 250, ISO 320, ISO 400, ISO 500, ISO 640, ISO 800, ISO 1000, ISO 1250, ISO 1600, ISO 2000, ISO 2500, ISO 3200, ISO 4000, ISO 5000, ISO 6400, ISO 8000, ISO 10000, ISO 12800, ISO 16000, ISO 20000, ISO 25600 Drive Mode Mode Single, Continuous, Burst (5M only), Timer, Bracket (Auto Exposure, White Balance, Picture Wizard) Continuous shooting • JPEG: High (8.6 fps), Normal (5 fps) • RAW: High (8.6 fps), Normal (5 fps) Burst shooting • 10, 15, or 30 frames per second • Up to 30 shots per shutter-press Bracket shooting Auto exposure bracketing (±3 EV), White Balance bracketing, Picture Wizard bracketing Self-timer 2–30 sec. (1 second interval) Shutter release SR2NX02 (via Micro USB port) (optional) Flash Type External Flash (Bundle with SEF8A) Mode Smart Flash, Auto, Auto Red-eye, Fill in, Fill-in Red, 1st Curtain, 2nd Curtain, Off Guide number 8 (based on ISO 100) (SEF8A) Angle of view 28 mm (35 mm film equivalent) Sync speed Less than 1/180 sec.186 Appendix > Camera specifications Flash EV -2–+2 EV (0.5 EV Step) External flash Optional Samsung external flashes: SEF42A, SEF220A Sync terminal Hot-shoe White Balance Mode Auto WB, Daylight, Cloudy, Fluorescent White, Fluorescent NW, Fluorescent Daylight, Tungsten, Flash WB, Custom Set, Color Temperature (Manual) Micro adjustment Amber/Blue/Green/Magenta 7 steps respectively Dynamic Range Off/Smart Range+/HDR Picture Wizard Mode Standard, Vivid, Portrait, Landscape, Forest, Retro, Cool, Calm, Classic, Custom1, Custom2, Custom3 Parameter Color, Saturation, Sharpness, Contrast Shooting Mode Smart Auto, Program, Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, Manual, Lens Priority, Smart Smart mode Beauty Face, Best Face, Landscape, Macro, Action Freeze, Rich Tones, Panorama, Waterfall, Silhouette, Sunset, Night, Fireworks, Light Trace, Creative Shot Smart Filter Vignetting, Miniature, Colored Pencil, Watercolor, Wash drawing, Oil Sketch, Ink Sketch, Acryl, Negative, Red, Green, Blue, Yellow Size • JPEG (3:2): 20.0M (5472X3648), 10.1M (3888X2592), 5.9M (2976X1984), 5.0M (2736X1824) (Burst mode only), 2.0M (1728X1152) • JPEG (16:9): 16.9M (5472X3080), 7.8M (3712X2088), 4.9M (2944X1656), 2.1M (1920X1080) • JPEG (1:1): 13.3M (3648X3648), 7.0M (2640X2640), 4.0M (2000X2000), 1.1M (1024X1024) • RAW: 20.0M (5472X3648) * 3D mode with 3D lens is available only with JPEG (16:9) 4.1M (2688X1512) or 2.1M (1920X1080). Quality Super Fine, Fine, Normal RAW standard SRW (ver.2.0.0) Color space sRGB, Adobe RGB187 Appendix > Camera specifications Video Type MP4 (H.264) Format Movie: H.264, Sound: AAC Movie AE mode Program, Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, Manual Movie clip Audio on/off (Shooting time: Max. 29' 59'') Smart Filter Vignetting, Miniature, Colored Pencil, Watercolor, Wash drawing, Oil Sketch, Ink Sketch, Acryl, Negative, Red, Green, Blue, Yellow Size 1920X1080, 1920X810, 1280X720, 640X480, 320X240 (For Sharing) Frame rate 60 fps, 30 fps, 24 fps (available only with 1920X810), 15 fps (available only with some Smart Filter options) Multi Motion x0.25 (640X480, 320X240 only), x0.5 (1280X720 (30 fps), 640X480, 320X240 only), x1, x5, x10, x20 Quality HQ, Normal Sound Stereo Edit Still image capture, Time trimming Playback Type Single image, Thumbnails (15/28), Slide show, Movie Edit Smart Filter, Red-eye Fix, Backlight, Resize, Rotate, Face Retouch, Brightness, Contrast Smart filter Vignetting, Miniature, Colored Pencil, Watercolor, Wash drawing, Oil Sketch, Ink Sketch, Acryl, Negative, Red, Green, Blue, Yellow Smart filter size • JPEG (3:2): 5.9M (2976X1984), 5.0M (2736X1824), 2.0M (1728X1152) • JPEG (16:9): 6.2M (3328X1872), 4.9M (2944X1656), 2.1M (1920X1080) • JPEG (1:1): 6.0M (2448X2448), 4.0M (2000X2000), 1.1M (1024X1024) Storage Media External memory (optional)*: SD card (2 GB guaranteed), SDHC card (up to 32 GB guaranteed), SDXC card (up to 64 GB guaranteed), UHS-1 card * Class 6 and above recommended File format RAW (SRW (ver.2.0.0)), JPEG (EXIF 2.21), MPO (3D), DCF, DPOF 1.1 GPS Type Geo-tagging with an optional GPS Module (WGS 84) Feature Location name (English and Korean only)188 Appendix > Camera specifications Wireless network Type IEEE 802.11b/g/n support Dual Band Function MobileLink, Remote Viewfinder, Auto Backup, Email, SNS & Cloud, AllShare Play, AutoShare, Wi-Fi Direct NFC Yes Interface Digital output USB 2.0 (micro USB jack) Video output • NTSC, PAL (selectable) • HDMI External release Yes (micro USB) External microphone Yes DC power input DC 5.0V, 1A via micro USB Power Source Type Rechargeable battery: BP1130 (1,130 mAh) * The power source may differ depending on your region. Dimensions (W X H X D) 122 X 63.7 X 40.7 mm (without protrusions) Weight 284 g (without battery and memory card) Operating Temperature 0–40 °C Operating Humidity 5–85 % Software i-Launcher, Adobe Photoshop Lightroom * Specifications may change without notice to improve performance. * Other brands and products names are trademarks of respective owners.189 Appendix Glossary AP (Access Point) An access point is a device that allows wireless devices to connect to a wired network. Ad-Hoc network An ad-hoc network is a temporary connection for sharing files or an internet connection and between computers and devices. AdobeRGB Adobe RGB is used for commercial printing and has a larger color range than sRGB. Its wider range of colors helps you to easily edit photos on a computer. AEB (Auto Exposure Bracket) This feature automatically captures several images at different exposures to help you capture a properly-exposed image. AEL/AFL (Auto Exposure Lock/Auto Focus Lock) These features help you lock the exposure or focus on which you want to focus or calculate the exposure. AF (Auto Focus) A system that automatically focuses the camera lens on the subject. Your camera uses the contrast to focus automatically. AMOLED (Active-matrix organic light-emitting diode) / LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) AMOLED is a visual display that is very thin and light, as it does not need backlighting. LCD is a visual display commonly used in consumer electronics. This display needs a separate backlight, such as CCFL or LED, to reproduce colors. Aperture The aperture controls the amount of light that reaches the camera’s sensor.190 Appendix > Glossary Composition Composition in photography means arranging objects in a photo. Usually, abiding by the rule of thirds leads to a good composition. DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) A specification to define a file format and file system for digital cameras created by the Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association (JEITA). Depth of field The distance between the nearest and farthest points that can be acceptably focused in a photograph. Depth of field varies with lens aperture, focal length, and distance from the camera to the subject. Selecting a smaller aperture, for example, will increase the depth of field and blur the background of a composition. DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) A format for writing printing information, such as selected images and number of prints, on a memory card. DPOF-compatible printers, sometimes available at photo shops, can read the information from the card for convenient printing. Camera shake (Blur) If the camera is moved while the shutter is open, the entire image may appear blurred. This occurs more often when the shutter speed is slow. Prevent camera shake by raising the sensitivity, using the flash, or using a faster shutter speed. Alternatively, use a tripod or the OIS function to stabilize the camera. Cloud Computing Cloud computing is a technology that allows you to store data on remote servers and to use them from a device with internet access. Color space The range of colors that the camera can see. Color temperature Color Temperature is a measurement in degrees Kelvin (K) that indicates the hue of a specific type of light source. As the color temperature increases, the color of the light source has a more bluish quality. As the color temperature decreases, the color of the light source has a more reddish quality. At 5,500 degrees Kelvin, the color of the light source is similar to the sun at midday.191 Appendix > Glossary Flash A speed light that helps to create adequate exposure in low-light conditions. Focal length The distance from the middle of the lens to its focal point(in millimeters). Longer focal lengths result in narrower angles of view and the subject is magnified. Shorter focal lengths result in wider angles of view. Histogram A graphical representation of the brightness of an image. The horizontal axis represents the brightness and the vertical axis represents the number of pixels. High points at the left (too dark) and right (too bright) on the histogram indicate a photo that is improperly exposed. H.264/MPEG-4 A high-compression video format established by international standard organizations ISO-IEC and ITU-T. This codec is capable of providing good video quality at low bit rates developed by the Joint Video Team (JVT). EV (Exposure Value) All the combinations of the camera’s shutter speed and lens aperture that result in the same exposure. EV Compensation This feature allows you to quickly adjust the exposure value measured by the camera, in limited increments, to improve the exposure of your photos. Exif (Exchangeable Image File Format) A specification to define an image file format for digital cameras created by the Japan Electronic Industries Development Association (JEIDA). Exposure The amount of light allowed to reach the camera’s sensor. Exposure is controlled by a combination of the shutter speed, the aperture value, and ISO sensitivity.192 Appendix > Glossary Metering The metering refers to the way in which the camera measures the quantity of light to set the exposure. MF (Manual Focus) A system that manually focuses the camera lens on the subject. You can use the focus ring to focus on a subject. MJPEG (Motion JPEG) A video format which is compressed as a JPEG image. MPO (Multi Picture Object) An image file format that contains multiple images in a file. An MPO file provides a 3D effect on MPO-compatible displays, such as 3D TVs or 3D monitors. Image sensor The physical part of a digital camera that contains a photosite for each pixel in the image. Each photosite records the brightness of the light that strikes it during an exposure. Common sensor types are CCD (Chargecoupled Device) and CMOS (Complementary Metal Oxide Semiconductor). IP (Internet protocol) address An IP address is a unique number that is assigned to every device that is connected to the internet. ISO sensitivity The sensitivity of the camera to light, based on the equivalent film speed used in a film camera. At higher ISO sensitivity settings, the camera uses a higher shutter speed, which can reduce blur caused by camera shake and low light. However, images with high sensitivity are more susceptible to noise. JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group) A lossy method of compression for digital images. JPEG images are compressed to reduce their overall file size with minimal deterioration of the image resolution. 193 Appendix > Glossary PAL (Phase Alternate Line) A video color encoding standard used in numerous countries throughout Africa, Asia, Europe, and the Middle East. Quality An expression of the rate of compression used in a digital image. Higher quality images have a lower rate of compression, which usually results in a larger file size. RAW (CCD raw data) The original, unprocessed data, collected directly from the camera’s image sensor. White Balance, contrast, saturation, sharpness, and other data can be manipulated with editing software before the image is compressed into a standard file format. Resolution The number of pixels present in a digital image. High resolution images contain more pixels and typically show more detail than low resolution images. Noise Misinterpreted pixels in a digital image that may appear as misplaced or random, bright pixels. Noise usually occurs when photos are shot with a high sensitivity or when a sensitivity is automatically set in a dark place. NFC (Near Field Communication) NFC is a set of standards for radio communication at very close proximity. You can use NFC-enabled devices to activate features or exchange data with other devices. NTSC (National Television System Committee) A video color encoding standard used most commonly in Japan, North America, the Philippines, South America, South Korea, and Taiwan. Optical zoom This is a general zoom which can enlarge images with a lens and does not deteriorate quality of images.194 Appendix > Glossary Shutter speed Shutter speed refers to the amount of time it takes to open and close the shutter, and it is an important factor in the brightness of a photo, as it controls the amount of light which passes through the aperture before it reaches the image sensor. A fast shutter speed allows less time to let light in and the photo becomes darker and more easily freezes subjects in motion. sRGB (Standard RGB) International standard of color space established by the IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission). This is defined from color space for PC monitors and is also used as the standard color space for Exif. Vignetting A reduction of an image’s brightness or saturation at the periphery (outer edges) compared to the center of the image. Vignetting can draw interest to subjects positioned in the center of an image. White Balance (Color balance) An adjustment of the intensities of colors (typically the primary colors red, green, and blue), in an image. The goal of adjusting the White Balance, or color balance, is to correctly render the colors in an image. Wi-Fi Wi-Fi is a technology that allows electronic devices to exchange data wirelessly over a network. WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) WPS is a technology that secures wireless home networks.195 Appendix Optional accessories Lens SAMSUNG 18-55 mm F3.5-5.6 OIS III SAMSUNG 20-50 mm F3.5-5.6 ED II SAMSUNG 16 mm F2.4 SAMSUNG 20 mm F2.8 SAMSUNG 30 mm F2 SAMSUNG 50-200 mm F4-5.6 ED OIS III SAMSUNG 60 mm F2.8 Macro ED OIS SSA SAMSUNG 18-200 mm F3.5-6.3 ED OIS Lens SAMSUNG 85 mm F1.4 ED SSA SAMSUNG 12-24 mm F4-5.6 ED SAMSUNG 45 mm F1.8 SAMSUNG 45 mm F1.8 [T6] 2D/3D External flash SEF42A SEF220A GPS GPS10196 Appendix > Optional accessories Shutter release (micro USB type) Microphone SR2NX02 EM10 Rechargeable battery Battery charger BP1130 BC3NX01 Camera bag Camera case Memory card Filter USB cable HDMI cable Strap • These illustrations may differ from your actual items. Refer to the user manuals of these optional accessories for details. • Use only Samsung-approved accessories. Samsung is not responsible for damage caused by using another manufacturer’s accessories.197 Appendix A Adobe Photoshop Lightroom 167 AllShare Play 141 Aperture 16, 20 Auto Backup 133 Auto focus 80 B Battery Caution 177 Charging 34 Insert 33 Best Face mode 65 Bracketing 92 C Camera Connecting as removable disk 160 Connecting to PC 160 Disconnecting (Windows) 161 Layout 30 Camera specifications 184 Charging 34 Color space 148 D Date & Time 153 Depth of Field (DOF) 17, 22 Digital Print Order Format (DPOF) 114 DIRECT LINK 32 Display brightness 152 Display type 43 Drive 90 E Enlarging 113 Exposure Value (EV) 16, 102 F Fader 105 Files Deleting 111 Photo type 74 Protecting 110 Video type 104 Flash Bounce photography 27 Flash options 94 Guide number 26 Intensity 95 F-number 16 Focal length 21 Focus assist 88 Focus Peaking 88 I Icons Playback mode 42 Shooting mode 40 i-Function 61 i-Launcher 163 Image adjustment Adjusting photos 119 Red-eye 120 Retouching faces 120 ISO sensitivity 75 i-Zoom 63 L Lenses Layout 44 Locking 45 Markings 47 Unlocking 46 M Maintenance 170 Memory card Caution 173 Insert 33 Metering 97 MobileLink 129 Index198 Appendix > Index O One touch shot 87 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) 89 Optional accessories Attach the GPS module 51 Connect the flash 49 Flash layout 48 GPS module layout 51 P Panorama mode 66 Photos Editing 117 Enlarging 113 Shooting options 73 Viewing on 3D TV 159 Viewing on camera 108 Viewing on HDTV 158 Picture Wizard 79 Posture 13 Power save mode 153 R Red-eye effect Playback mode 120 Shooting mode 95 Remote Viewfinder 131 Resolution Playback mode 118 Shooting mode (Movie) 104 Shooting mode (Photo) 73 Retouching faces 120 Rotating 118 Rule of thirds 24 S Service center 181 Settings 152 Shooting modes Aperture Priority 57 Lens Priority 60 Manual 59 Program 55 Recording 68 Shutter Priority 58 Smart 64 Smart Auto 53 Shutter speed 18, 20 Slide show 113 Smart filter Playback mode 121 Shooting mode 101 Smart panel 38 T Thumbnails 108 Timer 91 Touch AF 86 Touch screen 36 Tracking AF 86 Transferring files Mac 161 Windows 160 TV 158 U Unpacking 29 V Video Out 153 Videos Capturing 116 Options 104 Recording 68 Viewing 115 W White balance 76 Wireless network 123 3 3D mode 69199 Correct Disposal of This Product (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment) (Applicable in countries with separate collection systems) This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these items from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources. Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take these items for environmentally safe recycling. Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its electronic accessories should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal. Correct disposal of batteries in this product (Applicable in countries with separate collection systems) This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that the batteries in this product should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium or lead above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to human health or the environment. To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them through your local, free battery return system. CAN ICES-3 (B)/NMB-3(B) Dispose unwanted electronics through an approved recycler. To find the nearest recycling location, go to our website: www.samsung.com/recyclingdirect Or call, (877) 278 - 0799 Appendix200 Appendix FCC notice Caution: Any changes or modifications in construction of this device which are not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. NOTE: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorientate or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the distance between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. Declaration of Conformity Trade Name : Samsung Electronics America, Inc. Model No. : Samsung NX300 Responsible Party : Samsung Electronics America, Inc. Address : 85 Challenger Road, Ridgefield Park, NJ 07660 Telephone No. : 1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. RF exposure statements: This device is for handheld operation only. The antenna(s) used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a separation distance of at least 20 cm from all persons and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. FCC ID:A3LNX300201 TA-2012/1802 APPROVED Model : NX300 Year of Manufacture : 2013 CAUTION RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Caution: Any changes or modifications to the equipment not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void user’s authority to operate the equipment. IC: 649E-NX300 This equipment may be operated in all EU countries. In France, this equipment may only be used indoors. Complies with IDA Standards DA100790 No.: ESD-1306913C TRC/SS/2013/17Please refer to the warranty that came with your product or visit our website www.samsung.com for after-sales service or inquiries. imagine the possibilities Thank you for purchasing this Samsung product. To receive more complete service, please register your product at www.samsung.com/register 1-800-SAMSUNG(726-7864) Electric Range installation manual ENGLISH This manual is made with 100% recycled paper. Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 1 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:442_ Before you begin before you begin ANTI-TIP DEVICE WARNING: To reduce the risk of tipping the appliance, the appliance must be secured by properly installed anti-tip devices packed with the appliance. a) A child or adult can tip the range and be killed. b) Install the anti-tip device to the structure and/or the range at rear right (or rear left) of the range bottom. c) Engage the range to the anti-tip device by leveling leg at rear right (or rear left) of the range bottom. d) Re-engage the anti-tip device if the range is moved. e) See installation instructions for details. f) Failure to do so can result in death or serious burns to children or adults. AbouT ThIs mANuAl READ THESE INSTRUCTIONS COMPLETELY AND CAREFULLY. Important note to the installer • Read all instructions contained in these installation instructions before installing range. • Remove all packing materials from the oven compartments before connecting the electrical supply to the range. • Observe all governing codes and ordinances. • Be sure to leave these instructions with the consumer. Important note to the consumer Keep these instructions for the local electrical inspector’s use. • As when using any appliance generating heat, there are certain safety precautions you should follow. • Be sure your range is installed and grounded properly by a qualified installer or service technician. • Make sure the wall coverings around the range can withstand the heat generated by the range. • To eliminate the need to reach over the surface elements, cabinet storage space above the elements should be avoided. • The range should not be placed on a base. FoR YouR sAFETY WARNINGWARNING If the information in this manual is not followed exactly, a fire or electrical shock may result causing property damage, personal injury or death. WARNINGWARNING Before beginning the installation, switch power off at the service panel and lock the service disconnecting means to prevent power from being switched on accidentally. When the service disconnecting means cannot be locked, securely fasten a prominent warning device, such as a tag, to the service panel. WARNINGWARNING This appliance must be properly grounded. WARNING Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 2 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:4401 PREPARING TO INSTALL Preparing to install the range _3 preparing to install the range REmoVE PACKAGING Remove packaging materials. Failure to remove packaging materials could result in damage to the appliance. PREPARE Tools & PARTs What tools you will need Drill Adjustable Wrench Pliers 1/4˝ Nut Driver Phillips Screwdriver Flat Screwdriver Pencil Level What’s included with your range Template Anti-Tip Bracket Screws (2 ea) 4-Wire Cord or 3-Wire Cord (UL Approved 40 or 50 AMP) What’s not included Strain Relief (For Conduit Installation Only) Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 3 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:454_ Preparing to install the range ChECKING ThE INsTAllATIoN sITE Clearances and dimensions To install the range, refer to the following fi gure. For installation in CANADA, a Free-standing range is not to be installed closer than 12mm from any adjacent surface. CAUTION CAUTION This range has been designed to comply with the maximum allowable wood cabinet temperatures of 194°F. Make sure the wall covering, countertops and cabinets around the range can withstand the heat (up to 194°F) generated by the range. If not, discoloration, delamination or melting may occur. A B 36” 30” 24” 6” 25” 3” 24” 3” A : Cabinet opening 30” For U.S.A, 30”~31” For CANADA. B : Acceptable electrical outlet area Minimum dimensions IMPORTANT To eliminate the risk of burns or fi re caused by reaching over heated surface units, cabinet storage space located above the surface units should be avoided. If cabinet storage is to be provided, the risk can be reduced by installing a range hood that projects horizontally a minimum of 5” beyond the bottom of the cabinets. * 30” 30” ** 15” * 30” minimum clearance between the top of the cooking surface and the bottom of an unprotected wood or metal cabinet; or 24” minimum when the bottom of the wood or metal cabinet is protected by not less than 1/4” fl ame retardant millboard covered with not less than no.28 MSG sheet steel, 0.015” stainless steel, 0.024” aluminum or 0.020” copper. ** 15” minimum between the countertop and the adjacent cabinet bottom. Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 4 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:4602 CONNECTING THE POWER Connecting the power _5 connecting the power sTEP 1. mEETING ElECTRICAl CoNNECTIoN REQuIREmENTs CAUTION CAUTIONFor personal safety, do not use an extension cord with this appliance. Remove house fuse or open circuit breaker before beginning installation. This appliance must be supplied with the proper voltage and frequency, and connected to an individual properly grounded branch circuit, protected by a circuit breaker or fuse having amperage as specifi ed on the rating plate. The rating plate is located above the drawer on the oven frame. (Fig. 1 or Fig. 2) We recommend you have the electrical wiring and hookup of your range connected by a qualifi ed electrician. After installation, have the electrician show you where your main range disconnect is located. Check with your local utilities for electrical codes which apply in your area. Failure to wire your oven according to governing codes could result in a hazardous condition. If there are no local codes, your range must be wired and fused to meet the requirements of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA No. 70–Latest Edition. You can get a copy by writing: National Fire Protection Association Batterymarch Park Quincy, MA 02269 Effective January 1, 1996, the National Electrical Code requires that new construction (not existing) utilize a 4-conductor connection to an electric range. When installing an electric range in new construction, follow Steps 2 and 3 for 4-wire connection. You must use a 3-wire or 4-wire, single-phase A.C. 208Y/120 Volt or 240/120 Volt, 60 hertz electrical system. If the electrical service provided does not meet the above specifi cations, have a licensed electrician install an approved outlet. Use only a 3-conductor or a 4-conductor UL-listed range cord. These cords may be provided with ring terminals on wire and a strain relief device. A range cord rated at 40 amps with 125/250 minimum volt range is required. A 50 amp range cord is not recommended but if used, it should be marked for use with nominal 13⁄8” diameter connection openings. Care should be taken to center the cable and strain relief within the knockout hole to keep the edge from damaging the cable. • Because range terminals are not accessible after range is in position, fl exible service conduit or cord must be used. NOTE If conduit is being used, go to Step 4 on page 9. ALL NEW BRANCH-CIRCUIT CONSTRUCTIONS, MOBILE HOMES, RECREATIONAL VEHICLES AND INSTALLATIONS WHERE LOCAL CODES DO NOT ALLOW GROUNDING THROUGH NEUTRAL, REQUIRE A 4-CONDUCTOR UL-LISTED RANGE CORD. (Fig. 1) (Fig. 2) Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 5 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:476_ Connecting the power sTEP 2. ACCEssING ThE PoWER CoRD CoNNECTIoN Remove the rear access cover and loosen the screw with a screwdriver. The terminal block will then be accessible. Access cover Terminal block Specifi ed power-supply-cord kit rating Range rating, watts Specifi ed rating of power-supply-cord kit, amperes Diameter (inches) of range connection opening 120/240 volts 3-wire Power cord Conduit 8,750 - 16,500 40 or 50A 13/8” 11/8” Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 6 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:4802 CONNECTING THE POWER Connecting the power _7 sTEP 3. INsTAllING ThE PoWER CoRD For power cord installations, hook the strain relief over the power cord hole (13/8”) located below the rear of the drawer body. Insert the power cord through the strain relief and tighten the device. Strain relief Power cord Conduit connection plate • You must install the power cord with a strain relief. • Attach the strain relief to the 13/8” opening in conduit connection plate. Installing a 3-wire power cord WARNINGWARNING The neutral or ground wire of the power cord must be connected to the neutral terminal located in the center of the terminal block. The power leads must be connected to the lower left and the lower right terminals of the terminal block. 1. Remove the 3 lower terminal screws from the terminal block. 2. Insert the 3 terminal screws through each power cord terminal ring and into the lower terminals of the terminal block. Be certain that the center wire (white/neutral) is connected to the center lower position of the terminal block. 3. Tighten screws securely into the terminal block. DO NOT remove the ground strap connection. 4. Go to step 5 on page 10 and proceed with the installation. Neutral Ground strap terminal Black White Red Black White Red Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 7 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:498_ Connecting the power Installing a 4-wire power cord WARNINGWARNING The neutral wire of the supply circuit must be connected to the neutral terminal located in the lower center of the terminal block. The power leads must be connected to the lower left and the lower right terminals of the terminal block. The 4th grounding lead must be connected to the frame of the range with the ground plate and the ground screw. 1. Remove the 3 lower terminal screws from the terminal block. Remove the ground screw and ground plate and retain them. 2. Cut and discard the ground strap. Do not discard any screws. 3. Insert the one ground screw into the power cord ground wire terminal ring, through the ground plate, and into the frame of the range. 4. Insert the 3 terminal screws (removed earlier) through each power cord terminal ring and into the lower terminals of the terminal block. Be certain that the center wire (white/neutral) is connected to the center lower position of the terminal block. Tighten screws securely into the terminal block. 5. Go to step 5 on page 10 and proceed with the installation. Ground strap Ground plate Ground screw Neutral terminal Ground wire (Green) White Black Red Black White Red Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 8 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:5002 CONNECTING THE POWER Connecting the power _9 sTEP 4. INsTAllING ThE CoNDuIT Remove the conduit connection plate from the rear of the drawer body and rotate it as shown below. The conduit hole (11/8”) must be used. 11/8” 13/8” 11 13/8” /8” 1. Prepare the conduit cord shown in Figure 1. 2. Install the conduit cord as shown in Figure 2. Conduit connection plate Strain relief Ring Body Figure 2 1” 31/2” 3/8” 1” 31/2” 3 wire 4 wire Knockout surface Figure 1 3/8” For conduit installations, insert the strain relief (not included) into the conduit hole (11/8”). Then thread the conduit cord through the body of the strain relief and fasten the ring. Reinstall the bracket. Installing a 3-wire conduit • Aluminum building wire may be used but it must be rated for the correct amperage and voltage to make the connection. Connect wires according to Step 4 depending on the number of wires. • Wire used, location and enclosure of splices, etc., must conform to good wiring practices and local codes. 1. Loosen the 3 lower terminal screws from the terminal block. 2. Insert the center bare wire (white/neutral) tip through the bottom center terminal block opening. On certain models, the wire will need to be inserted through the ground strap opening and then into the bottom center block opening. 3. Insert the two side bare wire tips into the lower left and the lower right terminal block openings. 4. Tighten the screws until the wire is fi rmly secured (35 to 50 inch-lbs.). Do not over-tighten the screws since it could damage the wires. 5. Go to step 5 on page 10 and proceed with the installation. Black White Red Ground strap Neutral terminal Wire tips Red White Black Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 9 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:5110_ Connecting the power Installing a 4-wire conduit • Aluminum building wire may be used but it must be rated for the correct amperage and voltage to make the connection. Connect wires according to this Step 4 depending on the number of wires. • Wire used, location and enclosure of splices, etc., must conform to good wiring practices and local codes. 1. Loosen the 3 lower terminal screws from the terminal block. Remove the ground screw and ground plate and retain them. 2. Cut and discard the ground strap. Do not discard any screws. 3. Insert the ground bare wire tip between the range frame and the ground plate (removed earlier) and secure it in place with the ground screw (removed earlier). 4. Insert the bare wire (white/neutral) tip through the bottom center of the terminal block opening. 5. Insert the two side bare wire tips into the lower left and the lower right terminal block openings. 6. Tighten the screws until the wire is fi rmly secured (35 to 50 inch-lbs.). Do not over-tighten the screws since it could damage the wires. 7. Go to step 5 and proceed with the installation. Ground strap Ground plate White Black Red Neutral terminal Ground wire (Green) Wire tips White Black Red sTEP 5. REPlACING ThE ACCEss CoVER Replace the access cover on the range back. To replace the wire cover, insert double projections in the pockets located below the opening and tighten the screw. Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 10 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:53Installing the range _11 03 INSTALLING THE RANGE installing the range INsTAllING ThE ANTI-TIP DEVICE WARNINGWARNING To reduce the risk of tipping, the appliance must be secured by properly installing the Anti-Tip device packed with the appliance. • Refer to the installation instructions supplied with the bracket. • Unless properly installed, the range could be tipped by stepping or sitting on the door. Injury may result from spilled hot liquids or from the range itself. Anti-Tip bracket Screw must enter wood or concrete *approximately 21/32”(16.5mm) *NOTE: To install Anti-Tip bracket, release the leveling leg. A minimum clearance of 21/32”(16.5mm) is required between the range bottom and the kitchen fl oor. 1. Locate the bracket using the template The Anti-Tip bracket is packaged with a template. The instructions include information necessary to complete the installation. Read and follow the instructions on the sheet (template) for range installation. 2. Level the range Level the range by adjusting the leveling legs with a wrench. Lower range Raise range Leveling leg Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 11 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:5412_ Installing the range 3. Check your adjustments Use a spirit level to check your adjustments. Place the level diagonally on the oven rack or surface cooktop, and check each direction for level. 1. Check direction 1. 2. Check direction 2. If the spirit level doesn’t show level on the oven rack or surface cooktop, adjust the leveling legs with a wrench. FINAlIZING ThE INsTAllATIoN • Move range close enough to the opening to plug into the receptacle. • Slide range into position insuring that the rear left(or rear right) leg slides under the Anti-Tip bracket. The range will sit 0” away from the back wall when properly installed. • Carefully tip the range forward to insure that the Anti-Tip bracket engages the back brace and prevents tip-over. • Turn on the electrical power. Check the range for proper operation as described in the user manual. Anti-Tip bracket Leveling leg DG68-00109F-01 Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 12 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:54un monde de possibilités Nous vous remercions d'avoir choisi ce produit Samsung. Afin de bénéficier du meilleur du service après-vente, enregistrez votre appareil sur le site suivant : www.samsung.com/register 1-800-SAMSUNG(726-7864) Manuel d'utilisation Manuel d'installation FRANÇAIS CANADIEN Ce manuel est en papier recyclé à 100%. Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 1 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:552_ Avant de commencer avant de commencer DISPOSITIF ANTI-BASCULEMENT AVERTISSEMENT : Pour réduire le risque de basculement de l’appareil, ce dernier doit être sécurisé à l’aide des dispositifs anti-basculement correctement installés, fournis dans l’emballage. a) Adultes ou enfants peuvent faire basculer la cuisinière et être tués. b) Installez le dispositif anti-basculement sur la structure et/ou sur la cuisinière à l’arrière droit (ou arrière gauche) du dessous de l’appareil. c) Engagez le pied de mise à niveau de la cuisinière situé à l’arrière droit (ou arrière gauche) du dessous de l’appareil dans le dispositif anti-basculement. d) Engagez à nouveau le dispositif anti-basculement si la cuisinière est déplacée. e) Reportez-vous aux consignes d’installation pour plus d’informations. f) Le non-respect de cette consigne peut entraîner des brûlures graves ou des blessures mortelles chez l’enfant et l’adulte. A PrOPOS DE CE MANUEL LISEZ ENTIÈREMENT ET ATTENTIVEMENT CES INSTRUCTIONS. Note importante destinée à l'installateur • Lisez l'intégralité des consignes d'installation avant d'installer la cuisinière. • Retirez tous les éléments d'emballage des compartiments du four avant de raccorder la cuisinière à l'alimentation électrique. • Respectez tous les codes et règlements en vigueur. • Assurez-vous de laisser ces instructions à l'utilisateur. Note importante destinée à l'utilisateur Conservez précieusement ces instructions afin que la personne chargée du contrôle électrique puisse s'y reporter. • Comme pour tout appareil générant de la chaleur, certaines consignes de sécurité sont à respecter. • Assurez-vous que votre appareil est correctement installé et mis à la terre par un installateur qualifié ou un technicien spécialisé. • Assurez-vous que les revêtements muraux situés à proximité de l'appareil peuvent résister à la chaleur générée par celui-ci. • Pour ne pas avoir à accéder à l'espace au-dessus des éléments de cuisson, évitez d'y aménager des meubles de rangement. • La cuisinière ne doit pas être placée sur un socle. POUr VOTrE SÉCUrITÉ AVERTISSEMENT AVERTISSEMENT Si vous ne respectez pas scrupuleusement les informations contenues dans ce manuel, vous risquez de provoquer un incendie ou un choc électrique et, par conséquent, des dégâts matériels, blessures ou accidents mortels. AVERTISSEMENT AVERTISSEMENT Avant de démarrer l'installation, coupez l'alimentation au panneau de commande et verrouillez les dispositifs de débranchement de la mise en service ; cette précaution évitera toute mise sous tension accidentelle de l'appareil. Si vous ne parvenez pas à verrouiller les moyens de débranchement de la mise en service, fixez fermement au panneau de commande un dispositif d'alarme bien visible. AVERTISSEMENT AVERTISSEMENT Cet appareil doit être correctement mis à la terre. AVERTISSEMENT Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 2 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:5501 PREPARATION DE L'INSTALLATION Préparation avant l'installation de la cuisinière _3 préparation avant l'installation de la cuisinière rETrAIT DE L'EMBALLAGE Retirez le matériel d'emballage. Tout matériel d'emballage non retiré risque d'endommager l'appareil. PrEPArATION DES OUTILS ET DES PIECES Outils nécessaires Perceuse Clé à molette Pince Tournevis à douille de 1/4˝ Tournevis cruciforme Tournevis plat Crayon Niveau Accessoires fournis Modèle Support anti-basculement Vis (2 ch) Cordon 4 fils ou 3 fils (homologué UL 40 ou 50 AMP) Accessoires non fournis Protection contre la traction (pour le branchement des gaines uniquement) Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 3 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:564_ Préparation avant l'installation de la cuisinière VÉrIFICATION DU LIEU D'INSTALLATION Dégagements et dimensions Pour procéder à l'installation de la cuisinière, reportez-vous au schéma suivant. Concernant les installations au CANADA, une cuisinière non encastrable ne peut pas être installée à moins de 12 mm de toute surface adjacente. ATTENTION ATTENTION Cette cuisinière a été conçue pour supporter une température maximale de 194 ºF, température maximale autorisée pour toute structure en bois. Assurez-vous que le revêtement mural, les plans de travail et les meubles voisins peuvent résister à la chaleur (jusqu'à 194 ºF) générée par la cuisinière. Dans le cas contraire, des éléments peuvent se décolorer, se décoller ou fondre. A B 36” 30” 24” 6” 25” 3” 24” 3” A : Ouverture du meuble 30” pour les Etats-Unis, 30”~31” pour le CANADA. B : emplacement autorisé pour la prise électrique Dimensions minimales IMPORTANT Pour éliminer tout risque de brûlure ou d'incendie lors de l'accès à l'espace situé au-dessus des éléments de cuisson chauds, évitez d'y aménager tout meuble de rangement. Si, toutefois, un meuble de rangement doit être monté, réduisez ce risque en installant une hotte d'aspiration assurant une protection horizontale d'au moins 5" au-delà du dessous du meuble. * 30” 30” ** 15” * dégagement minimal de 30” entre le dessus de la table de cuisson et le dessous d'un meuble en métal ou en bois non protégé, ou de 24” minimum si le dessous du meuble en métal ou en bois est protégé par un carton pâte inifugeant d'au moins 1/4” recouvert par au moins une feuille d'acier n°28 MSG, d'acier inoxydable de 0.015”, d'aluminium de 0.024” ou de cuivre de 0.020”. ** 15 ” minimum entre le plan de travail et le dessous du meuble adjacent. Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 4 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:5602 MISE SOUS TENSION Mise sous tension _5 Mise sous tension ETAPE 1 : rESPECT DES EXIGENCES EN MATIErE DE rACCOrDEMENTS ELECTrIQUES ATTENTION ATTENTION Pour votre sécurité, n'utilisez pas de rallonge pour brancher l'appareil. Retirez le fusible de l'installation électrique ou ouvrez le disjoncteur avant de démarrer l'installation. Cet appareil doit être alimenté par la fréquence et la tension adaptées. Il doit également être branché sur un circuit individuel correctement mis à la terre et protégé par un disjoncteur ou un fusible dont l'ampérage est conforme à celui spécifi é sur la plaque signalétique de l'appareil. La plaque signalétique est située au-dessus du tiroir sur la structure du four. (Fig. 1 ou Fig. 2) Nous vous recommandons de confi er le câblage et le branchement électriques de votre cuisinière à un électricien qualifi é. Une fois l'installation eff ectuée, demandez à l'électricien de vous montrer l'emplacement de débranchement principal de votre cuisinière. Vérifi ez auprès de votre service public les codes électriques s'appliquant à votre zone. Le non-respect des codes obligatoires pour le branchement de votre four peut s'avérer dangereux. S'il n'existe pas de codes locaux, votre cuisinière doit être branchée conformément aux exigences du Code national électrique, ANSI/NFPA N° 70 (dernière édition). Vous pouvez en obtenir une copie en adressant un courrier à : National Fire Protection Association Batterymarch Park Quincy, MA 02269 Entré en vigueur le 1er janvier 1996, le Code électrique national exige que toute construction neuve (non existante) doit être équipée d'un branchement à 4 conducteurs pour les cuisinières électriques. Lorsque vous installez une cuisinière électrique dans une construction neuve, suivez les étapes 2 et 3 relatives aux connexions à 4 fi ls. Vous devez utiliser un système électrique à 3 ou 4 fi ls, monophasé CA de 208Y/120 V ou de 240/120 V (60 Hz). Si votre installation électrique n'est pas conforme aux spécifi cations ci-dessus, contactez un électricien agréé afi n d'installer une prise homologuée. Utilisez uniquement un cordon d'alimentation à 3 ou 4 fi ls fi gurant dans la liste UL. Ces cordons nécessitent des bornes rondes sur le fi l et un dispositif de protection contre la traction. Un cordon d'alimentation nominale de 40 A et de 125/250 V minimum est indispensable. Il n'est pas recommandé d'utiliser un cordon d'alimentation de 50 A, mais si toutefois vous en utilisé un, celui-ci doit être repéré pour être utilisé avec des ouvertures de connexion de diamètre nominal 13⁄8 ”. Veillez à bien centrer le câble et le dispositif de protection contre la traction dans le trou d'éjection afi n d'empêcher que le bord n'endommage le câble. • Etant donné que les prises de la cuisinière sont inaccessibles une fois la cuisinière installée, il est nécessaire d'utiliser une gaine ou un cordon fl exible. REMARQUE Si vous utilisez une gaine, suivez l'étape 4, page 9. TOUTES LES CONSTRUCTIONS DONT LES CIRCUITS DERIVES SONT NEUFS, LES MAISONS MOBILES, LES VEHICULES ET LES INSTALLATIONS DE LOISIRS DONT LES CODES LOCAUX NE PERMETTENT PAS UNE MISE A LA TERRE PAR UNE BORNE NEUTRE, NECESSITENT L'UTILISATION D'UN CORDON D'ALIMENTATION A 4 FILS FIGURANT DANS LA LISTE UL. (Fig. 1). (Fig. 2). Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 5 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:576_ Mise sous tension ETAPE 2 : ACCES AU BrANCHEMENT DU COrDON D'ALIMENTATION Retirez le panneau d'accès situé à l'arrière et desserrez la vis à l'aide d'un tournevis. Vous pourrez alors accéder au bornier. Capot d'accès Bornier Classifi cation de l'équipement nécessaire à la mise sous tension Classifi cation générale, watts Classifi cation de l'équipement nécessaire à la mise sous tension, ampères Diamètre (pouces) de l'ouverture de connexion de la cuisinière 120 / 240 volts, 3 fi ls Cordon d'alimentation Gaine 8750 - 16500 40 ou 50 A 13/8” 11/8” Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 6 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:5802 MISE SOUS TENSION Mise sous tension _7 ETAPE 3 : INSTALLATION DU COrDON D'ALIMENTATION Pour les installations de cordons d'alimentation, branchez le dispositif de protection de câble sur l'orifi ce du cordon d'alimentation (13/8”) situé sous la partie arrière du tiroir. Insérez le cordon d'alimentation dans le dispositif et serrez-le. Protection contre la traction Cordon d'alimentation Plaque de raccordement des gaines • Le cordon d'alimentation doit être installé au moyen d'une protection contre la traction. • Fixez la protection à l'ouverture 13/8” située dans la plaque de raccordement des gaines. Installation d'un cordon d'alimentation à 3 fi ls AVERTISSEMENT AVERTISSEMENT La prise de terre ou la prise neutre du cordon d'alimentation doit être connectée à la borne neutre située au centre du bornier. Les câbles d'alimentation doivent être connectés aux bornes inférieures gauches et inférieures droites du bornier. 1. Retirez les 3 vis de la borne inférieure du bornier. 2. Insérez les 3 vis de la borne dans les bornes inférieures du bornier en passant par chacun des anneaux de la borne du cordon d'alimentation. Assurez-vous que le fi l central (blanc/neutre) est relié à l'emplacement central inférieur du bornier. 3. Serrez fermement les vis dans le bornier. NE retirez PAS la connexion du conducteur de terre. 4. Reportez-vous à l'étape 5 de la page 10 et procédez à l'installation. Conducteur de terre Borne neutre Noir Blanc rouge Noir Blanc rouge Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 7 2012-02-21 �� 6:48:598_ Mise sous tension Installation d'un cordon d'alimentation à 4 fi ls AVERTISSEMENT AVERTISSEMENT La prise neutre du circuit d'alimentation doit être connectée à la borne neutre située au centre inférieur du bornier. Les câbles d'alimentation doivent être connectés aux bornes inférieures gauches et inférieures droites du bornier. Le 4ème câble de mise à la terre doit être connecté au bâti de la cuisinière au moyen de la plaque et de la vis de masse. 1. Retirez les 3 vis de la borne inférieure du bornier. Retirez la vis et la plaque de terre et conservezles. 2. Coupez et éliminez le conducteur de terre. Ne jetez aucune vis. 3. Insérez la première vis de terre dans l'anneau de la borne du fi l de mise à la terre du cordon d'alimentation, en passant par la plaque de masse puis dans le bâti de la cuisinière. 4. Insérez les 3 vis de la borne (retirées précédemment) dans les bornes inférieures du bornier en passant par chacun des anneaux de la borne du cordon d'alimentation. Assurez-vous que le fi l central (blanc/neutre) est relié à l'emplacement central inférieur du bornier. Serrez fermement les vis dans le bornier. 5. Reportez-vous à l'étape 5 de la page 10 et procédez à l'installation. Conducteur de terre Plaque de terre Vis de terre Borne neutre Fil de terre (Vert) Blanc Noir rouge Noir Blanc rouge Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 8 2012-02-21 �� 6:49:0002 MISE SOUS TENSION Mise sous tension _9 ETAPE 4 : INSTALLATION DE LA GAINE Retirez la plaque de connexion de la gaine de la partie arrière du tiroir, puis faites-la pivoter comme indiqué ci-dessous. Vous devez utiliser l'orifi ce de la gaine (11/8 ”). 11/8” 13/8” 11 13/8” /8” 1. Préparez le cordon de la gaine comme le montre la fi gure 1. 2. Installez le cordon de la gaine comme le montre la fi gure 2. Plaque de raccordement des gaines Protection contre la traction Anneau Corps Figure 2 1” 31/2” 3/8” 1” 31/2” 3 fi ls 4 fi ls Surface d'éjection Figure 1 3/8” Pour les installations de gaine, insérez le câble de tension (non fourni) dans l'orifi ce de la gaine (11/8 ”). Faites ensuite passer le cordon de la gaine dans le dispositif de protection, puis serrez l'anneau. Réinstallez le support. Installation d'un conduit à 3 fi ls • Un fi l de bâtiment en aluminium peut être utilisé mais il devra être doté de l'intensité et de la tension nominales correctes permettant d'établir la connexion. Connectez les fi ls en suivant l'étape 4 selon le nombre de fi ls utilisé. • Les fi ls utilisés, les emplacements, les jonctions de fi ls, etc. doivent être conformes aux bonnes pratiques de câblage et aux codes locaux. 1. Desserrez les 3 vis de la borne inférieure du bornier. 2. Insérez l'extrémité du fi l nu (blanc/neutre) central dans l'emplacement inférieur central de l'ouverture du bornier. Sur certains modèles, le fi l devra être inséré dans l'ouverture du conducteur de terre puis dans l'emplacement inférieur central de l'ouverture du bornier. 3. Insérez les deux extrémités de fi l nu latérales dans les ouvertures inférieure gauche et inférieure droite du bornier. 4. Serrez les vis jusqu'à fi xation complète du fi l (35 à 50 pouce-livre). Ne serrez pas excessivement les vis sous peine d'endommager les fi ls. 5. Reportez-vous à l'étape 5 de la page 10 et procédez à l'installation. Noir Blanc rouge Conducteur de terre Borne neutre Extrémités des câbles rouge Blanc Noir Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 9 2012-02-21 �� 6:49:0110_ Mise sous tension Installation d'un conduit à 4 fi ls • Un fi l de bâtiment en aluminium peut être utilisé mais il devra être doté de l'intensité et de la tension nominales correctes permettant d'établir la connexion. Connectez les fi ls en suivant l'étape 4 selon le nombre de fi ls utilisé. • Les fi ls utilisés, les emplacements, les jonctions de fi ls, etc. doivent être conformes aux bonnes pratiques de câblage et aux codes locaux. 1. Desserrez les 3 vis de la borne inférieure du bornier. Retirez la vis et la plaque de terre et conservez-les. 2. Coupez et éliminez le conducteur de terre. Ne jetez aucune vis. 3. Insérez l'extrémité du fi l de terre nu entre le bâti de la cuisinière et la plaque de terre (retirée précédemment) et fi xez-la à l'aide de la vis de terre (retirée précédemment). 4. Insérez l'extrémité du fi l nu (blanc/neutre) dans l'emplacement inférieur central de l'ouverture du bornier. 5. Insérez les deux extrémités de fi l nu latérales dans les ouvertures inférieure gauche et inférieure droite du bornier. 6. Serrez les vis jusqu'à fi xation complète du fi l (35 à 50 pouce-livre). Ne serrez pas excessivement les vis sous peine d'endommager les fi ls. 7. Reportez-vous à l'étape 5 et procédez à l'installation. Conducteur de terre Plaque de terre Blanc Noir rouge Borne neutre Fil de terre (Vert) Extrémités des câbles Blanc Noir rouge ETAPE 5 : rEMISE EN PLACE DU PANNEAU D'ACCES Replacez le panneau d'accès à l'arrière de la cuisinière. Pour replacer la protection du câblage, insérez les deux saillies dans les orifi ces situés sous les ouvertures et serrez la vis. Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 10 2012-02-21 �� 6:49:03Installation de la cuisinière _11 03 INSTALLATION DE LA CUISINIERE Installation de la cuisinière INSTALLATION DU DISPOSITIF ANTI-BASCULEMENT AVERTISSEMENT AVERTISSEMENT Afi n de réduire les risques de basculement, fi xez la cuisinière en installant correctement le dispositif anti-basculement fourni avec cette dernière. • Reportez-vous aux consignes d'installation fournies avec le support. • Si elle n'est pas correctement installée, la cuisinière risque de basculer si vous trébuchez ou vous asseyez sur la porte. Les liquides chauds renversés ou la cuisinière elle-même sont susceptibles de provoquer des blessures. Support antibasculement La vis doit pénétrer dans le bois ou le béton *approximativement 21/32” (16.5 mm) *REMARQUE desserrez le pied de mise à niveau pour installer le support anti-basculement. Un dégagement minimum de 21/32" (16.5 mm) est nécessaire entre le dessous de la cuisinière et le sol de la cuisine. 1. Déterminez l'emplacement du support à l'aide du modèle. Le support anti-basculement est fourni avec un modèle. Les consignes comportent les informations nécessaires à l'installation. Lisez et suivez les consignes fi gurant sur la fi che (modèle) pour l'installation de la cuisinière. 2. Mise à niveau de la cuisinière Mettez la cuisinière à niveau en ajustant les pieds de réglage à l'aide d'une clé. Abaissement de la cuisinière Elévation de la cuisinière Pied de mise à niveau Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 11 2012-02-21 �� 6:49:0312_ Installation de la cuisinière 3. Vérifi cation des réglages Utilisez un niveau à bulle pour vérifi er vos réglages. Placez le niveau en diagonale sur la grille du four ou la surface de la cuisinère et vérifi ez le niveau dans chaque direction. 1. Vérifi ez la direction 1. 2. Vérifi ez la direction 2. Si le niveau à bulle n'est pas à niveau sur la grille du four ou la surface de cuisson, ajustez les pieds de mise à niveau à l'aide d'une clé. MISE AU POINT DE L'INSTALLATION • Placez la cuisinière suffi samment près de l'ouverture pour permettre le branchement de la prise. • Positionnez la cuisinière en vous assurant que le pied arrière gauche (ou arrière droit) se place sous le support anti-basculement. La distance entre la cuisinière et le mur doit être de 0" lorsque cette dernière est correctement installée. • Inclinez avec précaution la cuisinière vers l'avant afi n de vous assurer que le support antibasculement s'emboîte dans la fi xation arrière et que la cuisinière ne bascule pas. • Mettez l'appareil sous tension. Vérifi ez que la cuisinière fonctionne correctement comme indiqué dans le manuel d'utilisation. Support antibasculement Pied de mise à niveau DG68-00109F-01 Installation_XAC_DG68-00109F-01_EN+CFR.indb 12 2012-02-21 �� 6:49:04 SCX-4600 Series SCX-4623 Series Imprimante multifonction Mode d’emploi imaginez les possibilités Merci d’avoir fait l’acquisition de ce produit Samsung.Copyright_ 2 Copyright © 2009 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Tous droits réservés. Le présent mode d’emploi n’est fourni qu’à titre informatif. Toutes les informations communiquées ci-après sont susceptibles d’être modifiées sans préavis. Samsung Electronics ne saurait être tenu pour responsable des dommages, directs ou indirects, consécutifs à l’utilisation de ce guide. • Samsung et le logo Samsung sont des marques commerciales de Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. • Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Windows 7 et Windows 2008 Server R2 sont des marques déposées ou des marques commerciales de Microsoft Corporation. • TrueType, LaserWriter et Macintosh sont des marques commerciales d’Apple Computer, Inc. • Les autres noms de produit et de marque sont des marques commerciales de leurs propriétaires respectifs. Reportez-vous au fichier « LICENSE.txt » du CD-ROM fourni pour consulter les informations de licence Open Source. REV. 1.02Table des matières_ 3 Table des matières COPYRIGHT 2 TABLE DES MATIÈRES 3 9 Informations en matière de sécurité 14 Informations légales 23 A propos de ce mode d’emploi 25 Caractéristiques de votre nouvel appareil INTRODUCTION 27 27 Description de l’appareil 27 Vue avant 28 Vue arrière 29 Vue d'ensemble du panneau de commande (SCX-4623 Series) 30 Vue d’ensemble du panneau de commande (SCX-4600 Series) 31 Signification du voyant Statut 31 Présentation des touches utiles 31 Touche Menu 31 Touche d’Alimentation 31 Touche Impr. Écran 31 Mise en marche de l’appareil PRISE EN MAIN 32 32 Configuration du matériel 32 Logiciels fournis 33 Configuration requise 33 Windows 34 Macintosh 34 Linux 34 Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté via USB 34 Windows 35 Macintosh 36 Linux 36 Partage local de l’appareil 37 Windows 37 Macintosh CONFIGURATION RÉSEAU 38 38 Environnement réseau 38 Présentation des programmes réseau utiles 38 SyncThru™ Web Service 38 SyncThru™ Web Admin Service 38 Samsung AnyWeb Print 38 SetIP 38 Utilisation d’un réseau câblé 38 Impression d’un rapport de configuration réseau 39 Création d’une adresse IP 40 Paramétrage des valeurs réseau 40 Restauration des paramètres usine par défaut 41 Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB 41 Windows 42 Macintosh 43 Linux 43 Configuration IPv6 43 Activation d’IPv6Table des matières Table des matières_ 4 43 Paramétrage des adresses IPV6 44 Connexion de SyncThru™ Web Service CONFIGURATION DE BASE 45 45 Réglage de l’altitude 45 Modification de la langue d’affichage 45 Paramétrage de la date et de l’heure 46 Modification du mode d’horloge 46 Modification du mode par défaut 46 Configuration des sons 46 Haut-parleur, sonnerie, bips de touches et bip d’avertissement 46 Volume du haut-parleur 46 Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique 46 Saisie de caractères alphanumériques 47 Lettres et chiffres du clavier 47 Correction de numéros ou de noms 47 Insertion d’une pause 47 Utilisation des modes d’économie 47 Utilisation de la fonctionnalité d’économie de toner 47 Utilisation de la fonctionnalité d’économie d’énergie 47 Réglage du bac et du papier par défaut 47 Au panneau de commande 48 Dans l’ordinateur 48 Réglage du délai d’expiration de la tâche SUPPORTS ET BACS 49 49 Préparation des originaux 49 Mise en place des originaux 49 Sur la vitre d’exposition 50 Dans le chargeur de documents 50 Sélection du support d’impression 50 Recommandations pour sélectionner le support d’impression 50 Formats de support pris en charge dans chaque mode 51 Modification du format du bac 51 Chargement de papier dans le bac 51 Bac 1 52 Bac manuel 52 Impression sur supports spéciaux 53 Enveloppe 53 Transparent 54 Étiquettes 54 Papiers cartonnés ou de format personnalisé 54 Papier à en-tête/papier pré-imprimé 54 Photo 54 Brillant 55 Réglage du type et du format de papier 55 Réglage du format de papier 55 Réglage du type de papier 55 Réglage de la source de papier 55 Utilisation du support de sortie papier 55 Empilement ferme des feuilles 56 Récupération d’une impression de petite taille IMPRESSION 57 57 Fonctions des pilotes d’impression 57 Pilote d’impression 57 Impression de base 58 Annulation d’une impressionTable des matières Table des matières_ 5 58 Ouverture des préférences d’impression 58 Utilisation d’un réglage favori 59 Utilisation de l’aide 59 Utilisation des fonctions d’impression spéciales 59 Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille 59 Impression d’affiches 59 Impression de documents reliés (manuelle) 60 Impression recto verso (manuelle) 60 Modification des proportions de votre document 60 Impression d’un document sur un format de papier donné 60 Impression de filigranes 61 Utilisation de la surimpression 62 Options avancées 62 Modification des réglages d’impression par défaut 62 Définition de votre appareil comme appareil par défaut 62 Impression dans un fichier (PRN) 63 Impression Macintosh 63 Impression d’un document 63 Modification des paramètres de l’imprimante 64 Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille 64 Impression Linux 64 Impression à partir d’applications 64 Impression de fichiers 65 Configuration des propriétés de l’imprimante COPIE DE DOCUMENTS 66 66 Copie de base 66 Changer le réglage pour chaque copie 66 Modification du contraste 66 Sélection du type des originaux 66 Réduction ou agrandissement de copies 67 Changer les réglages de copie par défaut 67 Utilisation des fonctions de copie spéciales 67 Copie de cartes d’identité 68 Copie de type 2 pages ou 4 pages (pages multiples) 68 Copie de type Affiche 68 Copie de type Clone 68 Effacement des images de fond 69 Choix de la forme de sortie de la copie 69 Réglage du délai de réinitialisation de copie NUMÉRISATION 70 70 Méthode de numérisation de base 70 Numérisation d’originaux et envoi vers votre ordinateur (NUMER. VERS PC) 70 Pour les appareils connectés via USB 71 Pour un appareil connecté au réseau 71 Utilisation du Gestionnaire de scan Samsung 71 Onglet Définir bouton de numérisation 72 Onglet Modifier port 72 Numérisation avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN 72 Numérisation avec le pilote WIA 72 Windows XP 72 Windows Vista 73 Windows 7 73 Numérisation Macintosh 73 Numérisation en USBTable des matières Table des matières_ 6 73 Numérisation en réseau 74 Numérisation Linux 74 Numérisation 74 Ajout de paramètres Job Type 75 Utilisation du Image Manager TÉLÉCOPIE 76 76 Préparation à l’envoi de télécopie 76 Utilisation d’une télécopie sur votre ordinateur 76 Envoi d’une télécopie 77 Réception d’une télécopie 77 Envoi d’une télécopie sur votre appareil 77 Réglage de l’en-tête de télécopie 78 Envoi d’une télécopie 78 Envoi manuel d’une télécopie 78 Confirmation d’une transmission 78 Recomposition automatique 78 Recomposition du dernier numéro 78 Envoi d’une télécopie vers plusieurs destinataires 79 Envoi d’une télécopie différée 79 Envoi d’une télécopie prioritaire 80 Réception d’une télécopie sur votre appareil 80 Modification des modes de réception 80 Réception manuelle en mode Tél 80 Réception automatique en mode Répondeur/Télécopie 80 Réception manuelle de télécopies avec un téléphone auxiliaire 81 Réception des télécopies en mode DRPD 81 Réception en mode de réception sécurisée 81 Activation du mode de réception sécurisée 81 Réception de télécopies en mémoire 81 Configuration des paramètres de document 82 RESOLUTION 82 LUMINOSITE 82 Transfert d’une télécopie vers une autre destination 82 Transfert d’une télécopie envoyée vers une autre destination 82 Transfert d’une télécopie reçue vers une autre destination 83 Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses 83 Numéros de composition abrégée 83 Numéros de composition de groupe 84 Recherche d’une entrée dans le Carnet d’adresses 84 Impression automatique d’un rapport de télécopie ÉTAT DE L’APPAREIL ET CARACTÉRISTIQUES AVANCÉES 85 85 Configuration de fax 85 Modification des options de configuration de télécopie 85 Envoi 86 Réception 87 Modifier défaut 87 Journal auto 87 Configuration de copie 87 Modification des options de configuration de copie 87 Modifier défaut 87 Impression d’un journal 88 Effacement de la mémoire 89 Réseau 89 Présentation des menusTable des matières Table des matières_ 7 OUTILS DE GESTION 91 91 Présentation des outils de gestion utiles 91 Utilisation de SyncThru™ Web Service 91 Accès à SyncThru™ Web Service 91 Présentation de SyncThru™ Web Service 91 Paramétrage des informations de contact 92 Utilisation du programme Smart Panel 92 Présentation de Smart Panel 92 Modification des paramètres du programme Smart Panel 92 SmarThru 93 Démarrage de SmarThru 93 Utilisation de SmarThru 94 Utilisation du programme SetIP 94 Windows 94 Macintosh 94 Linux 95 Utilisation de Linux Unified Driver Configurator 95 Ouverture d’Unified Driver Configurator 95 Printers configuration 96 Scanners configuration 96 Ports configuration MAINTENANCE 97 97 Impression d’un journal de l’appareil 97 Suivi de la durée de vie des consommables 97 Utilisation de l’alerte pour toner faible 97 Trouver le numéro de série 97 Nettoyage de l’appareil 98 Nettoyage de l’extérieur 98 Nettoyage de l’intérieur 98 Nettoyage du scanner 99 Stockage de la cartouche de toner 99 Instructions de manipulation 99 Utilisation de cartouches de toner d’une autre marque que Samsung et rechargées 99 Durée de vie estimée d’une cartouche 99 Conseils pour déplacer et ranger l’appareil DÉPANNAGE 100 100 Redistribution du toner 101 Suppression des bourrages d’original 102 Astuces pour éviter les voilages du papier 102 Astuces pour éviter les bourrages papier 102 Résolution des bourrages papier 102 Dans le bac 1 102 Dans le bac d’alimentation manuel 103 À l’intérieur de l’appareil 103 À la sortie papier 104 Signification des messages d’erreur 104 Vérification des messages à l’écran 108 Résolution d’autres problèmes 108 Problèmes d’alimentation 108 Problèmes d’alimentation papier 109 Problèmes d’impression 111 Problèmes de qualité d’impression 114 Problèmes de copie 114 Problèmes de numérisation 115 Problèmes de télécopieTable des matières Table des matières_ 8 115 Problème du Gestionnaire de scan Samsung 116 Problèmes Windows courants 116 Problèmes Linux courants 118 Problèmes Macintosh courants FOURNITURES ET ACCESSOIRES 119 119 Comment commander 119 Consommables disponibles 119 Pièces de rechange disponibles 120 Remplacement de la cartouche de toner 121 Vérification de la durée de vie des consommables CARACTÉRISTIQUES TECHNIQUES 122 122 Caractéristiques techniques du matériel 123 Caractéristiques techniques environnementales 123 Caractéristiques techniques électriques 124 Spécifications des supports d’impression CONTACT SAMSUNG WORLDWIDE 125 GLOSSAIRE 127 INDEX 133Informations en matière de sécurité_ 9 Informations en matière de sécurité Ces avertissements et précautions sont inclus afin d’éviter des blessures pour vous et d’autres personnes, ainsi que pour éviter des dommages potentiels à votre appareil. Veillez à lire et à comprendre toutes ces instructions avant d’utiliser l’appareil. Faites preuve de bon sens lors de l’utilisation d’appareils électriques et chaque fois que vous utilisez votre appareil. Observez en outre toutes les mises en garde et instructions mentionnées sur le produit et dans la documentation qui l’accompagne. Une fois que vous avez lu cette section, conservez-la pour pouvoir vous y reporter par la suite. Important symboles de sécurité Cette section explique la signification des icônes et des signes de ce guide de l’utilisateur. Ces symboles de sécurité sont dans l’ordre, suivant le degré de danger. Explication des icônes et des signes utilisés dans le guide de l’utilisateur : Avertissement Situations dangereuses ou à risques pouvant entraîner des blessures graves ou la mort. Mise en garde Situations dangereuses ou à risques pouvant entraîner des blessures légères ou des dommages matériels. Ne pas essayer. Ne pas démonter. Ne pas toucher. Débranchez la prise d’alimentation de la prise murale. Assurez-vous que votre appareil est branché sur une prise de courant reliée à la terre. Contactez le service de maintenance pour obtenir de l’aide. Suivez les instructions à la lettre.Informations en matière de sécurité_ 10 Environnement d’exploitation Avertissement Ne pas utiliser si le câble d’alimentation électrique est endommagé ou si la prise électrique n’est pas reliée à la terre. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Ne pliez pas le câble d’alimentation électrique et ne placez pas d’objets lourds dessus. ► Le fait de marcher sur le câble d’alimentation électrique ou de l’écraser avec un objet lourd peut occasionner une décharge électrique ou un incendie. Ne rien poser sur l’appareil (eau, objets métalliques, objets lourds, bougies, cigarettes allumées, etc.). ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Ne retirez pas la fiche en tirant sur le câble ; ne manipulez pas la prise avec des mains mouillées. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Si l’appareil surchauffe, libère de la fumée, émet des bruits étranges, ou produit une odeur bizarre : coupez immédiatement l’interrupteur d’alimentation et débranchez l’appareil. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Mise en garde Pendant un orage ou pendant une période de non-fonctionnement, retirez la fiche d’alimentation de la prise de courant. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Si la fiche n’entre pas facilement dans la prise, ne forcez pas pour l’insérer. ► Appelez un électricien pour changer la prise de courant, sous peine de décharge électrique possible. Faites attention, la zone de sortie papier est chaude. ► Vous pouvez vous brûler. Veillez à ce qu’aucun animal domestique ne ronge les cordons d’alimentation, de téléphone et d’interface PC. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie et/ou de blessure pour votre animal domestique. Si on a laissé tomber l’appareil, ou si le boîtier semble endommagé, débranchez toutes les connexions de l’appareil et demandez une assistance auprès du personnel de service qualifié. ► Dans le cas contraire, il y a un risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Si l’appareil ne fonctionne pas correctement après avoir suivi ces instructions, débranchez toutes les connexions de l’appareil et demandez une assistance auprès du personnel de service qualifié. ► Dans le cas contraire, il y a un risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Si l’appareil présente un changement visible et brusque du niveau de performance, débranchez toutes les connexions de l’appareil et demandez une assistance auprès du personnel de service qualifié. ► Dans le cas contraire, il y a un risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie.Informations en matière de sécurité_ 11 Méthode d’utilisation Mise en garde Ne tirez pas avec force sur la feuille durant l’impression. ► Vous risquez d’endommager l’appareil. Lors de l’impression de grandes quantités, la partie inférieure de la zone de sortie papier peut devenir chaude. Ne laissez pas des enfants y toucher. ► Vous pouvez vous brûler. Faites attention de ne pas mettre la main entre l’appareil et le bac d’alimentation papier. ► Vous pourriez vous blesser. Lorsque vous retirez du papier coincé, évitez d’utiliser des objets métalliques pointus. ► Cela pourrait endommager l’appareil. N’obstruez pas l’orifice de ventilation et n’y poussez pas d’objets. ► La température des composants risquerait d’augmenter et pourrait provoquer des dommages ou un incendie. Ne laissez pas le papier s’empiler sur le réceptacle de sortie. ► Cela pourrait endommager l’appareil. Faites attention lorsque vous remplacez du papier ou que vous retirez du papier coincé. ► Les bords d’une feuille neuve sont tranchants et peuvent provoquer des coupures douloureuses. Le dispositif d’interruption d’’alimentation de cet appareil est son câble d’alimentation électrique. ► Pour couper l’alimentation, retirez le câble d’alimentation électrique de la prise électrique. Informations en matière de sécurité_ 12 Installation/déplacement Avertissement Ne placez pas l’appareil dans un endroit poussiéreux, humide ou sujet à des fuites d’eau. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Mise en garde Avant de déplacer l’appareil, éteignez-le et débranchez tous les cordons. Puis levez l’appareil : •si le poids de l’appareil est inférieur à 20 kg, une seule personne suffit ; •si le poids de l’appareil est de 20 kg, deux personnes sont nécessaires ; •si le poids de l’appareil est supérieur à 40 kg, 4 personnes sont nécessaires. ► L’appareil pourrait tomber et être endommagé ou blesser quelqu’un. Ne couvrez pas l’appareil et ne le placez pas dans un endroit confiné comme un placard. ► Si l’appareil n’est pas bien ventilé, il y a un risque d’incendie. Ne placez pas l’appareil sur une surface instable. ► L’appareil pourrait tomber et être endommagé ou blesser quelqu’un. Branchez directement le câble d’alimentation électrique dans une prise de courant correctement reliée à la terre. ► Dans le cas contraire, il y a un risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. L’appareil doit être connecté au niveau de puissance indiqué sur l’étiquette. ► En cas de doute et si vous voulez vérifier le niveau de puissance utilisé, contactez le service d’électricité. Ne branchez pas un trop grand nombre d’appareils électriques sur une même prise murale ou sur une même rallonge. ► Une prise surchargée réduit les performances et constitue une source potentielle d’incendie et de décharges électriques. Utilisez exclusivement du câble AWG N°26a a.AWG : American Wire Gauge ou un câble de téléphone plus grand, si nécessaire. ► Dans le cas contraire, vous risquez d’endommager l’appareil. Pour un fonctionnement sûr, utilisez le câble d’alimentation électrique fourni avec votre appareil. Si vous utilisez un câble de plus de 2 mètres avec un appareil 140 V, le calibre doit être 16 AWG ou plus grand. ► Dans le cas contraire, l’appareil peut être endommagé et il y a un risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie.Informations en matière de sécurité_ 13 Entretien/contrôle Mise en garde Débranchez l’appareil de la prise secteur avant de nettoyer l’intérieur. Ne nettoyez pas l’appareil avec du benzène, du diluant pour peinture ou de l’alcool ; ne pulvérisez pas de l’eau directement dans l’appareil. ► Risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Gardez les produits de nettoyage hors de portée des enfants. ► Ils peuvent se blesser. Lorsque vous effectuez une tâche dans l’appareil pour remplacer des consommables ou nettoyer l’intérieur, ne le faites pas fonctionner. ► Vous pourriez vous blesser. Ne démontez pas, ne réparez pas et ne remontez pas l’appareil vous-même. ► Cela pourrait endommager l’appareil. Appelez un technicien agréé lorsque l’appareil doit être réparé. Gardez le câble d’alimentation et la surface de contact de la fiche exempts de poussière ou d’eau. ► Dans le cas contraire, il y a un risque de décharge électrique ou d’incendie. Pour nettoyer et faire fonctionner l’appareil, respectez à la lettre le guide d’utilisateur fourni avec l’appareil. ► Dans le cas contraire, vous pourriez endommager l’appareil. Ne retirez jamais les couvercles ou protections fixés avec des vis. ► L’appareil doit exclusivement être réparé par un technicien de maintenance Samsung. Utilisation des consommables Mise en garde Ne démontez pas la cartouche de toner. ► Les particules de toner peuvent être dangereuses si vous les inhalez ou les ingérez. Lorsque vous rangez les consommables comme les cartouches de toner, gardez-les hors de portées de enfants. ► Les particules de toner peuvent être dangereuses si vous les inhalez ou les ingérez. Ne brûlez aucun consommable comme une cartouche de toner ou une unité de chauffe. ► Cela pourrait provoquer une explosion ou déclencher un incendie incontrôlable. L’utilisation de consommables recyclés, comme le toner, peut endommager l’appareil. ► En cas de dommage lié à l’utilisation de consommables recyclés, des frais seront imputés. Lorsque vous changez la cartouche de toner ou que vous retirez un papier bloqué, faites attention de ne pas vous salir ou salir vos vêtements avec le toner. ► Les particules de toner peuvent être dangereuses si vous les inhalez ou les ingérez. Si du toner se dépose sur vos vêtements, n’utilisez pas d’eau chaude pour les laver. ► L’eau chaude fixe le toner sur le tissu. Utilisez de l’eau froide. Informations légales_ 14 Informations légales Cet appareil est certifié avec plusieurs déclarations légales. Avertissement relatif à la sécurité laser Cet appareil est certifié conforme aux spécifications DHHS 21 CFR, chapitre 1, sous-chapitre J pour les produits laser de classe I (1) aux États-Unis, et certifié dans les autres pays comme un produit laser de classe I, conformément aux spécifications IEC 825. Les produits laser de classe I ne sont pas considérés comme dangereux. Le système laser et l’imprimante sont conçus de manière à interdire tout accès aux rayonnements laser au-dessus d’un niveau de classe I pendant l’exploitation normale, les interventions de maintenance utilisateur, dans les conditions d’utilisation spécifiées. AVERTISSEMENT N’utilisez jamais l’imprimante après avoir retiré le capot protecteur du module laser/scanner. Le faisceau lumineux, bien qu’invisible, pourrait endommager vos yeux. Lors de l’utilisation de cet appareil, ayez toujours à l’esprit les recommandations de sécurité suivantes, afin de réduire les risques d’incendie, de décharge électrique et d’autres accidents corporels : Consignes de sécurité relatives à l’ozone En mode d’utilisation normal, cet appareil génère de l’ozone. Cette production ne présente aucun risque pour l’utilisateur. Toutefois, il est préférable d’utiliser l’appareil dans un local correctement aéré. Pour obtenir des informations complémentaires sur l’ozone, contactez votre revendeur Samsung le plus proche. AVERTISSEMENT CONCERNANT LE PERCHLORATE Cet avertissement concernant le Perchlorate s’applique uniquement aux piles au lithium à CR (Dioxyde de manganèse) primaire dans le produit vendu ou distribué UNIQUEMENT en Californie. Matériau à base de perchlorate – une manipulation spéciale peut être applicable. Voir www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate. (États-Unis uniquement).Informations légales_ 15 Économie d’énergie Cette imprimante est dotée d’un dispositif perfectionné d’économie d’énergie réduisant la consommation électrique en période d’inactivité. Lorsque l’imprimante ne reçoit pas de données pendant un certain temps, la consommation électrique est réduite automatiquement. ENERGY STAR et la marque ENERGY STAR sont des marques déposées aux États-Unis. Pour plus d’informations sur le programme ENERGY STAR, reportez-vous au site http://www.energystar.gov. Recyclage Veuillez recycler ou jeter les emballages de ce produit dans le respect de l’environnement. Chine uniquement Les bons gestes de mise au rebut de ce produit (Déchets d’équipements électriques et électroniques) (Applicable dans les pays de l’Union Européenne et dans d’autres pays européens pratiquant le tri sélectif) Le symbole sur le produit, les accessoires ou la documentation indique que le produit et ses accessoires électroniques (par ex. chargeur, écouteurs, câble USB) ne doivent pas être éliminés en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. Pour éviter toute atteinte à l’environnement ou à la santé des personnes due à une mise au rebut non contrôlée, veuillez séparer ces éléments des autres déchets et les recycler afin de promouvoir une réutilisation durable des ressources matérielles. Les particuliers doivent contacter le revendeur chez qui ils ont acheté le produit ou l’administration appropriée pour s’informer sur le lieu et le moyen de recycler ces éléments tout en préservant l’environnement. Les entreprises et professionnels sont invités à contacter leurs fournisseurs et à consulter les conditions de leur contrat de vente. Cet appareil et ses accessoires électroniques ne doivent pas être mélangés avec d’autres déchets commerciaux lors de leur mise au rebut. Élimination des batteries de ce produit (Applicable aux pays de l’Union européenne et aux autres pays européens dans lesquels des systèmes de collecte sélective sont mis en place) Le symbole sur la batterie, le manuel ou l’emballage indique que les batteries de ce produit ne doivent pas être éliminées en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. Lorsqu’ils sont inscrits, les symboles chimiques Hg, Cd ou Pb indiquent que la batterie contient une dose de mercure, de cadmium ou de plomb supérieure à ce que prévoit la directive européenne 2006/66. Si les batteries en question ne sont pas éliminées correctement, ces substances peuvent être nocives pour la santé humaine et pour l’environnement. Afin de protéger les ressources naturelles et d’encourager la réutilisation du matériel, veillez à séparer les batteries des autres types de déchets et à les recycler via votre système local de collecte gratuite des batteries.Informations légales_ 16 Taïwan uniquement Émissions radioélectriques Réglementation FCC Cet appareil est conforme à l’alinéa 15 de la réglementation FCC. Son exploitation ou utilisation est sujette aux deux conditions suivantes : • Cet appareil ne doit pas provoquer d’interférences nuisibles. • Cet appareil doit accepter toute interférence reçue, y compris les interférences pouvant provoquer un fonctionnement indésirable. Ce matériel a été testé et satisfait aux limites s’appliquant aux appareils numériques de classe B, en vertu des dispositions de l’alinéa 15 de la réglementation FCC. Ces limites visent à assurer une protection raisonnable contre les interférences en zone résidentielle. Cet appareil génère, utilise et peut émettre de hautes fréquences radio et, s’il n’est pas installé et utilisé conformément aux instructions, peut provoquer des perturbations dans les communications radio. Il est toutefois possible que son utilisation dans un environnement domestique génère de nombreuses interférences. Le cas échéant, l’utilisateur devra faire le nécessaire pour les éliminer et prendra toutes les dépenses afférentes à sa charge. Si cet appareil provoque des interférences sur la réception radio ou télévision lors de sa mise sous tension et hors tension, essayez de résoudre le problème en adoptant l’une des mesures suivantes : • Réorientez ou repositionnez l’antenne de réception. • Éloignez l’équipement du récepteur. • Branchez l’appareil sur une prise différente de celle du récepteur. • Consultez votre distributeur ou un technicien radio/télévision qualifié pour obtenir de l’aide. Tout changement ou modification effectué sans l’accord exprès du fabricant pourrait annuler la capacité de l’utilisateur à utiliser cet équipement. Réglementations canadiennes relatives aux interférences radio Cet appareil numérique ne dépasse pas les limites de Classe B pour les émissions de parasites radio par des appareils numériques, telles que définies dans la norme sur les équipements provoquant des interférences intitulée « Digital Apparatus », ICES-003 de l’Industry and Science Canada. Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques applicables aux appareils numériques de Classe B prescrites dans la norme sur le matériel brouilleur : « Appareils Numériques », ICES-003 édictée par l’Industrie et Sciences Canada. Russie uniquementInformations légales_ 17 Allemagne uniquement Marquage des télécopies Le Telephone Consumer Protection Act de 1991 rend illégal l’utilisation par quiconque d’un ordinateur ou de tout autre appareil électronique pour envoyer des messages via un télécopieur, sans qu’ils ne stipulent clairement dans la marge haute ou basse de chaque page, ou sur la première page transmise les informations suivantes : 1. La date et l’heure de transmission. 2. Le nom de l’entreprise, de l’entité commerciale ou du particulier qui envoie le message. 3. Le numéro de téléphone de la machine émettrice, de l’entreprise, de l’entité commerciale ou du particulier. Votre opérateur télécom peut modifier ses équipements de communication, leur fonctionnement ou certaines procédures lorsqu’il l’estime nécessaire dans la limite du raisonnable et tant que cela n’est pas en contradiction avec l’alinéa 68 de la réglementation FCC. Si, pour un client, il est logique de penser que de telles modifications risquent d’entraîner l’incompatibilité de certains de ses terminaux avec les équipements de communication de l’opérateur, de rendre nécessaire leur modification ou leur altération, ou d’avoir des conséquences matérielles quelconques sur leur utilisation ou leurs performances, ce client est en droit d’en être informé par écrit de façon adéquate, afin de lui permettre de prendre les mesures visant à une utilisation ininterrompue des terminaux en question. Indice REN L’indice REN (« Ringer Equivalence Number » – Indice d’équivalence de la sonnerie) et le numéro d’enregistrement FCC de cet appareil se trouvent sur l’étiquette placée dessous ou derrière la machine. Dans certains cas, vous pouvez être amené à fournir ces numéros à l’opérateur télécom. L’indice REN indique la charge électrique placée sur la ligne téléphonique. Il permet de déterminer les éventuelles surcharges. L’installation de plusieurs types d’équipement sur la même ligne téléphonique peut causer des problèmes pour les appels téléphoniques entrants et sortants, en particulier la sonnerie en cas d’appel. Pour un service optimal de l’opérateur télécom, la somme des indices REN de tous ces équipements doit être inférieure à cinq. Dans certains cas, la somme de cinq équipements peut ne pas permettre l’utilisation de la ligne. Si un élément de votre équipement téléphonique ne fonctionne pas correctement, débranchez-le immédiatement de la ligne téléphonique car il peut endommager le réseau téléphonique. Cet équipement est conforme à la section 68 de la réglementation FCC et aux exigences adoptées par l'ACTA. La partie arrière de cet équipement présente une étiquette mentionnant, entre autres, l’identifiant du produit au format américain : AAAEQ##TXXXX. En cas de besoin, vous devez indiquer ce numéro à l'opérateur télécom. La réglementation FCC indique que les changements ou modifications de cet équipement qui n’auraient pas pu être expressément approuvés par le fabricant peuvent priver l’utilisateur du droit de l’utiliser. Si un terminal endommage le réseau téléphonique, l’opérateur télécom doit prévenir le client que le service risque d’être interrompu. Toutefois, lorsqu’il n’est pas possible de donner un préavis, l’opérateur peut interrompre temporairement le service s’il : a) Prévient rapidement le client. b) Donne au client la possibilité de remédier au problème d’équipement. c) Informe le client de son droit à porter plainte auprès de la commission fédérale de la communication conformément aux procédures définies dans la sous-partie E de l’alinéa 68 de la réglementation FCC. Vous devez aussi savoir que : • Votre télécopieur Samsung n’est pas conçu pour être connecté à un système PBX (autocommutateur privé) numérique. • Si vous envisagez d’utiliser un modem d’ordinateur ou de télécopieur sur la même ligne téléphonique que votre télécopieur, tous les appareils peuvent présenter des problèmes de transmission et de réception. À part un téléphone, il est recommandé de ne pas installer d’autre appareil sur la même ligne que le télécopieur. • Si la foudre affecte souvent une région ou que les surtensions y sont fréquentes, il est recommandé d’installer des parasurtenseurs pour les lignes électrique et téléphonique. Vous pouvez les acheter auprès de votre revendeur ou dans des magasins spécialisés dans la téléphonie ou l’électronique. • Avant de programmer les numéros d’urgence et/ou de les tester, prévenez le régulateur de ces services en l’appelant sur un numéro autre que les numéros d’urgence. Il vous donnera des instructions sur la façon de tester le numéro d’urgence. • Cet appareil ne peut pas être utilisé avec les services payants ou sur des lignes partagées. • Ce téléphone dispose de couplage magnétique avec les appareils de correction auditive. Vous pouvez connecter cet appareil au réseau téléphonique en toute sécurité à l’aide d’une prise modulaire standard de type USOC RJ-11C.Informations légales_ 18 Remplacement de la prise (Royaume-Uni uniquement) Important Les fils électriques de cet appareil sont équipés d’une fiche électrique standard de 13 A (BS 1363) et d’un fusible de 13 A. Lorsque vous changez ou examinez le fusible, vous devez replacer le fusible de 13 A approprié. Vous devez ensuite replacer le capuchon du fusible. Si vous avez perdu le capuchon du fusible, n’utilisez pas la prise avant d’avoir replacé un autre capuchon. Prenez contact avec le détaillant qui vous a vendu l’appareil. La fiche électrique la plus utilisée au Royaume-Uni est la prise de 13 A. Cependant, certains bâtiments (particulièrement les plus anciens) ne disposent pas de prises de courant de 13 A. Vous devez alors vous procurer un adaptateur approprié. Ne retirez pas la fiche moulée d’origine. Si la fiche monocoque est endommagée, débarrassez-vous en immédiatement. Il n’est pas possible de la réparer et vous risqueriez de recevoir une décharge électrique si vous la branchiez dans une prise. Avertissement important Cet appareil doit être relié à la terre. Le code de couleurs suivant est appliqué aux fils des branchements électriques : • Vert et jaune : terre • Bleu : neutre • Brun : phase Si les fils de votre système électrique ne correspondent pas aux couleurs indiquées sur la fiche, procédez comme suit : Connectez le fil vert et jaune à la broche portant la lettre « E », le symbole de mise à la terre, la couleur verte ou les couleurs jaune et verte. Connectez le fil bleu à la broche signalée par la lettre « N » (neutre) ou par la couleur noire. Connectez le fil marron à la broche signalée par la lettre « L » ou par la couleur rouge. Un fusible de 13 A doit être présent dans la fiche, dans l’adaptateur ou sur le tableau électrique.Informations légales_ 19 Déclaration de conformité CE Approbations et certifications Le marquage CE apposé sur ce télécopieur signifie que Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. a déclaré l’appareil conforme aux directives 93/68/CEE de l’Union Européenne suivantes : Par la présente, Samsung Electronics déclare que l'appareil est conforme aux exigences essentielles et aux autres dispositions pertinentes de : SCX-4600 Series: Directive basse tension (2006/95/CE), Directive EMC (2004/108/CE). SCX-4623 Series: Directive R&TTE (1999/5/CE). Vous pouvez consulter cette déclaration de conformité sur www.samsung.com/printers. Accédez à Assistance > téléchargements et entrez le nom de votre imprimante (MFP) pour parcourir cette déclaration. 1er janvier 1995 : Directive 2006/95/EC du Conseil de l’UE, harmonisation des lois des États membres relatives aux équipements basse tension. 1er janvier 1996 : Directive 2004/108/EC (92/31/CEE) du Conseil de l’UE, harmonisation des lois des États membres relatives à la compatibilité électromagnétique. 9 mars 1999 : Directive 1999/5/CE relative à la conformité des équipements radios et des terminaux de télécommunications. Vous pouvez vous procurer le texte complet de la déclaration, décrivant en détail ces différentes directives et les normes correspondantes, auprès de votre distributeur Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Certification CE Certification de conformité à la Directive 1999/5/CE relative aux équipements radio et terminaux de télécommunications (FAX). Cet équipement Samsung a été auto-certifié par Samsung pour la connexion en Europe d’un terminal simple au réseau téléphonique commuté (RTPC) en conformité avec la Directive 1999/5/CE. Il a été prévu pour fonctionner sur le réseau téléphonique public commuté français et sur les autocommutateurs privés compatibles des pays européens : En cas de problème, il convient de contacter en premier lieu le laboratoire européen QA de Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Ce produit a été testé en fonction des normes TBR21. Pour faciliter l’utilisation et la mise en œuvre de tout équipement terminal compatible avec ces normes, l’Institut européen des normes de télécommunications (ETSI) a édité un document consultatif (EG 201 121) contenant des remarques et des obligations supplémentaires destinées à assurer la compatibilité totale des terminaux TBR21 avec les réseaux. Ce produit a été conçu en fonction et dans le respect total de toutes les informations applicables contenues dans ce document.Informations légales_ 20 Licence OpenSSL Copyright © 1998-2001 The OpenSSL Project. Tous droits réservés. La redistribution et l’emploi sous forme de code source et binaire, modifié ou non, sont autorisés si les conditions suivantes sont respectées : 1. La redistribution du code source implique d’inclure la déclaration de copyright ci-dessus, cette liste de conditions et la clause exonératoire suivante. 2. La redistribution sous forme binaire doit reprendre la déclaration de copyright précédente, cette liste de condition et la clause d’exonération de responsabilité suivante dans la documentation et/ou tout autre matériau fourni avec la distribution. 3. Tout support publicitaire mentionnant ou utilisant ce logiciel doit faire mention de la déclaration suivante : « Ce produit contient un logiciel développé par OpenSSL Project et inclus dans le OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/) ». 4. Toute utilisation des noms « OpenSSL Toolkit » et « OpenSSL Project » dans le but de promouvoir des produits dérivés de ce logiciel ou d’en faire de la publicité est formellement interdite sans 5. autorisation écrite préalable. Pour obtenir une autorisation écrite, veuillez vous adresser à openssl-core@openssl.org. 6. Les produits dérivés de ce logiciel ne peuvent s’appeler « OpenSSL » ni comporter « OpenSSL » dans leur nom sans autorisation écrite préalable de OpenSSL Project. 7. La redistribution, sous quelque forme que ce soit, doit mentionner la déclaration suivante : « Ce produit inclut un logiciel développé par OpenSSL Project pour une utilisation dans OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/) ». CE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI PAR THE OpenSSL PROJECT EN L’ÉTAT ET TOUTE GARANTIE EXPRESSE OU TACITE, Y COMPRIS MAIS SANS S’Y LIMITER, TOUTE GARANTIE IMPLICITE RELATIVE À LA QUALITÉ MARCHANDE ET À L’ADAPTATION À UN USAGE PARTICULIER EST REJETÉE. THE OpenSSL PROJECT OU SES COLLABORATEURS NE POURRONT EN AUCUN CAS ÊTRE TENUS POUR RESPONSABLES DE DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCIDENTELS, SPÉCIAUX, EXEMPLAIRES NI SECONDAIRES QUELS QU’ILS SOIENT (Y COMPRIS MAIS SANS S’Y LIMITER, LES DOMMAGES CAUSÉS PAR UNE PERTE D’USAGE, DE DONNÉES OU DE BÉNÉFICES, AU REMPLACEMENT DE MARCHANDISES OU DE SERVICES, OU À L’INTERRUPTION DE L’ACTIVITÉ), ET CE QUELLE QU’EN SOIT LA CAUSE OU LA RESPONSABILITÉ THÉORIQUE, QUE CETTE RESPONSABILITÉ SOIT DE NATURE CONTRACTUELLE, DÉLICTUELLE OU QUASI DÉLICTUELLE, OU QU’IL S’AGISSE D’UNE RESPONSABILITÉ SANS FAUTE OU RELEVANT D’UNE AUTRE CATÉGORIE (Y COMPRIS LA NÉGLIGENCE), SUITE À L’UTILISATION SOUS QUELQUE FORME QUE CE SOIT DE CE LOGICIEL, MÊME SI LA POSSIBILITÉ D’UN TEL DOMMAGE AVAIT ÉTÉ MENTIONNÉE. Ce produit inclut un logiciel cryptographique développé par Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). Ce produit inclut un logiciel développé par Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).Informations légales_ 21 Licence originale SSLeay Copyright © 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). Tous droits réservés. Ce progiciel est une implémentation SSL écrite par Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). L’implémentation a été écrite de façon à être compatible Netscapes SSL. Cette bibliothèque est gratuite pour un usage commercial et non commercial pour autant que les conditions suivantes soient respectées. Les conditions suivantes s’appliquent à tout le code présent dans cette distribution, à savoir le code RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc. ; pas seulement le code SSL. La documentation SSL incluse dans cette distribution est régie par les mêmes conditions de droits d’auteur, si ce n’est que le détenteur est Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). Les droits d’auteur demeurent la propriété d’Eric Young. Aucune information de droits d’auteur ne peut donc être retirée du code. Si ce progiciel est utilisé dans un produit, Eric Young doit être nommé comme auteur des parties de la bibliothèque utilisée. Il peut s’agir d’un message textuel au démarrage du programme dans la documentation (en ligne ou papier) fournie avec l’ensemble. La redistribution et l’emploi sous forme de code source et binaire, modifié ou non, sont autorisés si les conditions suivantes sont respectées : 1. La redistribution du code source implique d’inclure la déclaration de copyright ci-dessus, cette liste de conditions et la clause exonératoire suivante. 2. La redistribution sous forme binaire doit reprendre la déclaration de copyright précédente, cette liste de condition et la clause d’exonération de responsabilité suivante dans la documentation et/ou tout autre matériau fourni avec la distribution. 3. Tout support publicitaire mentionnant ou utilisant ce logiciel doit faire mention de la déclaration suivante : « Ce produit inclut un logiciel cryptographique écrit par Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) ». Le terme « cryptographique » peut être omis si les routines de la bibliothèque utilisée n’ont pas un caractère cryptographique. 4. Si vous incluez un code spécifique à Windows (ou un de ses dérivés) provenant du répertoire apps (code d’application) vous devez inclure un accusé de réception : « Ce produit contient un logiciel développé par Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com) ». CE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI PAR ERIC YOUNG AS EN L’ÉTAT ET TOUTE GARANTIE EXPRESSE OU TACITE, Y COMPRIS MAIS SANS S’Y LIMITER, TOUTE GARANTIE IMPLICITE RELATIVE À LA QUALITÉ MARCHANDE ET À L’ADAPTATION À UN USAGE PARTICULIER EST REJETÉE. L’AUTEUR OU SES COLLABORATEURS NE POURRONT EN AUCUN CAS ÊTRE TENUS POUR RESPONSABLES DE DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCIDENTELS, SPÉCIAUX, EXEMPLAIRES NI SECONDAIRES QUELS QU’ILS SOIENT (Y COMPRIS MAIS SANS S’Y LIMITER, LES DOMMAGES CAUSÉS PAR UNE PERTE D’USAGE, DE DONNÉES OU DE BÉNÉFICES, AU REMPLACEMENT DE MARCHANDISES OU DE SERVICES, OU À L’INTERRUPTION DE L’ACTIVITÉ), ET CE QUELLE QU’EN SOIT LA CAUSE OU LA RESPONSABILITÉ THÉORIQUE, QUE CETTE RESPONSABILITÉ SOIT DE NATURE CONTRACTUELLE, DÉLICTUELLE OU QUASI DÉLICTUELLE, OU QU’IL S’AGISSE D’UNE RESPONSABILITÉ SANS FAUTE OU RELEVANT D’UNE AUTRE CATÉGORIE (Y COMPRIS LA NÉGLIGENCE), SUITE À L’UTILISATION SOUS QUELQUE FORME QUE CE SOIT DE CE LOGICIEL, MÊME SI LA POSSIBILITÉ D’UN TEL DOMMAGE AVAIT ÉTÉ MENTIONNÉE. La licence et les termes de distribution pour toute version disponible publiquement de ce code ne peuvent pas être changés, c’est-à-dire que ce code ne peut pas simplement être copié et placé dans une autre licence publique (y compris la licence publique GNU).Informations légales_ 22 Chine uniquementA propos de ce mode d’emploi_ 23 A propos de ce mode d’emploi Ce mode d’emploi fournit des informations sur l’utilisation de l’appareil. Les novices comme les utilisateurs professionnels peuvent s’y reporter pour l’installation et l’utilisation de l’appareil. • Lisez les informations de sécurité avant d’utiliser l’appareil. • Si vous rencontrez un problème d’utilisation de l’appareil, reportez-vous au chapitre de dépannage (voir « Dépannage » à la page 100). • Les termes utilisés dans ce guide de l’utilisateur sont expliqués dans le chapitre du glossaire (voir « Glossaire » à la page 127). • Toutes les illustrations de ce mode d’emploi peuvent être différentes de votre appareil en fonction de ses options ou du modèle. • Les procédures de ce mode d’emploi sont principalement basées sur Windows XP. Convention Certains termes sont utilisés de manière interchangeable dans ce mode d’emploi, comme ci-dessous : • « Document » est synonyme d’« original ». • « Papier » est synonyme de « support » ou de « support d’impression ». • « Appareil » se rapporte à une imprimante ou une imprimante multifonctions. Vous trouverez les conventions utilisées dans ce guide récapitulées dans le tableau ci-dessous : Convention Description Exemple Gras Pour les textes apparaissant à l’écran ou les noms des boutons sur l’appareil. DEMAR Remarque Donne des informations supplémentaires ou des spécifications détaillées des fonctions et fonctionnalités de l’appareil. Le format de la date peut varier d’un pays à l’autre. Mise en garde Informe les utilisateurs des risques éventuels de dommages mécaniques ou de dysfonctionnements de l’imprimante. Ne touchez pas la partie inférieure verte de la cartouche de toner. Note de bas de page Donne des informations détaillées sur certains mots ou certaines expressions. a. pages par minute (« Référence ») Renvoie les utilisateurs à une page de référence pour des informations détaillées supplémentaires. (Voir Recherche d’autres informations.)A propos de ce mode d’emploi_ 24 Recherche d’autres informations Les ressources suivantes vous proposent, soit à l’écran, soit sous forme imprimée, des informations concernant la configuration et l’utilisation de l’appareil. Nom du document Description Guide d’installation rapide Ce guide fournit des informations de base sur l’installation de votre appareil. Mode d’emploi Ce guide fournit des instructions pas à pas pour utiliser toutes les fonctions de l’appareil, et contient des informations pour l’entretien et le dépannage, ainsi que pour le remplacement de consommables. Aide du pilote de l’appareil Cette aide fournit une assistance sur le pilote d’impression et des instructions concernant la configuration des propriétés pour l’impression (voir « Utilisation de l’aide » à la page 59). Site Web de Samsung Si vous avez accès à Internet, vous pouvez obtenir l’aide, le support, les pilotes de l’appareil, les manuels ou les informations de commande nécessaires sur le site Web Samsung, www.samsung.com/printer. Logiciels téléchargeables Vous pouvez télécharger des logiciels utiles à partir du site Web de Samsung. • SyncThruTM Web Admin Service : Pratique pour les administrateurs réseau qui ont besoin de gérer de nombreux appareils simultanément. Ce programme ne concerne que le modèle réseau. (http://solution.samsungprinter.com) • Samsung AnyWeb Print : Permet aux utilisateurs individuels de facilement capturer à l’écran la fenêtre du site Web dans Windows Internet Explorer. (http://solution.samsungprinter.com/personal/anywebprint)Caractéristiques de votre nouvel appareil_ 25 Caractéristiques de votre nouvel appareil Votre nouvel appareil est doté de fonctionnalités améliorant la qualité des documents que vous imprimez. Fonctions spéciales Impression rapide et de haute qualité • Vous pouvez imprimer jusqu’à une résolution effective de 1 200 × 1 200 points par pouce. • Vous pouvez imprimer jusqu’à 22 ppm sur du papier au format A4 et 23 ppm sur du papier au format Letter. Prise en charge de plusieurs types de support d’impression • Le bac manuel prend en charge le papier ordinaire en divers formats, le papier à en-tête, les enveloppes, les étiquettes, des supports de format personnalisé, des cartes postales, et du papier lourd. • Le bac de 250 feuilles prend en charge le papier ordinaire. Création de documents professionnels • Impression de filigranes. Vous pouvez personnaliser vos documents avec des mots tels que « Confidentiel » (voir « Impression de filigranes » à la page 60). • Impression d’affiches. Le texte et les images de chaque page de votre document sont agrandis et imprimés sur plusieurs feuilles de papier qui peuvent être collées ensemble pour former une affiche (voir « Impression d’affiches » à la page 59). • Vous pouvez utiliser des formulaires préimprimés avec du papier ordinaire (voir « Utilisation de la surimpression » à la page 61). Gain de temps et d’argent • Pour économiser du papier, vous pouvez imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille (voir « Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille » à la page 59). • Cet appareil économise l’électricité en réduisant considérablement la consommation électrique lorsqu’il n’est pas utilisé. • Afin d’économiser le papier, vous pouvez imprimer sur les deux faces de chaque feuille (impression manuelle) (voir « Impression recto verso (manuelle) » à la page 60). Impression sous différents environnements • Vous pouvez imprimer sur divers systèmes d’exploitation tels que Windows, Linux et Macintosh (voir « Configuration requise » à la page 33). • Votre appareil est équipé d’une interface USB et d’une interface réseau. Reproduction de documents originaux sous plusieurs formats • Votre appareil peut reproduire plusieurs copies d’un original sur une seule feuille (voir « Copie de type 2 pages ou 4 pages (pages multiples) » à la page 68). • Vous pouvez régler et améliorer simultanément la qualité d’impression et la taille de l’image. Numérisation des originaux et envoi sur-le-champ • Numérisez en couleur et recourez à la compression précise des formats JPEG, TIFF et PDF. • Numérisez rapidement des fichiers et envoyez-les à plusieurs destinataires via le réseau (voir « Pour un appareil connecté au réseau » à la page 71). Définition d’un jour et d’une heure spécifiques pour l’envoi d’une télécopie • Vous avez la possibilité d’indiquer le jour et l’heure d’envoi d’une télécopie ainsi que d’effectuer l’envoi à plusieurs destinataires enregistrés. • Vous pouvez configurer l’appareil pour l’impression de journaux des télécopies une fois celles-ci envoyées. IPv6 Cet appareil prend en charge IPv6.Caractéristiques de votre nouvel appareil_ 26 Fonctionnalités par modèle Cet appareil est conçu pour répondre à tous vos besoins documentaires, de l’impression à la copie, en passant par des solutions réseau avancées destinées à votre activité commerciale. Certains composants et fonctions en option peuvent être indisponibles en fonction du modèle ou du pays. Les fonctionnalités par modèle incluent : FONCTIONS SCX-4600(K) SCX-4605K SCX-4610K SCX-4623F(K) SCX-4623FN SCX-4623FH Impression ● ● ● ● Impression recto verso (manuelle) ● ● ● ● Copie ● ● ● ● TÉLÉCOPIE ● ● ● Télécopie PC réseau ● ● ● Télécopie vers PC (Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung) ● ● ● Composition combiné raccroché ● ● ● Combiné ● USB 2.0 ● ● ● ● Carte LAN filaire Ethernet 10/100 Base TX ● IPv6 ● SyncThru™ Web Service ● Impression écran ● ● ● Chargeur de documents ● ● ● (●: Inclus, ○ : optionnel, vierge : non disponible) Introduction_ 27 1.Introduction Ce chapitre vous présente brièvement l’appareil. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Description de l’appareil • Vue d'ensemble du panneau de commande (SCX-4623 Series) • Vue d’ensemble du panneau de commande (SCX-4600 Series) • Signification du voyant Statut • Présentation des touches utiles • Mise en marche de l’appareil Description de l’appareil Vue avant Selon le modèle, cette illustration peut différer de votre appareil. 1 Capot du chargeur de documentsa a.SCX-4623F(K), SCX-4623FN, SCX-4623FH 6 Poignée du capot avant 11 Bac de sortie des documents 16 Vitre d’exposition 2 Guides de largeur du chargeur de documentsa 7 Poignée 12 Panneau de commande 17 Combinéb b.SCX-4623FH 3 Bac d’alimentation du chargeur de documentsa 8 Bac 1 13 Cartouche de toner 18 Module de numérisation 4 Réceptacle de sortie du chargeur de documentsa 9 Bac manuel 14 Guides de largeur papier du chargeur manuel 19 Bouton de fermeture du module de numérisationc c. Ce bouton est utilisé pour fermer le module de numérisation. 5 Support de sortie papier 10 Capot avant 15 Cache du scannerIntroduction_ 28 Vue arrière Selon le modèle, cette illustration peut différer de votre appareil. 1 Port réseaua a.SCX-4623FN 5 Prise d’alimentation 2 Port USB 6 Capot arrière 3 Connecteur téléphoniqueb b.SCX-4623F(K), SCX-4623FN, SCX-4623FH 7 Poignée du capot arrière 4 Prise gigogne (EXT)bIntroduction_ 29 Vue d'ensemble du panneau de commande (SCX-4623 Series) Selon le modèle, ce panneau de commande peut différer de celui de votre appareil. 1 Duo Copie Vous pouvez copier les deux faces d’un document officiel, par exemple un permis de conduire, sur une même page (voir « Copie de cartes d’identité » à la page 67). 2 Impr. Écran Imprime l’écran actif qui s’affiche sur le moniteur (voir « Touche Impr. Écran » à la page 31). (SCX-4623F(K), SCX-4623FH uniquement). Réduc./Agrand. Permet de réduire ou d’agrandir la copie par rapport à l’original. (SCX-4623FN uniquement). 3 Affichage Permet d’afficher l’état de la tâche en cours et des messages. 4 Statut Permet d’afficher l’état de l’appareil (voir « Signification du voyant Statut » à la page 31). 5 (Fax) Active le mode télécopie. 6 (Copie) Active le mode copie. 7 (Numérisation) Active le mode numérisation. 8 Flèches Permettent de faire défiler les options disponibles dans le menu sélectionné et d’augmenter ou de diminuer des valeurs. 9 Menu Permet d’accéder aux menus et de les faire défiler (voir « État de l’appareil et caractéristiques avancées » à la page 85). 10 OK Permet de confirmer la sélection à l’écran. 11 Retour Permet de revenir au menu supérieur. 12 Clavier numérique Permet de composer les numéros de fax et de saisir le nombre de copies souhaitées ou d’autres options. 13 Répertoire Vous permet d’enregistrer les numéros de télécopie fréquemment utilisés ou de rechercher des numéros de télécopie enregistrés. 14 Bis/Pause En mode veille, recompose le dernier numéro. Également en mode édition, insère une pause dans un numéro de télécopie. 15 Ligne Vous permet de composer un numéro avec le combiné posé. 16 Départ Permet de lancer une tâche. 17 Arrêter/Suppr. Permet d’interrompre une opération à tout moment. Une fenêtre contextuelle s’affiche à l’écran, indiquant la tâche en cours que l’utilisateur peut interrompre ou reprendre. 18 Alimentation Permet de mettre l’appareil sous et hors tension (voir « Touche d’Alimentation » à la page 31).Introduction_ 30 Vue d’ensemble du panneau de commande (SCX-4600 Series) Selon le modèle, ce panneau de commande peut différer de celui de votre appareil. 1 Affichage Permet d’afficher l’état de la tâche en cours et des messages. 2 Statut Permet d’afficher l’état de l’appareil (voir « Signification du voyant Statut » à la page 31). 3 Flèches Permettent de faire défiler les options disponibles dans le menu sélectionné et d’augmenter ou de diminuer des valeurs. 4 Menu Permet d’accéder aux menus et de les faire défiler (voir « État de l’appareil et caractéristiques avancées » à la page 85). 5 OK Permet de confirmer la sélection à l’écran. 6 Retour Permet de revenir au menu supérieur. 7 Duo Copie Vous pouvez copier les deux faces d’un document officiel, par exemple un permis de conduire, sur une même page (voir « Copie de cartes d’identité » à la page 67). 8 Vers: Envoie des données numérisées (voir « Numérisation d’originaux et envoi vers votre ordinateur (NUMER. VERS PC) » à la page 70). 9 Impr. Écran Imprime l’écran actif qui s’affiche sur le moniteur (voir « Touche Impr. Écran » à la page 31). 10 Arrêter/Suppr. Permet d’interrompre une opération à tout moment. Une fenêtre contextuelle s’affiche à l’écran, indiquant la tâche en cours que l’utilisateur peut interrompre ou reprendre. 11 Départ Permet de lancer une tâche. 12 Alimentation Permet de mettre l’appareil sous et hors tension (voir « Touche d’Alimentation » à la page 31).Introduction_ 31 Signification du voyant Statut La couleur du voyant indique l’état actuel de l’appareil. Statut Description Désactivé • L’appareil est déconnecté. • L’appareil est en mode économie d’énergie. Dès que l’appareil reçoit des données ou qu’une touche est sélectionnée, l’appareil se remet automatiquement en ligne. Vert Clignotant • Un clignotement lent indique que l’appareil reçoit des données de l’ordinateur. • Un clignotement rapide indique que l’appareil imprime des données. Fixe L’appareil est connecté et il est prêt à être utilisé. Rouge Clignotant • Un léger dysfonctionnement est survenu et l’appareil est en attente jusqu’à ce qu’il soit corrigé. Consultez le message d’erreur. Dès que le problème est résolu, l’appareil reprend la tâche interrompue. • Il reste une petite quantité de toner dans la cartouche. L’autonomie estimée de la cartouchea a.L’autonomie estimée de la cartouche signifie l’autonomie attendue ou estimée de la cartouche de toner, ce qui indique la capacité moyenne d’impression. Elle est définie conformément à la norme ISO/IEC 19752. Le nombre de pages peut varier en fonction de l’environnement d’exploitation, du délai entre chaque impression, ainsi que du type et du format des supports. Un peu de toner peut rester dans la cartouche, même lorsque le message Fin de vie Rempl nouv cart apparaît, et l’imprimante arrête l’impression. (Voir www.samsung.com/printer pour obtenir des informations récentes.) est presque atteinte. Préparez une nouvelle cartouche en vue de son remplacement. Vous pouvez améliorer provisoirement la qualité d’impression en redistribuant le reste du toner. (Voir « Redistribution du toner » à la page 100.) Fixe • Une cartouche de toner a pratiquement atteint son autonomie estimée.a . Il est recommandé de remplacer la cartouche de toner (voir « Remplacement de la cartouche de toner » à la page 120). • Un bourrage papier s’est produit (voir « Résolution des bourrages papier » à la page 102). • Le capot est ouvert. Fermez le capot. • Le bac est vide. Insérez du papier dans le bac. • L’appareil s’est arrêté à la suite d’une erreur grave. Consultez le message d’erreur (voir « Signification des messages d’erreur » à la page 104). Samsung ne recommande pas l’utilisation de cartouches de toner non-Samsung, telles que les cartouches rechargées ou réusinées. Samsung ne peut garantir la qualité des cartouches de toner non-Samsung. Tout entretien ou réparation requis suite à l’utilisation de cartouches de toner non-Samsung ne sera pas couvert par la garantie de l’appareil. Vérifiez le message sur l’écran. Suivez les instructions du message ou reportez-vous au dépannage (voir « Signification des messages d’erreur » à la page 104). Si le problème persiste, contactez le service de maintenance. Toutes les erreurs d’impression doivent apparaître dans la fenêtre du programme Smart Panel. Si le problème persiste, contactez le service de maintenance. Présentation des touches utiles Touche Menu Lorsque vous souhaitez connaître l’état de l’appareil et régler votre appareil pour utiliser une fonctionnalité avancée, cliquez sur la touche Menu (voir « État de l’appareil et caractéristiques avancées » à la page 85). Touche d’Alimentation Lorsque vous souhaitez mettre hors tension, appuyez sur cette touche jusqu’à ce que Hors tension s’affiche. Choisissez OUI, pour mettre hors tension. Cette touche peut également servir à mettre l’appareil sous tension. Statut Description Désactivé • L’appareil est en mode prêt. • L’appareil est éteint. Activé L’appareil est en mode économie d’énergie. Touche Impr. Écran Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Appuyez sur la touche Impr. Écran : Message Description Active L’appareil imprime l’écran actif qui s’affiche sur le moniteur. Plein L’appareil imprime l’ensemble de l’écran qui s’affiche sur le moniteur. • La page sera imprimée sur le format par défaut (A4, Lettre, par exemple). • Vous ne pouvez utiliser cette fonction qu’avec un appareil connecté via un port USB. • Impr. Écran ne peut être utilisé qu’avec les systèmes d’exploitation Windows et Mac OS. • Vous ne pouvez utiliser cette fonction que si le pilote de l’appareil est installé. Mise en marche de l’appareil Branchez le cordon d’alimentation. L’appareil se mettra en marche. Si vous souhaitez mettre l’appareil hors tension, appuyez sur la touche Alimentation jusqu’à ce que Hors tension s’affiche. Prise en main_ 32 2.Prise en main Ce chapitre vous guide pas à pas dans la procédure de paramétrage de l’appareil connecté via USB et des logiciels. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Configuration du matériel • Logiciels fournis • Configuration requise • Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté via USB • Partage local de l’appareil Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Configuration du matériel Ce chapitre décrit les étapes de configuration du matériel, comme elles sont présentées dans le Guide d’installation rapide. En premier lieu, veillez à lire le Guide d’installation rapide et effectuez les étapes suivantes : 1. Choisissez un emplacement approprié. Installez votre copieur sur un support horizontal et stable en laissant suffisamment d’espace pour la circulation de l’air. Prévoyez un espace supplémentaire pour l’ouverture des capots et des bacs. Cet emplacement doit être bien aéré et à l’abri de toute exposition directe à la lumière du soleil, ou de toute source de chaleur, de froid et d’humidité. Évitez d’installer votre appareil près du bord de votre plan de travail. L’impression est adaptée pour des zones avec une altitude inférieure à 1 000 m. Reportez-vous au réglage d’altitude pour optimiser votre impression (voir « Réglage de l’altitude » à la page 45). Installez votre copieur sur un support horizontal et stable et ne le laissez pas s’incliner à plus de 2 mm. Sinon, la qualité d’impression peut être affectée. 2. Déballez l’appareil, puis contrôlez les éléments inclus. 3. Retirez toute la bande adhésive. 4. Installez la cartouche de toner. 5. Chargez du papier (voir « Chargement de papier dans le bac » à la page 51). 6. Vérifiez que les câbles sont correctement connectés à l’appareil. 7. Mettez l’appareil sous tension. Cet équipement ne fonctionnera pas en cas de panne secteur. Logiciels fournis Après avoir configuré et connecté votre appareil à votre ordinateur, vous devez installer le logiciel de l’appareil. Si vous utilisez un système d’exploitation Windows ou Mac OS, installez le logiciel depuis le CD fourni. Si vous utilisez Linux, téléchargez le logiciel du site Web de Samsung (www.samsung.com/printer) et installez-le. Les logiciels des appareils sont parfois mis à jour en raison du lancement d’un nouveau système d’exploitation, etc. Si nécessaire, téléchargez la version la plus récente du site web de Samsung (www.samsung.com/printer).Système d’exploita tion Contenu Windows • Pilote d’impression : ce pilote permet d’exploiter toutes les fonctions de votre appareil. • Pilote de numérisation : les pilotes TWAIN et WIA (Windows Image Acquisition) sont disponibles pour numériser des documents à partir de votre appareil. • Smart Panel : ce programme vous permet de surveiller l’état de l’appareil et vous avertit lorsqu’un dysfonctionnement survient en cours d’impression. • SmarThrua : a.Permet d’éditer une image numérisée selon différentes méthodes, à l’aide d’un puissant programme de retouche d’images, puis d’envoyer l’image par e-mail. Vous pouvez aussi ouvrir un autre programme de retouche d’images, comme Adobe Photoshop, depuis SmarThru. Pour plus de détails, reportez-vous à l’aide à l’écran du programme SmarThru (voir « SmarThru » à la page 92). ce programme est le logiciel conçu pour Windows, qui accompagne votre appareil multifonction. • Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung : vous avez accès aux informations sur le programme Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie et sur l’état du pilote de numérisation installé. • SetIP : ce programme permet de configurer les adresses TCP/IP de l’appareil. Macintosh • Pilote d’impression : ce pilote permet d’exploiter toutes les fonctions de votre appareil. • Pilote de numérisation : le pilote TWAIN est disponible pour la numérisation de documents sur votre appareil. • Smart Panel : ce programme vous permet de surveiller l’état de l’appareil et vous avertit lorsqu’un dysfonctionnement survient en cours d’impression. • Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung : vous avez accès aux informations sur le programme Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie et sur l’état du pilote de numérisation installé. • SetIP : ce programme permet de configurer les adresses TCP/IP de l’appareil. Linux • Unified Linux Driver : ce pilote permet d’exploiter toutes les fonctions de votre appareil. • SANE : utilisez ce pilote pour numériser des documents. • Smart Panel : ce programme vous permet de surveiller l’état de l’appareil et vous avertit lorsqu’un dysfonctionnement survient en cours d’impression. • SetIP : ce programme permet de configurer les adresses TCP/IP de l’appareil. Prise en main_ 33 Configuration requise Avant de commencer, assurez-vous que votre système répond aux conditions ci-dessous : Windows Votre appareil prend en charge les systèmes d’exploitation Windows suivants. SYSTÈME D’EXPLOITATI ON Configuration (recommandée) Processeur RAM Espace disque disponible Windows 2000 Pentium II 400 MHz (Pentium III 933 MHz) 64 Mo (128 Mo) 600 Mo Windows XP Pentium III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 Mo (256 Mo) 1,5 Go Windows Server 2003 Pentium III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 Mo (512 Mo) 1,25 Go à 2 Go Windows Server 2008 Pentium IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz) 512 Mo (2 048 Mo) 10 Go Windows Vista Pentium IV 3 GHz 512 Mo (1 024 Mo) 15 Go Windows 7 Processeur Pentium IV 1 GHz 32 bits ou 64 bits ou supérieur 1 Go (2 Go) 16 Go • Prise en charge DirectX 9 avec 128 Mo de mémoire (pour activer le thème Aero) • Lecteur de DVD-R/W Windows Server 2008 R2 Processeurs Pentium IV 1 GHz (x86) ou 1,4 GHz (x64) (2 GHz ou plus rapide) 512 Mo (2 048 Mo) 10 Go • Pour tous les systèmes d’exploitation Windows, Internet Explorer 5.5 ou supérieur doit être installé sur l’ordinateur. • Les utilisateurs qui disposent des droits d’administrateur peuvent installer le logiciel. • Windows Terminal Services est compatible avec cet appareil.Prise en main_ 34 Macintosh SYSTÈME D’EXPLOITA TION Configuration (recommandée) Processeur RAM Espace disque disponible Mac OS X 10.3 à 10.4 • Processeurs Intel • PowerPC G4/ G5 • 128 Mo pour un Mac équipé d’un processeur PowerPC (512 Mo) • 512 Mo pour un Mac équipé d’un processeur Intel (1 Go) 1 Go Mac OS X 10.5 • Processeurs Intel • Processeur PowerPC G4/ G5 à 867 MHz ou plus rapide 512 Mo (1 Go) 1 Go Mac OS X 10.6 • Processeurs Intel 1 Go (2 Go) 1 Go Linux Élément Configuration requise Système d’exploitation RedHat Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64 bits) Fedora Core 2 à 10 (32/64 bits) SuSE Linux 9.1 (32 bits) OpenSuSE 9.2, 9.3, 10.0, 10.1, 10.2, 10.3, 11.0, 11.1 (32/64 bits) Mandrake 10.0, 10.1 (32/64 bits) Mandriva 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 (32/64 bits) Ubuntu 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04, 8.10 (32/64 bits) SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 9, 10 (32/64 bits) Debian 3.1, 4.0, 5.0 (32/64 bits) Processeur Pentium IV 2,4 GHz (IntelCore2) RAM 512 Mo (1 024 Mo) Espace disque disponible 1 Go (2 Go) • Vous avez également besoin d’une partition de swap d’au moins 300 Mo si vous souhaitez travailler sur des images numérisées volumineuses. • Le pilote de numérisation Linux prend en charge la résolution optique maximale. Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté via USB Un appareil local est un appareil directement connecté à votre ordinateur à l’aide du câble USB. Si votre appareil est relié à un réseau, ignorez les étapes suivantes et passez à l’installation du pilote de l’appareil connecté à un réseau (voir « Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB » à la page 41). • Installation personnalisée vous permet de choisir les programmes à installer. • Utilisez uniquement un câble USB ne dépassant pas 3 m. Windows Vous pouvez installer le logiciel d’impression à l’aide de la méthode standard ou personnalisée. Les étapes suivantes sont recommandées pour la plupart des utilisateurs qui utilisent un appareil directement raccordé à l’ordinateur. Tous les composants nécessaires aux opérations de l’appareil seront installés. 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. Si la fenêtre Assistant Matériel détecté apparaît durant la procédure d’installation, fermez-la en cliquant sur , en haut à droite, ou sur Annuler. 2. Insérez le CD de logiciels dans le lecteur. • Le CD de logiciels s’exécute automatiquement et la fenêtre d’accueil s’affiche à l’écran. • Si la fenêtre d’installation ne s’affiche pas, cliquez sur Démarrer puis sur Exécuter. Tapez X:\Setup.exe, en remplaçant « X » par la lettre qui représente votre lecteur. Cliquez sur OK. • Si vous utilisez Windows Vista, Windows 7 ou Windows 2008 Server R2, cliquez sur Démarrer > Tous les programmes > Accessoires > Exécuter. Saisissez X:\Setup.exe, en remplaçant « X » par la lettre représentant le lecteur, puis cliquez sur OK. • Si la fenêtre Exécution automatique s’affiche sous Windows Vista, cliquez sur Exécuter Setup.exe dans le champ Installer or exécuter un programme, et cliquez sur Continuer dans les fenêtres Contrôle de compte d’utilisateurateur. • Si la fenêtre Exécution automatique s’affiche sous Windows 7 ou Windows 2008 Server R2, cliquez sur Exécuter Setup.exe dans le champ Installer or exécuter un programme, et cliquez sur Oui dans les fenêtres Contrôle de compte d’utilisateur. 3. Sélectionnez Installer maintenant. Au besoin, sélectionnez une langue dans la liste déroulante.Prise en main_ 35 4. Lisez le Contrat de licence et sélectionnez J’accepte les dispositions du contrat de licence. Ensuite, cliquez sur Suivant. Le programme recherche l’appareil. Si votre appareil n’est pas connecté à l’ordinateur, un message d’erreur s’affiche. • Une fois l’appareil connecté, cliquez sur Suivant. • Si vous ne souhaitez pas connecter l’appareil pour l’instant, cochez la case en regard de Vérifiez si vous souhaitez installer les logiciels sans connecter l’imprimante au réseau ou localement. La fenêtre « Imprimer une page de test » est alors ignorée et l’installation terminée. • La fenêtre d’installation présentée dans ce Mode d’emploi peut différer de celle qui apparaît sur votre écran. Cela dépend de l’appareil et de l’interface utilisés. 5. Lorsque la fenêtre de confirmation de la connexion de l’imprimante s’affiche, vérifiez le nom de l’imprimante et cliquez sur Suivant. 6. Une fois l’installation terminée, une fenêtre vous demandant d’imprimer une page de test apparaît. Si vous choisissez d’imprimer une page de test, cliquez sur le bouton puis sur Suivant. 7. Si la page s’imprime correctement, cliquez sur Oui. Sinon, cliquez sur Non pour relancer l’impression. 8. Pour vous inscrire en tant qu’utilisateur de l’appareil et recevoir des informations de Samsung, cliquez sur Inscription en ligne. 9. Cliquez sur Terminer. Si le pilote d’impression ne fonctionne pas correctement, procédez comme suit pour le réparer ou le réinstaller. a) Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. b) Dans le menu Démarrer, sélectionnez Programmes ou Tous les programmes > Samsung Printers > le nom de votre pilote d’impression > Maintenance. c) Sélectionnez l’option souhaitée, puis suivez les instructions qui s’affichent dans la fenêtre. Macintosh Le CD de logiciels livré avec votre appareil contient les fichiers de pilote vous permettant d’utiliser le pilote CUPS ou le pilote PostScript (disponible uniquement si vous utilisez un appareil prenant en charge les pilotes PostScript) pour imprimer à partir d’un Macintosh. Il fournit également le pilote TWAIN pour la numérisation sur un ordinateur Macintosh. 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Insérez le CD de logiciels dans le lecteur. 3. Double-cliquez sur l’icône CD-ROM qui apparaît sur le bureau du Macintosh. 4. Double-cliquez sur le dossier MAC_Installer. 5. Double-cliquez sur l’icône Installer OS X. 6. Saisissez le mot de passe et cliquez sur OK. 7. La fenêtre du programme d’installation Samsung s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Continuer. 8. Lisez le contrat de licence et cliquez sur Continuer. 9. Cliquez sur J’accepte pour accepter les termes du contrat de licence. 10.Sélectionnez Installation standard et cliquez sur Programme d’installation => Installer (10.4). L’option Installation standard est recommandée pour la plupart des utilisateurs. Tous les composants nécessaires aux opérations de l’appareil seront installés. Lorsque vous choisissez Installation personnalisée, vous pouvez installer les composants de votre choix. 11.Lorsqu'un message avertissant de la fermeture de toutes les applications en cours d’exécution sur votre ordinateur apparaît, cliquez sur Continuer. Si une fenêtre vous demandant de sélectionner un type d’installation s’affiche, sélectionnez Installation standard sur imprimante locale et cliquez sur OK. 12.Une fois l’installation terminée, cliquez sur Quitter. Si vous avez installé le pilote de numérisation, cliquez sur Redémarrer. 13.Ouvrez le dossier Applications > Utilitaires > Configuration d’imprimante. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, ouvrez le dossier Applications > Préférences Système et cliquez sur Imprimantes et fax. 14.Cliquez sur Ajouter dans la Liste des imprimantes. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, appuyez sur l’icône « + » ; une fenêtre d’affichage apparaît. 15.Sous Mac OS X 10.3, sélectionnez l’onglet USB. • Sous Mac OS X 10.4, cliquez sur Navigateur par défaut et recherchez la connexion USB. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, cliquez sur Par défaut et recherchez la connexion USB. 16.Sous Mac OS X 10.3, si la sélection automatique ne fonctionne pas correctement, sélectionnez Samsung dans Modèle de l’imprimante et votre nom d’appareil dans Nom de modèle. • Sous Mac OS X 10.4, si la sélection automatique ne fonctionne pas correctement, sélectionnez Samsung dans Imprimer via et votre nom d’appareil dans Modèle. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, si la sélection automatique ne fonctionne pas correctement, sélectionnez Sélectionner un gestionnaire à utiliser..., puis le nom de votre imprimante dans Imprimer via. Votre appareil apparaît dans la Liste des imprimantes et est défini comme imprimante par défaut. 17.Cliquez sur Ajouter. Si le pilote d’impression ne fonctionne pas correctement, désinstallez-le et réinstallez-le. Pour Mac OS, procédez comme suit pour désinstaller le pilote. a) Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. b) Insérez le CD de logiciels dans le lecteur. c) Double-cliquez sur l’icône CD-ROM qui apparaît sur le bureau du Macintosh. d) Double-cliquez sur le dossier MAC_Installer. e) Double-cliquez sur l’icône Installer OS X. f) Saisissez le mot de passe et cliquez sur OK. g) La fenêtre du programme d’installation Samsung s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Continuer. h) Sélectionnez Désinstaller et cliquez sur Désinstaller. i) Lorsqu'un message avertissant de la fermeture de toutes les applications en cours d’exécution sur votre ordinateur apparaît, cliquez sur Continuer. j) Une fois la désinstallation terminée, cliquez sur Quitter.Prise en main_ 36 Linux Vous devez télécharger les packages de logiciels Linux du site Web de Samsung pour installer le logiciel de l’imprimante. Suivez les étapes ci-dessous pour installer le logiciel. Installation du pilote Linux unifié 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Lorsque la fenêtre Administrator Login apparaît, entrez root dans le champ Login et entrez le mot de passe du système. Vous devez vous connecter en tant que super-utilisateur (root) pour installer le pilote de l’appareil. Si vous ne disposez pas du statut de super-utilisateur, contactez votre administrateur système. 3. Depuis le site Web de Samsung, téléchargez le package Unified Linux Driver sur votre ordinateur et décompressez-le. 4. Cliquez sur en bas du bureau. Lorsque l’écran Terminal apparaît, tapez : [root@localhost root]#tar zxf [CheminAccèsFichier]/ UnifiedLinuxDriver.tar.gz[root@localhost root]#cd [CheminAccèsFichier]/cdroot/Linux[root@localhost Linux]#./ install.sh Si vous n’utilisez pas l’interface graphique et que vous n’êtes pas parvenu à installer le logiciel, vous devez utiliser le pilote en mode texte. Suivez les étapes 3 et 4, puis les instructions qui s’affichent sur l’écran Terminal. 5. Lorsque l’écran de bienvenue s’affiche, cliquez sur Next. 6. Une fois l’installation terminée, cliquez sur Finish. Pour des raisons pratiques, le programme d’installation a ajouté l’icône de bureau d’Unified Driver Configurator et le groupe Unified Driver au menu système. Si vous rencontrez la moindre difficulté, consultez l’aide à l’écran, accessible via le menu système ou via les applications Windows du package du pilote, telles que Unified Driver Configurator ou Image Manager. Installation de Smart Panel 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Lorsque la fenêtre Administrator Login apparaît, entrez root dans le champ Login et entrez le mot de passe du système. Vous devez vous connecter en tant que super-utilisateur (root) pour installer le pilote de l’appareil. Si vous ne disposez pas du statut de super-utilisateur, contactez votre administrateur système. 3. Depuis le site Web de Samsung, téléchargez le package Smart Panel sur votre ordinateur et décompressez-le. 4. Cliquez sur en bas du bureau. Lorsque l’écran Terminal apparaît, tapez : [root@localhost root]#tar zxf [CheminAccèsFichier]/ SmartPanel.tar.gz[root@localhost root]#cd [CheminAccèsFichier]/ cdroot/Linux/smartpanel[root@localhost smartpanel]#./install.sh Si vous n’utilisez pas l’interface graphique et que vous n’êtes pas parvenu à installer le logiciel, vous devez utiliser le pilote en mode texte. Suivez les étapes 3 et 4, puis les instructions qui s’affichent sur l’écran Terminal. Installation de Printer Setting Utility 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Lorsque la fenêtre Administrator Login apparaît, entrez root dans le champ Login et entrez le mot de passe du système. Vous devez vous connecter en tant que super-utilisateur (root) pour installer le pilote de l’appareil. Si vous ne disposez pas du statut de super-utilisateur, contactez votre administrateur système. 3. Depuis le site Web de Samsung, téléchargez le package Printer Setting Utility sur votre ordinateur et décompressez-le. 4. Cliquez sur en bas du bureau. Lorsque l’écran Terminal apparaît, tapez : [root@localhost root]#tar zxf [CheminAccèsFichier]/ PSU.tar.gz[root@localhost root]#cd [CheminAccèsFichier]/cdroot/ Linux/psu[root@localhost psu]#./install.sh Si vous n’utilisez pas l’interface graphique et que vous n’êtes pas parvenu à installer le logiciel, vous devez utiliser le pilote en mode texte. Suivez les étapes 3 et 4, puis les instructions qui s’affichent sur l’écran Terminal. Si le pilote d’impression ne fonctionne pas correctement, désinstallez-le et réinstallez-le. Pour Linux, procédez comme suit pour désinstaller le pilote. a) Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. b) Lorsque la fenêtre Administrator Login apparaît, tapez root dans le champ Login et saisissez le mot de passe système. Vous devez vous connecter en tant que super-utilisateur (root) pour désinstaller le pilote d’impression. Si vous ne disposez pas du statut de super-utilisateur, contactez votre administrateur système. c) Cliquez sur l’icône située en bas du bureau. Lorsque l’écran Terminal apparaît, tapez : [root@localhost root]#cd /opt/Samsung/mfp/uninstall/ [root@localhost uninstall]#./uninstall.sh d) Cliquez sur Uninstall. e) Cliquez sur Next. f) Cliquez sur Finish. Partage local de l’appareil Procédez comme suit pour configurer les ordinateurs pour partager l’appareil localement. Si l’ordinateur hôte est directement connecté à l’appareil avec un câble USB et est également connecté à l’environnement du réseau local, l’ordinateur client connecté au réseau local peut utiliser l’appareil partagé pour imprimer via l’ordinateur hôte. 1 Ordinateur hôte Ordinateur qui est directement connecté à l’appareil par un câble USB. 2 Ordinateurs clients Ordinateurs qui utilisent l’appareil partagé via l’ordinateur hôte. Prise en main_ 37 Windows Configuration d’un ordinateur hôte 1. Installez votre pilote d’impression (voir « Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté via USB » à la page 34). 2. Cliquez sur le menu Démarrer de Windows. 3. Pour Windows 2000, sélectionnez Paramètres > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows XP/2003, sélectionnez Imprimantes et télécopieurs. • Sous Windows 2008/Vista, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows 7, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Périphériques et imprimantes. • Sous Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel > Périphériques et imprimantes. 4. Cliquez avec le bouton droit sur l’icône de votre imprimante. 5. Sous Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, sélectionnez Propriétés. Sous Windows 7 et Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez, dans les menus contextuels, les Propriétés de l’imprimante. Si la marque ► accompagne l’élément Propriétés de l’imprimante, vous pouvez sélectionner les autres pilotes d’impression reliés à l’imprimante sélectionnée. 6. Sélectionnez l’onglet Partage. 7. Cochez Modifier les options de partage. 8. Cochez Partager cette imprimante. 9. Renseignez le champ Nom de partage. Cliquez sur OK. Configuration d’un ordinateur client 1. Installez votre pilote d’impression (voir « Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté via USB » à la page 34). 2. Cliquez sur le menu Démarrer de Windows. 3. Sélectionnez Tous les programmes > Accessoires > Explorateur Windows. 4. Saisissez l’adresse IP de l’ordinateur hôte et appuyez sur Entrée sur votre clavier. Si l’ordinateur hôte exige un Nom d’utilisateurateur et un Mot de passe, indiquez l’ID d’utilisateur et le mot de passe du compte de l’ordinateur hôte. 5. Cliquez avec le bouton droit sur l’icône de l’imprimante que vous souhaitez partager et sélectionnez Se connecter. 6. Si un message de configuration terminée apparaît, cliquez sur OK. 7. Ouvrez le fichier que vous souhaitez imprimer et démarrez l’impression. Macintosh Les étapes suivantes concernent Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6. Reportez-vous à l’aide Mac pour les autres versions du système d’exploitation. Configuration d’un ordinateur hôte 1. Installez votre pilote d’impression (voir « Macintosh » à la page 35). 2. Ouvrez le dossier Applications > Préférences Système et cliquez sur Imprimantes et fax. 3. Sélectionnez l’imprimante à partager dans la Liste des imprimantes. 4. Sélectionnez Partager cette imprimante. Configuration d’un ordinateur client 1. Installez votre pilote d’impression (voir « Macintosh » à la page 35). 2. Ouvrez le dossier Applications > Préférences Système et cliquez sur Imprimantes et fax. 3. Appuyez sur l’icône « + ». Une fenêtre indiquant le nom de votre imprimante partagée apparaît. 4. Sélectionnez votre appareil et cliquez sur Ajouter. Configuration réseau_ 38 3.Configuration réseau Ce chapitre vous guide pas-à-pas dans la procédure de paramétrage de l’appareil connecté à un réseau et du logiciel. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Environnement réseau • Présentation des programmes réseau utiles • Utilisation d’un réseau câblé • Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB • Configuration IPv6 Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Environnement réseau Vous devez configurer les protocoles réseau de l’appareil pour pouvoir l’utiliser comme appareil réseau. Vous pouvez définir les paramètres réseau de base à l’aide du panneau de commande de l’appareil. Le tableau suivant indique les environnements réseau compatibles avec l’appareil : Élément Configuration requise Interface réseau • Ethernet 10/100 Base-TX Système d’exploitation réseau • Windows 2000/XP/2003/2008/Vista • Différents systèmes d’exploitation Linux • Mac OS X 10.3 à 10.6 Protocoles réseau • TCP/IPv4 • DHCP, BOOTP • DNS, WINS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP • Impression TCP/IP standard (RAW), LPR, IPP • SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP(S), IPSec • TCP/IPv6 (DHCP, DNS, RAW, LPR, SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP(S), IPSec) (Voir « Configuration IPv6 » à la page 43.) Présentation des programmes réseau utiles Il existe plusieurs programmes disponibles pour configurer facilement les paramètres réseau dans un environnement réseau. Pour l’administrateur réseau particulièrement, il est possible de gérer plusieurs appareils sur le réseau. Avant d’utiliser les programmes ci-dessous, définissez d’abord l’adresse IP. SyncThru™ Web Service Serveur Web intégré à votre périphérique réseau, vous permettant de : • Définir les paramètres réseau nécessaires à la connexion de l’appareil à divers environnements réseau. • Personnaliser les paramètres de l’appareil. (Voir « Utilisation de SyncThru™ Web Service » à la page 91.) SyncThru™ Web Admin Service Solution Web de gestion de parc d’appareils destinée aux administrateurs réseau. SyncThru™ Web Admin Service constitue un outil performant d’administration de vos imprimantes réseau, qui vous permet de les superviser à distance et de corriger tout dysfonctionnement depuis n’importe quel point du réseau. Téléchargez ce programme sur http:// solution.samsungprinter.com. Samsung AnyWeb Print Cet utilitaire vous aide à effectuer une capture d’écran, prévisualiser, supprimer et imprimer l’écran de Windows Internet Explorer plus facilement que lorsque vous utilisez le programme habituel. Cliquez sur Démarrer > Tous les programmes > Samsung Printers > Samsung AnyWeb Print > Download the latest version pour accéder au site Web où se trouve l’utilitaire en téléchargement. Cet utilitaire n’est disponible que pour les systèmes d’exploitation Windows. SetIP Cet utilitaire vous permet de sélectionner une interface réseau et de configurer manuellement les adresses IP à utiliser avec le protocole TCP/IP (voir « Définition d’adresse IP à l’aide du programme SetIP (Windows) » à la page 39 ou « Définition d’adresse IP à l’aide du programme SetIP (Macintosh) » à la page 40). TCP/IPv6 n’est pas pris en charge par ce programme. Utilisation d’un réseau câblé Vous devez configurer les protocoles réseau sur votre appareil pour utiliser celui-ci dans votre réseau. Ce chapitre vous explique comment le faire facilement. Vous pouvez utiliser le réseau après avoir connecté le câble réseau à un port correspondant sur votre appareil. Impression d’un rapport de configuration réseau Vous pouvez imprimer un Rapport de configuration réseau avec les paramètres réseau actuel de l’appareil à partir du panneau de commande. Cela vous aidera à configurer un réseau et à résoudre les problèmes. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Réseau s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK.Configuration réseau_ 39 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que INFO. RESEAU s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que OUI s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. Avec ce Rapport de configuration réseau, vous pouvez trouver l’adresse MAC et l’adresse IP de votre appareil. Par exemple : • Adresse MAC : 00:15:99:41:A2:78 • Adresse IP : 192.0.0.192 Création d’une adresse IP Commencez par créer une adresse IP pour l’impression et la gestion réseau. Dans la plupart des cas, une nouvelle adresse IP est attribuée automatiquement par un serveur DHCP (serveur de protocole DHCP) situé sur le réseau. Dans quelques cas, l’adresse IP doit être créée manuellement. Cette adresse est appelée IP statique et elle est souvent requise dans les Intranets d’entreprise pour des raisons de sécurité. • Affectation d’adresse IP par DHCP : connectez votre appareil au réseau et patientez quelques minutes jusqu’à ce que le serveur DHCP attribue une adresse IP à l’appareil. Ensuite, imprimez le Rapport de configuration réseau, comme expliqué ci-dessus. Si le rapport indique que l’adresse IP a changé, l’attribution est réussie. Vous verrez la nouvelle adresse IP sur le rapport. • Attribution d’adresse IP statique : utilisez le programme SetIP pour changer l’adresse IP depuis votre ordinateur. Si votre appareil possède un panneau de commande, vous pouvez également modifier l’adresse IP à partir du panneau de commande. Dans un environnement professionnel, nous vous recommandons de contacter un administrateur réseau pour définir cette adresse. Définition de l’adresse IP à l’aide du panneau de commande 1. Connectez l’appareil au réseau avec un câble réseau. 2. Mettez l’appareil sous tension. 3. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Réseau s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TCP/IP (IPv4) s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que STATIQUE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ADRESSE IP s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 8. Saisissez l’adresse IP à l’aide du pavé numérique, puis appuyez sur OK. Saisissez un octet compris entre 0 et 255 à l’aide du pavé numérique, puis appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour vous déplacer entre les octets. Répétez cette étape jusqu’à ce que vous ayez complété l’adresse du premier au quatrième octet. 9. Entrez les autres paramètres, tels que MASQUE SS RES. et PASSERELLE, puis appuyez sur OK. 10.Après avoir entré tous les paramètres, appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour retourner au mode prêt. Ensuite, passez à la section « Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB » à la page 41. Définition d’adresse IP à l’aide du programme SetIP (Windows) Ce programme permet de configurer manuellement l’adresse réseau IP de votre appareil à l’aide de son adresse MAC pour communiquer avec l’appareil. Une adresse MAC est le numéro de série matériel de l’interface réseau et peut être trouvé sur le Rapport de configuration réseau. Pour utiliser le programme SetIP, désactivez le pare-feu de l’ordinateur avant de poursuivre, en procédant comme suit : 1. Ouvrez Panneau de configuration. 2. Double-cliquez sur Centre de sécurité. 3. Cliquez sur Pare-feu Windows. 4. Désactivez le pare-feu. Installation du programme 1. Insérez le CD-ROM du logiciel de l’imprimante fourni avec votre appareil. Fermez la fenêtre d’exécution automatique du CD. 2. Lancez l’Explorateur Windows et ouvrez le lecteur X (X représente votre lecteur de CD-ROM). 3. Double-cliquez sur Application > SetIP. 4. Double-cliquez sur Setup.exe pour installer ce programme. 5. Sélectionnez une langue, puis cliquez sur Suivant. 6. Suivez les instructions qui s’affichent à l’écran pour terminer l’installation. Démarrage du programme 1. Connectez l’appareil au réseau avec un câble réseau. 2. Mettez l’appareil sous tension. 3. À partir du menu Démarrer de Windows, sélectionnez Tous les programmes > Samsung Printers > SetIP > SetIP. 4. Cliquez sur l’icône (la troisième en partant de la gauche) dans la fenêtre SetIP pour ouvrir la fenêtre de configuration TCP/IP. 5. Saisissez les nouvelles informations de l’appareil dans la fenêtre de configuration, de la manière suivante. Dans un intranet d’entreprise, ces informations peuvent devoir être affectées par un gestionnaire du réseau avant de poursuivre. • Adresse MAC : recherchez l’adresse MAC de l’appareil dans le Rapport de configuration réseau et saisissez-la sans les deux-points (:). Par exemple, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 devient 0015992951A8.Configuration réseau_ 40 • Adresse IP : saisissez une nouvelle adresse IP pour votre imprimante. Par exemple, si l’adresse IP de votre ordinateur est 192.168.1.150, entrez 192.168.1.X (X correspond à un nombre situé entre 1 et 254, autre que l’adresse de l’ordinateur). • Masque de sous-réseau : saisissez un masque de sous-réseau. • Passerelle par défaut : Saisissez une passerelle par défaut. 6. Cliquez sur Appliquer, puis sur OK. L’appareil imprimera automatiquement le Rapport de configuration réseau. Vérifiez que tous les paramètres sont corrects. 7. Cliquez sur Quitter pour fermer le programme SetIP. 8. Au besoin, redémarrez le pare-feu de l’ordinateur. Définition d’adresse IP à l’aide du programme SetIP (Macintosh) Pour utiliser le programme SetIP, désactivez le pare-feu de l’ordinateur avant de poursuivre, en procédant comme suit : 1. Ouvrez Préférences Système. 2. Cliquez sur Sécurité. 3. Cliquez sur le menu Coupe-feu. 4. Désactivez le pare-feu. Les instructions suivantes peuvent varier selon le modèle. 1. Connectez l’appareil au réseau avec un câble réseau. 2. Insérez le CD d’installation, et ouvrez la fenêtre disque, puis sélectionnez MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPApplet.html. 3. Double-cliquez sur le fichier et Safari s’ouvre automatiquement, puis sélectionnez Se fier. Le navigateur ouvrira la page SetIPApplet.html indiquant le nom et l’adresse IP de l’imprimante. 4. Mettez en surbrillance la ligne des informations de l’imprimante et sélectionnez l’icône Configurer, qui est la deuxième en partant de la gauche dans la barre de menu d’application. Une fenêtre de configuration TCP/IP s’ouvre alors. Si l’imprimante n’est pas indiquée dans la ligne d’informations, sélectionnez l’icône Définir manuellement (la troisième en partant de la gauche) pour ouvrir la fenêtre de configuration TCP/IP. 5. Saisissez les nouvelles informations de l’appareil dans la fenêtre de configuration, de la manière suivante. Dans un intranet d’entreprise, ces informations peuvent devoir être affectées par un gestionnaire du réseau avant de poursuivre. • Adresse MAC : recherchez l’adresse MAC de l’appareil dans le Rapport de configuration réseau et saisissez-la sans les deux-points (:). Par exemple, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 devient 0015992951A8. • Adresse IP : saisissez une nouvelle adresse IP pour votre imprimante. Par exemple, si l’adresse IP de votre ordinateur est 192.168.1.150, entrez 192.168.1.X (X correspond à un nombre situé entre 1 et 254, autre que l’adresse de l’ordinateur). • Masque de sous-réseau : saisissez un masque de sous-réseau. • Passerelle par défaut : saisissez une passerelle par défaut. 6. Sélectionnez Appliquer, puis OK et une nouvelle fois OK. L’imprimante imprimera automatiquement le rapport de configuration. Vérifiez que tous les paramètres sont corrects. Quittez Safari. Vous pouvez fermer et éjecter le CD-ROM d’installation. Au besoin, redémarrez le pare-feu de l’ordinateur. Vous avez à ce stade modifié l’adresse IP, le masque de sous-réseau et la passerelle. Définition d’adresse IP à l’aide du programme SetIP (Linux) Le programme SetIP devrait être automatiquement installé lors de l’installation du pilote d’impression. 1. Imprimez le rapport de configuration réseau de l’appareil pour trouver l’adresse MAC de votre appareil. 2. Ouvrez /opt/Samsung/mfp/share/utils/. 3. Double-cliquez sur le fichier SetIPApplet.html. 4. Cliquez pour ouvrir la fenêtre de configuration TCP/IP. 5. Saisissez l’adresse MAC de votre carte d’imprimante réseau, l’adresse IP, le masque de sous-réseau, la passerelle par défaut, puis cliquez sur Appliquer. Saisissez l’adresse MAC sans les deux-points (:). 6. La machine imprime les informations réseau. Vérifiez que tous les paramètres sont corrects. 7. Fermez le programme SetIP. Paramétrage des valeurs réseau Vous pouvez également configurer les divers paramètres réseau via les programmes d’administration réseau comme SyncThru™ Web Admin Service et SyncThru™ Web Service. Restauration des paramètres usine par défaut Vous devrez peut-être réinitialiser l’appareil selon les paramètres par défaut définis en usine lorsque l’appareil que vous utilisez est connecté au nouvel environnement réseau. Restauration des paramètres usine par défaut à l’aide du panneau de commande 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Réseau s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que EFFACER REGL. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Éteignez puis rallumez l’appareil pour appliquer les paramètres. Restauration des paramètres par défaut définis en usine à l’aide du SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Démarrez un navigateur Web, comme Internet Explorer, Safari ou Firefox et saisissez la nouvelle adresse IP de votre appareil dans la fenêtre du navigateur. Par exemple : 2. Lorsque la fenêtre SyncThru™ Web Service s’ouvre, cliquez sur Config. réseau.Configuration réseau_ 41 3. Cliquez sur Réinitialiser. Cliquez ensuite sur Supprimer pour le réseau. 4. Éteignez puis rallumez l’appareil pour appliquer les paramètres. Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB Windows Pour configurer le pilote de l’appareil, procédez comme suit. Il s’agit de la procédure recommandée pour la plupart des utilisateurs. Tous les composants nécessaires aux opérations de l’appareil seront installés. 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté au réseau ou via USB et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Insérez le CD du logiciel dans le lecteur. • Le CD du logiciel s’exécute automatiquement et la fenêtre d’accueil s’affiche à l’écran. • Si la fenêtre d’installation ne s’affiche pas, cliquez sur Démarrer puis sur Exécuter. Tapez X:\Setup.exe, en remplaçant « X » par la lettre qui représente votre lecteur. Cliquez sur OK. • Si vous utilisez Windows Vista, Windows 7 ou Windows 2008 Server R2, cliquez sur Démarrer > Tous les programmes > Accessoires > Exécuter. Saisissez X:\Setup.exe, en remplaçant « X » par la lettre représentant le lecteur, puis cliquez sur OK. • Si la fenêtre Exécution automatique s’affiche sous Windows Vista, cliquez sur Exécuter Setup.exe dans le champ Installer or exécuter un programme, et cliquez sur Continuer dans les fenêtres Contrôle de compte d'utilisateur. • Si la fenêtre Exécution automatique s’affiche sous Windows 7 ou Windows 2008 Server R2, cliquez sur Exécuter Setup.exe dans le champ Installer or exécuter un programme, et cliquez sur Oui dans les fenêtres Contrôle de compte d’utilisateur. 3. Sélectionnez Installer maintenant. Au besoin, sélectionnez une langue dans la liste déroulante. L’Installation avancée dispose de deux options, Installation personnalisée et Installer uniquement les logiciels. L’Installation personnalisée vous permet de sélectionner la connexion de l’appareil et de choisir les composants individuels à installer. Installer uniquement les logiciels vous permet d’installer les logiciels fournis, tels que Smart Panel. Suivez les instructions affichées dans la fenêtre. 4. Lisez le Contrat de licence et sélectionnez J’accepte les dispositions du contrat de licence. Ensuite, cliquez sur Suivant. Le programme recherche l’appareil. Si l’appareil n’est pas détecté dans le réseau ou localement, un message d’erreur s’affiche. • Vérifiez si vous souhaitez installer les logiciels sans connecter l’imprimante au réseau ou localement. - Cochez cette option pour installer le programme sans qu’un appareil soit connecté. La fenêtre « Imprimer une page de test » est alors ignorée et l’installation terminée. • Chercher à nouveau Lorsque vous appuyez sur ce bouton, la fenêtre d’avertissement concernant le pare-feu s’affiche. - Désactivez le pare-feu et cliquez sur Chercher à nouveau. Pour le système d’exploitation Windows, cliquez sur Démarrer > Panneau de configuration > Pare-feu Windows et désactivez cette option. - Désactivez tout pare-feu tiers. Reportez-vous au manuel fourni avec le programme correspondant. • Saisie directe La Saisie directe vous permet de rechercher un appareil spécifique sur le réseau. - Rechercher par adresse IP : Saisissez l’adresse IP ou le nom d’hôte. Cliquez sur Suivant. Pour vérifier l’adresse IP de l’appareil, imprimez un rapport de configuration réseau (voir « Impression d’un rapport de configuration réseau » à la page 38). - Rechercher par chemin réseau : Pour rechercher un appareil partagé (chemin d'accès UNC), saisissez le nom de partage manuellement ou recherchez une imprimante partagée en cliquant sur le bouton Parcourir. Cliquez sur Suivant. • Aide Si l’appareil n’est pas connecté à l’ordinateur ou au réseau, ce bouton d’aide vous fournira des procédures de connexion détaillées.Configuration réseau_ 42 • Définir l’adresse IP Si vous souhaitez définir une adresse IP spécifique sur un appareil réseau donné, cliquez sur le bouton Définir l’adresse IP. La fenêtre Définir l’adresse IP apparaît. Procédez comme suit : a) Sélectionnez l’appareil à associer à une adresse IP spécifique dans la liste. b) Configurez manuellement une adresse IP, un masque de sous-réseau et une passerelle pour l’appareil, puis cliquez sur Appliquer pour définir l’adresse IP spécifique de l’appareil réseau. c) Cliquez sur Suivant. 5. Les appareils détectés s’afficheront à l’écran. Sélectionnez celui que vous souhaitez utiliser. Si le pilote n’a trouvé qu’une seule imprimante, la fenêtre de confirmation s’affiche. Le programme démarre l’installation. 6. Une fois l’installation terminée, une fenêtre vous demandant d’imprimer une page de test apparaît. Si vous souhaitez imprimer un page de test, cliquez sur Imprimer une page de test. Sinon, contentez-vous de cliquer sur Suivant et passez à l’étape 8. 7. Si la page s’imprime correctement, cliquez sur Oui. Sinon, cliquez sur Non pour relancer l’impression. 8. Pour vous inscrire en tant qu’utilisateur de l’appareil et recevoir des informations de Samsung, cliquez sur Inscription en ligne. 9. Cliquez sur Terminer. • Une fois le pilote installé, vous pouvez activer les pare-feu. • Si, après son installation, le pilote d’impression ne fonctionne pas correctement, réparez-le ou réinstallez-le (voir « Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB » à la page 41). Macintosh 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre réseau et qu’il est sous tension. L’adresse IP de votre appareil doit également avoir été définie. 2. Insérez le CD du logiciel dans le lecteur. 3. Double-cliquez sur l’icône CD-ROM qui apparaît sur le bureau du Macintosh. 4. Double-cliquez sur le dossier MAC_Installer. 5. Double-cliquez sur l’icône Installer OS X. 6. Saisissez le mot de passe et cliquez sur OK. 7. La fenêtre du programme d’installation Samsung s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Continuer. 8. Lisez le contrat de licence et cliquez sur Continuer. 9. Cliquez sur J’accepte pour accepter les termes du contrat de licence. 10.Sélectionnez Installation standard et cliquez sur Programme d’installation => Installer (10.4). L’option Installation standard est recommandée pour la plupart des utilisateurs. Tous les composants nécessaires aux opérations de l’appareil seront installés. Lorsque vous choisissez Installation personnalisée (10.4), vous pouvez installer les composants de votre choix. 11.Le message avertissant de la fermeture de toutes les applications en cours d’exécution sur votre ordinateur apparaît. Cliquez sur Continuer. • Si une fenêtre vous demandant de sélectionner un type d’installation s’affiche, sélectionnez Installation standard sur imprimante réseau et cliquez sur OK. • Si vous sélectionnez Installation standard sur imprimante réseau, le programme SetIP se lance automatiquement. Si l’appareil dispose déjà d’informations réseau configurées, fermez le programme SetIP. Passez à l’étape suivante. 12.Une fois l’installation terminée, cliquez sur Quitter. 13.Ouvrez le dossier Applications > Utilitaires > Configuration d’imprimante. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, ouvrez le dossier Applications > Préférences Système et cliquez sur Imprimantes et fax. 14.Cliquez sur Ajouter dans la Liste des imprimantes. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, appuyez sur l’icône « + » ; une fenêtre d’affichage apparaît. 15.Sous Mac OS X 10.3, sélectionnez l’onglet Impression via IP. • Sous Mac OS X 10,4, cliquez sur Imprimante IP. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, cliquez sur IP. 16.Sélectionnez Socket/HP Jet Direct dans Type (10.3). Lors de l’impression d’un document contenant de nombreuses pages, le niveau de performance d’impression peut être amélioré en choisissant Socket pour l’option Type (10.3). 17.Saisissez l’adresse IP de l’appareil dans le champ Adresse de l’imprimante. 18.Saisissez le nom de la file d’attente dans le champ File d’attente. Si vous n’arrivez pas à déterminer le nom de la file d’attente du serveur de votre appareil, commencez par essayer d’utiliser la file d’attente par défaut. 19.Sous Mac OS X 10.3, si la sélection automatique ne fonctionne pas correctement, sélectionnez Samsung dans Nom de modèle et votre nom d’appareil dans Modèle de l’imprimante. • Sous Mac OS X 10.4, si la sélection automatique ne fonctionne pas correctement, sélectionnez Samsung dans Imprimer via et votre nom d’appareil dans Modèle. • Sous Mac OS X 10.5 à 10.6, si la sélection automatique ne fonctionne pas correctement, sélectionnez Sélectionner un gestionnaire à utiliser..., puis le nom de votre imprimante dans Imprimer via. L’adresse IP de votre appareil apparaît sur Liste des imprimantes, et l’appareil est réglé comme appareil par défaut. 20.Cliquez sur Ajouter. Si le pilote d’impression ne fonctionne pas correctement, désinstallez-le et réinstallez-le. Pour Macintosh, procédez comme suit pour désinstaller le pilote. a) Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. b) Insérez le CD du logiciel dans le lecteur. c) Double-cliquez sur l’icône CD-ROM qui apparaît sur le bureau du Macintosh. d) Double-cliquez sur le dossier MAC_Installer. e) Double-cliquez sur l’icône Installer OS X. f) Saisissez la clé réseau et cliquez sur OK. g) La fenêtre du programme d’installation Samsung s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Continuer. h) Sélectionnez Désinstaller et cliquez sur Désinstaller. i) Lorsqu'un message avertissant de la fermeture de toutes les applications en cours d’exécution sur votre ordinateur apparaît, cliquez sur Continuer. j) Une fois la désinstallation terminée, cliquez sur Quitter.Configuration réseau_ 43 Linux Installation du pilote Linux et ajout d’une imprimante réseau 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre réseau et qu’il est sous tension. L’adresse IP de votre appareil doit également avoir été définie. 2. Téléchargez le package Unified Linux Driver du site Web de Samsung. 3. Extrayez le fichier UnifiedLinuxDriver.tar.gz et ouvrez le nouveau répertoire. 4. Double-cliquez sur le dossier Linux. 5. Double-cliquez sur l’icône install.sh. 6. La fenêtre du programme d’installation Samsung s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Continue. 7. La fenêtre de l’assistant d’ajout d’imprimante s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Next. 8. Sélectionnez imprimante réseau et cliquez sur le bouton Search. 9. L’adresse IP et le nom de modèle de l’imprimante apparaissent dans le champ de liste. 10.Sélectionnez l’appareil, puis cliquez sur Next. 11.Entrez la description de l’imprimante et cliquez sur Next. 12.Une fois l’ajout d’imprimante terminé, cliquez sur Finish. 13.Une fois l’installation terminée, cliquez sur Finish. Ajout d’une imprimante réseau 1. Double-cliquez sur Unified Driver Configurator. 2. Cliquez sur Add Printer... 3. La fenêtre Add printer wizard s’ouvre. Cliquez sur Next. 4. Sélectionnez Network printer et cliquez sur le bouton Search. 5. L’adresse IP et le nom de modèle de l’imprimante apparaissent dans le champ de liste. 6. Sélectionnez l’appareil, puis cliquez sur Next. 7. Entrez la description de l’imprimante et cliquez sur Next. 8. Une fois l’ajout d’imprimante terminé, cliquez sur Finish. Configuration IPv6 TCP/IPv6 n’est correctement pris en charge que sur Windows Vista ou ultérieur. Si le réseau IPv6 ne semble pas fonctionner correctement, réinitialisez tous les paramètres réseau par défaut et réessayez (voir « Restauration des paramètres usine par défaut » à la page 40). Pour utiliser l’environnement réseau IPv6, procédez comme suit afin d’utiliser l’adresse IPv6 : 1. Connectez l’appareil au réseau avec un câble réseau. 2. Mettez l’appareil sous tension. 3. Depuis le panneau de commande de l’appareil, imprimez un Rapport de configuration réseau permettant de contrôler les adresses IPV6. a) Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. b) Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Réseau s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. c) Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que INFO. RESEAU s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. d) Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que OUI s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Sélectionnez Démarrer > Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Imprimantes > Ajouter une imprimante. 5. Cliquez sur Ajouter une imprimante locale dans la fenêtre Ajouter une imprimante. 6. Suivez les instructions affichées dans la fenêtre. Si l’appareil ne fonctionne pas dans l’environnement réseau, activez IPv6. Reportez-vous à la section suivante. Activation d’IPv6 L’appareil est fourni avec la fonction IPv6 activée. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Réseau s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TCP/IP (IPv6) s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que IPv6 activé s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Mettez l’appareil hors tension puis sous tension. 7. Réinstallez le pilote d’impression. Paramétrage des adresses IPV6 L’appareil prend en charge les adresses IPV6 suivantes pour l’impression et la gestion réseau. • Link-local Address : adresse IPv6 locale configurée automatiquement (l’adresse commence par FE80). • Stateless Address : adresse IPV6 configurée automatiquement par un routeur réseau. • Stateful Address : adresse IPV6 configurée par un serveur DHCPv6. • Manual Address : adresse IPV6 configurée manuellement par un utilisateur. Configuration d’adresse DHCPv6 (Stateful) Si vous possédez sur votre réseau un serveur DHCPv6, vous pouvez définir une des options suivantes pour la configuration dynamique de l’hôte par défaut : 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Réseau s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TCP/IP (IPv6) s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Config. DHCPv6 s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur les flèches gauche et droite pour accéder à la valeur souhaitée. • ROUTEUR : utilisation de DHCPv6 uniquement sur demande d’un routeur. • Adr. DHCPv6 : utilisation exclusive de DHCPv6 quelle que soit la demande du routeur. • DHCPv6 désact : utilisation proscrite de DHCPv6 quelle que soit la demande du routeur. 6. Appuyez sur OK.Configuration réseau_ 44 Configuration manuelle de l’adresse 1. Ouvrez un navigateur Web qui prend en charge l’adressage IPv6 comme URL, par exemple Internet Explorer (voir « Connexion de SyncThru™ Web Service » à la page 44). Pour IPv4, saisissez l’adresse IPv4 (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) dans le champ d’adresse, puis appuyez sur la touche Entrée ou cliquez sur Atteindre. 2. Lorsque la fenêtre SyncThru™ Web Service s’ouvre, cliquez sur Config. réseau. 3. Cliquez sur TCP/IP. 4. Activez l’option Adresse manuel dans la section TCP/IPv6. 5. Sélectionnez le Prfixe du routeur et cliquez sur le bouton Ajouter ; le préfixe du routeur est alors saisi automatiquement dans le champ d’adresse. Saisissez le reste de l’adresse (par ex. : 3FFE:10:88:194::AAAA. « A » est le chiffre hexadécimal 0 à 9, A à F). 6. Cliquez sur le bouton Appliquer. Connexion de SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Ouvrez un navigateur Web qui prend en charge l’adressage IPV6 comme URL, par exemple Internet Explorer. 2. Sélectionnez une des adresses IPV6 (Link-local Address, Stateless Address, Stateful Address, Manual Address) à partir du Rapport de configuration réseau. 3. Saisissez les adresses IPV6 (par ex. : http:// [FE80::215:99FF:FE66:7701]). L’adresse doit être placée entre crochets « [] ».Configuration de base_ 45 4.Configuration de base Une fois l’installation terminée, vous devez définir les paramètres par défaut de l’appareil. Consultez la section suivante si vous souhaitez définir ou modifier des valeurs. Ce chapitre vous guide pas-à-pas dans la procédure de paramétrage de l’appareil. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Réglage de l’altitude • Modification de la langue d’affichage • Paramétrage de la date et de l’heure • Modification du mode d’horloge • Modification du mode par défaut • Configuration des sons • Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique • Utilisation des modes d’économie • Réglage du bac et du papier par défaut • Réglage du délai d’expiration de la tâche Réglage de l’altitude La qualité d’impression est affectée par la pression atmosphérique, celle-ci étant déterminée par la position de l’appareil par rapport au niveau de la mer. Les informations suivantes traitent du paramétrage de l’appareil de façon à obtenir une qualité d’impression optimale. Avant de définir les paramètres d’altitude, déterminez l’altitude à laquelle vous trouvez. 0 1 Élevé 1 2 Élevé 2 3 Élevé 3 4 Normal 1. Vérifiez que vous avez bien installé le pilote d’impression inclus dans le CD-ROM du logiciel d’impression fourni. 2. Double-cliquez sur l’icône Smart Panel de la barre des tâches de Windows (ou de la zone Notification Area de Linux). Vous pouvez également cliquer sur Smart Panel de la barre d’état de Mac OS X. 3. Cliquez sur Paramètres d’imprimante. 4. Cliquez sur Paramètres > Ajustement altitude. Sélectionnez la valeur adéquate dans la liste déroulante, puis cliquez sur Appliquer. • Si votre appareil est connecté à un réseau, l’écran SyncThru™ Web Service apparaît automatiquement. Cliquez sur Config. appareil > Configuration du système > Config. appareil > Altitude. Sélectionnez la valeur d’altitude adéquate, puis cliquez sur Appliquer. • Si votre appareil est connecté via un câble USB, réglez l’altitude dans l’option ALTITUDE de l’écran de l’appareil. Modification de la langue d’affichage Pour modifier la langue qui apparaît sur l’écran, effectuez les opérations suivantes : 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que LANGUE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour afficher la langue souhaitée. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Paramétrage de la date et de l’heure Le réglage de la date et de l’heure est utilisé pour les options de télécopie différée et d’impression différée. Ces données sont également imprimées sur les journaux. Si celles-ci sont incorrectes, vous devez les mettre à jour. En cas de coupure de courant, vous devez de nouveau régler la date et l’heure une fois le courant rétabli. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que DATE & HEURE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez l’heure et la date correctes à l’aide de la flèche gauche/droite ou du pavé numérique. Mois = 01 à 12, Jour = 01 à 31, Année = 4 chiffres, Heure = 01 à 12, Minute = 00 à 59, et vous pouvez également sélectionner AM ou PM. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Configuration de base_ 46 Modification du mode d’horloge Vous pouvez paramétrer votre appareil pour que l’heure s’affiche au format 12 ou 24 heures. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MODE HORLOGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner l’autre mode, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Modification du mode par défaut Votre appareil est préconfiguré en mode copie. Vous pouvez basculer ce mode par défaut entre les modes télécopie et copie. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MODE PAR DEF. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le mode souhaité. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Configuration des sons Vous pouvez contrôler les sons suivants : • TONAL. CLAVIER : ACTIVE ou DESACTIVE la tonalité du clavier. Si cette option est ACTIVE, un bip est émis chaque fois que vous appuyez sur une touche. • TONAL. ALARME : ACTIVE ou DESACTIVE la tonalité de l’alarme. Lorsque cette option est réglée sur ACTIVE, une tonalité d’alarme retentit dès qu’une erreur intervient ou que la communication par fax s’interrompt. • HAUT-PARLEUR : ACTIVE ou DESACTIVE les sons de la ligne téléphonique diffusés par le haut-parleur, comme la tonalité de composition ou la tonalité de télécopie. Lorsque cette option est en mode COM. qui signifie « commun, courant », le haut-parleur reste activé jusqu’à ce que l’appareil distant réponde. Vous pouvez ajuster le niveau du volume à l’aide de Ligne. Si votre appareil est équipé d’un combiné, vous pouvez vous en servir pour régler le volume. • SONNERIE : ajuste le volume de la sonnerie. Pour le volume de la sonnerie, vous pouvez choisir entre DESACTIVE, FAIBLE, MILIEU et ELEVEE. Haut-parleur, sonnerie, bips de touches et bip d’avertissement 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que SON/VOLUME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’option de son souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le statut ou le volume sonore sélectionné s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Si besoin, répétez les étapes 4 à 5 pour paramétrer d’autres sons. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Volume du haut-parleur Pour régler le volume à l’aide de la touche Ligne : 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur Ligne. Le haut-parleur émet une tonalité de composition. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que vous obteniez le volume sonore souhaité. 4. Appuyez sur Ligne pour valider la modification et revenir au mode prêt. Si votre appareil est équipé d’un combiné : 1. Décrochez le combiné. L’écouteur émet une tonalité d’appel. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que vous obteniez le volume sonore souhaité. 3. Appuyez sur OK pour enregistrer la modification et reposez le combiné. Vous ne pouvez ajuster le volume du haut-parleur que lorsque le câble téléphonique est connecté. Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique Lors de l’exécution de diverses tâches, vous devrez indiquer différents noms et numéros. Par exemple, lorsque vous configurez votre appareil, vous indiquez votre nom ou le nom de la société et le numéro de télécopie. Saisie de caractères alphanumériques 1. Lorsque le système vous invite à saisir une lettre, repérez la touche sur laquelle figure le caractère souhaité. Appuyez sur la touche jusqu’à ce que la lettre souhaitée s’affiche à l’écran. Par exemple, pour taper la lettre O, appuyez sur la touche 6, qui représente les lettres « MNO ». À chaque pression sur la touche 6, l’écran affiche une lettre différente, M, N, O et finalement 6. Vous pouvez inclure des caractères spéciaux dans le nom (espace, signe plus, etc.). Pour plus de détails, consultez la section ci-dessous. 2. Pour saisir des caractères supplémentaires, recommencez l’étape 1. Si la lettre suivante à saisir se trouve sur la même touche, déplacez le curseur à l’aide de la flèche gauche/droite, puis appuyez sur la touche voulue. Le curseur se déplace vers la droite et la lettre suivante s’affiche. Vous pouvez saisir un espace en appuyant deux fois sur la touche 1. 3. Quand vous avez terminé de saisir les lettres, appuyez sur OK.Configuration de base_ 47 Lettres et chiffres du clavier Touche Chiffres, lettres ou caractères associés 1 @ / . ‘ 1 2 A B C a b c 2 3 D E F d e f 3 4 G H I g h i 4 5 J K L j k l 5 6 M N O m n o 6 7 P Q R S p q r s 7 8 T U V t u v 8 9 W X Y Z w x y z 9 0 & + - , 0 * * # # Correction de numéros ou de noms En cas d’erreur de saisie, appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour effacer le dernier chiffre ou caractère saisi. Saisissez ensuite le chiffre ou le caractère approprié. Insertion d’une pause Avec certains systèmes téléphoniques, vous devez composer un code d’accès (9, par exemple) puis patienter jusqu’à l’émission d’une deuxième tonalité de composition. Le cas échéant, vous devez insérer une pause dans le numéro de téléphone. Vous pouvez insérer une pause lorsque vous configurez les numéros de composition abrégée. Pour insérer une pause, appuyez sur Bis/Pause à l’endroit approprié lors de la saisie du numéro de téléphone. Un - apparaît sur l’écran à l’emplacement correspondant. Utilisation des modes d’économie Utilisation de la fonctionnalité d’économie de toner Le mode économie de toner permet à l’appareil d’utiliser moins de toner par page. Avec ce mode, la durée de vie des cartouches est allongée par rapport à celle obtenue en mode normal, mais la qualité d’impression est moins bonne. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ECO TONER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Si vous imprimez depuis un PC, vous pouvez aussi activer ou désactiver le mode d’économie de toner dans les propriétés de l’imprimante. Utilisation de la fonctionnalité d’économie d’énergie Lorsque vous n’utilisez pas l’appareil pendant un moment, utilisez cette fonctionnalité pour économiser l’énergie. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ECO ENERGIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le temps souhaité. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Réglage du bac et du papier par défaut Vous pouvez sélectionner le bac et le papier à utiliser par défaut pour les tâches d’impression. Au panneau de commande Réglage du format de papier 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FORMAT PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le bac d’alimentation papier souhaité, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le format de papier souhaité. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Réglage du type de papier 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TYPE PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le bac d’alimentation papier souhaité, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le type de support souhaité. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Réglage de la source de papier 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK.Configuration de base_ 48 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ALIM. PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que BAC COPIE ou BAC FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le bac d’alimentation papier souhaité. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Dans l’ordinateur Windows 1. Cliquez sur le menu Démarrer de Windows. 2. Pour Windows 2000, sélectionnez Paramètres > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows XP/2003, sélectionnez Imprimantes et télécopieurs. • Sous Windows 2008/Vista, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows 7, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Périphériques et imprimantes. • Sous Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel > Périphériques et imprimantes. 3. Cliquez avec le bouton droit sur votre appareil. 4. Sous Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, cliquez sur Options d’impression. Sous Windows 7 et Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez, dans les menus contextuels, les Options d’impression. Si la marque ► accompagne l’élément Options d’impression, vous pouvez sélectionner les autres pilotes d’impression reliés à l’imprimante sélectionnée. 5. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier. 6. Sélectionnez le bac souhaité et les options correspondantes, notamment le format et le type de papier. 7. Appuyez sur OK. Si vous souhaitez utiliser du papier de format spécial comme du papier à facture, sélectionnez l’onglet Papier > Format > Modifier... dans les Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). Macintosh Les utilisateurs de Macintosh doivent changer manuellement le réglage par défaut chaque fois qu’ils veulent utiliser d’autres réglages. 1. Ouvrez une application Macintosh, puis sélectionnez le fichier à imprimer. 2. Ouvrez le menu Fichier et cliquez sur Imprimer. 3. Sélectionnez le volet Alimentation. 4. Ouvrez le menu Fichier et cliquez sur Imprimer. 5. Accédez à Alimentation. 6. Définissez le bac approprié duquel vous souhaitez imprimer. 7. Sélectionnez le volet Papier. 8. Réglez le type de papier pour faire correspondre le papier inséré dans le bac avec celui voulu pour l’impression. 9. Cliquez sur Imprimer pour imprimer. Linux 1. Ouvrez le programme Terminal. 2. Lorsque l’écran Terminal apparaît, tapez : [root@localhost root]# lpr 3. Sélectionnez Printer et cliquez sur Properties… 4. Cliquez sur l’onglet Advanced. 5. Sélectionnez le bac (source) et ses options, telles que le format et le type de papier. 6. Appuyez sur OK. Réglage du délai d’expiration de la tâche Quand aucune saisie n’est réalisée pendant un certain laps de temps, l’appareil quitte le menu actif et retourne aux paramètres par défaut. Vous pouvez définir le temps d’attente de l’appareil. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que EXPIR. IMPR. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez le temps à l’aide de la flèche gauche/droite ou du pavé numérique. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Supports et bacs_ 49 5.Supports et bacs Ce chapitre vous explique comment installer les originaux et les supports d’impression dans votre appareil. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Préparation des originaux • Mise en place des originaux • Sélection du support d’impression • Modification du format du bac • Chargement de papier dans le bac • Impression sur supports spéciaux • Réglage du type et du format de papier • Utilisation du support de sortie papier Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Préparation des originaux • N’insérez pas du papier dont le format est inférieur à 142 × 148 mm ou supérieur à 216 × 356 mm. • N’essayez pas de charger les types de papier suivants au risque de provoquer un bourrage, une impression de mauvaise qualité et un endommagement de l’appareil. - Papier carbone ou papier autocopiant. - Papier couché. - Papier bible ou trop fin. - Papier froissé ou plié. - Papier ondulé ou en rouleau. - Papier déchiré. • Retirez tout trombone ou agrafe avant de charger des documents. • Si vous avez utilisé du correcteur, de la colle ou de l’encre, vérifiez que le papier est entièrement sec avant de charger les documents. • Ne chargez que des originaux de même format ou grammage. • Ne chargez pas de documents reliés, de livrets, de transparents ou de documents non standard. Mise en place des originaux Vous pouvez utiliser la vitre d’exposition ou le chargeur automatique de documents pour charger un document original à des fins de copie, de numérisation et d’envoi par fax. Sur la vitre d’exposition Assurez-vous que le chargeur de documents est vide. Si un original est détecté dans le chargeur de documents, il devient prioritaire par rapport à l’original placé sur la vitre d’exposition. Pour obtenir une qualité de numérisation optimale, notamment pour les images en couleur ou en niveaux de gris, utilisez la vitre d’exposition. 1. Soulevez et ouvrez le capot du scanner. 2. Placez les originaux, face imprimée vers le bas, sur la vitre d’exposition. Et alignez-le sur le guide situé dans l’angle supérieur gauche de la vitre. 3. Fermez le capot du scanner. • Refermez toujours le capot du scanner pour obtenir une qualité d’impression optimale et réduire la consommation de toner. • La présence de poussière sur la vitre d’exposition peut entraîner l’apparition de taches noires sur le document imprimé. Veillez à ce que cette vitre soit toujours propre (voir « Nettoyage du scanner » à la page 98). • Lorsque vous numérisez une page d’un livre ou d’un magazine, ouvrez complètement le capot du scanner, puis refermez-le. Si le livre ou le magazine fait plus de 30 mm d’épaisseur, laissez le capot ouvert pour effectuer la numérisation.Supports et bacs_ 50 • Faites attention à ne pas casser la vitre d’exposition. Vous pourriez vous blesser. • Ne la touchez pas avec vos doigts en refermant le capot du scanner. Le capot du scanner pourrait tomber et être endommagé. • Ne regardez pas la lumière qui vient de l’intérieur du scanner lorsque vous copiez ou numérisez un document. Cela est dangereux pour vos yeux. Dans le chargeur de documents Le chargeur automatique de documents peut recevoir jusqu’à 40 feuilles de papier (75 g/m2 ) pour une tâche. 1. Courbez ou déramez la pile de papier afin de séparer les feuilles avant de charger les originaux. 2. Placez l’original, face imprimée vers le haut, dans le chargeur de documents. Assurez-vous que le bord droit de l’original est aligné sur la marque de format de papier présente sur le bac d’alimentation. 3. Ajustez le guide de largeur du chargeur de documents en fonction du format du papier. Des particules de poussière sur la vitre du chargeur de documents peuvent créer des taches noires sur le document imprimé. Maintenez toujours la vitre propre (voir « Nettoyage du scanner » à la page 98). Sélection du support d’impression Vous pouvez imprimer sur différents supports, par exemple du papier ordinaire, des enveloppes, des étiquettes ou encore des transparents. N’utilisez que des supports d’impression compatibles avec l’appareil. Recommandations pour sélectionner le support d’impression L’utilisation d’un support d’impression non conforme aux spécifications décrites dans le présent mode d’emploi peut provoquer des problèmes, notamment : • Une qualité d’impression médiocre. • Des bourrages papier répétés. • Une usure prématurée de l’appareil. Certaines caractéristiques, comme le grammage, la composition, le grain et la teneur en humidité, constituent des facteurs importants qui ont une incidence sur les performances de l’imprimante et sur la qualité d’impression. Lorsque vous choisissez un support d’impression, tenez compte des points suivants : • Le type, le format et le grammage des supports d’impression pour votre appareil sont décrits dans les spécifications sur les supports d’impression (voir « Spécifications des supports d’impression » à la page 124). • Résultat recherché : choisissez un support d’impression adapté à votre travail. • Luminosité : plus le support d’impression est blanc, plus les couleurs paraissent éclatantes. • Satinage : le satinage du papier améliore la netteté de l’impression. • Il arrive que certains supports d’impression répondant aux critères décrits dans cette section ne fournissent cependant pas des résultats satisfaisants. Cela peut être dû à une manipulation inadéquate, à des niveaux de température et d’hygrométrie excessifs ou à d’autres facteurs sur lesquels aucun contrôle ne peut être exercé. • Avant de faire acquisition de supports d’impression en grande quantité, vérifiez qu’ils répondent aux spécifications indiquées dans le présent document. L’utilisation d’un support d’impression non conforme aux spécifications peut provoquer des problèmes de fonctionnement de l’imprimante, allant jusqu’à nécessiter l’intervention d’un technicien. Ce type d’intervention n’est pas couvert par la garantie ni par les contrats de maintenance. La quantité de papier placée dans le bac peut varier selon le type de support utilisé (voir « Spécifications des supports d’impression » à la page 124). Formats de support pris en charge dans chaque mode Mode Format Alimentation Mode copie Lettre, A4, Légal, Oficio, Folio, Exécutif, B5 ISO, B5 JIS, A5, A6 • bac 1 • bac manuel Mode d’impression Tous les formats pris en charge par l’appareil • bac 1 • bac manuel Mode télécopie Lettre, A4, Légal • bac 1Supports et bacs_ 51 Modification du format du bac Selon le pays, le bac est réglé par défaut sur le format Lettre ou A4. Pour changer le format, vous devez régler les guides-papier. 1 Guide de support 2 Guide-papier 3 Verrou du guide 4 Guide de largeur du papier 1. D’une main, pressez et maintenez le guide, et de l’autre main, tenez ensemble le guide-papier et le support de guidage. Faites glisser le guide-papier et le support de guidage pour les faire venir dans l’encoche correspondant au format du papier. 2. Courbez ou déramez la pile de papier afin de séparer les feuilles avant de les charger. Insérez le papier dans le bac. 3. Une fois le papier inséré dans le bac, réglez le guide de support jusqu’à ce qu’il touche légèrement la pile de papier. 4. Appuyez sur les guides de largeur du papier et déplacez-les au format de papier indiqué au fond du bac. • Si vous poussez le guide-papier trop loin, le papier risque de se courber. • Si vous n’ajustez pas le guide, vous risquez de provoquer des bourrages papier. Chargement de papier dans le bac Bac 1 1. Retirez le bac d’alimentation papier et réglez le format du bac en fonction du support chargé (voir « Modification du format du bac » à la page 51). 2. Courbez ou déramez la pile de papier afin de séparer les feuilles avant de charger le papier. 3. Insérez le papier face à imprimer vers le bas. 4. Remettez le bac en place dans l’appareil. 5. Lorsque vous imprimez un document, sélectionnez le format et le type de papier pour le bac. Pour plus d’informations sur la configuration du type et du format du papier, reportez-vous à la section « Réglage du bac et du papier par défaut » à la page 47. Si vous rencontrez des problèmes avec l’alimentation papier, vérifiez que le papier corresponde aux spécifications de support d’impression. Ensuite, essayez de placer une feuille à la fois dans le bac manuel (voir « Spécifications des supports d’impression » à la page 124).Supports et bacs_ 52 Bac manuel Le bac manuel peut contenir des supports de types et de formats spéciaux, tels que des cartes postales, des cartes de correspondance et des enveloppes. Il est très utile pour réaliser des impressions sur une seule feuille de papier à en-tête ou de papier de couleur. Conseils d’utilisation du bac d’alimentation manuel • Si vous sélectionnez Chargeur manuel comme Alimentation depuis votre application logicielle, vous devez appuyer sur OK à chaque fois que vous imprimez une page et chargez un seul type, un seul format et un seul grammage de support d’impression à la fois dans le bac manuel. • Pour éviter les bourrages papier, n’ajoutez pas de papier pendant l’impression tant que le bac manuel n’est pas vide. Cela s’applique également aux autres types de support. • Les supports doivent être chargés face vers le haut, le bord supérieur inséré en premier dans le bac d’alimentation manuel, et être placés au centre du bac. • Utilisez uniquement les supports d’impression répertoriés pour éviter les bourrages papier ou les problèmes de qualité d’impression (voir « Spécifications des supports d’impression » à la page 124). • Lissez les cartes, enveloppes et planches d’étiquettes avant de les insérer dans l’alimentation manuelle. 1. Chargez le format de papier approprié dans le bac manuel. • Ne forcez pas le papier au-delà de la surface marquée par lors du chargement. • Lors de l’impression sur support spécial, suivez les recommandations de chargement (voir « Impression sur supports spéciaux » à la page 52). • Lorsque des feuilles se chevauchent lors de l’impression avec le bac manuel, ouvrez le bac 1 et retirez les feuilles qui se chevauchent ; recommencez l’impression. • Lorsque le papier ne s’alimente pas correctement pendant l’impression, poussez manuellement le papier jusqu’à ce qu’il commence à s’alimenter automatiquement. 2. Pressez les guides de papier de l’alimentation manuelle et ajustez-les à la largeur du papier. Ne forcez pas trop, au risque de plier le papier et de provoquer un bourrage papier ou une impression oblique. 3. Pour imprimer dans une application, ouvrez-la et démarrez le menu d’impression. 4. Ouvrez Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 5. Appuyez sur l’onglet Papier dans Options d'impression, et sélectionnez le type de papier approprié. Par exemple, si vous souhaitez utiliser une étiquette, définissez le type de papier sur Étiquettes. 6. Sélectionnez Chargeur manuel dans la source de papier puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Lancez l’impression depuis l’application. Si vous imprimez plusieurs pages, insérez la feuille suivante une fois la première page imprimée, puis appuyez sur OK. Répétez cette opération pour chaque page à imprimer. Impression sur supports spéciaux Le tableau ci-dessous montre les supports spéciaux disponibles pour chaque bac. Lors de l’utilisation d’un support spécial, nous vous recommandons d’alimenter une feuille à la fois. Vérifiez le nombre maximum de feuilles à alimenter pour chaque bac (voir « Spécifications des supports d’impression » à la page 124). Types Bac 1 Bac manuel Papier ordinaire ● ● Papier épais ● ● Papier fin ● ● Papier de luxe ● Papier couleur ● Papier cartonné ● Étiquettes ● Transparent ● Enveloppe ● Pré-imprimé ● Papier en coton ● Papier recyclé ● ● Papier archive ● ● (●: pris en charge, vide : non pris en charge) Ces types de support sont affichés dans Options d'impression. Cette option de type de papier vous permet de définir le type du papier chargé dans le bac. Ce format défini apparaît alors dans la liste et vous pouvez le sélectionner. Vous obtiendrez ainsi une qualité d’impression optimale. Dans le cas contraire, la qualité d’impression souhaitée peut ne pas être atteinte. • Papier ordinaire : papier ordinaire normal. Sélectionnez ce type si votre appareil est monochrome et imprime sur du papier de 60 à 90 g/ m2 . • Papier épais : papier épais 90 à 105 g/m2 . • Papier fin : papier fin 60 à 70 g/m2 . • Papier de luxe : papier de luxe 105 à 120 g/m2 . • Papier couleur: papier de couleur 75 à 90 g/m2 . • Papier cartonné: papier cartonné 90 à 163 g/m2 . • Étiquettes : étiquettes 120 à 150 g/m2 . • Transparent: papier transparent 138 à 146 g/m2 . • Enveloppe : enveloppe 75 à 90 g/m2 .Supports et bacs_ 53 • Pré-imprimé : papier à en-tête/pré-imprimé 75 à 90 g/m2 . • Papier en coton : papier en fibre de coton 75 à 90 g/m2 . • Papier recyclé : papier recyclé 75 à 90 g/m2 . Lorsque vous utilisez du papier recyclé, les impressions peuvent sembler froissées. • Papier archive : 70 à 90 g/m2 . Si vous devez conserver des imprimés pendant une longue période, des archives par exemple, sélectionnez cette option. Enveloppe La qualité d’impression sur les enveloppes dépend de la qualité des enveloppes. Pour imprimer une enveloppe, introduisez en premier dans l’imprimante la partie où figure la zone réservée au timbre, à savoir le côté gauche. Positionnez l’enveloppe au centre du bac manuel. Si les enveloppes imprimées présentent des plis, des froissements ou des lignes noires épaisses, ouvrez le capot arrière et abaissez le levier de pression, puis réessayez d’imprimer. Maintenez le capot arrière ouvert pendant l’impression. 1 Levier de pression • Lorsque vous choisissez des enveloppes, tenez compte des facteurs suivants : - Grammage : le grammage du papier de l’enveloppe ne doit pas dépasser 90 g/m2 sinon un bourrage risque de se produire. - Qualité de fabrication : les enveloppes doivent être stockées à plat, avec moins de 6 mm de plissement. Elles ne doivent pas contenir d’air. - État : les enveloppes ne doivent pas être froissées, éraflées ni endommagées. - Température : utilisez des enveloppes résistant à la température de fusion et à la pression de l’appareil durant le fonctionnement. • Utilisez uniquement des enveloppes de bonne qualité, dotées de rabats bien découpés et bien pliés. • N’utilisez pas d’enveloppes affranchies. • N’utilisez pas d’enveloppes à fermoir, à soufflet, à fenêtre, préencollées, adhésives, ou comportant d’autres matériaux synthétiques. • Évitez d’utiliser des enveloppes endommagées ou non conformes. • Vérifiez que la bande collée aux deux extrémités de l’enveloppe se termine bien aux coins de l’enveloppe. 1 Acceptable 2 Inacceptable • Les enveloppes avec une bande adhésive ou avec plusieurs rabats se superposant doivent utiliser des adhésifs compatibles avec la température de fusion (environ 170 °C) pendant 0,1 seconde. Les rabats et les bandes risquent de se plier, de se froisser, de provoquer des bourrages ou même d’endommager le four. • Pour une qualité d’impression optimale, laissez une marge d’au moins 15 mm à partir du bord de l’enveloppe. • Évitez d’imprimer sur les pliures de l’enveloppe. Transparent Pour ne pas endommager l’appareil, utilisez uniquement des transparents conçus pour les imprimantes laser. • Les transparents utilisés doivent pouvoir supporter la température de fusion de l’appareil. • Placez les transparents sur une surface plane après les avoir retirés de l’appareil. • Ne laissez pas les transparents inutilisés trop longtemps dans le bac d’alimentation papier. Il se peut que de la poussière s’accumule sur les transparents et provoque des taches sur les impressions. • Pour éviter les taches dues aux traces de doigts, manipulez-les délicatement. • Pour que les transparents imprimés ne se décolorent pas, évitez de les exposer trop longtemps à la lumière du soleil. • Assurez-vous que les transparents ne sont pas froissés ou ondulés et qu’ils ne sont pas déchirés sur les bords. • N’utilisez pas de transparents qui se séparent de la feuille de support. • Pour éviter que les transparents se collent les uns aux autres, retirez au fur et à mesure du bac de sortie les feuilles imprimées. Supports et bacs_ 54 Étiquettes Pour éviter d’endommager l’appareil, n’utilisez que des étiquettes conçues pour les appareils laser. • Lorsque vous choisissez des étiquettes, tenez compte des facteurs suivants : - Substance adhésive : le revêtement adhésif doit rester stable à la température de fusion (environ 170 °C) de l’appareil. - Disposition : n’utilisez pas de planches partiellement décollées où le fond de la planche est visible. Les étiquettes pourraient se décoller et provoquer des bourrages importants. - Plissement : avant l’impression, les étiquettes doivent être stockées à plat, avec moins de 13 mm d’ondulation quel que soit le sens. - État : n’utilisez pas d’étiquettes froissées, présentant des bulles d’air ou d’autres signes de décollement. • Vérifiez que la substance adhésive ne dépasse pas des étiquettes. Les zones exposées risqueraient de provoquer le détachement des étiquettes durant l’impression, entraînant des bourrages papier. De plus, la substance adhésive pourrait endommager certains composants de l’appareil. • N’utilisez pas plusieurs fois la même planche d’étiquettes. Le revêtement adhésif n’est prévu que pour un seul passage dans l’imprimante. • N’utilisez pas d’étiquettes se décollant de la planche ou encore froissées, gondolées ou abîmées. Papiers cartonnés ou de format personnalisé Cet appareil permet d’imprimer des cartes postales, des cartes et des formats personnalisés. • N’utilisez pas de supports de largeur inférieure à 76 mm et d’une longueur inférieure à 127 mm. • Dans l’application, définissez des marges d’au moins 6,4 mm par rapport aux bords du support. • Si le grammage est supérieur à 160 g/m2 , imprimez dans le capot arrière (face imprimée vers le haut). Papier à en-tête/papier pré-imprimé Une seule face Recto verso Bac 1 Face imprimée vers le bas Face imprimée vers le haut Bac manuel Face imprimée vers le haut Face imprimée vers le bas • Les encres utilisées sur les formulaires pré-imprimés doivent être thermostables ; elles ne doivent ni fondre, ni s’évaporer, ni émettre de substances toxiques lorsqu’elles sont soumises à la température de fusion de l’appareil un dixième de seconde. Vérifiez les spécifications de votre appareil pour connaître la température de fusion (environ 170 °C). • Ces encres ne doivent pas être inflammables ni endommager les rouleaux de l’appareil. • Les formulaires et papiers à en-tête doivent être conservés dans un emballage résistant à l’humidité pour éviter toute altération pendant la période de stockage. • Avant d’insérer du papier préimprimé ou du papier à en-tête dans l’imprimante, vérifiez que l’encre est bien sèche. Durant le processus de fusion, une encre encore humide risquerait de s’effacer du support pré-imprimé, diminuant ainsi la qualité de l’impression. Photo • Veillez à ne pas utiliser du papier photo pour jet d’encre avec cet appareil. Vous risqueriez d’endommager l’appareil. Brillant Chargez une feuille à la fois dans le bac manuel, face brillante orientée vers le haut. • Supports recommandés : papier brillant (Lettre) pour cet appareil HP Brochure Paper (Produit : Q6611A) uniquement. • Supports recommandés : papier brillant (A4) pour cet appareil HP Superior Paper 160 glossy (Produit : Q6616A).Supports et bacs_ 55 Réglage du type et du format de papier Après avoir inséré du papier dans le bac papier, configurez l’appareil en fonction du format utilisé à l’aide du panneau de commande. Ces paramètres s’appliquent aux modes copie et télécopie. Pour l’impression PC, sélectionnez le format et le type du papier dans l’application utilisée sur votre ordinateur (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). Les paramètres définis sous le pilote de l’appareil prennent autorité sur ceux qui sont définis à partir du panneau de configuration. Réglage du format de papier 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FORMAT PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le bac d’alimentation papier souhaité, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le format de papier souhaité. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Si vous souhaitez utiliser du papier de format spécial comme du papier à facture, sélectionnez Modifier... dans l’onglet Papier des Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). Réglage du type de papier 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TYPE PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le bac d’alimentation papier souhaité, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le type de support souhaité. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Réglage de la source de papier 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ALIM. PAPIER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que BAC COPIE ou BAC FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner le bac d’alimentation papier souhaité. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Utilisation du support de sortie papier La surface du bac de sortie peut chauffer si vous imprimez un grand nombre de pages en une seule fois. Ne touchez pas cette surface et ne laissez pas les enfants s’en approcher. Les pages imprimées s’empilent sur le support de sortie papier, et celui-ci permet d’aligner les pages imprimées. Elle envoie l’impression vers le bac de sortie par défaut. Assurez-vous que le capot arrière est bien fermé pour utiliser le bac de sortie. Si vous utilisez du papier au format A5, repliez le bac de sortie, sans quoi un mauvais alignement ou un bourrage des pages imprimées pourrait se produire. Empilement ferme des feuilles Si vous utilisez un appareil dans un endroit humide, ou si vous utilisez un support d’impression humide à cause d’une humidité élevée, les feuilles imprimées présentes sur le bac de sortie pourraient être voilées et pourraient ne pas s’empiler correctement. Dans ce cas, vous pouvez dire à l’appareil d’utiliser la fonction Empil. papier pour laisser les impressions s’empiler fermement. Toutefois, l’utilisation de cette fonction ralentira l’impression. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MAINTENANCE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que Empil. papier s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Supports et bacs_ 56 Récupération d’une impression de petite taille Lorsque vous imprimez sur un support de petite taille tel qu’une enveloppe ou un format personnalisé, l’impression réalisée pourrait, du fait de sa taille, ne pas être positionnée sur le support de sortie papier. Dans ce cas, récupérez l’impression en tirant sur le module de numérisation et refermez-le en vue d’une utilisation future. Une fois votre impression récupérée, fermez le module de numérisation en appuyant sur le bouton de fermeture du module.Impression_ 57 6.Impression Ce chapitre décrit les tâches d’impression courantes. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Fonctions des pilotes d’impression • Impression de base • Ouverture des préférences d’impression • Utilisation de l’aide • Utilisation des fonctions d’impression spéciales • Modification des réglages d’impression par défaut • Définition de votre appareil comme appareil par défaut • Impression dans un fichier (PRN) • Impression Macintosh • Impression Linux Les procédures de ce chapitre sont principalement basées sur Windows XP. Fonctions des pilotes d’impression Les pilotes d’impression de votre imprimante sont dotés des fonctionnalités standard suivantes : • Sélection de l’orientation du papier, du format, de la source et du type de support. • Nombre d’exemplaires. Vous pouvez également utiliser diverses fonctions d’impression spéciales. Le tableau ci-dessous récapitule les différentes fonctions prises en charges par les pilotes d’impression. Certains modèles ou systèmes d’exploitation peuvent ne pas prendre en charge une ou plusieurs fonctionnalités du tableau suivant. Pilote d’impression Fonction Windows Qualité d’impression ● Impression brochure ● Impression d’affiche ● Plusieurs pages par face ● Ajustement à la page ● Réduction/agrandissement ● Source d’alimentation différente pour la première page ● Filigrane ● Surimpression ● Impression recto verso (manuelle) ● (●: pris en charge, vide : non pris en charge) Impression de base Votre appareil vous permet d’imprimer à partir de diverses applications Windows, Macintosh ou Linux. La procédure exacte peut légèrement varier d’une application à l’autre. • La fenêtre Options d'impression peut être différente de celle présentée dans ce mode d’emploi selon l’appareil utilisé. Cependant, la composition de la fenêtre Options d'impression est similaire. Vérifiez quels systèmes d’exploitation sont compatibles avec l’appareil. Dans les spécifications de l’imprimante, reportez-vous à la section relative à la compatibilité des systèmes d’exploitation (voir « Configuration requise » à la page 33). • Lorsque vous sélectionnez une option dans Options d’impression, vous pouvez voir une marque d’avertissement, ou . Un point d’exclamation ( ) signifie que vous pouvez sélectionner cette option, mais qu’elle n’est pas recommandée, et une croix ( ) signifie que vous ne pouvez pas sélectionner cette option à cause de la configuration ou de l’environnement de votre appareil. La procédure ci-dessous décrit les étapes à suivre pour effectuer des impressions à partir de diverses applications Windows. Impression de base Macintosh (voir « Impression Macintosh » à la page 63). Impression de base Linux (voir « Impression Linux » à la page 64). La fenêtre Options d'impression suivante s’applique au Bloc-notes sous Windows XP. Votre fenêtre Options d'impression peut varier suivant votre système d’exploitation ou l’application utilisée. 1. Ouvrez le document à imprimer. 2. Sélectionnez Imprimer dans le menu Fichier. La fenêtre Imprimer s’ouvre. 3. Sélectionnez votre appareil dans la liste Sélectionnez une imprimante.Impression_ 58 Les paramètres d’impression de base, notamment le nombre de copies et le nombre de pages à imprimer sont sélectionnés dans la fenêtre Imprimer. Pour exploiter pleinement les fonctions de votre pilote d’impression, cliquez sur Propriétés ou Préférences dans la fenêtre Imprimer de l’application pour changer les paramètres d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 4. Pour démarrer l’impression, cliquez sur OK ou sur Imprimer dans la fenêtre Imprimer. Si vous utilisez Windows Internet Explorer, l’utilitaire Samsung AnyWeb Print vous permet de gagner du temps pour les images de capture d’écran ou pour imprimer l’image. Cliquez sur Démarrer > Tous les programmes > Samsung Printers > Samsung AnyWeb Print > Download the latest version pour accéder au site Web où se trouve l’utilitaire en téléchargement. Annulation d’une impression Si la tâche d’impression est en attente dans une liste ou une file d’attente d’impression, annulez-la comme suit : 1. Cliquez sur le menu Démarrer de Windows. 2. Pour Windows 2000, sélectionnez Paramètres > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows XP/2003, sélectionnez Imprimantes et télécopieurs. • Sous Windows 2008/Vista, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows 7, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Périphériques et imprimantes. • Sous Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel > Périphériques et imprimantes. 3. Sous Windows 2000, XP, 2003 et Vista, double-cliquez sur votre appareil. Sous Windows 7 et Windows Server 2008 R2, cliquez avec le bouton droit de la souris sur l’icône de votre imprimante > menus contextuels > Afficher les tâches d’impression en cours. Si la marque ► accompagne l’élément Afficher les tâches d’impression en cours, vous pouvez sélectionner les autres pilotes d’impression reliés à l’imprimante sélectionnée. 4. Dans le menu Document, sélectionnez Annuler. Vous pouvez également accéder à cette fenêtre en double-cliquant simplement sur l’icône de l’appareil ( ) dans la barre des tâches de Windows. Vous pouvez également annuler la tâche en cours en appuyant sur Arrêter/Suppr. sur le panneau de commande. Ouverture des préférences d’impression Vous pouvez prévisualiser les paramètres sélectionnés en haut à droite de la fenêtre Options d'impression. 1. Ouvrez le document à imprimer. 2. Sélectionnez l’option Imprimer dans le menu Fichier. La fenêtre Imprimer s’ouvre. 3. Sélectionnez votre appareil dans la liste Sélectionnez une imprimante. 4. Cliquez sur Propriétés ou sur Préférences. Utilisation d’un réglage favori L’option Préréglages, visible sur chaque de préférences à l’exception de l’onglet Samsung, vous permet d’enregistrer vos préférences de réglages actuels en vue d’une utilisation future. Pour enregistrer des réglages Préréglages : 1. Dans chaque onglet, modifiez les paramètres selon vos préférences. 2. Entrez un nom dans la zone de saisie Préréglages. 3. Cliquez sur Ajouter. Lorsque vous enregistrez des réglages Préréglages, tous les paramètres actuels du pilote sont enregistrés. Si vous cliquez sur Ajouter, le bouton Ajouter se change en Mettre à jour. Sélectionnez d’autres options et cliquez sur Mettre à jour ; les paramètres seront ajoutés aux Préréglages que vous avez effectués. Pour utiliser un paramétrage enregistré, sélectionnez le nom correspondant dans la liste déroulante Préréglages. L’appareil est à présent prêt à imprimer en fonction de votre sélection. Pour supprimer un paramétrage enregistré, sélectionnez le nom correspondant dans la liste déroulante Préréglages, et cliquez sur Supprimer. Vous pouvez également restaurer les réglages par défaut du pilote d’impression en sélectionnant Préréglage par défaut dans la liste déroulante Préréglages.Impression_ 59 Utilisation de l’aide Cliquez sur le point d’interrogation en haut à droite de la fenêtre, puis sur l’option pour laquelle vous souhaitez obtenir des informations. Une fenêtre apparaît alors, comportant des informations à propos des fonctionnalités de cette option du pilote. Si vous souhaitez effectuer une recherche par mots-clés, cliquez sur l’onglet Samsung dans la fenêtre Options d'impression, et saisissez un mot-clé dans le champ de l’option Aide. Pour plus d’informations à propos des consommables, mises à jour de pilote, inscriptions, etc., cliquez sur les boutons appropriés. Utilisation des fonctions d’impression spéciales Les fonctionnalités spéciales d’impression comprennent : • « Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille » à la page 59. • « Impression d’affiches » à la page 59. • *** 'Impression de documents reliés (manuelle)' on page 59 ***. • « Impression recto verso (manuelle) » à la page 60. • « Modification des proportions de votre document » à la page 60. • « Impression d’un document sur un format de papier donné » à la page 60. • « Impression de filigranes » à la page 60. • « Utilisation de la surimpression » à la page 61. • « Options avancées » à la page 62. Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille Vous pouvez sélectionner le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une même feuille. Si vous choisissez d’imprimer plusieurs pages par feuille, les pages sont réduites et organisées dans l’ordre indiqué. Vous pouvez imprimer jusqu’à 16 pages par feuille. 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet De base, sélectionnez Plusieurs pages par face dans la liste déroulante Type. 3. Sélectionnez le nombre de pages à imprimer par feuille (2, 4, 6, 9 ou 16) dans la liste déroulante Pages par face. 4. Sélectionnez l’ordre des pages dans la liste déroulante Ordre des pages, si nécessaire. 5. Cochez la case Bordures pour qu’une bordure encadre chaque page imprimée sur la feuille. 6. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier, sélectionnez le Format, Alimentation, et Type. 7. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Impression d’affiches Cette fonction vous permet d’imprimer un document d’une seule page sur 4, 9 ou 16 pages que vous pouvez coller ensemble pour former une affiche. 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet De base, sélectionnez Affiche dans la liste déroulante Type. 3. Sélectionnez la mise en page de votre choix. Spécification de la mise en page : • Affiche <2x2>: le document sera agrandi et divisé en 4 pages. • Affiche <3x3>: le document sera agrandi et divisé en 9 pages. • Affiche <4x4>: le document sera agrandi et divisé en 16 pages. 4. Sélectionnez la valeur Chevauchement. Spécifiez Chevauchement en millimètres ou pouces en sélectionnant la case d’option en haut à droite de l’onglet De base pour faciliter le collage des feuilles ensemble. 5. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier, sélectionnez le Format, Alimentation, et Type. 6. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. 7. Vous pouvez reconstituer l’affiche en collant les feuilles ensemble. Impression de documents reliés (manuelle) Cette fonction imprime votre document en recto verso et permet d’organiser les pages imprimées afin de pouvoir les relier en les pliant par leur milieu. Si vous souhaitez réaliser une brochure, vous devez imprimer sur un support au format Lettre, Légal, A4, Folio ou Oficio. 8 9 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet De base, sélectionnez Impression brochure dans la liste déroulante Type. 3. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier, sélectionnez le Format, Alimentation, et Type. L’option Impression brochure n’est pas disponible pour tous les formats papier. Pour trouver le format de papier disponible pour cette fonctionnalité, sélectionnez le format de papier disponible dans l’option Format de l’onglet Papier.Impression_ 60 Si vous sélectionnez un format de papier non disponible, cette option peut être automatiquement annulée. Sélectionnez uniquement du papier disponible (du papier sans la marque ou ). 4. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. 5. Une fois le document imprimé, pliez, puis agrafez les pages. Impression recto verso (manuelle) Vous pouvez imprimer sur les deux faces d’une feuille de papier, en recto verso. Avant d’imprimer, décidez de l’orientation de vos documents. Vous pouvez utiliser cette fonctionnalité avec du papier au format Lettre, Légal, A4, Folio ou Oficio (voir « Spécifications des supports d’impression » à la page 124). Nous vous conseillons de ne pas imprimer sur les deux faces de supports spéciaux tels que les étiquettes, les enveloppes ou le papier épais. Cela peut provoquer un bourrage ou endommager l’appareil. 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé. 3. Dans la section Impression recto-verso (manuelle), sélectionnez l’option de reliure souhaitée. • Aucune • Bord long: cette option est la mise en page traditionnelle utilisée pour la reliure des livres. • Bord court: cette option est la mise en page traditionnelle utilisée pour les calendriers. 4. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier, sélectionnez le Format, Alimentation, et Type. 5. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Si votre appareil ne dispose pas d’un module recto verso, vous devez terminer le travail d’impression manuellement. L’appareil imprime d’abord toutes les autres pages du document. Ensuite, un message apparait sur votre ordinateur. Suivez les instructions à l’écran pour terminer la tâche d’impression. Modification des proportions de votre document Vous pouvez modifier la taille d’un document pour l’agrandir ou le réduire à l’impression, en donnant le pourcentage souhaité. 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier. 3. Entrez le taux de mise à l’échelle dans la zone de saisie Pourcentage. Vous pouvez également cliquer sur les flèches haut et bas pour sélectionner l’échelle. 4. Sélectionnez Format, Alimentation, et Type dans Options du papier. 5. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Impression d’un document sur un format de papier donné Cette fonction vous permet d’adapter votre travail d’impression à n’importe quel format de papier, quelle que soit la taille du document. Elle peut s’avérer utile pour vérifier les détails d’un petit document. A 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Papier. 3. Sélectionnez le format de papier souhaité dans Ajuster à la page. 4. Sélectionnez Format, Alimentation, et Type dans Options du papier. 5. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Impression de filigranes L’option Filigrane vous permet d’imprimer du texte sur un document existant. Par exemple, vous l’utilisez lorsque vous souhaitez imprimer le texte « BROUILLON » ou « CONFIDENTIEL » en diagonale sur la première page ou sur toutes les pages d’un document. Plusieurs filigranes prédéfinis sont fournis avec l’appareil. Vous pouvez les modifier ou en ajouter des nouveaux à la liste. Impression_ 61 Utilisation d’un filigrane existant 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé, et sélectionnez le filigrane souhaité dans la liste déroulante Filigrane. Le filigrane sélectionné apparaît dans l’image d’aperçu. 3. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre d’impression. Création d’un filigrane 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Dans sur l’onglet Avancé, sélectionnez Modifier... dans la liste déroulante Filigrane. La fenêtre Modifier filigranes s’ouvre. 3. Saisissez le texte dans le champ Texte du filigrane. Vous pouvez entrer jusqu’à 256 caractères. Le texte s’affiche dans la fenêtre d’aperçu. Si la case Première page seulement est cochée, le filigrane est uniquement imprimé sur la première page. 4. Définissez les options du filigrane. Vous pouvez choisir la police, le style, la taille ou l’ombrage du filigrane dans la zone Attributs de police et son angle dans la zone Angle du texte. 5. Cliquez sur Ajouter pour ajouter un nouveau filigrane à la liste Filigranes actuels. 6. Lorsque vous avez terminé l’édition, cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Pour ne pas imprimer de filigrane, sélectionnez Aucun dans la liste déroulante Filigrane. Modification d’un filigrane 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé, sélectionnez Modifier... dans la liste déroulante Filigrane. La fenêtre Modifier filigranes s’ouvre. 3. Sélectionnez le filigrane à modifier dans la liste Filigranes actuels, puis modifiez le message et les options du filigrane. 4. Cliquez sur Mettre à jour pour enregistrer les modifications. 5. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Suppression d’un filigrane 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé, sélectionnez Modifier... dans la liste déroulante Filigrane. La fenêtre Modifier filigranes s’ouvre. 3. Sélectionnez le filigrane à supprimer dans la liste Filigranes actuels, puis cliquez sur Supprimer. 4. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Utilisation de la surimpression Les surimpressions consistent en du texte et/ou des images enregistrés sur le disque dur de l’ordinateur sous un format spécial et qui peuvent être imprimés sur n’importe quel document. Les surimpressions remplacent souvent les papiers à en-tête. Plutôt que d’avoir recours à un en-tête pré-imprimé, vous pouvez créer une surimpression comportant les mêmes informations que cet en-tête. Vous n’avez donc plus à charger votre papier à en-tête habituel pour imprimer une lettre à l’en-tête de votre entreprise. Faites simplement apparaître l’en-tête en surimpression sur le document. Création d’une surimpression de page Pour utiliser une surimpression de page, vous devez préalablement la créer, et y insérer un logo ou une image. 1. Créez ou ouvrez un document contenant le texte ou l’image que vous souhaitez utiliser comme nouvelle surimpression de page. Placez les éléments exactement comme vous souhaitez qu’ils apparaissent à l’impression sous forme de surimpression. 2. Pour enregistrer le document en tant que surimpression, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 3. Cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé, sélectionnez Modifier... dans la liste déroulante Texte. La fenêtre Modifier les surimpressions apparaît. 4. Dans la fenêtre Modifier les surimpressions, cliquez sur Créer. 5. Dans la fenêtre Enregistrer sous, saisissez un nom comportant jusqu’à huit caractères dans la zone Nom du fichier. Sélectionnez le chemin de destination, si nécessaire (le chemin par défaut est C:\Formover). 6. Cliquez sur Enregistrer. Le nom apparaît sur la Liste des surimpressions. 7. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. 8. Le fichier n’est pas imprimé. Il est enregistré sur le disque dur de votre ordinateur. Le format du document de surimpression doit être identique à celui du document imprimé avec la surimpression. Vous ne pouvez pas créer de surimpression comportant un filigrane. Utilisation d’une surimpression de page Une fois la surimpression créée, vous pouvez l’imprimer en l’appliquant à votre document. Pour imprimer une surimpression avec un document : 1. Créez ou ouvrez le document à imprimer. 2. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 3. Cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé. 4. Sélectionnez la surimpression souhaitée dans la liste déroulante Texte. 5. Si le fichier de surimpression souhaité n’apparaît pas dans la liste déroulante Texte, sélectionnez Modifier... dans la liste et cliquez sur Charger. Sélectionnez le fichier de surimpression que vous souhaitez utiliser. Impression_ 62 Si vous avez enregistré le fichier de surimpression à utiliser dans une source externe, vous pouvez le charger à partir de la fenêtre Ouvrir. Après avoir sélectionné le fichier, cliquez sur Ouvrir. Le fichier apparaît dans la zone Liste des surimpressions. Vous pouvez donc l’imprimer. Sélectionnez la surimpression dans la zone Liste des surimpressions. 6. Si nécessaire, cochez la case Confirmer la surimpression. Si cette case est cochée, un message vous demande de confirmer l’application de la surimpression, chaque fois que vous imprimez un document. Si cette case n’est pas cochée et qu’une surimpression est sélectionnée, cette dernière est automatiquement imprimée avec le document. 7. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. L’en-tête sélectionné s’imprime sur votre document. Le fichier de surimpression et le document à imprimer doivent avoir la même résolution. Suppression d’une surimpression Vous pouvez supprimer les surimpressions de page dont vous ne vous servez plus. 1. Dans la fenêtre Options d’impression, cliquez sur l’onglet Avancé. 2. Sélectionnez Modifier... dans la liste déroulante Surimpression. 3. Sélectionnez la surimpression à supprimer dans la boîte Liste des surimpressions. 4. Cliquez sur Supprimer. 5. Lorsque le message de confirmation apparaît, cliquez sur Oui. 6. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Options avancées Les options de l’onglet Graphiques permettent de régler la qualité d’impression en fonction de vos besoins. Si l’option est grisée ou n’est pas affichée, elle n’est pas applicable avec le langage imprimante utilisé. 1. Pour changer les paramètres d’impression à partir de votre application, accédez à la fenêtre Options d’impression (voir « Ouverture des préférences d’impression » à la page 58). 2. Cliquez sur l’onglet Graphiques. Reportez-vous à l’aide en ligne pour les informations de chaque option fournies pas les Options d'impression. • Police/Texte: sélectionnez Texte foncé pour imprimer les textes plus sombres que sur un document normal. Utilisez Tout le texte en noir pour imprimer en noir, sans se soucier de la couleur qui apparaît sur l’écran. • Économie de toner: en sélectionnant cette option, vous augmentez la durée de vie de la cartouche de toner et réduisez le coût par page, tout en ne réduisant que faiblement la qualité d’impression. - Activé : sélectionnez cette option pour permettre à l’imprimante d’utiliser moins de toner sur chaque page. - Désactivé : sélectionnez cette option si vous ne souhaitez pas économiser le toner. 3. Cliquez sur OK ou Imprimer jusqu’à ce que vous quittiez la fenêtre Imprimer. Modification des réglages d’impression par défaut 1. Cliquez sur le menu Démarrer de Windows. 2. Pour Windows 2000, sélectionnez Paramètres > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows XP/2003, sélectionnez Imprimantes et télécopieurs. • Sous Windows 2008/Vista, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows 7, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Périphériques et imprimantes. • Sous Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel > Périphériques et imprimantes. 3. Cliquez avec le bouton droit sur votre appareil. 4. Sous Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, cliquez sur Options d’impression. Sous Windows 7 et Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez, dans les menus contextuels, les Options d’impression. Si la marque ► accompagne l’élément Options d’impression, vous pouvez sélectionner les autres pilotes d’impression reliés à l’imprimante sélectionnée. 5. Dans chaque onglet, modifiez les paramètres. 6. Cliquez sur OK. Si vous souhaitez modifier les réglages pour chaque tâche d’impression, changez-les dans les Options d’impression. Définition de votre appareil comme appareil par défaut 1. Cliquez sur le menu Démarrer de Windows. 2. Pour Windows 2000, sélectionnez Paramètres > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows XP/2003, sélectionnez Imprimantes et télécopieurs. • Sous Windows 2008/Vista, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Imprimantes. • Sous Windows 7, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Périphériques et imprimantes. • Sous Windows Server 2008 R2, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel > Périphériques et imprimantes. 3. Sélectionnez votre appareil. 4. Cliquez avec le bouton droit sur votre appareil et sélectionnez Définir comme imprimante par défaut. Sous Windows 7 et Windows Server 2008 R2 Si la marque ► accompagne l’élément Définir comme imprimante par défaut, vous pouvez sélectionner les autres pilotes d’impression reliés à l’imprimante sélectionnée. Impression dans un fichier (PRN) Vous devrez parfois sauvegarder les données d’impression en tant que fichier. Pour créer un fichier :Impression_ 63 1. Dans la fenêtre Imprimer, cochez la case Imprimer dans un fichier. 2. Cliquez sur Imprimer. 3. Saisissez le chemin d’accès et le nom du fichier de destination, et cliquez ensuite sur OK. Par exemple c:\Temp\nom de fichier. Si vous ne saisissez que le nom de fichier, le fichier est automatiquement enregistré dans Mes documents. Impression Macintosh Cette section explique la manière d’imprimer avec un Macintosh. Vous devez définir l’environnement d’impression avant d’imprimer. • Connexion USB (voir « Macintosh » à la page 35). • Connexion réseau (voir « Macintosh » à la page 42). Impression d’un document Lorsque vous imprimez à partir d’un Macintosh, vous devez vérifier la configuration du pilote d’impression dans chaque application utilisée. Pour imprimer à partir d’un Macintosh, procédez comme suit : 1. Ouvrez le document à imprimer. 2. Ouvrez le menu Fichier et cliquez sur Format d’impression. 3. Choisissez votre format papier, l’orientation, la mise à l’échelle, les autres options, et assurez-vous que votre appareil est sélectionné. Cliquez sur OK. 4. Ouvrez le menu Fichier et cliquez sur Imprimer. 5. Sélectionnez le nombre de copies et indiquez les numéros des pages à imprimer. 6. Cliquez sur Imprimer. Modification des paramètres de l’imprimante Vous pouvez utiliser des options d’impression avancées proposées par votre appareil. Ouvrez une application et sélectionnez Imprimer dans le menu Fichier. Le nom d’appareil qui apparaît dans la sous-fenêtre des propriétés de l’imprimante peut varier en fonction de l’appareil utilisé. Le reste des éléments de la sous-fenêtre des propriétés de l’imprimante est toujours identique aux éléments suivants. • Les options de configuration peuvent varier en fonction des imprimantes et de la version de Mac OS utilisée. • La sous-fenêtre suivante peut varier suivant votre système d’exploitation ou l’application utilisée. La sous-fenêtre ci-dessous sera la première à s’afficher à l’ouverture de la sous-fenêtre des propriétés de l’imprimante. Sélectionnez d’autres options avancées dans la liste déroulante. Mise en page L’onglet Mise en page permet de présenter le document tel qu’il sera sur la page imprimée. Vous pouvez imprimer plusieurs pages par feuille. Sélectionnez Mise en page dans la liste déroulante sous Orientation pour accéder aux options suivantes. • Page(s) par feuille: cette option détermine le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une feuille (voir « Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille » à la page 64). • Orientation : cette option permet de choisir le sens de l’impression sur une page similaire aux exemples montrés. • Bordure: cette option vous permet d’imprimer une bordure autour de chaque page imprimée sur la feuille. • Inverser l’orlentation de la page: cette option vous permet de faire pivoter la page de 180 degrés. Graphiques L’onglet Graphiques propose des options pour sélectionner la Résolution. Sélectionnez Graphiques dans la liste déroulante sous Orientation pour accéder aux options graphiques. • Résolution (Qualité) : cette option vous permet de sélectionner la résolution d’impression. Plus la valeur est élevée, plus les caractères et les graphiques imprimés sont nets. Toutefois, une résolution élevée peut augmenter le temps d’impression d’un document. Papier Réglez le Papier Type pour faire correspondre le papier inséré dans le bac avec celui voulu pour l’impression. Vous obtiendrez ainsi une qualité d’impression optimale. Si vous utilisez un support différent, sélectionnez le type correspondant.Impression_ 64 Configuration de l’imprimante L’onglet Configuration de l’imprimante comporte les options du Mode économie de toner. Sélectionnez Configuration de l’imprimante dans la liste déroulante sous Orientation pour accéder aux fonctionnalités suivantes. • Mode économie de toner: en sélectionnant cette option, vous augmentez la durée de vie de la cartouche de toner et réduisez le coût par page, tout en ne réduisant que faiblement la qualité d’impression. - Activé : sélectionnez cette option pour permettre à l’imprimante d’utiliser moins de toner sur chaque page. - Désactivé : sélectionnez cette option si vous ne souhaitez pas économiser le toner. Impression de plusieurs pages sur une seule feuille Vous pouvez imprimer plus d’une page sur une seule feuille de papier. Cette option vous permet d’imprimer les brouillons en mode économique. 1. Ouvrez une application et sélectionnez Imprimer dans le menu Fichier. 2. Sélectionnez Mise en page dans la liste déroulante Orientation. Dans la liste déroulante Page(s) par feuille, sélectionnez le nombre de pages que vous souhaitez imprimer sur une feuille de papier. 3. Sélectionnez les autres options que vous souhaitez utiliser. 4. Cliquez sur Imprimer, puis l’appareil imprime le nombre de pages que vous souhaitez imprimer sur une feuille de papier. Impression Linux Impression à partir d’applications Vous pouvez réaliser des impressions à partir de nombreuses applications Linux, à l’aide du système CUPS (Common UNIX Printing System). Vous pouvez ainsi procéder à des impressions sur votre appareil à partir de n’importe quelle application de ce type. 1. Ouvrez une application et sélectionnez Print dans le menu File. 2. Sélectionnez Print directement à l’aide de la fonction lpr. 3. Dans la fenêtre LPR GUI, sélectionnez le nom de modèle de votre appareil dans la liste des imprimantes, puis cliquez sur Properties. 4. Modifiez les propriétés de la tâche d’impression en utilisant les quatre onglets suivants affichés en haut de la fenêtre. • General : cette option vous permet de changer le format de papier, le type de papier et l’orientation des documents. Elle permet la fonctionnalité recto verso, ajoute des bannières de début et de fin, et change le nombre de pages par feuille. • Text: cette option permet de définir les marges de la page et les options du texte, telles que l’espacement et les colonnes. • Graphics: cette option permet de déterminer les options d’image appliquées lors de l’impression des images fichiers, telles que les couleurs, la taille ou la position de l’image. • Advanced : cette option permet de définir la résolution d’impression, le papier, la source et les options d’impression spéciales. Si une option est grisée, cela signifie qu’elle n’est pas prise en charge. 5. Cliquez sur Apply pour appliquer les modifications et fermer la fenêtre Properties. 6. Pour lancer l’impression, cliquez sur OK dans la fenêtre LPR GUI. 7. La fenêtre d’impression s’ouvre : elle vous permet de surveiller l’état de la tâche d’impression. Pour annuler la tâche actuelle, cliquez sur Cancel. Impression de fichiers Vous pouvez imprimer de nombreux types de fichier différents sur l’appareil à l’aide de CUPS (de la manière habituelle, c’est-à-dire directement à partir de l’interface de ligne de commande). Pour ce faire, vous pouvez utiliser l’utilitaire CUPS lpr. Toutefois, le package du pilote remplace l’outil lpr classique par un programme graphique LPR beaucoup plus convivial. Pour imprimer un fichier : 1. Entrez lpr sur la ligne de commande du shell Linux, puis appuyez sur Enter. La fenêtre LPR GUI s’ouvre. Lorsque vous tapez uniquement lpr et que vous appuyez sur Enter, la fenêtre Select file(s) to print, s’affiche d’abord. Sélectionnez les fichiers à imprimer, puis cliquez sur Open. 2. Dans la fenêtre LPR GUI, sélectionnez l’appareil dans la liste, puis modifiez les propriétés de la tâche d’impression.Impression_ 65 3. Cliquez sur OK pour démarrer l’impression. Configuration des propriétés de l’imprimante La fenêtre Printer Properties associée à l’option Printers configuration permet de modifier les propriétés de votre appareil dans son rôle d’imprimante. 1. Ouvrez Unified Driver Configurator. Si nécessaire, passez à Printers configuration. 2. Dans la liste des imprimantes disponibles, sélectionnez l’appareil voulu, puis cliquez sur Properties. 3. La fenêtre Printer Properties s’ouvre. Les cinq onglets suivants apparaissent en haut de la fenêtre : • General : cette option permet de modifier l’emplacement et le nom de l’imprimante. Le nom entré dans cet onglet s’affiche dans la liste des imprimantes de Printers configuration. • Connection : cette option permet d’afficher ou de sélectionner un autre port. Si vous changez le port de l’appareil (passage d’un port USB à un port parallèle et réciproquement) en cours d’utilisation, vous devez reconfigurer le port de l’appareil dans cet onglet. • Driver: cette option permet d’afficher ou de sélectionner un pilote d’appareil. Cliquez sur Options pour définir les options par défaut du périphérique. • Jobs: cette option affiche la liste des tâches d’impression. Cliquez sur Cancel job pour annuler la tâche sélectionnée et cochez la case Show completed jobs pour afficher les tâches précédentes dans la liste des tâches. • Classes: cette option affiche la catégorie dans laquelle figure votre appareil. Cliquez sur Add to Class pour ajouter l’appareil à une catégorie précise ou sur Remove from Class pour supprimer l’appareil de la catégorie sélectionnée. 4. Cliquez sur OK pour appliquer les modifications et fermer la fenêtre Printer Properties.Copie de documents_ 66 7.Copie de documents Ce chapitre vous guide pas-à-pas dans le processus de copie de documents. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Copie de base • Changer le réglage pour chaque copie • Changer les réglages de copie par défaut • Utilisation des fonctions de copie spéciales • Choix de la forme de sortie de la copie • Réglage du délai de réinitialisation de copie Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Copie de base Vous trouverez ci-dessous la procédure normale de copie d’originaux. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Sur la vitre d’exposition » à la page 49 ou « Dans le chargeur de documents » à la page 50.) 3. Si nécessaire, réglez les paramètres pour chaque copie : RED./ AGRAND., LUMINOSITE, TYPE DOC. etc. (voir « Changer le réglage pour chaque copie » à la page 66). 4. Si nécessaire, saisissez le nombre de copies à réaliser à l’aide de la flèche ou du pavé numérique. 5. Appuyez sur Départ sur le panneau de commande pour lancer la copie. Pour annuler la copie en cours, appuyez sur la touche Arrêter/Suppr. du panneau de commande. Changer le réglage pour chaque copie Votre appareil propose des paramètres par défaut pour la copie, afin que vous puissiez effectuer rapidement et facilement une copie. Cependant, si vous souhaitez modifier les options pour chaque copie, utilisez les touches de fonction de copie sur le panneau de commande. Si vous appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. lors du paramétrage des options de copie, toutes les options définies pour la tâche en cours sont annulées et réinitialisées à leurs valeurs par défaut lorsque l’appareil a terminé la tâche en cours. Modification du contraste Si votre original comporte des marques atténuées ou des images sombres, vous pouvez ajuster la luminosité pour obtenir une copie dont la lecture soit plus facile. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que LUMINOSITE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le mode de contraste souhaité apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. • CLAIR : convient aux images sombres. • LE PLUS CLAIR : convient aux images plus sombres. • NORMAL : convient aux originaux tapés ou imprimés standard. • SOMBRE : convient aux images claires. • LE PLUS SOMB. : convient aux images plus claires ou aux marques au crayon de papier. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Sélection du type des originaux Le paramètre de type d’original permet d’améliorer la qualité de la copie en indiquant le type de document de la tâche de copie à effectuer. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TYPE DOC. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le mode d’image souhaité apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. • TEXTE : adapté aux documents contenant essentiellement du texte. • TEXTE/PHOTO : adapté aux documents contenant à la fois du texte et des photographies. • PHOTO : adapté aux photographies. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Réduction ou agrandissement de copies Vous pouvez réduire ou agrandir la taille d’une image copiée de 25 à 400 % par rapport au document original lorsque vous utilisez la vitre d’exposition, et de 25 à 100 % lorsque vous vous servez du chargeur automatique de documents. Pour sélectionner des formats de copie prédéfinis : 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RED./AGRAND. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le paramètre de taille souhaité apparaisse et appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Copie de documents_ 67 Mettre à l’échelle la copie en introduisant directement le pourcentage : 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RED./AGRAND. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que PERSO s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite ou le pavé numérique pour entrer la taille de copie souhaitée. Maintenez la flèche gauche/droite enfoncée pour faire défiler les valeurs plus rapidement. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Lors d’une réduction d’échelle, des lignes noires peuvent apparaître dans la partie inférieure de votre copie. Changer les réglages de copie par défaut Vous pouvez définir les options de copie, notamment la luminosité, le type d’original, le format de copie, le classement et le nombre d’exemplaires en fonction des modes les plus utilisés. Lorsque vous copiez un document, les paramètres par défaut sont utilisés, sauf si vous les modifiez à l’aide des touches correspondantes situées sur le panneau de commande. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MODIF. DEFAUT s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’option de configuration souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le paramètre souhaité apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Répétez les étapes 5 à 6, si nécessaire. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Lorsque vous paramétrez les options de copie, l’activation de la touche Arrêter/Suppr. annule les modifications effectuées et rétablit les valeurs par défaut. Utilisation des fonctions de copie spéciales Vous pouvez utiliser les options de copie suivantes : Copie de cartes d’identité Votre machine peut imprimer un document recto verso sur une seule feuille au format A4, Lettre, Légal, Folio, Exécutif, B5, A5 ou A6. L’appareil imprime le recto sur la moitié supérieure de la feuille et le verso sur la moitié inférieure de la feuille, sans réduire le format de l’original. Cette fonction est particulièrement adaptée aux documents de format réduit, tels que les cartes de visite. • Cette fonctionnalité est disponible uniquement lorsque vous placez les originaux sur la vitre d’exposition. • Le format des originaux à 2 faces doit être plus petit que A5, sinon une partie ne sera pas copiée. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Duo Copie du panneau de commande. 2. Placer recto et app. sur [Start] s’affiche à l’écran. 3. Placez la face avant d’un original face vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition, à l’endroit indiqué par la flèche, puis fermez le capot du scanner. 4. Appuyez sur la touche OK du panneau de commande. Votre appareil commence la numérisation de la face avant et indique Placer verso et app. sur [Start]. 5. Retournez l’original et placez-le sur la vitre d’exposition, à l’endroit indiqué par la flèche, puis fermez le capot du scanner. 6. Appuyez sur OK sur le panneau de commande pour lancer la copie. • Si l’original est plus grand que la zone imprimable, certaines parties risquent de ne pas apparaître à l’impression. • Si vous n’appuyez pas sur la touche OK, seul le recto est copié. • Si vous appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr., l’appareil annule le travail de copie et retourne en mode prêt. Copie de documents_ 68 Copie de type 2 pages ou 4 pages (pages multiples) L’appareil peut réduire le format des images originales et imprimer deux ou quatre pages sur une seule feuille. 1 2 1 2 3 4 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MISE EN PAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 2 pages/1 ou 4 PAGES/1 s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Lorsque OUI apparaît, appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur Départ sur le panneau de commande pour lancer la copie. Vous ne pouvez pas régler le format de copie à l’aide de RED./ AGRAND. pour la fonction N PAGES SUR 1. Copie de type Affiche L’original est divisé en neuf zones. Il suffit ensuite de coller ces feuilles ensemble pour former une affiche. Cette fonctionnalité est disponible uniquement lorsque vous placez les originaux sur la vitre d’exposition. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MISE EN PAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COPIE AFFICHE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. 7. Appuyez sur Départ sur le panneau de commande pour lancer la copie. L’original est divisé en neuf zones. Les zones sont numérisées et imprimées les unes après les autres dans l’ordre ci-après : Copie de type Clone L’appareil imprime plusieurs images d’origine sur une seule page. Le nombre d’images est automatiquement déterminé en fonction de l’image d’origine et du format de papier. Cette fonctionnalité est disponible uniquement lorsque vous placez les originaux sur la vitre d’exposition. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MISE EN PAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que DUPLICATION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Lorsque OUI apparaît, appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur Départ du panneau de commande pour lancer la copie. Vous ne pouvez pas régler le format de copie à l’aide de RED./ AGRAND. pour la fonction DUPLICATION. Effacement des images de fond Cette fonction est utile lors de la copie d’originaux contenant une couleur d’arrière-plan, comme les journaux ou les catalogues. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FONCT. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que REGLER LE FOND s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’option de reliure souhaitée apparaisse. • DESACTIVE : permet de désactiver cette fonction. • AUTO : permet d’optimiser l’arrière-plan. • Améliorée : plus le chiffre est élevé, plus l’arrière-plan sera de couleur vive. • Erase : plus le chiffre est élevé, plus l’arrière-plan sera clair. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Copie de documents_ 69 Choix de la forme de sortie de la copie Vous pouvez paramétrer l’appareil afin qu’il trie les tirages d’une tâche de copie. Par exemple, si vous effectuez 2 copies d’un original de 3 pages, vous obtiendrez un premier jeu de 3 pages, suivi d’un deuxième. 1. Appuyez sur (Copie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux, face imprimée vers le haut, dans le chargeur de documents. Vous pouvez également placer un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition et fermer le capot du scanner. 3. Appuyez sur OK et saisissez le nombre de copies à réaliser à l’aide de la flèche gauche/droite ou du pavé numérique. 4. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG. COPIE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MODIF. DEFAUT s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COPIES ASSEMB. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 8. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. • ACTIVE: permet d’imprimer des jeux de copie respectant l’ordre des originaux. • DESACTIVE: permet d’imprimer des jeux de copie triés par page. 9. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. 10.Appuyez sur Départ pour lancer la copie. Un document complet s’imprimera, puis le deuxième document complet. Réglage du délai de réinitialisation de copie Vous pouvez définir le temps d’attente de l’appareil avant le rétablissement des paramètres de copie par défaut, au cas où vous n’effectueriez pas de copie après avoir modifié les paramètres dans le panneau de commande. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TEMPORISATION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le délai souhaité s’affiche. Si vous sélectionnez DESACTIVE, l’appareil ne rétablit les paramètres par défaut qu’une fois que vous avez appuyé sur Départ pour effectuer une copie ou sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour annuler l’opération. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour valider votre choix. 7. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Numérisation_ 70 8.Numérisation Avec votre appareil, la numérisation vous permet de convertir des images et du texte en fichiers numériques pouvant être enregistrés sur votre ordinateur. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Méthode de numérisation de base • Numérisation d’originaux et envoi vers votre ordinateur (NUMER. VERS PC) • Utilisation du Gestionnaire de scan Samsung • Numérisation avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN • Numérisation avec le pilote WIA • Numérisation Macintosh • Numérisation Linux La résolution maximale que vous pouvez obtenir dépend de plusieurs facteurs, notamment la rapidité de votre ordinateur, l’espace disque disponible, la taille de la mémoire et celle de l’image à numériser, ainsi que le paramétrage de la profondeur de bit. Ainsi, selon votre système et l’objet que vous souhaitez numériser, vous ne pourrez pas utiliser certaines résolutions, surtout si vous faites appel à la fonctionnalité de résolution avancée. Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Méthode de numérisation de base Vous pouvez numériser les originaux avec votre appareil via un câble USB ou le réseau. • Gestionnaire de scan Samsung: Numérisez les originaux à partir du panneau de commande. Ensuite, les données numérisées seront stockées dans le dossier Mes documents de l’ordinateur connecté. Lorsque vous installez tous les logiciels du CD fourni, le Gestionnaire de scan Samsung est également installé automatiquement sur votre ordinateur. Vous pouvez utiliser cette fonction via la connexion locale ou réseau (voir « Utilisation du Gestionnaire de scan Samsung » à la page 71). • TWAIN : TWAIN est l’une des applications de gestion d’images prédéfinies. La numérisation d’une image lance l’application sélectionnée, vous permettant ainsi de contrôler le processus de numérisation. Vous pouvez utiliser cette fonction via la connexion locale ou réseau (voir « Numérisation avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN » à la page 72). • SmarThru: ce programme est le logiciel accompagnant votre appareil. Vous pouvez utiliser ce programme pour numériser des images ou des documents. Vous pouvez utiliser cette fonction via la connexion locale ou réseau (voir « SmarThru » à la page 92). • WIA: WIA signifie Windows Images Acquisition. Pour pouvoir utiliser cette fonction, votre ordinateur doit être directement connecté à l’appareil via un câble USB (voir « Numérisation avec le pilote WIA » à la page 72). Numérisation d’originaux et envoi vers votre ordinateur (NUMER. VERS PC) Vous pouvez numériser une image sur l’appareil via le programme Gestionnaire de scan Samsung installé sur votre ordinateur en réseau. Pour les appareils connectés via USB Voici une méthode de numérisation de base pour un appareil connecté par le port USB. 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 3. Appuyez sur (Numérisation) sur le panneau de commande. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NUMER. VERS PC s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que PC LOCAL s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. Si vous voyez le message INDISPONIBLE, vérifiez la connexion du port. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’application souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. Le paramètre par défaut est Mes documents. Pour ajouter ou supprimer le dossier de destination du fichier numérisé, ajoutez ou supprimez l’application dans Gestionnaire de scan Samsung > Propriétés > Définir bouton de numérisation. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le paramètre souhaité apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. • RESOLUTION : définit la résolution de l’image. • COULEUR NUMER. : définit le mode couleur. • FORMAT NUMER. : définit le format de fichier sous lequel l’image sera enregistrée. • TAILLE NUMER. : définit la taille de l’image. • FORMAT NUMER. apparaît uniquement lorsque vous sélectionnez la destination de numérisation Mes documents. • Si vous souhaitez numériser avec les paramètres par défaut, appuyez sur Départ.Numérisation_ 71 8. La numérisation commence. • L’image numérisée est enregistrée dans le dossier Mes documents > Mes images > Samsung de l’ordinateur. • Pour une numérisation rapide, vous pouvez utiliser le pilote TWAIN dans le programme Gestionnaire de scan Samsung. • Vous pouvez également numériser en appuyant sur Démarrer > Panneau de configuration > Gestionnaire de scan Samsung > Numérisation rapide dans Windows. Pour un appareil connecté au réseau Vérifiez que le pilote d’impression a été installé sur votre ordinateur à l’aide du CD de logiciels fourni, le pilote d’impression incluant le programme de numérisation (voir « Installation du pilote d’un appareil connecté à un réseau câblé ou via USB » à la page 41). 1. Assurez-vous que votre appareil et l’ordinateur sont connectés à un réseau et que le Gestionnaire de scan Samsung est installé sur l’ordinateur. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. 3. Appuyez sur (Numérisation) sur le panneau de commande. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NUMER. VERS PC s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que PC RESEAU s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. Si vous voyez le message INDISPONIBLE, vérifiez la connexion du port. 6. Sélectionnez l’ID de votre ordinateur enregistré et, au besoin, saisissez le MOT DE PASSE. • ID est la même ID que l’ID de l’ordinateur enregistrée pour Gestionnaire de scan Samsung. • MOT DE PASSE est le Mot de passe à 4 chiffres enregistré pour Gestionnaire de scan Samsung. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’application souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. Le paramètre par défaut est Mes documents. Pour ajouter ou supprimer le dossier de destination du fichier numérisé, ajoutez ou supprimez l’application dans Gestionnaire de scan Samsung > Propriétés > Définir bouton de numérisation. 8. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le paramètre souhaité apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. • RESOLUTION : définit la résolution de l’image. • COULEUR NUMER. : définit le mode couleur. • FORMAT NUMER. : définit le format de fichier sous lequel l’image sera enregistrée. • TAILLE NUMER. : définit la taille de l’image. • FORMAT NUMER. apparaît uniquement lorsque vous sélectionnez la destination de numérisation Mes documents. • Si vous souhaitez numériser avec les paramètres par défaut, appuyez sur Départ. 9. La numérisation commence. • L’image numérisée est enregistrée dans le dossier Mes documents > Mes images > Samsung de l’ordinateur. • Pour une numérisation rapide, vous pouvez utiliser le pilote TWAIN dans le programme Gestionnaire de scan Samsung. • Vous pouvez également numériser en appuyant sur Démarrer > Panneau de configuration > Gestionnaire de scan Samsung > Numérisation rapide dans Windows. Utilisation du Gestionnaire de scan Samsung Si vous avez installé le pilote d’impression, le Gestionnaire de scan Samsung l’est également. Démarrez le Gestionnaire de scan Samsung pour accéder aux informations de ce programme et à l’état du pilote de numérisation installé. Via ce programme, vous pouvez également modifier les paramètres de numérisation et ajouter ou supprimer les dossiers où sont enregistrés les documents numérisés sur l’ordinateur. Le Gestionnaire de scan Samsung ne peut être utilisé que sur les systèmes Windows et Mac OS. Si vous utilisez Macintosh, reportez-vous à « Paramétrage des informations de numérisation dans le Gestionnaire de numérisation » à la page 74. 1. À partir du menu Démarrer, cliquez sur Panneau de configuration > Gestionnaire de scan Samsung. Vous pouvez ouvrir le Gestionnaire de scan Samsung en faisant un clic droit sur l’icône du Smart Panel dans la barre des tâches Windows et en sélectionnant le gestionnaire de numérisation. 2. Sélectionnez l’appareil approprié depuis la fenêtre du Gestionnaire de scan Samsung. 3. Appuyez sur Propriétés. 4. L'onglet Définir bouton de numérisation vous permet de modifier la destination d’enregistrement et les paramètres de numérisation, ainsi que d’ajouter ou de supprimer des applications et des fichiers de format. Vous pouvez modifier l’appareil de numérisation à l’aide du paramètre Modifier port (local ou réseau). 5. Lorsque le paramétrage est terminé, appuyez sur OK. Onglet Définir bouton de numérisationNumérisation_ 72 Emplacement de numérisation • Liste des emplacements disponibles : affiche la liste des applications actuellement liée aux images numérisées dans le registre de l’ordinateur. Sélectionnez le programme que vous souhaitez utiliser puis cliquez sur la flèche droite, et ajouter à Liste des emplacements du panneau de commande. • Liste des emplacements du panneau de commande : affiche la liste d’applications pouvant ouvrir l’image numérisée. • Ajouter une application : vous permet d’ajouter l’application que vous souhaitez utiliser à Liste des emplacements disponibles, • Supprimer l’application : vous permet de retirer un élément ajouté par l’utilisateur dans la Liste des emplacements disponibles. • Format fichier : vous permet de sélectionner la forme des données numérisées à enregistrer. Vous avez le choix entre BMP, JPEG, PDF, et TIFF. Propriétés de numérisation • ID de l’ordinateur : indique l’ID de votre ordinateur. • Emplacement d’enregistrement : vous permet de choisir l’emplacement du dossier d’enregistrement par défaut. • Résolution: vous permet de choisir la résolution de numérisation. • Couleur de numérisation : vous permet de choisir la couleur de numérisation. • Taille de numérisation: vous permet de choisir la taille de numérisation. • CAD recto verso : numérise automatiquement les deux faces. Si votre modèle ne prend pas en charge cette option, elle sera grisée. • Afficher aperçu : le fait de cocher cette case vous permet de prévisualiser les options de numérisation appliquées. Vous pouvez modifier les options avant numérisation. • Par défaut : vous permet de revenir aux options par défaut. Onglet Modifier port Scanner local Sélectionnez si votre appareil est connecté par le port USB ou LPT. Scanner en réseau Sélectionnez si votre appareil est connecté par le port réseau. • Détection automatique sur le réseau : détecte automatiquement votre appareil. • Adresse IP: saisissez l’adresse IP de votre appareil pour le détecter. Numérisation avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN Si vous souhaitez numériser des documents à l’aide d’autres logiciels, vous devez utiliser un logiciel compatible TWAIN, comme Adobe Photoshop. Procédez comme suit pour numériser avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN : 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 3. Ouvrez une application, par exemple Adobe Photoshop. 4. Ouvrez la fenêtre TWAIN et définissez les options de numérisation. 5. Numérisez et sauvegardez votre image numérisée. Numérisation avec le pilote WIA L’appareil prend également en charge le pilote WIA (Windows Image Acquisition) de numérisation d’images. WIA est l’un des composants standard fournis par Microsoft Windows XP ; il fonctionne avec les appareils photo numériques et les scanners. Contrairement au pilote TWAIN, le pilote WIA permet de numériser des images et de les manipuler facilement sans avoir recours à d’autres logiciels. Le pilote WIA fonctionne uniquement sous Windows XP/Vista, sur le port USB. Windows XP 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 3. Dans le menu Démarrer, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Scanneurs et appareils photo. 4. Double-cliquez sur l’icône de votre pilote de numérisation. L’assistant Assistant Scanneur-appareil photo apparaît. 5. Cliquez sur Suivant. 6. Définissez l’option dans la fenêtre Choisir des préférences de numérisation et cliquez sur Aperçu pour voir dans quelle mesure les options affectent l’image. 7. Cliquez sur Suivant. 8. Entrez un nom d’image, puis sélectionnez un format et une destination de fichier pour enregistrer l’image. 9. Votre image a été copiée sur votre ordinateur. Choisissez l’une des options à l’écran. 10.Cliquez sur Suivant. 11.Cliquez sur Terminer. Windows Vista 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.)Numérisation_ 73 3. Dans le menu Démarrer, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Scanneurs et appareils photo. 4. Double-cliquez sur Numériser un document ou une image. L'application Télécopie et numérisation Windows apparaît. • Vous pouvez cliquer sur on Afficher les scanneurs et les appareils photo pour afficher les scanners. • S’il n’y a pas d’option Numériser un document ou une image, ouvrez le programme MS Paint et, dans Fichier, cliquez sur D’un scanneur ou d’un appareil photo... 5. Cliquez sur Nouvelle numérisation. Le pilote de numérisation apparaît. 6. Choisissez des options de numérisation et cliquez sur Aperçu pour obtenir un aperçu de votre image en fonction des options choisies. 7. Cliquez sur Numériser. Pour annuler une numérisation, appuyez sur le bouton Annuler de l’Assistant Scanneur-appareil photo. Windows 7 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 3. Dans le menu Démarrer, sélectionnez Panneau de configuration > Matériel et audio > Périphériques et imprimantes. 4. Cliquez avec le bouton droit de la souris sur l’icône du pilote de l’appareil dans Imprimantes et télécopieurs > Rechercher. L’application Nouvelle numérisation s’affiche. 5. Choisissez des options de numérisation et cliquez sur Aperçu pour obtenir un aperçu de votre image en fonction des options choisies. 6. Cliquez sur Numériser. Numérisation Macintosh Vous pouvez numériser des documents avec le programme Transfert d’images. Mac OS propose le programme Transfert d’images. Numérisation en USB 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 3. Démarrez Applications et cliquez sur Transfert d’images. Si le message Aucun appareil de transfert d’images apparaît, déconnectez le câble USB et reconnectez-le. Si le problème persiste, reportez-vous à l’aide de Transfert d’images. 4. Définissez les options de numérisation sur ce programme. 5. Numérisez et sauvegardez votre image numérisée. • Pour de plus amples informations concernant l’utilisation de Transfert d’images, reportez-vous à l’aide de Transfert d’images. • Utilisez des logiciels compatibles TWAIN pour appliquer plus d’options de numérisation. • Vous pouvez également numériser avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN, comme Adobe Photoshop. • Le processus de numérisation varie en fonction du logiciel compatible TWAIN utilisé. Reportez-vous au mode d’emploi du logiciel. • Si la numérisation ne fonctionne pas dans Transfert d’images, mettez à jour le système Mac OS à la dernière version. Transfert d’images fonctionne correctement dans Mac OS 10.3.9 ou version ultérieure et Mac OS X 10.4.7 ou version ultérieure. Numérisation en réseau 1. Assurez-vous que l’appareil est connecté à votre ordinateur et qu’il est sous tension. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 3. Démarrez Applications et cliquez sur Transfert d’images. 4. Sous Mac OS X 10.4 à 10.5 Cliquez sur Appareils, puis cliquez sur Parcourir le contenu des appareils. Sous Mac OS X 10.6 Sélectionnez votre appareil sous PARTAGÉS. Passez ensuite à l’étape 7. 5. Sous Mac OS X 10.4 : Sélectionnez votre appareil dans l’option des périphériques TWAIN. Assurez-vous que la case Utiliser le logiciel TWAIN est cochée, et cliquez sur Se connecter. • Si un message d’avertissement s’affiche, cliquez sur Modifier port pour sélectionner un port. • Si l’interface TWAIN s’affiche, dans l’onglet Préférences, cliquez sur Modifier port pour sélectionner un port. Reportez-vous au gestionnaire de numérisation pour l’utilisation de Modifier port (voir « Paramétrage des informations de numérisation dans le Gestionnaire de numérisation » à la page 74). Sous Mac OS X 10.5 : Vérifiez que la case Connecté est cochée en regard de votre appareil dans Appareils Bonjour. Si vous souhaitez numériser à l’aide de TWAIN, reportez-vous à la procédure ci-dessus pour Mac OS X 10.4. 6. Définissez les options de numérisation sur ce programme. 7. Numérisez et sauvegardez votre image numérisée. • Sous Mac OS X 10.3, utilisez des logiciels compatibles TWAIN. • Pour de plus amples informations concernant l’utilisation de Transfert d’images, reportez-vous à l’aide de Transfert d’images. • Utilisez des logiciels compatibles TWAIN pour appliquer plus d’options de numérisation. • Vous pouvez également numériser avec un logiciel compatible TWAIN, comme Adobe Photoshop. • Le processus de numérisation varie en fonction du logiciel compatible TWAIN utilisé. Reportez-vous au mode d’emploi du logiciel. • Si la numérisation ne fonctionne pas dans Transfert d’images, mettez à jour le système Mac OS à la dernière version. Transfert d’images fonctionne correctement dans Mac OS X 10.4.7 ou ultérieur.Numérisation_ 74 Paramétrage des informations de numérisation dans le Gestionnaire de numérisation Pour accéder aux informations sur le programme Gestionnaire de numérisation et sur l’état du pilote de numérisation installé, pour changer les paramètres de numérisation et pour ajouter ou supprimer les dossiers où les documents numérisés sur l’ordinateur sont enregistrés dans le gestionnaire de numérisation, suivez ces instructions : 1. Dans le menu Smart Panel de la barre d’état, cliquez sur Gestionnaire de numérisation. 2. Sélectionnez l’appareil approprié depuis le gestionnaire de numérisation. 3. Appuyez sur Propriétés. 4. L’onglet Définir bouton de numérisation vous permet de modifier la destination d’enregistrement et les paramètres de numérisation, ainsi que d’ajouter ou de supprimer des applications et des fichiers de format. Vous pouvez modifier l’appareil de numérisation à l’aide du paramètre Modifier port (local ou réseau). 5. Une fois terminé, appuyez sur OK. Numérisation Linux Vous pouvez numériser un document via la fenêtre Unified Driver Configurator. Numérisation 1. Double-cliquez sur l’icône Unified Driver Configurator du bureau. 2. Cliquez sur le bouton pour passer en mode Scanners configuration. 3. Sélectionnez le scanner dans la liste. Lorsque vous ne disposez que d’un appareil, et que celui-ci est connecté à l’ordinateur et sous tension, le scanner apparaît dans la liste et est sélectionné automatiquement. Si plusieurs scanners sont connectés à l’ordinateur, vous pouvez sélectionner n’importe lequel à tout moment. Par exemple, pendant que l’opération d’acquisition est en cours sur le premier scanner, vous pouvez sélectionner un deuxième scanner, définir les options du périphérique et lancer l’acquisition d’image. 4. Cliquez sur Properties. 5. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49.) 6. Dans la fenêtre Scanner Properties, cliquez sur Preview. Le document est numérisé et l’aperçu de l’image apparaît dans le Preview Pane. 7. Faites glisser le pointeur afin de définir la zone de l’image à numériser dans le Preview Pane. 8. Modifiez les options de numérisation dans les zones Image Quality et Scan Area. • Image Quality : cette option permet de sélectionner la composition des couleurs et la résolution de numérisation de l’image. • Scan Area : cette option vous permet de sélectionner la taille de la page. À l’aide du bouton Advanced, vous pouvez définir manuellement le format de page. Pour utiliser un paramètre d’option de numérisation prédéfini, sélectionnez-la dans la liste déroulante Job Type (voir « Ajout de paramètres Job Type » à la page 74). Cliquez sur Default pour rétablir les paramètres par défaut pour les options de numérisation. 9. Une fois les modifications terminées, cliquez sur Scan pour lancer la numérisation. La barre d’état apparaît dans l’angle inférieur gauche de la fenêtre ; elle affiche l’état d’avancement de la numérisation. Pour annuler la numérisation, cliquez sur Cancel. 10.L’image numérisée apparaît. Pour modifier l’image numérisée, utilisez la barre d’outils (voir « Utilisation du Image Manager » à la page 75). 11.Une fois l’opération terminée, cliquez sur Save dans la barre d’outils. 12.Sélectionnez le répertoire de fichiers dans lequel enregistrer l’image et entrez le nom du fichier. 13.Cliquez sur Save. Ajout de paramètres Job Type Vous pouvez enregistrer les paramètres des options de numérisation afin de les réutiliser plus tard. Pour enregistrer un nouveau paramètre Job Type : 1. Modifiez les options dans la fenêtre Scanner Properties. 2. Cliquez sur Save As. 3. Entrez le nom du paramètre. 4. Cliquez sur OK. Le paramètre est ajouté à la liste déroulante Saved Settings.Numérisation_ 75 Pour enregistrer un paramètre Job Type pour une prochaine tâche de numérisation : 1. Dans la liste déroulante Job Type, sélectionnez le paramètre à utiliser. 2. Lorsque vous ouvrez à nouveau la fenêtre Scanner Properties, le paramètre enregistré est sélectionné automatiquement pour la tâche de numérisation. Pour supprimer un paramètre Job Type : 1. Dans la liste déroulante Job Type, sélectionnez le paramètre à supprimer. 2. Cliquez sur Delete. Le paramètre est supprimé de la liste. Utilisation du Image Manager Le Image Manager permet de modifier les images numérisées, à l’aide de commandes de menu et d’outils. Pour modifier une image, utilisez les outils suivants : Outils Nom Fonction Save Enregistre l’image. Undo Annule la dernière action. Redo Restaure l’action annulée. Scroll Permet de faire défiler l’image. Crop Rogne la zone d’image sélectionnée. Zoom Out Applique un zoom arrière à l’image. Zoom In Applique un zoom avant à l’image. Scale Permet de mettre à l’échelle la taille de l’image ; vous pouvez entrer la taille manuellement ou définir un taux de mise à l’échelle proportionnelle, verticale ou horizontale. Rotate Permet de faire pivoter l’image ; vous pouvez sélectionner l’angle de rotation dans la liste déroulante. Flip Permet de retourner l’image verticalement ou horizontalement. Effect Permet de régler la luminosité ou le contraste de l’image, ou d’inverser l’image. Properties Affiche les propriétés de l’image. Pour plus de détails concernant l’application Image Manager, reportez-vous à l’aide à l’écran.Télécopie_ 76 9.Télécopie Ce chapitre fournit des informations sur l’emploi de votre appareil en tant que télécopieur. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Préparation à l’envoi de télécopie • Utilisation d’une télécopie sur votre ordinateur • Envoi d’une télécopie sur votre appareil • Réception d’une télécopie sur votre appareil • Configuration des paramètres de document • Transfert d’une télécopie vers une autre destination • Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses • Impression automatique d’un rapport de télécopie • Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser cet appareil comme télécopieur via le téléphone par Internet. Pour plus d’informations, consultez votre fournisseur d’accès à Internet. • Nous vous recommandons d’utiliser des services téléphoniques analogiques classiques (PSTN : réseau téléphonique public commuté) lors de la connexion des lignes téléphoniques pour utiliser la télécopie. Si vous utilisez d’autres services Internet (DSL, ISDN, VolP), vous pouvez améliorer la qualité de connexion en utilisant le Micro-filtre. Le microfiltre élimine les signaux de bruit inutiles et améliore la qualité de la connexion ou d’Internet. Étant donné que le Micro-filtre DSL n’est pas fourni avec l’appareil, contactez votre fournisseur de services Internet pour l’utilisation sur le Micro-filtre DSL. 1 Port ligne 2 Micro filtre 3 Modem DSL/Ligne téléphonique Les fonctions et les périphériques optionnels pris en charge peuvent varier selon le modèle. Veuillez vérifier le nom de votre modèle. (Voir « Fonctionnalités par modèle » à la page 26.) Préparation à l’envoi de télécopie Avant d’envoyer ou de recevoir une télécopie, vous devez raccorder le cordon fourni à la prise murale. Reportez-vous au Guide d’installation rapide pour la procédure de connexion. La mise en place d’une connexion téléphonique varie d’un pays à un autre. Utilisation d’une télécopie sur votre ordinateur Vous pouvez envoyer et recevoir une télécopie depuis votre ordinateur sans utiliser l’appareil. Envoi d’une télécopie Pour envoyer une télécopie à partir de votre ordinateur, le programme Samsung Network PC Fax doit être installé. Ce programme sera installé lors de l’installation du pilote d’imprimante. 1. Ouvrez le document à envoyer. 2. Sélectionnez Imprimer dans le menu Fichier. La fenêtre Imprimer s’affiche. Son apparence peut légèrement varier selon les applications. 3. Sélectionnez Samsung Network PC Fax dans la fenêtre Imprimer. 4. Cliquez sur Imprimer ou OK. 5. Saisissez les numéros des destinataires et sélectionnez l’option. Pour utiliser une page de garde, cochez la case Utiliser une page de garde. Cochez la case Notify me on delivery une fois la télécopie bien reçue par les destinataires. 6. Cliquez sur Envoyer. Pour de plus amples informations concernant Samsung Network PC Fax, cliquez sur Help. Consultation de liste de télécopies envoyées Vous pouvez consulter une liste des télécopies envoyées sur votre ordinateur. Dans le menu Démarrer, cliquez sur Programmes ou Tous les programmes > Samsung Printers > Network PC Fax > Fax Journal. La fenêtre Fax Journal s’ouvre alors avec la liste des télécopies envoyées.Télécopie_ 77 Réception d’une télécopie Si vous avez installé le pilote d’impression, le programme Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung l’est également. Démarrez le programme Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung pour accéder aux informations de ce programme et à l’état du pilote installé. Via ce programme, vous pouvez modifier les paramètres de télécopie et ajouter ou supprimer les dossiers où sont enregistrés les documents télécopiés sur l’ordinateur. Le programme Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung ne peut être utilisé que sur les systèmes Windows et Mac OS. Vérifiez si le transfert d’une télécopie vers PC est défini sur ACTIVE : a) Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. b) Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. c) Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. d) Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que REROUTAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. e) Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que PC s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 1. Ouvrez Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung. • Sous Windows, à partir du menu Démarrer, cliquez sur Panneau de configuration > Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung. Vous pouvez ouvrir ce programme en cliquant avec le bouton droit de la souris sur l’icône du Smart Panel dans la barre des tâches de Windows et en sélectionnant Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung. • Pour les ordinateurs Macintosh, cliquez sur Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung dans le menu Smart Panel de la barre d’état. 2. Sélectionnez l’appareil approprié depuis Gestionnaire de numérisation et de télécopie Samsung. 3. Cliquez sur Propriétés. 4. Utilisez Configurer la réception de télécopies pour modifier les paramètres de télécopie. 5. Lorsque le paramétrage est terminé, appuyez sur OK. Onglet Configurer la réception de télécopies • Activer la réception de télécopies: vous pouvez indiquer si vous souhaitez ou non l’utiliser. • Format fichier: vous pouvez convertir les télécopies reçues en PDF ou TIFF. • Emplacement d’enregistrement: permet de sélectionner le dossier d’enregistrement des télécopies converties. • Préfixe: permet de sélectionner le schéma de fichier ou de dossier en tant que préfixe. • Imprimer la télécopie reçue: une fois la télécopie reçue, permet d’imprimer les informations de la télécopie reçue. • M’envoyer une notification une fois la télécopie reçue: affiche une fenêtre contextuelle avertissant de la réception d’une télécopie. Onglet Modifier port Scanner local Sélectionnez si votre appareil est connecté par le port USB ou LPT. Scanner en réseau Sélectionnez si votre appareil est connecté par le port réseau. • Détection automatique sur le réseau: détecte automatiquement votre appareil. • Adresse IP: saisissez l’adresse IP de votre appareil pour le détecter. Envoi d’une télécopie sur votre appareil Cette partie explique comment envoyer une télécopie et quelles sont les méthodes spéciales de transmission. Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de documents tout comme la vitre d’exposition pour charger les originaux (voir « Mise en place des originaux » à la page 49). Si les originaux sont placés à la fois dans le chargeur de documents et sur la vitre d’exposition, l’appareil lit d’abord les documents du chargeur de documents, qui est prioritaire en matière de numérisation. Réglage de l’en-tête de télécopie Dans certains pays, vous devez, afin de vous acquitter de vos obligations légales, indiquer votre numéro de télécopie sur toutes les télécopies que vous envoyez. Télécopie_ 78 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG SYSTEME s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ID MACHINE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez votre nom ou celui de votre entreprise à l’aide du pavé numérique. Vous pouvez saisir des caractères alphanumériques à l’aide du pavé numérique, y compris des symboles spéciaux, en appuyant sur la touche 1. Pour plus de détails concernant la saisie de caractères alphanumériques, reportez-vous à la section « Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique » à la page 46. 6. Appuyez sur OK pour enregistrer l’identifiant. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NO. MACH. FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 8. Saisissez votre numéro de télécopie à l’aide du clavier numérique, puis appuyez sur OK. 9. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Envoi d’une télécopie 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. (Voir « Sur la vitre d’exposition » à la page 49 ou « Dans le chargeur de documents » à la page 50.) 3. Vous pouvez ajuster la résolution et le contraste du document (voir « Configuration des paramètres de document » à la page 81). 4. Saisissez le numéro du télécopieur de réception. Vous pouvez utiliser les numéros de composition abrégée ou les numéros de composition de groupe. Pour plus de détails concernant l’enregistrement et la recherche d’un numéro, reportez-vous à la section « Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses » à la page 83. 5. Appuyez sur la touche Départ du panneau de commande. L’appareil lance la numérisation et envoie la télécopie aux destinataires. • Si vous souhaitez envoyer une télécopie directement à partir de votre ordinateur, utilisez Samsung Network PC Fax (voir « Envoi d’une télécopie » à la page 76). • Lorsque vous souhaitez annuler une télécopie, appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. avant que l’appareil ne lance la transmission. • Si vous avez utilisé la vitre d’exposition, un message vous invite à charger une autre page. Envoi manuel d’une télécopie Cette méthode envoie une télécopie à l’aide de Ligne sur le panneau de commande. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. 3. Vous pouvez ajuster la résolution et le contraste du document (voir « Configuration des paramètres de document » à la page 81). 4. Appuyez sur la touche Ligne du panneau de commande ou soulevez le combiné. 5. Saisissez un numéro de télécopie à l’aide du clavier numérique du panneau de configuration. 6. Appuyez sur Départ lorsque vous percevez le signal sonore aigu du télécopieur distant. Pour annuler une télécopie, appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. à n’importe quel stade de l’envoi. Confirmation d’une transmission Lorsque la dernière page de votre original a été envoyée avec succès, l’appareil émet un signal sonore et revient en mode prêt. Si un dysfonctionnement survient en cours de transmission, un message d’erreur s’affiche à l’écran. Pour consulter la liste des messages d’erreur et leur signification, reportez-vous à la section « Signification des messages d’erreur » à la page 104. Si vous recevez un message d’erreur, appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour effacer le message et essayez à nouveau d’envoyer la télécopie. Vous pouvez configurer votre appareil pour qu’il imprime un rapport de façon automatique après chaque envoi de télécopie. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à la section « Impression automatique d’un rapport de télécopie » à la page 84. Recomposition automatique Si le numéro que vous avez composé est occupé ou ne répond pas lorsque vous essayez d’envoyer une télécopie, l’appareil recompose automatiquement le numéro toutes les trois minutes et jusqu’à sept fois de suite, conformément aux paramètres d’usine par défaut. Si l’écran affiche RECOMPOSER ?, appuyez sur OK pour recomposer immédiatement le numéro. Pour annuler la recomposition automatique, appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. Pour modifier l’intervalle entre les recompositions et le nombre d’essais de recomposition, consultez « Modification des options de configuration de télécopie » à la page 85. Recomposition du dernier numéro Pour recomposer le dernier numéro appelé : 1. Appuyez sur la touche Bis/Pause du panneau de commande. 2. Lorsqu’un original est placé dans le chargeur de documents, la transmission démarre automatiquement. Si vous placez un original sur la vitre d’exposition, sélectionnez OUI pour ajouter une autre page. Placez un autre original, puis appuyez sur OK. Lorsque vous avez terminé, sélectionnez NON à l’invite AUTRE PAGE? Envoi d’une télécopie vers plusieurs destinataires Utilisez la fonction d’envoi multiple pour envoyer une télécopie vers plusieurs destinataires. Les originaux sont automatiquement enregistrés dans la mémoire et envoyés à un système distant. Une fois transmis, les documents sont automatiquement effacés de la mémoire. Vous ne pouvez pas envoyer de télécopie couleur avec cette fonction. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. 3. Vous pouvez ajuster la résolution et le contraste du document (voir « Configuration des paramètres de document » à la page 81). 4. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ENVOI MULTIPLE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK.Télécopie_ 79 7. Introduisez le numéro du premier télécopieur de réception, puis appuyez sur OK. Vous pouvez appuyer sur les numéros de composition abrégée ou sélectionner un numéro de composition de groupe à l’aide de la touche Répertoire. Pour plus d’informations, voir « Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses » à la page 83. 8. Saisissez le deuxième numéro de télécopie, puis appuyez sur OK. Un message vous invite à saisir un autre numéro de télécopie auquel envoyer le document. 9. Pour saisir d’autres numéros de télécopie, appuyez sur OK lorsque OUI s’affiche, puis répétez les étapes 7 et 8. Vous pouvez ajouter jusqu’à 10 destinataires. 10.Appuyez sur OK pour lancer l’enregistrement des originaux numérisés dans la mémoire. Dès que vous aurez saisi un numéro de composition de groupe, vous ne pourrez plus saisir d’autres numéros de composition de groupe. 11.Lorsque vous avez terminé la saisie des numéros de télécopie, appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner NON à l’invite AUTRE NO.?, puis appuyez sur OK. 12.Si vous placez un original sur la vitre d’exposition, sélectionnez OUI pour ajouter d’autres pages. Placez un autre original, puis appuyez sur OK. Lorsque vous avez terminé, sélectionnez NON à l’invite AUTRE PAGE? L’appareil commence à envoyer la télécopie aux numéros indiqués, en suivant l’ordre dans lequel vous les avez saisis. Envoi d’une télécopie différée Vous pouvez configurer votre appareil pour qu’il envoie une télécopie en votre absence. Vous ne pouvez pas envoyer de télécopie couleur avec cette fonction. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. 3. Vous pouvez ajuster la résolution et le contraste du document (voir « Configuration des paramètres de document » à la page 81). 4. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ENV. DIFFERE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Introduisez le numéro du premier télécopieur de réception, puis appuyez sur OK. Vous pouvez appuyer sur les numéros de composition abrégée ou sélectionner un numéro de composition de groupe à l’aide de la touche Répertoire. Pour plus d’informations, voir « Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses » à la page 83. 8. Un message vous invite à saisir un autre numéro de télécopie auquel envoyer le document. 9. Pour saisir d’autres numéros de télécopie, appuyez sur OK lorsque OUI s’affiche, puis répétez l’étape 7 et 8. Vous pouvez ajouter jusqu’à 10 destinataires. Dès que vous aurez saisi un numéro de composition de groupe, vous ne pourrez plus saisir d’autres numéros de composition de groupe. 10.Lorsque vous avez terminé la saisie des numéros de télécopie, appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner NON à l’invite AUTRE NO.?, puis appuyez sur OK. 11.Introduisez le nom de tâche que vous souhaitez, puis appuyez sur OK. Pour plus de détails concernant la saisie de caractères alphanumériques, reportez-vous à la section « Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique » à la page 46. Si vous ne souhaitez pas attribuer de nom, ignorez cette étape. 12.Entrez l’heure à l’aide du clavier numérique, puis appuyez sur OK. Si vous introduisez une heure antérieure à l’heure actuelle, la télécopie sera envoyée à l’heure indiquée le lendemain. L’original est mémorisé avant d’être transmis. 13.Si vous placez un original sur la vitre d’exposition, sélectionnez OUI pour ajouter d’autres pages. Placez un autre original, puis appuyez sur OK. Lorsque vous avez terminé, sélectionnez NON à l’invite AUTRE PAGE? L’appareil se remet en mode prêt. L’écran affiche un message vous indiquant que le mode prêt est activé et qu’un envoi en différé est programmé. Ajout de documents à une tâche de télécopie différée et réservée Vous pouvez ajouter d’autres documents à la tâche de télécopie différée enregistrée en mémoire. 1. Chargez les originaux à ajouter et réglez les paramètres du document. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que AJOUTER PAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que la tâche de télécopie souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. Lorsque vous avez terminé, sélectionnez NON à l’invite AUTRE PAGE? L’appareil numérise l’original en mémoire. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Annulation d’une tâche de télécopie différée réservée Vous pouvez annuler la tâche de télécopie différée enregistrée en mémoire. 1. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ANNULER TACHE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que la tâche de télécopie souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur OK lorsque OUI s’affiche. La télécopie sélectionnée est effacée de la mémoire. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Envoi d’une télécopie prioritaire Utilisez cette fonction lorsqu’une télécopie prioritaire doit être envoyée avant toute autre opération programmée. L’original est mémorisé, puis envoyé immédiatement dès la fin de l’opération en cours. En outre, les envois prioritaires interrompent les opérations d’envoi multiple entre deux envois (par exemple, à la fin de l’envoi au poste A et avant le début de l’envoi au poste B) ou deux tentatives de recomposition.Télécopie_ 80 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Placez les originaux face imprimée vers le haut dans le chargeur de documents ou un seul original face imprimée vers le bas sur la vitre d’exposition. 3. Vous pouvez ajuster la résolution et le contraste du document (voir « Configuration des paramètres de document » à la page 81). 4. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ENVOI PRIORIT. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Introduisez le numéro du premier télécopieur de réception, puis appuyez sur OK. Vous pouvez appuyer sur les numéros de composition abrégée ou sélectionner un numéro de composition de groupe à l’aide de la touche Répertoire. Pour plus d’informations, voir « Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses » à la page 83. 8. Introduisez le nom de tâche que vous souhaitez, puis appuyez sur OK. L’original est mémorisé avant d’être transmis. 9. Si vous placez un original sur la vitre d’exposition, sélectionnez OUI pour ajouter d’autres pages. Placez un autre original, puis appuyez sur OK. Lorsque vous avez terminé, sélectionnez NON à l’invite AUTRE PAGE? L’appareil lance la numérisation et envoie la télécopie aux destinataires. Réception d’une télécopie sur votre appareil Cette partie explique comment recevoir une télécopie et décrit les différentes méthodes de réception disponibles. Modification des modes de réception Par défaut, votre appareil est préconfiguré en mode FAX. Lorsque vous recevez une télécopie, l’appareil répond à l’appel au bout d’un certain nombre de sonneries et la réception a lieu de façon automatique. Si vous souhaitez passer à un autre mode, reportez-vous aux étapes suivantes : 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG. FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RECEPTION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MODE RECEPTION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le mode de réception des télécopies souhaité s’affiche. • FAX : répond à une télécopie entrante et passe immédiatement en mode de réception de télécopies. • TEL : permet de recevoir une télécopie en appuyant sur Ligne puis sur Départ. Si votre appareil est équipé d’un combiné, vous pouvez recevoir une télécopie en le décrochant. • REP/FAX : à utiliser lorsqu’un répondeur est connecté à l’appareil. L’appareil répond aux appels entrants et votre correspondant peut laisser un message sur le répondeur. Si le télécopieur détecte une tonalité de télécopie, l’appareil passe automatiquement en mode Fax pour recevoir la télécopie. • DRPD : vous pouvez recevoir un appel à l’aide de la fonction de détection du motif de sonnerie distinct (DRPD). Le service téléphonique de sonnerie distincte permet à un utilisateur de se servir d’une seule ligne téléphonique pour répondre à différents numéros de téléphone. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à la section « Réception des télécopies en mode DRPD » à la page 81. 7. Appuyez sur OK pour enregistrer votre sélection. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. • Pour utiliser le mode REP/FAX, vous devez brancher un répondeur sur la prise gigogne à l’arrière de l’appareil. • Si vous souhaitez éviter que d’autres personnes aient accès à vos documents, vous pouvez utiliser le mode de réception sécurisée. Avec ce mode, toutes les télécopies reçues sont enregistrées dans la mémoire. Pour plus d’informations, reportez-vous à la section « Réception en mode de réception sécurisée » à la page 81. Réception manuelle en mode Tél Vous pouvez recevoir une télécopie en appuyant sur Ligne, puis en appuyant sur Départ lorsque vous entendez la tonalité de télécopie du télécopieur distant. L’appareil commence la réception du fax. Si votre appareil est équipé d’un combiné, vous pouvez l’utiliser pour répondre aux appels. Pour modifier le nombre de sonneries, reportez-vous à la section « Modification des options de configuration de télécopie » à la page 85. Réception automatique en mode Répondeur/ Télécopie Pour pouvoir utiliser ce mode, vous devez connecter un répondeur à la prise EXT située à l’arrière de l’appareil (voir « Vue arrière » à la page 28). Si l’interlocuteur laisse un message, le répondeur l’enregistre comme il le ferait en temps normal. Si votre appareil détecte une tonalité de télécopieur sur la ligne, il commence automatiquement la réception de la télécopie. • Si vous avez réglé l’appareil sur ce mode et que votre répondeur est éteint ou qu’aucun répondeur n’est connecté à la prise EXT, l’appareil passe automatiquement en mode Fax après un nombre de sonneries prédéfini. • Si votre répondeur est doté d’un compteur de sonneries paramétrable par l’utilisateur, réglez-le de sorte qu’il réponde aux appels au bout d’une sonnerie. • Si vous êtes en mode Tél et qu’un répondeur est connecté à l’appareil, vous devez éteindre le répondeur. Sinon, son message d’accueil interrompra votre conversation téléphonique. Réception manuelle de télécopies avec un téléphone auxiliaire Pour une utilisation optimale de cette fonction, vous devez brancher un téléphone auxiliaire sur la prise EXT située à l’arrière de l’appareil. Vous pouvez recevoir une télécopie d’une personne avec qui vous êtes en train de parler au téléphone sans vous déplacer jusqu’au télécopieur. Lorsque vous recevez un appel sur le poste téléphonique et que vous percevez la tonalité de télécopie, appuyez sur les touches *9* du téléphone auxiliaire. L’appareil reçoit la télécopie. Appuyez sur les touches doucement et l’une après l’autre. Si vous continuez à percevoir la tonalité de télécopie de la part du télécopieur de votre correspondant, appuyez à nouveau sur les touches *9*. *9* est le code de réception prédéfini en usine. Les astérisques de début et de fin sont fixes, mais vous pouvez modifier le numéro du milieu par celui de votre choix. Pour plus d’informations concernant la modification du code, reportez-vous à « Modification des options de configuration de télécopie » à la page 85.Télécopie_ 81 Réception des télécopies en mode DRPD Le service téléphonique de sonnerie distincte permet à un utilisateur de se servir d’une seule ligne téléphonique pour répondre à différents numéros de téléphone. Le numéro utilisé pour vous appeler est identifiable grâce à un motif de sonnerie déterminé, constitué d’une série de signaux sonores plus ou moins longs. Cette fonction est souvent utilisée par les services qui répondent aux appels destinés à plusieurs clients et qui ont besoin de connaître le numéro composé pour pouvoir répondre à l’appel de façon appropriée. La fonction de détection du motif de sonnerie distincte (DRPD) permet à votre télécopieur de mémoriser le motif de sonnerie auquel il doit répondre. Sauf modification ultérieure, ce motif de sonnerie sera toujours interprété comme un appel de type télécopie. Tous les autres motifs sont transmis au poste téléphonique ou au répondeur relié au connecteur d’extension. Vous pouvez facilement interrompre ou modifier la fonction DRPD à n’importe quel moment. Pour pouvoir utiliser l’option DRPD, demandez à votre opérateur d’installer le service de sonnerie distinctive sur votre ligne téléphonique. Pour configurer la détection de motifs de sonnerie distincte (DRPD), vous devez disposer d’une seconde ligne téléphonique au même endroit ou prévoir qu’une personne compose votre numéro de télécopie depuis l’extérieur. Pour configurer le mode DRPD : 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG. FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RECEPTION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que MODE RECEPTION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que DRPD s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. ATT. SONNERIE s’affiche sur l’écran. 7. Appelez votre numéro de télécopieur à partir d’un autre téléphone. Il n’est pas nécessaire d’effectuer l’appel à partir d’un télécopieur. 8. Laissez sonner votre appareil. L’appareil a besoin de plusieurs sonneries pour apprendre la séquence. Une fois cet apprentissage effectué, l’écran affichera le message CONFIG DRPD TERMINEE. Si la configuration DRPD échoue, ERREUR SONN. DRPD apparaît. Appuyez sur OK lorsque DRPD s’affiche, et recommencez à partir de l’étape 6. • Le mode DRPD doit être reconfiguré à chaque fois que vous modifiez le numéro de votre télécopieur ou que vous connectez l’appareil à une autre ligne téléphonique. • Une fois le mode DRPD configuré, appelez à nouveau votre télécopieur pour vérifier que l’appareil répond avec une tonalité de fax. Composez ensuite un numéro différent attribué à la même ligne afin d’être certain que l’appel est transmis au poste téléphonique ou au répondeur branché sur la prise gigogne. Réception en mode de réception sécurisée Vous pouvez empêcher les personnes non autorisées d’accéder à vos télécopies. Le mode de réception sécurisée permet d’interdire l’impression de toutes les télécopies reçues en votre absence. En mode de réception sécurisée, toutes les télécopies entrantes sont enregistrées dans la mémoire. Lorsque le mode est désactivé, toutes les télécopies enregistrées sont imprimées. Activation du mode de réception sécurisée 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RECEP PROTEGEE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Saisissez un mot de passe à 4 chiffres que vous souhaitez utiliser et appuyez sur OK. Vous pouvez activer le mode de réception sécurisée sans définir de mot de passe, mais vous ne pouvez pas protéger vos télécopies. 7. Saisissez à nouveau le mot de passe afin de le confirmer et appuyez sur OK. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. En mode de réception sécurisée, votre appareil enregistre les télécopies reçues dans la mémoire et affiche RECEP PROTEGEE pour vous avertir qu’une télécopie a été reçue. Impression des télécopies reçues 1. Accédez au menu RECEP PROTEGEE en suivant les étapes 1 à 4 de « Activation du mode de réception sécurisée ». 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que IMPRIMER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Saisissez le mot de passe à quatre chiffres et appuyez sur OK. L’appareil imprime l’ensemble des télécopies enregistrées dans la mémoire. Désactivation du mode de réception sécurisée 1. Accédez au menu RECEP PROTEGEE en suivant les étapes 1 à 4 de « Activation du mode de réception sécurisée ». 2. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que DESACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 3. Saisissez le mot de passe à quatre chiffres et appuyez sur OK. Le mode est alors désactivé et l’appareil imprime toutes les télécopies stockées en mémoire. 4. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Réception de télécopies en mémoire Étant donné que votre appareil est un dispositif multifonctions, il peut recevoir des télécopies même en cours de copie ou d’impression. Si vous recevez une télécopie alors que vous êtes en train d’effectuer une copie ou une impression, votre appareil enregistre les télécopies entrantes dans sa mémoire. Puis, dès que vous avez fini de copier ou d’imprimer, l’appareil se met automatiquement à imprimer la télécopie. Configuration des paramètres de document Avant d’envoyer une télécopie, modifiez les paramètres suivants en fonction de votre document original, afin d’obtenir la meilleure qualité.Télécopie_ 82 RESOLUTION Les paramètres par défaut donnent de très bons résultats avec les documents originaux classiques contenant du texte. Cependant, si vous envoyez des originaux peu visibles ou contenant des photographies, vous pouvez ajuster la résolution pour obtenir une télécopie de qualité supérieure. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RESOLUTION s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’option souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Les paramétrages de résolution recommandés pour les différents types d’originaux sont décrits dans le tableau ci-dessous : Mode Recommandé pour : STANDARD Originaux comportant des caractères de taille normale. SUPERIEURE Originaux contenant de petits caractères ou des lignes fines ou originaux imprimés à l’aide d’une imprimante matricielle. OPTIMALE Originaux contenant des détails extrêmement fins. La résolution OPTIMALE n’est activée que si l’appareil avec lequel vous communiquez la prend également en charge. • Le mode OPTIMALE n’est pas disponible lors de l’envoi de documents mémorisés. La résolution est automatiquement réglée sur SUPERIEURE. • Si la résolution de votre appareil est réglée sur OPTIMALE et que le télécopieur avec lequel vous communiquez ne prend pas en charge la résolution OPTIMALE, l’appareil transmet les données en appliquant la résolution la plus élevée acceptée par ce télécopieur. FAX PHOTO Originaux contenant des niveaux de gris ou des photographies. FAX COULEUR Originaux comportant des couleurs. L’envoi d’un fax couleur n’est activé que si l’appareil avec lequel vous communiquez prend également en charge la réception de fax couleur et que vous envoyez le fax manuellement. Dans ce mode, l’envoi de documents mémorisés n’est pas disponible. Le paramètre de résolution est appliqué au travail de télécopie en cours. Pour modifier le paramètre par défaut, reportez-vous à la section « Modifier défaut » à la page 87. LUMINOSITE Vous pouvez sélectionner le niveau de contraste du document original. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que LUMINOSITE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’option souhaitée apparaisse, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Le paramètre de contraste est appliqué au travail de télécopie en cours. Pour modifier le paramètre par défaut, reportez-vous à la section « Modifier défaut » à la page 87. Transfert d’une télécopie vers une autre destination Vous pouvez configurer l’appareil pour transférer une télécopie reçue ou envoyée vers une autre destination par télécopie. Cette fonction peut être utile si vous n’êtes pas au bureau et que vous attendez une télécopie. Transfert d’une télécopie envoyée vers une autre destination Vous pouvez configurer l’appareil pour transférer toutes vos télécopies envoyées vers une autre destination. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que REROUTAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RENVOI EMISS. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 8. Indiquez le numéro du télécopieur voulu, puis appuyez sur OK. 9. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Les télécopies envoyées suivantes seront transférées vers le télécopieur indiqué. Transfert d’une télécopie reçue vers une autre destination Grâce à cette fonction, vous pouvez transférer toutes vos télécopies reçues vers une autre destination. Lorsque l’appareil reçoit une télécopie, celle-ci est stockée en mémoire puis l’appareil la transmet à la destination spécifiée. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que 1.FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que REROUTAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK.Télécopie_ 83 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RECEP. TRANSF. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que REROUTAGE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. Pour paramétrer l’appareil pour qu’il imprime une télécopie lorsque le transfert est terminé, sélectionnez REROUT.&IMPR. 8. Indiquez le numéro du télécopieur voulu, puis appuyez sur OK. 9. Saisissez l’heure de début à l’aide de la flèche gauche/droite ou du pavé numérique, puis appuyez sur OK. 10.Saisissez l’heure de fin à l’aide de la flèche gauche/droite ou du pavé numérique, puis appuyez sur OK. 11.Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Les télécopies reçues suivantes seront transférées vers le télécopieur indiqué. Configuration d’un carnet d’adresses Vous pouvez configurer un Répertoire avec les numéros de télécopie les plus fréquemment utilisés. Votre appareil vous propose les fonctions suivantes pour paramétrer le Répertoire : Avant de commencer à enregistrer des numéros de télécopie, assurez-vous que votre appareil se trouve en mode télécopie. Numéros de composition abrégée Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu’à 200 numéros de télécopie fréquemment utilisés dans des numéros de composition rapide. Enregistrement d’un numéro abrégé 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NOUVEAU&MODIF. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COMP. ABREGEE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez un numéro abrégé compris entre 0 et 199, puis appuyez sur OK. Si une entrée est déjà enregistrée dans le numéro choisi, l’écran affiche le message afin de vous permettre de le modifier. Pour mémoriser le numéro à un autre emplacement mémoire, appuyez sur Retour. 6. Introduisez le nom que vous souhaitez, puis appuyez sur OK. Pour plus de détails concernant la saisie de caractères alphanumériques, reportez-vous à la section « Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique » à la page 46. 7. Saisissez le numéro de télécopie que vous souhaitez enregistrer, puis appuyez sur OK. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Modification de numéros abrégés 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NOUVEAU&MODIF. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COMP. ABREGEE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez le numéro abrégé que vous souhaitez modifier et appuyez sur OK. 6. Modifiez le nom et appuyez sur OK. 7. Modifiez le numéro de télécopie et appuyez sur OK. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Utilisation de numéros abrégés Lorsque vous êtes invité à introduire un numéro de destination lors de l’envoi d’une télécopie, saisissez le numéro abrégé auquel vous avez affecté le numéro souhaité. • Pour un numéro abrégé à un chiffre (0 à 9), pressez et maintenez enfoncée la touche numérique correspondante sur le clavier numérique. • Pour composer un numéro abrégé à deux ou trois chiffres, appuyez sur la ou les premières touches appropriées, puis appuyez sur la dernière touche et maintenez-la enfoncée. Vous pouvez également rechercher une entrée dans la mémoire en appuyant sur CARNET ADRES. (voir « Recherche d’une entrée dans le Carnet d’adresses » à la page 84). Numéros de composition de groupe Si vous envoyez fréquemment un même document à plusieurs destinataires, vous pouvez grouper ces destinataires et les affecter à un numéro de composition de groupe. Vous pouvez alors utiliser un numéro de composition de groupe pour envoyer un document à tous les destinataires au sein du groupe. Vous pouvez configurer 100 (0 à 99) numéros de composition de groupe à l’aide des numéros abrégés existant de destination. Enregistrement d’un numéro de composition de groupe 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NOUVEAU&MODIF. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COMP. GROUPE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez un numéro de composition de groupe compris entre 0 et 99, puis appuyez sur OK. Si une entrée est déjà enregistrée dans le numéro choisi, l’écran affiche le message afin de vous permettre de le modifier. 6. Introduisez le nom que vous souhaitez, puis appuyez sur OK. Pour plus de détails concernant la saisie de caractères alphanumériques, reportez-vous à la section « Saisie de caractères à l’aide du pavé numérique » à la page 46. 7. Saisissez les premières lettres du nom de composition abrégée souhaité. 8. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le nom et le numéro souhaités apparaissent, puis appuyez sur OK. 9. Appuyez sur OK lorsque OUI s’affiche à l’invite AUTRE NO.? Répétez l’étape 7 pour inclure d’autres numéros abrégés dans le groupe. 10.Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner NON à l’invite AUTRE NO.?, puis appuyez sur OK. 11.Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.Télécopie_ 84 Modification d’un numéro de composition de groupe 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que NOUVEAU&MODIF. s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COMP. GROUPE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Saisissez le numéro de composition de groupe que vous souhaitez modifier et appuyez sur OK. 6. Saisissez le nom que vous souhaitez modifier et appuyez sur OK. 7. Saisissez les premières lettres du nom de composition abrégée que vous souhaitez ajouter ou supprimer. 8. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le nom et le numéro souhaités apparaissent, puis appuyez sur OK. Si vous avez introduit un nouveau numéro abrégé, AJOUTER ? s’affiche. Si vous entrez un numéro abrégé enregistré dans le groupe, SUPPRIMER ? s’affiche. 9. Appuyez sur OK pour ajouter ou supprimer le numéro. 10.Appuyez sur OK lorsque OUI s’affiche, pour ajouter ou supprimer d’autres numéros, puis répétez les étapes 7 et 8. 11.Lorsque vous avez terminé, appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite pour sélectionner NON à l’invite AUTRE NO.?, puis appuyez sur OK. 12.Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Utilisation des numéros de composition de groupe Pour utiliser une entrée de composition de groupe, vous devez la rechercher et la sélectionner dans la mémoire. Lorsqu’on vous invite à introduire un numéro lors de l’envoi d’une télécopie, appuyez sur Répertoire. Voir ci-dessous. Recherche d’une entrée dans le Carnet d’adresses Il existe deux manières de retrouver un numéro en mémoire. Vous pouvez soit l’explorer de façon séquentielle de A à Z, soit l’explorer à l’aide des premières lettres du nom associé au numéro. Recherche séquentielle dans la mémoire 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RECH.&COMPOSER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COMP. GROUPE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que TOUS s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le nom et le numéro souhaités s’affiche. Vous pouvez rechercher vers le haut ou vers le bas dans l’ensemble de la mémoire et par ordre alphabétique. Recherche séquentielle dans la mémoire 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que RECH.&COMPOSER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que COMP. GROUPE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ID s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Saisissez les premières lettres du nom que vous recherchez. 7. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le nom et le numéro de composition de groupe souhaités s’affichent. Suppression d’une entrée du carnet d’adresses 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que SUPPRIMER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que l’option de suppression souhaitée s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que la méthode d’interrogation souhaitée s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. Sélectionnez TOUT RECH. pour rechercher une entrée en parcourant toutes les entrées du carnet d’adresses Répertoire. Sélectionnez RECH. ID pour rechercher une entrée par les premières lettres du nom. 6. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que le nom souhaité s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. Ou, introduisez les premières lettres. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/ droite jusqu’à ce que le nom souhaité s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 7. Appuyez sur OK lorsque OUI s’affiche pour confirmer la suppression. 8. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt. Impression du carnet d’adresses Vous pouvez vérifier les paramètres du Répertoire en imprimant une liste. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Répertoire du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que IMPRIMER s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. L’impression démarre. Impression automatique d’un rapport de télécopie Vous pouvez paramétrer l’appareil pour qu’il imprime un journal avec des informations détaillées concernant les 50 opérations de communication précédentes, notamment l’heure et la date. 1. Appuyez sur (Télécopie) sur le panneau de commande. 2. Appuyez sur la touche Menu du panneau de commande. 3. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que CONFIG. FAX s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 4. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que JOURNAL AUTO s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 5. Appuyez sur la flèche gauche/droite jusqu’à ce que ACTIVE s’affiche, puis appuyez sur OK. 6. Appuyez sur Arrêter/Suppr. pour revenir en mode prêt.État de l’appareil et caractéristiques avancées_ 85 10.État de l’appareil et caractéristiques avancées Ce chapitre vous explique comment naviguer dans les options d’état de l’appareil et comment définir les paramètres de configuration avancée. Lisez attentivement ce chapitre pour pouvoir utiliser toutes les fonctions de l’appareil. Ce chapitre contient les sections suivantes : • Configuration de fax • Configuration de copie • Impression d’un journal • Effacement de la mémoire • Réseau • Présentation des menus Selon les options ou le modèle de votre appareil, il est possible que certains menus ne s’affichent pas à l’écran. Dans ce cas, votre appareil ne les prend pas en charge. Configuration de fax Modification des options de configuration de télécopie Votre appareil possède diverses options personnalisables pour la configuration du télécopieur. Vous pouvez modifier les paramètres par défaut selon vos préférences et besoins.